Mathematical tools for the study of the incompressible Navier-Stokes equations 9781461459743, 9781461459750


202 92 3MB

English Pages 537 Year 2013

Report DMCA / Copyright

DOWNLOAD PDF FILE

Table of contents :
Mathematical Tools for the Study of the Incompressible Navier-Stokes Equations and Related Models......Page 3
Preface......Page 5
Contents......Page 9
1.1 The continuous medium assumption. Density......Page 15
1.2 Lagrangian and Eulerian coordinates......Page 17
2 The transport theorem......Page 19
3 Evolution equations......Page 21
3.1.2 Linear momentum equation......Page 22
3.1.3 Angular momentum equation......Page 23
3.1.4 Evolution of energy......Page 24
3.2 Cauchy's stress theorem......Page 25
3.3 Evolution equations revisited......Page 31
4 Fundamental laws: Newtonian fluids and thermodynamics laws......Page 33
4.2 Newton's hypothesis......Page 34
4.3 Consequences of the second law of thermodynamics......Page 39
4.4 Equation for the specific internal energy......Page 42
4.5 Formulation in entropy and temperature......Page 43
5 Summary of the equations......Page 44
6.1 The incompressibility assumption......Page 46
6.2.1 The nonhomogeneous incompressible Navier–Stoke sequations......Page 51
6.2.3 Dimensionless equations......Page 52
6.2.5 Initial and boundary data......Page 54
6.2.6 Additional comments......Page 55
7 Some exact steady solutions......Page 56
7.1 Poiseuille flow in a pipe......Page 57
7.2 Planar shear flow......Page 58
7.3 Couette flow between two cylinders......Page 60
Chapter II Analysis tools......Page 63
1 Main notation......Page 64
2.1 Banach spaces......Page 65
2.2 Weak and weak- convergences......Page 66
2.3.1 Definitions and main properties......Page 70
2.3.2 Elementary inequalities......Page 72
2.3.3 Mollifying kernels. Density result......Page 75
2.3.4 Weak and weak-* convergences in Lebesgue spaces......Page 77
2.3.5 Interpolation between Lp spaces......Page 80
2.3.6 Local Lebesgue spaces......Page 81
2.4 Partitions of unity......Page 82
2.5 A short introduction to distribution theory......Page 85
2.6 Lipschitz continuous functions......Page 89
3.1 Compact sets in function spaces......Page 91
3.2 Compact maps......Page 93
3.3 The Schauder fixed-point theorem......Page 97
4.1 Differentiation and antiderivatives......Page 98
4.2 Differential inequalities and Gronwall's lemma......Page 102
5.1 Definitions and main properties......Page 106
5.2.1 Weak time derivative......Page 108
5.2.2 Weak continuity......Page 109
5.2.3 Strong continuity......Page 112
5.3 Compactness theorems......Page 116
5.4 Banach-valued Fourier transform......Page 120
6.1 Definitions......Page 124
6.2 Elementary results of spectral theory......Page 126
6.3 Applications to the semigroup theory......Page 132
Chapter III Sobolev spaces......Page 135
1.1 General definitions......Page 136
1.2 Lipschitz domains......Page 137
2 Sobolev spaces on Lipschitz domains......Page 149
2.1 Definitions......Page 150
2.2 Mollifying operators and Friedrichs commutator estimates......Page 152
2.3 Change of variables......Page 163
2.4 Extension operator......Page 164
2.5.1 Trace operator and trace spaces......Page 167
2.5.2 Trace lifting operator......Page 170
2.5.3 Higher-order traces......Page 171
2.6.1 Definitions and characterisation......Page 173
2.6.2 Mollifying operators and Friedrichs commutation estimates......Page 176
2.7 Translation estimates......Page 178
2.8 Sobolev embeddings......Page 181
2.9 Poincaré and Hardy inequalities......Page 193
2.10 Domains of first-order differential operators......Page 198
3.1 Local charts description of the boundary......Page 203
3.2 Distance to the boundary. Projection on the boundary......Page 205
3.3 Regularised distance......Page 208
3.4 Parametrisation of a neighborhood of......Page 214
3.5.1 Definitions......Page 220
3.5.2 Tangent translation operators......Page 222
3.5.3 Characterisation through translation operators......Page 228
3.6 Differential operators in tangential/normal coordinates......Page 231
4.1 Dirichlet boundary conditions......Page 236
4.2 Neumann boundary conditions......Page 240
Chapter IV Steady Stokes equations......Page 243
1 Necas inequality......Page 244
1.1.1 The case of the whole space......Page 245
1.1.2 The flat half-space case......Page 246
1.1.3 The Lipschitz half-space case......Page 250
1.1.4 The general case......Page 251
1.2 Related Poincaré inequalities......Page 252
2 Characterisation of gradient fields. De Rham's theorem......Page 255
3.1 Right-inverse for the divergence......Page 259
3.2 The space Hdiv(Ω)......Page 262
3.3 Divergence-free vector fields. Leray decomposition......Page 263
4.1 Poincaré's theorems......Page 266
4.2.1 Definitions and first properties......Page 271
4.2.2 Density result and applications......Page 276
4.3 Kernel and image of the curl operator......Page 281
4.4 The div/curl problem......Page 283
5.1 Well-posedness of the Stokes problem......Page 287
5.2 Stokes operator......Page 291
5.3 The unsteady Stokes problem......Page 300
5.4 Penalty approximation of the Stokes problem......Page 301
6.1.1 Local regularity......Page 304
6.1.2.1 The case of the half-space Rd+......Page 307
6.1.2.2 Tangential regularity......Page 311
6.1.2.3 Complete regularity up to the boundary......Page 313
6.2 Higher-order regularity......Page 315
6.3 Lq theory of the Stokes problem......Page 316
6.4 Regularity for the div/curl problem......Page 318
7 The Stokes problem with stress boundary conditions......Page 320
7.1 The Stokes–Neumann problem......Page 321
7.2 Regularity properties......Page 325
7.3 Stress boundary conditions......Page 329
7.3.1 Preliminary remarks......Page 331
7.3.2 Existence......Page 333
7.3.3 Regularity......Page 336
8 The interface Stokes problem......Page 337
8.1 Existence and uniqueness......Page 338
8.2 Regularity of the solution......Page 340
9 The Stokes problem with vorticity boundary conditions......Page 343
9.1 Preliminaries......Page 344
9.2 A vector Laplace problem......Page 346
9.3 The Stokes problem......Page 354
Chapter V Navier–Stokes equations for homogeneous fluids......Page 358
1.1 Properties of the inertia term......Page 359
1.2 Weak formulations of the Navier–Stokes equations......Page 360
1.2.2 Time-dependent test functions......Page 361
1.2.3 Equivalence of the formulations......Page 362
1.3.1 Statement of the main result......Page 365
1.3.2 Approximate problem......Page 366
1.3.3 Energy estimates......Page 368
1.3.4 Passing to the limit......Page 370
1.3.5 The uniqueness problem......Page 373
1.3.6 Globality of weak solutions......Page 374
1.4 Kinetic energy evolution......Page 376
1.5 Existence and regularity of the pressure......Page 381
2 Strong solutions......Page 383
2.1 New estimates......Page 384
2.2.1 Existence......Page 386
2.2.2 Uniform bound over time......Page 388
2.3.1 General case......Page 389
2.3.2 Uniqueness of the strong solution......Page 391
2.3.3 The case of small data......Page 395
2.4 Parabolic regularity properties......Page 397
2.5 Regularisation over time......Page 402
3 The steady Navier–Stokes equations......Page 404
3.1.1 Existence......Page 405
3.1.2 Regularity......Page 407
3.2 The case of nonhomogeneous boundary conditions......Page 408
3.3 Uniqueness for small data......Page 414
3.4 Asymptotic stability of steady solutions......Page 415
Chapter VI Nonhomogeneous fluids......Page 421
1 Weak solutions of the transport equation......Page 423
1.1 Setting of the problem......Page 424
1.2 Trace theorem. Renormalisation property......Page 425
1.3 The initial- and boundary-value problem......Page 435
1.4 Stability theorem......Page 439
2.1 Main result......Page 446
2.2.1 Definition of the approximate problem......Page 447
2.2.2 Resolution of the approximate problem......Page 448
2.3.2 Time derivative estimate for the density......Page 455
2.3.3 Time translations estimates for the velocity......Page 456
2.4 End of the proof of the existence theorem......Page 459
2.5 The case without vacuum......Page 464
Chapter VII Boundary conditions modelling......Page 465
1.1 Setting up the model......Page 466
1.2 Existence and uniqueness......Page 470
1.2.2 The energy inequality......Page 471
1.2.3 Estimates of fractional derivatives with respect to time......Page 473
1.2.4 Existence of a weak solution......Page 477
1.2.5 Uniqueness in the case d = 2......Page 480
1.2.6 Existence of the pressure......Page 481
2 Dirichlet boundary conditions through a penalty method......Page 482
2.1 A simple example of a boundary layer......Page 484
2.2 Statement of the main result......Page 488
2.3 Formal asymptotic expansion......Page 491
2.3.1.1 Asymptotic expansion of Equation (1) of (VII.29)......Page 494
2.3.1.3 Asymptotic expansion of Equation (3) in (VII.29)......Page 496
2.3.2 Formal resolution of the profile equations......Page 497
2.3.2.2 Determination of W0......Page 498
2.3.2.4 Determination of 'W1 and q0......Page 499
2.3.2.5 Determination of q0 and W......Page 500
2.3.2.7 Determination of 'W2 and q1......Page 501
2.3.2.9 Determination of q1......Page 503
2.4 Well-posedness of profile equations......Page 504
2.5 Convergence of the asymptotic expansion......Page 509
2.5.1 Equations satisfied by the remainders......Page 510
2.5.2 Estimate of the remainders......Page 514
1.1 Definitions......Page 519
2 Extension to second-order tensors......Page 521
Appendix B Thermodynamics supplement......Page 523
2 The first law of thermodynamics. Internal energy......Page 524
3.1 Entropy......Page 525
3.2 Internal energy calculation......Page 526
4 Specific variables......Page 527
References......Page 529
Index......Page 535
Recommend Papers

Mathematical tools for the study of the incompressible Navier-Stokes equations
 9781461459743, 9781461459750

  • 0 0 0
  • Like this paper and download? You can publish your own PDF file online for free in a few minutes! Sign Up
File loading please wait...
Citation preview

Applied Mathematical Sciences Founding Editors Fritz John, Joseph Laselle and Lawrence Sirovich

Volume 183 Editors S.S. Antman Department of Mathematics and Institute for Physical Science and Technology University of Maryland College Park, MD 20742-4015 USA [email protected] P. Holmes Department of Mechanical and Aerospace Engineering Princeton University 215 Fine Hall Princeton, NJ 08544 USA [email protected] K. Sreenivasan Department of Physics New York University 70 Washington Square South New York City, NY 10012 USA [email protected] Advisors Greengard, L., Keener, J. Keller, J., Matkowsky, B., Pego, R. Peskin, C., Stevens, A., Stuart, A.

For further volumes: http://www.springer.com/series/34

Franck Boyer • Pierre Fabrie

Mathematical Tools for the Study of the Incompressible Navier-Stokes Equations and Related Models

Franck Boyer Laboratoire d’Analyse, Topologie, Probabilités Aix Marseille Université Marseille, France

Pierre Fabrie Institut de Mathématiques de Bordeaux Institut Polytechnique de Bordeaux ENSEIRB-MATMECA Pessac, France

ISSN 0066-5452 ISBN 978-1-4614-5974-3 ISBN 978-1-4614-5975-0 (eBook) DOI 10.1007/978-1-4614-5975-0 Springer New York Heidelberg Dordrecht London Library of Congress Control Number: 2012951655 Mathematics Subject Classification (2010): 35K55, 35J25, 35Q30, 76D03, 76D05, 76D07 © Springer Science+Business Media New York 2013 This work is subject to copyright. All rights are reserved by the Publisher, whether the whole or part of the material is concerned, specifically the rights of translation, reprinting, reuse of illustrations, recitation, broadcasting, reproduction on microfilms or in any other physical way, and transmission or information storage and retrieval, electronic adaptation, computer software, or by similar or dissimilar methodology now known or hereafter developed. Exempted from this legal reservation are brief excerpts in connection with reviews or scholarly analysis or material supplied specifically for the purpose of being entered and executed on a computer system, for exclusive use by the purchaser of the work. Duplication of this publication or parts thereof is permitted only under the provisions of the Copyright Law of the Publisher’s location, in its current version, and permission for use must always be obtained from Springer. Permissions for use may be obtained through RightsLink at the Copyright Clearance Center. Violations are liable to prosecution under the respective Copyright Law. The use of general descriptive names, registered names, trademarks, service marks, etc. in this publication does not imply, even in the absence of a specific statement, that such names are exempt from the relevant protective laws and regulations and therefore free for general use. While the advice and information in this book are believed to be true and accurate at the date of publication, neither the authors nor the editors nor the publisher can accept any legal responsibility for any errors or omissions that may be made. The publisher makes no warranty, express or implied, with respect to the material contained herein. Printed on acid-free paper Springer is part of Springer Science+Business Media (www.springer.com)

Preface

This monograph is a revised and augmented version of a previous book [24] written in French and published in 2006. Our objective is twofold. First, we want to introduce the reader to the modelling and the mathematical analysis in fluid mechanics. The central models we deal with are the incompressible Stokes and Navier–Stokes equations, whose derivation is exposed in the first chapter. Second, we introduce mathematical tools in a sufficiently general way so that the reader should be able to use them for studying many other kinds of nonlinear evolution partial differential equations. In this spirit, we tried to make the book as self-contained as possible. The only prerequisites that are needed to begin reading are basic results in calculus, integration, and functional analysis. The second chapter is a recap of more or less standard analysis results that are used in this book. This includes for instance: the definitions and properties of weak and weak- convergences in a Banach space, a short introduction to distribution theory, basic compactness results, the Bochner integral and related spaces, basic results in spectral theory, and so on. In Chapter III, we introduce and study Sobolev spaces on Lipschitz domains of Rd . The first section contains main definitions and properties of such domains. We describe, in particular, how to define the integral of functions defined on the boundary of such domains and we prove the fundamental Stokes formula. Sobolev spaces are then introduced and thoroughly studied in Section 2. An important role is played (in this chapter but also in the next ones) by suitable mollifying operators that permit us to prove the density of sets of smooth functions in various functional spaces. We also study embedding theorems, extension operators, trace and trace lifting operators, duality theory for Sobolev spaces, and the very important Poincar´e and Hardy inequalities. The third section of the chapter is devoted to the introduction of suitable normal/tangential coordinates near the boundary of a sufficiently smooth domain. This framework is useful for the study of tangential Sobolev spaces and thus for the proof of regularity properties, up to the boundary, to solutions of elliptic problems (like the Stokes problem, for instance). All v

vi

Preface

these notions are illustrated in the last section of the chapter where a complete study of the Laplace problem with Dirichlet or Neumann boundary conditions is given. Chapter IV concerns the steady (incompressible) Stokes equations. This is a central topic for the study of any model in incompressible fluid mechanics. A basic tool in this theory is the Neˇcas inequality, a complete proof of which is given in Section 1. This inequality is used in the next section to study relations between the gradient fields and the divergence-free vector fields. This is fundamental in order to build the pressure in the Stokes system. The next two sections are dedicated to particular properties of the divergence and curl operators as well as some related function spaces. The analysis of the Stokes problem with Dirichlet boundary conditions is undertaken in Section 5, which includes the definition of the Stokes operator and application to the unsteady Stokes problem through the semigroup approach. We postponed to Section 6 the complete proof of elliptic regularity properties of the Stokes equations. The last three sections are concerned with some nonstandard variants of the Stokes problem, considering different kind of boundary or interface conditions. The steady and unsteady Navier–Stokes equations are studied in Chapter V. For the unsteady problem, we prove existence and uniqueness (in 2D) of global weak solutions, we also investigate smoother solutions and discuss the parabolic regularisation properties of the system. Then, for the steady problem, we discuss existence and uniqueness issues in the case of homogeneous and nonhomogeneous boundary data and we deal with very basic stability issues for these solutions. In Chapter VI, we study the most complex model considered in this book which is the one of the (unsteady) incompressible Navier–Stokes equations for a nonhomogeneous fluid. The first ingredient that is useful in the analysis of this problem is the study of weak solutions for the transport equation. We propose here, in the first section of this chapter, a self-contained exposition of the Di Perna–Lions theory of renormalized solutions for such equations including more recent developments related to the associated trace problem. Those results are then used to prove global existence of weak solutions for the initial- and boundary-value problem associated with the complete Navier– Stokes system in the second section of the chapter. The final chapter is concerned with two different issues related to boundary conditions arising in numerical simulations of incompressible flows. The first section deals with the problem of outflow boundary conditions that one needs to choose in the case where the computational domain is, for practical reasons, smaller than the real physical domain. We analyse here a nonlinear boundary condition relating normal stress and momentum flux at the outflow boundary. In the second section of the chapter, we study the penalty method which can be used, for instance, to impose a homogeneous Dirichlet boundary condition on the boundary of an obstacle located in a computational domain whose geometry is simple. We prove convergence of the penalised

Preface

vii

solution towards the exact solution when the penalisation parameter goes to 0, through the description of a suitable boundary layer. Additionally to their practical interest, the analysis of these two problems gives the opportunity to introduce mathematical methods that the reader may find useful in other contexts. Marseille, August 2012,

Franck Boyer, Pierre Fabrie.

Contents

Preface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

v

Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

ix

I

The equations of fluid mechanics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 Continuous description of a fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.1 The continuous medium assumption. Density . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2 Lagrangian and Eulerian coordinates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 The transport theorem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 Evolution equations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.1 Balance equations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2 Cauchy’s stress theorem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.3 Evolution equations revisited . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 Fundamental laws: Newtonian fluids and thermodynamics laws 4.1 Fluids at rest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.2 Newton’s hypothesis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.3 Consequences of the second law of thermodynamics . . . . . 4.4 Equation for the specific internal energy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.5 Formulation in entropy and temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 Summary of the equations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 Incompressible models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.1 The incompressibility assumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.2 Overview of the incompressible models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 Some exact steady solutions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.1 Poiseuille flow in a pipe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.2 Planar shear flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.3 Couette flow between two cylinders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

1 1 1 3 5 7 8 11 17 19 20 20 25 28 29 30 32 32 37 42 43 44 46

II

Analysis tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 1 Main notation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 2 Fundamental results from functional analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 ix

x

Contents

2.1 Banach spaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.2 Weak and weak- convergences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.3 Lebesgue spaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.4 Partitions of unity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.5 A short introduction to distribution theory . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.6 Lipschitz continuous functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Basic compactness results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.1 Compact sets in function spaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2 Compact maps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.3 The Schauder fixed-point theorem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Functions of one real variable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.1 Differentiation and antiderivatives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.2 Differential inequalities and Gronwall’s lemma . . . . . . . . . . Spaces of Banach-valued functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.1 Definitions and main properties . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2 Regularity in time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.3 Compactness theorems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.4 Banach-valued Fourier transform . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Some results in spectral analysis of unbounded operators . . . . . 6.1 Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.2 Elementary results of spectral theory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.3 Applications to the semigroup theory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

51 52 56 68 71 75 77 77 79 83 84 84 88 92 92 94 102 106 110 110 112 118

Sobolev spaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 Domains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.1 General definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2 Lipschitz domains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 Sobolev spaces on Lipschitz domains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.1 Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.2 Mollifying operators and Friedrichs commutator estimates 2.3 Change of variables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.4 Extension operator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.5 Trace and trace lifting operators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.6 Duality theory for Sobolev spaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.7 Translation estimates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.8 Sobolev embeddings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.9 Poincar´e and Hardy inequalities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.10 Domains of first-order differential operators . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 Calculus near the boundary of domains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.1 Local charts description of the boundary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2 Distance to the boundary. Projection on the boundary . . . 3.3 Regularised distance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.4 Parametrisation of a neighborhood of ∂Ω . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.5 Tangential Sobolev spaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.6 Differential operators in tangential/normal coordinates . . .

121 122 122 123 135 136 138 149 150 153 159 164 167 179 184 189 189 191 194 200 206 217

3

4

5

6

III

Contents

xi

4 The Laplace problem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222 4.1 Dirichlet boundary conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222 4.2 Neumann boundary conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226 IV

Steady Stokes equations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 Neˇcas inequality . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.1 Proof of the inequality . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2 Related Poincar´e inequalities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 Characterisation of gradient fields. De Rham’s theorem . . . . . . . 3 The divergence operator and related spaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.1 Right-inverse for the divergence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2 The space Hdiv (Ω) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.3 Divergence-free vector fields. Leray decomposition . . . . . . . 4 The curl operator and related spaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.1 Poincar´e’s theorems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.2 The space Hcurl (Ω) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.3 Kernel and image of the curl operator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.4 The div/curl problem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 The Stokes problem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.1 Well-posedness of the Stokes problem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2 Stokes operator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.3 The unsteady Stokes problem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.4 Penalty approximation of the Stokes problem . . . . . . . . . . . 6 Regularity of the Stokes problem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.1 First degree of regularity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.2 Higher-order regularity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.3 Lq theory of the Stokes problem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.4 Regularity for the div/curl problem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 The Stokes problem with stress boundary conditions . . . . . . . . . 7.1 The Stokes–Neumann problem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.2 Regularity properties . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.3 Stress boundary conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 The interface Stokes problem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.1 Existence and uniqueness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.2 Regularity of the solution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 The Stokes problem with vorticity boundary conditions . . . . . . . 9.1 Preliminaries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.2 A vector Laplace problem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.3 The Stokes problem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

229 230 231 238 241 245 245 248 249 252 252 257 267 269 273 273 277 286 287 290 290 301 302 304 306 307 311 315 323 324 326 329 330 332 340

V

Navier–Stokes equations for homogeneous fluids . . . . . . . . . 1 Leray’s theorem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.1 Properties of the inertia term . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2 Weak formulations of the Navier–Stokes equations . . . . . . . 1.3 Existence and uniqueness of weak solutions . . . . . . . . . . . . .

345 346 346 347 352

xii

Contents

1.4 Kinetic energy evolution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.5 Existence and regularity of the pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 Strong solutions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.1 New estimates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.2 The two-dimensional case . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.3 The three-dimensional case . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.4 Parabolic regularity properties . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.5 Regularisation over time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 The steady Navier–Stokes equations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.1 The case of homogeneous boundary conditions . . . . . . . . . . 3.2 The case of nonhomogeneous boundary conditions . . . . . . . 3.3 Uniqueness for small data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.4 Asymptotic stability of steady solutions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

363 368 370 371 373 376 384 389 391 392 395 401 402

Nonhomogeneous fluids . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 Weak solutions of the transport equation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.1 Setting of the problem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2 Trace theorem. Renormalisation property . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.3 The initial- and boundary-value problem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.4 Stability theorem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 The nonhomogeneous incompressible Navier–Stokes equations . 2.1 Main result . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.2 Approximate problem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.3 Estimates for the approximate solution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.4 End of the proof of the existence theorem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.5 The case without vacuum . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

409 411 412 413 423 427 434 434 435 443 447 452

VII Boundary conditions modelling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 Outflow boundary conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.1 Setting up the model . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2 Existence and uniqueness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 Dirichlet boundary conditions through a penalty method . . . . . 2.1 A simple example of a boundary layer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.2 Statement of the main result . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.3 Formal asymptotic expansion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.4 Well-posedness of profile equations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.5 Convergence of the asymptotic expansion . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

453 454 454 458 470 472 476 479 492 497

Classic differential operators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 The scalar and vector cases . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.1 Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2 Useful formulas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 Extension to second-order tensors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

507 507 507 509 509

VI

A

Contents

B

Thermodynamics supplement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 Heat capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 The first law of thermodynamics. Internal energy . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 The second law of thermodynamics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.1 Entropy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2 Internal energy calculation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 Specific variables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

xiii

511 512 512 513 513 514 515

References . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 517 Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 523

Chapter I

The equations of fluid mechanics

This first chapter introduces the equations of fluid mechanics and the various models which we study later. Among the many books published on fluid mechanics, and more generally on the mechanics of continuous media, we recommend that readers consult, for example, references [90, 66, 102, 127, 126, 123] if they seek a more detailed description of the various concepts. Moreover, some of the thermodynamics concepts we use here are very briefly described in Appendix B.

1 Continuous description of a fluid 1.1 The continuous medium assumption. Density A fluid consists in a large number of molecules in motion without a precise shape at rest (contrary to a solid). A first approach to studying a fluid might involve writing down the equations of motion for each of the particles by considering their interactions (collisions, characterised by the mean free path, but also long-range interaction). One such, so-called statistical, approach led to the kinetic theory of fluids and to statistical mechanics more generally. It can be traced back to the work of Maxwell in the middle of the nineteenth century. In a large number of physical situations, if the mean density of the fluid studied is not too low (i.e., if the characteristic lengths of the problem are large compared to the mean free path of the particles), then the fluid can be considered as a continuous medium. This means that the movement of the particles can be considered as a whole and not independently for each particle. Hence, we can define macroscopic quantities that characterise the system: density, velocity, and so on. F. Boyer and P. Fabrie, Mathematical Tools for the Study of the Incompressible Navier-Stokes Equations and Related Models, Applied Mathematical Sciences 183, DOI 10.1007/978-1-4614-5975-0_1, © Springer Science+Business Media New York 2013

1

2

Chapter I. The equations of fluid mechanics

An intuitive description of a continuum medium is the following. Let δV be an elementary volume of space around a point M at a given time t in the considered fluid. Here, the volume δV is supposed to be small compared to the size of the problem studied but, nevertheless, sufficiently large compared to the mean free path of the molecules. This implies that this volume δV contains a large number of molecules. If we now denote δm as the mass contained in this elementary volume, then the density of the fluid at the point M at time t can be intuitively defined as the ratio ρ≈

δm . δV

If it can be established by measurements that this quantity is essentially independent of the elementary volume δV selected around M at time t, provided that its size remains within the limits described above, then it is said that the continuous medium assumption holds. In that case, an intuitive statistical definition of the velocity of the flow at point M and at time t is defined as the velocity of the centre of mass of the particles contained in the elementary volume δV N mi vi v ≈ i=1 , N i=1 mi where mi and vi represent the mass and velocity of each of the molecules in δV and N is the number of these molecules. Here also, this ratio is expected to be essentially independent of the size of the volume δV . An interactive illustration of the validity of the continuous medium assumption is available in [125]. A more formal definition of the density is the following. Definition I.1.1. We say that the continuous medium description is valid, if there exists a nonnegative function (t, X) → ρ(t, X) such that the mass contained in any fluid volume ω at time t can be expressed as follows  Mass in ω at time t = ρ(t, X) dX. (I.1) ω

This function ρ is called the density field of the fluid under study. From the previous formal discussion, it should be clear that formula (I.1) can only be expected to be valid for fluid volumes ω whose size is sufficiently larger than the mean free path of the molecules in the fluid. Under normal conditions of temperature and pressure, the mean free path in a conventional gas (oxygen, hydrogen, nitrogen, etc.) is on the order of 100 nm = 10−7 m, whereas in water this characteristic length is around 10−10 m. This is, of course, very small compared with the characteristic size of problems studied in the majority of actual situations. However, in more extreme situations, for example, at very high altitudes where the air is rarefied, the mean free path in the medium may be very much longer and its order of

1. Continuous description of a fluid

3

magnitude can become comparable to the dimensions of the real problems being investigated (e.g. the flow of air around a space shuttle in the upper layers of the atmosphere). In this case, the fluid can no longer be assumed to be a continuous medium and it becomes necessary to use a microscopic statistical description of the medium. Throughout the sequel of this book, we assume that we are dealing with a continuous medium. Notation: The main notation and properties used here concerning common differential operators are reviewed in appendix A.

1.2 Lagrangian and Eulerian coordinates In fluid mechanics there are two “canonical” coordinate systems in which the various equations of motion can be written. Lagrangian coordinates are associated with a fluid particle (or a fluid volume element) as described below and follow it throughout its evolution. By contrast, Eulerian coordinates are the coordinates of the fixed reference frame associated with the experiment. In some circumstances, such as for studying free surface flows or fluid– solid interactions, Lagrangian coordinates are actually quite useful. However, since the work of Euler in the eighteenth century, it has been more usual and convenient to write flow equations using Eulerian coordinates, and it is these that we will use here. The continuous medium assumption allows us to consider the movement of the fluid molecules as a whole and not individually. Let ω ⊂ R3 be the volume of space occupied by the fluid at the initial time. The flow is described by a family of bijective maps (ϕt )t defined on ω, such that for any Ω0 ⊂ ω, the set Ωt = ϕt (Ω0 ) exactly contains, at time t, the same fluid molecules that were present in Ω0 at the initial time (we always assume in this book that there is no matter source or sink in the system, otherwise the equations should be adapted accordingly). Definition I.1.2. Such a family of sets (Ωt )t , with Ωt = ϕt (Ω0 ), indexed by the time variable t, is called a fluid element. In the case where Ω0 is a single point Ω0 = {x0 }, we call it a fluid particle. This is a purely mathematical concept, that is not related to any precise molecule of the fluid. In this last case, for any t we have Ωt = {ϕt (x0 )}. As a consequence, ϕt (x0 ) is the position in a fixed reference frame at time t of the fluid particle that occupied the position x0 at the initial time 0. We may thus introduce for any t, t0 , and x0 the point X(t, t0 , x0 ) = ϕt (ϕ−1 t0 (x0 )) which is the position at time t of the fluid particle whose position was x0 at time t0 . The map t → X(t, t0 , x0 ) is called the trajectory of this fluid particle. Knowing X or (ϕt )t is equivalent and allows the evolution of the system to be perfectly determined. Nevertheless, we are not generally interested in

4

Chapter I. The equations of fluid mechanics

identifying the positions of each of the fluid particles of the system at a given time; rather, it is preferable to work with the macroscopic velocity field v defined by the kinematic relation   ∂X(s, t, x) , (I.2) v(t, x) = ∂s |s = t which means that v(t, x) is the velocity of the fluid particle passing through x at time t. Equivalently, for any t and any x0 , this definition reads v(t, ϕt (x0 )) =

∂ϕs (x0 ) . ∂s |s = t

(I.3)

Remark I.1.1. From (I.3), we see that, provided the velocity field v is known and is smooth enough, it is theoretically possible to determine the position field X by resolving the following differential equation, sometimes known as the characteristic equation, ∂X(t, t0 , x0 ) = v(t, X(t, t0 , x0 )), and X(t0 , t0 , x0 ) = x0 . ∂t

(I.4)

The coordinates (t, X) above, constitute the so-called Eulerian coordinate system. Working in Eulerian coordinates involves fixing a position X and writing the mechanical and thermodynamical balance equations at this fixed point. Let f (t, X) be any quantity related to the description of the fluid (density, temperature, etc.). The price to pay for the use of Eulerian coordinates is that the partial derivative of f with respect to time ∂f /∂t does not correctly describe the variation of the quantity f with time for the particle passing through the fixed position X at time t. This is because it does not account for the motion of the particle. In this case, the correct concept for a time derivative of f in the Eulerian description is that of the material derivative defined by Df ∂f = + v · ∇f. (I.5) Dt ∂t This definition comes from the following calculation of the variation with respect to time of the quantity f associated with a fluid particle.  d f (t, X(t, t0 , x0 )) dt ∂X ∂f = (t, X(t, t0 , x0 )) + (t, t0 , x0 ) · ∇f (t, X(t, t0 , x0 )) ∂t ∂t ∂f = (t, X(t, t0 , x0 )) + v(t, X(t, t0 , x0 )) · ∇f (t, X(t, t0 , x0 )) ∂t Df (t, X(t, t0 , x0 )). = Dt

2. The transport theorem

5

For simplicity, when stating and describing the results of this chapter, a number of assumptions are made regarding the regularity of the variables used to characterise the flow (density, velocity, etc.). Note, however, that it is possible to weaken those assumptions in some cases.

2 The transport theorem We begin by describing a fundamental result of differentiation, known in fluid mechanics as the transport theorem. It shows us how to differentiate the value of a scalar quantity integrated over a fluid element (Ωt )t . We assume that, for each t, the map ϕt is a smooth diffeomorphism and that t → ϕt is smooth. To simplify the notation a little we also set ϕ(t, x) = ϕt (x) = X(t, 0, x). Theorem I.2.1. For any function f of class C 1 with respect to the variables (t, X) ∈ R × R3 , we have     ∂f d f (t, X)dX = + div(f v) dX, dt Ωt ∂t Ωt for any time t, where v is the vector field in R3 defined in (I.2). Proof. At a fixed t, the change of variables x ∈ Ω0 → X = ϕ(t, x) ∈ Ωt ensures that   f (t, X)dX = f (t, ϕ(t, x))|J(t, x)|dx, Ωt

Ω0

where J is the Jacobian determinant of the map x → ϕ(t, x). Moreover the determinant is a trilinear function with respect to its three rows. From (I.3) we deduce the identity ∂ ∂ϕi ∂ ∂ϕi ∂ (t, x) = (vi (t, ϕ(t, x))) . (t, x) = ∂t ∂xj ∂xj ∂t ∂xj Omitting to write the points where the derivatives are evaluated, we obtain ∂v1 ∂v1 ∂v1 ∂x1 ∂x2 ∂x3 d ∂ϕ2 ∂ϕ2 ∂ϕ2 J(t, x) = dt ∂x1 ∂x2 ∂x3

∂ϕ1 ∂ϕ1 ∂ϕ1 ∂x1 ∂x2 ∂x3 +

∂ϕ3 ∂ϕ3 ∂ϕ3 ∂x1 ∂x2 ∂x3 Applying the chain rule then gives

∂v2 ∂v2 ∂v2 ∂x1 ∂x2 ∂x3 ∂ϕ3 ∂ϕ3 ∂ϕ3 ∂x1 ∂x2 ∂x3

∂ϕ1 ∂ϕ1 ∂ϕ1 ∂x1 ∂x2 ∂x3 +

∂ϕ2 ∂ϕ2 ∂ϕ2 . ∂x1 ∂x2 ∂x3 ∂v3 ∂v3 ∂v3 ∂x1 ∂x2 ∂x3

Chapter I. The equations of fluid mechanics

6

 ∂vk ∂ ∂ϕl (vk (t, ϕ(t, x))) = (t, ϕ(t, x)) (t, x). ∂xj ∂Xl ∂xj 3

(I.6)

l=1

We define the row vectors Lk and Mk as   ∂ϕk ∂ϕk ∂ϕk (t, x), (t, x), (t, x) , Lk = ∂x1 ∂x2 ∂x3   ∂ ∂ ∂ (vk (t, ϕ(t, x))) , (vk (t, ϕ(t, x))) , (vk (t, ϕ(t, x))) . Mk = ∂x1 ∂x2 ∂x3 Equation (I.6) shows that Mk =

3  ∂vk (t, ϕ(t, x)) Ll , ∂Xl l=1

hence, this gives

3 3  ∂v1  ∂v1 Ll , L2 , L3 = det(Ll , L2 , L3 ) det(M1 , L2 , L3 ) = det ∂Xl ∂Xl l=1

l=1

∂v1 ∂v1 det(L1 , L2 , L3 ) = (t, ϕ(t, x)) J, = ∂X1 ∂X1 because the determinant is trilinear and alternating. Similar calculations yield det(L1 , M2 , L3 ) =

∂v2 ∂v3 (t, ϕ(t, x)) J, det(L1 , L2 , M3 ) = (t, ϕ(t, x)) J. ∂X2 ∂X3

However, we have seen that we can write ∂J = det(M1 , L2 , L3 ) + det(L1 , M2 , L3 ) + det(L1 , L2 , M3 ). ∂t This results in

∂J(t, x) = (div v)(t, ϕ(t, x)) J(t, x). ∂t

We have defined ϕ(t) to be a C 1 -diffeomorphism that depends continuously − on t, so its Jacobian J is not zero and it takes all its values in R+ ∗ or in R∗ , ∞ domains over which the “absolute value” function is C and has the “sign” function as its derivative. Therefore, the function |J| is differentiable, and ∂|J| ∂J = sgn(J) = sgn(J)(div v)(t, ϕ(t, x)) J = (div v)(t, ϕ(t, x)) |J|. ∂t ∂t By applying the theory for differentiation under the integral sign, we obtain

3. Evolution equations

d dt



f (t, X) dX = Ωt

d dt 

7



= Ω0

f (t, ϕ(t, x))|J(t, x)| dx Ω0

 ∂ f (t, ϕ(t, x))|J(t, x)| dx. ∂t

Furthermore,    ∂f ∂ ∂ϕ ∂ · ∇f |J| + f (t, ϕ) |J| f (t, ϕ(t, x))|J(t, x)| = (t, ϕ) |J| + ∂t ∂t ∂t ∂t   ∂f = (t, ϕ) + v · ∇f + f (t, ϕ)(div v)(t, ϕ(t, x)) J | |. ∂t An inverse change of variables in the above, gives the result that     ∂f d f (t, X) dX = + v · ∇f + f div v dX dt Ωt ∂t Ω   t ∂f = + div(f v) dX. ∂t Ωt  Remark I.2.1. This result for differentiation of a scalar equation can be generalised to vector equations. For convenience, we give this result below in condensed form, in which F (t, X) is a vector quantity:     d ∂F F (t, X) dX = + div(F ⊗ v) dX, dt Ωt ∂t Ωt with the same vector field v as in the preceding theorem. See Appendix A for the definition of div(F ⊗ v).

3 Evolution equations In this section, we introduce the set of equations that describes the motion of a fluid. These are the equations for the conservation of mass, for the conservation of momentum, and finally for the conservation of energy. We use a Eulerian description of motion and limit ourselves to the case of Newtonian flows (see Section 4). In all this section, (Ωt )t is an arbitrary fluid element as in Definition I.1.2.

8

Chapter I. The equations of fluid mechanics

3.1 Balance equations 3.1.1 Mass conservation We recall that we assumed that there is neither a sink nor a source of matter within the flow considered. Therefore, the mass conservation property can be stated as follows: for any given initial volume Ω0 the total mass of the matter contained in Ωt = ϕt (Ω0 ) at time t is the same as the one contained in Ω0 at the initial time. Using the notion of density introduced in Definition I.1.1, this property can be expressed as  d ρ dX = 0. dt Ωt Note that to avoid the equations appearing too cumbersome, we no longer express the dependency on (t, X) for the various unknowns in the problem, unless it is really necessary. Using the transport theorem (Theorem I.2.1), this can be equivalently written as    ∂ρ + div(ρv) dX = 0, ∂t Ωt which has to hold for all time t and for any choice of the fluid element (Ωt )t evolving with the flow. Assuming that ρ and v are regular functions, this clearly leads to the following partial differential equation, known as the conservation of mass equation or the continuity equation or the mass balance equation ∂ρ + div(ρv) = 0. (I.7) ∂t 3.1.2 Linear momentum equation In this section we apply Newton’s second law of motion in order to express the evolution of linear momentum for a fluid element. The total linear momentum contained within a fluid element (Ωt )t , at time t, is the quantity  ρv dX. Ωt

Newton’s second law of motion states that the rate of change of this total momentum is equal to the sum of the external forces applied to this fluid element. In general, these forces are of two types: • Body forces,

 ρf dX, Ωt

3. Evolution equations

9

where, in many situations, the mass density of forces f (which represents the external forces experienced by the fluid) is reduced to the acceleration due to gravity. • Surface forces,  τ (ν) dy, ∂Ωt

where ν is the unit normal outward from the surface ∂Ωt of Ωt . These forces are exerted on the investigated fluid element, (Ωt )t , by the rest of the flow; they are called the stress forces. Of course, the vector τ (ν) also depends on (t, y) but we have not expressed this explicitly in the equations. Hence, in general, the equation for the linear momentum is written using the transport theorem for vector fields (Remark I.2.1) in the following way,      ∂ρv ρf dX + τ (ν) dy, (I.8) + div(ρv ⊗ v) dX = ∂t Ωt Ωt ∂Ωt and has to be satisfied for any choice of the fluid element (Ωt )t .

3.1.3 Angular momentum equation We now apply the theory of angular momentum to the fluid element (Ωt )t . This states that the rate of change of the total angular momentum of the fluid element, calculated with respect to a given fixed point, is equal to the sum of the moments of the forces exerted on the element calculated at the same point. This can be written by considering a fixed point O and by defining r as −−→ the position vector OX    d r ∧ (ρv) dX = r ∧ (ρf ) dX + r ∧ τ (ν) dy. dt Ωt Ωt ∂Ωt Since in Eulerian coordinates the position vector r does not depend on time, the transport theorem (Theorem I.2.1) tells us that the preceding equation can be written          ∂ρv + div (r ∧ ρv) ⊗ v dX = r∧ r∧(ρf )dX+ r∧τ (ν) dy. ∂t Ωt Ωt ∂Ωt Furthermore, using Formula (A.10) from Appendix A, we have

10



Chapter I. The equations of fluid mechanics



div (r ∧ ρv) ⊗ v = (div v)(r ∧ ρv) + (v · ∇)(r ∧ ρv) 3    vi ∂xi (r ∧ ρv) = r ∧ (div v)ρv + i=1 3 3     ∂r vi (r ∧ ∂xi ρv) + vi ∧ (ρv) = r ∧ (div v)ρv + ∂xi i=1 i=1 3      ∂r vi ∧ (ρv). = r ∧ (div v)ρv + r ∧ v · ∇(ρv) + ∂x i i=1

However, since the point O is fixed, we have ∂r/∂xi = ei , the ith vector of the canonical basis of R3 . Hence the final term of the preceding equation can be expressed by 3  i=1

 ∂r ∧ (ρv) = vi ei ∧ (ρv) = v ∧ (ρv) = 0. ∂xi i=1 3

vi

By applying Formula (A.10) once more, we obtain   div (r ∧ ρv) ⊗ v = r ∧ (div(ρv ⊗ v)). In conclusion, the equation for conservation of angular momentum can be written in the form      ∂ρv r∧ r ∧ (ρf ) dX + r ∧ τ (ν) dy. (I.9) + div(ρv ⊗ v) dX = ∂t Ωt Ωt ∂Ωt 3.1.4 Evolution of energy We start by recalling the first law of thermodynamics which states that the rate of change of the total energy of a system is the sum of the power of mechanical forces and of the heat exchange rate with the exterior. The total energy per unit volume is given by the quantity ρ E ≡ ρ (e+ 12 |v|2 ) where e is the specific internal energy (i.e. per unit mass) related to the thermodynamic state of the fluid and 12 ρ|v|2 represents the kinetic energy per unit volume. The power of external forces can be broken down into two terms, one associated with the body forces and the other with the stresses applied at the surface   ˙ = W ρ f · v dX + τ (ν) · v dy. Ωt

∂Ωt

We assume that there is no heat source (by radiation, for example) inside the volume; then the heat input rate in the volume Ωt takes the form

3. Evolution equations

11

 Q˙ = −

Φ(t, y, ν) dy, ∂Ωt

where the assumption is made that the term Φ for heat transfer across the surface of Ωt depends only on the position, time, and the outward normal of Ωt at the point considered. As with the stress τ , we only express the dependency on (t, y) when necessary. The energy balance can now be written as     d ρE dX = ρf · v dX + τ (ν) · v dy − Φ(ν) dy. dt Ωt Ωt ∂Ωt ∂Ωt By applying the transport theorem to the derivatives with respect to time, the following conservation equation is obtained.    ∂ρE + div(ρE v) dX ∂t Ωt   (I.10) = ρf · v dX + τ (ν) · v dy − Φ(ν) dy. Ωt

∂Ωt

∂Ωt

3.2 Cauchy’s stress theorem In this section, we study the general form of stresses τ (ν) and, more precisely, we demonstrate the fundamental theorem below. This stipulates that stress is linear with respect to the normal to the surface of the volume element considered. In this section, we explicitly express the dependence of stresses on (t, y) which are, therefore, denoted by τ (t, y, ν). Theorem I.3.1 (Cauchy’s stress). Assume that the density field ρ, the velocity field v, and the body force density f are regular. Let also assume that, the vector ν being fixed, the function (t, y) → τ (t, y, ν) is continuous. Then, there exists a tensor-valued function (t, y) → σ(t, y) such that for all (t, y) and for all unit vectors ν we have τ (t, y, ν) = σ(t, y).ν. Proof. The key point of the proof is an homogeneity argument comparing the sizes of surface and volume integrals in linear momentum balance equations on an elementary control volume whose size tends to 0. Let us give the details of these computations. • We first show that τ (t, y, ν) = −τ (t, y, −ν) for all (t, y, ν). Let us set

Chapter I. The equations of fluid mechanics

12

h=

∂ρv + div(ρv) − ρf, ∂t

such that the equation for conservation of momentum (I.8) is written for any domain ω as   h dX = τ (t, y, ν) dy. (I.11) ω

∂ω

Let y0 be an unspecified point and ν0 a unit vector. We consider a sphere ω centred on y0 and divided into two hemispheres ω1 and ω2 by the plane Σ passing through y0 and orthogonal to ν0 (it is assumed that ν0 is directed from ω1 towards ω2 ). By applying the conservation equation above to ω, to ω1 and to ω2 , we obtain, respectively,   h dX = τ (t, y, ν) dy, ∂ω  ω h dX = τ (t, y, ν0 ) dy + τ (t, y, ν) dy, ∂ω1 ∩Σ

ω1

and



 h dX =

ω2

∂ω∩∂ω1

∂ω2 ∩Σ

 τ (t, y, −ν0 ) dy +

τ (t, y, ν) dy. ∂ω∩∂ω2

Inasmuch as ω = ω1 ∪ ω2 and ∂ω = (∂ω ∩ ∂ω1 ) ∪ (∂ω ∩ ∂ω2 ), we can combine these three equations to obtain    τ (t, y, ν0 ) + τ (t, y, −ν0 ) dy = 0. ∂ω1 ∩Σ

This is valid for any sphere ω centred on y0 , which can be as small as desired, thus by continuity of the function y → τ (t, y, ν0 ) + τ (t, y, −ν0 ) we obtain τ (t, y0 , −ν0 ) = −τ (t, y0 , ν0 ). • A priori, the function τ (t, y, ν) is only defined for unit vectors ν. Because of the property above, we can extend this function to all vectors ξ of R3 by   ξ , τ (t, y, ξ) = |ξ|τ t, y, |ξ| and τ (t, y, 0) = 0. From this, it follows that this function is homogeneous of order 1 with respect to ξ. Indeed, we have

3. Evolution equations







ξ λξ = |λ||ξ|τ t, y, sgn(λ) |λξ| |ξ|   ξ = λτ (t, y, ξ). = |λ||ξ| sgn(λ)τ t, y, |ξ|

τ (t, y, λξ) = |λ||ξ|τ



13

t, y,

• We can now demonstrate the additive nature of the function ξ → τ (t, y, ξ). Let ξ1 and ξ2 be two vectors from R3 . If these two vectors are colinear, then the homogeneity property above is sufficient to make the conclusion. Suppose, now, that ξ1 is not colinear with ξ2 . Let y0 be a fixed point. There is a plane P generated by the point y0 and the vectors ξ1 , ξ2 with an orientation, which is equivalent to choosing a unit normal ν0 to this plane. We denote ξi⊥ as the vector obtained by the rotation of the vector ξi through an angle of π/2 in the positive sense.

x ˜2 x ˜1 y˜0 Ωε ν0

x2 x1

y0

P Fig. I.1 The prism Ωε

We now introduce the points x1 = y0 + εξ1⊥ , x2 = y0 − εξ2⊥ , and y˜0 = y0 + εν0 , x ˜1 = x1 + εν0 , x ˜2 = x2 + εν0 , ˜1 x ˜2 form a right prism (denoted Ωε ) of height ε and such that y0 x1 x2 y˜0 x having the triangle y0 x1 x2 as its base (see Figures I.1 and I.2). If we now apply Equation (I.11) to this prism Ωε , then after division by ε2 , we obtain   1 1 h dX = τ (t, y, ν) dy. (I.12) ε2 Ωε ε2 ∂Ωε The surface terms can be broken into five components, three referring to the lateral faces of the prism and two concerning the bases of the prism. On the two bases, the outward unit normal is given by ±ν0 , and the outward unit normals of the lateral faces are exactly identical to the outward unit

Chapter I. The equations of fluid mechanics

14

−ε(ξ1 + ξ2 ) ⊥ + ξ2 )

1



− εξ 2

εξ2

x1 ⊥ −ε(ξ 1

εξ ⊥

x2

εξ

1

y0 Fig. I.2 The triangle y0 x1 x2 in the plane P

normals of triangle y0 x1 x2 in the plane P of the triangle. However, we have x1 − y0 = εξ1⊥ , x2 − y0 = −εξ2⊥ , and hencex2 − x1 = −ε(ξ1⊥ + ξ2⊥ ), and, therefore, there exists a value η ∈ {−1, 1} that does not depend on ε (it depends only on the orientation selected) such that the outward unit normals of the lateral faces of the prism are given by ξ1 , |ξ1 | ξ2 ˜2 y˜0 ) = η ν(y0 x2 x , |ξ2 | ξ1 + ξ2 ˜2 x ˜1 ) = −η ν(x1 x2 x . |ξ1 + ξ2 | ν(y0 x1 x ˜1 y˜0 ) = η

The surface term in (I.12), is then expressed by using the homogeneity of the function τ with respect to ξ, as  1 τ (t, y, ν) dy ε2 ∂Ωε  η τ (t, y, ξ1 + ξ2 ) dy =− 2 ε |ξ1 + ξ2 | x1 x2 x˜2 x˜1   η η τ (t, y, ξ1 ) dy + 2 τ (t, y, ξ2 ) dy + 2 ε |ξ1 | y0 x1 x˜1 y˜0 ε |ξ2 | y0 x2 x˜2 y˜0   1 1 τ (t, y, −ν0 ) dy + 2 τ (t, y, ν0 ) dy. + 2 ε y0 x1 x2 ε y˜0 x˜1 x˜2

3. Evolution equations

15

However, we have already seen that τ (t, y, −ν0 ) = −τ (t, y, ν0 ) and, furthermore, the area of the triangle y0 x1 x2 is equal to the area of the triangle y˜0 x ˜2 x ˜2 and has the value ε2 |ξ1 ∧ ξ2 |/2. It is therefore proportional to ε2 . Since we assume that y → τ (t, y, ν0 ) is continuous, we obtain, using the mean value theorem,   1 1 τ (t, y, −ν0 ) dy + 2 τ (t, y, ν0 ) dy ε2 y0 x1 x2 ε y˜0 x˜1 x˜2  1 (τ (t, y, −ν0 ) + τ (t, y + εν0 , ν0 )) dy = 2 ε y0 x1 x2  C (τ (t, y, −ν0 ) + τ (t, y + εν0 , ν0 )) dy −−−→ 0. = ε→0 area(y0 x1 x2 ) y0 x1 x2 Let us now consider one of the terms on a lateral face, for example, y0 x1 x ˜1 y˜0 . The area of this rectangular face is ε|x1 − y0 | = ε2 |ξ1 |. The term corresponding to this face can therefore be written as   η η τ (t, y, ξ ) dy = τ (t, y, ξ1 ) dy 1 ε2 |ξ1 | y0 x1 x˜1 y˜0 area(y0 x1 x ˜1 y˜0 ) y0 x1 x˜1 y˜0 −−−→ ητ (t, y0 , ξ1 ). ε→0

Passing to the limits is justified by continuity (and thus uniform continuity in the neighborhood of y0 ) of the function y → τ (t, y, ξ1 ). The two remaining surface terms are treated in the same way. It just remains to investigate the volume term in Equation (I.12). Remember that it was assumed that ρ and v are regular fields and therefore the function h is locally bounded. The volume of the prism Ωε is clearly proportional to ε3 , therefore we immediately obtain  1 ≤ Cε −−−→ 0. h dX ε2 ε→0 Ωε Finally, we can pass to the limit in (I.12), when ε tends to 0, and we obtain 0 = ητ (t, y0 , ξ1 ) + ητ (t, y0 , ξ2 ) − ητ (t, y0 , ξ1 + ξ2 ). After simplifying this equation by η, this can be expressed as τ (t, y0 , ξ1 + ξ2 ) = τ (t, y0 , ξ1 ) + τ (t, y0 , ξ2 ). All of the above demonstrate the linearity of the stress τ (t, y, ξ) with respect to ξ and therefore prove the existence of the tensors σ(t, y) such that τ (t, y, ν) = σ(t, y).ν, for each unit vector ν.  Definition I.3.2. For all points (t, y), the tensor σ(t, y) defined by the relation

Chapter I. The equations of fluid mechanics

16

τ (t, y, ν) = σ(t, y).ν, for all unit vectors ν, is known as the stress tensor of the flow. Again, to avoid cumbersome equations, we no longer indicate the dependence of the stress tensor on (t, y). Hence, we write the stress in the form τ (ν) = σ.ν. The surface term in the energy conservation equation (I.10) is now expressed by using the divergence theorem (i.e., the Stokes formula; see Theorem III.1.8)    t (σ.ν) · v dy = ν · ( σ.v) dy = div(t σ.v) dX. ∂Ωt

∂Ωt

Ωt

Hence, the energy evolution equation becomes    ∂ρE + div(ρE v) dX ∂t Ω    t ρf · v dX + div(t σ.v) dX − = Ωt

Ωt

(I.13) Φ(ν) dy.

∂Ωt

It is now possible to establish a result, similar to Cauchy’s theorem, for the heat transfer terms Φ, which is stated in the following form. Theorem I.3.3. Let us assume that ρ, E , v and f are regular functions. Let us further assume that for all ν the function (t, y) → Φ(t, y, ν) is continuous; then there exists a continuous vector field ϕ, such that Φ(t, y, ν) = ϕ(t, y) · ν. This vector field is called the heat flux in the flow. The proof of this result is formally identical to that for Cauchy’s theorem using the conservation of energy equation in the form (I.13). We can then apply the divergence theorem again to obtain a new form of the energy evolution equation    ∂ρE + div(ρE v) dX ∂t Ω    t ρf · v dX + div(t σ.v) dX − div ϕ dX. = Ωt

Ωt

Ωt

Since this holds for any fluid element (Ωt )t evolving with the flow, we obtain the local form of the equation ∂ρE + div(ρE v) − div(t σ.v) + div ϕ = ρf · v. ∂t

(I.14)

3. Evolution equations

17

3.3 Evolution equations revisited Now that we know, from Cauchy’s theorem, that the stress forces have the tensor form τ (ν) = σ.ν, we can deduce a simpler form for the conservation of momentum equation. Indeed, the divergence theorem (Theorem III.1.8) tells us that for any domain Ω, we have   σ.ν dy = div σ dX, ∂Ω

Ω

hence, the conservation equation (I.8) can be written as      ∂ρv ρf dX + div σ dX. + div(ρv ⊗ v) dX = ∂t Ωt Ωt Ωt This relation having to be valid for any fluid element (Ωt )t , we obtain the linear momentum equation in its local form ∂(ρv) + div(ρv ⊗ v) − div σ = ρf. ∂t

(I.15)

What will the angular momentum conservation relation now become? First we need to calculate the surface term and try to express it as a volume integral. To do this we attempt to write the term r ∧ (σ.ν) in the form T.ν where T is a new tensor to be determined. We therefore write ⎞ ⎛ ⎞ ⎛ ⎞ ⎛ 3 3 3    r ∧ (σ.ei ) = r ∧ ⎝ σji ej ⎠ = ⎝ rj ej ⎠ ∧ ⎝ σji ej ⎠ j=1

j=1

j=1

= (r2 σ3i − r3 σ2i )e1 + (r3 σ1i − r1 σ3i )e2 + (r1 σ2i − r2 σ1i )e3 , which demonstrates that the ith column of the tensor matrix T in the canonical basis is simply ⎛ ⎞ r2 σ3i − r3 σ2i ⎝ r3 σ1i − r1 σ3i ⎠ . r1 σ2i − r2 σ1i The surface term of (I.9) is expressed, by applying the divergence theorem to tensor T , as    r ∧ (σ.ν) dy = T.ν dy = div T dX. ∂Ωt

∂Ωt

Ωt

Hence, Equation (I.9) becomes      ∂ρv r∧ r ∧ (ρf ) dX + div T dX. + div(ρv ⊗ v) dX = ∂t Ωt Ωt Ωt

Chapter I. The equations of fluid mechanics

18

Inasmuch as this relation must be true for any time t and any fluid element (Ωt )t , this provides us with the equation for the angular momentum in its local form   ∂ρv r∧ + div(ρv ⊗ v) − ρf − div T = 0. (I.16) ∂t We now need to calculate the divergence of T . Let us begin with the first component, and note that the position vector, r, satisfies the relation ∂ri /∂xj = δij (the Kronecker delta): 3  ∂ (r2 σ3i − r3 σ2i ) ∂x i i=1   3  3  ∂σ3i ∂σ2i ∂r2 ∂r3 r2 + − r3 σ3i − σ2i = ∂x ∂x ∂x ∂x i i i i i=1 i=1   = r ∧ div σ 1 + (σ32 − σ23 ).

(div T )1 =

A similar calculation for the other two components gives ⎞ ⎛ σ32 − σ23 div T = r ∧ div σ + ⎝ σ13 − σ31 ⎠ . σ21 − σ12 Hence, Equation (I.16) can now be written as  r∧

⎞ σ32 − σ23 ∂ρv + div(ρv ⊗ v) − ρf − div σ − ⎝ σ13 − σ31 ⎠ = 0. ∂t σ21 − σ12 



However, Equation (I.15) demonstrates that the vector product which appears in this equation is identically zero (because the second factor is zero). It has hence been shown that ⎛ ⎞ σ32 − σ23 ⎝ σ13 − σ31 ⎠ = 0. σ21 − σ12 This fundamental property can be stated in the following way. Theorem I.3.4. Let us assume that the density field ρ, the velocity field v, and the body forces field f are smooth; then the stress tensor acting on the fluid in the flow is symmetric. This result has a number of fundamental consequences, as we show below. One of these is the existence, for all points (t, y), of an orthonormal basis of R3 that diagonalises the tensor σ. These basis vectors are known as the principal axes of the tensor and the corresponding eigenvalues are termed the principal stresses associated with the tensor σ.

4. Fundamental laws: Newtonian fluids and thermodynamics laws

19

Remark I.3.1. Now that we have established that the stress tensor is symmetric, it is clear that the evolution equation for the linear momentum implies the one for the angular momentum. Hence, from this point onwards, it is not needed to add this last equation in the system governing the motion of a fluid. Using the symmetry of the stress tensor, the evolution equation for the energy (I.14) can be written in the form ∂(ρE ) + div(ρE v) − div(σ.v) + div ϕ = ρf · v. ∂t

(I.17)

Remark I.3.2. The equations (I.15) and (I.17) obtained so far, are said to be in the conservative form, because they are expressed in the form of a divergence in (t, x) of a given quantity equal to a source term. It is sometimes more relevant, for formal calculations or physical interpretations, to write the preceding equations in the nonconservative form, as follows, • Linear momentum equation:   ∂v ρ + (v · ∇)v − div σ = ρf. ∂t   

(I.18)

= Dv Dt

• Energy equation:   ∂E + (v · ∇)E − div(σ.v) + div ϕ = ρf · v. ρ ∂t   

(I.19)

= DE Dt

These equations are obtained algebraically, starting from our earlier equations and using the mass balance equation and (A.4), (A.10). From a formal point of view they are completely equivalent. From a mathematical point of view, when working with weak solutions (i.e., solutions that are not very regular), it is not always clear whether these two formulations are equivalent or even if we can attach a meaning to the nonconservative formulations.

4 Fundamental laws: Newtonian fluids and thermodynamics laws In the preceding section, we provided the general form of the equations for the conservation of mass and the evolution of linear momentum and energy, describing the flow of a fluid that is subject to body forces and does not contain a source of matter or heat within the domain being studied.

20

Chapter I. The equations of fluid mechanics

These equations give rise to several, and yet undetermined, quantities, namely, the stress tensor σ (so far we only know that it is symmetric), the heat flux ϕ, and the specific internal energy e. These last two quantities are related to the other fields describing the flow via the laws of thermodynamics; we return to them in Section 4.4.

4.1 Fluids at rest We consider initially the case of the stress tensor, σ. We start by remembering one of the fundamental properties of fluids. Definition I.4.1. In a fluid at rest, the stress acting on a surface element of a fluid element acts in the direction opposite to the one of the outward normal of the surface. Moreover, the modulus of this stress is independent of direction. It is denoted as p and referred to as the hydrostatic pressure of the fluid. Hence, from this definition of the pressure, for a fluid at rest, the stress at all points is τ (ν) = −p ν, with p ≥ 0. This means that the stress tensor can, in this case, be written as σ = −p Id. When the fluid is in motion, the effects due to pressure and to the motion are separated by expressing the stress tensor in the form σ = T − p Id, where the new tensor T (which is clearly symmetric) is called the viscous stress tensor. Notice that it is postulated that the hydrostatic pressure p exactly coincides with the thermodynamic pressure P which is related to the state of the material at the molecular level as defined in Appendix B.

4.2 Newton’s hypothesis Let us consider a planar Couette flow for a viscous fluid (see also Section 7.2). This involves a fluid flow between two parallel plates that are assumed to be infinite (e.g., parallel to the plane generated by the first two coordinate vectors e1 and e2 ). We assume that under the action of a stress (i.e., of a force per unit surface) of constant magnitude and aligned along the direction of e1 (this stress is denoted F e1 ), the upper plate is driven at a velocity equal to U0 e1 whereas the lower plate is held at rest.

4. Fundamental laws: Newtonian fluids and thermodynamics laws

21

It can be observed experimentally for “classic” fluids, such as water for example, that the viscous stress F required to move the plate at velocity U0 is given by U0 (I.20) F =μ , d where μ is a constant that depends only on the fluid being considered. Put another way, the stress F is proportional to the velocity gradient U0 /d in the flow. This stress effect is a form of resistance of the fluid to shearing. Indeed, if we cease to apply the driving force F at a given instant, then after a certain time the fluid will return to the rest state. However, we know that in the absence of a driving force and frictional forces, a point mass having a certain initial non-zero velocity maintains this velocity over time. In the case of water, for instance, we observe that the velocity is damped over time when the driving force is stopped. Such a fluid is said to be viscous. We observed above that viscous effects appear once the fluid is subject to deformation. In a simplified way, in the case of the Couette flow, one can say that particles at height x3 = C + h have a horizontal velocity that is greater than that of particles at height x3 = C, which creates the deformation of the fluid. These ideas can be stated formally in the following way. Definition I.4.2. Consider a flow for which the velocity field is v. Let us consider three arbitrarily close points x0 , x1 = x0 +(δx)ξ1 , and x2 = x0 +(δx)ξ2 . ˜1 , and x ˜2 the positions at time t + δt of the fluid particles We denote as x ˜0 , x that were situated respectively at x0 , x1 , and x2 at time t. We say that the fluid behaves as a rigid body at the point x0 at time t, ˜0 x ˜1 x ˜2 can be superimposed up to a first-order if the triangles x0 x1 x2 and x correction with respect to δt and δx, for any choice of the directions ξ1 and ξ2 . More precisely, this means that for all i, j, k, we have   −−→ −−→ → − −x →) 1 + Oδt2 + δx2  . ˜j · x ˜i x ˜k ) = (− x− x · x (x ˜i x (I.21) i j i k Definition and Proposition I.4.3. A fluid behaves like a rigid body at (t, x) if, and only if, the tensor defined by    1 ∂vi ∂vj 1 t + D(v) = (∇v + ∇v) = 2 2 ∂xj ∂xi 1≤i,j≤3 is zero at (t, x). The tensor D(v) is known as the strain rate tensor for the flow. Proof. We denote as s → x0 (s), x1 (s), and x2 (s), the respective trajectories start˜i = xi (t + δt). From the charing from x0 , x1 , and x2 at time t, such that x

Chapter I. The equations of fluid mechanics

22

acteristic equation (I.4), we have xi (s) = v(s, xi (s)), 

so that xi (s)

=

 ∂v + (v · ∇)v (s, xi (s)). ∂t

Let us carry out a Taylor expansion in the following way for each j ∈ {0, 1, 2}, 



1

(1 − s)

x ˜j = xj + δt v(t, xj ) + δt2 0

 ∂v + (v · ∇)v (t + s δt, xj (t + s δt)) ds. ∂t

However, since for i = j, |xi − xj | ≤ Cδx, and using the continuous dependence of the solutions of the characteristic equation with respect to the initial data, we get |xi (s) − xj (s)| ≤ Cδx, ∀s ∈ [t, t + δt]. Hence, using the mean value theorem and assuming that the velocity field is sufficiently regular, it follows x ˜j − x ˜i = xj − xi + δt(v(t, xj ) − v(t, xi )) + O(δt2 δx). By performing a first-order expansion of the term v(t, xj )−v(t, xi ), we obtain −−→ ˜1 = x ˜1 − x ˜0 = x1 − x0 + δtδx∇v(t, x0 ).ξ1 + O(δtδx2 ) + O(δt2 δx), x ˜0 x and −−→ ˜2 = x ˜2 − x ˜0 = x2 − x0 + δtδx∇v(t, x0 ).ξ2 + O(δtδx2 ) + O(δt2 δx). x ˜0 x Next, we take the scalar product to obtain   −−→ −−→ −−→ −−→ x ˜0 x ˜1 · x ˜0 x ˜2 = x0 x1 · x0 x2 + δtδx2 (∇v(t, x0 ).ξ1 ) · ξ2 + (∇v(t, x0 ).ξ2 ) · ξ1 + O(δtδx3 ) + O(δt2 δx2 ). → −−→ 2 2 By definition, we have − x− 0 x1 · x0 x2 = (δx )(ξ1 · ξ2 ) = Cδx , from which we can deduce −−→ −−→ → −−→ ˜1 · x ˜0 x ˜2 ) = (− x− (x ˜0 x 0 x1 · x0 x2 )     × 1 + δt (∇v(t, x0 ).ξ1 ) · ξ2 + (∇v(t, x0 ).ξ2 ) · ξ1 + O(δt2 + δx2 ) . It can then be seen that condition (I.21) is thus equivalent to (∇v(t, x0 ).ξ1 ) · ξ2 + (∇v(t, x0 ).ξ2 ) · ξ1 = 0,

4. Fundamental laws: Newtonian fluids and thermodynamics laws

23

for all vectors ξ1 and ξ2 ; this indicates exactly that the tensor ∇v(t, x0 ) is antisymmetric or, equivalently, that D(v) is zero at the point (t, x0 ).  Remark I.4.1. It can be shown (see Lemma IV.7.5) that a velocity field v obeying D(v) = 0 for all t, x is necessarily of the form v(t, x) = v0 (t) + ω(t) ∧ r, where r is the position vector in a fixed reference frame. Alternatively we could express this by saying that, under these conditions, the motion is the superposition of a translational motion at uniform velocity (in x) and a rotational motion around a fixed axis, which corresponds to the possible motions of a rigid body. Remark I.4.2. Elementary computations lead to the formulas Tr(Dv) = Tr ∇v = div v, div(t ∇v) = ∇(div v), div(2Dv) = div(∇v + t ∇v) = Δv + ∇(div v), div((div v) Id) = ∇(div v), which are useful in the sequel. The discussion above shows that all the information on the rate of deformation of the fluid in the flow is contained in the symmetric part D(v) of the velocity gradient tensor ∇v. Under these conditions, the standard viscous behavior of a fluid can be summed up as follows. 1. The viscous stress tensor T in a flow depends only on the strain rate tensor D(v). 2. The dependence of T on D(v) is linear. 3. The relation linking T and D(v) is isotropic. Of course, not all fluids will conform to these properties. A fluid that satisfies these properties experimentally is known as a Newtonian fluid. A Newtonian fluid may also display non-Newtonian behavior in extreme conditions of temperature, pressure, or velocity. Some comments are required on Newton’s three assumptions. The first comes directly from the preceding considerations: the viscous stress in a fluid results directly from the action of the strain rate to which the fluid is subjected. It is therefore natural that the tensor T only depends on D(v). The assumption of linearity is a simple generalisation of (I.20) which shows, in the simple case of planar Couette flow (see also Section 7.2), that the stress F is linear with respect to the deformation U/d. We can therefore write T = L(D(v)), where L is a linear map defined from the set of all symmetric tensors into itself. Finally, the third proposition is very natural in physics

Chapter I. The equations of fluid mechanics

24

and expresses the invariance of the rheological properties of the fluid studied when changing the orthonormal reference frame. The exact significance of this proposition is as follows. For all changes to the orthonormal reference frame (i.e., for all orthogonal matrices P ) and for all symmetric tensors d, we have L(t P dP ) = t P L(d)P. (I.22) Proposition I.4.4. For a Newtonian fluid, the law giving the viscous stress tensor as a function of the strain rate tensor is necessarily in the form T = 2μD(v) + λ(div v) Id, where λ and μ are both real coefficients. Proof. Let d be a symmetric tensor and x an eigenvector of d for an eigenvalue Λ. We consider the matrix P of the symmetry with respect to the hyperplane orthogonal to x. That is to say P x = −x and the restriction of P to the orthogonal of x is the identity. Since x is an eigenvector of d, and by definition of P , we have t P dP = d such that property (I.22) gives t

P L(d)P = L(d),

or even, inasmuch as P is orthogonal, L(d)P = P L(d). If we apply this to x, we get P L(d)x = L(d)P x = −L(d)x and hence, from the definition of P , L(d)x is necessarily colinear to x, which proves that x is an eigenvector of L(d). We denote the eigenvalue of L(d) associated with x as f (Λ). Note that f (Λ) does not depend on the eigenvector x for the eigenvalue Λ of d. Indeed, if y is another such eigenvector, then the preceding calculation shows that tx + (1 − t)y is also an eigenvector of L(d) for all t ∈ R. This proves that x and y are eigenvectors of L(d) for the same eigenvalue. We can now calculate L(d) when d is diagonal. Let Ei denote the matrix for which all the coefficients are zero except the coefficient (i, i) which has a value of 1. Following our discussion above, there exist values λ and μ such that L(E1 ) = 2μE1 + λ Id. Now, let Qi be the permutation matrix that exchanges the indices 1 and i, such that we have Ei = t Qi E1 Qi , and hence

4. Fundamental laws: Newtonian fluids and thermodynamics laws

25

L(Ei ) = L(t Qi E1 Qi ) = t Qi L(E1 )Qi = 2μt Qi E1 Qi + λ Id = 2μEi + λ Id. This is true for all i, thus we have established that for all diagonal tensors d we have L(d) = 2μd + λ(Tr d) Id. Now, let d be any symmetric tensor. There exists an orthogonal matrix Q such that t QdQ is diagonal, giving   t t t t L(d) = QL( QdQ) Q = Q 2μ QdQ + λ(Tr( QdQ)) Id t Q = 2μ d + λ(Tr d) Id. As a consequence, the relation giving the viscous stress tensor can be expressed as T = L(D(v)) = 2μD(v) + λ(Tr D(v)) Id = 2μD(v) + λ(div v) Id, because the trace of the strain rate tensor is simply the divergence of v.  We can now write the general form of the stress tensor for a Newtonian fluid σ = T − p Id = 2μD(v) + (λ div v − p) Id.

4.3 Consequences of the second law of thermodynamics The second law of thermodynamics implies that the viscous stresses are necessarily dissipative, that is, that the power of these forces must be nonnegative. In order to describe this more clearly, it is useful to write the entropy evolution equation. This is done in detail below by using the results revised in Appendix B. In particular, we show that the local specific entropy equation can be expressed in the following conservative form,   div ϕ Tr(T D(v)) ∂ρs + div(ρsv) + − = 0, ∂t T T where s is the specific entropy (i.e., per unit mass) in the flow, and T is the temperature. If we consider any fluid element (Ωt )t evolving with the flow under study, the total entropy evolution can be expressed, using the transport theorem, as

26

d dt



Chapter I. The equations of fluid mechanics

 ρs dX = −

Ωt

  ϕ · ∇T Tr(T D(v)) dX + dX − dX 2 T T T Ωt Ωt   ϕ·ν ϕ · ∇T Tr(T D(v)) dX + dy − dX. 2 T T T Ωt Ωt

div Ωt

 =−

∂Ωt

ϕ

If we integrate this equation between times t and t + δt, and if we call S(t) =  ρs dX the total entropy contained in the fluid element Ωt , it follows that Ωt





−ϕ · ν dy ds T t ∂Ωs  t+δt  −ϕ · ∇T Tr(T D(v)) dX ds + dX ds. T2 T Ωs t t+δt

S(t + δt) − S(t) − 

t+δt



= t

Ωs

(I.23)

The left-hand side of this equation can be written in the form ΔS − ΔQ/T where ΔQ if the quantity of heat acquired by the fluid element through its boundary between the two times t and t + δt (don’t forget that ν is the outward normal to Ωt ). The second law of thermodynamics in the form (B.1) tells us that this quantity should be nonnegative, or even positive if the transformation between these two times is irreversible. In this form, the second law of thermodynamics is known as the Clausius theorem. It can also be written in the local form:   ϕ ∂ρs + div(ρsv) + div ≥ 0. ∂t T We deduce from the Clausius theorem and from (I.23) that we must have ϕ · ∇T ≤ 0, for any possible ∇T ,

(I.24)

Tr(T D(v)) ≥ 0, for any possible D(v).

(I.25)

and By using the notation from the preceding paragraph, the relation (I.25) expresses that the quadratic form d → P(d) ≡ L(d) : d = Tr(L(d) . d) defined over the set of all symmetric tensors, must be positive-semidefinite. From the isotropy property (I.22), we know that P(t QdQ) = P(d) for all orthogonal matrix Q. Hence, it is sufficient for us to study the quadratic form defined in R3 by ⎞⎞ ⎛⎛ d1 0 0 P(d1 , d2 , d3 ) = P ⎝⎝ 0 d2 0 ⎠⎠ . 0 0 d3 Since the matrix of this quadratic form in the basis of R3 formed by the vectors

4. Fundamental laws: Newtonian fluids and thermodynamics laws



⎞ ⎛

27



⎛ ⎞ 1 1 1 ⎝ −1 ⎠ , ⎝ 0 ⎠ , and ⎝ 1 ⎠ , 0 −1 1 is simply



⎞ 4μ 2μ 0 ⎝ 2μ 4μ ⎠, 0 0 0 6μ + 9λ

we deduce that P is positive-semidefinite if and only if the following conditions hold, μ ≥ 0 and 2μ + 3λ ≥ 0. (I.26) The coefficient μ is known as the dynamic viscosity of the flow and the coefficient 2μ/3 + λ (which is then nonnegative) is known as the bulk viscosity of the flow. In many cases, the bulk viscosity is very low and can be neglected (Stokes’ assumption); that is, 2 (I.27) λ = − μ. 3 This finally gives rise to the following expression for the viscous stress tensor,   1 T = 2μ D(v) − (div v) Id , 3 which, in this case, has a zero trace. This implies that all of the isotropic components of the stresses are contained in the pressure p. In the case where the dynamic viscosity μ is small and can be neglected, we set μ = 0, and the fluid is said to be perfect or inviscid. To finish, we can now give a general expression for the heat flux, ϕ. Indeed, if we assume that the flux ϕ only depends on the temperature and its gradient, and that the dependence of ϕ on ∇T is invariant when changing between inertial reference frames, then we obtain Fourier’s law which says that ϕ is proportional to the temperature gradient. Furthermore, the relation (I.24) tells us that the flux’s direction is opposite to the one of the temperature gradient. We can therefore write ϕ = −k∇T,

(I.28)

where the coefficient k is nonnegative and called the thermal conductivity of the fluid. This coefficient may depend on various characteristics of the fluid such as temperature or pressure.

Chapter I. The equations of fluid mechanics

28

4.4 Equation for the specific internal energy Now that we have described the law which gives the stress tensor in a flow of a Newtonian fluid, we can concentrate on the various possible equivalent forms for the evolution equation for the energy, depending on the thermodynamic variables that we select to describe the system. We start by establishing the equation obeyed by the specific internal energy e which is linked to the total energy per unit mass E by the equation 1 E = e + |v|2 , 2 which shows the separation of the total energy into the internal and kinetic energy terms. To do this, it is useful first to write the evolution equation for kinetic energy in the nonconservative form. This is obtained as a consequence of the conservation of momentum equation by taking the scalar product of (I.18) by v. This gives   ρ ∂|v|2 2 + v · ∇|v| − (div σ) · v − ρ f · v = 0. 2 ∂t Let us subtract this equation from the energy equation (I.19). We obtain   ∂e + v · ∇e + div ϕ + (div σ) · v − div(σ.v) = 0. ρ ∂t However, the tensor σ being symmetric, we have v · div σ − div(σ.v) =

3 

vj

i,j=1

=−

3  i,j=1

3  ∂ ∂ σji − (σij vj ) ∂xi ∂x i i,j=1

σij

∂ vj = − Tr(σ∇v). ∂xi

By breaking down σ into σ = T − p Id where T is the viscous stress tensor, we obtain   ∂e ρ + v · ∇e + div ϕ + p (div v) − Tr(T ∇v) = 0. ∂t For a Newtonian fluid, we saw that we have T = 2μD(v) + λ (div v) Id, and hence we obtain

4. Fundamental laws: Newtonian fluids and thermodynamics laws

29

Tr(T ∇v) = Tr(T D(v))     = Tr λ(div v)D(v) + 2μ Tr D(v)D(v) ,   = λ(div v) Tr(∇v) + 2μ Tr D(v)D(v) , = λ(div v)2 + 2μD(v) : D(v) = λ(div v)2 + 2μ|D(v)|2 , because we have div v = Tr(D(v)). As we have seen above, under the conditions of Equation (I.26) this quantity is always nonnegative in accordance with the second law of thermodynamics. By applying Fourier’s law (I.28), the equation expressing the change in specific internal energy with time can be written as   ∂e ρ + v · ∇e − div(k ∇T ) + p (div v) − λ(div v)2 − 2μ|D(v)|2 = 0. (I.29) ∂t In the conservative form, Equation (I.29) has the form: ∂(ρe) + div(ρev) − div(k∇T ) + p (div v) − λ(div v)2 − 2μ|D(v)|2 = 0. ∂t

4.5 Formulation in entropy and temperature We can now use the thermodynamic concepts recalled in Appendix B to deduce the equivalent expression for the conservation equation using the specific entropy and temperature as variables. These concepts, even though they concern a priori the equilibrium thermodynamics for homogeneous systems, can be applied to any elementary fluid particle inasmuch as it is reasonable to assume that the relaxation time for the internal structure of the fluid particle is very much shorter than the characteristic time for the overall movement of the fluid. As a consequence, we assume that the fluid is everywhere and at any time at the thermodynamic equilibirum. First let us write the differential of (s, ρ) → e(s, ρ) in the form   1 de = T ds − p d , ρ where 1/ρ is the specific volume of the flow (refered to as v in the appendix). At the Lagrangian level, that is, using the material derivative D/Dt, we then deduce that

Chapter I. The equations of fluid mechanics

30

 

D

1

ρ De Ds =T −p Dt Dt Dt Ds p Dρ =T + 2 Dt ρ Dt Ds p =T − (div v), Dt ρ

by using the mass conservation equation (I.7). Equation (I.29) therefore becomes an equation for the specific entropy s ρT

Ds − div(k ∇T ) − λ(div v)2 − 2μ |D(v)|2 = 0. Dt

Let us now try to obtain the equation in terms of temperature T . To do this, we use the differential expression for the specific internal energy e as a function of the temperature and the specific volume (B.4). We write this as 

   ∂p 1 , de = cv dT + T −p d ∂T ρ ρ which using the conservation of mass equation (I.7) gives 

 ∂p DT De Dρ 1 −p = cv − 2 T Dt Dt ρ ∂T ρ Dt 

 ∂p DT 1 T = cv − p (div v). + Dt ρ ∂T ρ Hence, Equation (I.29) can be expressed in terms of temperature in the form   DT ∂p (div v) − div(k ∇T ) − λ(div v)2 − 2μ |D(v)|2 = 0, +T ρcv Dt ∂T ρ or again in the conservative form, assuming that cv is a constant   ∂p ∂(ρcv T ) (div v) + div(ρcv T v) + T ∂t ∂T ρ − div(k ∇T ) − λ(div v)2 − 2μ |D(v)|2 = 0,

5 Summary of the equations If we consider a Newtonian fluid for which the viscosity coefficients (λ and μ) are assumed to be constant (in general they may depend on density and

5. Summary of the equations

31

temperature), then the viscous stress tensor can be written as T = 2μD(v) + λ(div v) Id, where λ and μ obey the conditions (I.26). Under these conditions, using Remark I.4.2, the flow of the fluid is governed by the following equations. • Mass conservation:

∂ρ + div(ρv) = 0. ∂t • Linear momentum evolution:   ∂(ρv) + div (ρ v ⊗ v) − μΔv + ∇ p − (λ + μ)(div v) − ρ f = 0. ∂t

Remember that the equation governing kinetic energy can be deduced from the two preceding equations and therefore does not need to be added to the equations modelling the evolution of the flow. This property underlies all the mathematical techniques used in the rest of this book to study the equations of fluid mechanics. They are often called the energy methods. • Evolution of the total energy of the system: This last equation can take many formally equivalent forms, as a function of the thermodynamic unknowns that are considered. Each possesses both a conservative and a nonconservative form. – Using the total energy per unit mass E = e + 12 |v|2 ∂(ρE ) + div(ρE v) − div(k ∇T ) − div(T .v) + div(p v) − ρ f · v = 0. ∂t – Using the internal energy: ∂(ρe) + div(ρe v) − div(k∇T ) + p (div v) − λ(div v)2 − 2μ |D(v)|2 = 0. ∂t – Using the specific entropy:   ∂s + v · ∇s − div(k ∇T ) − λ(div v)2 − 2μ |D(v)|2 = 0. ρT ∂t – Using temperature, assuming a constant specific heat capacity at constant volume, cv :   ∂(ρcv T ) ∂p (div v) + div(ρcv T v) − div(k∇T ) + T ∂t ∂T ρ − λ(div v)2 − 2μ |D(v)|2 = 0. The motion is, therefore, perfectly defined by three evolution equations. Of course, the system must be closed by adding an equation of state which

32

Chapter I. The equations of fluid mechanics

relates the various thermodynamic variables of the system to one another (the ideal gas law p = kρT , the Van der Waals law (p + aρ2 )(1 − bρ) = kρT , or many others). This set of equations is called the full Navier–Stokes–Fourier system. It has to be supplemented by initial and boundary conditions that we discuss briefly in Section 6.2.5. Finally, we mention that the flow is said to be steady if all the fields associated with the flow (density, pressure, velocity, energy) are independent of the time t. However, this does not mean at all that the fluid is at rest (which would imply that v = 0).

6 Incompressible models In many situations, it is useless or at least undesirable to solve the full Navier– Stokes–Fourier equations because some physical phenomena can be neglected in the considered applications. In this book we consider the case of incompressible models, that we describe in this section. Very briefly, we show that this kind of simplified models is relevant for liquids in standard conditions and for gases for low-speed flows. In other cases, general compressible models have to be considered, even though other simplifications are possible. We refer, for instance, to [127] for a description of many different asymptotic regimes and simplified models derived from the full Navier–Stokes– Fourier system.

6.1 The incompressibility assumption Definition and Proposition I.6.1. The flow of a fluid is said to be incompressible if one of the following equivalent properties is satisfied. 1. The volume of any fluid element is constant along the time. 2. The velocity field v is divergence-free (it is also said to be solenoidal); that is (div v)(t, x) = 0, ∀(t, x). 3. The density ρ is constant along the trajectories associated with the velocity field v. We show below that the term incompressible can lead to confusion with the notions of compressibility and thermal expansion of the fluid under study. More appropriate terms should be isovolume flow or isochoric flow to describe the fact that volumes are preserved in the evolution. However, the term incompressible flow is widely used in the literature and we follow this convention in this book. Proof.

6. Incompressible models

33

1 ⇔ 2: Let (Ωt )t be any fluid element. Applying the transport theorem to f = 1, we get    d d 1 dX = (div v) dx. |Ωt | = dt dt Ωt Ωt Therefore, the conservation of the volume of (Ωt )t , for any choice of fluid element is equivalent to the divergence-free condition div v = 0. 2 ⇔ 3: We write the mass balance equation ∂ρ + v · ∇ρ + ρ(div v) = 0; ∂t that is, Dρ + ρ(div v) = 0, Dt if one uses the notation Dρ/Dt for the material derivative of ρ as defined in (I.5). The density ρ cannot vanish (if it becomes very small the continuous medium assumption is no longer valid) therefore we deduce that div v = 0 ⇐⇒

Dρ = 0, Dt

which exactly express that the divergence-free condition on v is equivalent to the fact that the density ρ is constant along the characteristic curves of v.  Remark I.6.1. A flow can be incompressible even if the density is not constant. It is only required that the density of a particle of fluid remain constant during the evolution. As an example of a nonhomogeneous incompressible flow we can consider water in the ocean whose density depends on the salinity but which is nevertheless incompressible. Remark I.6.2. For an incompressible flow, if the density ρ is homogeneous at the initial time (that is to say that x → ρ(0, x) = ρ0 is a constant), then the density remains constant ρ(t, x) = ρ0 , ∀(t, x). Indeed, we have seen that incompressibility implies that ρ is constant along trajectories of fluid particles ρ(t, X(t, 0, x0 )) = ρ(0, x0 ) = ρ0 , ∀t, ∀x0 .

34

Chapter I. The equations of fluid mechanics

Since, for a fixed time t the map x0 →  X(t, 0, x0 ) = ϕt (x0 ) is a bijection, we deduce that ρ(t, X) is indeed equal to ρ0 for any t and any X and the flow is globally homogeneous. Let us now investigate in which circumstances a flow can be supposed to be incompressible. We start from the equation of state which gives a relation of the form ρ = ρ(p, T ). Therefore, we can compute the divergence of v through the material derivative of the pressure and the temperature as follows:     1 Dρ Dp 1 ∂ρ DT 1 ∂ρ div v = − − . (I.30) =− ρ Dt ρ ∂p T Dt ρ ∂T p Dt       compression

thermal expansion

The incompressibility condition for the flow, div v = 0, is thus equivalent to assuming that the compression term and the thermal expansion term are both zero (or negligible) because it is not reasonable to think that the two terms, describing two different phenomena may compensate each other. In the sequel of this chapter (and in the rest of the book), we assume that • Either the coefficient of thermal expansion of the fluid (1/ρ)(∂ρ/∂T )p is negligible in the flow under study. This is, for instance, the case for barotropic fluids (those fluids for which the pressure depends only on the density at least in the conditions of the experiment). • Or that the temperature is almost constant along trajectories of fluid particles (this occurs for instance in isothermal flows). We now investigate the compression term in (I.30). This term can be supposed to be small enough in two different cases. • Case 1: The isothermal compressibility coefficient of the fluid is zero (or is negligible). This means that   1 ∂ρ β=− ≈ 0. ρ ∂p T This assumption is natural for liquids in standard temperature and pressure conditions. For instance, for liquid water the coefficient β is around 10−10 Pa−1 and the influence of the compressibility can be neglected for reasonable pressure variations in the flow. • Case 2: The compressibility coefficient β is not small enough. In the case of gases (the air, for instance) this coefficient is around 10−5 Pa−1 which is no more negligible (recall that 105 Pa = 1bar). However, we can still make the incompressibility assumption for such flows as soon as the typical velocity is small compared to the isothermal sound speed. Let us illustrate this point through a quite formal dimensional analysis.

6. Incompressible models

35

The isothermal sound speed c in such a fluid is defined through the formula   ∂ρ 1 = . 2 c ∂p T It can be shown, indeed, that pressure/density variations in the fluid travel at speed c. Let us introduce the Reynolds dimensionless number Re =

ρv0 l0 , μ

where l0 and v0 are typical length and velocity scales in the flow, chosen in such a way that v0 v0 |∇v| ≈ , |Δv| ≈ 2 . l0 l0 As we show in Section 6.2.3, the Reynolds number accounts for the ratio between inertia effects and viscous effects in the system. The above formal approximations can be justified by using a suitable scaling of the equations. With this definition and (I.30) (without thermal expansion effects) we have div v = −

1 Dp . ρc2 Dt

(I.31)

In order to simplify this formal analysis a little, we consider the steady case for which the material derivative of the pressure simply reads Dp/Dt = v · ∇p. – Subcase 1: We assume that viscous effects are negligible (high Reynolds number) so that the momentum equation (without source terms) reduces to 1 − ∇p ≈ (v · ∇)v. ρ It follows from (I.31) that | div v| =

1 v2 1 |v · ∇p| ≈ 2 |v · ((v · ∇)v)| ≈ 20 |∇v|. 2 ρc c c

As a consequence, if the Mach number defined as the ratio Ma = v0 /c satisfies Ma  1, (I.32) then the divergence of v can be assumed to be negligible compared to typical velocity gradients, and it can reasonably be assumed that the flow is incompressible. It is commonly admitted that the condition Ma < 0.3 is a good criterion for deciding whether compressibility effects have to be taken into account.

Chapter I. The equations of fluid mechanics

36

Note that Case 1 above is nothing but the assumption that c is infinite (or at least very large) which can also be understood as low Mach number asymptotics. – Subcase 2: We assume that nonlinear inertia terms are negligible in front of viscous effects (low Reynolds number). In that case (using Stokes assumption (I.27)) we have ∇p ≈ μΔv +

μ ∇(div v), 3

and we deduce that 1 |v · ∇p| ≈ ρc2 1 μv0 ≈ 2 |∇v| = c ρl0

| div v| =

μ μ |v · Δv| ≈ 2 2 v02 ρc2 ρc l0 v02 μ |∇v|. c2 ρv0 L    =1/Re

Therefore, in that case the flow will be considered to be incompressible as soon as √ Ma  Re. (I.33) This condition can be much more restrictive than (I.32). In each of the two cases described above the sound speed c is assumed to be large (infinite in Case 1, finite but large enough in Case 2). This corresponds to the limit where (∂ρ/∂p)T ≈ 0. In particular, in this asymptotic regime, it is not theoretically possible to use the equation of state ρ = ρ(p, T ) to obtain an expression of the pressure as a function of the density p = p(ρ, T ). Indeed, when the above derivative is zero it means that this reciprocal function may not exist (at least in the asymptotic regime Ma → 0). Therefore, it seems that for incompressible models the pressure is no longer related to the other thermodynamical variables and becomes an independent variable. This is consistent with the fact that we add a new equation to the whole system of evolution equations that v has to satisfy and which is the divergence-free condition. From a mathematical point of view, the pressure gradient term in the momentum equation has now become a Lagrange multiplier related to the divergence-free constraint (see Remark IV.5.1). In particular, we observe that one can add a constant to the pressure without changing the equations so that only pressure gradients have a physical meaning. This apparent ambiguity on the definition of the pressure can be analysed as follows. In the formal low-Mach number limit Ma → 0 it can be shown, in a suitable framework (see [127] for instance), that the thermodynamical pressure pMa (for which we explicitly show the dependence on the Mach number here) actually converges towards a constant p0 and that there exists a function π such that

6. Incompressible models

37

pMa − p0 ∇(pMa )



Ma π,



Ma2 ∇π.

Ma→0 Ma→0

2

Therefore, in this asymptotic incompressible regime, the pressure gradient term appearing in the momentum equation is in fact in the form Ma2 ∇π. This is exactly the Lagrange multiplier pressure term in the incompressible Navier–Stokes equations. It has to be interpreted as a pressure fluctuation and not as the absolute pressure; in particular this “incompressible” pressure has no particular sign. Even though it should be less ambiguous to refer to this incompressible pressure as π instead of p, for instance, using the letter p to represent this pressure fluctuation is still widely practiced in the literature. Rigorous mathematical justifications of the low-mach number limit (and thus of the incompressible limit for the isentropic or barotropic flows) are known in some cases. This goes beyond the scope of this book and we refer to the review papers [4, 46, 58, 4] for more details on this topic.

6.2 Overview of the incompressible models Let us recall that, from now on, we neglect (the influence of) temperature variations in the flow under study and that we concentrate on the case of an incompressible flow. We are in position to describe the various models that we study in the next chapters. Our assumption on temperature variations and incompressibility implies that there is no more energy evolution equation in the system and that the pressure p is not defined through an equation of state but rather in an indirect process associated with the divergence-free constraint. We recall that we showed in the previous section that this pressure term p has to be understood as a fluctuation of the actual thermodynamic pressure around its mean value.

6.2.1 The nonhomogeneous incompressible Navier–Stokes equations The more general and more complex system that we study in this book (Chapter VI), is the following one: ⎧ ∂ρ ⎪ ⎪ + div(ρv) = 0, ⎪ ⎪ ∂t ⎨ ∂(ρv) + div(ρv ⊗ v) − 2 div(μ(ρ)D(v)) + ∇p = ρf, ⎪ ⎪ ∂t ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ div v = 0,

38

Chapter I. The equations of fluid mechanics

At least formally, the first two equations can be written in nonconservative form but we will see that, for the mathematical definition of a weak solution (ρ, v, p) to this system, the conservative form is more suitable (and not necessarily equivalent to the nonconservative one).

6.2.2 The homogeneous incompressible Navier–Stokes equations Due to the fact that the density ρ is not constant, the previous system has many nonlinearities. That’s the reason why, before studying these equations, we first concentrate our attention on the simpler and more standard case where the density is homogeneous (see Remark I.6.2). Notice that the mass balance equation and the divergence-free constraint are now strictly identical so that only the following system remains, ⎧   ⎪ ⎨ ρ ∂v + (v · ∇)v − μΔv + ∇p = ρf, ∂t ⎪ ⎩ div v = 0, where ρ and μ are now given positive constants. This system is analysed in Chapter V as well as its steady version  −μΔv + ρ(v · ∇)v + ∇p = ρf, div v = 0.

6.2.3 Dimensionless equations The homogeneous incompressible Navier–Stokes equations given above explicitly depend on two (constant) parameters: the density and the viscosity of the fluid. Because of the nonlinear term, the behavior of the solutions will also clearly depend on the magnitude of the velocity field and in the time/space scales at which the system is observed. To make this point appear in the equations, we need to perform a dimensional analysis, that is, to put the equations into dimensionless form. This involves selecting, depending on the problem being studied, a timescale t0 (the characteristic time of observation of the phenomenon) and a spatial scale l0 (the characteristic size of the flow considered). From these two fixed scales, we can then deduce a characteristic velocity for the problem v0 =

l0 , t0

which is simply the mean velocity required to cross the distance l0 in a time t0 . Of course, it is equivalent (and sometimes more natural) to determine l0 and

6. Incompressible models

39

v0 from the geometry of the container and the inflow boundary conditions, and then deduce the time scale t0 = l0 /v0 at which interesting phenomena will certainly occur. Finally, we can set a characteristic size f0 for the body forces applied to the flow (typically buoyancy forces). We introduce new variables which are said to be dimensionless or adimensional, defined by t =

t  x v f , x = , v = , f  = , t0 l0 v0 f0

so that the equations above become ⎧    2 ⎪ ⎨ ρ v0 ∂v + v0 (v  · ∇  )v  − μ v0 Δ  v  + 1 ∇  p = ρf f  , x x x 0 t0 ∂t l0 l02 l0 ⎪ ⎩ div  v  = 0, x

where divx , ∇x , and Δx designate the usual differential operators acting on the new space variables x . We notice that through the relation among l0 , t0 , and v0 , the coefficients which appear in front of ∂v  /∂t and (v  · ∇x )v  are the same. This is not coincidence and corresponds to the fact that the material derivative operator D/Dt is invariant, apart from a multiplicative constant, through the scaling of the system we proposed. Hence, by setting p = p/ρv02 , we obtain ⎧   ⎪ ⎨ ∂v + (v  · ∇  )v  − μ Δ  v  + ∇  p = f0 f  , x x x ∂t ρv0 l0 v0 /t0 ⎪ ⎩ div  v  = 0. x It can be seen that the new system depends on two parameters only, the Reynolds number Re and the Froude number Fr, defined by Re =

ρv0 l0 v0 /l0 , and Fr = . μ f0

The Reynolds number measures the ratio between the order of magnitude of the inertial terms ρ(v · ∇)v and the order of magnitude of the viscous terms. When the Reynolds number is small, viscous effects dominate; we say that the flow is laminar. When the Reynolds number is high, inertial effects dominate and we say that the flow is turbulent. The transition between these two behaviors is, of course, rather fuzzy and depends largely on the physical case being investigated. We do not go further into such considerations here, although they are fundamental in many real applications; see for instance [59].

40

Chapter I. The equations of fluid mechanics

In the most common case, where the body forces reduce to gravity, the Froude number measures the ratio between the mean acceleration in the flow v0 /t0 and the acceleration due to buoyancy f0 . In the following, we assume that the Froude number is equal to 1; by contrast, we attempt, as far as possible, to observe the influence of the Reynolds number in the mathematical results presented in this book, at least when studying nonlinear models. Again, to prevent notation becoming too unwieldy, we make no further reference to the “primes” on the variables and the unknowns, so that the dimensionless equations we study in Chapter V are ⎧ ⎨ ∂v − 1 Δv + (v · ∇)v + ∇p = f, ∂t Re (I.34) ⎩ div v = 0.

6.2.4 The homogeneous Stokes problem In the case where non-linear effects can be neglected in the homogeneous Navier–Stokes equations (i.e., when the Reynolds number Re is sufficiently small) then System (I.34) formally reduces to the Stokes equation ⎧ ⎨ ∂v − 1 Δv + ∇p = f, ∂t Re ⎩ div v = 0. This problem is linear with constant coefficients. Therefore, it is clear that most of the mathematical difficulties for its study are contained in the steady Stokes problem ⎧ ⎨ − 1 Δv + ∇p = f, Re ⎩ div v = 0, in particular concerning the existence and properties of the pressure. The study of these equations in various contexts (in particular for different kinds of boundary conditions) is the topic of Chapter IV. It gives us the opportunity to introduce many mathematical tools which are useful in the study of more general fluid mechanics models.

6.2.5 Initial and boundary data For unsteady models, it is clearly required to impose initial conditions in order to define the evolution of the system. We show that we only need to impose the initial value of the density (in the nonhomogeneous case) and of the velocity. It has no mathematical meaning to impose an initial value for the pressure because this unknown has the role of a Lagrange multiplier

6. Incompressible models

41

associated with the incompressibility condition and thus, is defined in some indirect way. Concerning boundary conditions, the most widely used condition is a Dirichlet boundary condition for the velocity v = vb ,

on the boundary.

When vb = 0, it is called an homogeneous Dirichlet boundary condition or a no-slip condition. No boundary condition is necessary for the pressure. We study these boundary conditions for the homogeneous steady and unsteady Stokes and Navier–Stokes equations. As far as the nonhomogenous fluids are concerned, we have to discuss possible boundary conditions associated with the density ρ. We have seen that, in incompressible models, the material derivative of ρ is zero, which means that ρ is constant along trajectories associated with the flow, that is, along the solutions of the characteristic equation (I.4). Two cases have to be considered and are precisely discussed in Chapter VI. • If v is tangent to the boundary of the domain under study, then the solutions of the characteristic equation never cross the boundary of the domain. Therefore, it is very likely that no boundary condition is necessary for the density. • If v is not tangent to the boundary of the domain, then the characteristic curves will certainly cross the boundary. In that case, boundary data for ρ are necessary on the inflow points of the boundary. For the steady Stokes problem we study in Chapter IV more general boundary conditions: Neumann-like boundary conditions, normal stress boundary conditions, and vorticity/pressure conditions. We also investigate, in Chapter VII, outflow nonphysical boundary conditions for the Navier–Stokes problem which are necessary to solve the problem in the case of a computational domain obtained after truncation of a physical unbounded domain.

6.2.6 Additional comments For very high values of the Reynolds number, the incompressible Navier– Stokes system (I.34) formally becomes the incompressible Euler system ⎧ ⎨ ∂v + (v · ∇)v + ∇p = f, ∂t ⎩ div v = 0, which accounts for the flow of perfect (or inviscid) fluids. From a mathematical point of view, this new system is hyperbolic and thus of a very different nature than the Navier–Stokes system which is parabolic. We do not study the

42

Chapter I. The equations of fluid mechanics

Euler equations in the present book, and we refer, for instance, to [88, 86, 41] for questions related to this system. Similarly, the compressible Navier–Stokes equations and the full Navier– Stokes–Fourier system are not analysed in this book. The interested reader can find many results in [87, 57, 93]. Notice, however, that many mathematical tools presented in this book are useful in the study of compressible flows.

7 Some exact steady solutions Before attacking a precise analysis of the preceding equations in the following chapters, we would like to present quickly some examples of steady situations for which explicit formulas exist. These give the velocity field and the pressure field in very specific geometries. In this section we discuss steady solutions of the homogeneous incompressible Navier–Stokes equations (I.34). We are therefore seeking a pair (v, p) which is a solution of ⎧ 1 ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ − Re Δv + (v · ∇)v + ∇p = g, in Ω (I.35) div v = 0, in Ω, ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ v = vb , on ∂Ω, where g represents the buoyancy forces exerted on the fluid and vb the Dirichlet boundary data. Since these gravitational forces derive from a potential, we can introduce π0 such that ∇π0 = g. Then by setting π = p − π0 , we can always return to the case where the source term is zero. For example, if we assume that gravity is constant and directed along e3 on the experimental scale, then π0 = −g x3 . If we hope to find exact analytical solutions, it is of course necessary that the domain Ω exhibit a relatively simple geometry, for which it is possible to perform all the calculations. We note that such simple geometries are, nevertheless, representative of significant physical situations. Once these analytical expressions of the solutions are obtained, we can then ask if they correspond effectively to the observed physical solutions. Unfortunately, as soon as the Reynolds number Re is large, we note that this is not always the case. We should then study the stability of the solutions presented. These ideas, which are of great practical importance, are not covered in this text. Among the very abundant literature on the subject, we refer, for instance, to [40, 53, 127] or to more specialised texts such as [43].

7. Some exact steady solutions

43

7.1 Poiseuille flow in a pipe Let us consider an infinite tube with axis e3 and an ellipse-shaped cross section. The cross-section of the tube, denoted as E, is defined by the equation 

x1 R1

2

 +

x2 R2

2 ≤ 1.

(I.36)

From the symmetry of the domain considered, we can look for a velocity field solution of the equations, which depends on x1 and x2 only. Very generally, such a velocity field can be expressed as v = (u1 (x1 , x2 ), u2 (x1 , x2 ), u3 (x1 , x2 )). Since u3 does not depend on x3 , the divergence-free condition gives ∂u2 ∂u1 + = 0. ∂x1 ∂x2 Hence, by setting v˜ = (u1 , u2 ), we see that the two-dimensional velocity field v˜ satisfies the following two-dimensional steady Navier–Stokes equations, obtained by considering the two main components of the system of equation (I.35) ⎧ ⎨ − 1 Δ˜ v + (˜ v · ∇)˜ v + ∇π = 0, in E, Re ⎩ div v˜ = 0, in E. Furthermore, the homogeneous boundary conditions for the velocity at the wall give us v˜ = 0 at the boundary of the elliptic section E. Now we multiply the equation by v˜ and we integrate it over E. After integration by parts (formally justified because of the boundary conditions), using the divergence-free condition we obtain  1 (|∇u1 |2 + |∇u2 |2 ) dx1 dx2 = 0. Re E We often make use of this type of computation in the rest of this text. It shows that u1 and u2 are constants but, since they are zero at the boundary of E, we obtain u1 = u2 = 0. In consequence, the pressure π satisfies the relations ∂π ∂π = = 0. ∂x1 ∂x2 We thus see that the velocity field that we are seeking is necessarily of the form v = (0, 0, u(x1 , x2 )),

Chapter I. The equations of fluid mechanics

44

where u = u3 is a scalar function. It can easily be shown that such a velocity field does indeed have zero divergence and moreover that we have (v · ∇)v = u

∂u = 0. ∂x3

Hence (v, π) is a solution of the steady Navier–Stokes equations if the scalar functions u and π satisfy ⎧ 1 ∂π ⎪ ⎪ = 0, Δu + ⎨− Re ∂x3 ∂π ∂π ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ = = 0. ∂x1 ∂x2 Since u only depends on x1 and x2 , by differentiating the first equation with respect to x3 , we obtain ∂2π = 0. ∂x23 We denote the constant equal to ∂π/∂x3 as p1 , such that the equation for u becomes 1 − Δu + p1 = 0, Re in the elliptic equation (I.36). This equation is associated with the zero velocity boundary conditions at the wall u = 0 over the boundary of the ellipse. The unique solution of this equation is obtained in an analytical manner   2  x1 −Re x22 u = p1 2 1 − . + R12 R22 + R22 R2 1

2

The pressure field associated with this flow is therefore given (apart from one constant) by π = p1 x3 . Hence, this is the pressure gradient which drives the flow. We observe that the actual pressure of the fluid is in fact given by p = π+π0 where π0 is the potential of the gravitational force

7.2 Planar shear flow We now consider the two-dimensional planar flow of a viscous Newtonian fluid between two horizontal plates. This flow has already served as an example to illustrate Newton’s theory in Section 4.

7. Some exact steady solutions

45

The upper plate is driven at a velocity U ≥ 0, and the lower plate at a velocity −V ≤ 0. The open set Ω delimiting the fluid domain is R×] − h, h[. Guided once again by the geometry of the domain, we look for a velocity field which only depends on the transverse variable x2 . However, the divergencefree condition requires that the second component of the velocity field be a constant. The condition v · ν = 0 at the boundary of the domain shows us that v is necessarily of the form v = (u(x2 ), 0). As we saw previously, such a velocity field automatically cancels the inertia term (v · ∇)v. By introducing the total pressure, the equation satisfied by the couple (u, π) is written as ⎧ 1 ∂π ⎪ ⎪ Δu + = 0, ⎨− Re ∂x1 ⎪ ∂π ⎪ ⎩ = 0. ∂x2 Since u only depends on x2 , by differentiating the first equation with respect to x1 we obtain ∂2π = 0. ∂x21 Hence by denoting the constant equal to ∂π/∂x1 as p1 , we immediately obtain the general solution of the ordinary differential equation for u: u=

Re p1 2 x2 + b x2 + c. 2

The boundary conditions u(h) = U, u(−h) = −V, then allow the flow to be completely determined. Finally, we obtain u=

Re p1 2 U +V U −V (h − x22 ) + x2 + . 2 2h 2

The pressure field associated with the flow is again linear and given by π = p1 x1 . The actual pressure in the flow is again given by p = π + π0 . This time, the driving elements of the flow are both the pressure gradient and, of course, the boundary conditions.

Chapter I. The equations of fluid mechanics

46

7.3 Couette flow between two cylinders Let us consider a domain limited by two coaxial cylinders, with axes directed along e3 and having infinite height. The external cylinder is fixed and the internal cylinder is driven in a uniform rotation. Let the rotation vector Ω be colinear with e3 . The velocity field of a rigid solid which is submitted to a uniform rotation is given by v = Ω ∧ r, where r is the position vector, which is also written as v = Ω ∧ (rer ), where r = |r| and er is the unit rotation vector related to the description of the domain in cylindrical coordinates. Inspired by this formula, we thus look for a solution of the Navier–Stokes equations between the two cylinders in the form v = f (r)Ω ∧ er , where f has to be determined. We note that, according to Equation (A.1), such a vector field is necessarily divergence-free. We show that in this particular case, the inertia term can be written in the form of a gradient. Indeed, according to Equation (A.6), we have (v · ∇)v =

1 ∇|v|2 − v ∧ curl v, 2

and it is sufficient then to show that the last term is a gradient. For this we use the particular form chosen for the velocity field v. By using Equation (A.8), this becomes curl v = div(f (r)er ) Ω − (Ω · ∇)(f (r)er ), however, the last term is zero because Ω is directed along ez = e3 and f (r)er does not depend on z. By use of Equation (A.1), the first term becomes curl v = div(f (r)er ) Ω =

1 ∂ (rf (r)) Ω. r ∂r

Hence, the double vector product identity (A.3) gives us 1 ∂ (rf (r)) f (r)(Ω ∧ er ) ∧ Ω r ∂r 1 ∂ (rf (r)) f (r)er . = |Ω|2 r ∂r

v ∧ curl v =

(I.37)

7. Some exact steady solutions

47

Therefore, if r → g(r) designates an indefinite integral of the function r → then

1 ∂ (rf (r)) f (r), r ∂r

v ∧ curl v = |Ω|2 g  (r)er = |Ω|2 ∇g(r),

which shows that the inertia term can now be written as a gradient that is denoted by (v · ∇)v = ∇ π (r). We note, furthermore, that following the preceding calculations, the function π (r) is defined by π  (r) = −

|Ω|2 2 |v|2 f (r) = − . r r

The steady Navier–Stokes equation can now be written as −

1 ) = 0. Δ(Ω ∧ f (r)er ) + ∇(π + π Re

We look for particular solutions which satisfy the relations Δ(Ω ∧ f (r)er ) = 0, and ∇(π + π ) = 0. This equation gives us π = − π because the pressure is defined apart from a constant. If we then introduce an indefinite integral F of the function f , the first equation can be written as Δ(Ω ∧ ∇F (r)) = 0, or even Ω ∧ Δ(∇F (r)) = 0. However, since F (r) only depends on r, its gradient lies in the plane er , eθ and therefore this equation is equivalent to 0 = Δ(∇F (r)) = ∇(ΔF (r)). Hence, the function ΔF (r) is constant and we must now solve ΔF (r) = a, which by using Equation (A.2) can be written as   1 ∂ ∂F r = a. r ∂r ∂r We immediately obtain F (r) = a

r2 + b ln r + c. 4

We find the function f by differentiation

Chapter I. The equations of fluid mechanics

48

b r f (r) = F  (r) = a + . 2 r Let R1 be the radius of the inner cylinder and R2 that of the outer cylinder; then the boundary conditions are written as v(R1 ) = Ω ∧ (R1 er ) and v(R2 ) = 0, which gives, for the function f : f (R1 ) = R1 , and f (R2 ) = 0. We can now determine the constants a and b and obtain   1 r R12 R22 − 2 , f (r) = 2 R2 − R12 r R2 which gives us the velocity field through the equation v = f (r)(Ω ∧ er ) = f (r)|Ω|eθ . We should note that the function f (r) is decreasing and convex. It is now possible to calculate the pressure in this flow by using the fact that π = − π and that π  is the indefinite integral of the function −|Ω|2 f 2 (r)/r. After all the calculations, we obtain  π(r) = |Ω|

2

R12 R22 R22 − R12

2 

 r2 1 2 − 2 − 2 ln r . 2R24 2r R2

This function is increasing with respect to r, which proves that the pressure is higher in the neighborhood of the outer cylinder than in the neighborhood of the inner cylinder. Furthermore, the actual pressure in the flow is obtained by adding the gravitational potential p = π + π0 . We also note that, contrary to the preceding examples, this analytical solution of the Navier–Stokes equations does not depend on the Reynolds number for the flow. Indeed, we note that in this particular flow the inertia term is exactly compensated by the pressure term, as well as the fact that the viscous term is identically zero.

Chapter II

Analysis tools

The goal of this chapter is to describe the analysis tools that we use in later chapters. We have gathered together fundamental concepts required to study many linear or nonlinear evolution partial differential equations coming from many areas of physics and biology, for instance. We start in Section 2 by presenting, without proof, some classic results of functional analysis such as the open mapping theorem, the Banach–Steinhaus theorem and the Lax–Milgram theorem, proofs of which can easily be found in the literature (see, e.g., [27, 104, 105]). We also give definitions of weak and weak- convergence, which are frequently used in the analysis of partial differential equations. We pay particular attention to the expression of these results into some fundamental spaces, namely the Lebesgue spaces. The section is completed by a short introduction to distribution theory and by the description of some basic properties of Lipschitz continuous functions. Section 3 aims at describing some tools around the notion of compactness which is fundamental when one deals with nonlinear terms in partial differential equations. We recall in particular the Schauder fixed-point theorem. In the analysis of evolution problems, one of the usual ways for establishing existence theorems is first to obtain energy estimates. In general, these are deduced from elementary differential inequalities involving real functions of a single real variable (the time variable t, in the problems which concern us). In Section 4 of this chapter therefore, we describe the links between the concepts of weak differentiation and standard differentiation as applied to numerical functions of one single real variable. Finally, we prove the various Gronwall type inequalities, which allows us to obtain the desired estimates in most cases. Section 5 is dedicated to the introduction and study of the spaces of functions integrable on an interval of R with values in a Banach space. This is also known as the Bochner integral theory. In particular, we prove the Aubin– Lions–Simon compactness theorem [14, 84, 109], a fundamental result for the study of nonlinear problems. The main ingredient of this proof is the Ascoli F. Boyer and P. Fabrie, Mathematical Tools for the Study of the Incompressible Navier-Stokes Equations and Related Models, Applied Mathematical Sciences 183, DOI 10.1007/978-1-4614-5975-0_2, © Springer Science+Business Media New York 2013

49

Chapter II. Analysis tools

50

theorem, reviewed at the start of this chapter. We also present the definition and main properties of the Fourier transform for this class of functions. We conclude the chapter, in Section 6, with a very short introduction to the spectral theory of self-adjoint unbounded operators with compact resolvent.

1 Main notation Throughout this book, the space dimension is denoted by d ∈ N∗ (typically d = 2 or d = 3 in the case of fluid mechanics applications). The Euclidean norm on Rd is denoted by x → |x| and the associated inner product by (x, y) → x · y. For all multi-index α = (α1 , . . . , αd ) ∈ Nd we denote its length by |α| = α1 + · · · + αd . For any function f we define ∂ α f = ∂xα11 · · · ∂xαdd f as soon as this partial derivative exists (in a classic or in a weak sense). For any open set Ω ⊂ Rd we use the following standard functional spaces. • The set C k (Ω), k ≥ 0, of functions with continuous partial derivatives up to order k. • The subset Cbk (Ω) ⊂ C k (Ω) of functions such that all partial derivatives up to order k are bounded. • The set C 0,α (Ω), α ∈]0, 1] of α-H¨older continuous functions. In the case α = 1, C 0,1 (Ω) is the set of Lipschitz continuous functions. The Lipschitz seminorm of such a function is defined by |f (x) − f (y)| < +∞. |x − y| x,y∈Ω

Lip(f ) = sup x =y

• The set C k,α (Ω), k ≥ 0, α ∈]0, 1] of functions in C k (Ω) whose partial derivatives of order k are α-H¨older continuous. • The set Cc∞ (Ω) of functions in C ∞ (Ω) which are compactly supported in Ω. Another usual notation for this space, in particular in the theory of distributions, is D(Ω). • The set Cc∞ (Ω) of the restrictions to Ω of functions in Cc∞ (Rd ). Moreover, for any function u defined on Ω we denote as u ¯ its extension by 0 on the whole space defined by  u(x), for x ∈ Ω, u ¯(x) = 0, for x ∈ Ω. For any x ∈ Ω, we define δ(x) to be the signed distance from x to the boundary, which is defined by

2. Fundamental results from functional analysis

 d(x, ∂Ω) δ(x) = −d(x, ∂Ω)

51

for x ∈ Ω, for x ∈  Ω.

(II.1)

By using the triangle inequality, it is obvious to check that δ is Lipschitz continuous on Rd and that Lip(δ) ≤ 1.

2 Fundamental results from functional analysis 2.1 Banach spaces In this section we recall essential results of functional analysis. We do not provide proofs; the reader can find these in the classic monographs on the subject such as [27], [104], and [105]. For any normed vector space E, we denote its topological dual as E  , that is, the space of continuous linear functionals on E. For f ∈ E  and x ∈ E, we introduce the duality bracket f, xE  ,E = f (x). We reserve the notation (·, ·)H for a scalar product in a Hilbert space, H. Let E and F be two normed vector spaces and S : E → F be a continuous linear function. We define the adjoint or transposed function, denoted t S : F  → E  , by t Sf, xE  ,E = f, SxF  ,F , ∀f ∈ F  , ∀x ∈ E. From the Hahn–Banach theorem, we can express the norm of an element from a normed vector space E by duality as follows. Proposition II.2.1. Let E be a normed vector space. Then for all x ∈ E, we have |f, xE  ,E | xE = sup = sup |f, xE  ,E |. f E  f ∈E  ,f =0 f E  ≤1 Another consequence of the Hahn–Banach theorem is the following useful density criterion for a subspace of a given normed space. Proposition II.2.2. Let E be a normed vector space and F be a vector subspace of E. We assume that any continuous linear functional on E which vanishes on F is identically zero. Then, F is a dense subspace of E. The following result (due to Banach), gives a characterisation of the isomorphisms between Banach spaces. Theorem II.2.3 (Open mapping). Let E and F be two Banach spaces. If u is a surjective, continuous linear function from E into F , then u is an open

Chapter II. Analysis tools

52

map, which means that the image under u of all open sets of E is an open set of F . In particular, if u is bijective, its reciprocal function is continuous and, consequently, spaces E and F are algebraically and topologically isomorphic. Finally, the last result that we recall in this section, which is sometimes called the “uniform boundedness principle” shows that if a family of continuous linear functions defined on a Banach space is pointwise bounded, then it is uniformly bounded. Theorem II.2.4 (Banach–Steinhaus). Let (ui )i∈I be a family of continuous linear functions of a Banach space E within a normed vector space F , indexed by a set I. We assume that for all x ∈ E, the family (ui (x))i∈I , is bounded in F . Then, the family (ui )i∈I is uniformly bounded in the sense of the norm of the operators; that is, sup ui L(E,F ) < +∞; i∈I

or equivalently, ∃C > 0, such that ui (x)F ≤ CxE , ∀i ∈ I, ∀x ∈ E. We conclude this section by introducing the Lax–Milgram theorem, which is an important tool in the study of linear partial differential problems in variational formulation. Theorem II.2.5 (Lax–Milgram). Let V be a Hilbert space, a : V × V → R a bilinear form, and L : V → R a linear form. Assume that a and L are continuous and that a is coercive, that is, ∃α > 0, a(v, v) ≥ αv2V , ∀v ∈ V ; then there exists a unique solution v ∈ V to the problem a(v, w) = L(w), ∀w ∈ V.

(II.2)

Moreover, this solution satisfies vV ≤

LV  . α

(II.3)

2.2 Weak and weak- convergences We do not go into the details here of the general theory of weak and weak topologies (see [27] for a more complete study). Rather, we simply recall

2. Fundamental results from functional analysis

53

the sequential properties of these topologies, which are essential later. In this book, these notions are mainly used in the framework of Lebesgue and Sobolev spaces (see Section 2.3.4). Definition II.2.6. Let E be a Banach space and E  its dual space. • We say that a sequence (un )n of elements of E weakly converges towards u ∈ E, if for any f ∈ E  we have f (un ) = f, un E  ,E −−−−→ f, uE  ,E = f (u). n→∞

• We say that a sequence (fn )n of elements of E  weakly- converges towards f ∈ E  , if for any u ∈ E, we have fn (u) = fn , uE  ,E −−−−→ f, uE  ,E = f (u). n→∞

Of course, as soon as the space on which we are working is infinitedimensional (functional spaces of type Lp (Ω), for example), the closed bounded subsets of this space are not necessarily compact for the topology of the norm on E. Nevertheless, the following result establishes the property of weak compactness of closed bounded sets. Theorem II.2.7 (Weak and Weak- compactness). • Let E be a reflexive Banach space (i.e., E is isomorphic with E  via the natural embedding). Then, from any bounded sequence of elements of E, we can extract a subsequence which weakly converges in E. • Let E be a separable Banach space (i.e., one which contains a dense countable subset). Then, from any bounded sequence of elements of E  , we can extract a subsequence which weakly- converges in E  . One of the important consequences of the Banach–Steinhaus theorem (Theorem II.2.4) is the property of lower semicontinuity of the norm for weak and weak- topologies on a Banach space. Corollary II.2.8. Let E be a Banach space, and (un )n be a sequence of elements of E (or E  , respectively) which weakly converges (or weakly-, respectively) towards u ∈ E (or u ∈ E  , respectively). Then the sequence (un )n is bounded in E (or in E  , respectively) and we have uE ≤ lim inf un E , (resp., uE  ≤ lim inf un E  ). n→∞

n→∞

The following proposition is often used to prove the weak (resp., weak-) convergence of a whole sequence. Proposition II.2.9. Let E be a reflexive Banach space (resp., the dual of a separable Banach space) and (xn )n a bounded sequence in E.

Chapter II. Analysis tools

54

We assume that there exists x ∈ E such that every weakly convergent (resp., weakly- convergent) subsequence of (xn )n has a limit equal to x; then the whole sequence (xn )n weakly converges (resp., weakly- converges) to x. Proof. We only give the proof in the reflexive case, the other case being similar. Assume that (xn )n does not weakly converge to x. This means that there exists f ∈ E  such that (f, xn E  ,E )n does not converge to f, xE  ,E . Hence, there exists ε > 0 and a subsequence (xϕ(n) )n such that |f, xϕ(n) − xE  ,E | ≥ ε, ∀n ≥ 0.

(II.4)

Since (xϕ(n) )n is bounded in E which is reflexive, Theorem II.2.7 shows that there exists a new subsequence (xϕ(ψ(n)) )n that weakly converges in E. By assumption its weak limit is necessarily equal to x which implies that f, xϕ(ψ(n)) − xE  ,E −−−−→ 0. n→∞

This is a contradiction with (II.4) and the claim is proved.  A consequence of this result is that a bound in a “small” space and a weak convergence in a “large” space implies the weak convergence in the “small” space. The precise statement is the following. Proposition II.2.10. Let E, F, G be three Banach spaces such that E ⊂ G, F ⊂ G with continuous embeddings. We assume that F is reflexive. Let (xn )n be a sequence in E ∩ F such that there exists x ∈ E satisfying (xn )n is bounded in F , (xn )n weakly converges towards x in E. Then, (xn )n weakly converges towards x in F . Proof. From Proposition II.2.9, the claim will be proved if we show that x is the unique possible weak limit in F of subsequences of (xn )n . Let (xϕ(n) )n a subsequence which weakly converges in F towards some limit y ∈ F . The embedding F ⊂ G is continuous, therefore we know that (xϕ(n) )n weakly converges to y in G. On the other hand, we know by assumption that (xϕ(n) )n weakly converges towards x in E. The embedding E ⊂ G is continuous, therefore we deduce that (xϕ(n) )n weakly converges to x in G. It follows that y = x and the claim is proved.  Remark II.2.1. This result can be easily adapted to the case of the weak- convergence.

2. Fundamental results from functional analysis

55

We can now give a useful criterion of strong convergence for weakly convergent sequences in a Hilbert space. Proposition II.2.11. Let H be a Hilbert space and (un )n be a sequence of elements of H which weakly converges towards u in H. Let us assume that lim sup un H ≤ uH , n→∞

then the sequence (un )n strongly converges towards u in H. Proof. It is sufficient to write u − un 2H = u2H + un 2H − 2(u, un )H . Since the weak convergence gives (un , u)H −−−−→ u2H , we have n→∞

lim sup u − un 2H = u2H + lim sup un 2H − 2u2H ≤ 0, n→∞

n→∞

by using the assumption.  We later show (Proposition II.2.32) that this result is also valid in some Banach spaces (e.g. in the spaces Lp (Ω) with 1 < p < +∞). Unfortunately, the concept of weak convergence, although easier to use, does not generally allow passing to the limit in nonlinear terms. As an example (see Section 2.3 for the main properties of Lebesgue spaces), let the sequence of functions (un )n be defined on ]0, 1[ by un (x) = sin(nx). Then (un )n weakly converges towards 0 in L2 (]0, 1[) (Riemann–Lebesgue lemma)  1 u2n dx converges towards 1/2. Hence the sequence (u2n )n does not and 0

weakly converge towards 0 in L2 (]0, 1[). However, we note that the sequence (u2n )n does weakly converge in L2 (]0, 1[) but its limit is the constant function equal to 1/2 and not 0. Nevertheless, we prove in the following result that the product of a strongly converging sequence with a weakly converging one is a sequence which weakly converges towards the product of the limits. Proposition II.2.12. Let E, F , and G be three Banach spaces and let B be a continuous bilinear function of E ×F in G. If (un )n is a sequence of elements of E which strongly converges towards u and (vn )n is a sequence of elements of F which weakly converges towards v, then the sequence (B(un , vn ))n weakly converges towards B(u, v) in G. Proof. Let ϕ ∈ G ; we need to show that

Chapter II. Analysis tools

56

ϕ, B(un , vn )G ,G −−−−→ ϕ, B(u, v)G ,G . n→∞

By using the bilinearity of B, we have |ϕ, B(un , vn ) − B(u, v)G ,G | ≤ϕG B(u − un , vn )G + |ϕ, B(u, vn − v)G ,G | . From Corollary II.2.8, the sequence (vn )n is bounded. Hence, since the function B is continuous, the first term is estimated by ϕG B(u−un , vn )G ≤ ϕG Bu−un E vn F ≤ Cu−un E −−−−→ 0. n→∞

The function x ∈ F → ϕ, B(u, x)G ,G is a continuous linear functional on F because u is fixed in E and B is continuous. Hence from the definition of weak convergence, the second term also tends towards 0 when n tends towards infinity.  Remark II.2.2. If the space G is reflexive and if (un )n and (vn )n converge only weakly towards u (or, respectively, v), then the sequence (B(un , vn ))n is bounded in G (because B is continuous and (un )n and (vn )n are bounded). Hence, Theorem II.2.7 shows us that we can extract a subsequence which weakly converges in G towards a certain g. The problem is that without the property of strong convergence, we cannot in general conclude that g is equal to the expected limit, which would be B(u, v) as shown in the example given above. As shown in later chapters, we need to establish strong convergence properties of the sequence studied in larger spaces in order to identify the limit g to be the product B(u, v). Therefore, in order to deal with nonlinearities, it is necessary to obtain strong convergence in one way or another. One way to do this is to use the compactness properties described in Section 3.

2.3 Lebesgue spaces 2.3.1 Definitions and main properties Definition II.2.13 (Conjugate exponent). For all 1 ≤ p ≤ +∞, we define the conjugate exponent p of p by 1 1 = 1, + p p with the obvious conventions for p = 1 and p = +∞.

2. Fundamental results from functional analysis

57

This notation is used systematically throughout this text. We also note that for all p, we have (p ) = p. • For 1 ≤ p < +∞, the space Lp (Ω) is the set of Lebesgue-measurable functions on any open set Ω with real values, for which the pth power of the absolute value is integrable for the Lebesgue measure. For each  1/p f ∈ Lp (Ω) we set f Lp = Ω |f |p dx . • The space L∞ (Ω) is the set of Lebesgue-measurable functions which are essentially bounded on Ω. For each f ∈ L∞ (Ω), we set f L∞ = esssupΩ |f |. In fact, the elements of these spaces have to be considered as the classes of functions which coincide except over null Lebesgue measure sets. It can be shown (see Proposition II.2.21 and Remark II.2.3) that .Lp is a norm on Lp (Ω). Moreover, these spaces are Banach spaces. • For 1 < p < +∞, the space Lp (Ω) is separable and reflexive. Moreover its  dual is isomorphic with Lp (Ω) where p is the conjugate exponent of p. • The space L1 (Ω) is separable but not reflexive, its dual being isomorphic with L∞ (Ω). • By contrast, the space L∞ (Ω) is neither separable nor reflexive and its dual is strictly larger than L1 (Ω). We conclude this introduction by recalling the following version of the change of variable theorem. ˜ be two open sets in Rd . A map T : Ω ˜ → Ω is Definition II.2.14. Let Ω, Ω said to be a Lipschitz diffeomorphism if and only if • T is a bijection. • T and T −1 are Lipschitz-continuous. Notice that such a map is not in general a diffeomorphism in the usual sense because, in particular, it is not necessarily differentiable everywhere. ˜ be two open sets in Rd and T : Ω ˜ → Ω a Proposition II.2.15. Let Ω, Ω Lipschitz diffeomorphism. For any measurable function u : Ω → R and 1 ≤ p ≤ ∞, we have ˜ u ∈ Lp (Ω) ⇐⇒ u ◦ T ∈ Lp (Ω). Moreover, we have C1 uLp (Ω) ≤ u ◦ T Lp (Ω) ˜ ≤ C2 uLp (Ω) , for some C1 , C2 > 0 depending only on T .

Chapter II. Analysis tools

58

2.3.2 Elementary inequalities We give here rather general versions of Young’s and H¨ older’s inequalities, without proof. We use these repeatedly in the following sections, without necessarily explicitly referencing them. Proposition II.2.16 (Young’s inequality). Let n ≥ 2, and x1 , . . . , xn be nonnegative real numbers. Also, let p1 , . . . , pn be positive real numbers such that 1 1 + ··· + = 1. p1 pn We then have: x1 · · · xn ≤

xp11 xpn + ··· + n . p1 pn

The proof of this inequality is a simple application of the concavity of the logarithm function. We can directly deduce an useful version of this inequality. Corollary II.2.17. Let p1 , . . . , pn be real numbers satisfying the hypothesis of the preceding proposition. For all positive ε1 , . . . , εn−1 , there exists a C(ε1 , . . . , εn−1 ) > 0, such that for all positive x1 , . . . , xn , we have p

n−1 x1 · · · xn ≤ ε1 xp11 + · · · + εn−1 xn−1 + C(ε1 , . . . , εn−1 )xpnn .

In other words, in Young’s inequality, all the coefficients can be fixed except for one. Of course, the coefficient C(ε1 , . . . , εn−1 ) blows up when one of the εi tends towards 0. From Young’s inequality we can deduce H¨ older’s inequality which is stated in the following way. Proposition II.2.18 (H¨ older’s inequality). Let Ω be an open set of Rd and let p1 , . . . , pn be positive real numbers (possibly infinite). Let r ∈ [1, +∞] such that 1 1 1 = + ··· + . r p1 pn For all functions f1 , . . . , fn , with fi ∈ Lpi (Ω), the product f1 · · · fn belongs to Lr (Ω) and we have f1 · · · fn Lr ≤ f1 Lp1 · · · fn Lpn . We also need the following generalisation of Fubini’s theorem. Proposition II.2.19. Let d ≥ 2 and f1 , . . . , fd : Rd−1 → R be d functions belonging to Ld−1 (Rd−1 ). We define the following product f (x) = f1 (x2 , . . . , xd )f2 (x1 , x3 , . . . , xd ) · · · fd (x1 , . . . , xd−1 ), ∀x ∈ Rd ,

2. Fundamental results from functional analysis

59

where the term with fi depends on all the variables except xi . Then, f belongs to L1 (Rd ) and we have f L1 (Rd ) ≤

d 

fi Ld−1 (Rd−1 ) .

i=1

Proof. In the case d = 2, we have f (x1 , x2 ) = f1 (x1 )f2 (x2 ) and by assumption f1 , f2 ∈ L1 (R). Therefore, Fubini’s theorem implies that f ∈ L1 (R2 ) and that f L1 (R2 ) = f1 L1 (R) f2 L1 (R) . This proves the result (in this particular case the claimed inequality is an equality). Let us only prove the result for d = 3 because the general case follows by a simple induction using H¨ older’s inequality (see [27], for instance, for a complete proof). Let us integrate the definition of |f | with respect to the variable x3 and apply the Cauchy–Schwarz inequality  |f |(x1 , x2 , x3 ) dx3 R   =|f3 |(x1 , x2 ) |f1 |(x2 , x3 )|f2 |(x1 , x3 ) dx3 R

 ≤|f3 |(x1 , x2 )

1/2  |f1 | (x2 , x3 ) dx3  2



R

1/2 |f2 | (x1 , x3 ) dx3  2

R3



=(g1 (x1 ))1/2

. 

=(g2 (x2 ))1/2

We apply once more the Cauchy–Schwarz inequality to get 

 |f | dx ≤ R3

R2

1/2  |f3 |2 (x1 , x2 ) dx1 dx2

R2

1/2 g1 (x1 )g2 (x2 ) dx1 dx2

.

The last term is estimated by using the induction assumption (i.e., Fubini’s theorem) to get the claim 1/2

1/2

f L1 (R3 ) ≤ f3 L2 (R2 ) g1 L1 (R) g2 L1 (R) = f3 L2 (R2 ) f1 L2 (R2 ) f2 L2 (R2 ) .  We also need the following version of Jensen’s inequality. Proposition II.2.20 (Jensen’s inequality). Let Ω be an open set of Rd and η ∈ L1 (Ω) a nonnegative function. For any function f such that |f |p η ∈ L1 (Ω), for some 1 ≤ p < +∞, we have f η ∈ L1 (Ω) and p   f η dx ≤ ηp−1 |f |p η dx. L1 Ω

Proof.

Ω

Chapter II. Analysis tools

60 

We write f η = (f η 1/p )η 1/p and we use the H¨older inequality with exponents p and p = p/(p − 1).  Let us now establish a general version of the classic Minkowski inequality that we need below. Proposition II.2.21 (Minkowski’s inequality). Let (X1 , μ1 ) and (X2 , μ2 ) be two σ-finite measure spaces. Then for any nonnegative measurable function f defined on X1 × X2 and any r ≥ 1 we have 



r f (x1 , x2 ) dμ2

X1

1/r





1/r



dμ1

X2

f (x1 , x2 )r dμ1 X2

dμ2 .

X1

Remark II.2.3. If one takes X2 = {0, 1} and μ2 the counting measure, the above inequality can be written as f + gLr ≤ f Lr + gLr , for any nonnegative f, g and any r ≥ 1. Proof.  For all x1 ∈ X1 we denote J(x1 ) =

f (x1 , x2 ) dμ2 . Then, by using the

X2

H¨older inequality and the Fubini theorem, we have     r r−1 J(x1 ) dμ1 = J(x1 ) f (x1 , x2 ) dμ2 dμ1 X1 X2 X1  = J(x1 )r−1 f (x1 , x2 ) dμ2 dμ1 X1 X2   = J(x1 )r−1 f (x1 , x2 ) dμ1 dμ2 X2



X1





(r−1)/r  J(x1 )r dμ1

X2



X1

(r−1)/r 

X1



J(x1 )r dμ1

= X1

1/r f (x1 , x2 )r dμ1 1/r f (x1 , x2 )r dμ1

X2

dμ2 dμ2 .

X1

From where we deduce the claim.  Let us also mention the following reverse Minkowski inequality that we state in a simple framework sufficient for our purposes. Proposition II.2.22. Let 0 < q < 1 and Ω an open set of Rd . For any nonnegative measurable functions f, g : Ω → R, we have f + gLq ≥ f Lq + gLq .

2. Fundamental results from functional analysis

61

Proof. For any x ∈ Ω we write f (x) + g(x) f (x) g(x) f Lq gLq = + , q q q q q q q f L + gL f L + gL f L f L + gL gLq that is to say, f (x) g(x) f (x) + g(x) =θ + (1 − θ) , f Lq + gLq f Lq gLq with θ ∈ [0, 1]. From the assumption on q we know that the map s → sq is concave on R+ . Therefore we get  q q q   f (x) + g(x) f (x) g(x) ≥θ + (1 − θ) . f Lq + gLq f Lq gLq By integrating this inequality on Ω, we observe that we obtain 1 in the righthand side. The claim follows immediately. 

2.3.3 Mollifying kernels. Density result Mollifying is a central procedure in functional analysis. It in particular allows us to prove density results in suitable functional spaces related to mathematical fluid mechanics. It is also crucial in the renormalized solutions theory for the transport equation that we describe in detail in Chapter VI. Definition II.2.23. A map η : Rd → R is called a mollifying kernel if d • η ∈ Cc∞ (Rd), with Supp  η ⊂ B, the unit ball of R . • η ≥ 0 and Rd η dx = B η dx = 1. • η(x) only depends on |x|.

Note first that the last condition is not necessary but it sometimes allows simplifications in some computations. It is also worth noticing that such a function actually exists. For any ε > 0, we can now define ηε (x) =

x 1 x 1 η and (∇η)ε (x) = d (∇η) , d ε ε ε ε

in such a way that ∇ηε = (1/ε)(∇η)ε . Definition II.2.24. For any f ∈ Lp (Rd ), 1 ≤ p ≤ ∞ and any ε > 0 we define the convolution

62

Chapter II. Analysis tools

 (f  ηε )(x) =

Rd

f (y)ηε (x − y) dy 

 =

Rd

f (x − y)ηε (y) dy =

(II.5) f (x − εz)η(z) dz.

B

Notice that, inasmuch as η is bounded and compactly supported, all the integrals in the definition above make sense. Proposition II.2.25. For any ε > 0, we have f  ηε ∈ C ∞ (Rd ), C f  ηε L∞ ≤ d/p f Lp , ε C ∇(f  ηε )L∞ ≤ 1+d/p f Lp , ε f  ηε Lp ≤ Cf Lp ,

(II.6)

for some C > 0 depending only on η and p. Finally, if p < +∞ we have f  ηε −−−→ f, in Lp (Rd ). ε→0

Proof. The regularity of f ηε follows from the regularity of the kernel η and usual results of differentiation under the integral sign. The L∞ estimates simply follow from H¨ older’s inequality and the fact that ηε Lp = ηLp /εd/p . To prove the Lp estimate (II.6) for p < +∞, we first use the Jensen inequality (Proposition II.2.20) to get, for any x ∈ Rd ,  p |(f  ηε )(x)| ≤ |f (x − εz)|p η(z) dz. B

By integrating with respect to x and using Fubini’s theorem, we get   p f  ηε Lp ≤ |f (x − εz)|p η(z) dz dx Rd B    p = η(z) |f (x − εz)| dx dz = f pLp . Rd

B

Let us now show the convergence property. Since p < +∞, we can use the density of Cc0 (Rd ) in Lp (Rd ) (this property comes from the regularity of the Lebesgue measure). Therefore, there exists a sequence (fn )n of functions in Cc0 (Rd ) which converges towards f in Lp (Rd ). Each function fn is uniformly continuous and we denote by ωn its modulus of continuity. Using the properties of the kernel η, we observe that for each n we have  |fn  ηε (x) − fn (x)| ≤ |fn (x − εz) − fn (x)|η(z) dz ≤ ωn (ε), B

2. Fundamental results from functional analysis

63

and therefore, since fn is compactly supported we have fn  ηε − fn Lp ≤ Cn ωn (ε). Using the triangle inequality and (II.6) we get f  ηε − f Lp ≤ (f − fn )  ηε Lp + fn  ηε − fn Lp + fn − f Lp ≤ (1 + C)f − fn Lp + Cn ωn (ε). Taking the superior limit as ε → 0, we obtain for any n that lim sup f  ηε − f Lp ≤ (1 + C)f − fn Lp . ε→0

Taking now the limit n → ∞, we finally get lim supε→0 f  ηε − f Lp = 0 and the claim is proved.  Theorem II.2.26. For any open set Ω in Rd , the set D(Ω) is dense in Lp (Ω) for any 1 ≤ p < +∞. Proof. Let f ∈ Lp (Ω). For any n ≥ 1 we define the open set Ωn = {x ∈ Ω, d(x, ∂Ω) > 1/n}. By the dominated convergence theorem we see that fn = f 1Ωn converges to f in Lp (Ω). We consider now the function fn,ε = fn  ηε . By the previous proposition, we know that fn,ε ∈ C ∞ (Rd ); moreover, for any ε < 1/n, we observe that the support of fn,ε is contained in Ω, therefore fn,ε ∈ D(Ω). The result follows because we have limε→∞ (limn→∞ fn,ε ) = f in Lp (Ω). 

2.3.4 Weak and weak- convergences in Lebesgue spaces From the recap at the beginning of this section, and in particular from the characterisation of the dual space of Lp (Ω), we can write the Lp -version of Theorem II.2.7. Proposition II.2.27. Let (un )n be a bounded sequence of Lp (Ω), 1 < p < +∞; then we can extract a weakly converging subsequence from the sequence (un )n ; that is    ∃(unk )k , ∃u ∈ Lp (Ω), lim unk ϕ dx = uϕ dx, ∀ϕ ∈ Lp (Ω). k→∞

Ω

Ω

This result does not hold in L1 (Ω) because that space is not reflexive. Nevertheless, we have a similar result in L∞ (Ω) provided that we consider the weak- topology on this space, because it is the dual of the separable space L1 (Ω).

Chapter II. Analysis tools

64

Proposition II.2.28. Let (un )n be a bounded sequence of L∞ (Ω); then, from the sequence (un )n , we can extract a subsequence which is weakly- convergent; that is   ∞ ∃(unk )k , ∃u ∈ L (Ω), lim unk ϕ dx = uϕ dx, ∀ϕ ∈ L1 (Ω). k→∞

Ω

Ω

With this characterisation of the weak- convergence in L∞ (Ω), we can extend the density result given in Theorem II.2.26. Theorem II.2.29. For any open set Ω of Rd , the set D(Ω) is dense in L∞ (Ω) for the weak- topology. Proof. Let f ∈ L∞ (Ω). We set ψn = 1B(0,n) so that f ψn ∈ L1 (Ω) ∩ L∞ (Ω). By using Theorem II.2.26, we know that for each n there exists a function fn ∈ D(Ω) such that fn − f ψn L1 ≤ 1/n. Observe in the proof of this theorem that we have the additional property fn L∞ ≤ f ψn L∞ ≤ f L∞ . Let now ϕ ∈ D(Ω). We have     ≤ fn ϕ dx − f ϕ dx |f − f ψ ||ϕ| dx + |ψn − 1||f ||ϕ| dx. n n Ω Ω Ω Ω   fn −f ψn L1 ϕ L∞

The first term in the right-hand side tends to 0 by construction of (fn )n and the second one also tends to 0 thanks to the Lebesgue dominated convergence theorem. Finally, since (fn )n is bounded in L∞ (Ω) and D(Ω) is dense in L1 (Ω), we deduce that   −−−−→ 0, ∀g ∈ L1 (Ω), fn g dx − f g dx Ω

Ω

n→∞

which proves the theorem.  By applying Proposition II.2.12 within the framework of Lp -spaces, and by using H¨ older’s inequality, we obtain the following useful result. Proposition II.2.30. Let p, q, and r be three real numbers in [1, +∞[ such that 1 1 1 = + . r p q If (un )n is a sequence of Lp (Ω) which strongly converges towards u in Lp (Ω) and if (vn )n is a sequence of Lq (Ω) which weakly converges towards v in Lq (Ω), then the product sequence (un vn )n weakly converges towards uv in Lr (Ω).

2. Fundamental results from functional analysis

65

We now state the classic inequalities in Lp spaces which prove that these spaces are uniformly convex ([27], [69]) except for p = 1 and p = +∞. We can view these inequalities as generalisations of the parallelogram law in Hilbert space. Lemma II.2.31 (Clarkson’s inequalities). Let 1 < p < +∞, and let f, g be in Lp (Ω). • If p ≥ 2, we have    p   f + g p   +  f − g  ≤ 1 f p p + 1 gp p .  L L  2  p  2  p 2 2 L L • If p < 2, we have     p  1/(p−1)   f + g p   +  f − g  ≤ 1 f p p + 1 gp p  . L L  2  p  2  p 2 2 L L We can now prove the strong convergence criterion for a weakly converging sequence in Lp spaces. Proposition II.2.32. Let 1 < p < +∞, and let (un )n be a sequence of functions of Lp (Ω) which weakly converges towards u in Lp (Ω). If we assume lim sup un Lp ≤ uLp , n→∞

then the sequence (un )n strongly converges towards u. According to Corollary II.2.8, this hypothesis is equivalent to saying that the sequence of norms (un Lp )n converges towards uLp . For Lp spaces, this result generalises Proposition II.2.11 which dealt with the Hilbertian case (i.e., p = 2). Proof. The Clarkson inequalities given by the previous lemma can be written in the general form      α  f + g αp  f − g αp  +  ≤ 1 f p p + 1 gp p  , L L  2  p  2  p 2 2 L L where α = 1 if p ≥ 2 and α = 1/(p − 1) if p < 2. Let us apply this inequality to f = un and g = u. We obtain      α  un + u αp  un − u αp   +  ≤ 1 un p p + 1 up p , L L  2  p  2  p 2 2 L L and we denote the left-hand side of this inequality as an . If we pass to the upper limit in this inequality, then by using the hypothesis, we find that:

Chapter II. Analysis tools

66

lim sup an ≤ upα Lp .

(II.7)

n→∞

However, we have:    αp  un − u αp     = an −  un + u  ,  2  p  2  p L

L

which gives      un − u αp  un + u αp     . lim sup  ≤ lim sup an − lim inf  n→∞ 2  p 2  p n→∞ n→∞ L

(II.8)

L

Moreover, the sequence (un + u)/2 also weakly converges towards u, so that the Corollary II.2.8 shows us that    un + u αp pα   . (II.9) uLp ≤ lim inf  n→∞ 2 Lp By combining (II.7), (II.8), and (II.9), we finally obtain:    un − u αp   ≤ 0, lim sup  2 Lp n→∞ which concludes the proof.  2.3.5 Interpolation between Lp spaces We now establish an interpolation inequality which is nothing but a convexity property. Lemma II.2.33. Let Ω be any open set of Rd and let u ∈ Lp (Ω) ∩ Lq (Ω) with 1 ≤ p, q ≤ +∞. Then for all r such that 1 θ 1−θ = + , 0 ≤ θ ≤ 1, r p q we have u ∈ Lr (Ω) and uLr ≤ uθLp u1−θ Lq . Proof. We note that 1=

θr (1 − θ)r + , p q

and we can therefore apply the H¨ older inequality in the following way:

2. Fundamental results from functional analysis

67





|u|r dx = Ω

|u|rθ |u|r(1−θ) dx Ω

rθ/p 

 |u| dx



r(1−θ)/q |u| dx

p

q

Ω

Ω r(1−θ)

≤ urθ Lp uLq

.

 The preceding inequality allows us to obtain convergence properties in the intermediate spaces from the convergences in suitable Lp spaces. Corollary II.2.34. Let Ω be any open set of Rd . Let p1 , p2 ∈ [1, +∞] and let (un )n be a sequence of functions which strongly converges towards u in Lp1 (Ω) and which weakly converges (weakly- if p2 = +∞) in Lp2 (Ω). Then, for all p included strictly between p1 and p2 , the sequence (un )n strongly converges towards u in Lp (Ω). Proof. Since p is strictly included between p1 and p2 , there exists a θ ∈]0, 1[ such that θ 1−θ 1 = + . p p1 p2 From the interpolation inequality given by the preceding lemma, we have u − un Lp ≤ u − un θLp1 u − un 1−θ Lp2 . However, the weak (or weak-) convergence of (un )n in Lp2 (Ω), shows that the sequence (u−un )n is bounded in this space, as well as that the strong convergence in Lp1 (Ω) ensures convergence towards 0 of the first term, because θ is not zero. 

2.3.6 Local Lebesgue spaces Definition II.2.35. For all open sets Ω of Rd and for all p ∈ [1, +∞[, we denote as Lploc (Ω) the set of measurable functions for which the p-th power of the absolute value is locally integrable, that is, its integral over all compact subsets included in Ω is finite. Similarly, we denote as L∞ loc (Ω) the set of measurable functions essentially bounded over all compact sets included in Ω. We can say that a sequence (un )n converges towards u in Lploc (Ω), if (un )n converges towards u in Lp (ω) for any bounded open set ω such that ω ⊂ Ω. It is clear that Lp (Ω) ⊂ Lploc (Ω), the inverse inclusion being certainly false. A frequently useful property of sequences of functions in Lploc (Ω) is the following.

Chapter II. Analysis tools

68

Proposition II.2.36. Let Ω be a bounded open set of Rd , q > 1 and let (un )n be a sequence of bounded functions in Lq (Ω). We assume that (un )n converges towards u in Lploc (Ω) with 1 ≤ p < q; then we have u ∈ Lq (Ω), and un −−−−→ u, n→∞

in Lp (Ω).

Proof. The sequence (un )n being bounded in Lq (Ω), we know from Propositions II.2.27 and II.2.28 that we can extract a subsequence (unk )k which weakly converges (weakly- if q = +∞) towards a function v ∈ Lq (Ω). In particular, we deduce that for any ω ⊂ ω ⊂ Ω, (unk )k converges weakly (or weakly) towards v in Lq (ω) ⊂ Lp (ω). The convergence in Lploc (Ω) implies strong convergence in Lp (ω), thus we deduce that u = v ∈ Lq (Ω). For any k ≥ 1, we set ωk = {x ∈ Ω, d(x, ∂Ω) > 1/k}. We have ωk ⊂ Ω so that, by assumption, un − uLp (ωk ) −−−−→ 0. n→∞

Moreover, by using the H¨ older inequality we get un − uLp (Ω\ωk ) ≤ un − uLq (Ω) |Ω\ωk |(q−p)/q) ≤ 2C|Ω\ωk |(q−p)/q , where C is a bound of the sequence (un )n and of the function u in Lq (Ω). We then set ε > 0 and choose k to be sufficiently large so that 2C|Ω\ωk |(q−p)/q < ε. We then choose n0 sufficiently large that un − uLp (Ωk ) ≤ ε, ∀n ≥ n0 , and, therefore un − uLp (Ω) ≤ 2ε, ∀n ≥ n0 . 

2.4 Partitions of unity Let us start with a useful lemma when studying the local properties of functions. Lemma II.2.37. Let Ω be a nonempty open set of Rd and let ω be a bounded open set of Rd satisfying ω ⊂ Ω. Then there exists a function ϕ ∈ D(Ω), such that 0 ≤ ϕ ≤ 1, ϕ(x) = 1, ∀x ∈ ω.

2. Fundamental results from functional analysis

69

Proof. By hypothesis ω is compact and disjoint from the closed set Rd \Ω, hence δ = d(ω, Rd \Ω) > 0. We then introduce the open set U = {x ∈ Ω, d(x, ω) < δ/2}. It is clear that ω ⊂ U and U ⊂ Ω. The reader can easily convince her- or himself that the function ϕ = 1U  η δ , 4

obtained by convolution with a mollifying kernel of the characteristic function of U satisfies the stated result.  We can now show the essential result of this section. Lemma II.2.38 (Partition of unity). Let A be a nonempty set of Rd . We suppose given a covering of A by any family of open sets, A⊂

ωi . i∈I

There exists a family (ψi )i∈I of nonnegative functions of C ∞ (Rd ), indexed on I such that Supp ψi ⊂ ωi , ∀i ∈ I,  ψi (x) = 1, ∀x ∈ A, i∈I

this sum being locally finite. Moreover, the ψi are identically zero except for a countable number of indices i ∈ I. One such family of functions is called a partition of unity associated with the covering (ωi )i∈I . Proof. • Let us consider the set S of points of A with rational coordinates. We then consider the family (Bj )j∈J of spheres centred on S, for which the radius is rational and which are contained in one of the (ωi )i . This family is, of course, countable and we therefore index it with the integers n ∈ N, and by the density of Q in R we clearly have +∞

A⊂

Bn . n=0

Chapter II. Analysis tools

70

• For all n ≥ 0, we let Vn denote the ball with its centre at the same point as Bn and for which the radius is half that of Bn . According to Lemma II.2.37, there exists a positive regular function ϕn with compact support included in Bn and which is identically equal to 1 on Vn . We then define α0 = ϕ0 and for all n ≥ 1, αn = (1 − ϕ0 ) · · · (1 − ϕn−1 )ϕn . Is is clear that αn is smooth and nonnegative. Furthermore, by definition, αn has its support contained in Bn which is itself contained in one ωi for some i ∈ I. Moreover, a straightforward computation implies that N 

αn (x) = 1 − (1 − ϕ0 ) · · · (1 − ϕN ).

n=0

This shows firstly, since 0 ≤ ϕi ≤ 1, that for all N we have N 

αn (x) ≤ 1.

n=0

Furthermore, since ϕi = 1 on Vi , we see that N 

αn (x) = 1, ∀x ∈ V1 ∪ · · · ∪ VN .

n=0

Inasmuch as the αi are nonnegative, this implies that for all  n ≥ N + 1, αn is zero on V1 ∪ · · · VN , which indeed proves that the sum n≥0 αn is locally finite and that  αn (x) = 1, ∀x ∈ A. (II.10) n∈N

• For any n, we denote as i(n) ∈ I an index such that Supp αn ⊂ ωi(n) . We then note that +∞

A⊂

ωi(n) . n=0

Indeed, Equation (II.10), shows that any point of A belongs to the support of at least one function αn and therefore lies in ωi(n) . We now set ψi = 0 for any i ∈ I\{i(n), n ∈ N}. It remains to define the functions ψi(n) . To do this, we define

2. Fundamental results from functional analysis

ψi(0) (x) =

71



αk (x).

k∈N,s.t. Supp (αk )⊂ωi(0)

This sum is perfectly defined because the sum of the family (αn )n is locally finite in A. Furthermore, it is clear that βi(0) is nonnegative and that its support is contained in ωi(0) . We then define for n ≥ 1, ψi(n) (x) =



αk (x).

k∈N,s.t. Supp (αk )⊂ωi(n) ∀p≤n−1,Supp (αk ) ⊂ωi(p)

It is then obvious to check that those (ψi )i∈I solve the problem. 

2.5 A short introduction to distribution theory Let us first describe the sequential topology of D(Ω). A sequence (ϕn )n ⊂ D(Ω) is said to be convergent towards some ϕ ∈ D(Ω) if there is a compact K ⊂ Rd which contains the support of ϕ and of all the functions ϕn and if for any multi-index α ∈ Nd , the sequence (∂ α ϕn )n uniformly converges towards ∂ α ϕ. Definition II.2.39 (Distributions). A linear map T : D(Ω) → R is called a distribution if it is continuous in the sense that T (ϕn ) −−−−→ T (ϕ) for any sequence (ϕn )n converging towards ϕ in D(Ω). The set of distributions is denoted by D (Ω).

n→∞

Even though D(Ω) is not a Banach space, by similarity with the usual duality theory, we also adopt the notation T, ϕD ,D = T (ϕ). Definition II.2.40 (Convergence of distributions). A sequence of distributions (Tn )n ⊂ D (Ω) is said to converge towards a distribution T ∈ D (Ω) if for any ϕ ∈ D(Ω) we have Tn , ϕD ,D −−−−→ T, ϕD ,D . n→∞

Notice that the limit of a sequence of distributions (Tn )n , if it exists, is necessarily unique. Definition II.2.41 (Derivatives of distributions). For any distribution T ∈ D (Ω) and any multi-index α ∈ Nd , the derivative of T in the distribution sense is the distribution ∂ α T defined by

Chapter II. Analysis tools

72

∂ α T, ϕD ,D = (−1)|α| T, ∂ α ϕD ,D , ∀ϕ ∈ D(Ω). We can associate the distribution Tf ∈ D (Ω) defined by,  f ϕ dx Tf , ϕD ,D = Ω

with any f ∈ L1loc (Ω). The following property is fundamental. Proposition II.2.42. The map T : f ∈ L1loc (Ω) → Tf ∈ D (Ω) is injective and sequentially continuous. Proof. Let f, g ∈ L1loc (Ω) such that Tf = Tg . Let us show that f = g almost everywhere. Let ω be any bounded open subset of Ω. We set h = sgn(f − g) ∈ L∞ (ω). By using Theorem II.2.29 we can find a sequence ϕn ∈ D(ω) such that (ϕn )n converges to h in L∞ (ω) weak-. By extending ϕn by zero on Ω, we see that ϕn ∈ D(Ω) and therefore by assumption we have Tf , ϕn D ,D = Tg , ϕn D ,D ; that is,   0 = (f − g)ϕn dx = (f − g)ϕn dx. Ω

ω

Since f − g ∈ L (ω) and (ϕn )n converges in L∞ (ω) weak-, we can pass to the limit in this formula and finally obtain   0 = (f − g) sgn(f − g) dx = |f − g| dx. 1

ω

ω

It follows that f = g almost everywhere in ω. This is true for any such ω, thus we have f = g in Ω. Let (fn )n ⊂ L1loc (Ω) which converges towards some f ∈ L1loc (Ω). For any ϕ ∈ D(Ω), the sequence (ϕfn )n converges to ϕf in L1 (Ω) because ϕ is compactly supported. This implies that Tfn , ϕD ,D −−−−→ Tf , ϕD ,D , and the n→∞ claim is proved.  Thanks to the previous result we see that the map T let us identify L1loc (Ω) to a subspace of D (Ω). By abuse of notation we say that L1loc (Ω) ⊂ D (Ω) and we systematically identify f and the distribution Tf . Reciprocally, if a distribution T ∈ D (Ω) is such that T = Tf for some f ∈ L1loc (Ω) we say that T ∈ L1loc (Ω). Note also that, as soon as f is a smooth enough function, a simple integration by parts shows that we have ∂ α (Tf ) = T∂ α f , in D (Ω),

2. Fundamental results from functional analysis

73

so that the derivative in the distribution sense coincides with the derivative in the usual sense. It is also fundamental to recall that the convergence of functions in the distribution sense is weaker than all the weak and weak- convergences that we defined above. The precise result, whose proof is straightforward, is the following. Proposition II.2.43. • Let 1 ≤ p < +∞, and (fn )n be a sequence in Lp (Ω) which converges weakly towards f ∈ Lp (Ω). Then we have fn −−−−→ f, in D (Ω). n→∞

• Let (fn )n be a sequence in L∞ (Ω) which converges weakly- towards f ∈ L∞ (Ω). Then we have fn −−−−→ f, in D (Ω). n→∞

We conclude the presentation of the distribution theory with the following useful lemma. Despite its very simple statement, the proof is not so straightforward. Lemma II.2.44. Let Ω be a connected open set of Rd and let T ∈ D (Ω) be a distribution such that ∇T = 0 (in other words ∂T /∂xi = 0 in D (Ω) for all i). Then, T is constant; that is, there exists some α ∈ R such that T = α. Proof. • Let us start with the case where Ω is the cube ]0, 1[d . We fix a function θ ∈ D(]0, 1[) to be nonnegative with integral equal to 1. Now let ϕ ∈ D(Ω). We then denote  1  1 ... ϕ(u1 , . . . , ui , xi+1 , . . . , xd ) du1 . . . dui . mi (ϕ)(xi+1 , . . . , xd ) = 0

0

We set  Φ1 (x1 , . . . , xd ) =

x1

 ϕ(t, x2 , . . . , xd ) dt − m1 (ϕ)(x2 , . . . , xd )

0

x1

θ(t) dt. 0

It is clear that Φ1 is regular and, by choice of θ, this function has compact support in Ω. By hypothesis we have ! " " ! ∂T ∂Φ1 , Φ1 = − T, 0= ∂x1 ∂x1 D ,D D  ,D = −T, ϕ − m1 (ϕ)(x2 , . . . , xd )θ(x1 )D ,D .

Chapter II. Analysis tools

74

We have therefore shown that for any ϕ ∈ D(Ω), we have T, ϕD ,D = T, m1 (ϕ)θ(x1 )D ,D . We now set 

x2

Φ2 (x1 , . . . , xd ) = θ(x1 )

m1 (ϕ)(t, x3 , . . . , xd ) dt  x2 θ(t) dt. − θ(x1 )m2 (ϕ)(x3 , . . . , xd ) 0

0

By using the fact that ∂T /∂x2 = 0 for this test function (which belongs indeed to D(Ω)), we find T, ϕD ,D = T, θ(x1 )m1 (ϕ)(x2 , . . . , xd )D ,D = T, θ(x1 )θ(x2 )m2 (ϕ)(x3 , . . . , xd )D ,D . Hence, by induction we obtain that T, ϕD ,D = T, θ(x1 ) · · · θ(xd )md (ϕ)D ,D . However, md (ϕ) is a constant which is simply the integral of ϕ on Ω. If we define α = T, θ(x1 ) · · · θ(xd )D ,D , then we obtain

 αϕ dx1 · · · dxn ,

T, ϕD ,D = αmd (ϕ) = Ω

which proves the result in the case of the unique cube. It is clear that by translations and homothety this proves the result for all the cubes. • The case of any connected open set: We start by covering Ω with a locally finite family (ωi )i of open cubes. For all i, the distribution T restricted to ωi has zero gradient in D (ωi ) and is therefore constant on ωi . In other words, there exists some αi such that for all ϕ with support in ωi we have   T, ϕD ,D = αi ϕ(x) dx = αi ϕ(x) dx. ωi

Ω

We now consider a locally finite C ∞ partition of unity (ψi )i (see Lemma II.2.38) associated with the covering of Ω under consideration. Let ϕ ∈ D(Ω), then since the support of ϕ is compact, it is included in a finite union of the open sets of the family (ωi )i . We therefore obtain the following equality  ϕψi , ϕ= i

2. Fundamental results from functional analysis

75

the summation being, in fact, finite. Hence, we have  T, ϕψi D ,D . T, ϕD ,D = i

However, the functions ϕψi have support in the cube ωi , such that we obtain    αi ϕ(x)ψi (x) dx . T, ϕD ,D = Ω

i

The summation on i is in reality finite, therefore we have

  ϕ(x) αi ψi (x) dx. T, ϕD ,D = Ω

i

The fact that this is valid for all ϕ shows that the distribution T coincides with the function of class C ∞ defined by  αi ψi (x). T (x) = i

However, by hypothesis, this function has a gradient (in the classic sense) which is 0 on Ω. Since Ω is connected, this shows that the function T is indeed constant on Ω. 

2.6 Lipschitz continuous functions This class of function is important in the sequel because we mainly study the equations of fluid mechanics in a domain whose boundary has a Lipschitz regularity (including, in particular, polygonal/polyhedral domains). That is why we need to state here some basic results concerning those functions. We first give a very simple extension theorem in this class. Proposition II.2.45 (McShane–Whitney extension). Let A ⊂ Rd be any nonempty set and f : A → R be a Lipschitz continuous function on A. There exists a Lipschitz continuous function F : Rd → R such that F|A = f and Lip(F ) = Lip(f ). Proof. If we set L = Lip(f ), it is a simple exercise to check that F (x) = inf (f (y) + L|x − y|) , y∈A

Chapter II. Analysis tools

76

satisfies the required property.  In the sequel of this book (in particular in Chapter III), we often use the fact that Lipschitz continuous functions are almost-differentiable functions. The precise result, whose proof is given in [68], for instance, is the following. Theorem II.2.46 (Rademacher). Any locally Lipschitz continuous function f defined on an open set of Rd is differentiable (in the classic sense) almost everywhere. We need to analyse carefully the action of mollifying operators on Lipschitz continuous maps. We suppose given a mollifying kernel η as in Definition II.2.23 and we recall that, for any ε > 0, f  ηε is defined in (II.5). Proposition II.2.47. Assume that f is Lipschitz continuous on Rd , then 1. For any ε > 0, we have Lip(f  ηε ) ≤ Lip(f ). 2. f  ηε uniformly converges in Rd towards f as ε → 0. 3. For any x ∈ Rd such that f is differentiable at x, we have ∇(f  ηε )(x) −−−→ ∇f (x). ε→0

Proof. 1. The regularity of f  ηε comes from that of kernel η. The estimate of the Lipschitz seminorm is given by the following simple computation  |f  ηε (x) − f  ηε (y)| ≤ |f (x − εz) − f (y − εz)|η(z) dz B

≤ Lip(f )|x − y|, ∀x, y ∈ Rd . 2. Since



η(z) dz = 1, we have  |f  ηε (x) − f (x)| = (f (x − εz) − f (x))η(z) dz B  ≤ |f (x − εz) − f (x)|η(z) dz ≤ ε Lip(f ) |z|η(z) dz, Rd

B

B

and the claim is proved. 3. Let x be a point such that f is differentiable at x. Then, there exists τ : Rd → R such that limh→0 τ (h) = 0 and |f (x + h) − f (x) − ∇f (x) · h| ≤ |h|τ (h), ∀h ∈ Rd . Let i ∈ {1, . . . , d}. From (II.5), we see that  1 ∂xi (f  ηε )(x) = f (x − εz)∂zi η(z) dz. ε B

3. Basic compactness results

77

Moreover, by integration by parts, we observe that   ∂zi η(z) dz = 0, and z∂zi η(z) dz = −ei , B

B

so that we can write ∂xi (f  ηε )(x) − ∂xi f (x)  # $  1 = f (x − εz) − f (x) + ∇f (x).(εz) ∂zi η(z) dz , ε B and then we can conclude, by using the dominated convergence theorem, that  |∂xi (f  ηε )(x) − ∂xi f (x)| ≤ |z|τ (εz)∂zi η(z) dz −−−→ 0. B

ε→0



3 Basic compactness results As we show below, highlighting of the compactness properties of certain sets, or of certain maps, is often a crucial step in proving the existence of solutions to certain nonlinear partial differential equations. In this section we summarise essential definitions and results which are used later.

3.1 Compact sets in function spaces Ascoli’s theorem is one of the fundamental tools of nonlinear analysis. It allows relatively compact sets in C 0 (E, F ) to be simply characterised, where E is a compact space. This result is central because it underpins the majority of the compactness results used later in this text. A very classic proof of this theorem can be found, for example, in [99]. Theorem II.3.1 (Ascoli). Let E be a compact metric space, and let F be a metric space. Let C 0 (E, F ) be the metric space formed from the continuous functions of E in F equipped with the uniform distance: d(f, g) = sup d(f (x), g(x)). x∈E

Let K be a subset of C 0 (E, F ). We assume that: 1. For any x ∈ E, the subset of F , K (x) defined by:

Chapter II. Analysis tools

78

K (x) = {f (x), f ∈ K } is relatively compact in F . 2. The set K is equicontinuous; that is for all x ∈ E and all ε > 0, there exists an η > 0 such that d(f (x), f (y)) < ε, ∀y ∈ E, such that d(x, y) < η, ∀f ∈ K . Then, K is relatively compact (i.e., has compact adherence) in C 0 (E, F ). Unfortunately, it is very rare in the analysis of partial differential equations that we work in the set of continuous functions on a compact space. The following theorem, which follows from Ascoli’s theorem, gives us a compactness criterion similar to that of Ascoli for the bounded subsets in Lp (Ω) spaces. Theorem II.3.2 (Kolmogorov). Let Ω be any open set of Rd , and let F be a bounded subset of Lp (Ω), with 1 ≤ p < +∞. We assume that 1. For all ε > 0, and for all bounded open sets ω such that ω ⊂ Ω, there exists an α > 0, with α < d(ω, Rd \Ω) such that τh f − f Lp (ω) ≤ ε, ∀f ∈ F, ∀h ∈ Rd , |h| ≤ α.

(II.11)

2. For all ε > 0, there exists a bounded open set ω, such that ω ⊂ Ω and such that f Lp (Ω\ω) ≤ ε, ∀f ∈ F. (II.12) Then, F is relatively compact in Lp (Ω). In this theorem τh f denotes the translated function defined by τh f (x) = f (x + h). The first condition looks like the equicontinuity condition of Ascoli’s theorem; the second tells us that the functions of F must be “uniformly small” in the Lp norm near the boundary of Ω and near infinity. Proof. • We set ε > 0 and choose an open set ω satisfying (II.12). Let α > 0 with α < d(ω, Rd \ Ω) satisfying (II.11). We observe that, for any f ∈ F and any x ∈ ω we have  ¯ |f  ηα (x) − f (x)| ≤ |f¯(x − αz) − f (x)|η(z) dz. B

Using the Jensen inequality, integrating on ω and using Fubini’s theorem leads to  f¯  ηα − f Lp (ω) ≤ η(z)τ−αz f − f Lp (ω) dz. B

3. Basic compactness results

79

Note that we have used here the fact that, by assumption on α, x − αz belongs to Ω as soon as x ∈ ω and z ∈ B so that f¯(x − αz) = f (x − αz). For any z ∈ B we have |x − αz| ≤ α, therefore we deduce from (II.11) that f¯  ηα − f Lp (ω) ≤ ε, ∀f ∈ F.

(II.13)

• Let us define Fα = {f¯ηα , f ∈ F} and Fω = {f|ω , f ∈ F}. Each function in Fα is continuous on the compact ω and satisfies ∇(f¯  ηα )L∞ ≤

C

α

f Lp ≤ 1+d/p

C α1+d/p

,

because F is a bounded set of Lp (Ω). The number α > 0 being fixed, we have shown that Fα satisfies the assumptions of the Ascoli theorem. It follows that Fα is relatively compact in C 0 (ω) and thus in Lp (ω) by continuity of the embedding C 0 (ω) ⊂ Lp (ω). • As a consequence, there exist a finite number of balls in Lp (ω) with radius ε which cover Fα and with (II.13) we deduce that there exist a finite number of balls in Lp (ω) with radius 2ε which cover F|ω in Lp (ω). We denote such a covering as (BLp (ω) (gi , 2ε))1≤i≤N . • We finally prove that the balls (BLp (Ω) (gi , 3ε))1≤i≤N actually cover F. Indeed, for any f ∈ F there is a 1 ≤ i ≤ N such that f|ω ∈ BLp (ω) (gi , 2ε) and thus f − gi pLp (Ω) = f pLp (Ω\ω) + f − gi pLp (ω) ≤ εp + (2ε)p ≤ (3ε)p , by using (II.12). The claim is proved because, for any ε > 0, we have built a finite covering of F in Lp (Ω) made of balls of radius 3ε. 

3.2 Compact maps Definition II.3.3. Let E and F be two Banach spaces. We say that a map S from E into F is compact if the image of any bounded subset of E by S is a relatively compact set of F ; that is, it is a set having compact closure in F . Of course, any compact linear function is continuous because compactness implies that it is bounded in the neighborhood of 0. We generally use the compactness properties of maps in the following form. Let (un )n be a bounded sequence of points in E then, if S is compact, there exists a subsequence (unk )k such that (Sunk )k converges in F . In particular, we have the following result.

Chapter II. Analysis tools

80

Proposition II.3.4. Let (un )n be a sequence of points in E which weakly converges towards u in E, and let S : E → F be a compact linear map, then the sequence (Sun )n strongly converges towards Su in F . Proof. We note first that the sequence (Sun )n weakly converges towards Su. Indeed, for f ∈ F  , f, Sun F  ,F = t Sf, un E  ,E −−−−→ t Sf, uE  ,E = f, SuF  ,F . n→∞

Moreover, since (un )n is weakly convergent, it is a bounded sequence (Corollary II.2.8). Hence (un )n belongs to a bounded subset B of E. Inasmuch as S is compact, S(B) is compact, and therefore the sequence (Sun )n lies in a compact space of F . However, in a compact metric space, a sequence converges if and only if it has a unique accumulation point. Therefore let v = limk→∞ Sunk be an accumulation point of (Sun )n in F . As we have seen above, the sequence (Sunk )k weakly converges towards Su. From the uniqueness of the weak limit, this means v = Su. Hence, Su is the unique accumulation point of the sequence (Sun )n , which is therefore convergent.  In particular, this makes it possible to recover strong convergence from weak convergence, but in a larger space than the initial space. Indeed, if a space E is embedded into a space F with a compact embedding (we say that E is embedded in a compact way into F ), then any sequence of elements of E which is weakly convergent in E, is strongly convergent in F . On the other hand, the compactness of linear functions is a stable concept by composition and by passing to the adjoint. More precisely, we have the following results. Lemma II.3.5. Let E, F, G be three Banach spaces, let S be a continuous linear map from E to F , and let T be a continuous linear map from F to G. If S is compact or if T is compact, then T ◦ S is compact. Proof. This is essentially a consequence of the fact that the image of a bounded (resp., compact) set by a continuous linear map is another bounded (resp., compact) set.  Lemma II.3.6. Let E and F be two Banach spaces and let S be a compact linear map from E into F . Then the adjoint map t S from F  into E  is compact. Proof.

3. Basic compactness results

81

Let (fn )n be a bounded sequence of F  . From the definition of the adjoint of S, we have for all u ∈ BE (0, 1), t Sfn , uE  ,E = fn , SuF  ,F . Since S is compact, the set K = S (B(0, 1)E ), is a compact subset of F . The sequence (fn )n , being bounded in F  , is therefore also bounded in C 0 (K, R). Moreover, for all points v1 , v2 ∈ K we have |fn , v1 − v2 F  ,F | ≤ fn F  v1 − v2 F , which, since the sequence (fn )n is bounded in F  , proves that (fn )n is an equicontinuous family on K. Hence, from Ascoli’s theorem (Theorem II.3.1), there exists an extracted sequence (fnk )k which converges uniformly on K towards a continuous function f from K to R. Therefore, by transposition, for all u ∈ BE (0, 1) we have t Sfnk , uE  ,E = fnk , SuF  ,F −−−−→ f (Su), k→∞

and, moreover, the convergence is uniform in u on BE (0, 1). By homogeneity (i.e., because of the linearity of the functions t Sfnk ) we deduce that for all u ∈ E, the sequence (t Sfnk , uE  ,E )k converges and, furthermore, the convergence is uniform on all the bounded sets of E. The functions t Sfnk are linear and continuous, therefore the limit obtained is necessarily linear and continuous. All this demonstrates that convergence does indeed occur in E  (for which the strong topology is simply the uniform convergence on bounded sets).  Let us apply this result in the case where there is a continuous embedding of one Banach space into another. Proposition II.3.7. Let E and F be two Banach spaces. We assume that E is continuously embedded into F and that the range of E is dense in F (we say incorrectly that E is dense in F ); then the map T : f ∈ F  → Tf ∈ E  , defined by Tf , uE  ,E = f, uF  ,F , ∀u ∈ E, is an embedding (said to be canonical with respect to the considered embedding from E into F ) from F  into E  .

Chapter II. Analysis tools

82

Moreover, if the embedding of E into F is compact, then T is a compact embedding. Finally, if E is reflexive then the range of T is dense in E  . Proof. Since the embedding of E into F is continuous, there exists a constant C > 0 such that for any u ∈ E we have uF ≤ CuE . Hence, for all f ∈ F  , the function Tf is indeed continuous and linear on E, that is, an element of E  . Let us prove the injectivity of the function f → Tf . Let f ∈ F  such that Tf = 0. We therefore have f, uF  ,F = 0 for all u in E, but, since E is dense in F , we can deduce that f = 0. If the embedding from E into F is compact, then the compactness of T results directly from Lemma II.3.6. Let us now assume that E is reflexive. We need to show that T (F  ) is dense in E  . To do this, we use Proposition II.2.2. Any continuous linear functional on E  is of the form f → f, uE  ,E for a certain u in E. Let us suppose that one such functional cancels on T (F  ) and let us show that it cancels on all of E  . To say that this linear functional cancels on T (F  ) means that f, uF  ,F = 0, ∀f ∈ F  . Proposition II.2.1 then shows that uF = 0 and hence u = 0, which proves the result.  The Riesz theorem allows this result to be specified in the Hilbertian case. Corollary II.3.8. Let V and H be two Hilbert spaces such that V embeds densely into H. According to the Riesz theorem we can identify H and its dual via its scalar product. We then have a double dense embedding V ⊂ H ⊂ V , the second embedding being defined by f ∈ H → Tf ∈ V  , with Tf , vV  ,V = (f, v)H , ∀v ∈ V. If the embedding of V into H is compact, then the embedding of H into V  is also compact. For obvious reasons, in the situation described by the corollary, the space H is called the pivot space. Furthermore, since T is injective, we systematically identify f ∈ H with its image Tf ∈ V  so that the duality (V  , V ) can be expressed, using the scalar product of H, by f, vV  ,V = (f, v)H , ∀f ∈ H, ∀v ∈ V.

3. Basic compactness results

83

3.3 The Schauder fixed-point theorem For solving nonlinear partial differential equations, one can often use a rather classic fixed-point technique. In this book, we follow this strategy for studying the steady Navier–Stokes equations (Section 3 of Chapter V) and for studying the unsteady Navier–Stokes equations for a nonhomogeneous flow in Chapter VI. The key of this technique lies in the following theorem for which the rather tricky proof can be found, for example, in [114]. It relies on the concept of topological degree which is beyond the scope and objectives of this book. Theorem II.3.9 (Schauder fixed-point theorem). Let E be a Banach space and let C be a convex compact set in E. If T is a continuous (nonlinear) function from C into C, then it has at least one fixed-point in C. We note that this theorem says nothing about the uniqueness of the fixedpoint and that in general uniqueness does not hold (consider the identity function). Moreover, the fact that the function T maps the set C into itself is, of course, a crucial fact. In the particular case where E = R, we recover an elementary result which says that a continuous function from R into R which maps a compact interval [a, b] onto itself contains a fixed-point in this interval. This result also exists in a slightly different form which is given below. Theorem II.3.10. Let E be a Banach space and let C be a convex, closed and bounded region of E. If T is a compact and continuous (nonlinear) function from C into C, then it has at least one fixed-point in C. In the finite-dimensional framework, this theorem is known as the Brouwer theorem and is equivalent to the following result. Proposition II.3.11. Let P be a continuous function from RN to RN , such that there exists a ρ > 0 satisfying ξ · P (ξ) ≥ 0, ∀ξ ∈ RN , |ξ| = ρ. Then, there exists ξ ∈ RN , |ξ| ≤ ρ such that P (ξ) = 0. Proof. Suppose, by contradiction, that for all ξ ∈ B(0, ρ), P (ξ) = 0; then the continuous map Q : ξ ∈ RN → −(ρ/|P (ξ)|)P (ξ) maps the ball B(0, ρ) which is compact and convex into itself. Then by application of the Brouwer/Schauder fixed-point theorem, there exists ξ ∈ B(0, ρ) such that ξ = Q(ξ ).

(II.14)

Necessarily, we have |ξ | = ρ. By taking the scalar product of each term of (II.14) by ξ , one obtains:

Chapter II. Analysis tools

84

ρ2 = −

ρ (ξ · P (ξ )). |P (ξ )|

Therefore ξ · P (ξ ) < 0, which is in contradiction with the hypothesis.



4 Functions of one real variable In this section, we primarily review the links that exist between the concepts of weak derivatives and derivatives in the usual sense. We do this in a limited but sufficient way, for the case that concerns us, for functions of one real variable. We conclude the section by reviewing Gronwall-type inequalities which are a useful tool for obtaining a priori estimates for solutions of evolution partial differential equations.

4.1 Differentiation and antiderivatives Let [a, b] be a compact interval of R. We recall that W 1,1 (]a, b[) is the set of functions of L1 (]a, b[) for which the derivative in the sense of distributions is a function of L1 (]a, b[) (see Chapter III for a more complete study of Sobolev spaces). A fundamental question that we can ask for such a function is if it can be differentiated in the usual sense and if we can write the fundamental theorem of calculus  y f (y) = f (x) + f  (t) dt, ∀x, y ∈ [a, b]. x

Here, we recall some results that concern this question. This material is useful in the sequel of the book in order to justify the validity of the time evolution of the kinetic energy for weak solutions of the Navier–Stokes equations (see in particular Section 1.4 of Chapter V). Lemma II.4.1. Let g ∈ L1 (]a, b[) and C ∈ R. We consider the function f defined by  t f (t) = C + g(s) ds. a

Then, f is continuous on [a, b]. Moreover, f ∈ W 1,1 (]a, b[) and its derivative in the sense of distributions is g. Proof. For all t0 ∈ [a, b[ and h > 0 but sufficiently small, we have

4. Functions of one real variable

85

 f (t0 + h) − f (t0 ) =



t0 +h

b

g(s)1[t0 ,t0 +h] (s) ds −−−→ 0,

g(s) ds = t0

h→0

a

from Lebesgue’s dominated convergence theorem. A similar argument with h < 0 shows the continuity of f . We now need to verify that the derivative of f in the sense of distributions is the function g. Let ϕ ∈ D(]a, b[); we have 

b





b

f (t)ϕ (t) dt = −C







b



t



ϕ (t) dt −

a



g(s)ϕ (t) ds dt.

a

a

a

The first term is zero because ϕ(a) = ϕ(b) = 0 and we apply Fubini’s theorem to the second term (the function (t, s) → ϕ (t)g(s) is integrable with respect to the two variables). It follows that

   b



b

f (t)ϕ (t) dt = −

a

a



b

1[a≤s≤t] g(s)ϕ (t) ds

a

b





b

=−

dt



1[a≤s≤t] g(s)ϕ (t) dt a



b

=− 



a



b

g(s) a

ds



 ϕ (t) dt ds = − 

s

b

(g(s)(ϕ(b) − ϕ(s))) ds

a

b

g(s)ϕ(s) ds.

= a

This indeed proves that g = f  in the sense of distributions and therefore f ∈ W 1,1 (]a, b[).  Corollary II.4.2. Any function f of W 1,1 (]a, b[) is equal almost everywhere to a continuous function f˜ on [a, b] and we have for all x, y ∈ [a, b],  y ˜ ˜ f  (s) ds; f (y) = f (x) + x

in other words, we have for almost every x, y ∈ [a, b],  y f (y) = f (x) + f  (s) ds. x

Proof. Let f ∈ W 1,1 (]a, b[). We introduce  g(t) = a

t

f  (s) ds.

Chapter II. Analysis tools

86

• According to Lemma II.4.1, the function g is continuous in W 1,1 (]a, b[) and its derivative in the sense of distributions is f  . Hence, f − g is a function for which the distribution derivative is zero. We then know that there exists a real number C such that f − g = C almost everywhere (see Lemma II.2.44 for a more general case of this result). If we define f˜ = C + g, we have shown that f coincides with the continuous function f˜, almost everywhere. • From the definition of f˜, it is clear that for all x, y ∈ [a, b], we have      y  y  x f˜(y) − f˜(x) = C + f  (s) ds − C + f  (s) ds = f  (s) ds. a

a

x

 For any point t0 ∈ [a, b], we denote as Vη (t0 ) the set of open neighborhoods ω of t0 in [a, b] whose Lebesgue measure |ω| is less than η. Definition II.4.3 (Lebesgue points). Let f be a function of L1 (]a, b[) and t0 ∈]a, b[. We say that t0 is a Lebesgue point of f if  1 sup |f (t) − f (t0 )| dt −→ 0. η→0 ω∈Vη (t0 ) |ω| ω With this definition at hand, we have the following result. Proposition II.4.4. Let f be a function of L1 (]a, b[) and t0 ∈]a, b[. If t0 is a Lebesgue point of f , then any antiderivative of f defined by  t F (t) = C + f (s) ds, a

can be differentiated in the classic sense at t0 and moreover we have F  (t0 ) = f (t0 ). Proof. It is sufficient to write  t0 +h F (t0 + h) − F (t0 ) 1 (f (s) − f (t0 )) ds − f (x0 ) = h t0 h  1 t0 +h |f (s) − f (t0 )| ds ; ≤ h t0 this last quantity tends towards 0 when h tends towards 0, by definition of a Lebesgue point. 

4. Functions of one real variable

87

The fundamental theorem in this section is a rather difficult result from measure theory, which we do not prove. However, a proof can be found, for example, in [69] or in [100]. Theorem II.4.5. If f ∈ L1 (]a, b[), then almost every point of ]a, b[ is a Lebesgue point of f . The immediate consequence of the preceding two results is that the antiderivative F of any function f in L1 (]a, b[) is differentiable almost everywhere and satisfies F  = f and the fundamental theorem of calculus  y  y F (y) = F (x) + F  (t) dt = F (x) + f (t) dt, ∀x, y ∈ [a, b]. x

x

Finally, the following elementary result is useful. Proposition II.4.6. Let f ∈ L1 (]a, b[). Any point of continuity of f is a Lebesgue point of f and, in particular, any antiderivative of f is differentiable at any point t0 where f is continuous and its derivative is f (t0 ). Remark II.4.1. We can prove [69] that the functions of W 1,1 (]a, b[) are none other than the absolutely continuous functions on ]a, b[. We conclude this section by the following result and its corollary. Lemma II.4.7 (Hardy’s inequality). For any 1 < p < +∞ and any nonnegative f ∈ Lp (]0, +∞[) we have  0

M

p  M p    x 1 p f (s) ds dx ≤ f p (s) ds, ∀M ∈ [0, +∞]. x 0 p−1 0

Note that a similar inequality does not hold for p = 1. Proof. We prove the inequality for M = +∞. The general case follows by taking fM (s) = 1[0,M ] (s)f (s). ∞ By density, it is enough to prove this  x result for functions f ∈ Cc (]0, +∞[). For such an f , we set F (x) = (1/x) 0 f (s) ds and we note that F = 0 in the neighborhood of 0 and that F (x) = C/x for some C ∈ R and x large enough. In particular, we have F ∈ Lp (]0, +∞[). We remark that d(xF (x))/dx = f (x) so that we can integrate by parts as follows  +∞  +∞ 1 F (x)p dx = (xF (x))p p dx x 0 0  +∞ p 1 = (xF (x))p−1 f (x). p−1 dx p−1 0 x  +∞ p F (x)p−1 f (x) dx. = p−1 0

Chapter II. Analysis tools

88

We conclude the proof by using the H¨ older inequality  +∞ p F (x)p dx ≤ F p−1 Lp f Lp . p−1 0  We immediately deduce from this inequality the following result which is important in the sequel (see in particular the multidimensional version in Proposition III.2.40). Corollary II.4.8. Let f ∈ W 1,p (]a, b[) ⊂ W 1,1 (]a, b[) with 1 < p < +∞ and such that f (a) = 0. Then, the function g : x → f (x)/(x − a) belongs to Lp (]a, b[) and satisfies gLp ≤ Cf  Lp .

4.2 Differential inequalities and Gronwall’s lemma The following lemmas, concerning ordinary differential equations and inequalities, are very useful ingredients for studying time-dependent partial differential equations, in particular for proving energy estimates. Lemma II.4.9. Let there be two real numbers α > 0 and β ≥ 0 and let y be a function in C 1 ([0, +∞[, R) satisfying the differential inequality: y  (t) + αy(t) ≤ β, ∀t ≥ 0. Then we have y(t) ≤ y(0)e−αt +

β , ∀t ≥ 0. α

Proof. We multiply the two sides of the differential inequality by eαt and then integrate.  The following lemma, known as Gronwall’s inequality (even though its proof in the present form is due to Bellman [15]), is central in proving a priori estimates on solutions of (partial) differential equations. Lemma II.4.10. Let us consider a function y ∈ L∞ (]0, T [), a nonnegative function g ∈ L1 (]0, T [) and y0 ∈ R, such that  y(t) ≤ y0 +

t

g(s)y(s) ds, for almost all t ∈]0, T [, 0

we then have  t  g(s) ds , for almost all t ∈]0, T [. y(t) ≤ y0 exp 0

4. Functions of one real variable

89

Proof. We set



t

h(t) = y0 +

g(s)y(s) ds, 0

that is, the second term of the inequality from the hypothesis. Since y belongs to L∞ (]0, T [) and g to L1 (]0, T [), the function h lies in W 1,1 (]0, T [) and is therefore differentiable almost everywhere and its derivative is gy (see Section 4.1). Furthermore, for almost all t, we have h (t) = g(t)y(t) ≤ g(t)h(t), from the hypothesis and because g is nonnegative. Then, if we set z(t) = Rt h(t)e− 0 g , we immediately see that z belongs to W 1,1 (]0, T [) and that   t    z  (t) = h (t) − g(t)h(t) exp − g(s) ds . 0

Therefore, for almost all t, we have z  (t) ≤ 0. From Corollary II.4.2, this implies that the function z is nonincreasing and therefore we have z(t) ≤ z(0) = h(0) = y0 , ∀t ∈ [0, T ], which can be written as  t  h(t) ≤ y0 exp g(s) ds , ∀t ∈ [0, T ]. 0

This proves the claim since, by hypothesis, we have y ≤ h almost everywhere.  Lemma II.4.11 (Uniform Gronwall lemma [121]). nonnegative functions of L1loc (R+ ) satisfying: 

Let g1 and g2 be two

t+1

∃k1 ,

g1 (s) ds ≤ k1 , ∀t ∈ R+ , t



t+1

∃k2 ,

g2 (s) ds ≤ k2 , ∀t ∈ R+ . t

Let y be a function of C 1 ([0, +∞[, R+ ) satisfying y  (t) ≤ g1 (t) + g2 (t)y(t), for almost all t ≥ 0,  y(0) ≤ k3 and

(II.15)

t+1

y(s) ds ≤ k3 , ∀t ≥ 0. t

Then y is bounded on R+ and we have the following upper bound,

(II.16)

Chapter II. Analysis tools

90

y(t) ≤ (k1 + k3 )ek2 , ∀t ≥ 0. Proof. We integrate (II.15) between s and t (with 0 ≤ s ≤ t) and we get 



t

y(t) ≤ y(s) +

g1 (τ ) dτ + s

t

g2 (τ )y(τ ) dτ. s

From Lemma II.4.10, we deduce    t   t y(t) ≤ y(s) + g1 (τ ) dτ exp g2 (τ ) dτ . s

s

• For t ≤ 1, we take s = 0 and we directly obtain the result. • For t ≥ 1, we take s ∈ [t − 1, t], and we apply (II.16) to obtain y(t) ≤ (y(s) + k1 )ek2 . We integrate this last inequality with respect to s between t − 1 and t (with t fixed), which gives y(t) ≤ (k3 + k1 )ek2 .  We conclude this section by giving a result of the same type which is useful in the study of some nonlinear equations. This result is similar to the usual comparison theorems between differential inequalities, except that the hypothesis is formulated in an integral form, which is weaker. This explains the necessity of some monotonicity assumption for the nonlinear term. Lemma II.4.12 (Bihari’s inequality [16]). Let f : [0, +∞[→ [0, +∞[ be a nondecreasing continuous function such that f > 0 on ]0, +∞[ and  +∞ 1/f (x) dx < +∞. We denote the antiderivative of −1/f which cancels 1 at +∞ as F . Let y be a continuous function which is nonnegative on [0, +∞[ and let g be a nonnegative function in L1loc ([0, +∞[). We assume that there exists a y0 > 0 such that for all t ≥ 0 we have the inequality  t  t y(t) ≤ y0 + g(s) ds + f (y(s)) ds. 0

0

Then, there exists a unique T ∗ which satisfies the equation

 ∗ T∗ = F

T

y0 +

g(s) ds , 0

and, for any T < T ∗ we have

(II.17)

4. Functions of one real variable

91

sup y(t) ≤ F −1

F





T

y0 +

t≤T

−T

g(s) ds

.

0

Proof. The existence and uniqueness of T ∗ satisfying (II.17) arises from the fact that the function F is nonincreasing and tends towards 0 at +∞, and that g is nonnegative. Let us set T such that 0 < T < T ∗ . For all t ≤ T , since g is nonnegative, we have  y(t) ≤ y0 +



T

t

g(s) ds +

f (y(s)) ds.

0

(II.18)

0

Let us denote the right-hand side of this inequality as zT (t). Since f and y are T continuous, the function zT is of class C 1 and we have zT (0) = y0 + 0 g(s) ds and for all t < T zT (t) = f (y(t)) ≤ f (zT (t)), because f is nondecreasing. We note that zT is an nondecreasing function and since y0 > 0, the function zT does not cancel. Hence, we have zT (t) ≤ 1, ∀t < T, f (zT (t)) which, after integration between times 0 and T , gives F (zT (T )) − F (z(0)) ≥ −T. F is nonincreasing, thus it follows that zT (T ) ≤ F −1 (F (zT (0)) − T ) = F −1

F



y0 +



T

g(s) ds

−T

. (II.19)

0

We note that this makes sense because the definition of T ∗ and the condition T < T ∗ imply that F (zT (0)) − T belongs to the range of F . From (II.18), and since zT is nondecreasing, we have y(t) ≤ zT (t) ≤ zT (T ), ∀t < T. Inequality (II.19) therefore provides the claim. 

Chapter II. Analysis tools

92

5 Spaces of Banach-valued functions 5.1 Definitions and main properties Definition II.5.1. Let X be a Banach space and let I be an interval of R; we say that a function f from I in X is Lebesgue measurable, if • The inverse image under f of all open sets of X is a Borel set of I. • We can change f on a subset of zero Lebesgue measure of I, so that f takes its values into a separable subspace of X. In the case where X is separable, this definition is identical to the traditional definition of measurability. In the case where X is not separable, this definition ensures that one such function is indeed the limit almost everywhere of a sequence of simple functions with values in X, which makes it possible to define clearly the integral of f when it exists. This theory is known as the Bochner integral. Proposition II.5.2. Let X be a Banach space and let I be an interval of R. For all p ∈ [1, +∞[, we denote as Lp (]0, T [, X), the set of Lebesgue measurable functions defined on I and with values in X, such that t → f (t)pX is integrable on I. This is a Banach space for the norm 

1/p f (t)pX

f Lp (I,X) =

dt

.

I

In the same way, we define, for p = +∞, a Banach space L∞ (I, X) provided by the norm f L∞ (I,X) = esssupt∈I f (t)X . Proposition II.5.3. If p < +∞, the set of continuous functions on I with values in X is dense in Lp (I, X). For all f ∈ Lp (I, X), we denote as f˜ the extension by 0 of f to the whole time interval R; then, for all h ∈ R, we denote as τh f the translated function of f˜ defined by τh f (·) = f˜(· + h). (II.20) The restriction of τh f to the interval I is of course in Lp (I, X) and we have the following result (the proof being identical to the classic case where X = R; see [69] for example). Corollary II.5.4 (Continuity of the translation operator). If p < +∞, then for all f ∈ Lp (I, X) we have τh f −−−→ f, h→0

in Lp (I, X).

5. Spaces of Banach-valued functions

93

These results are of course false if p = +∞. In the case of p < +∞, the proposition above shows that we can also define Lp (I, X) as the completion of C 0 (I, X) for the norm  · Lp (I,X) . For any function f ∈ L1 (I, X) (and hence also if f ∈ Lp (I, X) and if I is bounded), we can define the integral  f (t) dt ∈ X, I

in a similar way to the Lebesgue integrals of real-valued functions, that is, by constructing the integral over simple measurable functions (i.e., taking a finite number of values) and by passing to the simple limit. We assume this result, as well as all the usual properties of the integral: Chasles’ linearity theorem, and so on. Moreover, for all linear forms ϕ ∈ X  , we have !  "  ϕ, f (t)X  ,X dt = ϕ, f (t) dt . I

X  ,X

I

The first examples for such spaces that are very useful in the sequel are given for p, q ∈ [1, +∞], by Lp (I, Lq (Ω)). The properties of Lp spaces, which we gave at the start of this section, naturally transpose into these spaces and we use these later without giving more details. In particular, if p < +∞ and q < +∞, then we have 



(Lp (I, Lq (Ω))) ≡ Lp (I, Lq (Ω)), the identification of the two spaces being achieved via the natural inner product of the Hilbert space L2 (I, L2 (Ω)) ≈ L2 (I × Ω). Hence, Propositions II.2.27, II.2.28, II.2.30, and II.2.32, can be immediately transposed to these spaces. Among the particularly useful results to keep in mind, we give the following interpolation result as well as its corollary which gives the convergence properties in some intermediate spaces. Theorem II.5.5. Let I be an interval of R, let Ω be an open set of Rd , and let p1 ,q1 ,p2 ,q2 be four real numbers in [1, +∞]. If f ∈ Lp1 (I, Lq1 (Ω)) ∩ Lp2 (I, Lq2 (Ω)) then for all θ ∈]0, 1[, the function f belongs to Lp (I, Lq (Ω)) for p and q defined by 1 1−θ 1 1−θ θ θ + , and = + , = p p1 p2 q q1 q2 and we have f Lp (I,Lq (Ω)) ≤ f θLp1 (I,Lq1 (Ω)) f 1−θ Lp2 (I,Lq2 (Ω)) . Proof.

(II.21)

Chapter II. Analysis tools

94

From Lemma II.2.33, for almost all t ∈ I we have: p(1−θ)

f (t)pLq ≤ f (t)pθ Lq1 f (t)Lq2

.

If we assume that p1 and p2 are finite, then the H¨ older inequality applied with the conjugate exponents p1 /(pθ) and p2 /(p(1 − θ)) shows that 

 f (t)pLq dt ≤ I

f (t)pL1q1 dt I

pθ/p1 

f (t)qL1q2 dt

p(1−θ)/p2 ,

I

which gives the desired result. The case where p1 and/or p2 are infinite is straightforward.  Corollary II.5.6. We consider the same notation as in the previous theorem and we assume further that p1 and q1 are finite and that p2 and q2 are strictly larger than 1. If (un )n is a sequence of functions which strongly converges towards u in Lp1 (I, Lq1 (Ω)) and weakly (or weakly- if p2 and/or q2 are infinite) in Lp2 (I, Lq2 (Ω)), then for all θ such that 0 < θ ≤ 1 the sequence (un )n strongly converges towards u in Lp (I, Lq (Ω)), where p and q are given by (II.21). Proof. From the preceding theorem we have for all n, u − un Lp (I,Lq (Ω)) ≤ u − un θLp1 (I,Lq1 (Ω)) u − un 1−θ Lp2 (I,Lq2 (Ω)) . The weak convergence in Lp2 (I, Lq2 (Ω)) shows that the sequence (u − un )n is bounded in this space and the strong convergence in Lp1 (I, Lq1 (Ω)) allows us to reach our conclusion, given that θ > 0.  All of these results are used systematically in this book, without necessarily referencing them.

5.2 Regularity in time 5.2.1 Weak time derivative In the study of parabolic partial differential equations, one independent variable (usually time) plays a particular role with respect to the other variables (typically space variables). This is why we work in Lp (]0, T [, X) spaces where X is the functional space in the space variables. In this section, we therefore generalise the concept of weak derivatives for functions defined on an interval of R and with values in a Banach space. In a

5. Spaces of Banach-valued functions

95

general way, it is possible to define and study distribution spaces with values in X, but this theory is not required here and we refer the reader to [113] for more details. For reasons which become clear later, it is useful to construct a theory in which the weak derivative of the function being considered can exist in a space that is larger than the initial space. Definition II.5.7. Let I be an interval of R, and X ⊂ Y be two Banach spaces, 1 ≤ p, q ≤ +∞. We say that a function u ∈ Lp (I, X) has a weak derivative in Lq (I, Y ) if there exists a function g ∈ Lq (I, Y ) such that    ϕ (t)u(t) dt = − ϕ(t)g(t) dt, ∀ϕ ∈ D(I). (II.22) I

I

If such a function g exists, it is unique and we denote du = g(t). dt We should note that in (II.22), the left-hand term is an element of X and the right-hand term is an element of Y . However, since X ⊂ Y this equality makes sense. Remark II.5.1. A priori this definition depends on the space Lq (I, Y ) in which we seek the weak derivative. We can show that if Y ⊂ Z in a dense way, if Z  is separable and if g and h are the weak derivatives of u in Lq (I, Y ) and Lr (I, Z), respectively, then g = h almost everywhere. This, therefore, justifies the notation du/dt.

5.2.2 Weak continuity Definition II.5.8. Let Y be a Banach space; we say that a function u : [0, T ] → Y is weakly continuous if for all ψ ∈ Y  , the function defined by t ∈ [0, T ] → ψ, u(t)Y  ,Y ∈ R is continuous. We denote by C 0 ([0, T ], Yweak ), the set of functions defined on [0, T ] with values in Y which are weakly continuous. We will now show the following important result (see, e.g., [85]). Lemma II.5.9. Let X be a separable and reflexive Banach space, and let Y be a Banach space, such that X ⊂ Y with continuous embedding. Then L∞ (]0, T [, X) ∩ C 0 ([0, T ], Yweak ) = C 0 ([0, T ], Xweak ). Proof. The space X is embedded into Y in a continuous way, therefore the restrictions to X of elements of Y  are in X  .

Chapter II. Analysis tools

96

• Let us show that C 0 ([0, T ], Xweak ) ⊂ L∞ (]0, T [, X) ∩ C 0 ([0, T ], Yweak ). Let u ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], Xweak ) and let ψ ∈ Y  . Since ψ|X ∈ X  , the function t → ψ, u(t) is continuous by definition, which shows that u ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], Yweak ). Let us show that u ∈ L∞ (]0, T [, X). First, we note that u is measurable. Indeed, any sphere B of X which is closed for the strong topology is also closed for the weak topology of X, because it is convex (see [27]). Therefore, u−1 (B) is a closed set and hence a Borel set of ]0, T [, because u is continuous on ]0, T [ with values in X for the weak topology. However, X being separable, any open set of X is a countable union of closed spheres. Indeed, if (xn )n is a dense sequence in X, it is obvious that any open set U is the union of all closed spheres centred on a point of the sequence (xn )n , with a rational radius and contained in U . Hence, for any open set U , u−1 (U ) is a Borel set of ]0, T [. This proves the measurability. Let us now introduce the family of elements of X  indexed by t ∈ [0, T ], defined by Φt : ψ ∈ X  → ψ, u(t). By hypothesis, for all ψ ∈ X  , the function t → Φt (ψ) is continuous on [0, T ] and therefore bounded. From the Banach–Steinhaus theorem (Theorem II.2.4), we know that the family of operators (Φt )t∈]0,T [ is bounded in the sense of the norm of X  . Alternatively, we can say that there exists C > 0 such that |ψ, u(t)X  ,X | = |Φt (ψ)| ≤ CψX  , ∀t ∈]0, T [, ∀ψ ∈ X  . If we apply Proposition II.2.1, this gives u(t)X =

sup

ψ∈X  ,ψ =0

|ψ, u(t)X  ,X | ≤ C, ∀t ∈]0, T [. ψX 

This demonstrates that u ∈ L∞ (]0, T [, X). • Let us show that L∞ (]0, T [, X) ∩ C 0 ([0, T ], Yweak ) ⊂ C 0 ([0, T ], Xweak ). Let u ∈ L∞ (]0, T [, X) ∩ C 0 ([0, T ], Yweak ). Let us first verify that for all t ∈ [0, T ], u(t) ∈ X. A priori, we know only that u(t) ∈ Y for all t, and that u(t) ∈ X for almost all t. First, let us extend u to all of R (e.g., by successive reflections performed by setting u(t) = u(−t) for t ∈ [−T, 0], etc.). It is then obvious that u ∈ L∞ (R, X) ∩ C 0 (R, Yweak ). Let η : R → R be a mollifying kernel (see Definition II.2.23). We set un = u  η1/n which is defined for all t and takes its values in X. Let t0 ∈ R be fixed. For all n ≥ 1, we have un (t0 )X = (u  η1/n )(t0 )X ≤ uL∞ (R,X) .

5. Spaces of Banach-valued functions

97

The sequence (un (t0 ))n is bounded in X, which is reflexive, therefore we can extract a subsequence (unk (t0 ))k which weakly converges in X towards a certain u ˜(t0 ) (Theorem II.2.7). However, for all ψ ∈ Y  , we have   ψ, (u  η1/n )(t0 ) − u(t0 )Y  ,Y = (ψ, uY  ,Y  η1/n )(t0 ) − ψ, uY  ,Y (t0 ) −−−−→ 0, n→∞

because, by hypothesis, t → ψ, u(t)Y  ,Y is a continuous function on R (the extension by reflection preserves this property). We have hence shown that (un (t0 ))n weakly converges in Y towards u(t0 ). Through the uniqueness of the weak limit in Y , we obtain u(t0 ) = u ˜(t0 ) ∈ X, which indeed proves that the function u takes its values in X for all t and that there exists C > 0 such that u(t)X ≤ C, ∀t ∈ R.

(II.23)

We can now define the function t → ψ, u(t)X  ,X for all ψ ∈ X  . Let us show that it is continuous. Let (tn )n be a sequence of real numbers which converges towards t ∈ R. From (II.23) the sequence (u(tn ))n is bounded in X, and we can therefore extract a subsequence which weakly converges towards a certain x in X. Furthermore (u(tn ))n weakly converges towards u(t) in Y , and through the uniqueness of the weak limit in Y , we obtain x = u(t). This proves that the sequence (u(tn ))n is relatively weakly compact in X and has only one accumulation point. We therefore know that all of the sequence weakly converges towards its unique accumulation point u(t).  Remark II.5.2. If X and Y are two separable Banach spaces such that Y is embedded in a dense way into X, then we have   L∞ (]0, T [, X  ) ∩ C 0 ([0, T ], Yweak− ) ⊂ C 0 ([0, T ], Xweak− ).

This result is proven in an equivalent way to the preceding one. The converse embedding is of course true from that which has gone before, if we add the reflexivity hypothesis.

Chapter II. Analysis tools

98

5.2.3 Strong continuity Let X and Y be two Banach spaces such that X is embedded in a continuous and dense way into Y , and let T > 0 and p, q satisfy 1 ≤ p, q ≤ +∞. We denote: % & du p q Ep,q = u ∈ L (]0, T [, X), ∈ L (]0, T [, Y ) . dt Lemma II.5.10. The space Ep,q endowed with the norm    du   , uEp,q = uLp (]0,T [, X) +   dt  q L (]0,T [, Y ) is a Banach space. Moreover, if p and q are finite then C ∞ ([0, T ], X) is dense in Ep,q . Proof. Let θ1 , θ2 be two nonnegative functions of C ∞ ([0, T ], R), having sum 1 with # # $ $ 2 1 supp(θ1 ) ⊂ 0, T , and supp(θ2 ) ⊂ T, T . 3 3 Then let u ∈ E. To approximate u by regular functions, it is sufficient to separately approximate θ1 u and θ2 u, because u = θ1 u + θ2 u. The function v = θ1 u is an element of & % df f ∈ Lp (]0, +∞[, X), ∈ Lq (]0, +∞[, Y ) . dt Let us set vh (t) = v(t+h); then vh,ε = vh ηε with ε < h where η : R → R is a mollifying kernel. The claim follows from Corollary II.5.4. A similar argument holds for the function θ2 u.  Remark II.5.3. Let us assume that p = +∞, q < +∞, and that X is the dual of a Banach space E. Then we can easily see that the family of regular functions constructed in the preceding proof satisfies vh, −−−−− v,

weakly- in L∞ (]0, +∞[, E  ),

(h,ε)→0

d d vh, −−−−−→ v, in Lq (]0, T [, Y ). dt (h,ε)→0 dt In other words, the density property of the regular functions still occurs by taking the weak-star topology on L∞ (]0, T [, E  ). We can deal, in the same way, with the case where p is finite, q = +∞, and Y is the dual of F as well as the case where p = q = +∞ and X = E  , Y = F  .

5. Spaces of Banach-valued functions

99

Proposition II.5.11. Any element u of Ep,q (defined almost everywhere) possesses a continuous representation on [0, T ] with values in Y , and the embedding of Ep,q into C 0 ([0, T ], Y ) is continuous. Moreover, for all t1 , t2 ∈ [0, T ], we have  u(t2 ) − u(t1 ) =

t2

t1

du dt, dt

where it is understood that we have identified u and its continuous representation. Proof. This result is proven in an entirely similar way to those established in Section 4.  In the Hilbertian case we can improve the preceding result in the following way. Theorem II.5.12 (Lions–Magenes [85]). Let V and H be two Hilbert spaces such that V is embedded in a continuous and dense way into H. We then identify H with its dual such that we have V ⊂ H ⊂ V  , the duality bracket between V and V  being given by the scalar product of H. Let 1 ≤ p, q ≤ +∞ and let u, v be two functions such that % &  df u ∈ Ep,q = f ∈ Lp (]0, T [, V ), ∈ Lq (]0, T [, V  ) , dt % & df q p  v ∈ Eq,p = f ∈ L (]0, T [, V ), ∈ L (]0, T [, V ) . dt Then the function t → (u(t), v(t))H has a continuous representation on [0, T ] and we have for all t1 , t2 ∈ [0, T ], (u(t2 ), v(t2 ))H − (u(t1 ), v(t1 ))H " ! "  t2 ! du dv (t), v(t) + (t), u(t) dt. = dt dt t1 V  ,V V  ,V Proof. Here, we give the proof of this result when 1 < p, q < +∞. The argument can be adapted to other cases by applying Remark II.5.3 and Proposition II.2.12. Let us consider the following bilinear forms defined on Ep,q × Eq,p with values in L1 (]0, T [) by   Ψ1 (f, g) = t → (f (t), g(t))H ,   ! ! " " df dg . + Ψ2 (f, g) = t → (t), g(t) (t), f (t) dt dt V  ,V V  ,V

Chapter II. Analysis tools

100

These two maps are well-defined because the exponents p, q and p , q  are conjugate, respectively. Moreover, we have for all (f, g) ∈ Ep,q × Eq,p : Ψ1 (f, g)L1 (]0,T [) ≤ f Lp (]0,T [,V ) gLp (]0,T [,V  ) 

≤ T 1/p f Lp (]0,T [,V ) gC 0 (]0,T [,V  ) ≤ Cf Ep,q gEq,p , and Ψ2 (f, g)L1 (]0,T [)

   df   ≤ gLq (]0,T [,V )  dt  q L (]0,T [,V  )    dg   + f Lp (]0,T [,V )  dt  p  L (]0,T [,V )

≤Cf Ep,q gEq,p . This proves that Ψ1 and Ψ2 are continuous bilinear forms. Using Lemma II.5.10, let us consider (un )n and (vn )n , two sequences of C ∞ ([0, T ], V ) which converge towards u and v, respectively, in Ep,q and Eq,p . The functions un and vn being regular, we can differentiate the scalar product (un (t), vn (t))H in the classic sense which implies, in particular, that for all functions ϕ ∈ D(]0, T [), we have 

T

− 

ϕ (t)(un (t), vn (t))H dt

!

0 T

= 0

" ! " dun dvn ϕ(t) dt. + (t), vn (t) (t), un (t) dt dt V  ,V V  ,V

In other words, we have  −

T





ϕ (t)Ψ1 (un , vn ) dt = 0

T

ϕ(t)Ψ2 (un , vn ) dt. 0

By continuity of Ψ1 and Ψ2 , we can pass to the limit in this expression and obtain  T − ϕ (t)(u(t), v(t))H dt 0

! " "  T ! du dv ϕ(t) dt. = + (t), v(t) (t), u(t) dt dt 0 V  ,V V  ,V The function Ψ1 (u, v) : t → (u(t), v(t))H belongs to L1 (]0, T [), therefore this last expression, valid for all regular functions with compact support ϕ,

5. Spaces of Banach-valued functions

101

shows us that Ψ1 (u, v) belongs to W 1,1 (]0, T [) and that its weak derivative is Ψ2 (u, v). Corollary II.4.2 then allows us to conclude the proof.  Theorem II.5.13. Let V and H be two Hilbert spaces satisfying the hypotheses of the preceding theorem; then the space % & du E2,2 = u ∈ L2 (]0, T [, V ), ∈ L2 (]0, T [, V  ) dt is continuously embedded into C 0 ([0, T ], H). Proof. We apply the preceding theorem, with p = q = 2 and u = v, and we immediately obtain that the function t → 12 u(t)2H is continuous on [0, T ] and that for all t, s ∈ [0, T ], we have "  t! 1 du 1 2 2 dτ u(t)H = u(s)H + ,u 2 2 dt s V  ,V 1 ≤ u(s)2H + Cu2E2,2 . 2 By integrating this with respect to s, we find 1 1 u(t)2H ≤ u2L2 (]0,T [,H) + Cu2E2,2 2 2 ≤ Cu2L2 (]0,T [,V ) + Cu2E2,2 ≤ Cu2E2,2 .

(II.24)

This proves that the function u lies in L∞ (]0, T [, H). Furthermore, Proposition II.5.11 shows that u is continuous with values in V  . We can then apply Lemma II.5.9, to obtain that u is weakly continuous with values in H (we should not forget that all Hilbert spaces are reflexive). The strong continuity of u with values in H is now a consequence of the weak continuity in H, of the continuity of the function t → u(t)2H , and Proposition II.2.11. Moreover, the estimate (II.24) leads to uC 0 ([0,T ],H) ≤ CuE2,2 .  This situation is a special case of a more general result (see [85]) which is the following. Theorem II.5.14. Let V and W be two Hilbert spaces; then % & dv 2 2 E2,2 = v ∈ L (]0, T [, V ), ∈ L (]0, T [, W ) dt

Chapter II. Analysis tools

102

is continuously embedded in C 0 ([0, T ], [V, W ] 12 ) where [V, W ] 12 is the interpolated space of order 12 of V and W . We refer the reader to [85] for a precise definition of interpolated space [V, W ] 12 . In Chapter IV, we present the proof of a special case of this statement (see Theorem IV.5.11).

5.3 Compactness theorems Let us start by proving a now classic lemma (due to J.-L. Lions [84]), which is the basis of a large part of all the following compactness results. Lemma II.5.15. Let B0 ⊂ B1 and ⊂ B2 be three Banach spaces. We assume that the embedding of B1 in B2 is continuous and the embedding of B0 in B1 is compact. Then, for all ε > 0, there exists a constant C(ε), such that for all u ∈ B0 , we have uB1 ≤ εuB0 + C(ε)uB2 . Proof. Let us assume that the claim is false; then there exists ε0 > 0 and a sequence (un )n ⊂ B0 , such that un B1 ≥ ε0 un B0 + nun B2 , ∀n ≥ 1. By homogeneity we can take un B1 = 1 in the above inequality. Hence, the sequence (un )n is bounded in B0 and satisfies un B2 ≤ 1/n. The embedding of B0 into B1 is compact, thus we can extract a subsequence (unk )k which converges in B1 towards an element denoted u∞ . Of course u∞ B1 = 1, and furthermore u∞ B2 = 0. This is the contradiction.  We can now prove one of the fundamental results of compactness in the study of nonlinear evolution problems. Theorem II.5.16 (Aubin–Lions–Simon). Let B0 ⊂ B1 ⊂ B2 be three Banach spaces. We assume that the embedding of B1 in B2 is continuous and that the embedding of B0 in B1 is compact. Let p, r such that 1 ≤ p, r ≤ +∞. For T > 0, we define % & dv p r ∈ L (]0, T [, B2 ) . Ep,r = v ∈ L (]0, T [, B0 ), dt i) If p < +∞, the embedding of Ep,r in Lp (]0, T [, B1 ) is compact. ii) If p = +∞ and if r > 1, the embedding of Ep,r in C 0 ([0, T ], B1 ) is compact.

5. Spaces of Banach-valued functions

103

The proof which follows comes from [109] and does not assume that the spaces considered are reflexive, in contrast to the proof in [14]. It thus applies to the spaces L1 and L∞ , for example. Proof. We only demonstrate point i) of the theorem the second point being treated in an entirely similar fashion. Furthermore, it is clear that we do not lose any generality by assuming that r = 1. To demonstrate the theorem, we establish that if a sequence (un )n satisfies: p  (un)n is bounded in L (]0, T [, B0 ), dun is bounded in L1 (]0, T [, B2 ), dt n

then we can extract a Cauchy subsequence in Lp (]0, T [, B1 ). • Step 1: From Lemma II.5.15, it suffices to find a Cauchy sequence in Lp (]0, T [, B2 ). Indeed, if a sequence (vn )n satisfies the Cauchy criterion in Lp (]0, T [, B2 ) and is bounded in Lp (]0, T [, B0 ), then for all ε > 0 we have vn − vm Lp (]0,T [, B1 ) ≤ εvn − vm Lp (]0,T [, B0 ) + C(ε)vn − vm Lp (]0,T [, B2 ) ≤ 2Kε + C(ε)vn − vm Lp (]0,T [, B2 ) , where K is some bound of (vn )n in Lp (]0, T [, B0 ). Hence, if (vn )n is a Cauchy sequence in Lp (]0, T [, B2 ), it follows lim sup vn − vm Lp (]0,T [, B1 ) ≤ 2Kε, n,m→∞

which proves the claim, ε being arbitrary. • Step 2: Let θ ∈ C ∞ ([0, T ], R), θ(T ) = 0, such that we have un = θun + (1 − θ)un ≡ vn + wn . We show that we are able to extract from (vn )n a Cauchy sequence in Lp (]0, T [, B2 ). We would proceed in a similar way for the sequence (wn )n . We extend vn by continuity to R+ by setting vn (t) = 0, ∀t ≥ T , and for all h > 0 we break down vn into 



1 t+h 1 t+h vn (t) = vn (s)ds + (vn (t) − vn (s))ds ≡ an,h (t)+bn,h (t). h t h t Let h be positive; then we show that the sequence (an,h (t))n is uniformly bounded and equicontinuous with values in a compact set of B2 (we know that an,h is continuous from Proposition II.5.11). For this, we have

Chapter II. Analysis tools

104

sup an,h (t)B0 ≤

t∈R+

1 1/p vn Lp (]0,T [, B0 ) , h h

which proves that t → an,h (t) takes its values, independently from n, in a bounded set of B0 (i.e., in a compact of B2 , because the embedding of B0 in B2 is compact). Moreover, we have dan,h 1 1 = (vn (t + h) − vn (t)) = dt h h



t+h

t

dvn (τ )dτ, dt

from which, for all t > 0,     t+h   d  dvn   an,h (t) ≤ 1   dτ, (τ )   dt  dt  h t B2 B2    dv 1 n ≤  . (τ )  1 h  dt L (]0,T [,B2 )

Hence, h being fixed, the sequence (an,h )n is equicontinuous with values in a compact set of B2 . Ascoli’s theorem (Theorem II.3.1) then shows that we can extract from the sequence (an,h )n a subsequence which is convergent in C 0 ([0, T ], B2 ) and thus in Lp (]0, T [, B2 ). Furthermore, we have bn,h (t)B2

1 ≤ h



t+h

vn (t) − vn (s)B2 ds  

  s  1 t+h dv n   ≤  dt (τ ) dτ ds. h t t B2 t

Hence, by using Jensen’s inequality (Proposition II.2.20) and Fubini’s theorem we obtain

p   T  T  t+h  s   dvn  1 p   bn,h (t)B2 dt ≤ ds dt  dt (τ ) dτ 0 0 h t t B2     T  t+h  s   dvn   dvn p−1 1    dτ ds dt ≤ (τ )  dt  dt  1  t L (]0,T [,B2 ) 0 h t B2     T  t+h   dvn p−1   1  dvn (τ ) (t + h − τ ) dτ dt  ≤  dt  1  dt  h t L (]0,T [,B2 ) 0 B2  p  dvn   , ≤ h  dt  1 L (]0,T [,B2 ) and hence bn,h Lp (]0,T [,B2 ) ≤ CT h1/p . • Step 3:

(II.25)

5. Spaces of Banach-valued functions

105

We now use a diagonal process to construct a convergent subsequence of (vn )n . For this, for k ≥ 1, we set hk = 1/k. For k = 1 we have seen that we can extract a convergent subsequence (aϕ1 (n),h1 )n from (an,h1 )n . For k = 2 we can again extract a subsequence of the sequence (aϕ1 (n),h2 )n , denoted (aϕ1 ◦ϕ2 (n),h2 )n , which converges. We hence proceed with successive extractions of subsequences such that for all k ≥ 1, the sequence (aϕ1 ◦···◦ϕk (n),hk )n converges. We now define ψ(k) = ϕ1 ◦ ϕ2 ◦ · · · ◦ ϕk (k). Let us verify that the sequence (vψ(k) )k is indeed a Cauchy sequence. Let ε > 0; according to (II.25) there exists k0 ≥ 1 such that for all n and for all k ≥ k0 , we have bn,hk Lp (]0,T [,B2 ) ≤ ε. Let us now write vψ(k) = aψ(k),hk0 + bψ(k),hk0 . From the diagonal extraction process employed, the sequence (aψ(k),hk0 )k≥k0 is a sequence extracted from the sequence (aϕ1 ◦···◦ϕk0 (n),hk0 )n which, by definition, is a convergent sequence and thus it satisfies the Cauchy criterion. Hence, there exists k1 ≥ k0 such that for all k, k  ≥ k1 , we have aψ(k),hk0 − aψ(k ),hk0 Lp (]0,T [,B2 ) ≤ ε. Thus, finally, we have for all k, k  ≥ k1 , vψ(k) − vψ(k ) Lp (]0,T [,B2 ) ≤ aψ(k),hk0 − aψ(k ),hk0 Lp (]0,T [,B2 ) + bψ(k),hk0 Lp (]0,T [,B2 ) + bψ(k ),hk0 Lp (]0,T [,B2 ) ≤ 3ε. This, indeed, proves that the sequence (vψ(k) )k is a Cauchy sequence in Lp (]0, T [, B2 ).  In certain cases, the preceding theorem does not apply and we need to use sharper results. Let E be a Banach space. For f ∈ L1 (]0, T [, E) we denote the translated function of f defined by (II.20) as τh f . For 1 ≤ q < +∞ and 0 < σ < 1, we define the Nikolskii spaces Nqσ (]0, T [, E) by: % & τh f − f Lq (]0,T −h[,E) q E) = f ∈ L (]0, T [, E), sup < +∞ , hσ 0 0. Any u ∈ H is the limit of a sequence (un )n of elements of D(A). This sequence being a Cauchy sequence, from the inequality above, (Aun )n is also a Cauchy sequence in H and therefore is convergent. Hence (un , Aun )n is a sequence of elements in the graph of A which converges, and, therefore, this graph being assumed to be closed, we obtain that u ∈ D(A). We have therefore shown that H = D(A), which is not the case. We now define the fundamental concept of self-adjoint operator, which again generalises the usual concept in finite-dimensional spaces. Definition II.6.1. Let A : D(A) ⊂ H → H, be an unbounded operator with a dense domain. We then introduce D(A∗ ) = {u ∈ H, v ∈ D(A) → (Av, u)H is continuous for the norm of H} . For u ∈ D(A∗ ), the mapping v → (Av, u)H can therefore be extended by a continuous linear functional on H which may be represented by an element denoted as A∗ u ∈ H: (Av, u)H = (v, A∗ u)H , ∀u ∈ D(A∗ ), ∀v ∈ D(A). The operator A∗ , whose domain is D(A∗ ), is called the adjoint operator of A. This definition is consistent because the density of D(A) into H ensures the uniqueness of the extension which is used in the definition. We can now define a fundamental class of operators. Definition II.6.2. An unbounded operator A is said to be self-adjoint if it satisfies D(A∗ ) = D(A) and Au = A∗ u, ∀u ∈ D(A). Proposition II.6.3. Let A be an unbounded self-adjoint operator. We assume that A is a bijection from D(A) onto H and that A−1 is continuous from H into H. Then, the (bounded) operator A−1 is self-adjoint. Proof. The domain of A−1 is H. We therefore first need to show that D((A−1 )∗ ) is also equal to H. Let u ∈ H; then, since A−1 is continuous, it is clear that v → (A−1 v, u)H is continuous on all of H and therefore by definition u ∈ D((A−1 )∗ ). Let u, v ∈ H, then A−1 u and A−1 v are in D(A), and since A is self-adjoint we have     A(A−1 u), A−1 v H = A−1 u, A(A−1 v) H ; in other words

(u, A−1 v)H = (A−1 u, v)H ,

Chapter II. Analysis tools

112

which shows that A−1 is indeed self-adjoint.  In general, unbounded operators are not continuous from D(A) equipped with the norm of H into H. This means that the norm of H is not the correct norm for us to set on D(A). The following proposition, whose proof is straightforward, is the consequence of the fact that the graph of A is closed. Proposition II.6.4. Let A be a closed unbounded operator in a Hilbert space H of domain D(A). We provide D(A) with the following scalar product, (u, v)D(A) = (u, v)H + (Au, Av)H , ∀u, v ∈ D(A),

(II.29)

and the associated norm. Then, D(A) is a Hilbert space, the embedding from D(A) into H is continuous and A is continuous from D(A) into H. Remark II.6.2. It is clear that the norm introduced above is equivalent to the norm known as the “graph norm” defined by ugraph = uH + AuH , ∀u ∈ D(A).

6.2 Elementary results of spectral theory The fundamental application of the concepts above, to the subject of interest to us, resides in the following result. Theorem II.6.5 (Compact self-adjoint operators). Let H be a separable (infinite-dimensional) Hilbert space and let T be a (bounded, i.e., defined and continuous on all H) compact self-adjoint operator from H to H. Then H has an orthonormal basis formed from eigenvectors of T . Moreover, the set of its eigenvalues (which are real numbers) can be ordered in a sequence tending towards 0. We do not give the proof here and we refer for instance to [27]. When A is an unbounded operator which is a bijection from D(A) onto H, then the open mapping theorem tells us that A is an isomorphism of D(A) (equipped with the graph norm) onto H. In this case A−1 is a continuous operator from H to D(A). The embedding from D(A) into H being continuous, we can also consider A−1 as a continuous operator from H into H. If, moreover, the embedding from D(A) into H is compact, which is often the case in the applications, then A−1 , seen as an operator from H to H, is compact (see Lemma II.3.5). We can therefore apply the preceding theorem and obtain the following result. Theorem II.6.6 (Operators with compact inverse). Let H be a separable, infinite-dimensional Hilbert space. Let A : D(A) ⊂ H → H be an unbounded

6. Some results in spectral analysis of unbounded operators

113

operator. We assume that A is self-adjoint, bijective from D(A) onto H and that the canonical embedding from D(A) into H is compact. Then there exists an orthonormal basis (wk )k≥1 of H formed by eigenvectors of A, that is, such that for all k ≥ 1, wk ∈ D(A), and Awk = λk wk , where the eigenvalues (λk )k≥1 of A are real numbers that we can order in such a way that (|λk |)k is increasing and tends towards +∞ when k tends towards infinity. Finally, the eigenvectors (wk )k≥1 form a complete orthogonal family of D(A). Proof. As we have remarked above, under the hypotheses of the theorem, the operator A−1 can be viewed as a bounded, compact self-adjoint operator. From Theorem II.6.5, there exists an orthonormal basis (wk )k≥1 of H formed from eigenvectors of A−1 for the eigenvalues μk with, moreover, μk → 0. Let us now note that, since A−1 is injective (Beware! It is not surjective on H), 0 cannot be an eigenvalue of A−1 . Hence, for all k ≥ 0, μk = 0. Moreover, since A−1 wk = μk wk , we can clearly see that wk belongs to the image of A−1 , that is to in D(A). If we now set λk = 1/μk , we immediately obtain wk ∈ D(A) and Awk = λk wk . The fact that |λk | → +∞ is a clear consequence of the fact that μk → 0. This demonstrates the first part of the theorem. For k, l ≥ 0, we have (wk , wl )D(A) = (wk , wl )H + (Awk , Awl )H = (1 + λk λl )(wk , wl )H , which shows, (wk )k≥1 being a Hilbertian ( basis of H, that when k = l, (wk , wl )D(A) = 0 and that wk D(A) = 1 + λ2k . The family (wk )k is therefore an orthogonal family of D(A). To establish that this is also a complete family, it is necessary to show that the only vector of D(A) orthogonal to all the wk is the null vector. Therefore, let u ∈ D(A) such that (u, wk )D(A) = 0 for all k. By using the self-adjoint characteristic of A, this gives 0 = (u, wk )D(A) = (u, wk )H + (Au, Awk )H = (u, wk )H + λk (Au, wk )H = (u, wk )H + λk (u, Awk )H = (1 + λ2k )(u, wk )H ,

Chapter II. Analysis tools

114

which demonstrates that (u, wk )H = 0 for all k. Since (wk )k is an orthonormal basis of H, we have indeed shown that u = 0.  We know that all u ∈ H can be expressed uniquely in the form  uk wk , u= k≥1

with the convergence being taken in the sense of H and moreover, uk = (u, wk )H . Using this expression we can recognise which of the elements of H are in D(A). Proposition II.6.7. Let us take an operator A which satisfies the hypotheses of the preceding theorem. We then have & %  λ2k (u, wk )2H < +∞ . D(A) = u ∈ H, such that k≥1

Proof. • Let u ∈ D(A); (wk )k is a complete orthogonal family of D(A), thus we can see that   wk wk D(A) k is an orthonormal basis of D(A). Hence, we know that  (u, wk )2D(A) k≥1

wk 2D(A)

< +∞.

However, for all k, we have (u, wk )D(A) = (u, wk )H + (Au, Awk )H = (u, wk )H + (u, A2 wk )H = (1 + λ2k )(u, wk )H , and in particular wk 2D(A) = (1 + λ2k )wk 2H = (1 + λ2k ). Hence, we have obtained 

(1 + λ2k )(u, wk )2H < +∞,

k≥1

which proves the desired assertion. • Now, let u ∈ H, we assume that

6. Some results in spectral analysis of unbounded operators



115

λ2k (u, wk )2H < +∞.

k≥1

The hypothesis implies that  2 (u, wk )H wk D(A) < +∞, k≥1

  and since the vectors (u, wk )H wk k are pairwise orthogonal in D(A), this shows that the series  (u, wk )H wk k≥1

converges towards a certain u ˜ ∈ D(A), in the sense of the norm of D(A). However, since the embedding from D(A) to H is continuous, the convergence also takes place in H and hence we obtain (˜ u, wk )H = (u, wk )H , which proves that u − u ˜ is orthogonal to all wk . Inasmuch as (wk )k is complete in H, this shows that u = u ˜ and therefore that u ∈ D(A). We have shown in passing that for u ∈ D(A), we have   (u, wk )2H and u2D(A) = (1 + λ2k )(u, wk )2H , u2H = k≥1



k≥1

and moreover, since the absolute values of the eigenvalues (|λk |)k are bounded below by a positive real number, the norm in D(A) is equivalent to the norm defined by ⎞1/2 ⎛  λ2k (u, wk )2H ⎠ . u ∈ D(A) → ⎝ k≥1

We now wish to define the powers of the operator A. We could, for example, define the operator A2 in the following natural way D(A2 ) = {u ∈ D(A), such that Au ∈ D(A)}, and A2 u = A(Au), ∀u ∈ D(A2 ). However, we choose another definition which allows us to define the fractional powers of an operator. To this end, we have to assume that the operator is nonnegative (i.e., such that (Au, u)H ≥ 0 for all u ∈ D(A)). This is equivalent to assuming that the eigenvalues of A are nonnegative. From now on, we make this assumption and for all nonnegative real numbers s, we introduce

Chapter II. Analysis tools

116

⎧ ⎫ ⎨ ⎬  2 D(As ) = u ∈ H, such that λ2s , k (u, wk )H < +∞ ⎩ ⎭ k≥1

and for all u ∈ D(As ), we set As u =



λsk (u, wk )H wk ∈ H.

k≥1

Finally, we equip D(As ) with the natural scalar product defined by  (1 + λ2s (u, v)D(As ) = k )(u, wk )H (v, wk )H . k≥1

We can easily verify the following properties. Proposition II.6.8. 1. The operator A1 is simply the operator A. Moreover, D(A0 ) = H and A0 is the identity operator. The norms on D(A1 ) and D(A0 ) are equivalent to the usual norms on these spaces. 2. For all s > 0, D(As ) is a Hilbert space and As is a nonnegative self-adjoint operator which is an isomorphism from D(As ) onto H. Moreover, (wk )k is a complete family in D(As ).  3. For all 0 ≤ s < s , we have D(As ) ⊂ D(As ), the inclusion being strict and the embedding being compact. Proof.  The first two points are trivial, as is the strict inclusion D(As ) ⊂ D(As ).  We only prove the compactness of the embedding of D(As ) in D(As ).  Let (uk )k be a bounded sequence in D(As ), then there exists a C > 0 such that   k 2 λ2s n |un | ≤ C, ∀k ∈ N, n

where we have denoted the coordinates of uk in the basis (wn )n as ukn = (uk , wn )H . We show that for all ε > 0, we can cover the sequence (uk )k by a finite number of spheres with radius ε in D(As ). For any ε > 0, the sequence (λn )n tends towards +∞, thus there exists a n0 ≥ 0 such that  λn ≥

2C ε2

1/(2(s −s)) , ∀n ≥ n0 .

Hence, for all k, we have  n≥n0

k 2 λ2s n |un | =

 n≥n0





) 2s λ2(s−s λn |ukn |2 ≤ n

ε2 ε2  2s k 2 λn |un | ≤ . 2C 2 n≥n0

Since n0 is fixed, we see that for all n < n0 , we have

(II.30)

6. Some results in spectral analysis of unbounded operators

|ukn |2 ≤

117

C ∀k.  , λ2s n

Thus, the sequences of real numbers (ukn )k for 0 ≤ n ≤ n0 − 1 are bounded. The closed spheres of Rn0 are compact sets, thus there exists a finite family of elements of Rn0 , denoted (v i )i∈I , with v i = (vni )0≤n≤n0 −1 such that ∀k ∈ N, ∃i ∈ I, such that |ukn − vni |2 ≤

2

ε2 n0 −1 n=0

λ2s n

, ∀n ≤ n0 − 1.

(II.31)

For all i ∈ I, we consider the element v˜i of D(As ) defined by v˜i =

n 0 −1

vni wn .

n=0

Let us now show that the sequence considered, (uk )k , is covered by the spheres of D(As ) with centres at v˜i and having radius ε. Indeed, if k ∈ N is fixed, we consider the index i ∈ I given by (II.31), such that we have uk − v˜i 2D(As ) =



k i 2 λ2s n |un − vn | +

n≤n0 −1

 n≥n0

k 2s λ2s ≤ n |un |

ε2 ε2 + = ε2 , 2 2

the first term being bounded above by (II.31) and the second by (II.30).  We now wish to define similar concepts for s < 0. Unfortunately, in this case the preceding definitions do not apply (because the spaces D(As ) would all be equal to H and none would be complete). The spaces D(As ) with s < 0 must be larger than H. Hence, for all u ∈ H, we define  2 u2D(As ) = λ2s k (u, wk )H . k≥1

This is a norm on H and if we define D(As ) as the completion of H for this norm, then the operator As is naturally defined. Indeed, D(As ) is a Hilbert space for the scalar product obtained by completion, and the preceding properties of positive real powers of A adapt without a problem. We then accept the following result. Proposition II.6.9. For all s ≥ 0, if we identify H with its dual, we have D(As ) ≈ D(A−s ), and the duality can be written using the scalar product of H in the following way,

Chapter II. Analysis tools

118

u, vD(A−s ),D(As ) =



(u, wk )H (v, wk )H , ∀u ∈ H, ∀v ∈ D(As ).

k≥1

6.3 Applications to the semigroup theory Let (A, D(A)) be an unbounded operator in H which is self-adjoint, bijective from D(A) onto H, nonnegative, and such that the canonical embedding of D(A) into H is compact. Our goal is to show, with the elements given above, how to solve the infinite-dimensional linear differential equation ⎧ ⎨ du + Au = 0, dt (II.32) ⎩ u(0) = u0 . Let (wk )k≥1 be the spectral basis associated with A and (λk )k≥1 the (positive) eigenvalues of A. We assume that the sequence (λk )k≥1 is sorted in a nondecreasing way. Definition and Proposition II.6.10. Let u0 ∈ H so that we write u0 =  k≥1 u0,k wk . For any t ≥ 0 we can define e−tA u0 =



u0,k e−tλk wk ∈ H.

k≥1

Moreover, for any s ≥ 0 and t > 0, we have e−tA u0 ∈ D(As ). Remark II.6.3. We obviously have the property e−(t+s)A = e−tA e−sA = e−sA e−tA , ∀s, t ≥ 0. That’s the reason why the family of continuous operator in H defined by (e−tA )t≥0 is called the semigroup associated with −A. Proof. Since λk ≥ 0 and t ≥ 0, it is clear that this sum is well-defined in H. Moreover, for a fixed t > 0 and any s > 0, we have λsk e−tλk = (tλk )s e−tλk t−s ≤ Cs t−s , where Cs = sup[0,+∞[ y s e−y < +∞. It follows that   2 λsk u0,k e−tλk ≤ Cs2 t−2s |u0,k |2 < +∞, k≥1

k≥1

6. Some results in spectral analysis of unbounded operators

119

and thus that e−tA u0 ∈ D(As ) for any t > 0 and any s ≥ 0.



Theorem II.6.11. For any u0 ∈ H, there exists a unique u ∈ C 0 ([0, +∞[, H)∩ C 1 (]0, +∞[, D(A)) which solves (II.32). It is defined by the formula u(t) = e−tA u0 , ∀t ≥ 0.

(II.33)

Proof. • Let us first show the uniqueness property. The problem is linear, therefore it is enough to show that any solution u for the initial data u0 = 0 is necessarily equal to 0. Let 0 < ε < T be given. We apply Theorem II.5.12 (and Corollary II.3.8) to obtain   T du 2 2 u(T )H − u(ε)H = 2 (t), u(t) dt dt ε H  T = −2 (Au(t), u(t))H dt ≤ 0, ε

inasmuch as A is a nonnegative operator. It follows that u(T )H ≤ u(ε)H , but since u is continuous with values in H and satifies u(0) = 0, we can let ε go to 0 in the inequality above and obtain that u(T )H = 0, which gives u(T ) = 0. This being true for any T > 0, the claim is proved. • We easily check that the function t ∈ [0, +∞[→ u(t) defined by (II.33) satisfies the claimed regularity property (notice that u is not necessarily differentiable at t = 0 with values in H) and u(0) = u0 . For any t > 0, we can differentiate the series to obtain  du (t) = (−λk )u0,k e−tλk wk dt k≥1

=−

 k≥1

⎛ u0,k e−tλk Awk = −A ⎝



⎞ u0,k e−tλk wk ⎠ = −Au(t),

k≥1

the last equality being true because the series converges in D(A) and A is continuous from D(A) in H.  When we add a source term f to the problem (II.32), the semigroup associated with −A still allows us to solve the problem. More precisely, one can prove, for instance, the following result (see [48] or [95]) which is an

Chapter II. Analysis tools

120

infinite-dimensional version of a very standard result for ordinary differential equations. Theorem II.6.12. Let u0 ∈ H and f ∈ C 1 ([0, +∞[, H). There exists a unique solution u ∈ C 0 ([0, +∞[, H) ∩ C 1 (]0, +∞[, H) ∩ C 0 (]0, +∞[, D(A)) to ⎧ ⎨ du + Au = f, dt (II.34) ⎩ u(0) = u0 . This solution is given by the Duhamel formula  t −tA u0 + e−(t−s)A f (s) ds, ∀t ≥ 0. u(t) = e

(II.35)

0

Proof. Using the change of variable s → t − s in the integral in (II.35) we get −tA

u(t) = e

 u0 +

t

e−sA f (t − s) ds.

0

Inasmuch as f is assumed to be of class C 1 with values in H, we can justify the derivation in all the terms and then conclude by integration by parts.  Remark II.6.4. The above result, in particular Formula (II.35), still holds for less regular source terms but this needs to weaken the notion of solution we consider.

Chapter III

Sobolev spaces

The first section of this chapter is dedicated to the basic definitions and properties of domains in Rd . We particularly focus our attention on the case of Lipschitz domains for which we can easily define an integration theory on ∂Ω, the outward unit normal on ∂Ω, and finally prove the Stokes formula which is the keystone of the study of partial differential equations on domains. In the second section we define and study Sobolev spaces on such domains. We are first interested in proving the density of smooth functions in those spaces and in studying the associated trace theory. We then introduce useful tools in the analysis of PDEs such as Sobolev embedding theorems or Poincar´e and Hardy inequalities. Section 3 concerns the study of suitable parametrisations of neighborhoods of the boundary of sufficiently smooth domains. The idea is to be able to separate tangential and normal coordinates near the boundary in a somewhat intrinsic way. To achieve this objective, we need to carefully study the properties and the regularity of the distance to the boundary function δ = d(., ∂Ω). In fact, it is also necessary to define and study a suitable regularised distance function. We are then able to build a normal/tangential coordinate system near the boundary and to write the expressions of usual differential operators in those variables. These elements are widely used in the proof of the elliptic regularity properties of Stokes problems in Chapter IV. This section can certainly be skipped for a first reading because the material it contains is not strictly necessary for understanding many results in this book. The last section of the chapter is dedicated to the study of the very classical Laplace problem with Dirichlet or Neumann boundary conditions. Existence, uniqueness, and regularity are proved in each case. These results are used at various places in the sequel of the book. Moreover, it is also an opportunity for us to illustrate the concepts introduced in Section 3 for a quite simple problem before applying similar ideas to the Stokes and Navier–Stokes equations. Following the general philosophy of this book, we decided to provide complete proofs for almost all results given in this chapter. As a consequence, this chapter should be self-contained and useful for any reader interested in F. Boyer and P. Fabrie, Mathematical Tools for the Study of the Incompressible Navier-Stokes Equations and Related Models, Applied Mathematical Sciences 183, DOI 10.1007/978-1-4614-5975-0_3, © Springer Science+Business Media New York 2013

121

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

122

the study of partial differential equations in bounded domains, not only in the framework of fluid mechanics.

1 Domains For any open set Ω, we recall that δ(x), defined in (II.1) denotes the signed distance from any point x ∈ Rd to the boundary ∂Ω. For any ξ ≥ 0 we use the following notation,

ξ

Ωξ Oξ = {x ∈ Ω, δ(x) < ξ}, ξ



Ωξ = {x ∈ Ω, δ(x) > ξ}.

∂Ω

1.1 General definitions In this section k designates a nonnegative integer and α designates a real number in [0, 1]. Moreover we assume that k + α ≥ 1, which implies that functions of class C k,α are at least locally Lipschitz continuous. We say that an open set Ω ⊂ Rd is a domain of class C k,α if its boundary ∂Ω is locally the graph of a function of class C k,α such that Ω is situated on one single side of this graph. Let us emphasise the fact that this last condition is crucial (particularly in allowing us to define the concept of an outward normal to the domain and hence an orientation on ∂Ω as we show below). Let us now give more precise definitions. Definition III.1.1 (C k,α half-spaces). For any map a : Rd−1 → R, of class C k,α and compactly supported we define the following open set Ha = {(¯ x, xd ) ∈ Rd , xd > a(¯ x)}, which is called a C k,α half-space in Rd . The set Rd+ = Rd−1 × R+ ∗ = H0 is called the flat half-space.

1. Domains

123

Definition III.1.2. An open set Ω of Rd is said to be a domain of class C k,α if for any point σ ∈ ∂Ω, there exists an open neighborhood Uσ of σ in Rd , a rotation Rσ ∈ Od+ (R), and a C k,α half-space Haσ such that Ω ∩ Uσ = (Rσ Haσ ) ∩ Uσ , ∂Ω ∩ Uσ = (Rσ ∂Haσ ) ∩ Uσ ,   Ωc ∩ Uσ = Rσ Hac σ ∩ Uσ .

∂Rσ Haσ

Ω

σ

Uσ Rσ

Fig. III.1 A C k,α domain is locally a C k,α half-space

In the case where k = 0 and α = 1, we simply say that the domain Ω is Lipschitz. In the case α = 0 we simply say that the domain Ω is of class C k .

1.2 Lipschitz domains The more general class of domains that we consider here is the one of Lipschitz domains. We refer for instance to the monographs [67, 89] for specific information about more complex domains. We also want to mention, without proof, that the class of Lipschitz domains contains, for example, all the convex open sets.

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

124

1.2.1 Lipschitz half-spaces In this section we prove that any Lipschitz half-space Ha as defined in Definition III.1.1 can be mapped onto the flat half-space Rd+ = Rd−1 ×R+ ∗ thanks to a suitable Lipschitz diffeomorphism. Therefore, many properties of functional spaces on Ha are deduced from the corresponding property on Rd+ . We suppose given a mollifying kernel η : Rd−1 → R as defined in Definition II.2.23. We introduce the following positive numbers associated with the kernel η,   Mη = |z|η(z) dz and M∇η,k = |z|k |∇η(z)| dz, ∀k ∈ {0, 1, 2}, B

B

where B is the unit ball of Rd−1 . Let now γ > 0 be given such that γ Lip(a)Mη ≤ 1/2. For any x = (x1 , . . . , xd−1 , xd ) in Rd we define    =¯ x

  aγ (¯ x, xd ) = a  ηγ|xd | (¯ x) =

 a(¯ x − γ|xd |z)η(z) dz.

(III.1)

B

Proposition III.1.3. The following properties hold. x, xd ) ∈ Rd , xd = 0} and we have aγ (¯ x, 0) = a(¯ x), for all 1. aγ is C ∞ on {(¯ d−1 x ¯∈R . 2. aγ is Lipschitz continuous on Rd and we have |∂xd aγ | ≤ γ Lip(a)Mη , |∂xi aγ | ≤ Lip(a), ∀i ∈ {1, . . . , d − 1}. 1 |∂xi ∂xj aγ | ≤ Cγ , ∀i, j ∈ {1, . . . , d}. |xd | ¯, we have 3. For any x ¯ ∈ Rd−1 such that a is differentiable at x ∂xi aγ (¯ x, xd ) −−−−→ ∂xi a(¯ x), ∀i ∈ {1, . . . , d − 1}. xd →0

4. For any x ¯ ∈ Rd−1 , the map xd ∈ R → xd + aγ (¯ x, xd ) ∈ R, is increasing and maps R onto R. 5. The map Ta : (¯ x, xd ) ∈ Rd → (¯ x, xd + aγ (¯ x, xd )) ∈ Rd , is a Lipschitz diffeomorphism from Rd onto Rd . Its Jacobian determinant JTa satisfies the estimates

1. Domains

125

1 3 Cγ ≤ JTa (x) ≤ and |∇JTa (x)| ≤ , ∀x ∈ Rd , 2 2 |xd | and the Jacobian determinant JTa−1 of Ta−1 satisfies 2 Cγ ≤ JTa−1 (y) ≤ 2 and |∇JTa−1 (y)| ≤ , ∀y ∈ Rd , 3 |(Ta−1 (y))d | Moreover, we have c

Ta (Rd+ ) = Ha , Ta (Rd− ) = Ha , Ta (∂Rd+ ) = ∂Ha . Proof. 1. This comes from Proposition II.2.47. 2. Let (¯ x, xd ) ∈ Rd and (¯ y , yd ) ∈ Rd ; we have  |aγ (¯ x, xd ) − aγ (¯ y , yd )| ≤ |a(¯ x − γ|xd |z) − a(¯ y − γ|yd |z)|η(z) dz B

≤ Lip(a)|¯ x − y¯| + Lip(a)γMη |xd − yd |, which gives the estimates for the first derivatives of aγ . We now compute Z  1 ∂xi aγ = a(¯ x − γ|xd |z)∂zi η(z) dz γ|xd | ZB    1 = a(¯ x − γ|xd |z) − a(¯ x) ∂zi η(z) dz , ∀i ∈ {1, . . . , d − 1}, γ|xd | B  because B ∂zi η(z) dz = 0. Similarly, we have   −1 d−1 ∂xd aγ = a(¯ x − γ|xd |z)z · ∇η(z) dz − aγ (¯ x, xd ) |xd | |xd | B   , −1 = a(¯ x − γ|xd |z) − a(¯ x) z · ∇η(z) dz |xd | B d−1 − (aγ (¯ x, xd ) − a(¯ x)), |xd |  because by integration by parts we have B z · ∇η(z) dz = −(d − 1). By using the Lipschitz regularity of a and aγ , it follows that Lip(a) M∇η,1 , ∀i ∈ {1, . . . , d − 1}, |xd | Lip(a) |∂xj ∂xi aγ | ≤ M∇η,0 , ∀i, j ∈ {1, . . . , d − 1}, γ|xd |

|∂xd ∂xi aγ | ≤ 2

and that

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

126

|∂x2d aγ | ≤

2γ Lip(a) 2γ|d − 1| Lip(a) M∇η,2 + Mη . |xd | |xd |

3. This point comes directly from Proposition II.2.47. 4. For any x ¯ ∈ Rd−1 and y1 > y2 given we have , - , y1 + aγ (¯ x, y1 ) − y2 + aγ (¯ x, y2 ) ≥ (y1 − y2 ) − ∂xd aγ ∞ |y1 − y2 | ≥ (1 − γ Lip(a)Mη ) |y1 − y2 |, and the clweaim is proved. 5. We easily compute JTa (x) = (1 + ∂xd aγ (x)). The properties of Ta , JTa , JTa−1 immediately follows from all the above estimates.  We later show (see Theorem III.2.13) that the map Ta allows us to build isomorphisms between the Sobolev spaces on Ha and the Sobolev spaces on the flat half-space Rd+ . At that point, by using Proposition II.2.15, we can just state that Lp (Ha ) and Lp (Rd+ ) are isomorphic.

1.2.2 The cone property and its consequences Most of the properties of Sobolev spaces that we establish below rely on the following property which is referred to as the cone property (see [1, 67, 33]). Theorem III.1.4. Any Lipschitz domain Ω ⊂ Rd with compact boundary satisfies the cone property: There exists a finite open covering (Ui )1≤i≤N of ∂Ω, and there exists θ ∈]0, π/2[ and δ0 > 0, such that .N • Oδ = {x ∈ Ω, δ(x) < δ0 } ⊂ i=1 Ui . • For each 1 ≤ i ≤ N , there is a point σi ∈ ∂Ω such that Ui ⊂ Uσi (where Uσi is introduced in Definition III.1.2). • For any 1 ≤ i ≤ N , there exists a unit vector ν˜i such that x + Ci ⊂ Ω, ∀x ∈ Ω ∩ Ui ,

(III.2)

x − Ci ⊂ Ωc , ∀x ∈ Ωc ∩ Ui , where Ci is the truncated cone Ci = {z ∈ Rd , sin(θ)|z| ≤ z · ν˜i ≤ δ0 }. Moreover, we have x − t˜ νi ∈ Ui , ∀x ∈ Ω ∩ Ui , ∀t ∈ [0, δ0 /2].

(III.3)

Proof. By using Definitions III.1.1, III.1.2, and the fact that ∂Ω is compact, we see that it is enough to assume that σ = 0, for instance and to consider

1. Domains

127

a Lipschitz half-space domain Ha such that σ = 0 ∈ ∂Ha because all the required properties are invariant by rotation.

θ θ

θ

θ

ν˜ θ θ

θ

θ

Fig. III.2 The half-space Ha

For such a Lipschitz half-space we prove the result by choosing the unit vector ν˜ = t (0, . . . , 0, 1), the angle θ = arctan(Lip(a)), and the open neighborhood of σ = 0 defined by , {¯ x} × a(¯ x) − α, a(¯ x) + α ,

U= x ¯∈Rd−1 |¯ x| 0 chosen small enough in such a way that Rσ U ⊂ Uσ . Let us introduce the infinite cone C = {z = (¯ z , zd ) ∈ Rd , sin(θ)|z| ≤ zd }. Note that we have z = (¯ z , zd ) ∈ C ⇒ |z| ≥

1 |¯ z |. cos θ

Let now x ∈ Ha and y ∈ x + C. Since y − x ∈ C, we have yd = xd + (y − x)d ≥ xd + sin(θ)|y − x| > a(¯ x) + sin(θ)|y − x|   = a(¯ y ) + a(¯ x) − a(¯ y ) + sin(θ)|y − x| ≥ a(¯ y ) − Lip(a)|¯ x − y¯| + tan(θ)|¯ x − y¯| = a(¯ y ),

(III.4)

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

128

and thus y ∈ Ha . A similar computation shows that x − C ⊂ (Ha )c for any x ∈ (Ha )c . Let us finally check the last property. By (III.4), any x ∈ Ω ∩ U can be written x = (¯ x, a(¯ x) + z) with |¯ x| < α and 0 < z < α. By construction of ν˜ we deduce that x − t˜ ν = (¯ x, a(¯ x) + z − t), so that for t ≥ 0 we have x − t˜ ν ∈ U if and only if z − t > −α. This is true for any 0 < z < α and any 0 < t < δ0 /2 if and only if we have δ0 < 2α. Therefore, (III.3) holds if we choose δ0 small enough.  We now set U0 = Ωδ0 /2 = {x ∈ Ω, δ(x) > δ0 /2} and ν0 = 0 ∈ Rd . As a consequence, we just have built a finite open covering of Ω. N

Ω⊂

Ui . i=0

Proposition III.1.5. Consider the same notation as in Theorem III.1.4; there exists M > 0, and ε0 > 0 such that if one defines νi = M ν˜i for any i ∈ {1, . . . , N }, the following properties hold for any 0 < ε < ε0 . • For any i ∈ {0, . . . , N } and any y ∈ Ui ∩ Ω we have B(y + ενi , ε) ⊂ B(y + ενi , 2ε) ⊂ Ω.

(III.5)

• For any i ∈ {1, . . . , N } and any y ∈ Ui such that d(y, ∂Ω) ≤ ε/M , we have c

B(y − ενi , ε) ⊂ Ω .

(III.6)

Notice that (III.6) is obviously false for i = 0. We also want to point out the fact that we do not require that y ∈ Ω in (III.6). Proof. Let us consider M > 2 such that sin(θ)2 = (M 2 − 4)/M 2 and define ε0 = δ0 /(M + 2). • For i = 0, since ν0 = 0 we only have to observe that for any y ∈ U0 we have B(y, 2ε) ⊂ Ω, because, by definition of U0 = Ωδ0 /2 , we have d(y, ∂Ω) > δ0 /2 ≥ 2ε0 ≥ 2ε. • Let i ∈ {1, . . . , N } and y ∈ Ui . – If we assume that y ∈ Ω, by (III.2) we have y + Ci ⊂ Ω. Therefore, we only need to show that B(ενi , 2ε) ⊂ Ci (see Figure III.3). Let z ∈ B(ενi , 2ε) = B(εM ν˜i , 2ε). We first have 0 < (M − 2)ε ≤ z · ν˜i ≤ (M + 2)ε ≤ (M + 2)ε0 ≤ δ0 .

1. Domains

129

2ε • y + ενi

•y

Fig. III.3 The ball B(y + ενi , 2ε) is included in the cone Ci

Second, we perform the following computation by using the Young inequality (Corollary II.2.17) |z|2 = |z − εM ν˜i + εM ν˜i |2 ≤ (4 − M 2 )ε2 + 2εM z · ν˜i ≤

M2 |z · ν˜i |2 , M2 − 4

which, by definition of M and the fact that z · ν˜i ≥ 0, exactly gives sin(θ)|z| ≤ (z · ν˜i ) and the claim is proved. – Let y ∈ Ui such that d(y, ∂Ω) ≤ ε/M . We claim that there exists 0 ≤ α ≤ d(y, ∂Ω)/2 such that y − ανi ∈ Ui ∩ Ωc . · If y ∈ Ωc , this is obvious by chosing α = 0. · If y ∈ Ω, since d(y, ∂Ω) ≤ ε, we deduce that M d(y, ∂Ω) M ε0 δ0 ≤ < , 2 2 2 by definition of ε0 . Hence, we can use (III.3) to assert that the point y ∗ defined by d(y, ∂Ω) y∗ = y − M ν˜i 2 belongs to Ui . Let us now prove that y ∗ ∈ Ωc . By contradiction, we assume that y ∗ ∈ Ω. By using (III.5) (with ε replaced by d(y, ∂Ω)/2 which is less than ε0 ) we find

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

130





⎜ ∗ d(y, ∂Ω) ⎟ B⎜ M ν˜i , d(y, ∂Ω)⎟ ⎝y + ⎠ ⊂ Ω, 2    =y

which implies that d(y, ∂Ω) > d(y, ∂Ω). This is obviously a contradiction. We know that y−ανi ∈ Ui ∩Ωc , therefore we can use the same argument as in the proof of (III.5) to obtain that B(y − ανi − ενi , 2ε) ⊂ Ωc , and we conclude by noting that B(y − ενi , ε) ⊂ B(y − ενi − ανi , ε + αM ) ⊂ B(y − ενi − ανi , 2ε), because αM ≤ M d(y, ∂Ω)/2 ≤ ε/2.  A first consequence of the cone property is the following result which shows that every bounded Lipschitz domain in Rd is locally star-shaped. Definition III.1.6. A set A ⊂ Rd is said to be star-shaped if there is a point x0 ∈ A such that for any x ∈ A, the segment [x0 , x] is included in A. We say that A is star-shaped with respect to x0 . Lemma III.1.7. Let Ω be a bounded Lipschitz domain of Rd . There exists a finite family (ωi )i∈I of star-shaped open sets of Rd such that Ω=

ωi . i∈I

If Ω is a nonbounded Lipschitz domain, we can cover it with a locally finite family of star-shaped open sets. Proof. It is enough to prove that for any point a ∈ Ω, there exists an open set O of Ω containing a such that O ∩ Ω is star-shaped. Indeed, since Ω is compact, it is possible to find a countable, locally finite, covering of Ω with such open sets. We also observe that the result is obvious for any point a ∈ Ω, by considering a ball centred at a and included in Ω. Let us then consider a point a ∈ ∂Ω and a 1 ≤ i ≤ N such that a ∈ Ui , where the covering (Ui )i is given by Theorem III.1.4. Let ε > 0 be given and let us define   ◦  O= x + C i ∪ {0} , x∈∂Ω∩Ui |x−a| 0, O is star-shaped with respect to the point y = a + (δ0 /2)˜ νi . Each set ◦  x + C i ∪ {0} is convex, thus it is sufficient to show that y belongs to each of these sets. ◦ Let x ∈ ∂Ω ∩ Ui such that |x − a| < ε and let us show that y ∈ x + C i , ◦

that is to say that y − x = a − x + (δ0 /2)˜ νi ∈ C i . • By construction, we have (y − x) · ν˜i = (a − x) · ν˜i +

δ0 , 2

so that

δ0 δ0 − ε ≤ (y − x) · ν˜i ≤ + ε. 2 2 Provided that ε < δ0 /2, we thus have (y − x) · ν˜i < δ0 . • Moreover, if we choose ε > 0 such that   δ0 δ0 < sin(θ) ε + − ε, 2 2 which is possible because sin(θ) < 1, we conclude that   δ0 δ0 < − ε ≤ (y − x) · ν˜i , sin(θ)|y − x| < sin(θ) ε + 2 2 and the claim is proved. 

1.2.3 Integration on the boundary of a Lipschitz domain Let Ha be a Lipschitz half-space as defined in Definition III.1.1 and ϕ a compactly supported continuous function on Rd . The integral of ϕ on ∂Ha is defined as   ϕ dσ = ϕ(¯ x, a(¯ x)) Ja (¯ x)d¯ x, (III.7) ∂Ha

where

Rd−1

1 2 2 d−1  2  ∂a x) = 31 + (¯ x) . Ja (¯ ∂xi i=1

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

132

Notice that, by Theorem II.2.46, this quantity is well-defined for almost every x ¯ and satisfies ( 1 ≤ Ja (¯ x) ≤ 1 + (d − 1) Lip(a)2 ; as a consequence, the integral (III.7) is well-defined. For almost any x ¯ we define the following unit vector ⎛ νHa (¯ x, a(¯ x)) =

1 ⎜ ⎜ ⎜ Ja (¯ x) ⎝

∂a x) ∂x1 (¯



⎟ ⎟ ⎟, ∂a x)⎠ ∂xd−1 (¯ −1 .. .

(III.8)

which is called the unit outward normal of Ha at the point (¯ x, a(¯ x)) ∈ ∂Ha . Finally, it is easy to check that the integral (III.7) and the unit outward normal (III.8) are invariant by rotation of the orthonormal reference frame in which they are computed. Let now Ω be a Lipschitz domain in Rd such that ∂Ω is bounded. We consider the finite open covering (Ui )1≤i≤N of ∂Ω introduced in Theorem III.1.4. By construction, for any i there exists a rotation Ri such that Ω ∩ Ui is equal to (Ri Hai ) ∩ Ui for a suitable Lipschitz continuous map ai . Let us then consider a partition of unity (ψi )i associated with this open covering of ∂Ω. Then, for any continuous function ϕ on Rd , we define  ϕ dσ = ∂Ω

N   i=1



  ϕ ◦ Ri ψi ◦ Ri dσ.

∂Hai

Moreover, for any 1 ≤ i ≤ N and any σ ∈ ∂Ω ∩ Ui , we can define the unit outward normal νΩ (σ) = Ri νHai (Ri−1 σ). It can be easily checked that those definitions depend neither on the covering (Ui )i , nor on the choice of the half-spaces Hai , nor on the partition of unity that we used.  Finally, the map ϕ ∈ C 0 (∂Ω) → ∂Ω ϕ dσ defines a Radon measure dσ on ∂Ω which lets us define the Lebesgue spaces Lp (∂Ω), 1 ≤ p ≤ +∞ and gives a sense to the integral ∂Ω ϕ dσ for any dσ-integrable function. Those spaces enjoy similar properties as the ones of the spaces Lp (Ω) stated in Section 2.3 of Chapter II. Notice for instance that, with this definition, we have νΩ ∈ (L∞ (∂Ω))d . When no confusion is possible, we simply denote the outward unit normal νΩ as ν.

1. Domains

133

1.2.4 Stokes formula In this section we prove the following fundamental theorem in the study of partial differential equations. Theorem III.1.8 (Stokes formula. Divergence theorem). Let Ω be a Lipschitz domain in Rd with compact boundary. For any vector field Φ ∈ (Cc1 (Rd ))d we have   (Φ · ν) dσ.

div Φ dx =

(III.9)

∂Ω

Ω

Let us first mention that using the formulas in Appendix A, we can state many equivalent forms of this formula. For instance, we shall often use that for any Φ ∈ (Cc1 (Rd ))d and ψ ∈ Cc1 (Rd ) we have    ψ div Φ dx + Φ · ∇ψ dx = ψ(Φ · ν) dσ. (III.10) Ω

∂Ω

Ω

This is obtained by simply applying (III.9) to the vector field ψΦ. Proof. We first assume that the result holds for any Lipschitz half-space Ha and then we prove it for a Lipschitz domain Ω with compact boundary. We use the fact that formula (III.9) is linear with respect to Φ. • If Φ is compactly supported in Ω, then the boundary integral in (III.9) obviously vanishes and the volume integral reads 

 div Φ dx =

div Φ dx = Rd

Ω

d   i=1

Rd

∂ Φi dx = 0, ∂xi

by integration by parts in Rd . • Let now (Ui )0≤i≤N be the open covering of Ω introduced in Section 1.2.2 and (ψi )0≤i≤N an associated partition of unity. We can check that ψ0 Φ is compactly supported in U0 ⊂ Ω so that we just have seen that it satisfies the Stokes formula. It remains to prove that (III.9) holds for any ψi Φ, for 1 ≤ i ≤ N . Since ψi is supported in Ui we have, by a change of variables    div(ψi Φ) dx = div(ψi Φ) dx = div(ψi Φ) ◦ Ri dy Ri Hai

Ω

 =

Hai



div (ψi ◦

Hai

Ri ) (Ri−1 Φ

 ◦ Ri ) dy.

We have used here that for any vector field v we have div(v) ◦ R = div(R−1 .v ◦ R). We assumed that the Stokes formula holds for Lipschitz half-spaces, and using that Ri−1 is an isometry of Rd , we therefore deduce that

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

134



 div(ψi Φ) dx = ∂Hai

Ω

  ψi ◦ Ri Ri−1 Φ ◦ Ri · νHai dσ



ψi ◦ Ri

= ∂Hai

 =

, −1   Ri Φ ◦ Ri · Ri−1 νΩ ◦ Ri dσ

,  ψi ◦ Ri Φ ◦ Ri · νΩ ◦ Ri dσ =



∂Hai

ψi Φ · νΩ dσ, ∂Ω

and the claim is proved. • It remains to show the formula in the case of Lipschitz half-spaces. We first prove the result for a smooth half-space Ha with a ∈ C ∞ . In this case, by the Fubini theorem, we have

   +∞  d−1 ∂ ∂ div Φ dx = Φi + Φd dxd d¯ x ∂xi ∂xd x) Ha Rd−1 a(¯ i=1 

 d−1 +∞  ∂ x = Φi dxd d¯ a(¯ x) Rd−1 i=1 ∂xi   d−1  ∂a + (¯ x)Φi (¯ x, a(¯ x)) d¯ x− Φd (¯ x, a(¯ x)) d¯ x. Rd−1 i=1 ∂xi Rd−1 Since Φ is compactly supported, an integration by parts shows that the first integral in the right-hand side vanishes. Using (III.8) and (III.7), it remains    div Φ dx = Φ(¯ x, a(¯ x)) · νHa (¯ x, a(¯ x))Ja (¯ x) d¯ x= Φ · νHa dσ, Ha

Rd−1

∂Ha

and the claim is proved. • We finally deal with the general case of a Lipschitz half-space domain Ha . We consider the map aγ defined in (III.1) and studied in Proposition III.1.3. For any ε > 0, we define the smooth half-space Haε γ = {x = (¯ x, xd ) ∈ Rd , xd > aγ (¯ x, ε)}, which is an approximation of Ha . We apply the Stokes formula in Haε γ 

 div Φ dx =

Hεaγ

∂Hεaγ

Φ · νHεaγ dσ.

When ε goes to 0, we have aγ (¯ x, ε) → a(¯ x) for any x ¯. Thus the characteristic function of Haε γ converges almost everywhere to the characteristic function of Ha . By using the dominated convergence  theorem, we deduce that the integral in the left-hand side converges to Ha div Φ dx. It remains

2. Sobolev spaces on Lipschitz domains

135

ε ∂Ha γ

∂Ha ε Fig. III.4 Lipschitz half-space Ha and its smooth approximation Ha γ

to pass to the limit in the right-hand side, that is, in the formula Z  Φ(¯ x, aγ (¯ x, ε)) · t ∂x1 aγ (¯ x, ε), . . . , ∂xd−1 aγ (¯ x, ε), −1 d¯ x. Rd−1

This can also be justified by the Lebesgue dominated convergence theorem, as follows. – Since Φ is continuous and compactly supported, and Lip(aγ ) ≤ Lip(a), we can easily dominate the function which is integrated uniformly with respect to ε by some integrable function. – From Proposition III.1.3, we know that, for any x ¯ we have aγ (¯ x, ε) → a(¯ x) when ε → 0 and that, for almost every x ¯ (using Theorem II.2.46), we have ∂xi aγ (¯ x, ε) → ∂xi a(¯ x). We finally find that Z Z  div Φ dx = Φ(¯ x, a(¯ x)) · t ∂x1 a(¯ x), ..., ∂xd−1 a(¯ x), −1 d¯ x Ha Rd−1 Z Z = Φ(¯ x, a(¯ x)) · νHa (¯ x, a(¯ x))Ja (¯ x) d¯ x= Φ · νHa dσ, Rd−1

∂Ha

and the theorem is proved. t u

2 Sobolev spaces on Lipschitz domains We now give the main definitions and results related to Sobolev spaces (see, e.g., [1, 27, 92, 117, 33]).

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

136

2.1 Definitions Definition III.2.1. Let Ω be an open set of Rd , let m be a nonnegative integer, and let 1 ≤ p ≤ +∞. We define the Sobolev spaces by W m,p (Ω) = {f ∈ Lp (Ω), ∂ α f ∈ Lp (Ω), ∀|α| ≤ m} , where ∂ α f are the derivatives of f in the sense of distributions as described in Section 2.5 of Chapter II. The Sobolev space W m,p (Ω) is a Banach space for the natural norm ⎧ ⎞1/p ⎛ ⎪ ⎪  ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ f W m,p = ⎝ ∂ α f pLp ⎠ , for p < +∞, |α|≤m ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ α ⎪ ⎩ f W m,∞ = sup ∂ f L∞ ,

for p = +∞,

|α|≤m

or for any other equivalent norm constructed from the norms in Lp (Ω) of the weak derivatives of f . For p = 2, the space W m,2 (Ω) is denoted as H m (Ω) and its norm is a Hilbertian norm. For all p ∈ [1, +∞[, we denote as W0m,p (Ω) (or H0m (Ω)), the closure of D(Ω) in W m,p (Ω) (or in H m (Ω), resp.). Of course, we have for all p < +∞, W 0,p (Ω) = W00,p (Ω) = Lp (Ω). Remark III.2.1. In the whole space Ω = Rd , we can define the spaces H s (Rd ) (for all s ≥ 0, not being necessarily an integer) using the Fourier transform (f → fˆ) by 4 5 H s (Rd ) = f ∈ S  (Rd ), ξ → (1 + |ξ|2 )s/2 fˆ(ξ) ∈ L2 (Rd ) , (III.11) where S  (Rd ) denotes the set of tempered distributions on Rd . We may also define and characterise local Sobolev spaces as follows. Definition III.2.2. Let Ω be an open set of Rd , f be a measurable function on m,p Ω, m be a nonnegative integer, and 1 ≤ p ≤ +∞. We say that f ∈ Wloc (Ω) if for any bounded open set ω such that ω ⊂ Ω, we have f|ω ∈ W m,p (ω). Proposition III.2.3. With the same notation as in the previous definition, we have m,p f ∈ Wloc (Ω) ⇐⇒ ϕf ∈ W m,p (Rd ), ∀ϕ ∈ D(Ω). As usual the notation ϕf is used for the extension by 0 of f ϕ outside Ω. The proof of this result is straightforward by using Lemma II.2.37.

2. Sobolev spaces on Lipschitz domains

137

To begin with, we start to investigate the relationship between the functions in W 1,∞ (Ω) and the Lipschitz-continuous functions. Proposition III.2.4. Let Ω ⊂ Rd be any open set and f : Ω → R be a bounded Lipschitz continuous function. We denote by ∇f the gradient of f , which is defined almost everywhere thanks to the Rademacher theorem (Theorem II.2.46). Then, we have f ∈ W 1,∞ (Ω) and its gradient in the sense of distributions is ∇f . Moreover, if there is a continuous function G : Ω → Rd such that G = ∇f almost everywhere, then f is of class C 1 in Ω and G is the gradient of f in the classic sense. Proof. We consider a Lipschitz continuous extension F : Rd → R of f given by Proposition II.2.45. Let ϕ ∈ (D(Ω))d be a test function. We have   F  ηε (div Φ) dx = − ∇(F  ηε ) · Φ dx, Ω

Ω

where the convolution is defined in (II.5). By using Proposition II.2.47, and the dominated convergence theorem, we can pass to the limit in this formula to obtain   F (div Φ) dx = − (∇F ) · Φ dx. Ω

Ω

Since F = f on Ω and Φ is supported in Ω, we have   f (div Φ) dx = − (∇f ) · Φ dx, Ω

Ω

which proves that ∇f is the gradient of f in the distribution sense. Hence, we have ∇f ∈ (L∞ (Ω))d and thus f ∈ W 1,∞ (Ω). For any ε > 0 we have ∇(F  ηε ) = (∇F )  ηε . Since G is continuous and ∇F = G almost everywhere in Ω, we easily see that ∇(F  ηε ) = G  ηε converges locally uniformly towards G in Ω. This implies that f , which is the uniform limit of F ηε , is differentiable everywhere on Ω and that its gradient is G, so that f ∈ C 1 (Ω).  The converse result (namely that W 1,∞ (Ω) ⊂ Lip(Ω)) is not true in general. For instance if we consider Ω = Rd+ ∪ Rd− and f = sgn(xd ), we can check that f ∈ W 1,∞ (Ω) but f is not Lipschitz continuous on Ω. This comes from the fact that Ω lies on both sides of its boundary. However, we show below, in Proposition III.2.9, that this converse inclusion is true provided that Ω is a Lipschitz domain with a compact boundary, for instance.

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

138

2.2 Mollifying operators and Friedrichs commutator estimates From now on, we are given a Lipschitz domain Ω in Rd with compact boundary. We introduce suitable mollifying operators that enable a complete study of functional spaces on Lipschitz domains in a general framework. This idea comes back to the works of Friedrichs (see, for instance, [61]). Note that using these operators is also crucial in other places in this book (see, in particular, Theorem IV.4.7 and Section 1 of Chapter VI). The presentation we give here is particularly inspired by [17]. We first need to introduce a truncation function. More precisely, let β : R → R be a nonnegative decreasing C ∞ function such that β = 1 on R− and β = 0 on ]1, +∞[. For any 0 < ε < 1, we define βε : Rd → R as follows, βε (x) = β(|x| + ln ε), so that the following properties hold, βε = 1, on B(0, | ln ε|), Supp (βε ) ⊂ B(0, 1 + | ln ε|),

(III.12)

βε Lp (Rd ) ≤ Cp,d (1 + | ln ε|)d/p , ∀p ∈ [1, +∞[,

(III.13)

∂ α βε L∞ (Rd ) ≤ ∂ α βL∞ (Rd ) , ∀ε > 0, ∀α ∈ Nd . Finally, by the dominated convergence theorem we see that βε f − f Lp (Ω) −−−→ 0, ∀f ∈ Lp (Ω), ε→0

(III.14)

and (∂ α βε )f Lp (Ω) −−−→ 0, ∀f ∈ Lp (Ω), ∀α ∈ Nd , |α| ≥ 1. ε→0

(III.15)

Let U = (Ui )0≤i≤N be the open covering of Ω that we constructed in Section 1.2.2. We consider an associated partition of unity denoted by (ψi )0≤i≤N (see Lemma II.2.38). Lemma III.2.5. For any y ∈ Ω, we have N 

 ψi (y)

N  i=0

ηε (y − x + ενi ) dx = 1,

(III.16)

ηε (y − x − ενi ) dx = 1,

(III.17)

Ω

i=0

 ψi (y)

Rd

Proof. Let y ∈ Ω and i ∈ {0, . . . , N }. If ψi (y) > 0, then y ∈ Ui and by (III.5), we deduce that B(y + ενi , ε) ⊂ Ω; then

2. Sobolev spaces on Lipschitz domains



139

 ηε (y − x + ενi ) dx =

Ω



ηε (y B(y+ενi ,ε)

− x + ενi ) dx =

η(z) dz = 1. Rd

N The property (III.16) follows because i=0 ψi = 1. The proof of (III.17) is even simpler because all the integrals are taken on the whole space Rd and thus, by a change of variable, are all equal to 1.  Definition III.2.6. For any distribution f ∈ D (Ω) and any ε < ε0 , we define a function Sε f by Sε f (y) =

N 

! " βε (y)ψi (y) f, ηε (y + ενi − ·)

i=0

D  ,D

, ∀y ∈ Ω.

(III.18)

Remark III.2.2. This definition makes sense inasmuch as for any y ∈ Ω such that ψi (y) = 0 we have y ∈ Ui so that by (III.5) we have B(y + ενi , ε) ⊂ Ωε/2 which implies that x ∈ Rd → ηε (y − x + ενi ), is compactly supported in Ωε/2 . Notice that this argument shows in fact that Sε f is well-defined on an open neighborhood of Ω. Definition III.2.7. For any function f ∈ L1 (Ω) + L∞ (Ω), and any ε < ε0 , we define the following function Sε f (y) =

N 

 f (x)ηε (y − x − ενi ) dx, ∀y ∈ Rd .

βε (y)ψi (y) Ω

i=0

Remark III.2.3. The difference between the definition of Sε and Sε is the sign in front of the normal νi in the term ηε (y − x − ενi ). As a consequence, when y is near ∂Ω, the support of x → ηε (y − x − ενi ) is located outside Ω. It follows that • Contrary to Sε f , the function Sε f is compactly supported in Ω (see Proposition III.2.8). • The definition of Sε f cannot be generalised to distributions f . These definitions are extended to vector-valued functions in a straightforward way. It is useful to notice the following equivalent definition of Sε , Sε f (y) =

N  i=0

 βε (y)ψi (y)

Rd

f (x)ηε (y − x − ενi ) dx, ∀y ∈ Rd .

Moreover, if f ∈ L1loc (Ω), we can simply write

(III.19)

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

140

Sε f (y) =

N 

 f (x)ηε (y − x + ενi ) dx, ∀y ∈ Ω.

βε (y)ψi (y)

(III.20)

Ω

i=0

The first properties of these mollifying operators are summed up in the following result. Proposition III.2.8. 1. We have Sε f ∈ Cc∞ (Ω), ∀f ∈ D (Ω), Sε f ∈ Cc∞ (Ω), ∀f ∈ L1 (Ω) + L∞ (Ω). Moreover, for any p ∈ [1, +∞], and any f ∈ Lp (Ω), we have Sε f Lp (Ω) ≤ f Lp (Ω) and Sε f Lp (Ω) ≤ f Lp (Ω) ,

(III.21)

C C f Lp (Ω) and ∇(Sε f )Lp (Ω) ≤ f Lp (Ω) . ε ε  2. Let p, q ∈ [1, +∞] with (p, q) = (+∞, +∞), and q ≥ p . Let r ∈ [1, +∞[ such that 1/r = 1/p + 1/q. For any α ∈ Lq (Ω) and f ∈ Lp (Ω) we have ∇(Sε f )Lp (Ω) ≤

Sε (αf ) − α(Sε f )Lr −−−→ 0, ε→0

Sε (αf ) − α(Sε f )Lr −−−→ 0, ε→0

so that in particular, for any p ∈ [1, +∞[, Sε f and Sε f both converge towards f in Lp (Ω) when ε goes to 0. It can also be shown that if f ∈ L∞ (Ω) then Sε f and Sε f both weakly- converge to f in L∞ (Ω). Proof. 1. The truncation function β and the kernel η are smooth, thus it is clear that Sε f and Sε f both belong to C ∞ (Ω). Moreover, by (III.12), their supports are bounded. For f ∈ Lp (Ω), we observe that, because of (III.16)–(III.17) and (III.19)– (III.20), the values of |Sε f | and |Sε f | are bounded by convex combinations of values of |f |, as soon as f ∈ Lp (Ω). As a consequence, the Jensen inequality (Proposition II.2.20) gives that for any 1 ≤ p < +∞ and any f ∈ Lp (Ω), |Sε f (y)|p ≤ Sε (|f |p )(y), and |Sε f (y)|p ≤ Sε (|f |p )(y), ∀y ∈ Ω so that estimates (III.21) hold. Using (III.20), we can compute

2. Sobolev spaces on Lipschitz domains

∇Sε f (y) =

N 

141

 ∇(βε ψi )(y)

f (x)ηε (y − x + ενi ) dx Ω

i=0

1 βε (y)ψi (y) ε i=0 N

+

 f (x)(∇η)ε (y − x + ενi ) dx. (III.22) Ω

Thus, the claimed estimates follow by using once more the Jensen inequality and the fact that for y ∈ Ui we have   |(∇η)ε |(y − x + ενi ) dx = |∇η(x)| dx, Rd

Ω

which does not depend on ε. A similar computation leads to the corresponding estimate for Sε f . It remains to show that Sε f is compactly supported in Ω. We already know that its support is contained in B(0, 1 + | ln ε|), therefore it is enough to prove now that its support is contained in Ωε/M ∪ U0 , where we recall that U0 = Ωδ0 /2 . For y ∈ Ω \ (Ωε/M ∪ U0 ), we know that ψ0 (y) = 0 and moreover, for any i ∈ {1, . . . , n} such that ψi (y) = 0, we have y ∈ Ui and d(y, ∂Ω) ≤ ε/M by assumption. Thus, the support of x → ηε (y − x − ενi ) which is included in the ball B(y − ενi , ε) is itself included in Ωc , thanks to (III.6). As a consequence, all the terms of the sum in the definition of Sε f (y) vanish for such a point y. 2. • We first focus on the case α = 1, q = +∞ and p < +∞. By the previous estimates, it is enough to show the convergence property for any f in a dense subset of Lq (Ω). For instance we consider a function f ∈ Cc0 (Ω) and, by (III.16), we find that for any y ∈ Ω, we have Sε f (y) − βε (y)f (y) =

N 

 (f (x) − f (y))ηε (y − x + ενi ) dx,

βε (y)ψi (y)

i=0

Ω

from which we deduce that |Sε f (y) − βε f (y)| ≤ Lip(f )(1 + M )εβε (y), and thus by (III.13) and (III.14) we have Sε f − f Lp (Ω) ≤ Cεβε Lp (Rd ) + βε f − f Lp (Ω) −−−→ 0, ε→0

so that the claim is proved for the operator Sε . A similar computation gives the result for the operator Sε , by using the expression (III.19), the formula (III.17), and the fact that, since f is compactly supported in Ω, its extension f¯ is Lipschitz continuous on the whole space Rd .

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

142

• It remains to treat the general case α ∈ Lq (Ω) and f ∈ Lp (Ω). We only give the proof for Sε because the one for Sε is the same. – If p < +∞, then we have Sε (αf ) − αSε (f )Lr ≤ Sε (αf ) − αf Lr + αf − αSε (f )Lr ≤ Sε (αf ) − αf Lr + αLq f − Sε (f )Lp , and we can conclude by applying the convergence we just obtained to the functions αf ∈ Lr (Ω) and f ∈ Lq (Ω). – If p = +∞ (so that r = q < +∞), we need to use a slightly different argument. We take ε > 0, ε > 0 and we write Sε (αf ) − αSε (f )Lq ≤Sε (αf ) − αf Lq + (α − Sε α)(f − Sε f )Lq + Sε α(f − Sε f )Lq ≤Sε (αf ) − αf Lq + Cf L∞ α − Sε αLq + Sε αL∞ f − Sε f Lq ≤Sε (αf ) − αf Lq + Cf L∞ α − Sε αLq + Sε αL∞ βε f − Sε (βε f )Lq + 2Sε αL∞ f − βε f Lq . Using the previous convergence results on Sε in Lq (Ω) with finite q and since βε f ∈ Lq (Ω), we get for any ε , ε > 0 the inequality lim sup Sε (αf ) − αSε (f )Lq ≤ Cf L∞ α − Sε αLp ε→0

+ 2Sε αL∞ f − βε f Lq . We first take the limit when ε goes to 0, using (III.14), and then the limit ε goes to 0. We obtain that lim sup Sε (αf ) − αSε (f )Lq = 0, ε→0

and the proof is complete.  We can now prove the following result, which is the reciprocal property of the one given in Proposition III.2.4. It implies that, for a smooth enough domain, the set of bounded Lipschitz continuous functions can be identified to the Sobolev space W 1,∞ . Proposition III.2.9. Let Ω be a Lipschitz domain in Rd with compact boundary. Any f ∈ W 1,∞ (Ω) is equal almost everywhere to a Lipschitz continuous function in Ω, still referred to as f , and we have Lip(f ) ≤ Cf W 1,∞ (Ω) ,

2. Sobolev spaces on Lipschitz domains

143

for some C > 0 depending only on Ω. Proof. We have seen that Sε f ∈ Cc∞ (Rd ) and by integrating by parts the last term in formula (III.22) we get that ∇Sε f L∞ ≤

N 

(∇βL∞ ψi L∞ +∇ψi L∞ )f L∞ +

i=0

N 

ψi L∞ ∇f L∞ .

i=0

Therefore, Sε f is Lipschitz continuous on Rd and using the mean-value theorem we get Lip(Sε f ) ≤ Cf W 1,∞ . (III.23) By the Ascoli theorem (see Theorem II.3.1), we deduce that (Sε f )ε has a subsequence which converges locally uniformly towards some continuous function F . By the results of Proposition III.2.8, this limit is certainly equal to f almost everywhere in Ω. We conclude that f is continuous in Ω, and passing to the limit in the following property (obtained from (III.23)) |Sε f (x) − Sε f (y)| ≤ Cf W 1,∞ |x − y|, ∀x, y ∈ Ω, we conclude that f is Lipschitz continuous in Ω and satisfies the required Lipschitz estimate.  We can now investigate the properties of the commutators between the mollifying operators Sε , Sε and first-order differential operators. The main result in this direction (which is often called Friedrichs’ lemma) is the following. We give it in a quite general form which is useful to us in Chapter VI. Theorem III.2.10. Let Ω be a Lipschitz domain of Rd with compact boundary. Let k ∈ N∗ , p, q ∈ [1, +∞], with q ≥ p and (p, q) = (+∞, +∞) and let r ∈ [1, +∞[ be defined by 1/r = 1/p + 1/q. For j ∈ {1, . . . , d}, let αj ∈ (W 1,q (Ω))k and let D : (Lp (Ω))k → D (Ω) be the differential operator defined by d  ∂ Du = (αj · u), ∀u ∈ (Lp (Ω))k . ∂x j j=1

(III.24)

For any u ∈ (Lp (Ω))k , we have Sε Du − DSε uLr ≤ CuLp αW 1,q , for some C > 0 independent of u, α and ε, and moreover Sε Du − DSε uLr −−−→ 0. ε→0

(III.25)

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

144

In particular, if Du ∈ Lr (Ω) then we have DSε u −−−→ Du in Lr (Ω). ε→0

p

Remark III.2.4. A similar result holds with L (Ω), Lq (Ω), and Lr (Ω) replaced with W m,p (Ω), W m,q (Ω), and W m,r (Ω) that we do not state for simplicity. Before proving the theorem above, let us deduce the following density result. Theorem III.2.11. Let Ω be a Lipschitz domain in Rd with compact boundary and 1 ≤ p < +∞, m ∈ N∗ . The set Cc∞ (Ω) is dense in W m,p (Ω). Proof. We only give the proof for m = 1 because the one for m > 1 uses Theorem III.2.10 in the case that we have not presented (see Remark III.2.4). For u ∈ W 1,p (Ω), and l ∈ {1, . . . , d}, we can apply Theorem III.2.10 with k = 1 and αj (x) = δjl so that D = ∂/∂xl . We obtain u ∈ Lp (Ω) and

∂u ∂Sε u ∂u ∈ Lp (Ω) =⇒ −−−→ in Lp (Ω), ∂xl ∂xl ε→0 ∂xl

and thus Sε u ∈ Cc∞ (Ω) converges to u in W 1,p (Ω) as ε → 0.



Remark III.2.5. The proof of Theorem III.2.11 gives in fact a little more precise result that can be useful in some cases. Indeed, using the properties of the mollifying operator Sε , one can check that if u ∈ W 1,p (Ω) is nonnegative, then it can be approximated by nonnegative functions in Cc∞ (Ω). Similarly, if u ∈ W 1,p (Ω)∩L∞ (Ω), then it can be approximated in W 1,p (Ω) by a sequence of functions in Cc∞ (Ω) which is, additionally, bounded in L∞ (Ω). Proof (of Theorem III.2.10). For any y ∈ Ω, we build a test function ϕy,ε ∈ D(Ω) defined by ϕy,ε (x) = Φ(y)

N 

βε (y)ψi (y)ηε (y − x + ενi ), ∀x ∈ Ω.

i=0

The fact that ϕy,ε is compactly supported in Ω comes from (III.5). Indeed, if x ∈ Ω is such that ϕy,ε (x) = 0, there exists i ∈ {0, . . . , N } such that ψi (y) = 0 and ηε (y − x + ενi ) = 0. This implies that y ∈ Ui and x ∈ B(y + ενi , ε) so that, by (III.5), B(x, ε) ⊂ B(y − x + ενi , 2ε) ⊂ Ω. We deduce that x ∈ Ω and δ(x) ≥ ε. We have proved that the support of ϕy,ε is contained in Ωε . By definition of Sε , we have Sε (Du)(y) = Du, ϕy,ε D ,D .

2. Sobolev spaces on Lipschitz domains

145

It follows that Sε (Du)(y) = −

N d  

 βε (y)ψi (y) Ω

j=1 i=0

 ∂  ηε (y − x + ενi ) αj (x) · u(x) dx. ∂xj

Moreover, by definition, we have D(Sε u)(y) =

=

d   ∂  αj (y) · Sε u(y) ∂yj j=1 N  d   j=1 i=0

u(x) ·

Ω

 ∂  αj (y)βε (y)ψi (y)ηε (y − x + ενi ) dx. ∂yj

Therefore, if we define Rε = D(Sε u) − Sε (D)u, we have obtained Rε (y) =

  ∂  u(x) · αj (x)βε (y)ψi (y) ηε (y − x + ενi ) ∂xj j=1 i=0 Ω   ∂  αj (y)βε (y)ψi (y)ηε (y − x + ενi ) dx. + ∂yj

N  d  

We now prove the estimate (III.25). We first observe that, since αj ∈ (W 1,q (Ω))k , we have Rε ∈ Lq (Ω) ⊂ Lr (Ω) because Supp Rε ⊂ Supp βε is bounded. By using that   ∂  ∂  ηε (y − x + ενi ) = − ηε (y − x + ενi ) , ∂xj ∂yj we can write Rε = Rε,0 + Rε,0 (y) =

d  N   j=1 i=0

Rε,j (y) =

N   i=0

d

u(x) ·

Ω

j=1

Rε,j with

∂(αj βε ψi ) (y)ηε (y − x + ενi ) dx, ∂yj

βε (y)ψi (y)u(x) · (αj (y) − αj (x))

Ω

 ∂  ηε (y − x + ενi ) dx. ∂yj

Let us study those terms separately. • The term Rε,0 is written Rε,0 (y) =

  N d   ∂ (αj (y)βε (y)ψi (y)) · u(x)ηε (y − x + ενi ) dx . ∂yj Ω j=1 i=0

By using Proposition II.2.25 (with the translated kernel η(.+νi )) we deduce that

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

146

 d  d  N   ∂ ∂ (αj ψi ) · u = αj · u, in Lr (Ω), ∂yj ∂yj j=1 i=0 j=1

Rε,0 −−−→ ε→0

(III.26)

N where we have used that i=0 ∂ψi /∂yj = 0, for any j ∈ {1, . . . , d}, inasmuch as (ψi )i is a partition of unity. Note that we can immediately prove the bound Rε,0 Lr ≤ CuLp

d 

αj W 1,q .

(III.27)

j=1

• Since ψi is supported in Ui and using (III.5), we can write Rε,j (y) =

N 

 B(y+ενi ,ε)

i=0

=

N 

u(x) · (αj (y) − αj (x))

βε (y)ψi (y) 

u(y + ενi − εz) ·

βε (y)ψi (y) B

i=0

=

N 

 ∂  ηε (y − x + ενi ) dx ∂yj

αj (y) − αj (y + ενi − εz) ∂η (z) dz ε ∂zj

βε (y)ψi (y)

i=0

 

1

× B

0

# $ ∂η u(y + ενi − εz) · ∇αj (y + tενi − tεz).(z − νi ) (z) dz dt. ∂zj

It follows that  |Rε,j (y)|r dy Ω

≤C

N  

B

N  





0

r/p |u| (y + ενi − εz) dy dz p

Ui

i=0

1

|u|r (y + ενi − εz)|∇αj |r (y + tενi − tεz) dz dt dy

Ui

i=0

≤C

 

B

 

×

p/q

1

|∇αj | (y + tενi − tεz) dz dt dy q

Ui

B

.

0

Notice that, for any t ∈ [0, 1] and z ∈ B, the map y → y + tενi − tεz maps Ui onto some open subset of Ω. Thus, by change of variables, we conclude that Rε,j Lr ≤ CuLp ∇αj Lq . (III.28) Furthermore, by integration by parts, we observe that

2. Sobolev spaces on Lipschitz domains

 (z − νi ) B

147

∂η dz = −ej , ∂zj

where ej is the jth vector of the canonical basis of Rd . Hence, when u and αj are smooth enough we immediately see, by using the dominated convergence theorem, that Rε,j (y) −−−→ ε→0

#  $ ∂η ψi (y)u(y) · ∇αj (y). (z − νi ) dz ∂zj B i=0

N 

=−

N 

ψi (y)u(y) ·

i=0

∂αj ∂αj (y) = −u(y) · (y), ∂yj ∂yj

uniformly with respect to y, and thus in particular we have Rε,j −−−→ −u · ε→0

∂αj , in Lr (Ω). ∂yj

(III.29)

• Let us denote by Rε the bilinear map which, to any u ∈ Lp (Ω), α = (αi )i ∈ (W 1,q (R))k associates the term Rε ∈ Lr (Ω) defined above. Gathering (III.27)–(III.28) and (III.26)–(III.29), we finally proved that Rε (u, α)Lr ≤ CuLp αW 1,q ,

(III.30)

Rε (u, α)Lr −−−→ 0, as soon as u ∈ C ∞ (Ω), α ∈ C ∞ (Ω)kd . ε→0

We are now able to conclude the proof of this theorem. – In the case p < +∞ and q < +∞, we know that C ∞ (Ω) is dense in Lp (Ω) and in W 1,q (Ω). It is then obvious to deduce that Rε (u, α)Lr → 0 for any (u, α) ∈ Lp (Ω) × (W 1,q (Ω))kd . – In the case p = +∞ and q < +∞ (and thus r = q), C ∞ (Ω) is not dense in L∞ (Ω) but we can argue as follows. For any n ≥ 1, there exists an αn ∈ (C ∞ (Ω))k such that α − αn W 1,q ≤ 1/n. We have αn ∈ (H 1 (Ω))k , ∀n ≥ 1, and u ∈ L∞ (Ω) ⊂ L2 (Ω), thus we can find a sequence (un )n ⊂ C ∞ (Ω) such that un − uL2 ≤

1 . nαn H 1

Using (III.30) with the chosen exponents (p, q) but also with the exponents (2, 2), we obtain that

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

148

Rε (u, α)Lq ≤Rε (u, α − α )Lq + Rε (u − un , αn )Lq    n

≤C Rε (u−un ,αn ) L∞

+ Rε (un , αn )Lq ≤CuL∞ α − αn W 1,q + C  u − un L2 αn H 1    ≤(n αn H 1 )−1

+ Rε (u , α )Lq n



n

CuL∞ C + + Rε (un , αn )Lq . n n

For a fixed n, the last term of this inequality tends to 0 when ε → 0 because un and αn are smooth. We deduce that 0 ≤ lim sup Rε (u, α)Lq ≤ ε→0

CuL∞ C + . n n

We can now let n → +∞ to deduce that lim supε→0 Rε (u, α)Lq = 0, which proves the claim. – The case p < +∞ and q = +∞ can be treated in the same way.  Remark III.2.6. Notice that the density argument used at the end of the above proof is only needed when the coefficients αj are not constant. This is coherent with the fact that, in order to prove the density Theorem III.2.11, we only used Theorem III.2.10 in the constant coefficient case. We now state and prove a result similar to Theorem III.2.10 for the operator Sε . For this result to be true, we need a stronger assumption on the function u, namely that u ¯, the extension of u by 0, satisfies D¯ u ∈ Lr (Rd ). As we show later, this assumption is equivalent to asking that some well-adapted trace of u vanishes on ∂Ω (see Theorem III.2.45). Theorem III.2.12. Under the same assumptions as in Theorem III.2.10, for any u ∈ (Lp (Ω))k such that D¯ u ∈ Lr (Rd ), we have Sε Du − DSε uLr (Ω) −−−→ 0. ε→0

In particular we have DSε u −−−→ Du in Lr (Ω). ε→0

Proof. The computation of D¯ u needs a priori to extend the coefficients αj to the whole space Rd , but in fact the result does not depend on the particular extension we choose. More precisely, the statement that D¯ u = f ∈ Lr (Rd ) means that we have   ∂ϕ − αj (x) · u(x) (x) dx = f (x)ϕ(x) dx, ∀ϕ ∈ Cc∞ (Ω). (III.31) ∂xj Ω Ω

2. Sobolev spaces on Lipschitz domains

149

The important point is that this formula holds even if ϕ is not compactly supported in Ω. As a consequence, we can follow the same line of proof as for Theorem III.2.10 by taking ϕ˜y,ε (x) = Φ(y)

N 

βε (y)ψi (y)ηε (y − x − ενi ),

i=0

as a test function in (III.31). Note that, since the sign in front of ενi has been changed, this function ϕ˜y,ε is not compactly supported in Ω. It remains to integrate the result with respect to y in Ω. We finally get a ˜ ε = D(Sε u) − Sε (D¯ formula for R u) which is similar to the one obtained in the proof of Theorem III.2.10 and we can conclude in the very same way as in this proof. 

2.3 Change of variables  be two Lipschitz domains (not necessarily Theorem III.2.13. Let Ω and Ω d ∗ bounded) in R and m ∈ N . Assume that we are given an homeomorphism ˜ → Ω such that T ∈ (C m−1,1 (Ω))  d and T −1 ∈ (C m−1,1 (Ω))d with bounded T :Ω derivatives up to the order m. For any measurable function u : Ω → R and any 1 ≤ p ≤ +∞, we have  u ∈ W m,p (Ω) ⇐⇒ u ◦ T ∈ W m,p (Ω), and there exist C1 , C2 > 0 which do not depend on u such that C1 uW m,p (Ω) ≤ u ◦ T W m,p (Ω) e ≤ C2 uW m,p (Ω) . Proof. We only prove the case m = 1, because the general case can be deduced by successive differentiations of u ◦ T . Moreover, since T −1 satisfies the same assumptions as T , it is enough to prove that for u ∈ W 1,p (Ω) we have u ◦ T ∈  with a suitable estimate of the norm. W 1,p (Ω) For u ∈ Cc∞ (Ω), we observe that u ◦ T is Lipschitz continuous and that  where T is differentiable (i.e., for almost every x; see Theorem for any x ∈ Ω II.2.46), u ◦ T is also differentiable and we have   ∇(u ◦ T ) = t (∇T ). (∇u) ◦ T , almost everywhere. We deduce that |∇(u ◦ T )| ≤ Lip(T )|∇u ◦ T |,

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

150

 by using Proposition and we can conclude that ∇(u ◦ T ) belongs to Lp (Ω) II.2.15. Since Cc∞ (Ω) is dense in W 1,p (Ω), the claim is proved. 

2.4 Extension operator The goal of this section is to build, for a given Lipschitz domain Ω with compact boundary a linear extension operator, referred to as EΩ , such that for any given 1 < p < +∞, EΩ maps W 1,p (Ω) into W 1,p (Rd ) and satisfies for any such p the properties EΩ is continuous from W 1,p (Ω) into W 1,p (Rd ),

(III.32)

(EΩ u)|Ω = u, ∀u ∈ W 1,p (Ω),

(III.33)

(EΩ u)|Ωc = 0, ∀u ∈ W01,p (Ω).

(III.34)

Notice that the operator EΩ does not depend on p. Remark III.2.7. Here also the case p = 1 is specific. It can be shown that in that case, such an extension operator EΩ does not exist. Nevertheless, it Ω from W 1,1 (Ω) into W 1,1 (Rd ) is possible to build an extension operator E satisfying (III.32) and (III.33) but which does not satisfy (III.34); see, for instance, [33]. Particularities due to the case p = 1 are also observed in Remark III.2.10. We first need to build such an extension operator on the flat half-space Rd+ . Let η : Rd−1 → R be a mollifying kernel supported in the unit ball B of Rd−1 . We define the extension operator on Rd+ , for any u ∈ C 0,1 (Rd+ ), as follows ⎧ d ⎨u(x),     for x ∈ R+ , ERd+ u (x) = ⎩ϕ(xd ) u(¯ x − xd z, 0)η(z) dz , for x = (¯ x, xd ) ∈ Rd− , B

where ϕ : R → R is smooth, compactly supported, and satisfies ϕ(0) = 1. Proposition III.2.14. For any 1 < p < +∞, the operator ERd+ satisfies properties (III.32)–(III.34). Proof. Property (III.33) is clear from the definition of ERd+ . It is also clear that ERd+ u vanishes on Rd− for any u ∈ D(Rd+ ). Assume that we can prove the inequality

2. Sobolev spaces on Lipschitz domains

151

ERd+ uW 1,p (Rd ) ≤ CuW 1,p (Rd+ ) , ∀u ∈ Cc∞ (Rd+ ); then, by density, the operator EΩ can be uniquely extended to the whole Sobolev space W 1,p (Rd+ ) and all the required properties are proved. Let u be any element in Cc∞ (Rd+ ). • It is straightforward to check that, for such a u, ERd+ u is Lipschitz contin-

uous on Rd and compactly supported. • We first estimate the Lp (Rd− )-norm by using the Fubini theorem and the  fact that B η(z) dz = 1   p  ERd+ u (x) dx Rd −





0



|ϕ(xd )| |u(¯ x − xd z, 0)|p η(z) d¯ x dz Rd−1 B −∞ =ϕpLp (R) u(., 0)pLp (∂Rd ) ≤ CupW 1,p (Rd ) + +

=

p

• We now estimate the Lp (Rd− )-norm of ∂xi (ERd+ u) for i = 1, . . . , d − 1. To begin with, we write    ϕ(xd ) ∂xi ERd+ u (¯ x, xd ) = u(¯ x − xd z, 0)∂zi η(z) dz, xd B  and since B ∂zi η(z) dz = 0, we deduce that     ϕ(xd ) x, xd ) = x − xd z, −xd ) u(¯ x − xd z, 0) − u(¯ ∂xi ERd+ u (¯ xd B  x, −xd ) ∂zi η(z) dz, + u(¯ x − xd z, −xd ) − u(¯ and then  ∂xi



ϕ(xd ) x, xd ) = ERd+ u (¯ xd

  B

|xd |

∂xd u(¯ x − xd z, ξ)∂zi η(z) dξ dz

0

 

1

∂xi u(¯ x − txd z, −xd )∂zi η(z) dt dz.

+ ϕ(xd ) B

0

Let us refer to the two terms in the right-hand side as v1 (x) and v2 (x), respectively. – We perform the change of variables z → xd y in the definition of v1 to obtain

  |xd | ∂zi η(y/xd ) 1 ∂xd u(¯ x − y, ξ) dξ dξ dy; v1 (x) = ϕ(xd ) xd 0 xd−1 Rd−1 d

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

152

then we use the Jensen inequality (Proposition II.2.20) to get p   ∂ η(y/x ) 1 |xd | zi d p−1 p ∂xd u(¯ x − y, ξ) dξ dξ dy. |v1 (x)| ≤ ∂zi ηL1 xdd−1 Rd−1 xd 0 We integrate with respect to x ¯ ∈ Rd−1 to get p    1 |xd | |v1 (¯ x, xd )|p d¯ x≤C ∂xd u(¯ x, ξ) dξ d¯ x. x d−1 d−1 d 0 R R Finally, we integrate with respect to xd ∈]−∞, 0] and we use the Hardy inequality (Lemma II.4.7) so that we finally have v1 pLp (Rd ) ≤ C∂xd upLp (Rd ) . −

+

– For estimating v2 we first use the Jensen inequality to get   1 |∂xi u(¯ x − txd z, −xd )|p |∂zi η(z)| dt dz, |v2 (x)|p ≤ C B

0

and we first integrate with respect to x ¯ to find   |v2 (¯ x, xd )|p d¯ x ≤ C |∂xi u(¯ x, −xd )|p d¯ x; Rd−1

Rd−1

then we integrate with respect to xd to conclude that v2 pLp (Rd ) ≤ C  ∂xi upLp (Rd ) . −

+

• It remains to study the derivative of ERd+ u with respect to xd . A straightforward computation shows that    ∂xd ERd+ u (¯ x, xd ) =ϕ (xd ) u(¯ x − xd z, 0)η(z) dz B    ϕ(xd ) − u(¯ x − xd z, 0) divz η(z)z dz, xd B so that the estimate of ∂xd ERd+ uLp (Rd− ) can be done in a similar way as before.  We may now build an extension operator for any Lipschitz half-space Ha as defined in Definition III.1.1. Let Ta be the Lipschitz diffeomorphism that we introduced in Proposition III.1.3. Proposition III.2.15. The operator EHa defined by

2. Sobolev spaces on Lipschitz domains

153



 EHa u = ERd+ (u ◦ Ta ) ◦ Ta−1 , ∀u ∈ W 1,p (Ha ), satisfies the properties (III.32)–(III.34). Proof. This is a straightforward consequence of Proposition III.1.3, Theorem III.2.13, and Proposition III.2.14.  Finally, for any Lipschitz domain with compact boundary Ω, we can use once more a suitable open covering (Ui )1≤i≤N of ∂Ω and an associated partition of unity (ψi )1≤i≤N . Theorem III.2.16. The operator EΩ defined by EΩ u =

d 

EHai ((uψi ) ◦ Ri−1 ) ◦ Ri , ∀u ∈ W 1,p (Ω),

i=1

satisfies the properties (III.32)–(III.34). Proof. The main point is to observe that for any i = 1, . . . , N , the function uψi is supported in Ω∩Ui = Ri Hai ∩Ui , so that the extension of (uψi )◦Ri−1 by zero on Hai is a function in W 1,p (Hai ) whose norm is controlled by uW 1,p (Ω) . 

2.5 Trace and trace lifting operators In this section, we study the trace theory for functions belonging to a Sobolev space W 1,p (Ω).

2.5.1 Trace operator and trace spaces Once more, we begin by studying the case of a flat half-space. Proposition III.2.17. Let 1 ≤ p < +∞. There exists C > 0 such that, for any ϕ ∈ C 0,1 (Rd ) which is compactly supported, we have 1−1/p

1/p

ϕ|∂Rd+ Lp (∂Rd+ ) ≤ CϕLp (Rd ) ϕW 1,p (Rd ) . +

+

Proof. Let us first prove the result for ϕ ∈ Cc∞ (Rd ). For any x = (¯ x, xd ), we compute  xd ∂ϕ |ϕ(¯ x, 0)|p = |ϕ(¯ x, xd )|p − p |ϕ(¯ x, s)|p−2 ϕ(¯ x, s) (¯ x, s) ds. ∂xd 0

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

154

Since ϕ is compactly supported, we can take the limit xd → +∞; then we integrate with respect to x ¯ ∈ Rd−1 to find that  +∞   ∂ϕ |ϕ(¯ x, 0)|p d¯ x≤p |ϕ(¯ x, s)|p−1 (¯ x, s) ds d¯ x. ∂xd Rd−1 Rd−1 0 By using the H¨ older inequality we find that     ∂ϕ  p−1 p   |ϕ(¯ x, 0)| d¯ x ≤ pϕLp (Rd )  , + ∂xd Lp (Rd ) Rd−1 +

which implies the required inequality. In the case where ϕ is only Lipschitz continuous and compactly supported, we can apply the above inequality to the function ϕ  ηε defined in (II.5). We observe that the functions ϕ  ηε are compactly supported, uniformly with respect to ε. By using Proposition II.2.47, we deduce that ϕ  ηε converges to ϕ in W 1,p (Rd+ ) and that the traces of ϕ  ηε on ∂Rd+ also converge towards the trace of ϕ in Lp (∂Rd+ ). The claim is proved.  We can now extend the previous result to any Lipschitz half-space. Proposition III.2.18. Let 1 ≤ p < +∞ and Ha be a Lipschitz half-space of Rd . There exists Ca > 0 such that for any ϕ ∈ Lip(Rd ) compactly supported, we have 1−1/p 1/p ϕ|∂Ha Lp (∂Ha ) ≤ Ca ϕLp (Ha ) ϕW 1,p (Ha ) . Proof. We consider the Lipschitz diffeomorphism Ta : Rd+ → Ha that we studied in Proposition III.1.3. By construction, ϕ ◦ Ta is Lipschitz continuous and compactly supported, so that we can apply Proposition III.2.17 to obtain 1−1/p

ϕ ◦ Ta |∂Rd+ Lp (∂Rd+ ) ≤ Cϕ ◦ Ta Lp

1/p

ϕ ◦ Ta W 1,p (Rd ) . +

By Proposition II.2.15 and Theorem III.2.13, we can bound the right-hand side by corresponding norms of ϕ in Lp (Ha ) and in W 1,p (Ha ). It remains to observe that   ϕ ◦ Ta |∂Rd+ pLp (∂Rd ) = |ϕ(Ta (¯ x, 0))|p d¯ x= |ϕ(¯ x, a(¯ x))|p d¯ x + d−1 d−1 R R  1 |ϕ(¯ x, a(¯ x))|p Ja (¯ x) = d¯ x J (¯ x) Rd−1  a 1 |ϕ|p dσ. ≥( 1 + (d − 1) Lip(a)2 ∂Ha  Finally, we can prove the main result of this section.

2. Sobolev spaces on Lipschitz domains

155

Theorem III.2.19. Let Ω be a Lipschitz domain of Rd with compact boundary and 1 ≤ p < +∞. There exists C > 0, such that for any ϕ ∈ D(Rd ) we have 1−1/p

1/p

ϕ|∂Ω Lp (∂Ω) ≤ CϕLp (Ω) ϕW 1,p (Ω) . As a consequence, there exists a unique linear continuous operator γ0 : W 1,p (Ω) → Lp (∂Ω), such that γ0 (ϕ) = ϕ|∂Ω for any ϕ ∈ Cc∞ (Ω). This operator is called the trace operator on W 1,p (Ω). Remark III.2.8. We show in Theorem III.2.46 that the kernel of the operator γ0 is nothing but the space W01,p (Ω). That is the reason why we can say that W01,p (Ω) is exactly the set of functions in W 1,p (Ω) which vanish on the boundary ∂Ω. Proof. We consider the open covering (Ui )1≤i≤N of ∂Ω that we introduced in Theorem III.1.4 and (ψi )1≤i≤N an associated partition of unity. Using that N i=1 ψi = 1 on ∂Ω we have ϕ|∂Ω Lp (∂Ω) ≤

N 

(ψi ϕ)|∂Ω Lp (∂Ω) .

i=1

Since each ψi ϕ is supported in Ui and ∂Ω ∩ Ui = Ri ∂Hai ∩ Ui , Ω ∩ Ui = Ri Hai ∩ Ui , we can apply Proposition III.2.18 to find that (ψi ϕ)|∂Ω Lp (∂Ω) =(ψi ϕ)|∂Ri Hai Lp (∂Ri Hai ) 1−1/p

1/p

≤Ci ϕψi Lp (Ri Ha ) ϕψi W 1,p (Ri Ha i

i

)

1−1/p 1/p ≤Ci ϕψi Lp (Ω) ϕψi W 1,p (Ω) .

Each ψi belongs to D(Rd ), thus we have ϕψi W 1,p (Ω) ≤ Ci ϕW 1,p (Ω) which gives the inequality. The existence and uniqueness of the trace operator now follows from the density of Cc∞ (Ω) in W 1,p (Ω); see Theorem III.2.11.  We later show (Remark III.2.18) that the trace operator γ0 is not surjective onto Lp (∂Ω) for 1 < p < +∞. This justifies the following definition. Definition III.2.20. Let Ω be a Lipschitz domain with compact boundary and 1 < p < +∞. The range of the trace operator is referred to as   W 1−1/p,p (∂Ω) = γ0 W 1,p (Ω) . This is a Banach space for the following norm,

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

156

vW 1−1/p,p (∂Ω) =

inf

u∈W 1,p (Ω) γ0 (u)=v

uW 1,p (Ω) .

Remark III.2.9. • As suggested by the notation, the space W 1−1/p,p (∂Ω) only depends on the manifold ∂Ω and not on the domain Ω itself. This is due to the existence of the extension operator EΩ . Indeed, it implies in c particular that the trace space associated with W 1,p (Ω) and with W 1,p (Ω ) are the same, and that the associated norms are equivalent. The result c follows because Ω and Ω share the same boundary. In fact, trace spaces can be defined in an intrinsic way as fractional Sobolev spaces but this is not needed here (see, for instance, [33]). • In the case p = 1, the trace operator γ0 is surjective, that is γ0 (W 1,1 (Ω)) = L1 (∂Ω) but this is quite difficult to show (see Remark III.2.10). As an extension of the previous notation we set W 0,1 (∂Ω) = L1 (∂Ω). Theorem III.2.21. With the same notation as in Definition III.2.20 and 1 ≤ p < +∞, we have the following properties. • The trace operator γ0 is continuous from W 1,p (Ω) onto W 1−1/p,p (∂Ω). • The space C 0,1 (∂Ω) is included and dense in W 1−1/p,p (∂Ω). • The space W 1−1/p,p (∂Ω) is dense in Lp (∂Ω). Proof. • The first property is obvious by definition of the norm on W 1−1/p,p (∂Ω). • Note first that, thanks to Proposition II.2.45, any Lipschitz-continuous function v on ∂Ω is the restriction on ∂Ω of some compactly supported Lipschitz continuous function u on Rd . In particular such a u belongs to W 1,p (Ω) and therefore v ∈ C 0,1 (∂Ω) ⊂ W 1−1/p,p (Ω). Let now v ∈ W 1−1/p,p (∂Ω), with v = γ0 (u), u ∈ W 1,p (Ω). The trace of Sε u on ∂Ω is, at least, Lipschitz-continuous and converges to v in W 1−1/p,p (∂Ω), because the trace operator is continuous and Sε u converges to u in W 1,p (Ω). • The last property follows from the density of C 0,1 (∂Ω) into Lp (∂Ω).  As a consequence of the above properties of trace operators and of the density of smooth functions in Sobolev spaces, we can extend the Stokes  formula (III.10) to any ϕ ∈ W 1,p (Ω) and Ψ ∈ (W 1,p (Ω))d as follows    ϕ div Ψ dx + Φ · ∇ψ dx = γ0 (ψ)(γ0 (Φ) · ν) dσ. (III.35) Ω

Ω

∂Ω

2.5.2 Trace lifting operator  = Ωc which Let Ω be a Lipschitz domain with compact boundary. We set Ω  = ∂Ω. is also a Lipschitz domain with the same compact boundary as Ω : ∂ Ω

2. Sobolev spaces on Lipschitz domains

157

˜ 0 from W 1,p (Ω) into itself as We define a continuous operator R   ˜ 0 u = E e (EΩ u) e R , ∀u ∈ W 1,p (Ω). |Ω Ω |Ω

Since EΩ and EΩ e are continuous (as well as the restriction operators), the ˜ ˜0u = linear operator R0 is also continuous. Moreover, by (III.34) we see that R 1,p 0 for any u ∈ W0 (Ω). We later show (Theorem III.2.46) that W01,p (Ω) = Ker γ0 . As a consequence, if u1 , u2 ∈ W 1,p (Ω) are such that γ0 (u1 ) = γ0 (u2 ) then we have ˜ 0 u1 = R ˜ 0 u2 . u1 − u2 ∈ Ker γ0 ∈ W01,p (Ω) and then we have R ˜ 0 u only depends on the trace γ0 (u) ∈ W 1−1/p,p (∂Ω) As a consequence, R and we can define a new operator R0 : W 1−1/p,p (∂Ω) → W 1,p (Ω) by R0 v = ˜ 0 u for any u ∈ W 1,p (Ω) such that γ0 (u) = v. R The properties of R0 are now summed up in the following theorem. Theorem III.2.22 (Lifting operator). Let Ω be a Lipschitz domain with compact boundary and 1 < p < +∞. There exists a linear continuous operator R0 from W 1−1/p,p (∂Ω) into W 1,p (Ω) which is a right-inverse of the trace operator, that is, which satisfies γ0 ◦ R0 = IdW 1−1/p,p (∂Ω) . Proof. The only point that remains to be proved is the continuity of the operator R0 . For any v = γ0 (u) ∈ W 1−1/p,p (∂Ω) with u ∈ W 1,p (Ω) we have ˜ 0 uW 1,p (Ω) ≤ R ˜ 0 uW 1,p (Ω) . R0 vW 1,p (Ω) = R Inasmuch as this estimate is true for any u ∈ W 1,p (Ω) satisfying γ0 u = v we can take the infimum to obtain R0 vW 1,p (Ω) ≤ CvW 1−1/p,p (∂Ω) .  Remark III.2.10. Such a linear continuous lifting operator does not exist in the case p = 1. This is closely related to Remark III.2.7. Nevertheless, it is possible to show that there exists a continuous nonlinear lifting operator from L1 (∂Ω) into W 1,1 (Ω); see, for instance, [33]. In particular the trace operator γ0 : W 1,1 (Ω) → L1 (∂Ω) is onto.

2.5.3 Higher-order traces By extension of the previous definitions we define, for any k ≥ 1 and any 1 < p < +∞, the space

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

158

W k−1/p,p (∂Ω) = γ0 (W k,p (Ω)), equipped with the norm vW k−1/p,p =

inf

u∈W k,p (Ω) γ0 (u)=v

uW k,p (Ω) .

This is a Banach space (and even a Hilbert space when p = 2). We can show that, as soon as Ω is a C k−1,1 domain, the lifting operator R0 that we built in the previous section is continuous from W k−1/p,p (∂Ω) onto W k,p (Ω). To this end, it is enough to prove that the extension operator EΩ satisfies the additional property: for any u ∈ W k,p (Ω), we have (EΩ u)Ωc belongs to c W k,p (Ω ) and there is a C > 0 independent of u, so that we have (EΩ u)|Ωc W k,p (Ωc ) ≤ CuW k,p (Ω) .

(III.36)

By using the regularity assumptions on Ω, we see that it is enough to prove (III.36) in the case of the flat half-space. This can be done in the very same way as we did for the case k = 1. We leave this calculation to the reader. Remark III.2.11. It is not true that EΩ u ∈ W k,p (Rd ). However, it is possible to build extension operators satisfying this additional property but not (III.34). We do not present this construction which is not useful here (see [1], for instance). Assume now that Ω is of class C 1,1 . We observe that, for any u ∈ W 2,p (Ω), we have ∇u ∈ (W 1,p (Ω))d so that we can define the normal derivative γν (u) =

∂u = γ0 (∇u) · ν ∈ Lp (∂Ω). ∂ν

In fact, from the smoothness hypothesis on the domain, it can be shown (see Section 3.2) that ν can be extended to a Lipschitz continuous function on Ω. Therefore, the product (∇u) · ν belongs to W 1,p (Ω) and thus, the normal derivative γν (u) belongs to W 1−1/p,p (∂Ω). We have shown that γν is a continuous linear operator from W 2,p (Ω) into 1−1/p,p W (∂Ω). In fact, it can be shown that this operator has a continuous right inverse. Theorem III.2.23. Let Ω be a domain of Rd of class C 1,1 with compact boundary. There exists a continuous linear lifting operator Rν from W 1−1/p,p (∂Ω) into W 2,p (Ω) such that γν ◦ Rν = IdW 1−1/p,p (∂Ω) , and γ0 ◦ Rν = 0. The proof of this result is postponed to Section 3.3.

2. Sobolev spaces on Lipschitz domains

159

Remark III.2.12. Let us define the following operator R : (g0 , g1 ) ∈ W 2−1/p,p (∂Ω) × W 1−1/p,p (∂Ω) → − R(g0 , g1 ) = R0 g0 + Rν (g1 − γν (R0 g0 )) ∈ W 2,p (Ω). By the properties of R0 and Rν , and the definition of W 2−1/p,p (∂Ω), we see that this operator is linear and continuous. Using that γ0 Rν = 0, γ0 R0 = Id, and γν Rν = Id, we get γ0 (R(g0 , g1 )) = γ0 R0 g0 = g0 , γν (R(g0 , g1 )) = γν (R0 g0 ) + γν Rν (g1 − γν (R0 g0 )) = g1 . We have thus obtained an operator which is a simultaneous lifting operator for the usual trace and for the trace of the normal derivative in W 2,p (Ω).

2.6 Duality theory for Sobolev spaces 2.6.1 Definitions and characterisation For all p ∈ [1, +∞] and m ≥ 1, we define the following distribution space, % &  −m,p  α p (Ω) = u ∈ D (Ω), u = ∂ fα , with fα ∈ L (Ω) , (III.37) W |α|≤m

which is equipped with the norm ⎧ ⎞1/p ⎛ ⎪ ⎪  ⎪  ⎪ ⎪ ⎝ fα pLp ⎠ , for p < +∞ ⎪ ⎨ uW −m,p = inf |α|≤m



⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ uW −m,∞ = inf sup fα L∞ ,

(III.38) for p = +∞

|α|≤m

 where the infimum is taken on all the families (fα )α such that u = |α|≤m ∂ α fα . These spaces play an important role in the duality theory of W0m,p (Ω) spaces. Let us make this point precise. 

Theorem III.2.24. 1. For all m ≥ 1 and p ∈ [1, +∞], the space W −m,p (Ω) is a Banach space.  2. For all m ≥ 1 and p ∈]1, +∞], the dual of W −m,p (Ω) is isomorphic with m,p W0 (Ω). 3. For all m ≥ 1 and p ∈ [1, +∞[, the dual of W0m,p (Ω) is isomorphic with  W −m,p (Ω).

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

160

Proof. 1. We denote as Nm the number of multi-indices α ∈ Nd such that |α| ≤ m. Then, let Φ be the map   Nm  Φ : Lp (Ω) −→ W −m,p (Ω)  ∂ α fα . (fα )α → |α|≤m

By definition, this map is linear, continuous, and surjective. Hence, Φ naturally infers a linear, continuous, and bijective function Φ between the   quotient space X = (Lp (Ω))Nm / Ker Φ and W −m,p (Ω). Since Ker Φ is closed, X, provided with the quotient norm, is a Banach space. Furthermore, from the definitions of the quotient norm and the norm (III.38)  chosen on W −m,p (Ω), we see that Φ is an isometry between these two  spaces which proves that W −m,p (Ω) is a Banach space. 2. We assume p > 1, in other words p < +∞. By duality, the adjoint function  t Φ produces an isomorphism between (W −m,p (Ω)) and X  . However, the dual of X is naturally identified with the subspace of continuous linear  functionals on (Lp (Ω))Nm which cancel on Ker Φ. Since p is finite, the  dual of Lp (Ω) is canonically isomorphic with Lp (Ω) such that the dual of X is made up of elements of (Lp (Ω))Nm which cancel on the kernel of Φ. One such element can be written as u = (uα )|α|≤m ∈ (Lp (Ω))Nm with   uα fα dx = 0, Ω |α|≤m

  for all families (fα )α ∈ (Lp (Ω))Nm such that α ∂ α fα = 0. If we apply this to the families of the form (−∂ α ϕ, 0, . . . , 0, ϕ, 0, . . .) for any ϕ ∈ D(Ω), we obtain the result that the family (uα )α has the form uα = (−1)|α| ∂ α v. In particular, the function v belongs to W m,p (Ω). However, we can also take the ϕ in D(Ω), which shows that v belongs to W0m,p (Ω). In summary, the function S : v ∈ W0m,p (Ω) → (v, . . . , (−1)|α| ∂ α v, . . .) ∈ X  , produces an isomorphism between W0m,p (Ω) and X  which is itself isomor phic with the dual of W −m,p (Ω). 3. The proof of this point is similar to that of the previous example.  In this proof, we have used the identification of the dual of Lp (Ω) with   Lp (Ω) through the bilinear form (f, g) ∈ Lp (Ω) × Lp (Ω) → Ω f g dx. It

2. Sobolev spaces on Lipschitz domains

161 

is useful to understand that, when it occurs, the duality (W −m,p , W0m,p ) is written using this bilinear form as follows, 6 7    α ∂ fα , ϕ = (−1)|α| fα ∂ α ϕ dx, ∀ϕ ∈ W0m,p (Ω). |α|≤m

W −m,p ,W0m,p

Ω |α|≤m

(III.39) Of course, the term on the right-hand side of this equality only depends on  the sum |α|≤m ∂ α fα . 

Remark III.2.13. For any u ∈ W −m,p (Ω), we have uW −m,p =

u, ϕW −m,p ,W0m,p

sup

ϕW0m,p

ϕ∈W0m,p (Ω)

,

(III.40)

even for p = +∞, thanks to Proposition II.2.1. In the case p = 2, it can be shown that the norm of H −m (Ω) defined by (III.38) and characterised by (III.40) is an Hilbert norm. Definition III.2.25. For any Lipschitz domain Ω in Rd with compact boundary   and any 1 ≤ p < +∞, we define W −1/p ,p (∂Ω) to be the dual space of W 1−1/p,p (∂Ω). Note that in the case p = 1 we have seen (Remark III.2.9) that W 0,1 (∂Ω) = L1 (∂Ω), so that we adopt the convention that W 0,∞ (∂Ω) = L∞ (∂Ω). By using Theorem III.2.21, W 1−1/p,p (∂Ω) is dense in Lp (∂Ω). Therefore,  by using Proposition II.3.7 we can identify Lp (∂Ω) as a dense subspace of    W −1/p ,p (∂Ω). Indeed, for any v ∈ Lp (∂Ω), the mapping  Tv : w ∈ W 1−1/p,p (∂Ω) → vw dσ, ∂Ω 



is linear continuous so that Tv ∈ W −1/p ,p (∂Ω) and moreover Tv W −1/p ,p (∂Ω) ≤ wLp (∂Ω) vLp (∂Ω) ≤ CwW 1−1/p,p (∂Ω) vLp (∂Ω) . 





Therefore, the map v ∈ Lp (∂Ω) → Tv ∈ W −1/p ,p (∂Ω) is a canonical con   tinuous embedding of Lp (∂Ω) into W −1/p ,p (∂Ω). In other words, we often use the following duality formula on the boundary in the sequel,  v, wW −1/p ,p (∂Ω),W 1−1/p,p (∂Ω) = vw dσ, ∂Ω 

for any v ∈ Lp (∂Ω) and w ∈ W 1−1/p,p (∂Ω) ⊂ Lp (∂Ω).

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

162

2.6.2 Mollifying operators and Friedrichs commutation estimates We study here the properties of the mollifying operator Sε defined in Section 2.2 when applied to distributions belonging to dual Sobolev spaces. These results are useful in the study of the functional spaces of fluid mechanics that we give in Chapter IV, in particular in the proof of the Neˇcas inequality (see Remark IV.1.2). We suppose we are given a Lipschitz domain Ω with compact boundary. Proposition III.2.26. For any f ∈ W −1,p (Ω), with p ∈ [1, +∞[, we have Sε f − f W −1,p −−−→ 0. ε→0

Proof. From Definition III.37, any distribution in W −1,p (Ω) can be written as d f = g0 + j=1 ∂gj /∂xj , with g0 , . . . , gd ∈ Lp (Ω). By using Proposition III.2.8, we know that Sε g0 −−−→ g0 , in Lp (Ω), ε→0

which implies the convergence in W −1,p (Ω). Since Sε is linear, it remains to show that Sε (∂gj /∂xj ) converges towards ∂gj /∂xj in W −1,p (Ω) for any j. To this end, we write      ∂gj  ∂gj  ∂gj  ∂ Sε  Sε  − ≤ − (S g ) ε j   ∂xj   ∂xj W −1,p ∂xj ∂xj −1,p   W  ∂   +  ∂xj (Sε gj − gj ) −1,p W    ∂gj  ∂  ≤C Sε − (Sε gj )  p + Sε gj − gj Lp . ∂xj ∂xj L Theorem III.2.10 proves that the first term converges to zero and Proposition III.2.8 shows that the second term also tends to zero. The proof is complete.  Remark III.2.14. This result proves in particular that, for any Lipschitz domain Ω with compact boundary, the set Cc∞ (Ω) is dense in W −1,p (Ω), 1 ≤ p < +∞. We can now prove a commutator estimate similar to the one given in Theorem III.2.10 in the framework of the dual space W −1,p (Ω). For reasons of simplicity and because it is sufficient for our purposes in this book (i.e., for the proof of the Neˇcas inequality in Chapter IV; see Remark IV.1.2), we only consider here the case of constant coefficient differential operators.

2. Sobolev spaces on Lipschitz domains

163

Theorem III.2.27. Let k ∈ N∗ . For any j ∈ {1, . . . , d}, let αj ∈ Rk be a constant vector and let D : (W −1,p (Ω))k → D (Ω) be the differential operator defined by d  ∂ Df = (αj · f ), ∀f ∈ (W −1,p (Ω))k . ∂x j j=1 For any f ∈ (W −1,p (Ω))k , we have Sε Df − DSε f W −1,p −−−→ 0. ε→0

In particular, if Df ∈ W −1,p (Ω) we have DSε f −−−→ Df in W −1,p (Ω). ε→0

Proof. Let Φ ∈ D(Ω) be a test function. When f is smooth, we can use the computations done during the proof of Theorem III.2.10, and find that  (Sε Df − DSε f )(y)Φ(y) dx Ω  Rε,0 (y) · Φ(y) dy = Ω

 =

η(z) B

n   i=0

d 



∂(βε ψi ) f (x) αj · Φ ∂xj Ω j=1

 (x − ενi + εz) dx dz,

the last equality being obtained by performing the change of variable z = (y − x + ενi )/ε. Note that there is no term Rε,j in this formula because we assume here that the coefficients αj are constant. By density of Cc∞ (Ω) in W −1,p (Ω), the above formula finally gives, for any f ∈ W −1,p (Ω), Sε Df − DSε f, ΦW −1,p ,W 1,p 0   "  n !  d  ∂(βε ψi ) f, (· − ενi + εz) = η(z) αj · Φ dz.  ∂xj B W −1,p ,W 1,p i=0 j=1 0

We introduce Rε : (W −1,p (Ω))k → W −1,p (Ω) the map which associates to any f ∈ (W −1,p (Ω))k the right-hand side of this formula. We first observe that  d  N    ∂(βε ψi )  Φ  Rε f, ΦW −1,p ,W 1,p ≤ Cf W −1,p  0 ∂xj W 1,p i=1 j=1 0

≤ Cf W −1,p ΦW 1,p , 0

so that, by (III.40), we get

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

164

Rε f W −1,p ≤ Cf W −1,p . Moreover, if f ∈ (Cc∞ (Ω))k , we know by Theorem III.2.10 that Sε Df − DSε f converges to 0 in Lp (Ω) and then Rε f W −1,p −−−→ 0, ∀f ∈ (C ∞ (Ω))k . ε→0

We can now conclude that Rε f converges to 0 for any f ∈ (W −1,p (Ω))k by using the density of (Cc∞ (Ω))k in (W −1,p (Ω))k that we just proved before (see Remark III.2.14). In the case where Df ∈ W −1,p (Ω), we know from Proposition III.2.26 that Sε Df converges towards Df in W −1,p (Ω) so that we can conclude that DSε f also converges towards Df in W −1,p (Ω). 

2.7 Translation estimates Definition III.2.28. Let h ∈ Rd . The translation operator along h, referred to as τh , is defined for any measurable function f on Rd by   τh (f ) = x → f (x + h) . We also define the difference operator δh for any function f by δh (f ) = τh (f ) − f. We recall the notation Ωξ = {x ∈ Ω, δ(x) > ξ} that we introduced at the beginning of Section 1. Theorem III.2.29. Let Ω be any open set in Rd and 1 ≤ p ≤ +∞. For any h ∈ Rd and any f ∈ W 1,p (Ω) we have τh f − f Lp (Ω2|h| ) ≤ |h|∇f Lp (Ω) . Proof. Let h ∈ Rd with |h| small enough such that Ω|h| is nonempty. The case p = +∞ comes directly from Proposition III.2.9. We assume now that p is finite. By using the same strategy as in the proof of Lemma II.2.37, we can find a function ϕ ∈ C ∞ (Rd ) such that 0 ≤ ϕ ≤ 1, ϕ|Ω|h| = 1, and ϕ|Ωc = 0. We set g = f¯ϕ and we observe that g ∈ W 1,p (Rd ). Hence, there exists a sequence (gε )ε ⊂ D(Rd ) which converges towards g in W 1,p (Rd ). For any x ∈ Rd we have  1 gε (x + h) − gε (x) = ∇gε (x + th) · h dt, 0

2. Sobolev spaces on Lipschitz domains

165

and then



1

|gε (x + h) − gε (x)|p ≤ |h|p

|∇gε (x + th)|p dt, 0

so that by integration on Ω2|h| , we find 



1



|gε (x + h) − gε (x)| dx ≤ |h| p

|∇gε (x + th)| dx

p

p

Ω2|h|

0

dt.

Ω2|h|

For any t ∈ [0, 1], and any x ∈ Ω2|h| we have x + th ∈ Ω|h| so that we finally get τh gε − gε pLp (Ω2|h| ) ≤ |h|p ∇gε pLp (Ω|h| ) . We can now pass to the limit when ε → 0 and find that τh g − gpLp (Ω2|h| ) ≤ |h|p ∇gpLp (Ω|h| ) . Since g = f on Ω|h| we have obtained τh f − f Lp (Ω2|h| ) ≤ |h|∇f Lp (Ω|h| ) ≤ |h|∇f Lp (Ω) .  In fact, one can characterise Sobolev spaces by means of translation operators. We first consider only the case of the whole space Ω = Rd . We address the problem of such characterisations for Sobolev spaces on bounded domains in Section 3.5. 

Lemma III.2.30. Let 1 ≤ p ≤ +∞, f ∈ Lp (Rd ), g ∈ Lp (Rd ), and h ∈ Rd . We have   τh (f )g dx = f τ−h (g) dx, Rd

and

Rd

 Rd

 δh (f )g dx =

Rd

f δ−h (g) dx.

Proof. Straightforward by using an affine change of variable.  Lemma III.2.31. Let 1 ≤ p ≤ +∞ + ∞, k ≥ 0, and f ∈ W k,p (Rd ). For any h ∈ Rd , we have δh f W k−1,p ≤ |h| ∇f W k−1,p ≤ |h| f W k,p . Proof. • In the case k ≥ 1, the result is nothing but a consequence of Theorem III.2.29 because the boundary of Rd is empty.

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

166

• Let us now deal with the slightly more specific case where k = 0. This concerns an inequality with a negative Sobolev norm, thus it is convenient to  argue by duality. Hence, let g ∈ W 1,p (Rd ) and, according to the preceding lemma, we have   δh (f )g dx = f δ−h g dx. Rd

Hence



Rd

Rd

δh (f )g dx ≤ f Lp δ−h gLp ≤ |h|f Lp gW 1,p ,

from the case k = 1 applied to the function g. This inequality, valid for  any function g in W 1,p (Rd ), proves the result.  Let (e1 , . . . , ed ) be the canonical basis of Rd , k be a nonnegative integer, and 1 ≤ p ≤ ∞. For f ∈ W k,p (Rd ), we define |||f |||k+1,p = f W k +

d   i=1

1 δhei f W k,p 0 3, then p∗ = +∞ and therefore $ # 2 1 1 1 ,1 , = =1− ∈ t1 q p 3 $ # 3 t1 ∈ 1, . 2

or even

In this case, we therefore have Lt2 (Ω) ⊂ W −1,t1 (Ω), and by bringing together the results obtained on f0 , f1 , and f2 , we indeed have uv ∈ W −1,t1 (Ω). – If p = 3, q = 32 , and p∗ is finite and as large as we wish, then 1 1 2 = ∗+ t1 p 3 where t1 is any value strictly less than 32 and uv is indeed in W −1,σ (Ω) for all σ < t1 . – If p < 3, then t1 = 32 and in this case Lt2 (Ω) = L1 (Ω) is only embedded in the W −1,σ (Ω) for all σ < 32 . • If now t2 ∈]1, 3[, then ∗

Lt2 (Ω) ⊂ W −1,t2 (Ω), and therefore ∗



uv ∈ W −1,t2 (Ω) + W −1,t1 (Ω) = W −1,min(t2 ,t1 ) (Ω). However, t2 < 3, hence we have

2. Sobolev spaces on Lipschitz domains

179

1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 = − = − + ≤ ∗+ = , ∗ t2 t2 3 p 3 q p q t1 hence t∗2 ≥ t1 which proves the result. • Finally, if t2 ≥ 3 then Lt2 (Ω) ⊂ W −1,∞ (Ω) ⊂ W −1,t1 (Ω), which allows the conclusion to be reached again. 

2.9 Poincar´ e and Hardy inequalities In the first part of this section we present two Poincar´e-type inequalities. The idea is that, in a bounded domain, if we possess a minimum of a priori information on a function u (essentially saying that u cannot be a nonzero constant), then the W 1,p -norm of u is equivalent to the Lp -norm of the gradient of u. The first result is valid when we control the trace of u on a nontrivial part of the boundary and the second result when we control the mean value of u on Ω. Note that, with the same strategy of proof (i.e., by using a compactness argument) we prove similar results in slightly different contexts in Chapter IV (see Propositions IV.1.7 and IV.7.7). The second part of this section is dedicated to the proof of the Hardy inequality, which says that if u ∈ W01,p (Ω) (this means that u = 0 on the boundary in some sense; see Remark III.2.8), then the function u/δ belongs to Lp (Ω), where δ is the distance to the boundary function. Proposition III.2.38 (Generalised Poincar´ e inequality). Let Ω be a bounded, connected, Lipschitz domain of Rd . Let Γ1 be a part of the boundary ∂Ω with a nonzero surface measure. For 1 ≤ p < +∞, we define 8 9 1,p W0,Γ (Ω) = u ∈ W 1,p (Ω), γ0 (u)|Γ1 = 0 . 1 1,p There exists a C > 0 such that, for all functions u ∈ W0,Γ (Ω) we have: 1

uLp ≤ C∇uLp ; that is, in other words, uW 1,p ≤ C  ∇uLp . Proof. From Section 1.2.3, the fact that Γ1 has a nonzero surface measure means that

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

180

 1Γ1 dσ > 0.

(III.49)

∂Ω

Let us assume that the first inequality is not satisfied; there then exists a 1,p sequence (un )n of W0,Γ (Ω) such that: 1 un Lp ≥ n∇un Lp (Ω) . By homogeneity, we can assume that un Lp has value 1, which then implies that ∇un Lp ≤ 1/n. Hence, the sequence (un )n is bounded in W 1,p (Ω) and there exists a subsequence (unk )k which weakly converges towards u in W 1,p (Ω). The embedding of W 1,p (Ω) in Lp (Ω) is compact, therefore we know that this sequence strongly converges in Lp (Ω) (Proposition II.3.4). Hence, at the limit, u satisfies uLp = 1. (III.50) Since (∇un )n converges towards ∇u in the sense of distributions and towards 0 in Lp (Ω), we therefore have ∇u = 0 in the sense of distributions. Since the open set Ω is connected, we can deduce from Lemma II.2.44 that u is a constant referred to as u ¯ ∈ R. Moreover we have   u ¯ 1Γ1 dσ = 1Γ1 γ0 (u) dσ = 0, ∂Ω

∂Ω

and thus u ¯ = 0 thanks to (III.49). Therefore, we proved that u = 0. The contradiction with (III.50) then follows directly.  This result is particularly useful in the case Γ1 = ∂Ω. It implies that u → ∇uLp (Ω) is a norm on W01,p (Ω) which is equivalent to the W 1,p (Ω)norm. Proposition III.2.39 (Poincar´ e–Wirtinger inequality). Let Ω be a connected, bounded Lipschitz domain and 1 ≤ p < +∞. There exists C > 0 such that, for all functions u of W 1,p (Ω), we have      u − 1  u(x) dx   1,p ≤ C∇uLp , |Ω| Ω W or equivalently    1 . u(x) dx uLp ≤ C ∇uLp + |Ω| Ω Proof. The proof is entirely similar to that of the preceding proposition. If the inequality above is false, then there exists a sequence (un )n of functions of W 1,p (Ω) such that:

2. Sobolev spaces on Lipschitz domains

 un Lp ≥ n ∇un Lp

181

  1 . + u (x) dx n |Ω| Ω

By homogeneity, we can assume that un Lp = 1. Hence, the sequence (un )n is a bounded sequence of W 1,p (Ω) from which we can extract a subsequence (unk )k which is weakly converging in W 1,p (Ω) and strongly converging in Lp (Ω) (by compactness of the Sobolev embedding) towards a certain function u of W 1,p (Ω). However, since ∇un Lp ≤ 1/n, the limit u satisfies ∇u = 0 in the sense of distributions, which is equivalent to saying via Lemma II.2.44, that u is constant because Ω is connected. This constant is necessarily zero because at the limit we have  1 u(x) dx = 0. |Ω| Ω This contradicts the fact that un Lp = 1 for all n.



Proposition III.2.40 (Hardy inequality in W01,p (Ω)). Let Ω ⊂ Rd be a Lipschitz domain in Rd with compact boundary and 1 < p < +∞. There exists a C > 0, such that for any function u belonging to W01,p (Ω), one has u     p ≤ C∇uLp , δ L where we recall that δ(x) = d(x, ∂Ω) is the distance from any point x ∈ Ω to the boundary. Let us observe once more that this result does not hold when p = 1. Proof. • Let us first prove the result for the flat half-space Ω = Rd+ . It is enough to prove the inequality for functions u ∈ D(Rd+ ). The general claim follows by the usual density argument. Since u vanishes on ∂Ω = Rd−1 × {0}, for any x = (¯ x, xd ) ∈ Rd+ , we have  xd x, 0) ∂u u(¯ x, xd ) − u(¯ 1 u(¯ x, xd ) = = (¯ x, s) ds. xd xd xd 0 ∂s By using Lemma II.4.7, we deduce p p  +∞  +∞ u(¯ ∂u x, xd ) dxd ≤ C (¯ xd ∂s x, s) ds. 0 0 We integrate this formula with respect to x ¯ ∈ Rd−1 to get   u(x) p p dx ≤ C |∇u| dx, xd d Rd R + +

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

182

and the claim is proved because xd = d(x, Rd−1 × {0}), for any x ∈ Rd+ . • We deduce now the result for any Lipschitz half-space Ω = Ha by using the Lipschitz diffeomorphism Ta that we introduced in Proposition III.1.3, and Theorem III.2.13. For u ∈ W01,p (Ha ) we apply the Hardy inequality in the flat half-space to v = u ◦ Ta ∈ W01,p (Rd+ ). It follows that    u ◦ Ta     xd  p d ≤ C∇(u ◦ Ta )Lp (Rd+ ) . L (R ) +

Since ∇(u ◦ Ta ) = t (∇Ta ).(∇u) ◦ Ta and ∇Ta is bounded, a simple change of variables gives that the right-hand side of this inequality is bounded by ∇uLp (Ha ) . We may also perform a change of variables in the left-hand side and we get     u   ≤ C∇uLp (Ha ) .  (T −1 (.))  a d Lp (Ha ) In order to prove the result we just have to show that there is some α > 0 such that |(Ta−1 (x))d | ≤ αδ(x). In other words we have to show that |yd | ≤ αδ(Ta (y)), ∀y ∈ Rd+ . Let x ¯ ∈ Rd−1 we have |Ta (y) − (¯ x, a(¯ x))| = |(¯ y−x ¯, yd + aγ (¯ y , yd ) − a(¯ x))| ≥ |¯ y−x ¯| + |yd + aγ (¯ y , yd ) − a(¯ x)|. Let ξ > 0 be determined later. – For x ¯ such that |¯ y−x ¯| ≥ ξyd , we obviously deduce |T (y) − (¯ x, a(¯ x))| ≥ ξyd . – For x ¯ such that |¯ y−x ¯| ≤ ξyd , we get |T (y) − (¯ x, a(¯ x))| ≥ yd − |aγ (¯ y , yd ) − a(¯ y )| − |a(¯ y ) − a(¯ x)| y−x ¯| ≥ yd − γ Lip(a)Mη yd − Lip(a)|¯ ≥ (1 − γ Lip(a)Mη − Lip(a)ξ) yd . If we choose ξ such that γ Lip(a)Mη + Lip(a)ξ < 1, we see that we obtained |T (y) − (¯ x, a(¯ x))| ≥ αyd , ∀¯ x ∈ Rd−1 ,

2. Sobolev spaces on Lipschitz domains

183

with α = min (ξ, 1 − γ Lip(a)Mη − Lip(a)ξ) . This gives exactly δ(T (y)) ≥ αyd , and the claim is proved. • We consider a finite open covering (Ui )1≤i≤N of ∂Ω as given by Theorem III.1.4. We also further assume that for each 1 ≤ i ≤ N we have δ(x) = d(x, ∂Ω) = d(x, Rσi ∂Hai ), ∀x ∈ Ui ∩ Ω.

(III.51)

This property can always be achieved by considering a finer open covering, if necessary. We finally consider an open set U0 ⊂ U0 ⊂ Ω such that (Ui )0≤i≤N is an open covering of Ω, and we choose an associated partition of unity (ψi )0≤i≤N . N For any u ∈ D(Ω), we write u = uψ0 + i=1 uψi . – Since uψ0 is compactly supported in U0 , and U0 ⊂ Ω, we have inf δ > 0, U0

so that

     uψ0   uψ0  1     = ≤ uLp (Ω) .  δ  p  δ  p inf U0 δ L (Ω) L (U0 )

– Since uψi is compactly supported in Ui ∩ Ω = (Rσi Hai ) ∩ Ui , we can apply to uψi the Hardy inequality we have proved above    uψi    ≤ Ci ∇(uψi )Lp (Rσi Hai ) ,  δi  p L (Rσ Ha ) i

i

where δi (x) = d(x, Rσi ∂Hai ). By using Property (III.51), we deduce that      uψi   uψi      = ≤ Ci (uLp (Ω) + ∇uLp (Ω) ).  δ  p δi Lp (Rσ Ha ) L (Ω) i

i

Summing all the inequalities above we finally obtain u   ≤ C(uLp (Ω) + ∇uLp (Ω) ),   p δ L (Ω) and the conclusion follows by using the Poincar´e inequality of Proposition III.2.38 and the density of D(Ω) in W01,p (Ω). We sometimes need the following corollary of the Hardy inequality.

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

184

Corollary III.2.41. With the same assumptions as in the previous proposition, assume that f is a function such that f ∈ L∞ (Ω) and that δ∇f ∈ L∞ (Ω); then for any u ∈ W01,p (Ω) we have f u ∈ W01,p (Ω) and f uW 1,p ≤ CuW 1,p , 0

0

where C does not depend on u. Proof. As usual, by a density argument, it is enough to prove the result for any u ∈ D(Ω). Since f is bounded, it is clear that f uLp ≤ f L∞ uLp . Moreover, we have ∇(f u) = f (∇u) + (∇f )u = f (∇u) + δ(∇f )(u/δ). Since f and δ∇f are bounded and using the Hardy inequality, we find that ∇(uf )Lp ≤ C (f L∞ + δ∇f L∞ ∇uLp ) , and the claim is proved. 

2.10 Domains of first-order differential operators Let D be a first-order differential operator as defined in (III.24) whose coefficients αj belong to W 1,q(Ω), 1 ≤ q ≤ ∞. For any 1 ≤ p ≤ +∞ such that p ≥ q, we observe that D (W 1,p (Ω))k ⊂ Lr (Ω) where r ∈ [1, +∞] is defined by 1/p + 1/q = 1/r. It is then natural to consider D as an unbounded operator from (Lp (Ω))k into Lr (Ω) with a domain defined by p,r WD (Ω) = {u ∈ (Lp (Ω))k , Du ∈ Lr (Ω)},

and which is equipped with the graph norm p,r uWDp,r = uLp + DuLr , ∀u ∈ WD (Ω).

Theorem III.2.42. With the same assumption as in Theorem III.2.10, the p,r space WD (Ω) is a Banach space which contains (W 1,p (Ω))k . p,r Moreover, if p < +∞, the space (Cc∞ (Ω))k is dense in WD (Ω). Proof. p,r Any Cauchy sequence (un )n in WD (Ω) is such that (un )n and (Dun )n p k are Cauchy sequences in (L (Ω)) and Lr (Ω), respectively. Therefore, (un )n converges towards some u in (Lp (Ω))k and (Dun )n converges towards some g in Lr (Ω).

2. Sobolev spaces on Lipschitz domains

185

We observe that (Dun )n converges to Du in the sense of distributions. This implies that Du = g ∈ Lr (Ω) and finally that (un )n converges towards p,r u in WD (Ω). Proposition III.2.8 and Theorem III.2.10 exactly imply that the function p,r Sε u ∈ (Cc∞ (Ω))k converges towards u in WD (Ω) as ε goes to 0.  For any x ∈ Ω, we denote by α(x) the k × d matrix whose columns are the αj (x), j = 1, . . . , d. Theorem III.2.43. Let us assume that 1 < p ≤ +∞ and q ≥ p with (p, q) = (+∞, +∞). We define t ∈ [1, +∞[ by   1 1 1 1 . = min  ,  + p r d t p,r For any t > t, there is a unique linear continuous operator from WD (Ω)   −1/t ,t into W (∂Ω), referred to as γα.ν , such that

γα.ν (u) = γ0 (u) · (γ0 (α).ν) , ∀u ∈ (W 1,p (Ω))k .

(III.52)

Moreover, we have the following generalised Stokes formula  (Du)ϕ dx + Ω

  d

(u · αj )

Ω j=1

∂ϕ dx = γα.ν u, γ0 ϕW −1/t ,t ,W 1−1/t,t , (III.53) ∂xj

p,r for any u ∈ WD (Ω) and ϕ ∈ W 1,t (Ω). Moreover the same result holds with t = t except in the two cases q = d or q = p > d.

Proof. For any u ∈ (Cc∞ (Ω))k and any ϕ ∈ W 1,∞ (Ω) = C 0,1 (Ω), the Stokes formula (III.35) gives 

  d

∂ϕ (Du)ϕ dx + (u · αj ) dx = ∂xj Ω Ω j=1

 ϕu · (γ0 (α).ν) dσ.

(III.54)

∂Ω

p,r For any u ∈ WD (Ω) we define

Tε u = (Sε u) · (γ0 (α).ν) ∈ Lq (∂Ω). It is clear that, for u ∈ W 1,p (Ω), we have Tε u −−−→ γ0 (u) · (γ0 (α).ν) in ε→0

L1 (∂Ω), for instance. Let θ ∈ D(Rd ) be a smooth function such that θ = 1 on ∂Ω. Let u ∈ p,r WD (Ω) and ϕ ∈ Cc∞ (Ω); we deduce from (III.54) that

186



∂Ω

 (Tε1 u − Tε2 u)ϕ dσ =

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

∂Ω

(Tε1 u − Tε2 u)θϕ dσ

≤DSε1 u − DSε2 uLr θϕLr +

d 

(Sε1 u − Sε2 u) · αj (|θ| + |∇θ|)Lt ϕW 1,t .

j=1

(III.55) Notice that, by definition of t we have 1 1 1 1 1 − < − ≤ , t d d r t and thus, since θϕ is supported in a fixed compact of Rd , we have θϕLr ≤ CθϕW 1,t ≤ C  ϕW 1,t . By density of Cc∞ (Ω) into W 1,t (Ω) (because t is finite), the estimate (III.55), proves that Tε1 u − Tε2 uW −1/t ,t (∂Ω) ≤ CDSε1 u − DSε2 uLr +C

d 

(Sε1 u − Sε2 u) · αj (|θ| + |∇θ|)Lt .

j=1

By definition of t, we have 0 < 1/p − 1/t < 1, therefore we can introduce s ∈]1, +∞[ such that 1/s = 1/p − 1/t. Using once more the assumption t > t and the definition of t we see that 1 1 1 1 1 − < − = , q d p t s and thus, since |θ| + |∇θ| is supported in a fixed compact set, we deduce that αj (|θ| + |∇θ|) ∈ Ls (Ω) for any j with αj (|θ| + |∇θ|)Ls ≤ Cαj W 1,q . By using Proposition III.2.8 (because s is finite), we know that (Sε u)·αj (|θ|+  |∇θ|) is convergent in Lt because we have 1/t = 1/s + 1/p by definition of s. We finally deduce from all the above estimates that (Tε u)ε is a Cauchy   sequence in W −1/t ,t (∂Ω). We define γα.ν (u) to be its limit. It is clear that γα.ν is linear and the same estimates as above show that it is continuous from   p,r WD (Ω) into W −1/t ,t (∂Ω). In the case t = t, it may happen that some Sobolev embeddings that we  used above (namely W 1,t ⊂ Lr and W 1,q ⊂ Ls ) are in fact critical L∞ embeddings which do not hold.

2. Sobolev spaces on Lipschitz domains

187 

• The fact that the Sobolev embedding W 1,t ⊂ Lr is critical means that r = +∞ and t = d. This means that q = p and p ≥ d. • The fact that the Sobolev embedding W 1,q ⊂ Ls is critical means that q = d and s = +∞ (those two equalities being in fact equivalent).  p,r Definition III.2.44. We define WD,0 (Ω) to be the closure of (D(Ω))k in p,r WD (Ω). p,r Theorem III.2.45. Let u ∈ WD (Ω). We have the following equivalences p,r p,r u ∈ WD,0 (Ω) ⇐⇒ u ∈ Ker γα.ν ⇐⇒ u ¯ ∈ WD (Rd ).

Notice that in this statement we have extended the definition of the operator D to the whole space Rd . This is possible by applying the extension operator introduced in Section 2.4 to the coefficients αj . Proof. • By construction, it is clear that γα.ν (u) = u · (α.ν) = 0 on ∂Ω for any u ∈ (D(Ω))k . The operator γα.ν is continuous, therefore we deduce that p,r it vanishes identically on WD,0 (Ω), which is the closure of (D(Ω))k . This p,r proves that WD,0 (Ω) ⊂ Ker γα.ν . • Let us consider u ∈ Ker γα.ν . By the Stokes formula (III.53) we have, for  any ϕ ∈ W 1,r (Ω),  (Du)ϕ dx +

  d

Ω

(u · αj )

Ω j=1

∂ϕ dx = 0, ∂xj

and thus, by extending u and Du by zero to the whole space Rd , we get 

 Du ϕ dx +

Rd

d 

Rd j=1

(¯ u · αj )

∂ϕ dx = 0, ∂xj

for any ϕ ∈ D(Rd ). This formula exactly means that D¯ u, in the sense of distributions on Rd , is equal to Du which belongs to Lr (Rd ). We thus have p,r proved that u ¯ ∈ WD (Rd ). p,r • Let us finally assume that u is such that u ¯ ∈ WD (Rd ). We can thus use Theorem III.2.12 to affirm that the family (Sε u)ε ⊂ (D(Ω))k converges p,r p,r towards u in WD (Ω), so that u belongs to WD,0 (Ω).  By applying the above results to the elementary differential operators ∂xi (in which case we have q = +∞ and r = p) we get the following. Theorem III.2.46. Let Ω be a Lipschitz domain with compact boundary and 1 ≤ p < +∞. We have the equalities

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

188 d :

W 1,p (Ω) =

W∂p,p (Ω), x

(III.56)

W∂p,p (Ω). x ,0

(III.57)

i

i=1

W01,p (Ω) =

d :

i

i=1

Moreover, for any u ∈ W 1,p (Ω), we have γ0 (u) νi = γνi (u), ∀i ∈ {1, . . . , d}, and γ0 (u) =

d 

(III.58)

γνi (u)νi .

(III.59)

i=1

Finally, for any u ∈ W 1,p (Ω), we have u ∈ W01,p (Ω) ⇐⇒ u ∈ Ker γ0 ⇐⇒ u ¯ ∈ W 1,p (Rd ). Proof. • The first equality is nothing but the definition of the Sobolev space W 1,p (Ω). • For any u ∈ W01,p (Ω), there is a sequence (un )n ⊂ D(Ω) which converges towards u in W 1,p (Ω). In particular we have un −−−−→ u in Lp (Ω) and n→∞

(Ω) ∂xi un −−−−→ ∂xi u in Lp (Ω), which implies that un −−−−→ u in W∂p,p x n→∞

n→∞

i

(Ω) for any i. for any i ∈ {1, . . . , d}. This proves that u ∈ W∂p,p xi ,0 p,p Conversely, if u ∈ W∂x ,0 (Ω), Theorem III.2.45 shows that u ¯ ∈ W∂p,p (Ω) xi ,0 i  so that, by Theorem III.2.12, the family (Sε u)ε ⊂ D(Ω) converges to u in W∂p,p (Ω). This being true for any i ∈ {1, . . . , d}, we conclude that (Sε u)ε x i

converges to u in W 1,p (Ω). This proves that u ∈ W01,p (Ω). Notice that it is absolutely fundamental here that the same mollifying p,r operator Sε can be used in all the spaces WD,0 (Ω). • We apply (III.52) with D = ∂xi , that is αj = δi,j . We exactly obtain (III.58). Formula (III.59) comes from the fact that |ν| = 1 almost everyd where, which means that i=1 νi2 = 1 almost everywhere on ∂Ω. It follows from (III.58) and (III.59) that Ker γ0 =

d : i=1

Ker γνi =

d :

W∂p,p (Ω) = W01,p (Ω). x ,0 i

i=1

The characterisation of W01,p (Ω) which uses the extension u ¯ of u comes from Theorem III.2.45, (III.56) and (III.57). 

3. Calculus near the boundary of domains

189

3 Calculus near the boundary of domains 3.1 Local charts description of the boundary From now on, we consider a given domain Ω of Rd of class C k+1,1 , k ≥ 0, with compact boundary. An orientation in Rd is chosen. For reasons of clarity, in the sequel of this chapter and contrary to the convention in other chapters of this book, we denote by ·, · the usual Euclidean scalar product of Rd (and of Rd−1 ). To simplify the notation a little, we set Γ = ∂Ω. From the implicit function theorem and using Definition III.1.2, we can state the following. Definition and Proposition III.3.1. For any point σ ∈ Γ, there exists a convex open set Uσ of Rd−1 containing 0, an open set Vσ of Rd containing σ, and a function ϕσ : Uσ → Vσ of class C k+1,1 such that ϕσ (Uσ ) = Vσ ∩ Γ, ϕσ (0) = σ, and |u1 − u2 | ≤ C|ϕσ (u1 ) − ϕσ (u2 )|, ∀u1 , u2 ∈ Uσ ,

(III.60)

for some C > 0 independent of σ. The pair (Uσ , ϕσ ) is referred to as a local chart of the manifold Γ around the point σ. Furthermore, we can choose the maps associated with the various points of the manifold Γ in a compatible way; that is, that if σ1 and σ2 are in Γ def and such that Γσ1 σ2 = Vσ1 ∩ Vσ2 ∩ Γ = ∅ then the change of map function def

−1 −1 Φ21 = ϕ−1 σ1 ◦ ϕσ2 defined on ϕσ2 (Γσ1 σ2 ) and with values in ϕσ1 (Γσ1 σ2 ) is a k+1,1 C diffeomorphism. Finally, since Γ is compact, we can describe the whole manifold Γ by a finite number of charts.

We therefore possess local coordinates of the manifold Γ in the neighborhood of any point σ. In particular, the family of vectors of Rd defined by (∂ϕσ /∂ui )1≤i≤d−1 is linearly independent and generates an hyperplane of Rd called the vector tangent hyperplane Γ at the point σ and denoted as Tσ Γ. We easily see that this hyperplane does not depend on the local map chosen around σ. For any chart (U, ϕ), we set Nϕ (u) =

∂ϕ ∂ϕ (u) ∧ · · · ∧ (u), ∂u1 ∂ud−1

so that the outward unit normal ν can be expressed in the considered chart as follows Nϕ (u) ν(ϕ(u)) = εϕ , |Nϕ (u)|

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

190

where εϕ ∈ {−1, 1} is a sign which depends on the orientation. It follows in particular, since ϕ ∈ C k+1,1 , that ν ◦ ϕ ∈ C k,1 (U ). At each point σ = ϕ(u) (or at almost each point in the case k = 0), we can define the endomorphism dν(σ) : Tσ Γ → Tσ Γ by the formula dν(σ).

∂ ∂ϕ (u) = (ν ◦ ϕ)(u). ∂ui ∂ui

The fact that dν(σ) maps Tσ Γ into itself comes from the fact that |ν| = 1. Indeed, we have ! "  ∂ϕ ∂  |ν ◦ ϕ|2 = 2 dν(σ). (u), ν ◦ ϕ(u) , 0= ∂ui ∂ui so that dν(σ).(∂ϕ/∂ui )(u) is orthogonal to Nϕ (u) which proves that it belongs to the tangent space Tσ Γ. Definition III.3.2. We call the first fundamental quadratic form of the manifold Γ in the chart (U, ϕ), the quadratic form in Rd−1 associated with the matrix ! " ∂ϕ ∂ϕ g(u) = (gij (u))1≤i,j≤d−1 = (u), (u) , ∂ui ∂uj 1≤i,j≤d−1 for any u ∈ U . This is the Gram matrix associated with the basis of the tangent plane canonically associated with the chart being considered. Notice that g is of class C k,1 in U . The first fundamental quadratic form allows us to compute the norm of a tangent vector to Γ in terms of its coordinates in the basis of Tσ Γ issued from the chart. More precisely, we have the following proposition. Proposition III.3.3. Let σ ∈ Γ, (U, ϕ) be a chart of the neighborhood of σ and u ∈ U such that σ = ϕ(u). d−1 Let F = i=1 fi (∂ϕ/∂ui )(u) be a vector of Tσ Γ. We denote as f = (fi )i the vector of the coordinates of F in the basis of Tσ Γ associated with the map (U, ϕ). We then have |F |2 = g(u).f, f  = t f.g(u).f, and f = g(u)−1 .

! F,

" ∂ϕ (u) . ∂ui 1≤i≤d−1

Corollary III.3.4. The first fundamental form is positive definite. Therefore, the matrix g(u) is invertible and its determinant is strictly positive for any u ∈ U.

3. Calculus near the boundary of domains

191

In all that follows we denote the coefficients of the inverse matrix g(u)−1 by

g(u)−1 = (gij (u))1≤i,j≤d−1 .

The definition of the first fundamental form depends explicitly on the chart in which it is considered. Nevertheless, one can show that if (U1 , ϕ1 ), (U2 , ϕ2 ) are two charts around the same point of Γ, the two associated first fundamental forms g1 and g2 are related through the formula g2 = t (∇Φ21 ) · g1 · (∇Φ21 ), where Φ21 = ϕ−1 1 ◦ ϕ2 is the change of variable between the two charts.

3.2 Distance to the boundary. Projection on the boundary We recall that Ω is a domain of Rd of class C k+1,1 , k ≥ 0, with compact boundary. In this section we investigate further the regularity properties of the signed distance function δ defined in (II.1). We consider the locally Lipschitz continuous map ψ0 : (σ, s) = Γ × R → σ − sν(σ) ∈ Rd . We are going to show that, through this map ψ0 , one can use the coordinates (σ, s), that we call tangent/normal coordinates, to describe points in a suitable neighborhood of Γ. We recall that we have defined Oγ = {x ∈ Ω, δ(x) < γ}. Theorem III.3.5. There exists a γ > 0 and a C > 0 such that |σ1 − σ2 | + |s1 − s2 | ≤C|ψ0 (σ1 , s1 ) − ψ0 (σ2 , s2 )|, ∀σ1 , σ2 ∈ Γ, ∀s1 , s2 ∈] − γ, γ[,

(III.61)

and moreover ψ0 (Γ×]0, γ[) = Oγ , c

ψ0 (Γ×] − γ, 0[) ⊂ Ω . This result shows that ψ0 is, at least, a Lipschitz diffeomorphism from Γ×]0, γ[ onto Oγ . Proof. We recall that Γ can be covered by a finite number of charts (Ui , ϕi ), i = 1, . . . , N , of class C k+1,1 .

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

192

• We first observe that there exists a γ > 0 such that for any σ1 , σ2 ∈ Γ such that |σ1 − σ2 | ≤ γ, there exists a chart (Ui , ϕi ) such that σ1 , and σ2 both belong to ϕi (Ui ). Then we can write σ1 = ϕi (u1 ), σ2 = ϕi (u2 ), and since ϕi ∈ C 1,1 (Ui ) and Ui is convex we can write  σ2 − σ1 , ν(σ1 ) =

1

;

< (∇ϕi )(u1 + t(u2 − u2 )).(u1 − u2 ), ν(ϕ(u1 )) dt.

0

Since (∇ϕi )(u1 +t(u2 −u2 )).(u1 −u2 ) is orthogonal to ν(ϕi (u1 +t(u2 −u2 ))) we can write σ2 − σ1 , ν(σ1 )  1 < ; = (∇ϕi )(u1 +t(u2 −u2 )).(u1 −u2 ), ν(ϕ(u1 +t(u2 −u1 ))−ν(ϕ(u1 )) dt, 0

and then |σ2 − σ1 , ν(σ1 )| ≤ ∇ϕi ∞ Lip(ν ◦ ϕi )|u1 − u2 |2 , and finally, using (III.60), we find that |σ2 − σ1 , ν(σ1 )| ≤ C|σ1 − σ2 |2 .

(III.62)

Since Γ is compact, this inequality remains true even if |σ1 − σ2 | ≥ γ with a possibly different C. • Let us prove (III.61) by contradiction. Assume that, for any n ≥ 1, there exists σ1n , σ2n ∈ Γ, sn1 , sn2 ∈ R such that sn1 → 0, sn2 → 0 and 1 (|σ1n − σ2n | + |sn1 − sn2 |) > |ψ0 (σ1n , sn1 ) − ψ0 (σ2n , sn2 )|. n

(III.63)

Γ is compact, therefore we can assume that (σ1n )n and (σ2n )n are convergent towards σ1 ∈ Γ, σ2 ∈ Γ, respectively. Passing to the limit in (III.63) shows that ϕ(σ1 , 0) = ϕ(σ2 , 0) so that σ1 = σ2 . We set σ = σ1 = σ2 . • Computing ψ0 (σ1n , sn1 )−ψ0 (σ2n , sn2 ), ν(σ2n ) and using the fact that |ν| = 1, we find that sn2 − sn1 =sn1 ν(σ1n ) − ν(σ2n ), ν(σ2n ) + σ2n − σ1n , ν(σ2n ) + ψ0 (σ1n , sn1 ) − ψ0 (σ2n , sn2 ), ν(σ2n ). Moreover, since |ν(σ1n )| = |ν(σ2n )| = 1, we have 1 ν(σ1n ) − ν(σ2n ), ν(σ2n ) = − ν(σ1n ) − ν(σ2n ), ν(σ1n ) − ν(σ2n ), 2 and therefore by using (III.62) and (III.63), we deduce that

3. Calculus near the boundary of domains

193

|sn1 − sn2 | ≤ C  |σ1n − σ2n |2 + |ψ0 (σ1n , sn1 ) − ψ0 (σ2n , sn2 )| 1 1 ≤ C  |σ1n − σ2n |2 + |sn1 − sn2 | + |σ1n − σ2n |, n n and then, for n large enough, |sn1 − sn2 | ≤ C  |σ1n − σ2n |2 +

1 n |σ − σ2n |. n 1

(III.64)

• Computing now ψ0 (σ1n , sn1 ) − ψ0 (σ2n , sn2 ) and using (III.63) we get |σ2n − σ1n | = |ψ0 (σ2n , sn2 ) − ψ0 (σ1n , sn1 )| + |sn2 ν(σ2n ) − sn1 ν(σ1n )|, 1 1 ≤ |sn1 − sn2 | + |σ1n − σ2n | + |sn1 − sn2 | + |sn1 | Lip(ν)|σ1n − σ2n |. n n Since sn1 → 0 and using (III.64), we get |σ2n − σ1n | ≤ C  |σ2n − σ1n |2 , This inequality implies that σ1n = σ2n for n large enough, because σ1n −σ2n → 0, and therefore sn1 = sn2 for n large enough (thanks to (III.64)). This is a contradiction with the strict inequality (III.63) so that (III.61) is proved for a γ > 0 small enough. • It is clear that for γ > 0 small enough we have c

ψ0 (Γ×]0, γ[) ⊂ Ω, ψ0 (Γ×] − γ, 0[) ⊂ Ω . – If x = ψ0 (σ, s) with σ ∈ Γ and s ∈]0, γ[, we have |x − σ| = s so that δ(x) ≤ s < γ and thus x ∈ Oγ . – Conversely, let x ∈ Oγ and let σ ∈ Γ such that |x − σ| = δ(x) = inf σ ∈Γ |x − σ  |. Notice that it is possible a priori to have many such σ. Consider a chart (U, ϕ) such that σ = ϕ(u0 ) ∈ ϕ(U ). By definition of σ, the map u ∈ U → |ϕ(u) − x|2 has a minimum at u = u0 and is of class C 1 . It follows that its derivative has to vanish at u = u0 which means that σ − x = ϕ(u0 ) − x is orthogonal to the tangent hyperplane Tσ Γ and therefore is proportional to ν(σ). It follows that x = σ − sν(σ) for some s. It is easy to check that |s| = δ(x) < γ, therefore we have x = ψ0 (σ, s) ∈ ψ0 (Γ×] − γ, γ[).  It follows from the last part of this proof that, for x ∈ Oγ , there is a unique point σ ∈ Γ such that |x − σ| = δ(x): this point is called the projection of x onto Γ and is referred to as P0 (x). Moreover, we have the inversion formula x = ψ0 (P0 (x), δ(x)) = P0 (x) − δ(x)ν(P0 (x)), ∀x ∈ Oγ .

(III.65)

In addition (III.61) shows that the projection P0 and the distance function d(., Γ) are, at least, Lipschitz continuous in Oγ .

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

194

Let x ∈ Oγ be a point where δ is differentiable and h ∈ R small enough. We then have (x − hν(P0 (x))) = P0 (x) − (δ(x) + h)ν(P0 (x)) = ψ0 (P0 (x), δ(x) + h), and then δ(x − hν(P0 (x))) = δ(x) + h. Letting h → 0 we deduce that ∇δ(x), ν(P0 (x)) = −1, and since we know that |∇δ| ≤ 1, we find that, for such a point x we have ∇δ(x) = −ν(P0 (x)).

(III.66)

Since ν ◦ P0 is continuous, by using Proposition III.2.4, we deduce that δ is C 1 and its gradient is −ν ◦ P0 so that we have finally proved that δ is C 1,1 . More generally, if k ≥ 1 then we can show that δ is C k+1,1 and P is C k,1 in Oγ . For simplicity, let us only consider the case k = 1. Taking the derivative of (III.65) with respect to xi we get ∂δ ∂P0 ∂P0 (x) = ei + ν(P0 (x)) + δ(x)dν(P0 (x)). (x), ∂xi ∂xi ∂xi which gives ∂P0 (x) = ∂xi



−1   ∂δ ei + Id − δ(x)dν(P0 (x)) ν(P0 (x)) , ∂xi

(III.67)

where we recall that dν(P0 (x)) is an endomorphism of the tangent space TP0 (x) Γ. Since Γ is of class C 2,1 , σ → sν(σ) is a Lipschitz continuous map. It follows from (III.67) that ∂P0 /∂xi is itself Lipschitz continuous. Therefore, we have P0 ∈ C 1,1 and ν ◦ P0 ∈ C 1,1 . By (III.66), we also get that δ ∈ C 2,1 .

3.3 Regularised distance The regularity of δ away from ∂Ω that we proved in the previous section is not sufficient for our purposes. In particular it is the case when we consider the problem of proving elliptic regularity properties of the Stokes operator (or even for the Laplace operator) with optimal generic regularity assumptions on the domain Ω. However, in most of the results that we prove in the next chapters, one can use the original distance δ instead of the regularised distance as soon as Ω is more regular than necessary (one level of regularity higher is in general sufficient). In that case, some computations can be slightly simplified. With this objective in mind, we need now to build a regularised distance function as follows. This construction is taken from [82]. We choose a molli-

3. Calculus near the boundary of domains

195

fying kernel as defined in Definition II.2.23. For any x ∈ Rd and any τ ∈ R we set   τ  G(x, τ ) = δ x + z η(z) dz. 2 B Since η is smooth, we see that G is of class C ∞ on Rd × R∗ . Moreover, using that Lip(δ) = 1, we have the estimate    τ2  τ1  |G(x, τ1 ) − G(x, τ2 )| ≤ δ x + z − δ x + z η(z) dz 2 2 B  1 1 |z|η(z) dz ≤ |τ1 − τ2 |, ≤ |τ1 − τ2 | 2 2 B and thus, by using the Banach fixed-point theorem, we obtain that for any x ∈ Rd , there exists a unique ρ(x) ∈ R such that ρ(x) = G(x, ρ(x)).

(III.68)

Definition III.3.6. The function ρ defined by (III.68) is said to be a regularised distance function for the domain Ω. We now investigate the main properties of ρ, showing in particular why it can plays the role of a distance function. Proposition III.3.7. 1. For any x ∈ Rd , we have ρ(x) = 0 ⇐⇒ δ(x) = 0 ⇐⇒ x ∈ ∂Ω. Moreover, there exists C1 , C2 > 0 such that C1 ≤

δ(x) ≤ C2 , ∀x ∈ Rd \ ∂Ω. ρ(x)

(III.69)

2. The function ρ is of class C k+1,1 in Rd and of class C ∞ in Rd \∂Ω. Moreover for any multi-index α ∈ Nd such that |α| = k + 3, we have the estimate |∂ α ρ(x)| ≤

C , ∀x ∈ Rd \ ∂Ω. ρ(x)

3. On the boundary ∂Ω, we have ∇ρ(x) = ∇δ(x) = −ν(x), ∀x ∈ ∂Ω. Moreover, there is an open neighborhood U of ∂Ω in Rd , such that inf |∇ρ| > 0. U

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

196

Remark III.3.1. It is not surprising that, in general, the derivatives of order k + 3 of ρ are blowing up on ∂Ω inasmuch as, if it were not the case, the boundary ∂Ω would be a submanifold of class C k+2,1 . Remark III.3.2. Even though, in some cases, the regularity of the original distance function δ near the boundary ∂Ω is sufficient for our needs, it may happen that δ is not smooth inside the whole domain Ω. This leads to complication of some computations, and therefore it is preferable, even in this case, to use the regularised function ρ instead. This is for instance the case in the proof of Theorem III.2.23 below. Proof. 1. Since

 B

η dz = 1 we have      ρ(x) ρ(x) − δ(x) = δ x+ z − δ(x) η(z) dz. 2 B

so that |ρ(x) − δ(x)| ≤

1 |ρ(x)| 2

 |z|η(z) dz ≤ B

1 |ρ(x)|. 2

It follows that ρ(x) = 0 if and only if δ(x) = 0 and that ρ and δ have the same signs away from ∂Ω. We also get that, for any x ∈ ∂Ω, 1 δ(x) 3 ≤ ≤ . 2 ρ(x) 2 2. By the implicit function theorem and the regularity of G, we see that ρ is C ∞ on Rd \ {ρ = 0} = Rd \ {δ = 0} = Rd \ ∂Ω. Moreover for any x, y ∈ Rd , we have |ρ(x) − ρ(y)| = |G(x, ρ(x)) − G(y, ρ(y))| ≤ |G(x, ρ(x)) − G(x, ρ(y))| + |G(x, ρ(y)) − G(y, ρ(y))| 1 ≤ |ρ(x) − ρ(y)| + |x − y|, 2 so that |ρ(x) − ρ(y)| ≤ 2|x − y|, and thus ρ is Lipschitz continuous on Rd with Lip(ρ) ≤ 2. For simplicity we only consider here the case k = 0. By differentiation of (III.68), we find that    ∂ρ ρ(x) ∂δ x+ z η(z) dz (x) = ∂xi 2 B ∂xi  "  ! ρ(x) 1 ∂ρ z, ∇δ x + (x) z η(z) dz. + 2 ∂xi 2 B

3. Calculus near the boundary of domains

197

It follows that  ρ(x) z η(z) dz x + 2 T1 (x) ∂ρ > =  = (x) = .  1 ρ(x) 1 ∂xi 1 − 1 − 2 B z, ∇δ x + 2 z η(z) dz 2 T2 (x) 

∂δ B ∂xi



Notice that, since |∇δ| ≤ 1, the denominator 1 − 12 T2 (x) in the above formula does not vanish. By the usual computations, we find that for l = 1, 2 we have Lip(Tl ) ≤ C Lip(∇δ)(1 + Lip(ρ)), therefore ∇ρ is Lipschitz continuous on Rd ; that is, ρ ∈ C 1,1 . Let now x ∈ Ω; we can compute the derivatives of T1 as follows    ∂η ∂T1 ∂δ 2 ρ(x) z =− (z) dz x+ ∂xj ρ(x) B ∂xi 2 ∂zj    ∂δ ρ(x) 1 ∂ρ z divz (η(z)z) dz. (x) x+ − ρ(x) ∂xj 2 B ∂xi We want to study the second derivatives of T1 (inasmuch as these terms are involved in the computation of third derivatives of ρ). Since ∂xj ρ is smooth, it is enough to study the regularity of terms of the form    ∂δ ρ(x) 1 z ψ(z) dz, x+ F (x) = ρ(x) B ∂xi 2  where ψ is smooth, compactly supported in B and satisfies B ψ dz = 0. We have    ∂δ ∂F ∂ρ 1 ρ(x) z ψ(z) dz (x) = − (x) x + ∂xl ∂xl ρ(x)2 B ∂xi 2    1 ∂2δ ρ(x) + z ψ(z) dz x+ ρ(x) B ∂xi ∂xl 2 "   !  1 1 ∂ρ ∂δ ρ(x) z + z, ∇ x+ ψ(z) dz. 2 ρ(x) ∂xl B ∂xi 2    “ ” 2 ∂δ = ρ(x) ∇z ∂x (x+ ρ(x) 2 z) i Integrating the last term by parts, and using that   ψ(z) dz = div(ψ(z)z) dz = 0, B

we have

B

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

198

 



  ∂δ ρ(x) ∂F ∂ρ 1 ∂δ x + (x) = − (x) (x) ψ(z) dz z − ∂xl ∂xl ρ(x)2 B ∂xi 2 ∂xi    ρ(x) 1 ∂2δ x+ + z ψ(z) dz ρ(x) B ∂xi ∂xl 2      ∂δ ρ(x) ∂δ 1 ∂ρ x + (x) divz (ψ(z)z) dz, z − − ρ(x)2 ∂xl B ∂xi 2 ∂xi and then

∂F (1 + Lip(ρ)) Lip(∇δ) . ∂xl (x) ≤ C ρ(x)

This proves that the second derivatives of T1 are bounded by C/ρ. The same computations can be made for the term T2 which gives the estimate for third derivatives of ρ. 3. For x ∈ ∂Ω we have ρ(x) = 0 and then we find that  ∂δ ∂δ T1 (x) = (x) η(z) dz = (x), ∂xi ∂x i B ! "  T2 (x) = ∇δ(x), zη(z) dz = 0, B

because η is symmetric. Finally, it follows that ∂δ ∂ρ (x) = (x). ∂xi ∂xi As a consequence we have |∇ρ| = 1 on ∂Ω and since ∇ρ is continuous on Rd , the existence of such an open set U is straightforward.  We are now in position to prove the lifting theorem for normal derivatives that we presented in Section 2.5.3. Proof (of Theorem III.2.23). For any g ∈ W 1−1/p,p (∂Ω), we define  Rν g(x) = −ρ(x) (R0 g)(x + αρ(x)z)η(z) dz. B

In this definition R0 g ∈ W 1,p (Ω) is the lifting of g introduced in Theorem III.2.22 and α > 0 is such that α ≤ C1 , α Lip(ρ) < 1, where C1 > 0 is the constant appearing in (III.69). Note that, for any x ∈ Ω and any z ∈ B, we have x + αρ(x)z ∈ Ω, so that Rν g is well-defined. Since ρ is C ∞ in Ω and η is smooth, we see that Rν g ∈ C ∞ (Ω). Let us show that Rν g ∈ W 2,p (Ω). Let 1 ≤ i ≤ d, we have

3. Calculus near the boundary of domains

199



∂Rν g ∂ρ (x) = − (x) (R0 g)(x + αρ(x)z)η(z) dz ∂xi ∂xi "  !B ∂ρ − ρ(x) (x)z η(z) dz ∇(R0 g)(x + αρ(x)z), ei + α ∂xi B  ∂ρ (x) (R0 g)(x + αρ(x)z) (η(z) − divz (η(z)z)) dz =−    ∂xi B −



1 αd ρd−1 (x)

Rd

∂(R0 g) (y)η ∂xi



=ψ(z)

y−x αρ(x)



dy. (III.70)

By the same kind of computation we get  ∂2ρ ∂ 2 (Rν g) (x) = − (x) (R0 g)(x + αρ(x)z)ψ(z) dz ∂xi ∂xj ∂xi ∂xj B  ∂(R0 g) ∂ρ (x) (x + αρ(x)z)ψ(z) dz − ∂xi ∂xj B  ∂ρ 1 ∂ρ (x) (x) (R0 g)(x + αρ(x)z) divz (ψ(z)z) dz + ρ(x) ∂xi ∂xj B  ∂(R0 g) ∂ρ (x) (x + αρ(x)z)η(z) dz + (d − 1) ∂xj ∂xi B  ∂(R0 g) ∂η 1 (x + αρ(x)z) (z) dz + α B ∂xi ∂zj  ∂(R0 g) ∂ρ (x) (x + αρ(x)z) ∇η(z), z dz + ∂xj ∂xi B We can integrate by parts the integral in the third term to obtain  1 ∂ρ ∂ρ (x) (x) (R0 g)(x + αρ(x)z) divz (ψ(z)z) dz ρ(x) ∂xi ∂xj B ∂ρ ∂ρ (x) (x) ∇(R0 g)(x + αρ(x)z), ψ(z)z dz. =−α ∂xi ∂xj B All the derivatives of ρ up to second-order are bounded, therefore it remains to study terms of the form   dz, x ∈ Ω, F (x) = f (x + αρ(x)z)ψ(z) B

where f ∈ Lp (Ω) and ψ is smooth and compactly supported in the unit ball B. By the Jensen inequality we get  p p   |f (x + αρ(x)z)|p |ψ(z)| dz, |F (x)| ≤ ψL1 B

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

200

so that we have   F pLp (Ω) ≤ Cψ,p

B

 |f (x + αρ(x)z)|p dx dz.

Ω

For any given z ∈ B, by the choice of α, the map x → x + αρ(x)z is a diffeomorphism from Ω onto some subset of Ω whose Jacobian determinant is bounded from below by 1 − α Lip(ρ) > 0. It follows that F pLp (Ω) ≤ Cψ,p,ρ,α f pLp (Ω) . Gathering all the previous results we have finally proved that Rν g ∈ W 2,p (Ω) and that Rν gW 2,p (Ω) ≤ CR0 gW 1,p (Ω) ≤ C  gW 1−1/p,p (∂Ω) . Since ρ = 0 and ∇ρ = −ν on the boundary ∂Ω, we immediately see from (III.70) that for x ∈ ∂Ω we have ∂Rν g (x) = νi (x)(R0 g)(x) = νi (x)g(x), ∂xi so that γν (Rν g) = ∇(Rν g), ν =

d 

νi2

g = g,

i=1

and the claim is proved. 

3.4 Parametrisation of a neighborhood of ∂Ω Using the regularised distance ρ that we have constructed above, we set Osρ0 = {x ∈ Rd , 0 < ρ(x) < s0 }. For s0 > 0 small enough we have Osρ0 ⊂ U so that ∇ρ does not vanish in Osρ0 . For 0 ≤ s ≤ s0 we let Γs = {x ∈ Rd , ρ(x) = s}. We have Γ0 = Γ = ∂Ω and Γs ⊂ Ω for any 0 < s ≤ s0 . Moreover Γ0 is a C k+1,1 compact manifold (by assumption on Ω) and Γs , s > 0 is a C ∞ compact manifold because ρ is smooth in a neighborhood of Γs and its gradient does not vanish on Γs . We now set ∇ρ(x) ν(x) = − , ∀x ∈ Osρ0 . |∇ρ(x)| This notation is consistent with the fact that ∇ρ is equal to the outward unit normal denoted by ν on ∂Ω. For any vector field w : Osρ0 → Rd , we define its normal and tangential parts as follows

3. Calculus near the boundary of domains

wN (x) = w(x), ν(x) ∈ R,

201

∀x ∈ Osρ0 ,

wT (x) = w(x) − wN (x)ν(x) ∈ Rd , ∀x ∈ Osρ0 . By construction, at each point x the vector wT (x) is tangent to the manifold Γρ(x) . Actually, wT (x) is the orthogonal projection of w(x) onto the tangent space T Γρ(x) . • In the case where w = ∇v is a gradient, we rather use the notation ∇T v = (∇v)T , ∇N v = (∇v)N . • In the case where v : Osρ0 → Rd is a vector field and thus ∇v is a tensor field, the formulas above can be generalised naturally as follows ∇N v = (∇v).ν, ∇T v = ∇v − (∇N v) ⊗ ν. By using the properties of ρ established above, we see that ν is C ∞ away from ∂Ω and of class C k,1 on Osρ0 . Moreover the second derivatives of ν behave as does 1/ρ in a neighborhood of ∂Ω (see Proposition III.3.7). Associated with ν we set ν ν˜ = , |∇ρ| and the corresponding flow ζ defined on R × Rd by ⎧ ⎨ d ζ(s, x) = ν˜(ζ(s, x)), ∀(s, x) ∈ R × Rd , ds ⎩ ζ(0, x) = x, ∀x ∈ Rd .

(III.71)

This flow is well-defined thanks to the Cauchy–Lipschitz theorem. Moreover we observe that ! " d d ρ(ζ(s, x)) = ∇ρ(ζ(s, x)), ζ(s, x) = −1, ds ds which leads to the formula ρ(ζ(s, x)) = ρ(x) − s, ∀s ∈ R, ∀x ∈ Rd .

(III.72)

Proposition III.3.8. The flow (s, x) → ζ(s, x) is of class C k,1 on R × Rd , and of class C ∞ in the set E = {(s, x) ∈ R × Osρ0 , s < ρ(x)}, and satisfies for any α ∈ Nd , |α| = k + 2, and any (s, x) ∈ E, the estimates |∂ α ζ(s, x)| ≤ C| ln(ρ(x) − s)|,

(III.73)

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

202

∂ α C ∂ ζ(s, x) ≤ ρ(x) − s . ∂s

(III.74)

Proof. Since ν˜ is of class C k,1 , the first part of the result is simply the usual regularity result for solutions of ordinary differential equations. For simplicity, let us only establish (III.73) and (III.74) the second estimate in the case k = 0. Using (III.72), we first note that for any (s, x) ∈ E, we have ζ(t, x) ∈ Osρ0 for any t ∈ [0, s]. The vector field ν˜ is of class C ∞ in Osρ0 , so that the differential equation satisfied by second derivatives of ζ is given by   d ∂2ζ ∂2ζ ∂ζ ∂ζ , (III.75) = ∇˜ ν (ζ). + D2 ν˜(ζ) · , ds ∂xi ∂xj ∂xi ∂xj ∂xi ∂xj so that, using (III.72), the properties of ν˜ and the fact that ∇ζ is bounded, we get 2 d ∂2ζ C ≤C ∂ ζ + ds ∂xi ∂xj ∂xi ∂xj ρ(x) − s . By integration between 0 and s, and the Gronwall lemma, we deduce (III.73). The estimate (III.74) now comes from (III.75).  Using the flow ζ we can now define a suitable parametrisation of Osρ0 . Proposition III.3.9. The map ψ : (σ, s) ∈ Γs0 × [0, s0 ] → ζ(s0 − s, σ) ∈ Osρ0 , is a bijection and its inverse is given by x ∈ Osρ0 → (P (x), ρ(x)) ∈ Γs0 × [0, s0 ], where P is the projection onto Γs0 defined by P (x) = ζ(ρ(x) − s0 , x), ∀x ∈ Osρ0 . Furthermore, ψ is of class C ∞ on Γs0 ×]0, s0 ] and of class C k,1 on Γs0 × [0, s0 ]. Similarly, P is C ∞ in Osρ0 . Proof. The regularity properties directly follow from the ones of the flow ζ (see Proposition III.3.8). It remains to show that ψ is a bijection and to characterise its inverse. • Assume that ψ(σ1 , s1 ) = ψ(σ2 , s2 ). Let us denote this point by x. Using (III.72) we have ρ(x) = ρ(ζ(s0 − s1 , σ1 )) = ρ(σ1 ) −(s0 − s1 ) = s1 ,    =s0

3. Calculus near the boundary of domains

203

because σ1 ∈ Γs0 . Similarly we have ρ(x) = s2 and thus s1 = s2 . We now have ζ(s0 − s1 , σ1 ) = ζ(s0 − s1 , σ2 ) and thus σ1 = σ2 because ζ is the flow associated with an ordinary differential equation. • Let x ∈ Osρ0 . By assumption we have 0 ≤ ρ(x) ≤ s0 . We define P (x) = ζ(ρ(x) − s0 , x) so that, by (III.72) we get that ρ(P (x)) = s0 , (i.e., P (x) ∈ Γs0 ) and it is clear that x = ψ(P (x), ρ(x)).  Remark III.3.3. With this parametrisation at hand, we can see that (∇N v) ◦ ψ = (∇v) ◦ ψ, ν ◦ ψ = −

1 ∂ (v ◦ ψ). |˜ ν | ∂s

(III.76)

Proposition III.3.10. For any s ∈ [0, s0 ], there exists a function Js : σ ∈ Γs0 → R such that   v(σ) dσ = v ◦ ψ(σ, s)Js (σ) dσ, Γs

Γ s0

for any integrable function v : Γs → R. Proof. Let (U, ϕ) be a chart of Γs0 . We observe that (U, ψ(ϕ(.), s)) is a chart on the manifold Γs for any s ∈ [0, s0 ]. Assume that v is supported in ψ(ϕ(U ), s). For any u ∈ U , we define  det gs (u) Js (ϕ(u)) = , det gs0 (u) where for any s, gs is the matrix of the first fundamental form of Γs in the chart (U, ψ(ϕ(.), s)). We can easily check that this quantity only depends on the point ϕ(u) and not on the particular chart (ϕ, U ) used in this computation. By definition of the integral we have   ( v(σ) dσ = v ◦ ψ(ϕ(u), s) det gs (u) du Γs U   det gs (u) ( v ◦ ψ(ϕ(u), s) det g0 (u) du = det gs0 (u) U  = v ◦ ψ(σ, s)Js (σ) dσ. Γ s0

 Definition III.3.11. We define the Jacobian J : Osρ0 → R as J (x) = Jρ(x) (P (x)), ∀x ∈ Osρ0 .

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

204

In particular we have Js (σ) = J ◦ ψ(σ, s) for any s ∈ [0, s0 ] and σ ∈ Γs0 . Proposition III.3.12. For any integrable function v, we have the following change of variable formula    s0  v(x) dx = |˜ ν |v dσ ds Osρ0

0



Γs

 s0

 |˜ ν |J v ◦ ψ(σ, s) dσ

= 0



ds.

Γ s0

Moreover J is of class C ∞ in Osρ0 and satisfies, for any α ∈ Nd ∂ α J ∈ L∞ (Osρ0 ), for |α| ≤ k, 1 ∂ α J ∈ L∞ (Osρ0 ), for |α| = k + 1, | ln ρ| ρ∇N ∂ α J ∈ L∞ (Osρ0 ), for |α| = k + 1. Remark III.3.4. In some situations we do not need additional regularity properties of the distance function, and one can use the original distance function δ in those computations. In particular, for a small enough s1 > 0 we can obtain the following formula    s1    ˜ v(x) dx = J v (σ − sν(σ)) dσ ds, Os1

∂Ω

0

where J˜ is a Jacobian term which satisfies ∂ α J˜ ∈ L∞ (Os1 ), for |α| ≤ k + 1, but not the other regularity properties of J . Proof. It is enough to show the first equality because the second one comes from Proposition III.3.10. Let U ⊂ Rd−1 and ϕ : U → Rd such that (U, ϕ) is a chart of the manifold Γs0 . Assume that v is supported in ψ(ϕ(U ) × [0, s0 ]) and let us write   s0  v(x) dx = v(ψ(ϕ(u), s))| Jac ψ(ϕ(u), s)| du ds. Osρ0

0

U

The Jacobian matrix J of (u, s) ∈ Rd−1 × R → ψ(ϕ(u), s) is given by   ∂ψ(ϕ(.), s) ∂ψ(ϕ(.), s) ∂ψ(ϕ(.), s) . ,..., , J= ∂u1 ∂ud−1 ∂s We notice that, by definition of the flow we have

3. Calculus near the boundary of domains

205

∂ψ(ϕ(.), s) = −˜ ν (ψ(ϕ(.), s)), ∂s and since ν˜ is orthogonal to the tangent space of Γs at each point it follows ⎛⎛ ⎞ ⎞ t

⎜⎝ gs (u) ⎠ ⎟ 0 ⎟, J.J = ⎜ ⎝ ⎠ 2 0 |˜ ν (ψ(ϕ(u), s))|

where gs (u) is the matrix of the first quadratic form of Γs in the chart (U, ψ(ϕ(.), s)). All this gives that ( Jac ψ(ϕ(u), s) = det J = |˜ ν | det gs (u). We deduce that   v(x) dx = Osρ0

0

s0



( |˜ ν (ψ(ϕ(u), s))|v(ψ(ϕ(u), s)) det gs (u) du

 ds,

U

and the result follows by definition of the integral on the manifold Γs . If the support of v is not included in ψ(ϕ(U ) × [0, s0 ]), we can prove the result by considering a covering of Γs0 by such charts (U, ϕ) and by using a partition of unity. The regularity properties of J immediately come from the ones of the flow ζ; see Proposition III.3.8.  As a first application of the previous results, we can prove the following generalised Hardy inequality which holds for functions which do not necessarily vanish on the boundary. Proposition III.3.13. Let Ω be a domain of Rd of class C 1,1 and with compact boundary and 1 < p < +∞. There exists a C > 0 such that for any u ∈ W 1,p (Ω) we have    u − (γ0 u) ◦ ψ(P (.), 0)     p ρ ≤ CuW 1,p .  ρ L (Os ) 0

Remark III.3.5. Note that for any x ∈ O , ψ(P (x), 0) is nothing but the point on the boundary ∂Ω which is obtained by following the flow ζ starting from x. In the case where Ω is smooth enough, we can replace the regularised distance ρ by the usual distance δ. In that case ψ(P (.), 0) is exactly the usual orthogonal projection P0 on ∂Ω, and the same Hardy inequality holds. ρ s0

Proof. By density of Cc∞ (Ω) in W 1,p (Ω), it is enough to prove the inequality for any smooth u. For such a u, we have

Chapter III. Sobolev spaces

206

u(x) − (γ0 u) ◦ ψ(P (x), 0) = u(x) − u(ζ(ρ(x), x))



ρ(x)

= u(ζ(0, x)) − u(ζ(ρ(x), x)) = 

0

d u(ζ(s, x)) ds ds

ρ(x)

(∇u)(ζ(s, x))˜ ν (s, x) ds.

= 0

It follows that  ρ(x) u(x) − (γ0 u) ◦ ψ(P (x), 0) ≤ 1 |∇u|(ζ(s, x)) ds. ρ(x) ρ(x) 0 By Proposition III.3.12, we get  u − (γ0 u) ◦ ψ(P (.), 0) p dx ρ Osρ0 p  s0    s 1 |∇u|(ζ(τ, ψ(σ, s))) dτ dσ ds. ≤C s 0 0 Γ s0 By definition of ψ, we have ζ(τ, ψ(σ, s)) = ζ(s0 +τ −s, σ). We can perform the change of variable τ → s − τ and then use the Hardy inequality for functions defined on R (Lemma II.4.7) to obtain    s0 u − (γ0 u) ◦ ψ(P (.), 0) p dx ≤ C |∇u|p (ψ(σ, s)) ds dσ ρ Osρ0 Γ s0 0  ≤C |∇u|p dx, Osρ0

where we used the properties of ν˜ and of J .



3.5 Tangential Sobolev spaces 3.5.1 Definitions Let us first characterise the Sobolev regularity in Osρ0 by means of tangent and normal parts of the gradient of functions and of lower-order Sobolev spaces. Theorem III.3.14. Let Ω be a C k+1,1 domain of Rd , k ≥ 0, with compact boundary. l+1,p Let 0 ≤ l ≤ k + 1, 1 ≤ p < +∞, and f ∈ W l,p (Ω) ∩ Wloc (Ω). We have f ∈ W l+1,p (Ω) ⇐⇒ ∇T f ∈ (W l,p (Osρ0 ))d and ∇N f ∈ W l,p (Osρ0 ).

3. Calculus near the boundary of domains

207

Proof. • Assume that ∇f ∈ W l,p (Ω). By definition we have ∇N f = ∇f, ν in Osρ0 . Let α, β be multi-indices such that |α| + |β| = l and let us show that ∂ α ∇f, ∂ β ν belongs to Lp (Osρ0 ). Since |β| ≤ k+1, we know that ∂ β ν is bounded and moreover ∂ α f ∈ Lp (Ω) by assumption on f ; the result follows. The tangential part has the same regularity because ∇T f = ∇f − (∇N f )ν. • Assume now that ∇T f and ∇N f belong to W l,p (Osρ0 ); the same argument as above shows the result.  We can now introduce the tangential Sobolev spaces which are useful in the study of regularity properties for solutions of elliptic problems, in particular for the Stokes problem. Definition III.3.15. Let Ω be a C k+1,1 domain, k ≥ 0, with compact boundary. l+1,p (Ω). We say For 0 ≤ l ≤ k + 1, 1 ≤ p < +∞, and f ∈ W l,p (Ω) ∩ Wloc l+1,p that f ∈ Wtang (Ω) if and only if ∇T f ∈ (W l,p (Osρ0 ))d and ρ∇N f ∈ W l,p (Osρ0 ). Observe that, in this definition, we require that ∇N f blows up at most like 1/ρ near the boundary of Ω, ρ being the (regularised) distance to the boundary. Proposition III.3.16. Using the assumptions and notations of the previous definition, we have that l+1,p 1,p (Ω) =⇒ ∂ α f ∈ Wtang (Ω), ∀α ∈ Nd , s.t. |α| = l. f ∈ Wtang

Proof. Let α ∈ Nd such that |α| = l, the Leibniz formula leads to ∂ α (∇T f ) = ∇(∂ α f ) − ∇(∂ α f ), νν    =∇T ∂ α f

+









cα ,α ,α ∇(∂ α f ), ∂ α ν∂ α ν,

α ,α ,α ∈Nd |α |+|α |+|α |≤|α| |α | 0 such that pL2 (Ω) ≤ Cpχ(Ω) , ∀p ∈ L2 (Ω).

(IV.1)

Remark IV.1.1. For any 1 < q < +∞, we also have pLq (Ω) ≤ C(pW −1,q (Ω) + ∇pW −1,q (Ω) ), ∀p ∈ Lq (Ω). The proof of Theorem IV.1.1 which is given below can be easily adapted to this framework. The main new difficulty is to prove the inequality for Ω = Rd , as in Proposition IV.1.2. Indeed, in the case q = 2, this requires us to characterise the Fourier multipliers that continuously map Lq (Rd ) into itself, which is far from the main scope of this book (see [91]). However, all the other steps of the proof can be adapted in a straightforward way. Remark IV.1.2. To prove this theorem, it is enough to prove (IV.1) for any p ∈ Cc∞ (Ω). Indeed, assume that this inequality holds for any such functions; then we know from Proposition III.2.26 and Theorem III.2.27 that for any p ∈ χ(Ω), the family (Sε p) ⊂ Cc∞ (Ω) converges towards p in χ(Ω). Therefore, by assumption we have that Sε1 p − Sε2 pL2 (Ω) ≤ CSε1 p − Sε2 pχ(Ω) , from which we deduce that (Sε p)ε is a Cauchy sequence in L2 (Ω). We already know that Sε p −−−→ p in H −1 (Ω), therefore we deduce that p necessarily beε→0

longs to L2 (Ω) and that (IV.1) holds by passing to the limit in the inequality Sε pL2 (Ω) ≤ CSε pχ(Ω) . Following this remark, our goal is now to prove (IV.1) for any sufficiently smooth enough function. We start by studying the case where Ω = Rd and follow with the case of the flat half-space Ω = Rd+ . We then deduce the result for any Lipschitz half-space Ha and finally for any Lipschitz domain with compact boundary.

1.1 Proof of the inequality 1.1.1 The case of the whole space This case becomes entirely elementary by using the characterisation of Sobolev spaces through the Fourier transform given by (III.11). Proposition IV.1.2. Theorem IV.1.1 holds for Ω = Rd .

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

232

Proof. We follow Remark IV.1.2 and we consider a p ∈ D(Rd ). Denoting as pˆ the Fourier transform of p, we have from (III.11) that  2 pH −1 = C (1 + |ξ|2 )−1 |ˆ p(ξ)|2 dξ, Rd  2 (1 + |ξ|2 )−1 |ξ|2 |ˆ p(ξ)|2 dξ. ∇pH −1 = C Rd

Thus, using that |ˆ p(ξ)|2 = (1+|ξ|2 )−1 (1+|ξ|2 )|ˆ p(ξ)|2 = (1+|ξ|2 )−1 |ˆ p(ξ)|2 +(1+|ξ|2 )−1 |ξ|2 |ˆ p(ξ)|2 , we deduce, by the Hausdorff–Young theorem, that p2L2 = Cˆ p2L2 ≤ Cp2H −1 + C∇p2H −1 ≤ Cp2χ(Ω) . The claim is proved. 

1.1.2 The flat half-space case Lemma IV.1.3. The operator π : p ∈ L2 (Rd+ ) → p¯ ∈ L2 (Rd ), which associates with any p ∈ L2 (Rd+ ) its extension by 0 on the whole space is continuous. Moreover, it maps H01 (Rd+ ) continuously into H 1 (Rd ). Proof. The continuity of π in L2 is straightforward. We know from Theorem III.2.46, that π actually maps H01 (Rd+ ) into H 1 (Rd ). Moreover, we observe that ∇¯ p = ∇p (because p ∈ H01 (Ω)) so that we have ¯ pL2 (Rd ) = pL2 (Rd+ ) , ∇¯ pL2 (Rd ) = ∇pL2 (Rd ) = ∇pL2 (Rd+ ) , and therefore we get πpH 1 (Rd ) = pH01 (Rd+ ) . We consider now the adjoint operator t π : L2 (Rd ) → L2 (Rd+ ) defined by (t πp, q)L2 (Rd+ ) = (p, πq)L2 (Rd ) , ∀p ∈ L2 (Rd ), ∀q ∈ L2 (Rd+ ).



1. Neˇ cas inequality

233

For any p ∈ L2 (Rd ) and any q ∈ H01 (Rd ), using the previous lemma and (III.39), we deduce that (t πp, q)L2 (Rd+ ) ≤ pH −1 (Rd ) πqH 1 (Rd ) ≤ CpH −1 (Rd ) qH01 (Rd ) , which proves that t πpH −1 (Rd+ ) ≤ CpH −1 (Rd ) , ∀p ∈ L2 (Rd ). Since L2 (Rd ) is dense in H −1 (Rd ), we deduce that t π has a unique continuous extension defined from H −1 (Rd ) into H −1 (Rd+ ). We still denote this extension by t π. We easily observe that for all p ∈ L2 (Rd ) we have t πp = p|Rd+ so that π can also be viewed as a “restriction to Rd+ ” operator for the elements of H −1 (Rd ).

t

Lemma IV.1.4. There exists a linear continuous operator P from χ(Rd+ ) into χ(Rd ) which satisfies t π ◦ P = Idχ(Rd+ ) . Proof. We define this extension operator by duality. • Step one: Let us begin by introducing a projection operator from H 1 (Rd ) onto H01 (Rd+ ). We first define this operator on smooth functions p ∈ D(Rd ), for all x = (xi )1≤i≤d ∈ Rd+ by Qp(x) = p(x) +

2 

αj p(x1 , . . . , xd−1 , −jxd ).

j=1

It is clear that the function Qp is smooth, and that if we impose the condition 2  1+ αj = 0, (IV.2) j=1

= R × {0} is zero and, consequently, Qp ∈ then its trace on H01 (Rd+ ). Moreover, we can easily verify that for all p ∈ D(Rd ),we have ∂Rd+

d−1

QpH01 (Rd+ ) ≤ CpH 1 (Rd ) , where C > 0 only depends on the (αi )i . Hence, by the density of D(Rd ) in H 1 (Rd ), this operator can be extended in a unique way as a continuous operator from H 1 (Rd ) into H01 (Rd+ ). Finally we can show (first on smooth functions and then by density) that

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

234

Q ◦ π = IdH01 (Rd+ ) . • Step two: By taking the adjoint of the above identity, we get t

π ◦ t Q = IdH −1 (Rd+ ) .

Hence, by restricting this equality in the subspace χ(Rd+ ) of H −1 (Rd+ ), we find t π ◦ P = Idχ(Rd+ ) , where we have defined P = t Q|χ(Rd+ ) .

The operator P : χ(Rd+ ) → H −1 (Rd ), thus defined, is a suitable candidate to be the sought-after extension operator. To complete the proof, we need to prove that P takes its values in χ(Rd ) and that it is continuous for the respective topologies of χ(Rd+ ) and χ(Rd ). • Step three: Let now v be any element in χ(Rd+ ). By definition, the operator t Q is linear and continuous from H −1 (Rd+ ) into H −1 (Rd ) and hence we have P vH −1 (Rd ) = t QvH −1 (Rd ) ≤ CvH −1 (Rd+ ) . We now need to show that the gradient of P v belongs to the space (H −1 (Rd ))d . For all ϕ ∈ D(Rd ) and for all i ∈ {1, . . . , d},we have ∂xi P v, ϕH −1 ,H01 = ∂xi t Qv, ϕH −1 ,H01 = −t Qv, ∂xi ϕH −1 ,H01 = −v, Q∂xi ϕH −1 ,H01 . To demonstrate the result, it is necessary to make use of the assumption that ∇v ∈ (H −1 (Rd+ ))d and thus, we need to express the operator Q∂xi as a divergence operator applied to some functions of H01 (Rd+ ). To do this, we must consider two different cases. For all x = (xi )i ∈ Rd+ , we denote x ¯ = (x1 , . . . , xd−1 ). – If i < d: We have from the definition of Q: Q∂xi ϕ(x) = ∂xi ϕ(x) +

2 

αj (∂xi ϕ)(¯ x, −jxd )

j=1

= ∂xi Qϕ(x). We then have ∂xi P v, ϕH −1 ,H01 = −v, ∂xi QϕH −1 ,H01 = ∂xi v, QϕH −1 ,H01 ,

1. Neˇ cas inequality

235

which shows that |∂xi P v, ϕH −1 ,H01 | ≤ ∂xi vH −1 (Rd+ ) QϕH01 (Rd+ ) ≤ C∇vH −1 (Rd+ ) ϕH 1 (Rd ) . This indeed proves that ∂xi P v ∈ H −1 (Rd ) and that we have the estimate ∂xi P vH −1 (Rd ) ≤ C∇vH −1 (Rd+ ) . – If i = d : In this case, we have 2 

Q∂xd ϕ(x) = ∂xd ϕ(x) +

αj (∂xd ϕ)(¯ x, −jxd )

j=1 2  1

= ∂xd ϕ(x) −

j=1

j

  x, −jxd ) αj ∂xd ϕ(¯

= ∂xd Rd ϕ(x), where the operator Rd is defined by Rd ϕ(x) = ϕ(x) −

2  1 j=1

j

x, −jxd ). αj ϕ(¯

We can verify that Rd maps H 1 (Rd ) into H 1 (Rd+ ) in a continuous way. It just remains to ensure that Rd ϕ is indeed in H01 (Rd+ ). We immediately see that this is true as soon as the condition 1−

2  αj j=1

j

= 0,

(IV.3)

is satisfied. By assuming this condition is satisfied, we can conclude by writing that |∂xd P v, ϕH −1 ,H01 | = |∂xd v, Rd ϕH −1 ,H01 | ≤ ∂xd vH −1 (Rd+ ) Rd ϕH01 (Rd+ ) ≤ C∂xd vH −1 (Rd+ ) ϕH 1 (Rd ) , which simultaneously shows that ∂xd P v ∈ H −1 (Rd ) and demonstrates the estimate ∂xd P vH −1 (Rd ) ≤ C∇vH −1 (Rd+ ) . It remains, of course, to observe that we can simultaneously fulfill the two conditions (IV.2) and (IV.3) by taking (α1 , α2 ) = (3, −4). 

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

236

Proposition IV.1.5. Theorem IV.1.1 holds for Ω = Rd+ . Proof. Let p be an element of χ(Rd+ ); then, by definition of the extension operator P p ∈ χ(Rd ). By Proposition IV.1.2, we deduce that P p ∈ L2 (Rd ) and that P pL2 (Rd ) ≤ CP pχ(Rd ) ≤ Cpχ(Rd+ ) . By using Lemma IV.1.4, we get p = t πP p, and since P p ∈ L2 (Rd ) we have seen that t π(P p) = (P p)|Rd+ .

It follows that p ∈ L2 (Rd+ ) and that pL2 (Rd+ ) ≤ Cpχ(Rd+ ) , which proves the result. 

1.1.3 The Lipschitz half-space case Proposition IV.1.6. Theorem IV.1.1 holds for any Lipschitz half-space Ha as defined in Definition III.1.1. Proof. We use the Lipschitz diffeomorphism Ta : Rd+ → Ha introduced in Section 1.2.1 of Chapter III. Let ϕ ∈ H01 (Rd+ ). By using Corollary III.2.41 and the properties of Ta given in Proposition III.1.3 we deduce that     ϕ ◦ Ta−1 JTa−1 ∈ H01 (Ha ), and ϕ ◦ Ta−1 JTa−1  1 ≤ CϕH01 (Rd+ ) . H0 (Ha )

For any p ∈ Cc∞ (Ha ), we can write  p ◦ Ta , ϕH −1 (Rd+ ),H01 (Rd+ ) =

Rd +

(p ◦ Ta )ϕ dx



p(ϕ ◦ Ta−1 )JTa−1 dy ; < = p, (ϕ ◦ Ta−1 )JTa−1 H −1 (H

=

Ha

1 a ),H0 (Ha )

,

and then it follows p ◦ Ta , ϕH −1 (Rd+ ),H01 (Rd+ ) ≤ CpH −1 (Ha ) ϕH01 (Rd+ ) , so that we have proved p ◦ Ta H −1 (Rd+ ) ≤ CpH −1 (Ha ) . We use now the chain rule to get

(IV.4)

1. Neˇ cas inequality

237

∇(p ◦ Ta ) = t (∇Ta )(∇p) ◦ Ta , so that for any ψ ∈ (H01 (Rd+ ))d we have  ∇(p ◦ Ta ), ψH −1 (Rd+ ),H01 (Rd+ ) =

Rd +

((∇p) ◦ Ta ) · ((∇Ta ).ψ) dx.

Since ∇Ta is bounded and has first derivatives which behave as does 1/ρ we can apply once more Corollary III.2.41 to deduce that ((∇Ta ).ψ) belongs to (H01 (Rd+ )) with an estimate (∇Ta ).ψH01 ≤ CψH01 . It follows that ∇(p ◦ Ta ), ψH −1 (Rd+ ),H01 (Rd+ ) = ((∇p) ◦ Ta ), (∇Ta ).ψH −1 (Rd+ ),H01 (Rd+ ) ≤ (∇p) ◦ Ta H −1 (Rd+ ) (∇Ta ).ψH01 (Rd+ ) ≤ C(∇p) ◦ Ta H −1 (Rd+ ) ψH01 (Rd+ ) . Using (IV.4) with p replaced by ∇p, we finally deduce ∇(p ◦ Ta )H −1 (Rd+ ) ≤ C∇pH −1 (Ha ) .

(IV.5)

Finally, by (IV.4) and (IV.5) we get that p ◦ Ta χ(Rd+ ) ≤ Cpχ(Ha ) . Using Proposition IV.1.5, we deduce that for any such smooth p, we have p ◦ Ta L2 (Rd+ ) ≤ Cpχ(Ha ) , and finally, with Proposition II.2.15, we get that pL2 (Ha ) ≤ Cp ◦ Ta L2 (Rd+ ) ≤ C  pχ(Ha ) , which concludes the proof, following Remark IV.1.2. 

1.1.4 The general case We can now perform the proof of the main theorem of this section. Proof (of Theorem IV.1.1). We consider a finite open covering (Ui )1≤i≤N of ∂Ω as given by Theorem III.1.4, and another open set U0 ⊂ U0 ⊂ Ω such that (Ui )0≤i≤N is a finite open covering of Ω. Let (ψi )0≤i≤N be an associated partition of unity, and p ∈ Cc (Ω). • The function pψ0 is compactly supported in Ω. Therefore, its extension by 0, pψ0 satisfies ∇(pψ0 ) = ∇(pψ0 ) and we can apply Proposition IV.1.2 to get

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

238

pψ0 L2 (Ω) = pψ0 L2 (Rd ) ≤ C0 (pψ0 H −1 (Rd ) + ∇(pψ0 )H −1 (Rd ) ) ≤ C0 (pH −1 (Ω) + ∇pH −1 (Ω) ). • For any 1 ≤ i ≤ N , the function pψi is supported in a (rotated) Lipschitz half-space Rσi Hai . By Proposition IV.1.6, we can deduce that pψi L2 (Ω) = pψi L2 (Rσi Hai ) ≤ Ci (pψi H −1 (Rσi Hai ) + ∇(pψi )H −1 (Rσi Hai ) )

(IV.6)

= Ci (pψi H −1 (Ω) + ∇(pψi )H −1 (Ω) ). We observe now that for any ϕ ∈ H01 (Ω), we have  pψi , ϕH −1 (Ω),H01 (Ω) = pψi ϕ dx = p, ψi ϕH −1 (Ω),H01 (Ω) Ω

≤ pH −1 (Ω) ψi ϕH01 (Ω) ≤ Cψi pH −1 (Ω) ϕH01 (Ω) , so that pψi H −1 (Ω) ≤ Cψi pH −1 (Ω) . Similarly, we can prove that ∇(pψi )H −1 (Ω) ≤ (∇p)ψi H −1 (Ω) + (∇ψi )pH −1 (Ω) ≤ Cψ i (pH −1 (Ω) + ∇pH −1 (Ω) ). Hence, (IV.6) gives pψi L2 (Ω) ≤ Ci (pH −1 (Ω) + ∇pH −1 (Ω) ) = Ci pχ(Ω) . Gathering all the above inequalities, we have finally proved that there exists a C > 0 such that pL2 (Ω) ≤ Cpχ(Ω) , ∀p ∈ Cc∞ (Ω). By using Remark IV.1.2, the proof is complete. 

1.2 Related Poincar´ e inequalities The Neˇcas inequality now allows us to demonstrate a new Poincar´e-type inequality for the functions of L2 (Ω). Proposition IV.1.7. Let Ω be a connected, bounded, Lipschitz domain of Rd . There exists a C > 0 such that for all p ∈ L2 (Ω), we have

1. Neˇ cas inequality

239

 pH −1 ≤ C

  1 + ∇pH −1 . p dx |Ω| Ω

Proof. This is the same principle as for Propositions III.2.38 and III.2.39. We argue by contradiction, by initially assuming that there exist functions (pn )n in L2 (Ω) such that    1 + ∇pn H −1 . p dx pn H −1 ≥ n n |Ω| Ω By homogeneity, we assume that pn H −1 = 1. Then, since we have the inequality ∇pn H −1 ≤ 1/n, we can deduce that (pn )n is bounded in L2 (Ω) according to Theorem IV.1.1. The embedding of H01 (Ω) into L2 (Ω) is compact, thus we know that the adjoint embedding of L2 (Ω) into H −1 (Ω) is also compact (Lemma II.3.6). We can therefore extract from (pn )n a sequence (pnk )k which weakly converges in L2 (Ω) and strongly in H −1 (Ω) towards a function p of L2 (Ω). Since ∇pn H −1 ≤ 1/n, we obtain ∇p = 0 in the distribution sense and therefore, the open set Ω being connected, the limit p is necessarily a constant α ∈ R (Lemma II.2.44). However, we also have  pnk H −1 1 1 pnk dx ≤ = , |Ω| Ω nk nk and therefore at the limit (we can pass to the limit in the integral by weak convergence in L2 (Ω)), we obtain |α| ≤ 0. This shows that p is zero, which is in contradiction with the fact that pH −1 = lim pnk H −1 = 1, k→∞

the convergence in this space being strong.  Of course, we cannot obtain a similar result to Proposition III.2.38, because the functions of L2 (Ω) do not have traces on ∂Ω. We now define a quotient space which is useful in our study because as we show later in incompressible models, the pressure is only defined apart from a constant, as soon as the domain Ω is connected. Definition IV.1.8. Let Ω be a connected, bounded open set of Rd . We define the quotient space L20 (Ω) = L2 (Ω)/R,

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

240

made up of classes of functions of L2 (Ω) which differ by a constant. We equip this space with the quotient norm uL20 = inf u + αL2 . α∈R

Furthermore, for any function u of L2 (Ω), we introduce the mean of u on Ω defined by  1 m(u) = u(x) dx. |Ω| Ω In the usual way, we identify a class of L20 (Ω) with any of its representatives. It is easy to verify that, provided with the quotient norm above, the space L20 (Ω) is a Banach space. This is in fact a Hilbert space for the scalar product  (u, v)L20 =

(u − m(u))(v − m(v)) dx. Ω

Indeed, the norm coming from this scalar product is equivalent to the quotient norm thanks to the following result. Lemma IV.1.9. For any bounded, connected, and Lipschitz domain Ω of Rd , there exists a C > 0 such that for all p ∈ L20 (Ω), we have pL20 ≤ p − m(p)L2 ≤ 2pL20 , 1 pL20 ≤ ∇pH −1 ≤ CpL20 . C

(IV.7) (IV.8)

Proof. The first inequality of (IV.7) is a direct consequence of the definition of the quotient norm. The second inequality of (IV.7) is obtained by writing for all α ∈ R p − m(p)L2 = p + α − m(p + α)L2 ≤ p + αL2 + |Ω|1/2 |m(p + α)|. However, for any function v of L2 (Ω), the H¨ older inequality gives us  1 |m(v)| ≤ |v| dx ≤ |Ω|−1/2 vL2 , |Ω| Ω from which we get the desired result by taking the infimum in α of the inequality obtained. The inequalities (IV.8) are obtained by using (IV.7), Theorem IV.1.1, and the Poincar´e inequality of Proposition IV.1.7.  This lemma proves that the space L20 (Ω) is isomorphic with the closed subspace of L2 (Ω) made up of functions with a zero mean. Often, we choose the unique representative with zero mean as the representative of the L20 (Ω) classes.

2. Characterisation of gradient fields. De Rham’s theorem

241

2 Characterisation of gradient fields. De Rham’s theorem The aim of this section is to provide a useful characterisation of gradient fields among the set of all vector fields. Definition IV.2.1. Let E be a Banach space, whose dual space is E  . For all A subset of E, we define the orthogonal of A to be the linear subspace of E  defined by A⊥ = {ϕ ∈ E  , ∀x ∈ A, ϕ, xE  ,E = 0} . In the case where E is a Hilbert space, by using the Riesz representation theorem, it is easily seen that A⊥ is also the orthogonal of A with respect to the scalar product of E. Remark IV.2.1. • The orthogonal of A is a closed linear subspace of E  . When E is reflexive, A⊥⊥ can be identified with a linear subspace of E. This is then the smallest closed linear subspace of E containing A; that is, A⊥⊥ = Span A. Therefore, for any vector subspace A of E we have A is closed in E ⇐⇒ A⊥⊥ = A. • If A ⊂ B then B ⊥ ⊂ A⊥ . Theorem IV.2.2. Let Ω be a Lipschitz domain of Rd . • If Ω is bounded, the image of the gradient operator   8 9 ∇ L2 (Ω) = f ∈ (H −1 (Ω))d , ∃p ∈ L2 (Ω), f = ∇p , is closed in (H −1 (Ω))d . • If Ω is not bounded, the set   8 9 ∇ L2loc (Ω) ∩ (H −1 (Ω))d = f ∈ (H −1 (Ω))d , ∃p ∈ L2loc (Ω), f = ∇p , is closed in (H −1 (Ω))d . Note that in the unbounded case, the gradient (in the distribution sense) of a function of L2loc (Ω) is not, in general, an element of (H −1 (Ω))d . Proof (of Theorem IV.2.2). We can only consider the case of a connected domain. Indeed, if Ω is not connected the result follows by applying the theorem on each of its connected components. • Let us first assume that Ω is bounded. Let (∇pn )n with pn ∈ L2 (Ω) be a sequence which converges in (H −1 (Ω))d . Since Ω is bounded we can assume that m(pn ) = 0 without changing ∇pn .

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

242

We can now apply the Neˇcas inequality (Theorem IV.1.1) and Poincar´e’s inequality (Proposition IV.1.7) to obtain pn − pn+k L2 ≤ C∇(pn − pn+k )H −1 . Since (∇pn )n is a Cauchy sequence in (H −1 (Ω))d , we deduce that (pn )n is a Cauchy sequence in L2 (Ω). It follows that there exists a p ∈ L2 (Ω) such that pn → p as n → ∞. Therefore, ∇pn −−−−→ ∇p in (H −1 (Ω))d and the n→∞ claim is proved. • In the unbounded case, we deduce the result from the one in the bounded case. To do this we consider an increasing sequence of regular, bounded, and connected open sets, (Ωk )k having union Ω.  d Now, let (fn )n be a sequence of elements of H −1 (Ω) which is expressed as fn = ∇pn with pn ∈ L2loc (Ω) and which converges towards an element  d f of H −1 (Ω) . For all k ≥ 1, the restriction of f to Ωk is well-defined (by extending the functions of H01 (Ωk )  by 0 on all Ω). Furthermore, we can easily see that  d converges towards f|Ω in H −1 (Ωk ) . Hence, the sequence fn |Ω k n k from the result obtained in the bounded case, we know that f|Ω is the k

gradient of a function qk ∈ L2 (Ωk ). Since the Ωk are connected, the function qk is uniquely defined apart from a constant. We choose this function such that qk has a zero mean on Ω1 (which is contained in all the Ωk ). It is therefore evident that if k1 < k2 , then the function qk1 − qk2 is zero on Ωk1 . Indeed, this function having a zero gradient in the sense of distributions (because f|Ω = ∇q1 and f|Ω = ∇q2 ), is therefore k1 k2 constant according to Lemma II.2.44. However, since qk1 and qk2 both have zero mean on Ω1 , this constant is necessarily zero. Hence, the functions (qk )k are constructed in a coherent way on the (Ωk )k , which gives us a function q defined on all Ω and which is indeed in L2loc (Ω).  d Moreover, it is clear that the gradient of q is also equal to f in H −1 (Ω) . 

Theorem IV.2.3. Let Ω be a connected, Lipschitz domain of Rd with compact  d boundary. Let f be in H −1 (Ω) such that f, ϕH −1 ,H01 = 0,

 d ∀ϕ ∈ H01 (Ω) , such that div ϕ = 0.

Then there exists an element p in L2loc (Ω), unique apart from a constant, such that f = ∇p. Furthermore, if Ω is bounded, then p belongs to L2 (Ω). Proof.

2. Characterisation of gradient fields. De Rham’s theorem

243



d Let Y be the subspace of H −1 (Ω) defined by 8 9 Y = ∇ p, p ∈ L2 (Ω) , if Ω is bounded, 4 5  −1 d Y = f ∈ H (Ω) , ∃p ∈ L2loc (Ω), f = ∇p , if Ω is unbounded.  d Now, let Z be the subspace of H01 (Ω) defined by 4 5  d Z = ϕ ∈ H01 (Ω) , div ϕ = 0 . From Definition IV.2.1, the theorem that we wish to prove affirms that if f ∈ Z ⊥ , then f ∈ Y . However, Theorem IV.2.2 says that Y is a closed  d subspace of H −1 (Ω) which is reflexive, and hence we have Y ⊥⊥ = Y from Remark IV.2.1. Therefore, it is sufficient to establish the inclusion Y ⊥ ⊂ Z (the other inclusion is obviously true).  d Let u ∈ Y ⊥ ⊂ H01 (Ω) . By definition this implies that ∇p, uH −1 ,H01 = 0, ∀p ∈ L2 (Ω). However, for any p ∈ L2 (Ω) we have by definition  ∇p, uH −1 ,H01 = − p div u dx. Ω

Hence, we have proved that any u ∈ Y ⊥ , satisfies  p(div u) dx = 0, ∀p ∈ L2 (Ω). Ω

Choosing p = div u in this formula exactly gives that div u = 0 and thus u ∈ Z.  We can now prove a stronger version of Theorem IV.2.3 which gives the same result but with weaker assumptions. Indeed, we can now assume that d f cancels against the divergence-free test functions of (D(Ω)) but no longer  1 d against all divergence-free functions of H0 (Ω) . Theorem IV.2.4 (de Rham). Let Ω be a connected, bounded, Lipschitz do d main of Rd . Let f be an element in H −1 (Ω) , such that for any function ϕ ∈ (D(Ω))d satisfying div ϕ = 0, we have f, ϕH −1 ,H01 = 0. Then, there exists a unique function p belonging to L20 (Ω) such that f = ∇p. Proof. • Step one: Let (Ωn )n be an increasing sequence of regular and connected open sets included in Ω (i.e., Ωn ⊂ Ωn+1 ) such that ∪n Ωn = Ω.

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

244



d For all un ∈ H01 (Ωn ) such that div un = 0, and for any ε > 0, we set un,ε = un ηε . We observe that un,ε is compactly supported in Ω for ε small enough, because un is supported in Ωn . Therefore we have un,ε ∈ (D(Ω))d and div un,ε = 0. By hypothesis, we have f, un H −1 ,H01 = lim f, un,ε H −1 ,H01 = 0. ε→0

Hence, from Theorem IV.2.3, f|Ωn as an element of (H −1 (Ωn ))d , is the gradient of some function pn of L2 (Ωn ). Furthermore, for all n, the restriction of pn+1 to Ωn has the same gradient as pn , hence pn+1 − pn is a constant function in Ωn , and we can choose pn+1 so that this constant is zero. All things considered, the sequence of functions (pn )n defines a function p ∈ L2loc (Ω) such that f = ∇p. • Step two: It remains to show that indeed p ∈ L2 (Ω). To do this, we use Lemma III.1.7. Hence, we can write k

Ω=

ωi , i=1

where the ωi are a finite number of star-shaped open sets. It is sufficient to show that p ∈ L2 (ωi ) for all i. We now place ourselves in the star-shaped open set ωi and, to simplify the notation, we assume (up to a translation) that it is star-shaped with respect to 0. For all ui ∈ (H01 (ωi ))d , such that div(ui ) = 0 (which we extend by 0 to all Rd ), and for all θ ∈ [0, 1[, we set ui,θ (x) = ui (x/θ) which is compactly supported in ωi and therefore in Ω, and divergence-free. We now proceed again through regularisation by introducing ui,θ,ε = ui,θ  ηε which is divergence-free and compactly supported in Ω for ε > 0 small enough, so that the assumption gives f, ui,θ H −1 ,H01 = lim f, ui,θ,ε H −1 ,H01 = 0, ε→0

and then we can easily show that ui,θ converges towards ui (when θ tends towards 1) in (H01 (Ω))d which, finally, gives f, ui H −1 ,H01 = lim f, ui,θ H −1 ,H01 = 0. θ→1

 d This being true for all ui in H01 (ωi ) , Theorem IV.2.3 applies and we therefore know that f = ∇pi with pi ∈ L2 (ωi ). As in step one, it is clear that p − pi is constant and that we can choose this constant to be zero. Hence, we have proved that

3. The divergence operator and related spaces

245

p|ωi ∈ L2 (ωi ), ∀i ∈ {1, . . . , k}, and thus that p ∈ L2 (Ω). We can of course now replace p by p − m(p) to ensure that p ∈ L20 (Ω).  We have, in fact, a more general result due to de Rham [49], one consequence of which is the following result (see also [111, 112, 124]).  d Theorem IV.2.5. Let Ω be any open set of Rd and let f ∈ D (Ω) such that  d for all ϕ ∈ D(Ω) with zero divergence, f, ϕD ,D = 0; then there exists π ∈ D (Ω) such that f = ∇π.

3 The divergence operator and related spaces 3.1 Right-inverse for the divergence The results above imply that the divergence operator defined from (H01 (Ω))d into L20 (Ω) has a continuous right-inverse. Theorem IV.3.1. Let Ω be a connected, bounded, Lipschitz domain of Rd . There exists a continuous linear operator Π from L20 (Ω) into (H01 (Ω))d , such that for all q ∈ L20 (Ω), the function u = Π(q) satisfies div u = q. Remark IV.3.1. Notice that there exists a somewhat more explicit proof of this result using the theory of singular integrals. This is a construction due to Bogovskii (see [18, 19, 63, 93]). We also give below a simpler proof in the case of a smooth 2D domain. Remark IV.3.2. Following Remark IV.1.1, it can be shown that the same result holds if we replace L20 (Ω) by Lp0 (Ω) and (H01 (Ω))d by (W01,p (Ω))d for 1 < p < +∞. Nevertheless, it does not hold for p = 1 or p = +∞. We refer, for instance, to [21] for a detailed discussion on those questions, in particular for some alternative proof of the above theorem. Proof. We have previously seen (Theorem IV.2.2) that the map ∇ from L2 (Ω) into (H −1 (Ω))d has a closed range and thus is a Banach space. Let N be the kernel of this map; then we know that the map ∇ can be considered as a continuous linear bijection of L2 (Ω)/N on ∇(L2 (Ω)). From the open mapping theorem (Theorem II.2.3) we know, therefore, that ∇ produces an isomorphism of Banach spaces between L2 (Ω)/N and ∇(L2 (Ω)).

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

246

Hence, the adjoint of this map produces an isomorphism from (∇(L2 (Ω))) onto (L2 (Ω)/N ) . Let us identify the objects involved: • (∇(L2 (Ω))) is the set of the continuous linear functionals on ∇(L2 (Ω)); it   is naturally identified with the quotient of (H −1 (Ω))d by all the linear functionals which cancel on ∇(L2 (Ω)), that is on Z using the notation of the proof of Theorem IV.2.3. Furthermore, (H01 (Ω))d is reflexive, thus ((H −1 (Ω))d ) is naturally identified with (H01 (Ω))d . In summary, we have (∇(L2 (Ω))) = (H01 (Ω))d /Z. • The elements of (L2 (Ω)/N ) are the linear functionals on L2 (Ω) which cancel on N which is the set of constant functions because Ω is connected. A continuous linear form on L2 (Ω) is represented by a function q ∈ L2 (Ω). It cancels over the constants if and only if we have  q(x) dx = 0. Ω

Hence, we have % &  2 (L (Ω)/N ) = q ∈ L (Ω), q(x) dx = 0 = L20 (Ω). 

2

Ω

• Finally, for all p ∈ L2 (Ω) and u ∈ (H01 (Ω))d , using integration by parts we obtain ∇p, uH −1 ,H01 = −(p, div u)L2 (Ω) , which shows that the adjoint of the operator ∇ is the operator (− div). In summary, we have shown that the operator (− div) produces an isomorphism between (H01 (Ω))d /Z and L20 (Ω). We denote the reciprocal isomorphism as Π0 . Since Z is a closed linear subspace of (H01 (Ω))d , then we know that the orthogonal projection operator on Z ⊥ , denoted by PZ ⊥ , induces an isomorphism from (H01 (Ω))d /Z onto Z ⊥ . Hence, the operator Π = PZ ⊥ ◦ Π0 from L20 (Ω) into (H01 (Ω))d satisfies the required properties.  The previous result implies the following well-known inf-sup inequality (also known the as Ladyzhenskaya–Babuˇska–Brezzi (LBB) inequality)  ⎛ ⎞ p(div v) dx ⎟ ⎜ Ω ⎜ sup ⎟ > 0. inf ⎝ ⎠ 2 p∈L0 (Ω) v∈(H 1 (Ω))d pL2 vH 1 p =0

0

v =0

In fact this inequality is equivalent to the existence of a continuous rightinverse for the divergence operator from L20 (Ω) into (H01 (Ω))d .

3. The divergence operator and related spaces

247

Related inequalities are particularly important in the numerical analysis of the Stokes problem (see for instance [65, 55]). Let us now give an alternative proof of Theorem IV.3.1 in a particular case, see for instance [26]. Proof (in the case where Ω is a domain of R2 of class C 1,1 ). We choose the usual counterclockwise orientation on R2 and for any two vectors a, b ∈ R2 we define a ∧ b = a1 b2 − a2 b1 ∈ R. Let q ∈ L20 (Ω), and consider the following Laplace–Neumann problem ⎧ ⎨ −Δψ = q, in Ω, (IV.9) ⎩ − ∂ψ = 0, on ∂Ω. ∂ν  Since Ω is of class C 1,1 and Ω q dx = 0, Theorem III.4.3 implies that there exists a solution ψ ∈ H 2 (Ω) of (IV.9) and that ψH 2 ≤ CqL2 . We set v = −∇ψ so that v ∈ (H 1 (Ω))2 , div v = q and vH 1 ≤ CqL2 . Unfortunately, v does not vanish on the boundary because we only have v · ν = −∂ψ/∂ν = 0. We set g = v ∧ ν on ∂Ω, so that g ∈ H 1/2 (∂Ω). We use now the lifting operator R that we built in Remark III.2.12. We set ϕ = R(0, g) ∈ H 2 (Ω), so that ϕ satisfies ϕH 2 ≤ CgH 1/2 (∂Ω) ≤ C  vH 1 ≤ C  qL2 , γ0 (ϕ) = 0, ∂ϕ γν (ϕ) = = g. ∂ν We introduce now w = (∇ϕ)⊥ =

  ∂ϕ ∂ϕ − , ∈ (H 1 (Ω))2 . ∂x2 ∂x1

• Since ϕ is constant on ∂Ω, we have ∇T ϕ = 0 on ∂Ω. Therefore we have ∇ϕ = (ν · ∇ϕ)ν, on ∂Ω, so that w = (∇ϕ)⊥ is orthogonal to ν on the boundary; that is, w · ν = 0 on ∂Ω. • By construction we have w ∧ ν = (∇ϕ)⊥ ∧ ν = −(∇ϕ) · ν = −g, and div w = 0. Gathering the properties of v and w, we see that u = v + w satisfies

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

248

div u = div(v + w) = q, uH 1 ≤ vH 1 + wH 1 ≤ CqL2 , u · ν = v · ν +w  · ν = 0, =0

=0

∧ ν = 0. u ∧ ν = v  ∧ ν + w   =g

=−g

It follows that u ∈ (H01 (Ω))2 and the claim is proved because the definition of u linearly depends on q. 

3.2 The space Hdiv (Ω) Definition IV.3.2. Let Ω be a Lipschitz domain of Rd with compact boundary. We introduce the space 8 9 Hdiv (Ω) = u ∈ (L2 (Ω))d , div u ∈ L2 (Ω) ,  1/2 equipped with the graph norm u → u2L2 +  div u2L2 . Moreover, we define Hdiv,0 (Ω) to be the closure of (D(Ω))d in Hdiv (Ω). With the notation introduced in Section 2.10, we observe that Hdiv (Ω) is nothing but the domain in L2 of the divergence operator. More precisely, we have 2,2 Hdiv (Ω) = Wdiv (Ω). We can then reformulate with this notation the various results obtained in Section 2.10: • The space (Cc∞ (Ω))d is dense in Hdiv (Ω) (see Theorem III.2.42). • There exists a continuous trace operator γν from Hdiv (Ω) into H −1/2 (∂Ω) such that γν (u) = u · ν for any u ∈ (Cc∞ (Ω))d . Moreover the following Stokes formula holds,   u · ∇w dx + w div u dx (IV.10) Ω Ω =γν (u), γ0 (w)H −1/2 ,H 1/2 , ∀u ∈ Hdiv (Ω), ∀w ∈ H 1 (Ω). This comes from Theorem III.2.43. • The space Hdiv,0 (Ω) is the kernel of the trace operator γν (see Theorem III.2.45). To conclude we state an extension of the above results to tensor fields. We identify (Hdiv (Ω))d with the set of tensors σ ∈ (L2 (Ω))d×d whose divergence belongs to (L2 (Ω))d . By reasoning row by row, we can define a continuous

3. The divergence operator and related spaces

249

linear operator still denoted by γν : (Hdiv (Ω))d → (H −1/2 (∂Ω))d such that γν (σ) = σ.ν for any smooth tensor field σ. We immediately obtain the following result. Lemma IV.3.3. Let Ω be a bounded Lipschitz domain of Rd . For any v ∈ (H 1 (Ω))d and any σ ∈ (Hdiv (Ω))d , we have the following Stokes formula   σ : ∇v dx + v · div σ dx = σ.ν, vH −1/2 ,H 1/2 . Ω

Ω

3.3 Divergence-free vector fields. Leray decomposition Let us consider the set V of smooth divergence-free vector fields which are compactly supported in Ω, 8 9 V = ϕ ∈ (D(Ω))d , div ϕ = 0 . We can then define the following fundamental spaces: V the closure of V in (H01 (Ω))d , and H the closure of V in (L2 (Ω))d . These two spaces are, of course, Hilbert spaces equipped with the scalar products respectively induced by those of (H01 (Ω))d and of (L2 (Ω))d . We can now characterise these two spaces in a more precise way. Lemma IV.3.4. Let Ω be a bounded Lipschitz domain of Rd . We have 8 9 V = v ∈ (H01 (Ω))d , div v = 0 . Proof. 8 9 We denote the space v ∈ (H01 (Ω))d , div v = 0 as V . We need to prove the equality V = V . It is clear that V ⊂ V and that V is closed in (H01 (Ω))d , hence the inclusion ⊂ is evident. To demonstrate the other inclusion, we proceed by duality showing that any continuous linear functional on V which cancels on V also cancels on V (which is sufficient according to Proposition II.2.2).  d Hence, if f ∈ H −1 (Ω) ∩V ⊥ , then from Theorem IV.2.4, f is the gradient of a function p of L2 (Ω). We then have for any v ∈ V , f, vH −1 ,H01 = ∇p, vH −1 ,H01 = −(p, div v)L2 = 0. We have hence proved that f cancels on V˜ , which concludes the proof.  Theorem IV.3.5. Let Ω be a connected, bounded, Lipschitz domain of Rd . Then we have

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

250

8

9 H = u ∈ (L2 (Ω))d , div u = 0, γν (u) = 0 , and the orthogonal of H in (L2 (Ω))d satisfies 8 9 H ⊥ = u ∈ (L2 (Ω))d , ∃p ∈ H 1 (Ω), u = ∇p .

(IV.11)

Proof. • We first show the second equality which characterises the orthogonal of H in (L2 (Ω))d . For this, we denote 8 9 H = u ∈ (L2 (Ω))d , ∃p ∈ H 1 (Ω), u = ∇p . Let u ∈ H ; then for all v of V we have    (u, v)L2 = u · v dx = ∇p · v dx = − p div v dx = 0. Ω

Ω

Ω

This shows, by the density of V in H for the topology of (L2 (Ω))d , that u ∈ H ⊥ , and that as a consequence H ⊂ H ⊥ . Reciprocally, if u ∈ H ⊥ then, in particular, for all v of V , we have u, vH −1 ,H01 = (u, v)L2 = 0, and by consequence, from Theorem IV.2.4, there exists p ∈ L20 (Ω) such that u = ∇p. Since u ∈ (L2 (Ω))d , we indeed have p ∈ H 1 (Ω). Hence, u ∈ H . • Let us now prove the first equality. We denote 8 9 H = u ∈ (L2 (Ω))d , div u = 0, γν (u) = 0 . Let us demonstrate the inclusion H ⊂ H . If u ∈ H, there exists a sequence (un )n of elements of V , which converges towards u for the topology of (L2 (Ω))d . The functions un are divergence-free, thus it is the same for its limit u (in D (Ω)). Consequently u ∈ Hdiv (Ω) and lim u − un Hdiv (Ω) = 0.

n→∞

From the continuity of the normal trace operator γν , we can deduce that lim γν (u) − γν (un )H −1/2 (∂Ω) = 0,

n→∞

and hence γν (u) = 0. This exactly states that u belongs to H . We now know that H is included in H , and therefore we denote the orthogonal complement of H into H as H . Let u ∈ H ⊂ H ⊥ . By the characterisation (IV.11) we know that there exists a p in H 1 (Ω) such that u = ∇p, and since u ∈ H , we see that p satisfies the problem

3. The divergence operator and related spaces

251

⎧ ⎨ Δp = div u = 0, in Ω, ⎩ ∂p = γν (u) = 0, on ∂Ω. ∂ν Then, using (IV.10) we can deduce that  |∇p|2 dx = 0, Ω

and thus u = ∇p = 0. Hence H = {0}. Therefore H = H.  Hence, the space (L2 (Ω))d decomposes orthogonally into two subspaces: the space H of vector fields with zero divergence and for which the normal trace γν (u) is zero, and the space H ⊥ of gradient fields of functions in H 1 (Ω). Definition IV.3.6. The decomposition ⊥

(L2 (Ω))d = H ⊕ H ⊥ , is called the Leray decomposition of the space (L2 (Ω))d . The orthogonal projection from (L2 (Ω))d onto H is known as the Leray projection and denoted as P. When we work in all the space Ω = Rd , we can give an explicit expression for the Leray projection in Fourier variables. Unfortunately, in a bounded open set such an analysis is much more complicated. In particular, because of the boundary conditions, it is easy to see that, contrary to the case for the whole space or the periodic case, the Leray projection P does not commute with the usual differential operators. Furthermore, the operator P is nonlocal; the value of Pu depends on the values of the function u on all Ω and not only in the neighborhood of the point at which we are looking. In the case where the domain is smooth enough, we can prove that the Leray projection P maps H 1 (Ω)d into itself. More precisely, we have the following result. Proposition IV.3.7. Assume that Ω is a bounded domain of class C 1,1 . Then, for any u ∈ (H 1 (Ω))d we have Pu ∈ (H 1 (Ω))d and PuH 1 ≤ CuH 1 , where C depends only on Ω. Proof. By definition, we write u = Pu + ∇p where p ∈ H 1 (Ω) and div(Pu) = 0, γν (Pu) = 0. By taking the divergence of this equation, we get Δp = div u ∈ L2 (Ω),

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

252

because we assumed that u ∈ (H 1 (Ω))d . Moreover, we have γν (∇p) = γν (u) + γν (Pu) = γν (u) = γ0 (u) · ν ∈ H 1/2 (∂Ω). Therefore, p is a solution to the Laplace equation with a source term in L2 (Ω) and Neumann boundary data which lie in H 1/2 (∂Ω). The elliptic regularity property for the Laplace–Neumann problem (see Theorem III.4.3) implies that p ∈ H 2 (Ω) and that pH 2 ≤ C( div uL2 + γ0 (u) · νH 1/2 ) ≤ C  uH 1 . Finally, we get Pu = u − ∇p ∈ (H 1 (Ω))d and PuH 1 ≤ CuH 1 .



4 The curl operator and related spaces All the material in this section is given in the case of the space dimension 3 because this is the natural setting for the definition of the curl operator. Nevertheless, most of the results can be translated to the 2D case, by adapting the definition of this operator; in fact it is then needed to define two different curl-like operators in that case, one from R2 into R, another from R into R2 . We have chosen to focus only on the main results that are needed in the sequel of this book. Many more results can be found in the references [54, 65, 47, 6, 60]. The main property we are interested in is the one given in Theorem IV.4.13 which says that, under suitable assumptions, a divergence-free vector field in (H 1 (Ω))3 can be written as the curl of a vector potential field in (H 2 (Ω))3 . This result is particularly useful for studying the steady Navier– Stokes equations with nonhomogeneous boundary conditions, in Section 3 of Chapter V. We denote by S 2 = {x ∈ R3 , |x| = 1} the unit sphere of R3 . We recall that this sphere is simply connected (whereas the unit sphere of R2 is not). This means that any continuous closed curve on S 2 can be continuously deformed into a single point.

4.1 Poincar´ e’s theorems In this section we prove some results which are simple versions of the famous Poincar´e theorem saying that any closed differential form in a star-shaped domain is an exact differential form. Lemma IV.4.1. Let U ⊂ R3 be an open set which is star-shaped with respect to the origin and k ≥ 1 an integer.

4. The curl operator and related spaces

253

1. For any Φ ∈ (C k (U))3 , such that curl Φ = 0 in U, the formula 

1

Φ(tx) · x dt,

ψ(x) =

(IV.12)

0

defines a function ψ ∈ C k+1 (U) such that Φ = ∇ψ. 2. For any Φ ∈ (C k (U))3 , such that div Φ = 0 in U, the formula 

1

tΦ(tx) ∧ x dt,

Ψ(x) = 0

defines a function Ψ ∈ (C k (U))3 such that Φ = curl Ψ. One can easily modify the above formulas by translation in the case where U is star-shaped with respect to a point different from the origin. Proof. 1. Equation (IV.12) clearly defines a function in C k (U). Let us compute its gradient  1  1 ∂ψ ∂Φ = (tx) · xt dt + Φ(tx) · ei dt ∂xi 0 ∂xi 0  1 3  1  ∂Φj = (tx)xj t dt + Φi (tx) dt. ∂xi 0 j=1 0 Since curl Φ = 0, we have ∂Φj /∂xi = ∂Φi /∂xj and thus  1 3  1  ∂Φi ∂ψ = (tx)xj t dt + Φi (tx) dt ∂xi ∂xj 0 j=1 0  1 d = (tΦi (tx)) dt = Φi (x). dt 0 Therefore ∇ψ = Φ and ψ ∈ C k+1 (U). 2. Let i, j, k ∈ {1, 2, 3} such that ei ∧ ej = ek , we have to show that Φk =

∂Ψj ∂Ψi − . ∂xi ∂xj

To this end, we write  0

and then

1

txk Φj (tx) − txj Φk (tx) dt,

Ψi (x) =

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

254

∂Ψi (x) = ∂xj



1

t2 xk 0

∂Φj ∂Φk (tx) − t2 xj (tx) − tΦk (tx) dt. ∂xj ∂xj

Similarly we get ∂Ψj (x) = ∂xi



1

−t2 xk 0

∂Φi ∂Φk (tx) + t2 xi (tx) + tΦk (tx) dt, ∂xi ∂xi

and it follows that ∂Ψi ∂Ψj (x) − (x) = ∂xi ∂xj





1

−t xk 2

0



1

t2 xj

+ 0

 ∂Φi ∂Φj (tx) + (tx) dt ∂xi ∂xj

∂Φk ∂Φk (tx) + t2 xi (tx) + 2tΦk (tx) dt. ∂xj ∂xi

Since div Φ = 0, we have ∂Φj ∂Φk ∂Φi + =− , ∂xi ∂xj ∂xk and then ∂Ψi ∂Ψj (x) − (x) = ∂xi ∂xj



1

t2 x · ∇Φk (tx) + 2tΦk (tx) dt 0



= 0

1

 d 2 t Φk (tx) dt = Φk (x). dt

Finally we have shown that curl Ψ = Φ.  Lemma IV.4.2. Let Ω be a simply connected open set in R3 and k ≥ 1 an integer. For any Φ ∈ (C k (Ω))3 satisfying curl Φ = 0 in Ω, there exists ψ ∈ (C k+1 (Ω))3 such that Φ = ∇ψ. Proof. Let x0 ∈ Ω. We define U to be the largest connected open set containing x0 and included in Ω for which such a function ψ exists. By Lemma IV.4.1, we already know that U is not empty because we can find such a ψ in any ball included in Ω and centred at x0 . We denote by ψ ∈ C k+1 (U ) a map such that Φ = ∇ψ in U . We now show by contradiction that U = Ω. • Assume that V = Ω \ U is not empty; then we have ∂U ∩ V = ∅. Indeed, if ∂U ∩ V is empty, we have V = Ω \ U and thus V is open. Therefore we have Ω = U ∪ V and U ∩ V = ∅, but this is impossible because Ω is connected.

4. The curl operator and related spaces

255

Let x ∈ ∂U ∩ V , and B ⊂ Ω be a ball centred at x. Since x ∈ ∂U , we have that U ∩ B = ∅ and then we can find a point x ˜ ∈ U ∩ B. • By Lemma IV.4.1, there exists ψ ∈ C k+1 (B) such that Φ = ∇ψ in B and,  x) = ψ(˜ we can add a constant to ψ to ensure that ψ(˜ x).  • Let us now show that ψ = ψ on U ∩ B. Let y be any point in U ∩ B. Since U is a connected open set, there exists a C 2 path γ0 : [0, 1] → U such that γ0 (0) = x ˜ and γ0 (1) = y. In a similar way there exists a C 2 path γ1 : [0, 1] → B such that γ1 (0) = x ˜ and γ1 (1) = y. The domain Ω being open and simply connected, there exists a C 2 map γ : [0, 1] × [0, 1] → Ω such that γ(0, .) = γ0 , γ(1, .) = γ1 , γ(., 0) = x ˜ and γ(., 1) = y. Let us now define the following quantity 

1

Φ(γ(s, t))∂t γ(s, t) dt, ∀s ∈ [0, 1].

I(s) = 0

– For s = 0, we have γ(0, .) = γ0 which is a path in U and thus we have 

1

Φ(γ0 (t))γ0 (t) dt =

I(0) = 0



1

(∇ψ)(γ0 (t))γ0 (t) dt

0

= ψ(γ0 (1)) − ψ(γ0 (0)) = ψ(y) − ψ(˜ x). – For s = 1, we have γ(1, .) = γ1 which is a path in B and thus we have 

1

Φ(γ1 (t))γ1 (t) dt =

I(1) = 0



1

 1 (t))γ  (t) dt (∇ψ)(γ 1

0

 0 (1)) − ψ(γ  0 (0)) = ψ(y)  − ψ(˜  x). = ψ(γ – Let us compute the derivative I  (s): 





1

I (s) = 0



 (∇Φ)(γ(s, t)).(∂s γ(s, t)) .∂t γ(s, t) dt

1

+

Φ(γ(s, t)).∂s ∂t γ(s, t) dt. 0

The fact that curl Φ = 0 implies that ∇Φ is a symmetric matrix and then we find  1   I  (s) = (∇Φ)(γ(s, t)).(∂t γ(s, t)) .∂s γ(s, t) dt 0



+ 

1

Φ(γ(s, t)).∂s ∂t γ(s, t) dt 0 1

d (Φ(γ(s, t)).∂s γ(s, t)) dt dt 0 =Φ(γ(s, 1)).∂s γ(s, 1) − Φ(γ(s, 0)).∂s γ(s, 0) = 0, =

256

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

because s → γ(s, 1) and s → γ(s, 0) are constant. – As a consequence of the previous computation we have I(0) = I(1); that is,  − ψ(˜  x) = ψ(y) − ψ(˜ ψ(y) x).  x) = ψ(˜ By construction we have ψ(˜ x) and then we deduce that ψ(y) =  ψ(y). • We have shown that ψ = ψ on U ∩ B and thus the map ψ defined on U ∪ B by  ψ, on U , ψ=  ψ, on B, is well-defined, smooth, and satisfies ∇ψ = Φ on U ∪ B which is open and connected. This is a contradiction with the maximality assumption on U .  Lemma IV.4.3. Let U ⊂ R3 be an open set in R3 which is star-shaped with respect to the origin and k ≥ 1 an integer. For any Φ ∈ (Cck (U))3 such that div Φ = 0, there exists Ψ ∈ (Cck (U))3 such that Φ = curl Ψ. Proof. Since Φ is compactly supported, we can assume without loss of generality  ∈ that U is bounded; then we know by Lemma IV.4.1 that there exists a Ψ k 3   (C (U)) such that Φ = curl Ψ in U, but Ψ is not necessarily compactly supported. Let U0 ⊂ U0 ⊂ U be an open set star-shaped with respect to 0 which  = 0 in U \ U0 . contains the support of Φ. By construction, we have curl Ψ Note that there exist two continuous maps ξ0 , ξ : S 2 →]0, +∞[ with ξ0 < ξ and such that we have %  & %  & x x 3 3 U0 = x ∈ R , |x| < ξ0 , and U = x ∈ R , |x| < ξ . |x| |x| '0 = U \ U0 satisfies In particular, the set U  &   % '0 = x ∈ R3 , ξ0 x < |x| < ξ x , U |x| |x| '0 is simply conand is then homeomorphic to S 2 ×]0, 1[. As a consequence, U k+1 '0 ) such that Ψ  = ∇ψ nected. By Lemma IV.4.2, there exists ψ ∈ C (U ' in U0 . Let U1 be any open set star-shaped with respect to 0 and such that U0 ⊂ U1 ⊂ U1 ⊂ U. We can find a function ψ ∈ C k+1 (U) such that ψ = ψ in  − ∇ψ. U \ U1 and we define now Ψ = Ψ By construction, we have curl Ψ = Φ in U and Ψ = 0 in U \ U1 , so that the claim is proved. 

4. The curl operator and related spaces

257

4.2 The space Hcurl (Ω) We can now study functional spaces of interest in which the curl operator plays a key role, just as we did in Section 3.2 with the space Hdiv (Ω).

4.2.1 Definitions and first properties Definition IV.4.4. Let Ω be a Lipschitz domain of R3 with compact boundary. We define the space 8 9 Hcurl (Ω) = u ∈ (L2 (Ω))3 , curl u ∈ (L2 (Ω))3 , embedded with the norm  1/2 uHcurl = u2L2 +  curl u2L2 . It is straightforward to see that Hcurl (Ω) is a Hilbert space. Moreover, we define Hcurl,0 (Ω) to be the closure of (D(Ω))3 in Hcurl (Ω). With the notation introduced in Section 2.10 of Chapter III, we observe that Hcurl (Ω) is nothing but the domain in L2 of the curl operator. More precisely, we have 2,2 Hcurl (Ω) = Wcurl (Ω). We can then reformulate with this notation the various results obtained in Section 2.10: • The space (Cc∞ (Ω))3 is dense in Hcurl (Ω) (see Theorem III.2.42). • There exists a continuous trace operator γ∧ν defined from Hcurl (Ω) into (H −1/2 (∂Ω))3 such that γ∧ν (u) = u ∧ ν for any u ∈ (Cc∞ (Ω))d . Moreover the following Stokes formula holds   u · (curl ψ) dx = (curl u) · ψ dx (IV.13) Ω Ω + γ∧ν (u), γ0 (ψ)H −1/2 ,H 1/2 , ∀ψ ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 . This comes from Theorem III.2.43. Note also that the trace γ∧ν (u) is a tangent vector field in the following weak sense, γ∧ν (u), γ0 (ψ)H −1/2 ,H 1/2 = 0, ∀ψ ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 , such that γ0 (ψ) ∧ ν = 0. • The space Hcurl,0 (Ω) is the kernel of the trace operator γ∧ν (see Theorem III.2.45). We notice that for any function p ∈ H 1 (Ω), we have curl(∇p) = 0 and thus ∇p ∈ Hcurl (Ω). Basically, we can imagine that ∇p ∧ ν is nothing but the tangential part of the gradient of p, so that the condition ∇p ∧ ν = 0 should

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

258

imply that p is locally constant on the boundary of Ω. Nevertheless, since the trace is understood in a weak sense this is not so obvious. The following proposition gives a detailed proof of this property when the domain is smooth enough. Proposition IV.4.5. Let Ω be a bounded domain in R3 of class C 1,1 . Let p ∈ H 1 (Ω) such that γ∧ν (∇p) = 0; then γ0 (p) is a constant on each connected component of ∂Ω. Proof. By (IV.13), we deduce that  ∇p · curl ψ dx = 0, ∀ψ ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 .

(IV.14)

Ω

We show from this formula that γ0 (p) is locally constant on ∂Ω, and the claim is thus proved. Let us consider any point x0 ∈ ∂Ω and let Σ, Σ ∗ be two connected bounded open neighborhoods of x0 in ∂Ω such that Σ ⊂ Σ ∗ (the closure being understood in the sense of the topological space ∂Ω). Let then g be any function  in Cc∞ (Σ) such that ∂Ω g dσ = Σ g dσ = 0. We extend g by 0 on ∂Ω \ Σ. The claim is proved if we manage to show that for any such g, we have  γ (p)g dσ = 0. Indeed, we deduce that γ0 (p) is constant on Σ which is an 0 Σ open neighborhood of an arbitrary point of ∂Ω. We use the notation and the results of Section 3 of Chapter III. In particular, we consider the coordinate system ψ : (σ, s) ∈ Γs0 × [0, s0 ] → Osρ0 , which can be extended to Γs0 × [−s0 , s0 ]. We introduce Σs0 = ψ(., s0 )−1 (Σ) and Σs∗0 = ψ(., s0 )−1 (Σ ∗ ), and, for any ξ1 , ξ2 , Uξ1 ,ξ2 = ψ(Σs0 ×]ξ1 , ξ2 [), Uξ∗1 ,ξ2 = ψ(Σs∗0 ×]ξ1 , ξ2 [), Σξ = ψ(Σs0 × {ξ}). • Let us define in Osρ0 , the vector field F (x) =

J (P (x)) g(P (x))ν(x), ∀x ∈ Osρ0 . J (x)

By construction, the tangential part FT of F is zero. Thus, Proposition III.3.23 gives

4. The curl operator and related spaces

259 Σ∗

Uξ∗∗ ,ξ∗ 1

Σ

2

Uξ1 ,ξ2

Fig. IV.1 Notations for the proof of Proposition IV.4.5

div F = ∇N FN +

∇N J 1 FN = ∇N (J FN ). J J

By definition of F , we have (J FN )(x) = J (P (x))g(P (x)); that is, the product J FN only depends on the projection of x on the boundary. It follows from (III.76) that ∇N (J FN ) = 0 and therefore that div F = 0. By construction, F is smooth in Ω, divergence-free, and satisfies F · ν = g on the boundary ∂Ω. Moreover, since g is supported in Σ0 , we see that F is supported in U0,s0 • Let us consider a truncation function β ∈ Cc∞ (] − 2s0 /3, 2s0 /3[) such that β = 1 on ] − s0 /3, s0 /3[. We define F ∗ (x) = β(ρ(x))F (x). We see that F ∗ still satisfies the boundary condition F ∗ · ν = g, is compactly sup∗ ported in U0,2s0 /3 , and satisfies the divergence-free condition on U0,s . 0 /3 ∗ ∗ Unfortunately, F is no longer divergence-free on the whole set U0,s0 . • We set f ∗ = div(F ∗ ), which is compactly supported in Us0 /3,2s0 /3 and satisfies     f ∗ dx = F ∗ · ν dσ = F ∗ · ν dσ = g dσ = 0, Uσ0 /3,2s0 /3

Σs0 /3

Σ

Σ

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

260

because, by construction, div F ∗ vanishes in U0,s0 /3 . Hence, by Theorem IV.3.1, we know that there is a Φ∗ ∈ (H01 (Us0 /3,2s0 /3 ))3 such that div Φ∗ = f ∗ . We extend Φ∗ by 0 outside its domain of definition and we set now F = F ∗ − Φ∗ which is divergence-free and compactly supported in U0,2s0 /3 and moreover satisfies F = gν on Σ. c • By a similar construction in Ω , we may finally suppose that F is divergence-free and compactly supported in U−2s0 /3,2s0 /3 . We introduce a mollifying kernel η ∈ Cc∞ (B(0, 1)) and ηε = ε−3 η(./ε) then we define F ε = F  ηε , ∗ so that F ε is smooth, divergence-free, and compactly supported in U−s , 0 ,s0 as soon as ε is sufficiently small. ∗ We may now assume that Σ and s0 are sufficiently small so that U−s is 0 ,s0 star-shaped since ∂Ω is smooth enough. Therefore, by using Lemma IV.4.3 ∗ we deduce that there exists Ψε ∈ (Cc∞ (U−s ))3 such that Fε = curl Ψε . 0 ,s0 3 • We extend Ψε by 0 on the whole space R and we use it as a test function in (IV.14) to get   0= ∇p · curl Ψε dx = ∇p · F ε dx Ω Ω   p div(F ε ) dx + γ0 (p)F ε · ν dσ. =− Ω    Σ∗ =0

Since F is smooth in the neighborhood of Σ ∗ , we can pass to the limit as ε → 0 in this formula and find that   0= γ0 (p)F · ν dσ = γ0 (p)g dσ. Σ

Σ

This property holds for any g whose mean value on Σ is zero, therefore we deduce as expected that γ0 (p) is a constant on Σ.  Let us define now the following space % Hdiv,curl,ν (Ω) = u ∈ (L2 (Ω))3 , div u ∈ L2 (Ω), & curl u ∈ (L (Ω)) , γν (u) ∈ H 2

3

1/2

(∂Ω) ,

equipped with the norm  1/2 . uHdiv,curl,ν = u2L2 +  div u2L2 +  curl u2L2 + γν (u)2H 1/2 We also define the following closed subspace of Hdiv,curl,ν (Ω),

4. The curl operator and related spaces

261

Hdiv,curl,ν,0 (Ω) = {u ∈ Hdiv,curl,ν (Ω), γν (u) = 0} .

(IV.15)

Lemma IV.4.6. Let Ω be a simply connected Lipschitz domain in R3 . If u ∈ (L2 (Ω))3 is such that div u = 0, curl u = 0, and γν (u) = 0, then u = 0. Proof. By assumption we have that u ∈ Hdiv (Ω), so that the trace γν (u) has to be understood in the sense of H −1/2 (∂Ω). Let B be any ball in Ω. Let Φ ∈ (Cc∞ (B))3 such that div Φ = 0. By Lemma IV.4.3, there exists Ψ ∈ (Cc∞ (B))3 such that curl Ψ = Φ. Hence, we have   1 u, ΦH −1 (B),H0 (B) = u · Φ dx = u · (curl Ψ) dx. B

B

Using Stokes formula (IV.13), we deduce that  u, ΦH −1 (B),H01 (B) = (curl u) · Ψ dx + γ∧ν (u), ΨH −1/2 ,H 1/2 . B

Since curl u = 0 and Ψ is compactly supported in B, we have u, ΦH −1 ,H01 = 0 for any such Φ. By Theorem IV.2.4, we know that there exists a pB ∈ L20 (B) such that u = ∇pB in B. We have in fact pB ∈ H 1 (B), because u ∈ (L2 (B))3 . Moreover, we have ΔpB = div(∇pB ) = div u = 0, which means that pB is harmonic in B and thus pB ∈ C ∞ (B) (see, for instance, [56]). Finally, u = ∇pB is also in C ∞ (B). Since this is true for any ball B in Ω, we have finally shown that u ∈ (C ∞ (Ω))3 . We can now apply Lemma IV.4.2, and find that there exists a p ∈ C ∞ (Ω) such that u = ∇p in Ω. Moreover, p is harmonic. Note that ∇p ∈ (L2 (Ω))3 and p ∈ L2loc (Ω). Thus, for any Φ ∈ (Cc∞ (Ω))3 , such that div Φ = 0, we have   1 u, ΦH −1 ,H0 = u · Φ dx = ∇p · Φ dx = −p, div ΦD ,D = 0. Ω

Ω

By Theorem IV.2.4, we deduce that there is a q ∈ L20 (Ω) such that u = ∇q. Since Ω is connected, p − q is constant and thus p ∈ L2 (Ω). Finally, we have u = ∇p with p ∈ H 1 (Ω). We conclude by applying the Stokes formula (IV.10)    |∇p|2 dx = u · ∇p dx = − (div u)p dx + γν (u), γ0 (p)H −1/2 ,H 1/2 , Ω

Ω

Ω

and the two terms in the right-hand side are zero because div u = 0 and γν (u) = 0. We deduce that u = ∇p = 0. The claim is thus proved. 

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

262

4.2.2 Density result and applications We are going to show that the spaces Hdiv,curl,ν (Ω) and Hdiv,curl,ν,0 (Ω) are algebraically and topologically equal to (H 1 (Ω))3 and (H 1 (Ω))3 ∩ Ker γν , respectively. To this end, we first need the following density result. Theorem IV.4.7. Let Ω be a bounded connected domain of class C 1,1 . The set 8 9 H = u ∈ (C 0,1 (Ω))3 ∩ (C ∞ (Ω))3 , u · ν = 0 in a neighborhood of ∂Ω , is dense in Hdiv,curl,ν,0 (Ω) and in (H 1 (Ω))3 ∩ Ker γν . Proof. 1. We first prove the density of H in (H 1 (Ω))3 ∩ Ker γν . Let v ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 such that γν (v) = 0 on ∂Ω. Let Osρ0 be a neighborhood of ∂Ω on which we can use tangential and normal coordinates (see Section 3 of Chapter III) and ϕ ∈ Cc∞ (Ω) such that Supp (1 − ϕ) ⊂ Osρ0 . We write v = ϕv + (1 − ϕ)v. By construction ϕv belongs to (H01 (Ω))3 and then can be approximated in the H 1 -norm by a sequence of functions in (D(Ω))3 ⊂ H. It remains to deal with u = (1 − ϕ)v. Since u is supported in Osρ0 we can define the tangential part of u as uT = u − (u · ν)ν which possesses the same regularity as u (because ν is Lipschitz continuous) and satisfies uT · ν = 0 in Osρ0 . Since ϕ = 0 on ∂Ω, we have u · ν = v · ν = 0, on ∂Ω. Therefore, u · ν ∈ H01 (Osρ0 ) and uT ∈ (H 1 (Osρ0 ))3 and then, for any ε > 0 we can find uT,ε ∈ (C ∞ (Osρ0 ))3 and fε ∈ D(Osρ0 ) such that fε − (u · ν)H 1 (Osρ0 ) + uT,ε − uT H 1 (Osρ0 ) −−−→ 0. ε→0

We now set uε = uT,ε − (uT,ε · ν)ν + fε ν, and we observe that uε · ν = fε in Osρ0 so that uε · ν is identically zero in a neighborhood of the boundary. Since ν is Lipschitz-continuous on Ω and of class C ∞ in Osρ0 , we see that uε satisfies the required regularity properties. Moreover, since by construction we have uT · ν = 0, we can write u − uε H 1 = uT,ε − uT − ((uT,ε − uT ) · ν)ν + (ψε − (u · ν))νH 1 ≤ CuT,ε − uT H 1 + Cψε − (u · ν)H 1 −−−→ 0, ε→0

which proves the first part of the result. 2. We deal now with the second density result. Let v ∈ Hdiv,curl,ν,0 (Ω) and let us define, for any ε > 0, v˜ε = Sε v ∈ (C ∞ (Ω))3 , where (Sε )ε is the family of mollifying operators as defined in Section 2.2 of Chapter III.

4. The curl operator and related spaces

263

By Theorem III.2.10, we have the following convergences ⎧ ⎪ v˜ε −−−→ v, in L2 (Ω), ⎪ ⎪ ε→0 ⎪ ⎨ div v˜ε −−−→ div v, in L2 (Ω), ε→0 ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎩curl v˜ε −−−→ curl v, in (L2 (Ω))3 . ε→0

Notice that v˜ε · ν does not necessarily vanish on ∂Ω. Let us now consider the following Neumann problem ⎧  1 1 ⎪ ⎪ ⎪−Δfε = v˜ε · ν dσ = ˜ vε · ν, 1H −1/2 ,H 1/2 , in Ω, ⎪ ⎪ |Ω| ∂Ω |Ω| ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ ∂fε − on ∂Ω, = v˜ε · ν, ⎪ ⎪ ∂ν ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ fε dx = 0. ⎩ Ω

• First of all, since v˜ε is smooth and ν is a Lipschitz vector field, we see that v˜ε · ν is Lipschitz continuous so that it belongs to H 1/2 (∂Ω). The source term in this Neumann problem is a constant function, thus the compatibility is satisfied; we deduce from Theorem III.4.3 that fε ∈ H 2 (Ω), because Ω is supposed to be of class C 1,1 . • Second, thanks to the continuity of the trace operator γν , and to the fact that γν (v) = 0, we know that ˜ vε · νH −1/2 = γν (˜ vε − v)H −1/2 ≤ C(v − v˜ε L2 +  div v − div v˜ε L2 ), and thus we deduce that v˜ε · ν tends to 0 in H −1/2 (∂Ω). The energy estimate (III.106) for the Laplace–Neumann problem gives ∇fε L2 ≤ C˜ vε · νH −1/2 −−−→ 0. ε→0

Moreover, by construction, we have  v˜ε · ν dσ −−−→ 0. Δfε L2 = CΩ ε→0 ∂Ω

• We can now define vε = v˜ε +∇fε , which belongs to (H 1 (Ω))3 and which satisfies vε − vL2 ≤ ˜ vε − vL2 + ∇fε L2 −−−→ 0, ε→0

 div vε − div vL2 ≤  div v˜ε − div vL2 + Δfε L2 −−−→ 0, ε→0

and, since curl ∇fε = 0,

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

264

 curl vε − curl vL2 =  curl v˜ε − curl vL2 −−−→ 0. ε→0

In conclusion, we just proved that vε ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 ∩ Ker γν and satisfies v − vε Hdiv,curl,ν −−−→ 0.

(IV.16)

ε→0

• We now use the density of H into (H 1 (Ω))3 ∩ Ker γν that we proved above. We can then find wε ∈ H such that vε − wε H 1 −−−→ 0. But, ε→0

since vε , wε ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 , we obviously have vε − wε Hdiv,curl,ν ≤ Cvε − wε H 1 −−−→ 0. ε→0

(IV.17)

Using (IV.16) and (IV.17) we deduce that wε ∈ H converges to v in Hdiv,curl,ν (Ω) which proves the claim.  Theorem IV.4.8. Let Ω be a bounded domain of class C 1,1 in R3 . The following equalities hold  Hdiv,curl,ν,0 (Ω) = (H 1 (Ω))3 ∩ Ker γν , 1

3

Hdiv,curl,ν (Ω) = (H (Ω)) , and there exists C > 0 depending only on Ω such that   uH 1 ≤ C uL2 +  div uL2 +  curl uL2 + γν (u)H 1/2 ,

(IV.18) (IV.19)

(IV.20)

for any u ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 = Hdiv,curl,ν (Ω). That is, the H 1 norm and the Hdiv,curl,ν norm are equivalent in the space (H 1 (Ω))3 . Moreover, if Ω is simply connected, then (IV.20) can be replaced with   (IV.21) uH 1 ≤ C  div uL2 +  curl uL2 + γν (u)H 1/2 , for any u ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 = Hdiv,curl,ν (Ω). Proof. • We first assume that (IV.20) holds for any vector field u ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 ; we then show that the equality (IV.18) holds. Consider the identity mapping I from (H 1 (Ω))3 ∩Ker γν into Hdiv,curl,ν,0 (Ω). – By definition of the Hdiv,curl,ν -norm, we obviously see that I is continuous. – The image of I is closed in Hdiv,curl,ν,0 . Indeed, if (un )n is a sequence in (H 1 (Ω))3 ∩ Ker γν which converges in Hdiv,curl,ν,0 (Ω), then by (IV.20)

4. The curl operator and related spaces

265

we see that (un )n is a Cauchy sequence in (H 1 (Ω))3 ; thus it converges towards some u ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 ∩ Ker γν and it is clear that this function u is also the limit of (un )n in Hdiv,curl,ν,0 (Ω). – By Theorem IV.4.7, we know that the space H, which is included in the image of I, is dense in Hdiv,curl,ν,0 (Ω), therefore the image of I is dense in Hdiv,curl,ν,0 (Ω). Finally, I has a closed and dense range in Hdiv,curl,ν,0 (Ω). This means that its range is nothing but the whole space Hdiv,curl,ν,0 (Ω) which proves (IV.18). Then, we deduce that (IV.19) also holds. Indeed, for any u in Hdiv,curl,ν (Ω), since γν (u) ∈ H 1/2 (∂Ω), we can use the lifting operator R0 to set v = u − R0 (γν (u)ν). since R0 (γν (u)ν) ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 , we see by construction that v belongs to Hdiv,curl,ν,0 (Ω). By (IV.18) we deduce that v ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 and then u = v + R0 (γν (u)ν) also belongs to (H 1 (Ω))3 . • It remains to prove (IV.20) for any u ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 . First of all, by the same reasoning as above, using the lifting operator R0 , we see that it is enough to prove the inequality for u ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 ∩ Ker γν . By Theorem IV.4.7, we can find a sequence ϕn ∈ H which converges to u in (H 1 (Ω))3 . Therefore, if we manage to prove (IV.20) for all the functions ϕ ∈ H, the result will follow by density. Let ϕ ∈ H. By (A.9) we have −Δϕ · ϕ = curl curl ϕ · ϕ − ∇(div ϕ) · ϕ. We integrate this equality on Ω and then use the Stokes formula for each term. It follows   |∇ϕ|2 dx = | curl ϕ|2 + | div ϕ|2 dx Ω Ω  (IV.22)  ,  (ϕ ∧ ν) · (curl ϕ) + (ν · ∇)ϕ · ϕ − (div ϕ)(ϕ · ν) dσ. + ∂Ω

By using formulas (A.3), (A.4), (A.7), and (A.8) we can write , (ϕ ∧ ν) · (curl ϕ) + (ν · ∇)ϕ · ϕ   |ϕ|2 = div(ϕ ∧ (ϕ ∧ ν)) + ϕ · curl(ϕ ∧ ν) + (ν · ∇) 2 |ϕ|2 2 = div((ϕ · ν)ϕ − |ϕ| ν) + (ν · ∇) 2   + ϕ · (div ν)ϕ − (div ϕ)ν + (ν · ∇)ϕ − (ϕ · ∇)ν =(ϕ · ∇)(ϕ · ν) − ((ϕ · ∇)ν) · ϕ =((ϕ · ∇)ϕ) · ν. Hence, the boundary terms can be written

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

266

, (ϕ ∧ ν) · (curl ϕ) + (ν · ∇)ϕ · ϕ − (div ϕ)(ϕ · ν) =((ϕ · ∇)ϕ) · ν − (div ϕ)(ϕ · ν) = − ((ϕ · ∇)ν) · ϕ + (ϕ · ∇)(ϕ · ν) − (div ϕ)(ϕ · ν).

Since ϕ ∈ H, we know that ϕ · ν = 0 in a neighborhood of the boundary. As a consequence the last two terms in the formula above vanish and from (IV.22) we finally deduce    2 2 2 |∇ϕ| dx = | curl ϕ| + | div ϕ| dx − ((ϕ · ∇)ν) · ϕ dσ. (IV.23) Ω

∂Ω

Ω

The last term of this equality, referred to as I, does not contain any derivative of ϕ, thus it follows that |I| ≤ Lip(ν)ϕ2L2 (∂Ω) . By the trace inequality given in Theorem III.2.19, we have 1/2

1/2

ϕL2 (∂Ω) ≤ CϕL2 + CϕL2 ∇ϕL2 , and thus by using Young’s inequality (see Corollary II.2.17) we find that 1 |I| ≤ C  ϕ2L2 + ∇ϕ2L2 . 2 We use this estimate in (IV.23) and we obtain the claim. • We assume now that Ω is simply connected and we want to prove (IV.21) by contradiction, just as in the proof of the Poincar´e inequalities (see Propositions III.2.38 and III.2.39). We assume that (IV.21) does not hold, which implies the existence of a sequence (un )n ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 such that un H 1 = 1, ∀n ≥ 0,

(IV.24)

 div un L2 +  curl un L2 + γν (un )H 1/2 −−−−→ 0. n→∞

(IV.25)

Since Ω is bounded, the embedding of H 1 (Ω) into L2 (Ω) is compact and then there exists a subsequence (still denoted as (un )n ) which strongly converges in (L2 (Ω))3 towards some u ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 . By (IV.25) we see that, at the limit we have div u = 0, curl u = 0, and γν (u) = 0. Using the assumption that Ω is simply connected, Lemma IV.4.6 proves that u = 0. Therefore we necessarily have un L2 −−−−→ 0 in addition to (IV.25), and n→∞

then by (IV.20) we deduce that un H 1 −−−−→ 0, which is contradiction n→∞

with (IV.24). 

4. The curl operator and related spaces

267

The same kind of result holds for higher regularity Sobolev spaces. For the sake of simplicity we only state the corresponding result for the H 2 -regularity. Theorem IV.4.9. Let Ω be a bounded domain in R3 of class C 2,1 . For any u ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 such that div u ∈ H 1 (Ω), curl u ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 , γν (u) ∈ H 3/2 (∂Ω), then u ∈ (H 2 (Ω))3 and we have uH 2 ≤ C (uL2 +  div uH 1 +  curl uH 1 + γν (u)H 3/2 ) , for some C > 0 depending only on Ω. The proof of this theorem is given in Section 6.4 because we need to use some tools that are introduced later during the study of regularity properties for the Stokes problem.

4.3 Kernel and image of the curl operator Lemma IV.4.10. Let Ω be a simply connected domain in R3 of class C 1,1 . For any u ∈ (L2 (Ω))3 such that curl u = 0, there exists a p ∈ H 1 (Ω) such that u = ∇p. In other words we have the equality KerL2 (curl) = ∇(H 1 (Ω)). Proof. We write the Leray decomposition (Definition IV.3.6) of such a u as u = u0 + ∇p, where p ∈ H 1 (Ω) and div u0 = 0, γν (u0 ) = 0. Taking the curl of this formula gives curl u0 = curl u = 0. Therefore, by Lemma IV.4.6, we get u0 = 0. Hence, u = ∇p.  Remark IV.4.1. We emphasise the fact that, for elements in KerL2 (curl) = ∇(H 1 (Ω)), the inequality (IV.21) thus reads      ∂p   ∇pH 1 ≤ C ΔpL2 +   ∂ν  1/2 , H for any p ∈ H 1 (Ω) such that Δp ∈ L2 (Ω) and ∂p/∂ν ∈ H 1/2 (∂Ω). We observe that this result is nothing but the elliptic regularity theorem for the Laplace equation with Neumann boundary conditions (see Theorem III.4.3).

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

268

We can now characterise the image of the curl operator. Theorem IV.4.11. Let Ω be a simply connected bounded domain in R3 of class C 1,1 . We denote by Γ1 , . . . , Γm the connected components of the boundary ∂Ω. 1. We have

    curl (H 1 (Ω))3 = curl (H 1 (Ω))3 ∩ H . 2

(IV.26)

3

Moreover this space is closed in (L (Ω)) . 2. We have in (L2 (Ω))3 ,  -⊥ curl (H 1 (Ω))3 8 9 = u ∈ (L2 (Ω))3 , curl u = 0, γ∧ν u = 0 8 9 = u ∈ (L2 (Ω))3 , u = ∇p, p ∈ H 1 (Ω), γ0 (p) is constant on each Γi . (IV.27) 3. We finally have  9  8 curl (H 1 (Ω))3 = u ∈ (L2 (Ω))3 , div u = 0, satisfying (IV.28) , where the following compatibility conditions are introduced γν (u), 1H −1/2 (Γi ),H 1/2 (Γi ) = 0, ∀i = 1, . . . , m.

(IV.28)

Proof.  with Ψ  ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 . We introduce Ψ = P Ψ  the Leray 1. Let u = curl Ψ  on H, so that we have Ψ  = Ψ + ∇q, with q ∈ H 1 (Ω) and projection of Ψ  = u. Moreover, the Leray projection maps (H 1 (Ω))d then curl Ψ = curl Ψ into itself (see Proposition IV.3.7), therefore we know that Ψ ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 . This proves the equality between the two spaces. Note that, by Lemma IV.4.6, Ψ is the unique element in (H 1 (Ω))3 ∩ H such that curl Ψ = u. By the inequality (IV.20), we deduce that ΨH 1 ≤ C curl ΨL2 = CuL2 . (IV.29)  1  3 It follows curl  that  (H (Ω)) is closed. Indeed, if 2(un )n3 is a sequence 1 3 of curl (H (Ω)) which converges towards a u ∈ (L (Ω)) , we associate with each un , the unique Ψn ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 ∩ H such that curl Ψn = un . By (IV.29), we see that Ψn is a Cauchy sequence in (H 1 (Ω))3 and then converges towards some Ψ ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 . It is clear that the limit u satisfies u = curl Ψ and the result is proved.   2. Let u ∈ (L2 (Ω))3 which is orthogonal to curl (H 1 (Ω))3 . In particular, for any Φ ∈ (D(Ω))3 , we have curl u, ΦD ,D = u, curl ΦD ,D = 0,

4. The curl operator and related spaces

269

and thus curl u = 0. We may now apply (IV.13) for any v ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 as follows,   0= u · curl v dx = v · curl u dx +γ∧ν (u), γ0 (v)H −1/2 ,H 1/2 , Ω Ω   =0

which implies that γ∧ν (u) = 0 and the first part of the claim is proved. From Lemma IV.4.10, we know that u = ∇p for some p ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 . The fact that γ∧ν (∇p) = γ∧ν (u) = 0and Proposition IV.4.5 gives the result. 3. • For any u ∈ curl (H 1 (Ω))3 , we obviously have div u = 0. For any i ∈ {1, . . . , m}, we consider a function pi ∈ H 1 (Ω) such that pi = 1 on Γi and pi = 0 on Γj for j = i. Such a function is known to exist by the trace lifting theorem (Theorem III.2.22). Using (IV.27), the fact that div u = 0 and the Stokes formula (IV.10) we get  0= u · ∇pi dx = γν (u), γ0 (pi )H −1/2 (∂Ω),H 1/2 (∂Ω) Ω

= γν (u), 1H −1/2 (Γi ),H 1/2 (Γi ) , which proves that the conditions (IV.28) hold. • Conversely, assume that u ∈ (L2 (Ω))3 is such that div u = 0 and that (IV.28) hold. We want to show that u belongs to the image of the curl operator. This image is closed in (L2 (Ω))2 , therefore it is enough to   ⊥ show that u is orthogonal to any element in curl (H 1 (Ω))3 ; see Remark IV.2.1. Therefore, we use (IV.27) and consider some w = ∇p with p ∈ H 1 (Ω) and γ0 (p) which is constant on each Γi . Using once more the Stokes formula (IV.10) we obtain   u · w dx = u · ∇p dx Ω

Ω



=−

(div u)p dx + Ω

m 

pi γν (u), 1H −1/2 (Γi ),H 1/2 (Γi ) = 0.

i=1

This proves the claim. 

4.4 The div/curl problem Using all the previous results, we can now investigate the div/curl problem. We first study the case of normal boundary conditions, and then the case where we do not impose any boundary conditions. Notice that other kind

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

270

of boundary conditions can be considered for this problem (this is useful, in particular, in electromagnetism) but we do not consider them here. Theorem IV.4.12. We use the same notation as in Theorem IV.4.11. We suppose given • A vector field u ∈ (L2 (Ω))3 such that div u = 0 and satisfying (IV.28). • A scalar field v ∈ L2 (Ω) and a boundary data Ψν ∈ H 1/2 (∂Ω) satisfying the compatibility condition   v dx = Ψν dσ. Ω

∂Ω

Then there exists a unique solution Ψ ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 to the problem ⎧ in Ω, ⎪ ⎨ div Ψ = v, curl Ψ = u, in Ω, ⎪ ⎩ Ψ · ν = Ψν , on ∂Ω;

(IV.30)

moreover it satisfies ΨH 1 ≤ C(uL2 + vL2 + Ψν H 1/2 ), where C > 0 depends only on Ω. Finally, if Ω is of class C 2,1 , u ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 , v ∈ H 1 (Ω), and Ψν ∈ 3/2 H (∂Ω), then the solution Ψ of (IV.30) belongs to (H 2 (Ω))3 and satisfies ΨH 2 ≤ C(uH 1 + vH 1 + Ψν H 3/2 ), Proof. We know from Theorem IV.4.11 and from the assumptions on u, that u belongs to the image of the curl operator. Moreover, by (IV.26), we know that u ∈ curl (H 1 (Ω))3 ∩ H . This exactly means that there exists a Ψ1 ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 such that div Ψ1 = 0, curl Ψ1 = u, Ψ1 · ν = 0, on ∂Ω. We consider now the following Laplace–Neumann problem ⎧ in Ω ⎨ −Δϕ = v, ∂ϕ ⎩− = Ψν , on ∂Ω. ∂ν Since Ω is of class C 1,1 , and thanks to the compatibility assumption between v and Ψν , Theorem III.4.3 shows that there is a solution ϕ ∈ H 2 (Ω) of this problem. We set Ψ2 = −∇ϕ and we observe that div Ψ2 = v, curl Ψ2 = 0, Ψ2 · ν = Ψν , on ∂Ω.

4. The curl operator and related spaces

271

As a consequence the sum Ψ = Ψ1 + Ψ2 ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 is a solution to Problem (IV.30). The uniqueness of this solution, as well as the estimate of ΨH 1 immediately follows from (IV.21). Finally, the H 2 (Ω) estimate in the case of smooth data follows from Theorem IV.4.9.  In the case where Ω is simply a Lipschitz bounded domain of Rd and if we do not impose any boundary condition on the solution of the div/curl problem, we can deduce the following result (see [63]), which will be useful in the study of the steady Navier–Stokes equations. Theorem IV.4.13. Let Ω be a simply connected bounded Lipschitz domain in R3 . The connected components of its boundary are denoted by Γ1 , . . . , Γm . Let k ∈ {0, 1}. We suppose given • A vector field u ∈ (H k (Ω))3 such that div u = 0 and satisfying (IV.28). • A scalar field v ∈ H k (Ω). Then there exists at least one solution Ψ ∈ (H k+1 (Ω))3 to the problem  div Ψ = v, in Ω, curl Ψ = u, in Ω, which satisfies ΨH k+1 ≤ C(uH k + vH k ), where C > 0 does not depend on u and v. Remark IV.4.2. The solution Ψ is certainly not unique because we can add the gradient of any harmonic function to Ψ to obtain another solution. Proof. • Let B = B(0, R) be a large ball which contains Ω. We consider the following Laplace–Dirichlet problem in B  −Δϕ = v˜, in B, ϕ = 0, on ∂B, where v˜ ∈ H k (B) is an extension of v in B. Note that for k = 0 we can simply take v˜ = v¯ the extension by 0 of v, whereas for k = 1, we need to use the extension operator from H 1 (Ω) into H 1 (R3 ). Since B is smooth and v˜ ∈ H k (B), we know from Theorem III.4.2 that this problem has a unique solution ϕ ∈ H k+2 (B), with the estimate ϕH k+2 ≤ C˜ v H k (B) ≤ C  vH k (Ω) . We now define Ψ1 to be the restriction to Ω of −∇ϕ. It is clear that Ψ1 satisfies in Ω the equations

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

272

div Ψ1 = v, curl Ψ1 = 0, and that Ψ1 H k+1 (Ω) ≤ ϕH k+2 (B) ≤ C  vH k (Ω) . As a consequence, we are led now to prove the result in the case where v = 0. • We set U = B \ Ω. Notice that U can be multiply connected. We denote by U1∗ , . . . , Uk∗ its connected components. Let 1 ≤ j ≤ k, we define gj∗ ∈ H −1/2 (∂Uj∗ ) as follows  0, on ∂Uj∗ ∩ ∂B gj∗ = γν (u), on ∂Uj∗ ∩ ∂Ω. The boundary of Uj∗ is necessarily the union of some of the sets ∂B, Γ1 , ... Γm , thus we see that the conditions (IV.28) imply that gj∗ , 1H −1/2 (∂Uj∗ ),H 1/2 (∂Uj∗ ) = 0. As a consequence, denoting by νj∗ the outward normal to Uj∗ (which is the opposite to the normal ν = νΩ ), Theorem III.4.3 shows that the Laplace– Neumann problem ⎧ ∗ ⎨ −Δϕj = 0, in Uj ⎩ − ∂ϕj = g ∗ , on ∂U ∗ , j j ∂ν ∗ has a solution ϕj ∈ H 1 (Uj∗ ) which satisfies. ∇ϕj L2 (Uj∗ ) ≤ Cgj∗ H −1/2 (∂Uj∗ ) ≤ C  uHdiv (Ω) = C  uL2 (Ω) , the last equality being true because div u = 0 in Ω. As a consequence the function u∗ defined by  u, in Ω, ∗ u = ∇ϕj , in Uj∗ for any 1 ≤ j ≤ k, belongs to (L2 (B))3 and satisfies u∗ L2 (B) ≤ CuL2 (Ω) , in B, div u∗ = 0, ∗ γν (u ) = 0, on ∂B. The ball B is a smooth domain, therefore we can apply Theorem IV.4.11 in B and thus find a vector field Ψ ∈ (H 1 (B))3 such that u∗ = curl Ψ and div Ψ = 0, in B, ΨH 1 (B) ≤ Cu∗ L2 (B) ≤ C  uL2 (Ω) .

5. The Stokes problem

273

It follows that the restriction of Ψ to Ω satisfies the required properties. • In the case where u ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 , following the same idea as before, we need to construct a suitable extension u∗ of u in the ball B. To this end, on each connected component Uj∗ of U we use the trace lifting operator to build a u∗j ∈ (H 1 (Uj∗ ))3 such that γ0 (u∗j ) = γ0 (u) on ∂Uj∗ u∗j H 1 (Uj∗ ) ≤ Cγ0 (u)H 1/2 ≤ C  uH 1 (Ω) . The Stokes formula and the conditions (IV.28) show that  div(u∗j ) dx = 0. Uj∗

Therefore, using Theorem IV.3.1, we know that there exists a uj ∈ (H01 (Uj∗ ))3 such that div uj = div u∗j and uj H 1 ≤ C div u∗j L20 ≤ C  u∗j H 1 . Gathering all these results, we see that the function u∗ defined by  u, in Ω, ∗ u = ∗ uj − uj , in Uj∗ for any 1 ≤ j ≤ k, satisfies u∗ ∈ (H 1 (B))3 , div u∗ = 0 in B, u∗ H 1 (B) ≤ CuH 1 (Ω) . Since B is smooth, we can apply Theorem IV.4.11 in B and thus find a vector field Ψ ∈ (H 2 (B))3 such that u∗ = curl Ψ, div Ψ = 0, in B, ΨH 2 (B) ≤ Cu∗ H 1 (B) ≤ C  uH 1 (Ω) . Here also the claim is proved by considering the restriction of Ψ to Ω. 

5 The Stokes problem 5.1 Well-posedness of the Stokes problem We recall here the spaces introduced and studied in Section 3.3:

274

8

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

9 V = ϕ ∈ (D(Ω)) , div ϕ = 0 , 4 5  d V = v ∈ H01 (Ω) , div v = 0 , 4 5  d H = v ∈ L2 (Ω) , div v = 0, γν (v) = 0 . d

We also recall that the vector fields of (L2 (Ω))d with divergence in L2 (Ω) (i.e., belonging to Hdiv (Ω)) have a normal trace that is well-defined in H −1/2 (∂Ω) (see Section 3.2). The dual of the space V , once the identification of H with its dual is made, is denoted as V  . As we saw in Chapter II, we have V ⊂ H ⊂ V  with compact and dense embeddings (Lemma II.3.6 and Corollary II.3.8). For all f in (H −1 (Ω))d , we refer to the following system of equations as the homogeneous Stokes problem, with Dirichlet boundary conditions, ⎧ ⎪ ⎨ −Δv + ∇p = f, in Ω, div v = 0, in Ω, (IV.31) ⎪ ⎩ v = 0, on ∂Ω. As we saw in Chapter I, these equations describe a laminar steady flow of a homogeneous incompressible fluid. We can prove an existence and uniqueness theorem for weak solutions of the Stokes problem with homogeneous Dirichlet boundary conditions as follows. Theorem IV.5.1. Let Ω be a connected, bounded, Lipschitz domain of Rd , and  d let f be in H −1 (Ω) ; then there exists a unique pair (v, p) ∈ V × L20 (Ω), which is a solution of (IV.31). Proof. We consider the Hilbert space V defined at the beginning of this section and we define the bilinear form on V by  a(v, w) = ∇v : ∇w dx. Ω

This bilinear form is continuous and coercive on V (because from the Poincar´e inequality v → a(v, v) is a norm on (H01 (Ω))d ). Now let the linear form L be defined by L(w) = f, wH −1 ,H01 . This linear form is continuous on V . From the Lax–Milgram theorem (Theorem II.2.5), we deduce that there exists a unique element v ∈ V which is a solution of a(v, w) = L(w), ∀w ∈ V.

(IV.32)

Hence, by the Stokes formula (see Theorem III.1.8 and its consequences) and from the definition of the duality bracket between H −1 (Ω) and H01 (Ω) via the scalar product of L2 (Ω) given by (III.39), it follows

5. The Stokes problem

275

−Δv − f, wH −1 ,H01 = 0, ∀w ∈ V. Therefore, from Theorem IV.2.3 there exists a p ∈ L2 (Ω) such that −Δv + ∇p = f. If we choose p with a zero mean value, we ensure the uniqueness of the pressure because Ω is connected.  Remark IV.5.1. It is easily observed that the velocity field v obtained above through the Lax–Milgram theorem is the unique minimiser on V of the energy functional   1 2 J(w) = |∇w| dx − f · w dx, ∀w ∈ V. 2 Ω Ω This is a general property of the solution of variational problems in the symmetric case. The term −Δv−f ∈ (H −1 (Ω))d is nothing but the gradient of J considered as a functional defined on (H01 (Ω))d . Since v minimises J on the subspace V of divergence-free vector fields, the Lagrange multiplier theorem shows that, at the optimum point v, the gradient of J has to be proportional to the gradient of the constraint in some sense. More precisely, the constraint here is linear and defined by the operator div : (H01 (Ω))d → L20 (Ω) and thus there must exist a Π ∈ (L20 (Ω)) such that (∇J)(v) = Π ◦ div ∈ (H −1 (Ω))d . Since L20 (Ω) can be identified with L20 (Ω) itself, there exists a unique p ∈ L20 (Ω) such that  Π, q(L20 ) ,L20 = pq dx, ∀q ∈ L20 (Ω), Ω

so that Π ◦ div, wH −1 ,H01 =

 Ω

p(div w) dx = −∇p, wH −1 ,H01 , ∀w ∈ (H01 (Ω))d ;

that is Π◦div = −∇p. It follows from these computations that, for the Stokes problem, the pressure can be understood as the Lagrange multiplier related to the divergence-free constraint. This was already mentionned in Section 6 of Chapter I. We can now study a slightly generalised Stokes problem. Its consists in assuming, instead of the divergence-free condition, that div v is a given function g which represents mass sources in the domain, and that the velocity v is equal to some given boundary data on ∂Ω.

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

276

Theorem IV.5.2. Let Ω be a connected, bounded, Lipschitz domain of Rd . Let f ∈ (H −1 (Ω))d , vb ∈ (H 1/2 (∂Ω))d , and g ∈ L2 (Ω) satisfying the compatibility condition   vb · ν dσ = g dx, (IV.33) ∂Ω

Ω

then there exists a unique pair (v, p) in (H (Ω))d × L20 (Ω) which is a solution of ⎧ ⎪ ⎨ −Δv + ∇p = f, in Ω, div v = g, in Ω, (IV.34) ⎪ ⎩ v = vb , on ∂Ω. 1

Moreover, there exists a C > 0 depending only on Ω such that vH 1 + pL20 ≤ C (f H −1 + gL2 + vb H 1/2 ) . Remark IV.5.2. By the divergence theorem (Theorem III.1.8), we know that if a solution to (IV.34) exists, then the compatibility condition IV.33 necessarily holds. Proof. The idea of the proof is to build a lifting of the trace and of the mass source term in order to reduce the problem to a classic Stokes problem (i.e., with homogeneous boundary data and divergence-free condition) with a modified source term belonging to (H −1 (Ω))d . Thanks to Theorem III.2.22, G = R0 (vb ) ∈ (H 1 (Ω))d is such that γ0 (G) = vb . This lifting G does not satisfy a priori the equation div G = g. Nevertheless, thanks to the data compatibility condition and the divergence theorem, we have     div G dx = G · ν dσ = vb · ν dσ = g dx. Ω

∂Ω

∂Ω

Ω

Hence, the function g−div G belongs to L2 (Ω) and has a zero mean value, and thus from Theorem IV.3.1, there exists a function H in (H01 (Ω))d satisfying div H = g − div G. Hence, the function G + H simultaneously satisfies the conditions div(G + H) = g, in Ω, and (G + H) = vb on ∂Ω. We then seek v in the form v = G + H + w where w must now satisfy the system ⎧ ⎪ ⎨ −Δw + ∇p = f + Δ(G + H), in Ω, div w = 0, in Ω, ⎪ ⎩ w = 0, on ∂Ω. The source term f + Δ(G + H) belongs to (H −1 (Ω))d so that Theorem IV.5.1 allows us to conclude the existence of a unique pair (w, p) ∈ (H01 (Ω))d ×L20 (Ω)

5. The Stokes problem

277

which is a solution to the problem above. The pair (v = G + H + w, p) is then the unique solution of system (IV.34). Furthermore, we have wH 1 + pL20 ≤ Cf + Δ(G + H)H −1   ≤ C f H −1 + GH 1 + HH01 . However, according to Theorem IV.3.1, the function H satisfies HH01 ≤ Cg − div GL2 ≤ C(gL2 + GH 1 ). Furthermore, by continuity of the trace lifting operator (Theorem III.2.22), we have GH 1 ≤ Cvb H 1/2 . Finally, one obtains wH 1 ≤ C (f H −1 + gL2 + vb H 1/2 ) . And hence, since v = w + G + H, we have proved vH 1 ≤ C (f H −1 + gL2 + vb H 1/2 ) . To obtain the estimate of the pressure, we write the equation in the form ∇p = f + Δv, from which we deduce ∇pH −1 ≤ f H −1 + vH 1 ≤ C (f H −1 + gL2 + vb H 1/2 ) . Hence, according to the Poincar´e inequality given in Proposition IV.1.7, and since p has a zero mean value, we indeed have pL2 ≤ C (f H −1 + gL2 + vb H 1/2 ) . 

5.2 Stokes operator In fact, in the previous section, we can apply the Lax–Milgram theorem for f ∈ V  (which is larger than (H −1 (Ω))d ), but then we can no longer interpret the solution as a solution to the Stokes problem because we cannot show the existence of the pressure. This is essentially due to the fact that the space V  is not a distribution space.

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

278

Nevertheless, the bilinear form a defined in the proof above being continuous on V × V , we can define an operator A from V to V  by  Av, uV  ,V = ∇u : ∇v dx, ∀u, v ∈ V. (IV.35) Ω

The operator A is called the Stokes operator. From the Lax–Milgram theorem this operator is an isomorphism from V onto V  . We can now consider A as an unbounded operator in H with domain D(A) = {u ∈ V, Au ∈ H} . We check now that this operator (A, D(A)) enters the framework described in Section 6 of Chapter II. Lemma IV.5.3. The operator (A, D(A)) has a closed graph in H × H. Proof. Let (un )n be a sequence of elements of D(A) which converges in H towards an element u ∈ H and such that (Aun )n converges in H towards a certain f . Since f ∈ H, there exists a unique v ∈ D(A) such that Av = f . We then need to show that v = u. The convergence in H implies that in V  , therefore we deduce that (Aun )n converges towards Av in V  . However, A is an isomorphism from V onto V  and hence (un )n converges towards v in V . The convergence in V implies the convergence in H, thus we have shown that u = v.  As we saw in the general theory of unbounded operators this property implies that D(A), equipped with the scalar product defined in (II.29), is a Hilbert space and that the operator A is an isomorphism from D(A) onto H. Furthermore for all u ∈ D(A) we have   uV ≤ CAuV  ≤ CAu H ≤ CuD(A) , which shows that the canonical embedding from D(A) to V is continuous. Finally, since the embedding from V to H is compact, by using Lemma II.3.5 we see that the embedding from D(A) to H is compact. Last, we have the following fundamental result. Lemma IV.5.4. The Stokes operator (A, D(A)) is self-adjoint in H. Proof. • First, by definition, for all u, v ∈ D(A), we have  (Au, v)H = Au, vV  ,V = ∇u : ∇v dx, Ω

and therefore it is clear that

5. The Stokes problem

279

(Au, v)H = (u, Av)H , ∀u, v ∈ D(A).

(IV.36)

This implies, in particular, that D(A) ⊂ D(A∗ ) and that for all u ∈ D(A), A∗ u = Au. • We now need to show that D(A∗ ) = D(A). Let u ∈ D(A∗ ). By definition, there exists f = A∗ u ∈ H such that for all v ∈ D(A) we have (Av, u)H = (v, f )H . However, A is bijective from D(A) onto H, and thus there exists u ˜ ∈ D(A) such that f = A˜ u. Let us show that u = u ˜. To do this, let w ∈ H; there then exists w ˜ ∈ D(A) such that Aw ˜ = w. We then have (w, u − u ˜)H = (Aw, ˜ u)H − (Aw, ˜ u ˜ )H .

(IV.37)

From the definition of the adjoint we have (Aw, ˜ u)H = (w, ˜ A∗ u)H , and from (IV.36), since u ˜ ∈ D(A), we have (Aw, ˜ u ˜)H = (w, ˜ A˜ u)H . By definition of u ˜, we have A˜ u = A∗ u and hence, (IV.37) becomes (w, u − u ˜)H = 0, and this for all w ∈ H, which shows that u = u ˜ and, in particular, that u ∈ D(A).  In consequence of all the preceding results, the Stokes operator enters the general framework given in Section 6 of Chapter II. We can therefore construct a spectral decomposition of the Stokes operator. More precisely, we have the following result. Theorem IV.5.5. Let Ω be a bounded, connected, Lipschitz domain of Rd . There exists an increasing sequence of positive real numbers (λk )k≥1 , which tends towards +∞, and a sequence of functions (wk )k≥1 which is orthonormal in H, orthogonal in V and in D(A), forming a complete family in H, in V , and in D(A), and a sequence of functions (pk )k≥1 in L20 (Ω) satisfying ⎧ ⎪ ⎨ −Δwk + ∇pk = λk wk , in Ω, div wk = 0, in Ω, (IV.38) ⎪ ⎩ wk = 0, on ∂Ω. Proof.

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

280

As we have just seen, the Stokes operator enters the framework of Theorem II.6.6. In consequence, there exists an orthonormal basis (wk )k of H formed with eigenvectors of A for the eigenvalues (λk )k , which is also a complete orthogonal family of D(A). It is clear, by construction of the Stokes operator, and via the preceding results of this chapter (Theorem IV.2.3) that there then exist pressures pk ∈ L20 (Ω) such that the system (IV.38) is satisfied. Moreover, we have  2 λk wk H = (Awk , wk )H = |∇wk |2 dx > 0, Ω

which proves that the eigenvalues λk are positive and that they can therefore be ordered in a divergent monotonically increasing sequence. It remains to prove that (wk )k is a complete orthogonal family of V . First, since D(A) ⊂ V , we indeed have wk ∈ V for all k. Moreover, we have (from the identification of H with its dual we remember that we are in the situation where V ⊂ H ⊂ V  )  (wk , wl )V = ∇wk : ∇wl dx = Awk , wl V  ,V = (Awk , wl )H Ω

= λk (wk , wl )H = λk δkl . This proves that the family (wk )k is orthogonal in V . Finally, D(A) is dense in V , and (wk )k is complete in D(A), thus it is clear that this is a complete family in V .  Definition IV.5.6. One such system of functions is called the special basis associated with the Stokes operator A of domain D(A). We often use this family of functions to construct approximate solutions of unsteady problems in the next chapters. Given the special basis of H made up of eigenfunctions of the Stokes operator, we can now give a suitable formula of the Leray projection P (Definition IV.3.6). Lemma IV.5.7. Let Ω be a bounded, connected, Lipschitz domain of Rd . Let (wk )k≥1 be a basis of H made up of eigenfunctions of the Stokes operator. Then, for any function u ∈ (L2 (Ω))d , we have Pu =

+∞  k=1

Proof. Let us define

(u, wk )L2 wk .

5. The Stokes problem

281

v=

+∞ 

(u, wk )L2 wk .

k=1

The sequence (wk )k forms an orthogonal family of H (and hence an orthogonal family in (L2 (Ω))d ), thus it is clear that v ∈ H. Furthermore, for all n ≥ 1 we have (v, wn )L2 =

+∞ 

(u, wk )L2 (wk , wn )L2 = (u, wn )L2 .

k=1

Hence, u − v is orthogonal to all the wn and therefore u − v is orthogonal to all of H. This indeed proves that v is the orthogonal projection of u on H.  The Stokes operator satisfies elliptic regularity properties which are similar to those of the Laplace operator, for instance. More precisely, we can state the following result. Theorem IV.5.8 (Regularity of the Stokes problem). Let Ω be a bounded connected domain of class C k+1,1 in Rd , with k ≥ 0. Then, for any f ∈  k d H (Ω) , g ∈ H k+1 (Ω), and vb ∈ (H k+3/2 (∂Ω))d satisfying (IV.33), the unique solution of (IV.34) in V × L20 (Ω) satisfies  d (v, p) ∈ H k+2 (Ω) × H k+1 (Ω) and we have vH k+2 + pH k+1 ≤ C (f H k + gH k+1 + vb H k+3/2 ) , where C > 0 depends only on Ω. This result is admitted for the moment. The proof of this result is the subject of Section 6. We note that, for k = 0, this result is even true in convex polygonal domains, for example (see, e.g., [73]). Remark IV.5.3. It is important to note that, as we might expect, the pressure p has one degree of regularity less than the velocity field v. The preceding regularity theory enables a precise description of the domain of the Stokes operator in the following way. Proposition IV.5.9 (Domain of the Stokes operator). Let Ω be a bounded domain of Rd of class C 1,1 , then we have: D(A) = V ∩ (H 2 (Ω))d . Moreover Av = P(−Δv), ∀v ∈ D(A),

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

282

where P is the Leray projection and there exists a C > 0 such that 1 vH 2 ≤ AvH ≤ CvH 2 , ∀v ∈ D(A). C In particular, if Ω is of class C 1,1 the eigenfunctions (wk )k of the Stokes operator belong to (H 2 (Ω))d and the associated pressures (pk )k belong to H 1 (Ω). Proof. • Let us show that V ∩ (H 2 (Ω))d ⊂ D(A). Let v ∈ V ∩ (H 2 (Ω))d , then a priori Av is an element of V  . For ϕ ∈ V ⊂ H and since v is smooth, we can integrate by parts and use the Leray projection P to obtain   Av, ϕV  ,V = ∇v : ∇ϕ dx = (−Δv) · ϕ dx Ω

Ω

= (−Δv, ϕ)L2 = (P(−Δv), ϕ)H = P(−Δv), ϕV  ,V . By definition V is dense in V , thus this shows that Av = P(−Δv) ∈ H and hence that v ∈ D(A). Moreover, since P is an orthogonal projection in (L2 (Ω))d we have AvH ≤  − ΔvL2 ≤ CvH 2 . • It therefore remains to show that D(A) ⊂ V ∩ (H 2 (Ω))d . Let v ∈ D(A), that is such that f = Av ∈ H. We can now write for all ϕ ∈ V f, ϕH −1 ,H01 = (f, ϕ)L2 = (f, ϕ)H = Av, ϕV  ,V  = ∇v : ∇ϕ dx = −Δv, ϕH −1 ,H01 . Ω

Hence −Δv − f is an element of (H −1 (Ω))d such that for all ϕ ∈ V , we have −Δv−f, ϕH −1 ,H01 = 0. From de Rham’s theorem (Theorem IV.2.4), there exists p ∈ L2 (Ω) such that −Δv + ∇p = f. Since f ∈ H ⊂ (L2 (Ω))d , the regularity Theorem IV.5.8 implies that v ∈ (H 2 (Ω))d and that vH 2 ≤ Cf L2 = CAvH , which ends the proof.  We now return to the definition of the fractional powers of the operator A described in Section 6 of Chapter II and we set for all s ∈ R,

5. The Stokes problem

283

Vs = D(As/2 ). We denote the scalar product and the norm on Vs as (·, ·)s and  · s , respectively. We then have the following result. Proposition IV.5.10. If Ω is of class C 1,1 and if 1 ≤ s ≤ 2, then Vs = V ∩ (H s (Ω))d . If Ω is of class C k,1 , k ≥ 2 and if 2 < s ≤ k + 1, we have only Vs ⊂ V ∩ (H s (Ω))d . Proof. The case s = 2 is given by the preceding proposition. We will only study the case s = 1, the rest of the proposition being admitted (see, for example, [44]). We now wish to show that V1 = D(A1/2 ) is equal to V . To do this, we consider the basis of eigenfunctions of the Stokes operator (wk )k which, as we have seen, all belong to V . Furthermore, we have (wk , wl )D(A1/2 ) = δkl (1 + λk )(wk , wk )H = δkl (wk 2H + (Awk , wk )H )    = δkl wk 2H + |∇wk |2 dx = δkl (wk 2H + wk 2V ) Ω

= (wk , wl )H + (wk , wl )V . (IV.39) Any u ∈ D(A1/2 ) is written as a limit in D(A1/2 ) of finite sums of the type N SN = k=1 αk wk , this sequence (SN )N is therefore a Cauchy sequence in D(A1/2 ). From (IV.39), we get SN − SN +p V ≤ SN − SN +p D(A1/2 ) , so that (SN )N is a Cauchy sequence in V and thus converges in V . Its limit is necessarily equal to u because the embeddings of D(A1/2 ) and of V in H are continuous and the limit of (SN )N in H is unique. As a consequence, D(A1/2 ) ⊂ V and (IV.39) gives (u, v)D(A1/2 ) = (u, v)H + (u, v)V , ∀u, v ∈ D(A1/2 ). Hence, the norms of V and of D(A1/2 ) are equivalent in this last space and since D(A1/2 ) is complete, this is a closed set of V . Finally, we know that D(A1/2 ) is dense in V , because the (wk )k , which form a complete family in V , all belong to D(A1/2 ). This proves that D(A1/2 ) = V . 

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

284

Using these definitions, we can prove a continuity result by interpolation, which is nothing but the expression of Theorem II.5.14 in the particular case of interest to us. Theorem IV.5.11. Let (α, β) be two real numbers such that β ≤ α. Let % & du E = u ∈ L2 (]0, T [, Vα ), ∈ L2 (]0, T [, Vβ ) . dt Then E is continuously embedded in C 0 ([0, T ], V(α+β)/2 ). Proof. • First, we take a function u written as u(t) =

N 

αk (t)wk ,

k=1

where αk ∈ C ∞ ([0, T ]). We can write αk (t) = θ1 (t)αk (t) + (1 − θ1 (t))αk (t) = βk (t) + γk (t), with θ1 being regular with support included in [0, T /2] and, for example, θ1 = 1 identically on [0, T /3]. We set v(t) =

N 

βk (t)wk ,

k=1

and we establish the result for v (the argument being made in an identical way for u − v). By noting that βk (t) = (v(t), wk )H , we have the equality 1 d (v, v)(α+β)/2 = 2 dt



dv ,v dt

 = (α+β)/2

N  

(α+β)/2

(1 + λk

 )βk (t)βk (t) .

k=1

Hence, since v(+∞) = 0, we have for all t ∈ [0, T ], 1 ||v(t)||2(α+β)/2 = − 2 1 ≤ 2 1 ≤ 2



N  T 

t





N 

N 2  2 (1 + λα + (1 + λβk )(βk (τ ) k )(βk (τ )

k=1

T



||v(τ )||2α 0

 )βk (τ )βk (τ ) dτ

k=1

T

0



(α+β)/2

(1 + λk



k=1

 

 dv 2 1  dτ ≤ ||v||2E . +  dt (τ ) 2 β

The function u (and therefore v) being clearly continuous with values in V(a+β)/2 , this shows that

5. The Stokes problem

285

uC 0 ([0,T ],V(a+β)/2 ) ≤ CuE . • By density of C ∞ ([0, T ]) in H 1 (]0, T [), we can extend the previous result to the case where all the functions αk belong to H 1 (]0, T [). However, any function u of E decomposes in a unique way in the form u(t) =

+∞ 

αk (t)ωk ,

k=1

where the αk belong to H 1 (]0, T [) and the convergence of the series takes place in E. We can therefore extend the result to all functions of E.  Let us finish this section with a new sight to the Poincar´e inequality. Proposition IV.5.12. Let Ω be a bounded, Lipschitz domain of Rd . We have the following Poincar´e inequalities 1 ∇v2L2 , ∀v ∈ V, λ1 1 ≤ Av2L2 , ∀v ∈ D(A), λ1

v2H ≤ ∇v2L2

(IV.40)

where λ1 is the smallest eigenvalue of the Stokes operator. Moreover, the constant 1/λ1 is optimal in these two inequalities. Proof. We already proved the Poincar´e inequality in a more general way (Proposition III.2.38). Inequality (IV.40) gives the value of the optimum constant in the case of divergence-free vector fields. We denote the special basis of the eigenfunctions of the Stokes operator as (wk )k≥1 . • Let us start   by proving (IV.40). Let v = k≥1 vk wk ∈ V , such that Av = k≥1 λk vk wk . We then have  |∇v|2 dx = Av, vV  ,V = Ω



λk |vk |2 ,

k≥1

and since λ1 is the smallest of the eigenvalues of A, we have   |∇v|2 dx ≥ λ1 |vk |2 = λ1 v2H . Ω

k≥1

It is clear that this constant is optimal, because if we take v = w1 in (IV.40) it becomes an equality. •  Now, let v ∈ D(A), which we again write in the special basis v = k≥1 vk wk . We have

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

286

Av2L2 =

 k≥1

λ2k vk2 ≥ λ1



λk vk2 = λ1 Av, vV  ,V = λ1 ∇v2L2 .

k≥1

The equality case is again obtained by taking v = w1 . 

5.3 The unsteady Stokes problem In this section, we use the elements introduced before concerning the Stokes operator in order to solve the following unsteady incompressible Stokes problem ⎧ ∂v ⎪ ⎪ − Δv + ∇p = f, in Ω, ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ ∂t div v = 0, in Ω, (IV.41) ⎪ ⎪ v = 0, on ∂Ω, ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ v(0) = v0 . Notice that the Reynolds number is chosen equal to 1. This is allowed without loss of generality because the problem is linear. Theorem IV.5.13. Let Ω be a connected, bounded, Lipschitz domain of Rd . For any v0 ∈ H, and f ∈ L2loc ([0, +∞[, (H −1 (Ω))d ), there exists a unique pair (v, p) defined on R+ which solves (IV.41) and such that for any T > 0 we have   (v, p) ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], H) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, V ) × W −1,∞ (]0, T [, L20 (Ω)), and

dv ∈ L2 (]0, T [, V  ). dt Moreover, it satisfies the following energy equality for any t ≥ 0.  t  t 1 1 1 ∇v(τ )2L2 dτ = v0 2L2 + f (τ ), v(τ )H −1 ,H01 dτ. v(t)2L2 + 2 Re 0 2 0 Proof. In order to illustrate the application of semigroup theory, here we only give the proof in the case of more regular source terms. The proof in the general case can be performed in a similar way as we do for the Navier–Stokes problem in Chapter V, that is, by using a suitable Galerkin approximation of the problem. Let us assume that f ∈ C 1 ([0, +∞[, (L2 (Ω))d ). We can use Theorem II.6.12 which shows that there exists a unique solution v ∈ C 0 ([0, +∞[, H) ∩ C 1 (]0, +∞[, H) ∩ C 0 (]0, +∞[, D(A)) of the linear problem

5. The Stokes problem

287

dv + Av = Pf, dt with v(0) = v0 . We used here the Leray projection P, so that Pf ∈ C 1 ([0, +∞[, H). Let ϕ ∈ V be any time-independent test function. For any t > 0 we thus have     dv dv 0= = +Av(t), ϕV  ,V . (t) + Av(t) − Pf (t), ϕ (t) − Pf (t), ϕ dt dt H L2 By definition of the Leray projection and since ϕ ∈ V ⊂ H, we have (Pf (t), ϕ)L2 = (f (t), ϕ)L2 , and by definition of the Stokes operator and integration by parts.  Av(t), ϕV  ,V = ∇v(t) : ∇ϕ dx = −Δv(t), ϕH −1 ,H01 . Ω

!

It follows 0=

" dv . (t) − Δv(t) − f (t), ϕ dt H −1 ,H 1 0

This being true for any ϕ ∈ V , we can use Theorem IV.2.3 to obtain that there exists a unique p(t) ∈ L20 (Ω) such that dv (t) − Δv(t) − f (t) = −∇p(t), in H −1 (Ω). dt

(IV.42)

From the regularity properties of v and f , it follows that the pressure gradient satisfies ∇p ∈ C 0 (]0, +∞[, (H −1 (Ω))d ). Using the Neˇcas inequality (Theorem IV.1.1) and the Poincar´e inequality (Proposition IV.1.7), we deduce that p belongs to C 0 (]0, +∞[, L20 (Ω)). We conclude the proof by observing that (IV.42) is true for any t > 0, so that (v, p) solves the unsteady Stokes problem in the distribution sense.  Remark IV.5.4. We observe that the above result is independent on the space dimension d which is considered. We show in Chapter V that the situation is very different for the Navier–Stokes equations due to the presence of nonlinear terms in the system.

5.4 Penalty approximation of the Stokes problem In this section, we present an alternative method to prove the well-posedness of the Stokes problem, that is to prove Theorem IV.5.1. In addition to its the-

288

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

oretical interest (it does not directly use de Rham’s theorem, but rather the Neˇcas inequality), the method has a practical interest in particular as far as numerical approximation of the solution of the Stokes problem is concerned. For any ε > 0 we consider the following penalty approximation of the system ⎧ ⎪ ⎨ −Δvε + ∇pε = f, in Ω, div vε + εpε = 0, in Ω, (IV.43) ⎪ ⎩ vε = 0, on ∂Ω. The main advantage of this new problem is that the pressure pε can be easily eliminated from the system (see (IV.45)). As a consequence, it is very easy to show that this system is well-posed. Lemma IV.5.14. Let Ω be a bounded, connected, Lipschitz domain in Rd and f ∈ (H −1 (Ω))d . For any ε > 0, there exists a unique pair (vε , pε ) ∈ (H01 (Ω))d × L20 (Ω) satisfying (IV.43). Proof. We observe that the second equation of (IV.43) can be immediately solved by 1 pε = − div vε , (IV.44) ε so that the first equation of (IV.43) becomes 1 − Δvε − ∇(div vε ) = f. ε

(IV.45)

It simply remains to solve this new problem by using the Lax–Milgram theorem. Indeed, the continuous bilinear form aε : (H01 (Ω))d × (H01 (Ω))d → R defined by   1 aε (v, w) = ∇v : ∇w dx + (div v)(div w) dx, ∀v, w ∈ (H01 (Ω))d , ε Ω Ω is clearly coercive on (H01 (Ω))d and the claim is proved.



Proposition IV.5.15. With the same assumption as in Lemma IV.5.14, there exists a C > 0 such that vε H 1 + pε H 1 ≤ Cf H −1 , ∀ε > 0. Proof. The application of the Lax–Milgram theorem above leads to the estimate 1 ∇vε 2L2 +  div vε 2L2 ≤ f H −1 vε H01 . ε By using the Poincar´e inequality, and (IV.44), we deduce

5. The Stokes problem

289

∇vε 2L2 + 2εpε 2L2 ≤ f 2H −1 . This estimate is not satisfactory for the pressure term. To obtain the bound on pε that we claimed, we use the Neˇcas inequality (Theorem IV.1.1) and more precisely the related Poincar´e inequality (IV.8). This inequality gives pε L2 ≤ C∇pε H −1 = CΔvε + f H −1 ≤ C∇vε L2 + Cf H −1 . Combining this with the estimate above, we obtain the claim.  We can deduce from this result the existence of a solution (v, p) ∈ (H01 (Ω))d × L20 (Ω) of the Stokes problem, that is, proving Theorem IV.5.1. Indeed, from the bounds obtained in Proposition IV.5.15, we can find a subsequence (vεn )n (resp., (pεn )n ) which weakly converges towards some v in (H01 (Ω))d (resp., towards some p in L20 (Ω)). These weak convergences let us pass to the limit in the approximate problem (IV.43) and prove that the limits (v, p) actually solve the Stokes problem. This solution is unique, therefore we can deduce the convergence of the whole families (vε )ε and (pε )ε (see Proposition II.2.9). Moreover, we have  div vε L2 ≤ Cε. We conclude this section by proving a first-order error estimate for this approximation method. Proposition IV.5.16. With the same assumption as in Lemma IV.5.14, there exists a C > 0 such that v − vε H 1 + p − pε L2 ≤ Cε. Proof. We set wε = v − vε , qε = p − pε and we write the equations satisfied by (wε , qε ) ⎧ in Ω, ⎪ ⎨ −Δwε + ∇qε = 0, div wε − εpε = 0, in Ω, (IV.46) ⎪ ⎩ wε = 0, on ∂Ω. Using once more the inequality (IV.8), we obtain qε L2 ≤ C∇qε H −1 ≤ CΔwε H −1 ≤ C∇wε L2 .

(IV.47)

Then, we use wε as a test-function in the first equation of (IV.46) to obtain  2 ∇wε L2 = (div wε )qε dx ≤  div wε L2 qε L2 ≤ εpε L2 qε L2 . Ω

From the estimate given in Proposition IV.5.15, from (IV.47) and from the Young inequality we get ∇wε 2L2 ≤ Cε2 . Coming back to (IV.47) we get

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

290

qε 2L2 ≤ Cε2 , and the claim is proved. 

6 Regularity of the Stokes problem 6.1 First degree of regularity The goal of this section is to prove Theorem IV.5.8 for k = 0. We demonstrate the general version of Theorem IV.5.8 in Section 6.2, using an induction argument.

6.1.1 Local regularity The first step in proving Theorem IV.5.8 is to establish a local regularity result. Notice that this result does not necessitate any assumption on the domain Ω. Moreover, it is independent on the boundary condition satisfied by the solution. Theorem IV.6.1. Let Ω be any open set of Rd , f ∈ (L2loc (Ω))d , and g ∈ 1 1 Hloc (Ω). For any (v, p) in (Hloc (Ω))d × L2loc (Ω) which is a solution of  −Δv + ∇p = f, in Ω, div v = g, in Ω, 2 1 (Ω))d × Hloc (Ω). More precisely, for any bounded open sets then (v, p) ∈ (Hloc ω, ω2 such that ω ⊂ ω2 ⊂ ω2 ⊂ Ω, there exists a C(ω, ω2 ) > 0, such that  vH 2 (ω) + pH 1 (ω) ≤C(ω, ω2 ) f L2 (ω2 ) + gH 1 (ω2 )  + vH 1 (ω2 ) + pL2 (ω2 ) .

Proof. From Proposition III.2.3, we know that is sufficient to prove that, for any ϕ ∈ D(Ω), we have ϕv ∈ H 2 (Rd ) and ϕp ∈ H 1 (Rd ) with a suitable estimate on ϕvH 2 (Rd ) + ϕpH 1 (Rd ) . To this end, we set w = ϕv and q = ϕp. Since ϕ is smooth, following the same computations as in the proof of Theorem III.4.2, we immediately find the equation satisfied by w and q in the sense of distributions of Rd  −Δw + ∇q = ϕf − (Δϕ)v − 2∇v.∇ϕ + p∇ϕ, div w = ϕg + v · ∇ϕ.

6. Regularity of the Stokes problem

291

If we denote the second terms of these equations as f˜ and g˜, it is clear that f˜ lies in (L2 (Rd ))d , that g˜ belongs to H 1 (Rd ), and that f˜L2 (Rd ) ≤ϕL∞ f L2 (ω2 ) + ΔϕL∞ vL2 (ω2 ) (IV.48) + 2∇ϕL∞ vH 1 (ω2 ) + ∇ϕL∞ pL2 (ω2 ) , ≤C1 (ϕ)(f L2 (ω2 ) + gH 1 (ω2 ) + vH 1 (ω2 ) + pL2 (ω2 ) ). Similarly, we obtain ˜ g H 1 (Rd ) ≤ C2 (ϕ)(f L2 (ω2 ) + gH 1 (ω2 ) + vH 1 (ω2 ) + pL2 (ω2 ) ). (IV.49) Moreover, we already have the estimate given by Theorem IV.5.2, which gives us here wH 1 (Rd ) ≤ (ϕL∞ + ∇ϕL∞ )vH 1 (ω2 ) ≤ C(ϕ)vH 1 (ω2 ) ,

(IV.50)

and qL2 (Rd ) ≤ ϕL∞ pL2 .

(IV.51)

We are therefore led to studying the following Stokes system in the whole space Rd  −Δw + ∇q = f˜, (IV.52) div w = g˜. We note that all of the functions appearing in this system are zero outside the compact set Ω, which justifies all the operations which follow. We use the characterisation of the Sobolev spaces H k+1 (Rd ) by means of translation operators which is given in Proposition III.2.32. We use the notations introduced in Section 2.7 of Chapter III. We need to estimate δh w and δh q. From (IV.52) we obtain  −Δδh w + ∇δh q = δh f˜, div δh w = δh g˜. We use the Neˇcas inequality (Theorem IV.1.1) which gives that δh qL2 ≤ C(δh qH −1 + ∇δh qH −1 ). The term δh qH −1 is bounded by |h|qL2 according to Lemma III.2.31. The second term is expressed using the first equation of the system ∇δh qH −1 = δh f˜ + Δδh wH −1 ≤ C|h|f˜L2 + ∇δh wL2 , so that we finally get δh qL2 ≤ C|h|(qL2 + f˜L2 ) + C∇δh wL2 .

(IV.53)

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

292

We can now use δh w (which is compactly supported) as a test function in the first equation to obtain, with the help of the second equation,   2 ˜ |∇δh w| dx = δh f , δh wH −1 ,H 1 + δh qδh g˜ dx Rd

Ω

≤ δh f˜H −1 δh wH 1 + δh qL2 δh g˜L2 ≤ C|h|f˜L2 (∇δh wL2 + |h|wH 1 ) + C|h|˜ g H 1 δh qL2 . Using (IV.53), it follows ∇δh w2L2 ≤C|h|f˜L2 (∇δh wL2 + |h|wH 1 ) + C|h|2 ˜ g H 1 (qL2 + f˜L2 ) + C|h|˜ g H 1 ∇δh wL2 . Through Young’s inequality, this gives   ∇δh w2L2 ≤ C|h|2 f˜2L2 + w2H 1 + ˜ g 2H 1 + q2L2 . We can now use the estimates (IV.48) through (IV.51) which finally give us, for any h ∈ Rd ,   ∇δh w2L2 ≤ C(ϕ)|h|2 f 2L2 (ω2 ) + g2H 1 (ω2 ) + v2H 1 (ω2 ) + p2L2 (ω2 ) . This allows us to conclude that w ∈ (H 2 (Rd ))d from Proposition III.2.32 and that we have the required estimate on wH 2 (Rd ) . Furthermore, we can immediately see in the first equation of (IV.52) that it implies that ∇q lies in (L2 (Ω))d and that we have vH 2 (ω1 ) + pH 1 (ω1 ) ≤ wH 2 + qH 1   ≤C(ϕ) f L2 (ω2 ) + gH 1 (ω2 ) + vH 1 (ω2 ) + pL2 (ω2 ) .  Remark IV.6.1. Assume that v ∈ (H 1 (Ω))d , p ∈ L2 (Ω), f ∈ (L2 (Ω))d , and g ∈ H 1 (Ω). Let us consider the family of open sets of Rd defined by & % 1 . ωk = x ∈ Ω, d(x, ∂Ω) > k For all sufficiently large k, we have ωk ⊂ ωk ⊂ ωk+1 ⊂ · · · . The estimate given by the previous theorem can be specified in the following way,

6. Regularity of the Stokes problem

293



 v2H 2 (ωk ) + p2H 1 (ωk ) ≤ Ck f 2L2 (Ω) + g2H 1 (Ω) + v2H 1 (Ω) + p2L2 (Ω) . We note that the constant Ck which acts in this inequality can be easily estimated by Ck ∼ ∇ϕk 2L∞ + Δϕk 2L∞ , where ϕk is the truncature function which is supported in ωk+1 and which is equal to 1 on ωk . A simple calculation shows that Ck behaves essentially as does k 8 when k tends towards infinity. This shows that the above technique does not allow us to pass to the limit, when k tends towards infinity, to obtain regularity of the solution on all Ω. This is in particular because the regularity up to the boundary of the solution of an elliptic problem, as with the Stokes problem, strongly depends on the kind and the regularity of the boundary condition satisfied by the solution and also on the regularity of the domain Ω.

6.1.2 Regularity up to the boundary We proved in the previous section the local regularity result for the Stokes problem. In order to complete the proof of the regularity result, it is now necessary to obtain regularity of the solution up to the boundary. As for the Laplace problem (see Section 4 of Chapter III), this is done in two main steps: we first obtain tangential regularity by using translations along tangent vector fields, then we deduce the complete regularity directly from the equations. We first illustrate this strategy in the case; of the flat half-space Rd+ because the computations are much simpler; then will consider the general case by using the tools introduced in Section 3 of Chapter III. 6.1.2.1 The case of the half-space Rd+ In this paragraph, we illustrate the general strategy of proof in the case of the simple geometry of the half-space Rd+ . The general case is considered in the next paragraph. Let us consider here the following problem ⎧ d ⎪ ⎨ −Δv + v + ∇p = f, in R+ , (IV.54) div v = 0, in Rd+ , ⎪ ⎩ d v = 0, on ∂R+ , where f ∈ (L2 (Rd+ ))d . Because of the unbounded character of the domain Rd+ that we are considering in this example, and in order to simplify the description of the method, we have added a zero-order term v to the operator considered. This ensures the coercivity of the operator on (H 1 (Rd+ ))d and

294

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

hence the existence and uniqueness of solutions. This system is therefore a model problem that we use to illustrate the method that we use below on a sufficiently smooth bounded domain Ω. Due to the coercivity of the operator, we know that there exists a unique pair (v, p) ∈ (H01 (Rd+ ))d × L2loc (Rd+ ), the pressure being defined apart from a constant, providing a solution of the preceding problem and satisfying vH01 + ∇pH −1 ≤ Cf H −1 .

(IV.55)

Remark IV.6.2. We pay attention to the fact that it is not possible to assert (see Proposition IV.2.4) that p ∈ L2 (Rd+ ) or even to H −1 (Rd+ ). In particular, we cannot consider a pressure here with a zero mean, unlike in the case of a bounded domain. We want to use the characterisation of tangential Sobolev spaces through translation operators that we introduced in Section 3.5 of Chapter III. In the case Ω = Rd+ considered here, it is easily seen that we only need to consider constant tangential vector fields θ(x) = ei , for i = 1, . . . , d − 1. The corresponding flows h → τ i (h, x), are thus defined with the differential equation  d i τ (h, x) = ei , dh i τ (0, x) = x. This equation can of course be immediately solved to give τ i (h, x) = x + hei . The vectors ei , i = 1, . . . , d − 1 are tangent to the boundary of Rd+ , thus these flows satisfy the condition: for all x ∈ Rd+ , and for all h ∈ R, τ i (h, x) also belongs to Rd+ . The geometry being very simple, the commutation estimates of Proposition III.3.19 are useless. Indeed, we easily check that in that case the translation operators and the differential operators exactly commute   ∂(v ◦ τ i (h, x)) ∂v ◦ τ i (h, x), ∀j ∈ {1, . . . , d}, ∀i ∈ {1, . . . , d − 1}. = ∂xj ∂xj As we did in Chapter III, we then introduce the difference operators associated with these translation operators (δhi v)(x) = v(τ i (h, x)) − v(x). Then, we can develop the same approach as we used for the Laplace problem in Section 4 of Chapter III. Of course, the presence of the pressure term and of the divergence-free constraint implies additional difficulties that we describe below. In particular, it should be noticed that tangential and normal components of the velocity field are not studied in a similar way. Proposition IV.6.2. Assuming that f ∈ (L2 (Rd+ ))d , the solution (v, p) of System (IV.54), satisfies v ∈ (H 2 (Rd+ ))d and ∇p ∈ L2 (Rd+ ). Moreover, there exists a C > 0 such that vH 2 + ∇pL2 ≤ Cf L2 .

6. Regularity of the Stokes problem

295

Proof. • Step 1 : tangential regularity. i Let ϕ ∈ (H01 (Rd+ ))d such that div ϕ = 0. The function δ−h ϕ is also divergence-free (thanks to the commutation property described above) and may therefore be chosen as a test function in our problem. By using Lemma III.2.30, we obtain a variational problem satisfied by δhi v    i i ∇(δh v) : ∇ϕ dx + (δh v) · ϕ dx = (δhi f ) · ϕ dx, Rd +

Rd +

Rd +

for all ϕ ∈ (H01 (Rd+ ))d , such that div ϕ = 0. Taking ϕ = δhi v in this equation gives δhi v2H 1 = δhi f, δhi vH −1 ,H01 . Using the assumption that f ∈ L2 (Rd+ ) and Lemma III.2.31, we obtain the inequality δhi vH 1 ≤ |h|f L2 , which implies that v is tangentially regular on all Rd+ . More precisely, by proceeding as in the proof of Proposition III.2.32, we deduce that ∂v/∂xi belongs to (H 1 (Rd+ ))d for all i ∈ {1, . . . , d − 1}. In other words, we have shown that ∂ 2 v/∂xi ∂xj belongs to L2 (Rd+ ) for all i, j except for i = j = d. We can now deduce the tangential regularity of the pressure. Indeed, for any i ≤ d − 1 we obtain from (IV.54) that ∂ ∂f ∂v ∂Δv (∇p) = − + ∂xi ∂xi ∂xi ∂xi   ∂f ∂v ∂v . = − + div ∇ ∂xi ∂xi ∂xi Note that in the term ∇∂v/∂xi , there is no second-order derivative of type ∂ 2 v/∂x2d ; this term thus belongs to (L2 (Rd+ ))d from the preceding arguments. By taking the divergence of this term and by using the fact that f ∈ (L2 (Rd+ ))d , we obtain ∇

∂ ∂p = (∇p) ∈ (H −1 (Rd+ ))d . ∂xi ∂xi

∂p ∈ H −1 (Rd+ ). Hence, ∂xi from the Neˇcas inequality (Theorem IV.1.1), we have shown that the dis∂p tribution lies in L2 (Rd+ ) and satisfies the expected estimate for all ∂xi i ≤ d − 1. • Step 2 : Complete regularity. Furthermore, from (IV.55), we already know that

296

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

To obtain the complete regularity of the solution, it remains to study the derivatives of v and p in the direction ed . In the same way as for the Laplace problem, these properties are directly obtained from the partial differential equations and using the tangential regularity properties we just obtained. – Substep 1 : Complete regularity of the normal component of the velocity field. We differentiate the divergence equation with respect to xd , which gives d−1  ∂ 2 vi ∂ 2 vd = − ∈ L2 (Rd+ ). 2 ∂xd ∂x ∂x i d i=1

Therefore, we have proved that the normal component vd belongs to H 2 (Rd+ ). – Substep 2 : Complete regularity of the pressure. We write the dth component of the momentum equation in the Stokes problem in the following form ∂p = Δvd − vd + fd , ∂xd so that, using the regularity of vd that we proved above, we immediately see that ∂p/∂xd also lies in L2 (Rd+ ). Therefore, we have proved that p ∈ H 1 (Rd+ ). – Substep 3 : Complete regularity of tangential components of the velocity field. For i ≤ d − 1, we can write the ith equation of the system in the form d−1 2  ∂ vi ∂p ∂ 2 vi = − + vi + − fi . 2 2 ∂xd ∂xj ∂xi j=1

We deduce that ∂ 2 vi /∂x2d also belongs to L2 (Rd+ ), and thus that vi ∈ H 2 (Rd+ ). The regularity theorem is then proved and more precisely, we have established the existence of some C > 0 such that   vH 2 + ∇pL2 ≤ C f L2 + ∇pH −1 .  Let us now follow the same scenario in the case of a general smooth bounded domain in the sequel.

6. Regularity of the Stokes problem

297

6.1.2.2 Tangential regularity We recall that we have already shown in Theorem IV.6.1 the local regularity 2 1 (Hloc (Ω))d × Hloc (Ω) of the solution of the Stokes problem. Let us now show 2 1 the tangential regularity (Htang (Ω))d × Htang (Ω) of this same solution if the data are regular up to the boundary. We use here the notation introduced in Section 3 of Chapter III. Theorem IV.6.3. Let Ω be a connected bounded domain of class C 1,1 of Rd , f ∈ (L2 (Ω))d and g ∈ H 1 (Ω) ∩ L20 (Ω). If (v, p) is the unique solution in (H01 (Ω))d × L20 (Ω) of ⎧ ⎪ ⎨ −Δv + ∇ p = f, in Ω, div v = g, in Ω, ⎪ ⎩ v = 0, on ∂Ω, 2 1 (Ω))d and p ∈ Htang (Ω) and for any vector field θ satisfying then v ∈ (Htang (III.77) with k = 0, there exists a C(Ω, θ) > 0 such that

|||v|||θ,2 + |||p|||θ,1 ≤ C(Ω, θ) (f L2 + gH 1 ) . The proof of this result requires several steps, inspired by the calculations carried out in the case of the half-space (see Section 6.1.2.1). We begin by looking for the equation satisfied by the differences δhθ v = v ◦ τ θ (h, ·) − v and δhθ p = p ◦ τ θ (h, ·) − p, paying attention to the differentiation operations. The lemma below gives a suitable expression of the commutators between the differential operators and the translation operators along the tangential fields. In the case of the half-space that we have considered previously, these commutators were zero because of the particularly simple structure of the tangential translations. Lemma IV.6.4. We have the following equalities , , -  ⎧ θ θ θ θ v) = −δ (Δv) − div, τ ∇v − div ∇, τ v , −Δ(δ ⎪ h h h h ⎨ , ∇δhθ p = δhθ ∇p + ∇, τhθ p, ⎪ , ⎩ div(δhθ v) = δhθ (div v) + div, τhθ v.

(IV.56)

Proof (Lemma IV.6.4). This involves simple, purely algebraic computations.  Proof (Theorem IV.6.3). Let h ∈]0, 1[ and let θ be a vector field tangential to the boundary of Ω (i.e., satisfying (III.77) with k = 0). We denote w = δhθ v, π = δhθ p. By using (IV.56), we see that the pair (w, π) satisfy the system

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

298



−Δw + ∇π = F, in Ω, div w = G, in Ω,

(IV.57)

where , , , -  F = δhθ f + ∇, τhθ p − div, τhθ ∇v − div ∇, τhθ v , and

, G = δhθ g + δhθ (div v) + div, τhθ v.

(IV.58)

(IV.59)

We note that since for a fixed h τ (h, ·) is a bijection from ∂Ω onto itself, the function w belongs to (H01 (Ω))d . Let us now evaluate F in the (H −1 (Ω))d norm. With (III.91) and (III.92) we obtain θ

δhθ f H −1 ≤ Chf L2 , ,   div, τhθ ∇v  −1 ≤ Ch∇vL2 ,  , , - H -  div ∇, τhθ v  −1 ≤  ∇, τhθ v  2 ≤ ChvH 1 . H L We can then use the estimate in (H 1 (Ω))d on the solution v for the initial problem (Theorem IV.5.2) to obtain that F H −1 ≤ Ch(f L2 + gH 1 ). In the same way we can estimate G in L2 (Ω) by GL2 ≤ ChgH 1 + ChvH 1 ≤ Ch(f L2 + gH 1 ). We then carry out the classic energy estimate for problem (IV.57) and obtain  2 2 ∇wL2 ≤F H −1 ∇wL + π G dx Ω

≤Ch (f L2 + gH 1 ) ∇wL2 + πL2 GL2 ≤Ch (f L2 + gH 1 ) ∇wL2 + ChπL2 (f L2 + gH 1 ) .

(IV.60)

Furthermore, we read the following estimate directly from Equation (IV.6.4) ∇πH −1 ≤ ΔwH −1 + F H −1 ≤ C∇wL2 + Ch (f L2 + gH 1 ) , and from (III.92) and Theorem IV.5.2 we have πH −1 = δhθ pH −1 ≤ ChpL2 ≤ Ch (f L2 + gH 1 ) . Finally, from the Neˇcas inequality (see Theorem IV.1.1), we obtain

6. Regularity of the Stokes problem

πL2 ≤ C(πH −1 + ∇πH −1 ) ≤ C∇wL2 + Ch (f L2 + gH 1 ) .

299

(IV.61)

Hence, from inequalities (IV.60), (IV.61), and Young’s inequality   ∇w2L2 ≤ Ch (f L2 + gH 1 ) ∇wL2 + Ch2 f 2L2 + g2H 1   1 ≤ Ch2 f 2L2 + g2H 1 + ∇w2L2 . 2 This allows us to conclude, using (IV.61), with the inequality   ∇δhθ v2L2 + δhθ p2L2 ≤ Ch2 f 2L2 + g2H 1 , which states precisely that   |||v|||2θ,2 + |||p|||2θ,1 ≤ C f 2L2 + g2H 1 . 

6.1.2.3 Complete regularity up to the boundary We now use the coordinate system established in a tubular neighborhood Osρ0 of the boundary of Ω in Chapter III. We have just seen that, under the hypothesis of Theorem IV.5.8 with k = 0, the solution of the Stokes problem 2 1 belongs to (Htang (Ω))d × Htang (Ω). To prove the regularity of the solution on all Ω, it is sufficient to prove its regularity in Osρ0 . The tangential/normal coordinate system allows the roles of the “tangential” variables and the normal variable to be separated, as we did in the much simpler case of the half-space Rd+ in Section 6.1.2.1. Recall that in Section 3 of Chapter III we used the notation x, y for the Euclidean scalar product of two vectors x and y, whereas in what follows we denote this scalar product as x · y. • In the open set Osρ0 , the equation on the divergence of v reads Tr(∇T v) + ∇N vN + v · G˜ = g ∈ H 1 (Osρ0 ).

(IV.62)

By using the tangential regularity properties of v that we proved before, we see that the first term of this equality belongs to H 1 (Osρ0 ). Furthermore, we have   ˜ ˜ ∇N v · G = (∇N v) · G˜ + v · ∇N G. (IV.63) Since G˜ is controlled by | ln ρ| and ∇v belongs to (L2 (Ω))d×d , we deduce that (∇N v) · G˜ ∈ Lq (Ω), ∀q < 2. (IV.64)

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

300

˜ ≤ C and that v = 0 on ∂Ω, the Hardy inequality implies Using that |∇N G| ρ that the second term in the right-hand side of (IV.63) belongs to L2 (Ω) and satisfies    ˜ (IV.65)  2 ≤ CvH 1 . v · (∇N G) L

Therefore, it follows from (IV.62) and (IV.63) that ∇N ∇N vN ∈ Lq (Osρ0 ), ∀q < 2. • Let q < 2 and let us prove that vN ∈ W 2,q (Osρ0 ). First of all, we prove that ∇N vN ∈ (W 1,q (Ω))d . To this end, we compute ∇(∇N vN ) = ∇T (∇N vN ) + (∇N ∇N vN )ν     = ∇T (∇N v) · ν +∇T v · (∇N ν) + (∇N ∇N vN )ν.     =∇T (∇v).ν·ν

We have shown just before that the last term belongs to Lq . Since ν is 1 Lipschitz continuous and ∇v ∈ (Htang (Ω))d×d , the first term belongs to 2 q L ⊂ L . Finally, using the properties of ν and the Hardy inequality, we see that the second term satisfies   ∇T v · (∇N ν) ∈ L2 (Ω) ⊂ Lq (Ω). (IV.66) This actually proves that ∇N vN belongs to (W 1,q (Ω))d . Finally, we write ∇vN = ∇T vN + (∇N vN )ν, and since each term has been proved to belong to (W 1,q (Ω))d , we deduce that vN lies in W 2,q (Ω). • We compute the normal part of the Laplacian of v as (Δv)N = (Δv) · ν = Δ(vN ) − v · (Δν) − 2(∇v) : (∇ν). We perform the same computations as above. In particular we use the Hardy inequality using the fact that |Δν| ∼ 1/ρ to prove that the second term satisfies v · (Δν) ∈ L2 (Ω), (IV.67) and the fact that vN ∈ W 2,q (Ω). We deduce that (Δv)N ∈ Lq (Ω). The momentum equation projected onto the normal direction gives −(Δv)N + ∇N p = fN , and thus ∇N p ∈ Lq (Ω).

6. Regularity of the Stokes problem

301

Since ∇T p is already known to belong to (L2 (Ω))d , we finally get that p ∈ W 1,q (Ω). • Let 1 ≤ i ≤ d and let us look at the ith component of the momentum equation   ∂p − Tr(∇T ∇vi ) − ∇N ∇N vi − (∇vi ) · G˜ + = fi . ∂xi All the terms except the second one are already known to belong to Lq (Osρ0 ); therefore it follows that ∇N ∇N vi ∈ Lq (Osρ0 ). Proceeding as before, we can prove that ∇N vi ∈ W 1,q (Osρ0 ). Indeed, we have   ∇(∇N vi ) = ∇T (∇N vi ) + (∇N ∇N vi )ν = ∇T (∇v).ν · ei + (∇N ∇N vi )ν, and each term belongs to Lq by using the properties of ν and all the above regularity properties of v. To conclude, we write ∇vi = ∇T vi + (∇N vi )ν, and it follows that ∇vi ∈ (W 1,q (Osρ0 ))d and then that v ∈ (W 2,q (Ω))d . • We have proved that v ∈ (W 2,q (Ω))d for all q < 2. By Sobolev embeddings, we deduce that there exists some r > 2 such that ∇v ∈ (Lr (Ω))d×d . As a consequence, (IV.64) also holds for q = 2 and the sequel of the proof above still holds in this case. We finally deduce that v ∈ (H 2 (Ω))d . The proof of Theorem IV.5.8 in the case k = 0 is now complete.

6.2 Higher-order regularity Let us move to the general case of the elliptic regularity results for the Stokes problem. Proof (Theorem IV.5.8). Let k ≥ 0 and let Ω be a connected bounded domain of class C k+1,1 of Rd , let f be a function of (H k (Ω))d , and g be a function of H k+1 (Ω). We wish to show that the solution (v, p) ∈ (H01 (Ω))d × L20 (Ω) of ⎧ ⎪ ⎨ −Δv + ∇p = f, in Ω, div v = g, in Ω, ⎪ ⎩ v = 0, on ∂Ω, belongs to the space (H k+2 (Ω))d × H k+1 (Ω). To do this, we proceed by induction.

302

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

The case k = 0 was proved in Section 6.1. Let us take k ≥ 1 and assume that we have established the result with k replaced with k − 1: vH k+1 + pH k ≤ C (f H k−1 + gH k ) . We could first prove the local regularity, as before, by reducing the problem to the whole space Rd and then by carrying out translations parallel to the coordinate axis. To obtain tangential regularity, we again take the notation from the proof of Theorem IV.6.3. We recall that we established that w = δhθ v and π = δhθ p, are solutions of the Stokes problem (IV.57) with the right-hand side terms defined by (IV.58) and (IV.59). By using the induction hypothesis applied to the initial Stokes problem, the regularity of f and g, and the properties (III.91) and (III.92), we immediately obtain F H k−1 ≤ Ch(f H k + gH k+1 ), GH k ≤ Ch(f H k + gH k+1 ). Hence, from the induction hypothesis applied to the Stokes problem (IV.57), we get δhθ v2H k+1 + δhθ p2H k ≤ Ch2 (f 2H k + g2H k+1 ). This gives the result from the characterisation of tangential Sobolev spaces (Theorem III.2.32). To conclude, we again use the tangential and normal coordinates in the tubular neighborhood Osρ0 of ∂Ω in Ω, to deduce the regularity up to the boundary of the solution from the tangential regularity. Again, this proof requires a level of additional regularity on the domain Ω.

6.3 Lq theory of the Stokes problem The last subsection of this section aims to introduce, very briefly, a few elements in the theory of the Stokes problem posed in Lq (Ω) spaces. We refer to [63] for a complete study of this problem. First, we state the following theorem, proved by Agmon, Douglis, and Nirenberg, which, assuming the existence of a solution in (W 2,q (Ω))d × W 1,q (Ω), allows us to obtain additional regularity on this solution. This theorem is in fact a special case of the more general theorems established in [2] and [3]. We emphasise the fact that this theorem is not an existence theorem of smooth solutions. Theorem IV.6.5 (Agmon–Douglis–Nirenberg). Let Ω be a bounded domain of Rd , of class C k+2 , where k is a positive integer.

6. Regularity of the Stokes problem

303

Let 1 < q < +∞, and the data f ∈ (Lq (Ω))d , g ∈ W 1,q (Ω), and vb ∈ (W 2−1/q,q (∂Ω))d satisfying the compatibility condition   g dx = vb · ν dσ. Ω

∂Ω

We assume that there exists a pair (v, p) ∈ (W 2,q (Ω))d ×(W 1,q (Ω)∩L20 (Ω)), which is a solution of the Stokes problem ⎧ ⎪ ⎨ −Δv + ∇p = f, in Ω, div v = g, in Ω, ⎪ ⎩ v = vb , on ∂Ω. If the data (f, g, vb ) are more regular (f, g, vb ) ∈ (W k,q (Ω))d × W k+1,q (Ω) × (W k+2−1/q,q (∂Ω))d , then the solution of the problem above satisfies (v, p) ∈ (W k+2,q (Ω))d × W k+1,q (Ω),

(IV.68)

and we have the estimate vW k+2,q + pW k+1,q  ≤C f W k,q + gW k+1,q + vb 

k+2− 1 ,q q W

 + dq vLq ,

(IV.69)

where C depends only on (q, k, Ω) and dq = 0 for q ≥ 2 and 1 otherwise. This theorem is a genuine regularity theorem because it assumes that the existence of a solution is already known. In order to obtain a combined existence and regularity result it is necessary to refer, for example, to the result of Cattabriga in [39] (see also [7]), proven by the author in dimension 3 and which we give here without proof. Theorem IV.6.6 (Cattabriga). Let k be an integer k ≥ −1 and let Ω be a connected bounded domain of R3 of class C m , with m = max(2, k + 2). For all data (f, g, vb ) ∈ (W k,q (Ω))d × W k+1,q (Ω) × (W k+2−1/q,q (∂Ω))d , with 1 < q < +∞ satisfying the compatibility condition   g dx = vb · ν dσ, Ω

there exists a unique solution (v, p) of

∂Ω

304

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

⎧ ⎪ ⎨ −Δv + ∇p = f, div v = g, ⎪ ⎩ v = vb ,

in Ω, in Ω, on ∂Ω,

satisfying (IV.68) and the estimate (IV.69) with dq = 0 for all q. We note that the theorem is also true in two dimension (see, e.g., [122]).

6.4 Regularity for the div/curl problem We can now proceed to the proof of the regularity theorem for the div/curl system that we stated in Section 4. Proof (of Theorem IV.4.9). We assume that u ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 satisfies div u ∈ H 1 (Ω), curl u ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 , and γν (u) ∈ H 3/2 (∂Ω) and we want to show that u ∈ (H 2 (Ω))3 . First of all, we notice that it is enough, by using some suitable lifting of the trace, to consider the case where γν (u) = 0. • We first prove the local regularity of the solution. Let ϕ ∈ D(Ω) and set v = ϕu. By using (A.4) and (A.5), and that v is compactly supported in Ω, we get div v = ϕ(div u) + u · ∇ϕ ∈ H 1 (Ω), curl v = ϕ(curl u) + ∇ϕ ∧ u ∈ H 1 (Ω). Thus, for any 1 ≤ i ≤ 3, wi = ∂xi v satisfies wi ∈ (L2 (Ω))3 , div wi ∈ L2 (Ω), curl wi ∈ (L2 (Ω))3 , γν wi = 0. Using Theorem IV.4.8, we deduce that wi ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 and that wi H 1 ≤ Cϕ (uH 1 +  div uH 1 +  curl uH 1 ) . This is true for any 1 ≤ i ≤ 3, therefore we deduce that ϕu = v ∈ 2 (H 2 (Ω))3 , for any ϕ ∈ D(Ω). This proves that u ∈ (Hloc (Ω))3 . • We only need now to study the regularity properties in a neighborhood of the boundary ∂Ω. We use the same strategy as in Section 6.1.2 and we begin by showing the tangential regularity of u. To this end, we consider a vector field θ which is tangent to the boundary of Ω (i.e., which satisfies (III.77)) and use the corresponding flows (h, x) → τ θ (h, x) (see (III.78)). Since θ is smooth enough, we see that δhθ u = τhθ u − u belongs to (H 1 (Ω))3 and satisfies moreover (see Lemma IV.6.4)

6. Regularity of the Stokes problem

305

, div(δhθ u) = δhθ div u + div, τhθ u, , curl(δhθ u) = δhθ curl u + curl, τhθ u, γν (δhθ u) = τhθ u · ν −  u · ν = − (τhθ u) · (τhθ ν) +τhθ u · ν    =0

=

−τhθ u

·

(τhθ ν

− ν) =

=0 θ −τh u · δhθ ν.

By using the commutator estimates in Proposition III.3.19 we find that  div(δhθ u)L2 ≤ Cθ |h| ( div uH 1 + uH 1 ) ,  curl(δhθ u)L2 ≤ Cθ |h| ( curl uH 1 + uH 1 ) , γν (δhθ u)H 1/2 ≤ Cθ |h|νW 2,∞ uH 1 .

(IV.70)

By using Theorem IV.4.8, we deduce that the H 1 -norm of δhθ u is bounded as follows δhθ uH 1 ≤ Cθ,ν |h| (uH 1 +  div uH 1 +  curl uH 1 ) . 2 Thanks to Theorem III.3.20, we deduce that u ∈ (Htang (Ω))3 with the suitable estimate of its norm. • We use Proposition III.3.23 to get that uN = u · ν satisfies

∇N uN = div u − div uT −

∇N J uN , in Osρ0 . J

Since Ω is of class C 2,1 , we know that J is of class C 1,1 on Osρ0 ; see Proposition III.3.12. Therefore, since we assumed that div u ∈ H 1 (Ω), and we 2 showed just before that u ∈ (Htang (Ω))3 , we deduce that ∇N (u · ν) ∈ H 1 (Osρ0 ). Using the tangential regularity of u that we already proved, it follows that u · ν ∈ H 2 (Ω). • Finally, for any 1 ≤ i ≤ 3, we set wi = ∂xi u and we see that wi · ν = ∂xi (u · ν) − u · (∂xi ν) ∈ H 1 (Ω), because ν belongs to C 1,1 (Ω). It follows that the trace γν (wi ) belongs to H 1/2 (∂Ω). Moreover, we have div wi = ∂xi (div u) ∈ L2 (Ω), and curl wi = ∂xi (curl u) ∈ (L2 (Ω))3 . Using once more Theorem IV.4.8, we find that wi ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 . This being valid for any i, we get that u ∈ (H 2 (Ω))3 and the required estimate. 

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

306

7 The Stokes problem with stress boundary conditions In the preceding sections, we have considered the Stokes problem with boundary data of the Dirichlet type. We now consider Neumann-type boundary conditions for this problem. At the end of this section we also consider a more physically relevant variant of this boundary condition which concerns stress boundary conditions; see Problem (IV.84). We recall that the Stokes equation is written as −Δv + ∇p = f, or equivalently − div(∇v − p Id) = f. By assuming that v ∈ (H 1 (Ω))d , p ∈ L2 (Ω) and f ∈ (L2 (Ω))d , we see from Lemma IV.3.3 that we can define, in (H −1/2 (∂Ω))d , the trace of σ.ν where σ = ∇v − p Id. Hence, the natural Neumann problem for the Stokes problem in the particular divergence form given above can be stated as ⎧ −Δv + ∇p = f, in Ω, ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ div v = g, in Ω, (IV.71) ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ ∂v − pν = f , on ∂Ω. b ∂ν We propose to prove the following theorem. Theorem IV.7.1. Let Ω be a connected and bounded domain of class C 1,1 in Rd . For all data (f, g, fb ) ∈ (L2 (Ω))d × L2 (Ω) × (H −1/2 (∂Ω))d , satisfying the compatibility condition  f (x) dx + fb , 1H −1/2 ,H 1/2 = 0,

(IV.72)

Ω

problem (IV.71) possesses one, and only one, solution (v, p) in the space (H 1 (Ω) ∩ L20 (Ω))d × L2 (Ω). Moreover, if for k ≥ 0, the open set Ω is of class C k+2,1 and if the triplet (f, g, fb ) belongs to (H k (Ω))d ×H k+1 (Ω)×(H k+1/2 (∂Ω))d then the pair (v, p) belongs to (H k+2 (Ω))d × H k+1 (Ω) and there exists a C > 0 depending only on Ω such that vH k+2 + pH k+1 ≤ C (f H k + gH k+1 + fb H k+1/2 ) .

(IV.73)

7. The Stokes problem with stress boundary conditions

307

Notice that, in the proof of this result, we need one degree of regularity supplementary for the domain Ω compared to the case of Dirichlet boundary conditions (see Theorem IV.5.8).

7.1 The Stokes–Neumann problem Here we are concerned with proving the first part of Theorem IV.7.1. • Step 1: We start by considering a lifting of the mass source term, while being aware of the fact that g does not necessarily belong to L20 (Ω). We consider the smooth vector field given by v1 (x) =

1t (x1 , . . . , xd ), d

where the xi are the coordinates of the point x in the canonical basis of Rd . It is easy to verify that this vector field satisfies Δv1 = 0, div v1 = 1 and ∂v1 /∂ν = (1/d)ν at all points on the boundary of Ω. Let us then set v = v˜ + m(g)v1 , where we recall that m(g) denotes the mean value of the function g on Ω. Problem (IV.71) can now be written using v˜, in the form ⎧ −Δ˜ v + ∇˜ p = f, in Ω, ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ div v˜ = g − m(g), in Ω, (IV.74) ⎪ ⎪ v ⎩ ∂˜ on ∂Ω, − p˜ ν = fb , ∂ν where the new pressure is defined by p˜ = p − m(g)/d. Since g − m(g) has a zero mean value, we have seen in Theorem IV.5.2 that we can solve the problem ⎧ ⎪ ⎨ −Δw0 + ∇π0 = 0, in Ω, div w0 = g˜, in Ω, ⎪ ⎩ w0 = 0, on ∂Ω. In a more precise way, there exists a unique pair (w0 , π0 ) in the space (H01 (Ω))d ×L20 (Ω) which satisfies the system above. If we now set v˜ = w+w0 and p˜ = π + π0 , we see that System (IV.74) becomes ⎧ −Δw + ∇π = f, in Ω, ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ div w = 0, in Ω, ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ ∂w − π ν = F , on ∂Ω, b ∂ν

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

308

with Fb = fb − (∇w0 − π0 Id).ν. Since ∇w0 − π0 Id lies in (L2 (Ω))d×d and div(∇w0 − π0 Id) = 0 ∈ (L2 (Ω))d , Lemma IV.3.3 tells us that (∇w0 − π0 Id).ν is indeed defined on the boundary and belongs to (H −1/2 (∂Ω))d . We have therefore shown that we can go back to the general case of Problem (IV.71) with g = 0. • Step 2: We now assume that g = 0, and we are brought back to the following problem ⎧ −Δv + ∇p = f, in Ω, ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ div v = 0, in Ω, ⎪ ⎪ ∂v ⎩ − p ν = fb , on ∂Ω. ∂ν We introduce the Hilbert space 8 9 W = v ∈ (H 1 (Ω))d , div v = 0 , which is different from the now usual space V (defined in Section 3.3) by the fact that the functions of W are not necessarily zero at the boundary of Ω. We associate the following variational formulation with the problem above which is set in the Hilbert space W ∩ (L20 (Ω))d ,   ∇v : ∇ψ dx − fb , ψH −1/2 ,H 1/2 = f · ψ dx, ∀ψ ∈ W ∩ (L20 (Ω))d . Ω

Ω

(IV.75) The functions of W ∩ (L20 (Ω))d have zero mean value, thus the Poincar´e– Wirtinger inequality (Proposition III.2.39) shows that the symmetric bilinear form which appears in this formulation is indeed continuous and coercive on W ∩ (L20 (Ω))d . Hence, the Lax–Migram theorem shows that there exists a unique solution v to (IV.75) in W ∩ (L20 (Ω))d . Let ϕ be a function in W . We can take ψ = ϕ − m(ϕ), which is clearly in W ∩ (L20 (Ω))d , as a test function in (IV.75). This gives  ∇v : ∇ϕ dx − fb , ϕH −1/2 ,H 1/2 + m(ϕ) · fb , 1H −1/2 ,H 1/2 Ω  = f · ϕ dx − m(ϕ) · f dx. Ω

Ω

According to the compatibility condition (IV.72), the two terms which contain the mean value of ϕ offset each other thus leaving   ∇v : ∇ϕ dx − fb , ϕH −1/2 ,H 1/2 = f · ϕ dx. (IV.76) Ω

Ω

If we restrict ourselves to ϕ ∈ V , then de Rham’s theorem (Theorem IV.2.4) shows that there exists a unique pressure p in L20 (Ω) such that we have

7. The Stokes problem with stress boundary conditions

309

−Δv + ∇p = f, in Ω. We now need to prove that the boundary conditions are satisfied. By writing the equation in the form − div(∇v − p Id) = f, the Stokes equation of Lemma IV.3.3 shows that for any function ϕ ∈ W , we have   (∇v − p Id) : ∇ϕ dx − (∇v − p Id).ν, ϕH −1/2 ,H 1/2 = f · ϕ dx. Ω

Ω

Since ϕ is divergence-free, we have p Id : ∇ϕ = p div ϕ = 0, thus for all ϕ ∈ W   ∇v : ∇ϕ dx − (∇v − p Id).ν, ϕH −1/2 ,H 1/2 = f · ϕ dx. Ω

Ω

By comparing this to (IV.76), we obtain the relation σ.ν − fb , ϕH −1/2 ,H 1/2 = 0, ∀ϕ ∈ V,

(IV.77)

where σ = ∇v − p Id. This formula shows that σ.ν − fb is zero against the traces of the functions of (H 1 (Ω))d with zero divergence. 1/2 Let ψ ∈ (H (∂Ω))d . We have seen (Theorem IV.5.2) that, provided that  we have ∂Ω ψ · ν dσ = 0, then we can solve the Stokes problem ⎧ ⎪ ⎨ −Δϕ + ∇π = 0, in Ω, div ϕ = 0, in Ω, ⎪ ⎩ ϕ = ψ, on ∂Ω, with ϕ ∈ (H 1 (Ω))d and π ∈ L20 (Ω). The function ϕ is then a divergencefree lifting of ψ that we can put in (IV.77). We have then established that for all ψ ∈ (H 1/2 (∂Ω))d such that ∂Ω ψ · ν dσ = 0, we have fb − σ.ν, ψH −1/2 ,H 1/2 = 0.

(IV.78)

Let us now define ψ0 = ν, which is indeed a function of (H 1/2 (∂Ω))d since Ω is supposed to be of class C 1,1 . It satisfies   ψ0 · ν dσ = |ν|2 dσ = |∂Ω| > 0, ∂Ω

∂Ω

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

310

where |∂Ω| is the measure (of dimension d − 1) of ∂Ω. Now let any ψ ∈ (H 1/2 (∂Ω))d , we set   1 ψ · ν dσ ψ0 , ψ1 = ψ − |∂Ω| ∂Ω   1 ψ · ν dσ ψ0 . ψ = ψ1 + |∂Ω| ∂Ω  By definition ψ1 satisfies ψ1 · ν dσ = 0 and therefore we deduce from such that

∂Ω

(IV.78) that fb − σ.ν, ψ1 H −1/2 ,H 1/2 = 0. Hence, we obtain fb − σ.ν, ψH −1/2 ,H 1/2

1 = |∂Ω|



 ψ · ν dσ fb − σ.ν, ψ0 H −1/2 ,H 1/2 .

∂Ω

By introducing the number C0 =

1 fb − σ.ν, ψ0 H −1/2 ,H 1/2 , |∂Ω|

we have just shown that for any function ψ ∈ (H 1/2 (∂Ω))d we have  fb − σ.ν, ψH −1/2 ,H 1/2 = ψ · (C0 ν) dσ. ∂Ω

This proves that fb − σ.ν = C0 ν in the sense of (H −1/2 (∂Ω))d . We see, therefore, that if we set p˜ = p + C0 then we indeed have fb = σ .ν, on ∂Ω, where σ  = ∇v− p˜ Id. This new pressure p˜ only differs from p by a constant, therefore we have solved the problem ⎧ −Δv + ∇˜ p = f, in Ω, ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ div v = 0, in Ω, ⎪ ⎪ ∂v ⎩ − p˜ ν = fb , on ∂Ω. ∂ν We notice that in this case, contrary to the case with Dirichlet boundary conditions, the Neumann boundary conditions define the pressure in a unique way. By contrast, the velocity field v is only unique if we impose its mean value. We can easily verify that any other velocity field of the

7. The Stokes problem with stress boundary conditions

311

form v(x) + t where t is a constant vector in Rd is also a solution of the problem (associated with the same pressure p). 

7.2 Regularity properties To prove the regularity of the solution, we return to the initial problem (IV.71) with g not necessarily zero. In order to simplify the following proof, we first consider a lifting of the boundary conditions, that is, by introducing a vector field w1 which satisfies ∂w1 /∂ν = fb . Under the hypothesis fb ∈ (H 1/2 (∂Ω))d we know, from the trace lifting theorem (Theorem III.2.23), that one such w1 exists in the space (H 2 (Ω))d and satisfies w1 H 2 ≤ Cfb H 1/2 . We now set v˜ = v − w1 , such that the pair (˜ v , p) satisfies the system ⎧ −Δ˜ v + ∇p = f˜, in Ω, ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ div v˜ = g˜, in Ω, ⎪ ⎪ ∂˜ v ⎩ − p ν = 0, on ∂Ω, ∂ν where f˜ = f + Δw1 and g˜ = g − div w1 . Since w1 ∈ (H 2 (Ω))d , these new source terms have the same regularity as f and g, and we have f˜L2 ≤ C (f L2 + fb H 1/2 ) , ˜ g H 1 ≤ C (gH 1 + fb H 1/2 ) , and moreover, v H 2 + fb H 1/2 ) . vH 2 ≤ C (˜ We can then content ourselves with studying Problem (IV.71) associated which a boundary data fb = 0. This in no way obstructs obtaining estimate (IV.73). We are therefore interested in the regularity of (v, p), the solution of the following mixed variational formulation, which is equivalent to the system under study   ⎧ ⎪ ⎪ ∇v : ∇ψ dx − p div ψ dx = f · ψ dx, ∀ψ ∈ (H 1 (Ω))d , ⎨ Ω Ω Ω   (IV.79) ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ q div v dx = q g dx, ∀q ∈ L2 (Ω), Ω

Ω

where f ∈ (L2 (Ω))d , and g ∈ H 1 (Ω).

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

312

From Theorem IV.6.1 (which does not depend on the kind of boundary condition which is considered), we know that the unique solution (v, p) in 2 1 (H 1 (Ω) ∩ L20 (Ω))d × L2 (Ω) of (IV.79) belongs to (Hloc (Ω))d × Hloc (Ω). The proof of tangential regularity is more technical. Contrary to our approach in the case of Dirichlet boundary conditions, we cannot directly evaluate the commutator of the Stokes operator using translations, because the translation operators are not compatible with the boundary conditions. Indeed, if v satisfies the Neumann boundary conditions above, then v ◦ τ θ (h, ·) does not necessarily satisfy these boundary conditions. We therefore need to perform a proof by directly working on the variational formulation. To this end, we can demonstrate the following result for Problem (IV.79). Notice that we need here one degree of regularity supplementary of the domain Ω than for the Dirichlet boundary conditions (see the end of the proof). Theorem IV.7.2. Let Ω be a bounded domain of Rd of class C 2,1 . We assume that the data satisfy: f ∈ (L2 (Ω))d , g ∈ H 1 (Ω); 2 1 (Ω))d × Htang (Ω) and we then the solution (v, p) of (IV.79) belongs to (Htang have the estimate

|||v|||θ,2 + |||p|||θ,1 ≤ C(Ω, θ) (f L2 + gH 1 ) , for all vector fields θ satisfying (III.77) with k = 0. Remark IV.7.1. For the nonhomogeneous problem (IV.71), by using the process of lifting the boundary condition detailed above, we obtain the following estimate: |||v|||θ2 + |||p|||θ,1 ≤ C(Ω, θ) (f L2 + fb H 1/2 + gH 1 ) . To reason directly on the nonhomogeneous problem requires establishing the characterisation properties of the fractional Sobolev trace spaces by translation methods, which we wished to avoid here. Proof. We start by establishing the equations satisfied by δhθ v and δhθ p. To do this, θ in the first equation of system (IV.79) we take ψ = δ−h ϕ, where ϕ is any test function in H 1 (Ω). This gives    θ θ θ ∇v : ∇δ−h ϕ dx − p div(δ−h ϕ) dx = f · δ−h ϕ dx. Ω

Ω

Introducing suitable commutators we get

Ω

7. The Stokes problem with stress boundary conditions



313



  θ θ ∇v : δ−h p δ−h (div ϕ) dx ∇ϕ dx − Ω Ω    , -  , θ θ θ f · δ−h ϕ dx − ∇v : ∇, τ−h ϕ dx + p div, τ−h ϕ dx . = Ω Ω   Ω   =T1 (ϕ)

=T2 (ϕ)

We now want to discover the difference operator δhθ applied on ∇v and p. This is done by using the operator defined in (III.86). We obtain     θ δh ∇v : ∇ϕ dx − δhθ p(div ϕ) dx Ω Ω  θ f · δ−h ϕ dx − T1 (ϕ) + T2 (ϕ) = Ω   + {∇v, ∇ϕ}h dx − {p, div ϕ}h dx . Ω   Ω   =T3 (ϕ)

=T4 (ϕ)

Using once more the commutator between ∇ and δhθ , we finally get     θ ∇(δh v) : ∇ϕ dx − δhθ p(div ϕ) dx Ω Ω  θ f · δ−h ϕ dx − T1 (ϕ) + T2 (ϕ) + T3 (ϕ) − T4 (ϕ) = (IV.80) Ω  , -    θ ∇, τh v : ∇ϕ dx . + Ω   =T5 (ϕ)

With Proposition III.3.19, we get the following estimates on the terms T1 , . . . , T5 |T1 (ϕ)| ≤ C|h|∇vL2 ∇ϕL2 , |T2 (ϕ)| ≤ C|h|pL2  div ϕL2 , |T3 (ϕ)| ≤ C|h|∇vL2 ∇ϕL2 , |T4 (ϕ)| ≤ C|h|pL2  div ϕL2 , |T5 (ϕ)| ≤ C|h|∇vL2 ∇ϕL2 , where C depends only on Ω and θ. Coming back to (IV.80), we deduce first from these estimates that  (δhθ p) div ϕ dx Ω

≤∇δhθ vL2 ∇ϕL2 + C|h|(∇vL2 + pL2 + f L2 )ϕH01 , ∀ϕ ∈ (H01 (Ω))d .

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

314

By definition, this gives the estimate ∇(δhθ p)H −1 ≤ ∇δhθ vL2 + C|h|(∇vL2 + pL2 + f L2 ). Moreover, from (III.87), we obtain δhθ pH −1 ≤ C|h|pL2 . Gathering the two previous inequalities and using the Neˇcas inequality (Theorem IV.1.1) we get δhθ pL2 ≤ C∇δhθ vL2 + C|h|(∇vL2 + pL2 + f L2 ).

(IV.81)

θ We now choose q = δ−h δhθ p in the second equation of (IV.79) to get   θ θ (δ−h δhθ p)(div v) dx = g(δ−h δhθ p) dx. Ω

Ω

The same manipulations as before lead to    (δhθ p)(div δhθ v) dx = δhθ gδhθ p dx + {div v, δhθ p, }h dx Ω  Ω   Ω    +

=T1

=T2

 (IV.82) , -  (δhθ p) div, τhθ v dx − {g, δhθ p}h dx . Ω   Ω   =T3

=T4

Proposition III.3.19 leads to the estimates |T1 | ≤ δhθ gL2 δhθ pL2 ≤ C|h|gH 1 δhθ pL2 , |T2 | ≤ C|h| div vL2 δhθ pL2 , |T3 | ≤ C|h|δhθ pL2  div vL2 , |T4 | ≤ C|h|gL2 δhθ pL2 . We can now take ϕ = δhθ v in (IV.80), use (IV.82) to eliminate the pressure term, and finally use the estimates of the terms Ti and Tj to get ∇δhθ v2L2 ≤C|h|(vH 1 + pL2 + f L2 )δhθ vH 1 θ + Cf L2 δ−h δhθ vL2 +C|h|(gH 1 + vH 1 )δhθ pL2    θ v ≤C|h| δh H1

We use now the fact that δhθ vL2 ≤ C|h|vH 1 and the estimate of the pressure term given in (IV.81) to get

7. The Stokes problem with stress boundary conditions

315

∇δhθ v2L2 ≤C|h|(vH 1 + pL2 + f L2 + gH 1 )∇δhθ vL2 + C|h|2 (gH 1 + vH 1 + pL2 + f L2 )2 . With the Young inequality we finally obtain the estimate ∇δhθ v2L2 ≤ C|h|2 (gH 1 + vH 1 + pL2 + f L2 )2 . Since δhθ vL2 ≤ C|h|vH 1 , the above estimate shows that |||v|||θ,2,2 < +∞ 2 and thus v ∈ (Htang (Ω))d . Coming back to (IV.81), we deduce δhθ pL2 ≤ C|h|(vH 1 + pL2 + f L2 + gH 1 ), 1 so that we proved p ∈ Htang (Ω). The proof of the tangential regularity of the solution (v, p) is complete.

 The regularity up to the boundary can be shown in the same way as for the Dirichlet problem in Section 6.1.2.3. We write the equations using the normal and tangential variables and by using the tangential regularity to deduce, directly from these formulas, the regularity of all the other derivatives of the solution up to the boundary. The main differences lie in the proofs of (IV.65) through (IV.67) where we need to use the Hardy inequality which only holds when v vanishes on the boundary of Ω. That is the reason why, here, we assume that Ω is of class C 2,1 in such a way that we have G˜ ∈ C 0,1 (Ω) and ν ∈ C 1,1 (Ω) which implies that the estimates (IV.65) though (IV.67) hold without any need of the Hardy inequality. In particular, the proof holds even when v does not vanish on the boundary. To summarise the content of this section, we proved the following result for the general problem (IV.71) with nonhomogeneous boundary data. Theorem IV.7.3. Let Ω be a bounded connected domain of Rd of class C 2,1 . Under the hypothesis that (f, g, fb ) is given in (L2 (Ω))d ×H 1 (Ω)×(H 1/2 (∂Ω))d then the unique solution (v, p) of Problem (IV.71) belongs to (H 2 (Ω))d × H 1 (Ω) and we have the estimate vH 2 + pH 1 ≤ C (f L2 + gH 1 + fb H 1/2 ) .

7.3 Stress boundary conditions As we saw at the start of this section, expressing the equation in divergence form is fundamental to give a meaning to the Neumann-type boundary conditions. However, we saw in Chapter I, that the incompressible Stokes problem is, in reality, naturally written in the following form

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

316



− div σ = f, div v = g,

(IV.83)

where σ is the  stress tensor  which is given, according to Newton’s law, by σ = 2D(v) − p + 23 (div v) Id. We are still assuming for simplicity that the viscosity of the fluid is equal to 1. We recall that in this formulation, D(v) is the symmetric part of the tensor ∇v defined by D(v) = 12 (∇v + t ∇v). Let us now carry out a formal calculation:     2 − div σ = − div ∇v + t ∇v − p + div v Id 3     1 1 = −Δv + ∇ p − div v = −Δv + ∇ p − g . 3 3 Hence, problem (IV.83) is formally equivalent to (IV.71) by replacing the pressure p by p − 13 g. However, to give a meaning to the boundary conditions, the two formulations are different. Hence, the Neumann type problem associated with the expression in divergence form (IV.83) is given by   ⎧ ⎪ ⎨ − div 2D(v) − p Id = f, in Ω, div v = g, in Ω, (IV.84) ⎪  ⎩  2D(v) − p Id .ν = fb , on ∂Ω, where, for simplification, we have replaced the term p + 23 g by a simple pressure term, p. In this problem the boundary condition has a very clear physical meaning. Indeed, we saw in Chapter I that, by definition, the quantity σ.ν at the boundary is the force exerted by the wall on the fluid. In other words, instead of imposing the velocity field at the boundary, as in the case of Dirichlet boundary conditions, here we impose the force exerted on the fluid by the experimenter. In Chapter VII, we study outflow boundary conditions for the unsteady Navier–Stokes equations in which the quantity σ.ν plays a key role. For this model, we only consider the case of dimension d = 3 to illustrate the ideas. We prove results of existence, uniqueness, and regularity of solutions analogous to the preceding ones. We denote the centre of mass of the domain Ω as O, that is, the point defined by  1 O= x dx, |Ω| Ω and for all x ∈ Ω, we denote the vector position with respect to the origin O −→ fixed above as r = Ox. Theorem IV.7.4. Let Ω be a connected bounded Lipschitz domain of R3 . For all data (f, g, fb ) ∈ (L2 (Ω))3 × L2 (Ω) × (H −1/2 (∂Ω))3 ,

7. The Stokes problem with stress boundary conditions

317

satisfying the compatibility conditions  f dx + fb , 1H −1/2 ,H 1/2 = 0, Ω  f ∧ r dx + fb ∧ rH −1/2 ,H 1/2 = 0, Ω

Problem (IV.84) has a unique solution (v, p) ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 × L2 (Ω) such that m(v) = 0 and m(curl v) = 0. Moreover, if for k ≥ 0, the open set Ω is of class C k+1,1 and if the triplet (f, g, fb ) belongs to (H k (Ω))3 ×H k+1 (Ω)×(H k+1/2 (∂Ω))3 then the pair (v, p) belongs to (H k+2 (Ω))3 × H k+1 (Ω) and there exists C > 0 such that vH k+2 + pH k+1 ≤ C (f H k + gH k+1 + fb H k+1/2 ) . Note that, under these conditions, the pressure is defined in a unique way but the velocity field is only defined relative to a rigid body motion. Remark IV.7.2. In the second compatibility condition, the vector duality bracket fb ∧ rH −1/2 ,H 1/2 is defined component by component. For instance, the first component of this vector is given by (fb )2 , r3 H −1/2 ,H 1/2 − (fb )3 , r2 H −1/2 ,H 1/2 . 7.3.1 Preliminary remarks The first result that we need (and which was already referred to in Chapter I; see Remark I.4.1) is the following. Lemma IV.7.5. Let Ω be a connected open set of R3 and let v ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 be a vector field such that D(v) = 0 almost everywhere; then there exist two constant vectors t ∈ R3 and ω ∈ R3 such that 1 v(x) = t + ω ∧ r, for almost all x ∈ Ω. 2 Furthermore, we have m(v) = t, and curl v(x) = ω, for almost all x ∈ Ω. This corresponds to the motion of a rigid body. Proof. We set

⎛ ⎞ ∂v3 ω1 ∂x2 − ⎜ ∂v1 − ω(x) = ⎝ ω2 ⎠ = curl v = ⎝ ∂x 3 ∂v2 ω3 ∂x1 − ⎛

∂v2 ∂x3 ∂v3 ∂x1 ∂v1 ∂x2

⎞ ⎟ ⎠.

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

318

Since D(v) = 0, the gradient of v is reduced to its antisymmetric part, we therefore have ⎛ ⎞ 0 −ω3 ω2 1 ∇v = ⎝ ω3 0 −ω1 ⎠ . 2 −ω2 ω1 0 The Schwarz theorem on crossed derivatives then shows that we have ∂ω3 ∂ω2 = = 0, ∂x1 ∂x1 ∂ω3 ∂ω2 − = , ∂x3 ∂x2

∂ω1 ∂ω3 ∂ω1 ∂ω2 = = 0, and = = 0, ∂x2 ∂x2 ∂x3 ∂x3 ∂ω3 ∂ω1 ∂ω2 ∂ω1 =− , and − = , ∂x3 ∂x1 ∂x2 ∂x1

and thus ∇ω = 0, which proves that ω is a constant. It is then easy to show that ∇(v − 12 ω ∧r) = 0 and hence that there exists a constant vector t such that v(x) = t + 12 ω ∧ r. Consequently we can calculate the mean value of v   1 m(v) = t + r dx = t, ω∧ 2|Ω| Ω because, by definition of the origin O, being the centre of mass of Ω, we have  r dx = 0. Ω

 The same type of calculation then shows that if (v, p) is a solution of (IV.84) then for all constant vectors t ∈ Rd and ω ∈ Rd , the pair (v(x) + t + ω ∧ r, p) is also a solution. Hence, we cannot hope to show the uniqueness of solutions of (IV.84) except under the normalisation conditions m(v) = 0 and m(curl v) = 0. Furthermore, if (IV.84) is satisfied then, from the divergence theorem, we necessarily have  f (x) dx + fb , 1H −1/2 ,H 1/2 = 0. Ω

In the same way, if we take the vector product of the Stokes equation with the position vector r and integrate it on Ω, we obtain (from the symmetry of the tensor σ)   f (x) ∧ r dx = − (div σ) ∧ r dx Ω

Ω

= − (σ.ν) ∧ rH −1/2 ,H 1/2 = − fb ∧ rH −1/2 ,H 1/2 , the duality brackets being defined as in Remark IV.7.2. We clearly see, therefore, that the existence of a solution could only be established if the two compatibility conditions between f and fb given in the statement are satisfied.

7. The Stokes problem with stress boundary conditions

319

7.3.2 Existence As before, even if it means modifying the data f and fb , and even if it requires adding a constant to the pressure, we can focus our attention on the case where g = 0 (i.e., the case where the divergence of v is zero). Let us now concentrate on this case and, for this, introduce the Hilbert space 8 9 W = v ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 , div v = 0, m(v) = 0, m(curl v) = 0 . (IV.85) We now consider the following weak formulation for Problem (IV.84) with g = 0. We look for v ∈ W such that   2 D(v) : D(ϕ) dx − fb , ϕH −1/2 ,H 1/2 = f · ϕ dx, ∀ϕ ∈ W. (IV.86) Ω

Ω

To be able to apply the Lax–Milgram theorem (Theorem II.2.5), it is necessary to ensure that the bilinear form  a(v, w) = 2 D(v) : D(w) dx Ω

is coercive on the space W introduced above. To do this, we start by introducing a classic inequality in fluid mechanics and elasticity. Lemma IV.7.6 (Korn inequality). Let Ω be a bounded Lipschitz domain of R3 . There exists a C > 0 depending only on Ω such that ∇vL2 ≤ C (vL2 + D(v)L2 ) , ∀v ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 . Proof. Let v ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 ; we set   ∂vj 1 ∂vi , ∀i, j ∈ {1, . . . , 3}, + dij = 2 ∂xj ∂xi the entries of the matrix D(v). We note that, in the sense of distributions, we have the following relation   ∂ ∂vi ∂dij ∂dik ∂djk = + − . ∂xj ∂xk ∂xk ∂xj ∂xi Hence, it follows

    ∂ ∂vi     ∂xj ∂xk  −1 ≤ CD(v)L2 , H

but we also have

   ∂vi     ∂xk  −1 ≤ vL2 . H

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

320

Finally, we have obtained        ∂vi  ∂vi       ∂xk  −1 + ∇ ∂xk  −1 ≤ C(vL2 + D(v)L2 ). H H Hence, by applying the Neˇcas inequality (Theorem IV.1.1), we obtain the desired inequality for all i and k:    ∂vi     ∂xk  2 ≤ C(vL2 + D(v)L2 ). L  Remark IV.7.3. In the space (H01 (Ω))d , the Korn inequality is much easier to prove. Indeed, using the formulas given in Remark I.4.2, we get     ∇v : t ∇v dx = − v · div t ∇v dx Ω Ω   v · ∇(div v) dx = | div v|2 dx ≥ 0, =− Ω

Ω

for any v ∈ (D(Ω))d . It follows that      2 t 2 |D(v)| dx = ∇v : ∇v + ∇v dx ≥ |∇v|2 dx, Ω

Ω

(IV.87)

Ω

and the Korn inequality is proved√by density of D(Ω) in H01 (Ω). Notice that, in that case, the constant C = 2 in the inequality is universal and that the term vL2 is useless in the right-hand side. This is due to the fact that nontrivial rigid-body motions are not allowed in (H01 (Ω))d . Next, we can prove an inequality of the Poincar´e type as follows. Proposition IV.7.7. Let Ω be a bounded Lipschitz domain of R3 . There exists a C > 0 depending only on Ω such that vL2 ≤ C (|m(v)| + |m(curl v)| + D(v)L2 ) , ∀v ∈ (H 1 (Ω))d . Proof. We follow the path of the proof of the Poincar´e–Wirtinger inequality (Proposition III.2.39). We argue by contradiction, by assuming that for all n, there exists a function vn ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 such that vn L2 = 1 and |m(vn )| + |m(curl vn )| + D(vn )L2 ≤

1 . n

From the Korn inequality, we deduce that the sequence (vn )n is bounded in (H 1 (Ω))3 . We can extract a subsequence, still referred to as (vn )n for simplicity, which weakly converges towards a certain v ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 . By the

7. The Stokes problem with stress boundary conditions

321

compactness of the embedding from H 1 (Ω) into L2 (Ω), we know that the convergence of (vn )n towards v is strong in (L2 (Ω))3 . The limit v hence satisfies vL2 = 1, m(v) = 0, m(curl v) = 0, D(v) = 0. This is impossible inasmuch as from Lemma IV.7.5 the last three equalities imply that v is zero.  By combining the Korn inequality and the Poincar´e inequality above, we deduce that D( · )L2 is a norm on the space W (defined by (IV.85)) which is equivalent to the H 1 norm. We can, therefore, apply the Lax–Milgram theorem to establish the existence of a unique solution v ∈ W of (IV.86). It is now necessary to show that this function v is indeed a solution of the initial problem. To do this, we consider a function ψ ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 such that div ψ = 0 and we set 1 ϕ = ψ − m(ψ) − m(curl ψ) ∧ r, 2 which by definition belongs to the space W . We can therefore use this function ϕ in the formulation (IV.86) and obtain  2 D(v) : D(ψ) dx − fb , ψH −1/2 ,H 1/2 Ω

1 + m(ψ) · fb , 1H −1/2 ,H 1/2 − fb , m(curl ψ) ∧ rH −1/2 ,H 1/2 2    1 = f · ψ dx − m(ψ) · f dx − (m(curl ψ) ∧ r) · f dx. 2 Ω Ω Ω From the first compatibility condition, the terms which contain the mean of ψ compensate each other. By using the relation a · (b ∧ c) = −b · (a ∧ c) and the second compatibility condition, we see that the terms which contain the mean of the curl of ψ also compensate each other. This therefore leaves   2 D(v) : D(ψ) dx − fb , ψH −1/2 ,H 1/2 = f · ψ dx, Ω

Ω

for any function ψ which is divergence-free. In particular, using the symmetry of D(v), we get   2 D(v) : ∇ψ dx = f · ψ dx, ∀ψ ∈ V . Ω

Ω

It follows that − div(2D(v)) − f, ψD ,D = 0, ∀ψ ∈ V .

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

322

From Theorem IV.2.4, we deduce that there exists a unique pressure p ∈ L20 (Ω) such that − div(2D(v)) + ∇p = f, that is, − div(2D(v) − p Id) = f. We can then recover the boundary conditions as we did above for the first formulation of the Neumann problem, which determines the pressure in a unique manner.

7.3.3 Regularity It is difficult, now, to build a lifting of the boundary condition which is not a classic Neumann condition. We thus follow a different approach and directly account for the regularity of the boundary data in the weak formulation. As a consequence, we need the following lemma. Lemma IV.7.8. Let Ω be a connected bounded domain of R3 of class C 1,1 . Let θ be a vector field in Ω satisfying (III.77) with k = 0. Then, we have the following estimate for all g ∈ H 1/2 (∂Ω), δhθ gH −1/2 ≤ C(θ)|h|gH 1/2 . Proof. First, it is clear that, even if it means subtracting a constant of g, it is enough to consider the case where g has a zero mean value on ∂Ω. We consider the scalar Neumann problem defined by ⎧ −Δϕ = 0, in Ω, ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ ∂ϕ = g, on ∂Ω, (IV.88) ∂ν  ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ ϕ dx = 0 Ω

From Theorem III.4.3, since g has a zero mean value, we know that the above problem has a unique solution in H 1 (Ω). Moreover, we know that we have ϕ ∈ H 2 (Ω) as soon as g ∈ H 1/2 (∂Ω), as well as the estimate ϕH 2 ≤ CgH 1/2 . The variational formulation of problem (IV.88) is   ∇ϕ · ∇ψ dx − gψ dσ = 0, ∀ψ ∈ H 1 (Ω). Ω

∂Ω

(IV.89)

(IV.90)

8. The interface Stokes problem

323

We note that the boundary term, which a priori is a duality bracket, is in fact an integral term because g ∈ H 1/2 (∂Ω). θ We now take a test function in (IV.90) in the form ψ = τ−h v for any 1 v ∈ H (Ω). It follows that     (δhθ ∇ϕ)·∇v dx− (δhθ g)γ0 (v) dσ = {∇ϕ, ∇v}h dx− {g, γ0 (v)}h dσ. ∂Ω

Ω

∂Ω

Ω

We obtain, with (III.90),  θ δh g, γ0 (v)H −1/2 ,H 1/2 =

∂Ω



(δhθ g)γ0 (v) dσ

≤δhθ ∇ϕL2 ∇vL2

+ C|h|∇ϕL2 ∇vL2 + C|h|gL2 (∂Ω) γ0 (v)L2 (∂Ω) ≤C|h|ϕH 2 vH 1 + C|h|gH 1/2 γ0 (v)H 1/2 . Using (IV.89), we deduce that θ δh g, γ0 (v)H −1/2 ,H 1/2 ≤ C|h|gH 1/2 vH 1 , ∀v ∈ H 1 (Ω). The claim is proved.  Through this lemma and the methods used above for the Stokes–Neumann problem, we can easily demonstrate the regularity properties stated for the stress boundary conditions.

8 The interface Stokes problem The goal of this section is to show how to apply the tools and techniques of this chapter to more complex situations. As an example we consider here the following generalised Stokes problem ⎧   ⎪ ⎨ ρ(x)v − div 2μ(x)D(v) − p Id = f, in Ω, div v = 0, in Ω, (IV.91) ⎪ ⎩ v = 0, on ∂Ω, where ρ and μ are given functions which represent the density and the viscosity of the fluid mixture under study. Of course, in real-life nonsteady situations, ρ and μ also evolve with the flow (see, e.g., Chapter VI), and for instance the viscosity μ is a function of the density ρ. However, a very usual time discretisation of the nonhomogeneous Stokes equations can take the following form

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

324

⎧ n+1 ρ − ρn ⎪ ⎪ + v n · ∇ρn+1 = 0, ⎪ ⎪ δt ⎨   ρn+1 v n+1 − ρn v n − div 2μ(ρn+1 (x))D(v n+1 ) + ∇pn+1 = f n+1 , ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ δt ⎪ ⎩ div v n+1 = 0. Hence, for ρn , v n given, and δt small enough, the couple (v n+1 , pn+1 ) is a solution of a system whose form is exactly the one of (IV.91).

8.1 Existence and uniqueness With minimal regularity assumptions on ρ and μ, we can prove the following result. Theorem IV.8.1. Let Ω be a bounded connected Lipschitz domain in Rd . Assume that ρ, μ ∈ L∞ (Ω) with ρ ≥ 0 and inf Ω μ > 0; then for any f ∈ (H −1 (Ω))d , there exists a unique solution (v, p) ∈ (H01 (Ω))d × L20 (Ω) of Problem (IV.91). Furthermore, it satisfies vH 1 + pL2 ≤ Cf H −1 , for some C > 0 which does not depend on f . Proof. The proof is now classic. We introduce the bilinear form   a(v, w) = ρ(x)v · w dx + 2μ(x)D(v) : D(w) dx Ω Ω ρ(x)v · w dx + 2μ(x)∇v : D(w) dx, ∀v, w ∈ V, = Ω

Ω

which is continuous on V . Moreover we have   a(v, v) = ρ(x)|v|2 dx + 2 μ(x)|D(v)|2 dx ≥ 2(inf μ)D(v)2L2 , Ω

Ω

Ω

and by the Korn inequality (Lemma IV.7.6) we deduce that a(v, v) ≥ αv2V for some α > 0. The linear form L : v ∈ V → f, vH −1 ,H01 is continuous on V so that the Lax–Milgram theorem lets us conclude as to the existence and uniqueness of a solution v ∈ V of the problem a(v, w) = L(w), ∀w ∈ V. In particular, using the Stokes formula this proves that we have ρv − div(2μD(v)) − f, wH −1 ,H 1 = 0, ∀w ∈ V, 0

8. The interface Stokes problem

325

and thus by Theorem IV.2.3 we deduce the existence of a pressure p ∈ L20 (Ω) so that (v, p) solves (IV.91); moreover this pressure is unique because Ω is connected.  Let us assume now that we are given a decomposition of Ω into two Lipschitz open subdomains Ω1 , Ω2 such that Ω1 ∩ Ω2 = ∅, Ω1 ∪ Ω2 = Ω, ∂Ω1 ∩ ∂Ω2 ∩ ∂Ω = ∅. We define the interface between the two subdomains S = ∂Ω1 ∩ ∂Ω2 and γS : H 1 (Ω) → H 1/2 (S) denote the trace operator on S, which is well defined as the restriction to S of the trace of u|Ω1 on ∂Ω1 , or equivalently as the restriction to S of the trace of u|Ω2 on ∂Ω2 . Let jS ∈ (H −1/2 (S))d be given and let us consider the linear map JS : v ∈ (H 1 (Ω))d → jS , γS (v)H −1/2 (S),H 1/2 (S) . It is clear that the linear map JS is continuous on (H01 (Ω))d and thus defines an element of (H −1 (Ω))d . Thus, from Theorem IV.8.1, we know that for any given f0 ∈ (L2 (Ω))d , there exists a unique couple (v, p) ∈ (H01 (Ω))d × L20 (Ω) which satisfies ⎧   ⎪ ⎨ ρ(x)v − div 2μ(x)D(v) − p Id = f0 + JS , in Ω, div v = 0, in Ω, (IV.92) ⎪ ⎩ v = 0, on ∂Ω. Let us comment on this system. We denote by vi , pi the restrictions of v, p to Ωi , for i = 1, 2. • First of all, we observe that for any test function ϕ ∈ (D(Ωi ))d ⊂ (D(Ω))d , the term JS , ϕH −1 ,H01 vanishes. Therefore, the couple (vi , pi ) solves the Stokes problem with the source term f0 in Ωi , as well as the Dirichlet boundary condition vi = 0 on ∂Ωi ∩ ∂Ω. • From the previous facts, we deduce that the stress tensor σi = 2μ(x)D(vi )− pi Id belongs to (Hdiv (Ωi ))d for i = 1, 2. Hence, we can define the normal trace of these two tensor fields γνi (σi ) ∈ (H −1/2 (Ωi ))d . Taking a test function ϕ ∈ (D(Ω))d in the weak formulation of the problem and using the Stokes formula given in Lemma IV.3.3 on each of the two subdomains Ω1 and Ω2 we finally arrive at γν1 (σ1 ) + γν2 (σ2 ), γS (ϕ)H −1/2 (S),H 1/2 (S) =JS , γS (ϕ)H −1 ,H01 = jS , γS (ϕ)H −1/2 (S),H 1/2 (S) . Since γS is surjective onto H 1/2 (S), this finally leads to the formula γν1 (σ1 ) + γν2 (σ2 ) = jS .

(IV.93)

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

326

The outward normals νi have opposite directions on S, thus this exactly means that the solution (v, p) we constructed satisfies a stress jump condition at the interface S prescribed by the data jS . From a modelling point of view, stress jumps may account, for instance, for surface tension phenomena between two fluids, or for some mechanical properties of the interface in the case where S models a membrane separating the fluids. Here also, the more physically relevant situation is the one of nonsteady flows that we study in the next chapters.

8.2 Regularity of the solution We now want to prove that, under suitable assumptions, the solution (v, p) studied in the previous section is smooth on each subdomain Ω1 and Ω2 . We obviously cannot expect in general for the solution to be globally smooth on Ω because the jump condition (IV.93) implies that the pressure or the velocity gradient should be discontinuous on S. Let us denote by μi : Ωi → R the restriction of the viscosity μ to the domain Ωi . Theorem IV.8.2. Assume that Ω, Ω1 , and Ω2 are of class C 2,1 , that μi ∈ W 1,∞ (Ωi ) for i = 1, 2, and that jS ∈ H 1/2 (S); then the solution (v, p) to (IV.92) satisfies (v, p) ∈ (H 2 (Ωi ))d × H 1 (Ωi ), for i = 1, 2. Proof. We first observe that we have   − div 2μ(x)D(v) − p Id = f0 − ρv + JS , and since −ρv ∈ L2 , we can change f0 into f0 − ρv in order to study the regularity properties of (v, p). In other words, we can assume that ρ(x) = 0 for all x ∈ Ω without loss of generality. Therefore, the weak formulation of the problem that we consider from now on is the following  ⎧ ⎪ 2μ(x) D(v) : D(ψ) dx − p div ψ dx ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ Ω Ω  ⎨ f0 · ψ dx + jS · γS (ψ) dσ, ∀ψ ∈ (H01 (Ω))d , (IV.94) = ⎪ Ω S ⎪ ⎪  ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ q div v dx = 0, ∀q ∈ L2 (Ω). Ω

Notice that the jump term JS is now an integral term because we assume that jS belongs in (H 1/2 (S))d .

8. The interface Stokes problem

327

• Let i ∈ {1, 2} and let us first study the local regularity of the solution in Ωi . For any ψ˜ ∈ (H01 (Ωi ))d , since μi is Lipschitz continuous and does not ˜ vanish, we can take ψ = μ−1 i ψ as a test function in the first equation of (IV.94). After some straightforward computations, we find that (vi , μ−1 i pi ) solves the following problem in Ωi ⎧  −1   −1  −1 −1 , ⎪ i )) +∇ μi pi = μi f0 + 2μi D(vi ).∇μi + pi ∇ μi ⎨ − div(2D(v    =Δvi ⎪ ⎩ div vi = 0. (IV.95) Since pi ∈ L2 (Ωi ), vi ∈ (H 1 (Ωi ))d , and μi is smooth, we see that the source term in this problem belongs to L2 (Ωi ) and then (vi , μ−1 i pi ) solves a usual Stokes problem in Ωi with a source term in L2 . Thus, we can apply 2 1 Theorem IV.6.1 which gives that vi ∈ (Hloc (Ωi ))d and μ−1 i pi ∈ Hloc (Ωi ), 1 so that pi ∈ Hloc (Ωi ) and the claim is proved. Notice that, as expected, the jump jS does not play any role in the proof of the local regularity properties in each Ωi . • Let us now prove the tangential regularity up to the boundary and to the interface of the solution (v, p) of (IV.94). Most of the proof is the same as for the standard Stokes problem; we only concentrate here on the particular terms related to the interface. Let us consider any vector field θ satisfying (III.77) with k = 0 for the two domains Ω1 and Ω2 , so that in particular θ is tangent to S. We use the same notation as in Section 6.1.2.2. Since θ is tangent to S, the flow of θ satisfies τ θ (h, S) = S, ∀h ∈ R. In particular, we have γS (τhθ (v)) = τhθ (γS v), ∀v ∈ (H01 (Ω))d . θ θ For ϕ ∈ (H01 (Ω))d and π ∈ L2 (Ω), we take ψ = δ−h ϕ and q = δ−h π as test functions in (IV.94). Following the same computations as in previous sections, we obtain   2(τhθ μ)D(δhθ v) : D(ϕ) dx − δhθ p div ϕ dx Ω   Ω , θ f0 · δ−h ϕ dx − 2μD(v) : D, τhθ ϕ dx + 2 {μDv, D(ϕ)}h dx = Ω Ω Ω    , , p div, τhθ ϕ dx − {p, div ϕ}h dx + 2(τhθ μ)D(ϕ) : D, τhθ v dx + Ω Ω Ω    θ θ δh jS · γ0 (ϕ) dσ − {jS , γ0 (ϕ)}h dσ − 2 (δh μ)D(v) : D(ϕ) dx + Ω

S

S

(IV.96) All the terms in the right-hand side, except the last three, can be estimated in exactly the same way as we did in Section 6.1.2.2, by using additionally

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

328

that μ is a bounded function. Let us denote by T1 (ϕ), T2 (ϕ), and T3 (ϕ) the last three terms. Since θ is tangent to S, the flow τ θ maps each subdomain Ωi into itself. Therefore, μ being supposed to be Lipschitz-continuous on each subdomain, we have δhθ μL∞ ≤ C|h|(μW 1,∞ (Ω1 ) + μW 1,∞ (Ω2 ) ). Moreover, we can use Lemma IV.7.8 to deal with the boundary terms T2 and T3 . The estimates we finally obtain are |T1 (ϕ)| ≤ C|h|(μW 1,∞ (Ω1 ) + μW 1,∞ (Ω2 ) )vH 1 ϕH 1 , |T2 (ϕ)| ≤ δhθ jS H −1/2 (S) γ0 (ϕ)H 1/2 (S) ≤ C|h|jS H 1/2 (S) ϕH 1 , |T3 (ϕ)| ≤ C|h|jS L2 (S) γ0 (ϕ)L2 (S) ≤ C|h|jS H 1/2 (S) ϕH 1 . Gathering all these inequalities we get  (δhθ p) div ϕ dx ≤ ∇δhθ vL2 ∇ϕL2 Ω

+ C|h|(∇vL2 + pL2 + f0 L2 + jS H 1/2 )ϕH01 , ∀ϕ ∈ (H01 (Ω))d , and we can conclude with the Neˇcas inequality (Theorem IV.1.1) that δhθ pL2 ≤ C∇δhθ vL2 + C|h|(∇vL2 + pL2 + f L2 + jS H 1/2 ). (IV.97) Coming back to (IV.96) with ϕ = δhθ v, using the fact that inf Ω μ > 0, and the Korn inequality, we finally obtain ∇δhθ v2L2 ≤ C|h|2 (gH 1 + vH 1 + pL2 + f L2 + jS H 1/2 )2 , and the estimate on δhθ p follows from (IV.97). This proves the tangential regularity of v and p in each subdomain Ω1 and Ω2 . • Let us finally conclude with the complete regularity up to the boundary ∂Ω and to the interface S. To this end, we come back to (IV.95) and we see 2 d that for i ∈ {1, 2} fixed, the couple (vi , μ−1 i pi ) belongs to (Htang (Ωi )) × 1 Htang (Ωi ) and solves a standard Stokes problem with a right-hand side in (L2 (Ωi ))d . Therefore, we can apply exactly the same strategy as in Section 6.1.2.3 to obtain the normal regularity of the solution up to the boundary. Notice that, since Ωi is of class C 2,1 , this proof does not make use of the boundary condition which is satisfied by the solution, as we noticed in the study of the Stokes–Neumann problem (see the discussion at the end of Section 7.2). 

9. The Stokes problem with vorticity boundary conditions

329

9 The Stokes problem with vorticity boundary conditions The vorticity in a flow is defined to be ω = curl v. In order to illustrate its physical meaning, we consider a rotating fluid (in the whole space R3 ) whose velocity field is given, as for a rigid body rotation, by v(r) = rΩ ∧ er in cylindrical coordinates (Ω is the angular velocity). We saw in (I.37) that curl v = 2Ω, so that the vorticity ω = curl v is exactly equal, up to a factor 2, to the angular velocity Ω. That’s the reason why, for a general flow, the vorticity is a measure of the local angular velocity of fluid particles in the flow. We consider here the Stokes problem with an impermeable wall condition (i.e., only the normal part of the velocity field is imposed to be zero at the boundary) and an additional condition involving (the tangential part of) the vorticity. Therefore, the fluid is allowed to slide along the boundary of the domain. For simplicity, we only consider the three-dimensional case but all the results can be translated in the two-dimensional case. More precisely, the problem under study is the following ⎧ −Δv + ∇p = f, in Ω, ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ div v = 0, in Ω, (IV.98) ⎪ v · ν = 0, on ∂Ω, ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ (curl v) ∧ ν = g, on ∂Ω. The property of particular interest for this system is that the computation of the pressure and the one of the velocity can be uncoupled (see Proposition IV.9.9). This is generally not true for other kinds of boundary conditions for the Stokes equations as the ones studied in the previous sections. Remark IV.9.1. All the results of this section can be easily adapted to the  case of nonhomogeneous boundary data of the kind v·ν = vb , with ∂Ω vb dσ = 0. To this end, it is sufficient to solve Problem (IV.98) and to change the velocity v into v + ∇ϕ where ϕ solves the following Laplace problem ⎧ ⎨ −Δϕ = 0, in Ω, ⎩ ∂ϕ = vb , on ∂Ω. ∂ν This new velocity field is divergence-free because ϕ is harmonic, and satisfies −Δ(v + ∇ϕ) = −Δv so that it solves the Stokes equation with the same pressure p. Finally, the vorticity boundary condition is satisfied because curl(v + ∇ϕ) = curl v.

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

330

9.1 Preliminaries Let us define the Hilbert space 8 9 Hν = (H 1 (Ω))3 ∩ Ker γν = v ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 , γ0 (v) · ν = 0, on ∂Ω . We first need to define and study some special elements of (H −1 (Ω))3 . We recall that δ is the function “distance to the boundary” that we studied in Section 3.2. Since Ω is supposed to be of class C 1,1 we know that δ is also of class C 1,1 in a neighborhood of ∂Ω. For any ε > 0, we introduce βε : R+ → R+ which is defined by  1 for s > ε, βε (s) = s for s ≤ ε. ε Definition IV.9.1. We say that f ∈ (H −1 (Ω))3 does not contain tangential boundary terms if and only if   f, βε (δ)vH −1 ,H01 has a limit as ε → 0, for any v ∈ Hν . (IV.99) ε

We denote by Hν−1 ⊂ (H −1 (Ω))3 the set of such distributions. Lemma IV.9.2. For any w ∈ (H01 (Ω))3 , we have βε (δ)w −−−→ w in (H 1 (Ω))3 . ε→0

Proof. The convergence in L2 is straightforward by using the dominated convergence theorem. Then, we write ∂xi (βε (δ)w) − ∂xi wL2 ≤ (βε (δ) − 1)∂xi wL2 + ∂xi (βε (δ)) wL2 , and we see that the first term also converges to zero as ε → 0 by using the dominated convergence theorem. It remains to study the second term. Using that |∇δ| ≤ 1 and the expression of βε , we find   2 2 w 2 2 w ∂xi (βε (δ))wL2 = |∂xi δ| dx ≤ dx. ε Oε Oε δ We recall that Oε = {x ∈ Ω, δ(x) < ε}. Since w ∈ (H01 (Ω))3 , the Hardy inequality (Proposition III.2.40) proves that |w/δ| belongs to L2 (Ω) and therefore, by the dominated convergence theorem, the last integral above tends to 0 as ε goes to 0.  Proposition IV.9.3. For any f ∈ Hν−1 , we define

9. The Stokes problem with vorticity boundary conditions

331





f˜ : v ∈ Hν → lim f, βε (δ)vH −1 ,H01 . ε→0

Then f˜ belongs to Hν and f˜ = f on (H01 (Ω))3 . Proof. For any ε > 0, the map fε : v ∈ Hν → f, βε (δ)vH −1 ,H01 is linear and continuous. Moreover, from Assumption (IV.99), we know that fε , vHν ,Hν has a limit when ε → 0. Therefore, by the Banach–Steinhaus theorem (see Theorem II.2.4), we know that f˜ is a linear continuous form on Hν . Moreover, for any v ∈ (D(Ω))3 , we have βε (δ)v = v for ε > 0 small enough so that f˜ and f coincide on (D(Ω))3 . By density, we deduce that they also coincide on (H01 (Ω))3 .  We now show that the gradient of any function in L2 (Ω) belongs to the class Hν−1 . Lemma IV.9.4. For any q ∈ L2 (Ω), we have ∇q ∈ Hν−1 and more precisely, we have  ' ∇q, wHν ,Hν = − q(div w) dx, ∀w ∈ Hν . Ω

Proof. For any ε > 0 and any w ∈ Hν , we have    ∇q, βε (δ)wH −1 ,H01 = − q div βε (δ)w dx Ω  =− q(div w)βε (δ) dx − q(w · ∇βε (δ)) dx. Ω

Ω

By using the dominated convergence theorem, we immediately obtain that  the first term in the right-hand side converges towards − Ω q(div w) dx. Let us show that the second term, referred to as Iε , tends to zero. We first observe that ∇βε (δ) = βε (δ)∇δ, and that βε (δ)

 0, for δ > ε = 1 . ε , for δ < ε

It follows that Iε = −

1 ε

 Oε

q(w · ∇δ) dx.

By definition of Oε we have (1/ε) ≤ (1/δ) in Oε , so that we have the estimate 

|w · ∇δ| |Iε | ≤ |q| dx ≤ qL2 δ Oε

 Oε

1/2 |w · ∇δ|2 dx . δ2

(IV.100)

332

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

Finally, using that ∇δ = −ν on the boundary, and since w ∈ Hν , we have w · ∇δ = 0 on ∂Ω. In particular, we get w · ∇δ ∈ H01 (Ω) and the Hardy inequality (Proposition III.2.40) implies that (w · ∇δ)/δ belongs to L2 (Ω). We conclude from (IV.100) that Iε −−−→ 0 and the claim is proved. ε→0 

9.2 A vector Laplace problem We begin with the study of the following vector field v : Ω → R3 satisfying ⎧ ⎪ ⎨ −Δv = f, v · ν = 0, ⎪ ⎩ (curl v) ∧ ν = g,

vector Laplace problem: find a in Ω, on ∂Ω, on ∂Ω.

(IV.101)

Notice that all the components of v are coupled through the boundary conditions and therefore this problem cannot be reduced to scalar Laplace problems. Theorem IV.9.5. Let Ω be a simply connected bounded domain of R3 of class C 1,1 , f ∈ Hν−1 , and g ∈ (H −1/2 (∂Ω))3 , which is tangent to the boundary in the following sense g, ϕνH −1/2 ,H 1/2 = 0, ∀ϕ ∈ H 1/2 (∂Ω).

(IV.102)

Then, there exists a unique v ∈ Hν which is solution to (IV.101) and satisfies vH 1 ≤ C(f H −1 + gH −1/2 ), for some C > 0 depending only on Ω. More precisely, the third boundary condition in (IV.101) is satisfied in the following weak sense,   ε  1 (curl v)(. − sν(.)) ds ∧ ν(.) −−− g, in (H −1/2 (∂Ω))3 . (IV.103) ε→0 ε 0 Remark IV.9.2. Let us comment on the property (IV.103). Since curl v ∈ (L2 (Ω))3 , for any ε > 0 the map    ε 1 (curl v)(σ − sν(σ)) ds ∧ ν(σ), σ ∈ ∂Ω → ε 0 belongs to (L2 (∂Ω))3 ⊂ (H −1/2 (∂Ω))3 . It corresponds to taking averages of (curl v) ∧ ν along the normal direction to the boundary. We claim in (IV.103) that this family of functions weakly converges towards g as ε → 0. This weak interpretation of the boundary condition is

9. The Stokes problem with vorticity boundary conditions

333

unavoidable because we do not know, a priori, that (curl v) ∧ ν has a trace in any usual strong sense, because curl v is simply an element of (L2 (Ω))3 . Of course, we show below that, as soon as the solution is more regular, we are able to justify this boundary condition in the usual sense. Remark IV.9.3. In the case where Ω is simply a Lipschitz domain, not necessarily simply connected, we can prove the existence of a unique solution v belonging to the space Hdiv,curl,ν,0 (Ω) defined in (IV.15). Indeed, the regularity and the simple connexity of Ω is only needed in the following proof to affirm that Hdiv,curl,ν,0 (Ω) = Hν (see Theorem IV.4.8). Proof. We define the following bilinear form on Hν   a : (v, w) ∈ Hν × Hν → (curl v) · (curl w) dx + (div v)(div w) dx. Ω

Ω

It is clear that a is continuous on Hν . Moreover by using (IV.21) we have   v2H 1 ≤ C  div v2L2 +  curl v2L2 = Ca(v, v), ∀v ∈ Hν , so that a is coercive on Hν . Thus, we can use the Lax–Milgram theorem II.2.5 to prove the existence and uniqueness of a v ∈ Hν satisfying a(v, w) = f˜, wHν ,Hν + g, γ0 (w)H −1/2 ,H 1/2 , ∀w ∈ Hν ,

(IV.104)

where f˜ is the extension of f defined in Proposition IV.9.3. Let us now prove that this function v actually solves the problem under study. • Taking w ∈ (D(Ω))3 , integrating by parts in the distribution sense, and using (A.9) we first deduce that v solves the equation −Δv = f . • The boundary condition v · ν = 0 is satisfied by definition of the space Hν . • We have already proved that the following equation holds, in the sense of (H −1 (Ω))3 , curl curl v − ∇ div v = f. (IV.105) Since div v ∈ L2 (Ω), Lemma IV.9.4 implies that ∇ div v ∈ Hν−1 . Let w ∈ Hν , and choose βε (δ)w as a test function in (IV.105). It follows that  (curl v) · (curl(βε (δ)w)) dx = f + ∇(div v), βε (δ)wH −1 ,H01 . (IV.106) Ω

Let us study the limit when ε → 0 of the various terms in this equation. – By definition of f˜ and by Lemma IV.9.4, we know that the right-hand side term has a limit as ε → 0 which is  v), wH  ,H = f˜, wH  ,H − (div v)(div w) dx. f˜ + ∇(div ν ν ν ν Ω

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

334

– It remains to study the term   (curl v) · (curl(βε (δ)w)) dx = βε (δ)(curl v) · (curl w) dx Ω Ω  1 + (curl v) · ((∇δ) ∧ (curl w)) dx. ε Oε We can easily pass to the limit in the first term by using the dominated convergence theorem. By definition of βε , we can write the second term as  1 Tε (w) = − ((curl v) ∧ (ν ◦ P0 ) · w dx, ε Oε where we used (III.66) to express the gradient of δ as a function of the outward normal field ν and the projection P0 on ∂Ω. We have seen that the terms in the right-hand side of (IV.106) have a limit; we deduce that the term Tε (w) also has a limit and that   ˜ lim Tε (w) = f , wHν ,Hν − (curl v) · (curl w) dx − (div v)(div w) dx. ε→0

Ω

Ω

Comparing with the variational formulation (IV.104), we conclude that lim Tε (w) = −g, γ0 (w)H −1/2 ,H 1/2 ,

ε→0

(IV.107)

for any w ∈ Hν . Moreover, if w is any element in (H 1 (Ω))3 , we can introduce w 'T = w − (w · (ν ◦ P0 ))(ν ◦ P0 ) ∈ Hν and apply (IV.107) to w 'T . Since (ν ◦ P0 ) · ((curl v) ∧ (ν ◦ P0 )) = 0 almost everywhere and using (IV.102), we finally obtain that (IV.107) holds for any w ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 . – Let us now write  1 Tε (w) = − [(curl v) ∧ (ν ◦ P0 )] · γ0 (w) ◦ P0 dx ε Oε    1 − ε 



=Tε,1 (w)

  [(curl v) ∧ (ν ◦ P0 )] · w − γ0 (w) ◦ P0 dx . Oε   =Tε,2 (w)

By using the generalised Hardy inequality (Proposition III.3.13 and Remark III.3.5), and the same argument as above, we obtain that the term Tε,2 (w) tends to zero for any w ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 . With the change of variables formula stated in Remark III.3.4, the term Tε,1 (w) can be written as

9. The Stokes problem with vorticity boundary conditions

335

Tε,1 (w)  $   # 1 ε  − (curl v)(σ − sν(σ)) Js (σ)ds ∧ ν(σ) · γ0 (w)(σ) dσ. = ε 0 ∂Ω Finally, since δ ∈ C 1,1 , we have the estimate |Js (σ) − 1| = |Js (σ) − J0 (σ)| ≤ C|s|. It follows that lim Tε,1 (w)  $   # 1 ε − = lim (curl v)(σ − sν(σ)) ds ∧ ν(σ) · γ0 (w)(σ) dσ. ε→0 ∂Ω ε 0 ε→0

The limit in the right-hand side only depend on the trace of w. Therefore, gathering all the results we have obtained with (IV.107), we get #  $  1 ε − (curl v)(σ − sν(σ)) ds ∧ ν(σ) · ϕ(σ) dσ ε 0 ∂Ω



−−−→ −g, ϕH −1/2 ,H 1/2 , ∀ϕ ∈ (H 1/2 (∂Ω))3 , ε→0

which is exactly the property (IV.103). We can now prove the following elliptic regularity result for the problem under study. Theorem IV.9.6. We use the same notation as in the previous theorem. If Ω is of class C 2,1 , f ∈ (L2 (Ω))3 , and g ∈ (H 1/2 (∂Ω))3 , then the solution v of (IV.101) belongs to (H 2 (Ω))3 and we have vH 2 ≤ C(f L2 + gH 1/2 ), where C > 0 depends only on Ω. Moreover, the boundary condition on curl v is satisfied in a strong sense γ0 (curl v) ∧ ν = g, on ∂Ω. Proof. Observe first that (L2 (Ω))3 ⊂ Hν−1 , so that the previous theorem ap2 plies. Second, it is clear that v ∈ (Hloc (Ω))3 because local regularity does not depend on the boundary conditions and therefore we can apply to each component vi of v the local regularity result for the scalar Laplace problem (see the proof of Theorem III.4.2). The main new difficulty is then to prove regularity up to the boundary. 2 • Let us establish that v ∈ (Htang (Ω))3 . We first extend the formulation 1 (IV.104) to the entire space (H (Ω))3 . To this end, for any w ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 , and using Theorem III.4.3, we define Φ[w] to be the unique function in H 2 (Ω) such that

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

336

  ⎧ 1 ⎪ ⎪ γ (w) · ν dσ , in Ω, −Δ(Φ[w]) = 0 ⎪ ⎪ |Ω| ⎪ ∂Ω ⎪ ⎨ ∂Φ[w] on ∂Ω, − = γ0 (w) · ν, ⎪ ∂ν ⎪ ⎪  ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ Φ[w] dx = 0. Ω

Moreover we have the estimate ∇Φ[w]L2 ≤ Cγ0 (w) · νH −1/2 (∂Ω) .

(IV.108)

Notice that ∇Φ[w] = 0 for any w ∈ Hν . Using w − ∇Φ[w] in (IV.104), we find that v solves   (curl v) · (curl w) dx + (div v)(div w) dx Ω   Ω f · w dx − f · ∇Φ[w] dx + g · γ0 (w) dσ, ∀w ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 . = Ω

Ω

∂Ω

(IV.109) We used here the fact that g is tangent to the boundary (assumption (IV.102)). Let θ be a vector field satisfying (III.77). We use once more the notation θ of Section 3.5.2 of Chapter III. We take now w = δ−h δhθ v in (IV.109) and, by definition of the commutators, we find   θ θ (curl v) · δ−h (curl δhθ v) dx + (div v)δ−h (div δhθ v) dx Ω Ω   , , - θ - θ θ θ δh v dx = − (curl v) · curl, τ−h δh v dx − (div v) div, τ−h Ω   Ω   =T1 =T2   θ θ + f · δ−h δhθ v dx − f · ∇Φ[δ−h δhθ v] dx Ω   Ω   =T3 =T4   + δhθ g · γ0 (δhθ v) dσ − {g, γ0 (δhθ v)}h dσ . ∂Ω ∂Ω       =T5

It follows

=T6

9. The Stokes problem with vorticity boundary conditions



337

 δhθ (curl v) · (curl δhθ v) dx +

Ω

δhθ (div v)(div δhθ v) dx Ω

= − T 1 − T 2 − T3 − T 4 + T 5 − T 6   θ + {curl v, curl δh v}h dx + {div v, div δhθ v}h dx . Ω   Ω   =T7

=T8

Finally using once more the definition of the commutators, we obtain   θ 2 | curl δh v| dx + | div δhθ v|2 dx Ω

Ω

= − T1 − T2 − T3 − T4 + T5 − T6 + T7 + T8   , , + ( curl, τhθ v) · (curl δhθ v) dx + ( div, τhθ v)(div δhθ v) dx . Ω   Ω   =T9

=T10

We need now to estimate the terms T1 , ..., T10 . Using Proposition III.3.19 and Lemma IV.7.8 we find |T1 | ≤ C|h| curl vL2 δhθ vL2 ≤ C|h|2 v2H 1 , |T2 | ≤ C|h| div vL2 δhθ vL2 ≤ C|h|2 v2H 1 , |T3 | ≤ C|h|f L2 δhθ vH 1 , |T5 | ≤ δhθ gH −1/2 γ0 (δhθ w)H 1/2 ≤ C|h|gH 1/2 δhθ vH 1 |T6 | ≤ C|h|gL2 γ0 (δhθ w)L2 ≤ C|h|gH 1/2 δhθ vH 1 |T7 | ≤ C|h| curl vL2  curl δhθ vL2 ≤ C|h|vH 1 δhθ vH 1 , |T8 | ≤ C|h|vH 1 δhθ vH 1 , |T9 | ≤ C|h|vL2  curl δhθ vL2 ≤ C|h|vL2 δhθ vH 1 , |T10 | ≤ C|h|vL2 δhθ vH 1 . It remains to estimate the term T4 . To this end we use the following lemma. Lemma IV.9.7. For any v ∈ Hν , we have θ γ0 (δ−h δhθ v) · νH −1/2

 θ  ≤Ch2 νW 2,∞ vL2 + C|h|νW 1,∞ δ−h vH 1 + δhθ vH 1 . We postpone the proof of the lemma for the moment. Using this estimate and (IV.108), we find that

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

338

θ θ |T4 | ≤ f L2 ∇Φ[δ−h δhθ v]L2 ≤ Cf L2 γ0 (δ−h δhθ v) · νH −1/2  2  θ ≤ Cf L2 h vL2 + |h|δ−h vH 1 + |h|δhθ vH 1 .

Finally, we have already seen in (IV.70) that, for any v ∈ Hν , we have γ0 (δhθ v) · νH 1/2 ≤ C|h|vH 1 . Gathering all the estimates above and using (IV.21), we deduce that δhθ v2H 1 ≤Ch2 (v2H 1 + f 2L2 ) θ + |h|(f L2 + vH 1 + gH 1/2 )(δhθ vH 1 + δ−h vH 1 ).

We add this inequality with the same one where h is replaced by −h and we use the Young inequality to deduce that θ δhθ v2H 1 + δ−h v2H 1 ≤ Ch2 (v2H 1 + f 2L2 ). 2 This exactly proves that v ∈ (Htang (Ω))3 . 2 • Each component vi of v for i ∈ {1, . . . , 3}, belongs to Htang (Ω) and satisfies 2 −Δvi = fi ∈ L (Ω). Therefore, we can now deduce the complete regularity up to the boundary exactly as we did at the end of the proof of Theorem III.4.2. • Let us now prove that the boundary condition for curl v is satisfied in a stronger sense. We first observe that, since v ∈ (H 2 (Ω))3 , we know that curl v ∈ (H 1 (Ω))3 and therefore we can define its trace γ0 (curl v) ∈ (H 1/2 (∂Ω))3 . The idea is to use the fact that we have  1 ε (curl v)(. − ν(.)) ds −−−→ γ0 (curl v), in (L2 (∂Ω))3 . ε→0 ε 0

More precisely, for any σ ∈ ∂Ω, we have   ε  1 (curl v)(σ − ν(σ)) ds − γ0 (curl v)(σ) ε  0 1 ε, = (curl v)(σ − ν(σ)) − γ0 (curl v)(σ) ds, ε 0 so that, by taking the L2 norm with respect to σ and using the Jensen inequality, we find

9. The Stokes problem with vorticity boundary conditions

339

2  ε 1 (curl v)(σ − ν(σ)) ds − γ0 (curl v)(σ) dσ ε ∂Ω   ε0 1 2 |(curl v)(σ − ν(σ)) − γ0 (curl v)(σ)| ds dσ ≤ ε ∂Ω 0  1 | curl v − γ0 (curl v) ◦ P0 |2 dx ≤ ε Oε  | curl v − γ0 (curl v) ◦ P0 |2 ≤ε dx. δ2 Oε 

Using the generalised Hardy inequality (Proposition III.3.13 and Remark III.3.5) we get that this term tends to 0. The claim is proved.  It remains to prove the lemma. Proof (of Lemma IV.9.7). We consider ν as a vector field defined on the whole domain Ω (at least in a suitable neighborhood of the boundary) and we compute θ θ θ θ θ δ−h δhθ (v · ν) = (δ−h δhθ v) · ν − (δhθ v) · (δhθ ν) − (δ−h v) · (δ−h ν) + v · (δ−h δhθ ν).

Since v · ν vanishes on the boundary, in the trace sense, we observe that θ δ−h δhθ (v · ν) also vanishes on the boundary. As a consequence, we have θ θ θ θ δhθ v) · ν) = γ0 ((δhθ v) · (δhθ ν)) + γ0 ((δ−h v) · (δ−h ν)) − γ0 (v · (δ−h δhθ ν)), γ0 ((δ−h (IV.110) and we need to estimate the H −1/2 norm of these three terms. We deal with the first term by computing its H 1/2 -norm, which is stronger than required. Indeed, we have

γ0 ((δhθ v) · (δhθ ν))H 1/2 (∂Ω) ≤ C(δhθ v) · (δhθ ν)H 1 ≤ δhθ vH 1 δhθ νL∞ + δhθ vL2 ∇δhθ νL∞ ≤ C|h|νW 1,∞ δhθ vH 1 + h2 vH 1 νW 2,∞ . We estimate now the last term in (IV.110) in the L2 -norm (which is also stronger than required) θ θ δhθ ν))L2 (∂Ω) ≤ γ0 (v)L2 δ−h δhθ νL∞ ≤ C|h|2 vH 1 νW 2,∞ . γ0 (v·(δ−h

The proof of the lemma is complete. 

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

340

9.3 The Stokes problem We come now to the study of the Stokes problem (IV.98). Theorem IV.9.8. Let Ω be a bounded, simply connected domain of R3 , of class C 1,1 . For any f ∈ Hν−1 , and any g ∈ (H −1/2 (∂Ω))3 satisfying (IV.102), there exists a unique solution (v, p) ∈ Hν × L20 (Ω) to the problem (IV.98). Proof. We introduce the Hilbert space Vν = {v ∈ Hν , div v = 0}, and the bilinear form



a : (v, w) ∈ Vν × Vν → a(v, w) =

(curl v) · (curl w) dx. Ω

It is clear that a is continuous. Moreover, by using Theorem IV.4.8 we can see that a is coercive on Vν . The Lax–Milgram theorem proves that there exists a unique solution v ∈ Vν of a(v, w) = f˜, wHν ,Hν + g, γ0 (w)H −1/2 ,H 1/2 , ∀w ∈ Vν .

(IV.111)

Since div v = 0 and −Δv = curl curl v − ∇ div v, we deduce that −Δv − f, wH −1 ,H01 = 0, ∀ϕ ∈ (H01 (Ω))3 , div ϕ = 0. Using de Rham’s theorem (Theorem IV.2.4), we obtain that there exists a unique pressure p ∈ L20 (Ω) such that −Δv + ∇p = f. By Lemma IV.9.4, we know that f − ∇p ∈ Hν−1 . Therefore, by Theorem IV.9.5, there exists a unique solution v˜ ∈ Hν of the vector Laplace problem −Δ˜ v = f − ∇p, v˜ · ν = 0 and (curl v˜) ∧ ν = g. Let us show that v˜ = v. This will immediately prove that v satisfies the claimed boundary condition. • By definition, v˜ satisfies   (curl v˜) · (curl w) dx + (div v˜)(div w) dx Ω

Ω

(IV.112)

' wH  ,H + g, γ0 (w)H −1/2 ,H 1/2 , ∀w ∈ Hν . =f˜ − ∇p, ν ν By Theorem IV.4.12, we know that there exists w ∈ Hν such that div w = 0, curl w = curl(v − v˜). Using this particular test function w in (IV.112) gives

9. The Stokes problem with vorticity boundary conditions

341

 Ω

(curl v˜) · (curl(v − v˜)) dx = f˜, wHν ,Hν + g, γ0 (w)H −1/2 ,H 1/2 ,

' vanishes on divergence-free test functions. because the contribution of ∇p Moreover, by (IV.111) we have  (curl v) · (curl(v − v˜)) dx = f˜, wHν ,Hν + g, γ0 (w)H −1/2 ,H 1/2 . Ω

Subtracting the two previous equalities gives that  | curl(v − v˜)|2 dx = 0; Ω

that is curl v = curl v˜. • We have now the following two equations which are satisfied in the distribution sense curl curl v − ∇ div   v = −Δv = f − ∇p, =0

curl curl v˜ − ∇ div v˜ = −Δ˜ v = f − ∇p. Inasmuch as we proved above that curl v = curl v˜, we find that ∇(div v˜) = 0, in the distribution sense, which implies that div v˜ is a constant on Ω. The divergence theorem gives that   (div v˜) dx = v˜ · ν dσ = 0, Ω

∂Ω

by definition of Hν , and therefore we have proved that div v˜ = 0. • In conclusion, we have shown that curl v = curl v˜, div v = div v˜ = 0, v · ν = v˜ · ν = 0, so that v = v˜ (see Lemma IV.4.6 for instance). Therefore, curl v = curl v˜ satisfies the suitable boundary condition in the weak sense given in (IV.103).  We have shown in the proof of the previous theorem that, once the pressure is known, the velocity field v can be computed by simply solving a vector Laplace problem. We show now that it is actually possible to separate the computation of the pressure from the one of the velocity field for this particular choice of the boundary conditions for the Stokes equations. Proposition IV.9.9. We use the same notation as in Theorem IV.9.8.

Chapter IV. Steady Stokes equations

342

The pressure p which is a solution to Problem (IV.98) can be obtained by computing p = − div u, where u ∈ Hν is the unique solution to the vector Laplace problem ⎧ in Ω, ⎪ ⎨ −Δu = f, u · ν = 0, on ∂Ω, (IV.113) ⎪ ⎩ (curl u) ∧ ν = g, on ∂Ω. Proof. We denote by (v, p) ∈ Hν × L20 (Ω) the unique solution of (IV.98). By Theorem IV.9.5, Problem (IV.113) is known to have a unique solution u ∈ Hν . We set q = − div u ∈ L20 (Ω) and we want to show that q = p. By definition of u, we have   (curl u) · (curl w) dx + (div u)(div w) dx Ω

Ω

=f˜, wHν ,Hν + g, γ0 (w)H −1/2 ,H 1/2 , ∀w ∈ Hν . By Lemma IV.9.4, this can be written  ' wH  ,H + g, γ0 (w)H −1/2 ,H 1/2 , ∀w ∈ Hν . (curl u) · (curl w) dx = f˜ − ∇q, ν ν Ω

Subtracting this equation from the variational formulation satisfied by (v, p) gives   (curl(u − v)) · (curl w) dx = −∇(q − p), wHν ,Hν Ω  (IV.114) = (p − q)(div w) dx, ∀w ∈ Hν . Ω

We consider now the following scalar Laplace problem ⎧ ⎨ −Δψ = p − q, in Ω, ⎩ ∂ψ = 0, on ∂Ω. ∂ν Since p − q ∈ L20 (Ω), the above problem has a solution ψ ∈ H 2 (Ω) (we use here that Ω is of class C 1,1 ) which is unique apart from a constant. Taking w = −∇ψ ∈ Hν in (IV.114), we obtain  |p − q|2 dx = 0, Ω

and the claim is proved.  Remark IV.9.4. This result is particularly interesting from a numerical point of view because the resolution of the Stokes problem (IV.98) is then re-

9. The Stokes problem with vorticity boundary conditions

343

duced to the resolution of two Laplace problems. Applying some Galerkin approximation (through the finite-element method for instance) to these two problems leads to definite-positive symmetric matrices. This is very comfortable compared to the numerical approximation of the Stokes–Dirichlet or Stokes–Neumann problem for which the computation of v and p cannot be decoupled. After discretisation, this leads in general to more complex nonsymmetric matrices for which more specific solvers have to be used. Remark IV.9.5. In the proof above, we have shown that solving the Stokes problem (IV.98) can be reduced to solving a first vector Laplace problem with source term f (this leads us to compute the pressure p) and then to solve a second vector Laplace problem with source term f − ∇p (this leads us to compute the velocity field v). In fact the second step can be reduced to a scalar Laplace problem. Indeed, we know that p = q, thus Equation (IV.114) with w = u − v leads to the additional property that curl(u − v) = 0. By Lemma IV.4.10, we deduce that there exists a q = π ∈ H 1 (Ω) such that u − v = ∇π. Since div v = 0 and div u = −p, and since u · ν = v · ν = 0 on the boundary, we deduce that π solves the problem ⎧ ⎨ −Δπ = p, in Ω, (IV.115) ⎩ ∂π = 0, on ∂Ω. ∂ν Therefore, once u is known, it is enough to solve Problem (IV.115) to obtain π and thus the velocity field v = u − ∇π. With the help of the previous proposition and remarks, we can now obtain a regularity theorem for Problem (IV.98) by simply using the corresponding regularity result for the vector Laplace problem that we studied in the previous section. Theorem IV.9.10. We use the same notation as in Theorem IV.9.8. If we additionally assume that f ∈ (L2 (Ω))3 , g ∈ (H 1/2 (∂Ω))2 , Ω is of class C 2,1 , then we have (v, p) ∈ (H 2 (Ω))3 ×H 1 (Ω) and the boundary condition (curl v)∧ ν = g is satisfied in the strong sense. Proof. By using Theorem IV.9.5, we know that the solution u to (IV.113) belongs to (H 2 (Ω))3 . As a consequence, the pressure p = − div u belongs to H 1 (Ω). It follows that f −∇p lies in (L2 (Ω))3 and we can once more apply Theorem IV.9.5 to deduce that the velocity field v belongs to (H 2 (Ω))3 . The claim is proved. 

Chapter V

Navier–Stokes equations for homogeneous fluids

The main matter of this chapter concerns existence, uniqueness, and regularity results in a bounded domain of Rd , d = 2, 3 for solutions of the incompressible homogeneous Navier–Stokes equations. The study of steady solutions and their stability properties is also investigated. Many interesting topics have been purposely ignored, in particular the study of the Navier–Stokes equations in unbounded domains (particularly over all Rd ); see for instance [63] and the references therein. The first section is dedicated to so-called weak solutions which are defined for all time on any bounded domain of R3 . More precisely, it is mostly devoted to the proof of the theorem by Leray [79, 80] who, in 1934, first established the existence of weak solutions for the Navier–Stokes equations, which he called turbulent solutions (see also the contributions of Hopf in [71, 72]). The second section is dedicated to the existence and uniqueness of more regular solutions (known as strong solutions) in both dimension 2 and dimension 3 (on a finite time interval in the latter case). Moreover, we have given a detailed proof of the parabolic regularity properties of these equations. The techniques used are classic and the first two sections are largely inspired by the books of Ladyzhenskaya [76], Lions [84], and Temam [122], see also [62] for a more complete review on this topic. The last section of this chapter concerns the steady Navier–Stokes equations. We study existence and uniqueness of solutions in the case of homogeneous and nonhomogeneous Dirichlet boundary conditions and we discuss some of their stability properties. Of course, we cannot start this chapter without mentioning that, in the three-dimensional case, the question of the global existence (i.e., for all time t > 0) of regular solutions as well as the uniqueness of weak solutions, are yet unsolved problems inspiring a large amount of research. Throughout this chapter, we systematically use the concepts and notations introduced in Chapter IV, particularly regarding the spaces V , V, H and the Stokes operator A (see Section 5.2 of Chapter IV). F. Boyer and P. Fabrie, Mathematical Tools for the Study of the Incompressible Navier-Stokes Equations and Related Models, Applied Mathematical Sciences 183, DOI 10.1007/978-1-4614-5975-0_5, © Springer Science+Business Media New York 2013

345

346

Chapter V. Navier–Stokes equations for homogeneous fluids

1 Leray’s theorem Let Ω be a connected Lipschitz bounded domain of Rd (henceforth, we always assume that d = 2 or d = 3), let the Reynolds number be fixed Re > 0, let f be given in L2loc ([0, +∞[, (H −1 (Ω))d ), and v0 be given in H. As we saw in Chapter I, the flow of an incompressible homogeneous fluid in a domain Ω submitted to a body force field f is well described by the Navier–Stokes equations. We are therefore interested in the following mathematical problem: to find a vector field v and a scalar field p satisfying ⎧ ∂v 1 ⎪ ⎪ + (v · ∇)v − Δv + ∇p = f, in Ω, ⎪ ⎪ ∂t Re ⎪ ⎨ div v = 0, in Ω, (V.1) ⎪ ⎪ v = 0, on ∂Ω, ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ v(0) = v0 . To study this system, we need to define a functional space in which to search for the solution and then give a (weak) sense to the various equations of the system above before finally showing that we can find indeed a solution to the weak formulation adopted. Let us start with several technical results concerning the only nonlinear term that one can find in these equations: the inertia term (v · ∇)v. This is important because this term contains most of the new difficulties compared to the linear Stokes system.

1.1 Properties of the inertia term For all u, v, w ∈ (H01 (Ω))d , we define  b(u, v, w) = Ω



d    ∂vj ui wj dx. (u · ∇)v · w dx = ∂xi i,j=1 Ω

Lemma V.1.1. The trilinear form b is continuous on (H01 (Ω))d × (H01 (Ω))d × (H01 (Ω))d and satisfies b(u, v, w) + b(u, w, v) = 0, ∀u ∈ V, ∀v, w ∈ (H01 (Ω))d , b(u, v, v) = 0, ∀u ∈ V, ∀v ∈ (H01 (Ω))d .

(V.2)

Moreover, for all u ∈ V and all v, w ∈ (H01 (Ω))d we have 1−d/4

|b(u, v, w)| ≤ CuL2

d/4

1−d/4

uH 1 vL2

d/4

vH 1 wH 1 ,

(V.3)

1. Leray’s theorem

347

In the following, for all u, v ∈ V we denote as B(u, v) ∈ V  the continuous linear form on V defined by B(u, v), wV  ,V = b(u, v, w).

(V.4)

The estimate (V.3) shows that the bilinear map B is continuous from V × V into V  and that we have 2−d/2

B(u, u)V  ≤ CuL2

d/2

uH 1 , ∀u ∈ V.

(V.5)

Remark V.1.1. In a very simplified manner, we can state that it is the fact that the power on the H 1 norm in this estimate is “less good” (i.e., higher) in the three-dimensional case than in the two-dimensional case, which implies certain difficulties (in particular with regard to the uniqueness of the weak solutions in 3D). Proof. The continuity simpli follows from the Sobolev embedding H 1 (Ω) ⊂ L4 (Ω), valid in dimensions less than or equal to 4 (see Theorem III.2.34). The antisymmetry property is proved (for smooth functions, then we conclude by density) using the Stokes formula (the boundary terms are zero because u vanishes on ∂Ω), b(u, v, w) =

d   i,j=1

Ω

ui

∂vj wj dx ∂xi

d  d    ∂ui ∂wj vj wj dx − ui vj dx ∂xi ∂xi i,j=1 Ω i,j=1 Ω  = − (div u)(v · w) dx − b(u, w, v) = −b(u, w, v),

=−

Ω

because the divergence of u vanishes in Ω. To prove (V.3), we use the H¨older inequality to write |b(u, v, w)| = |b(u, w, v)| ≤ uL4 vL4 wH 1 , and then we use Proposition III.2.35 to obtain the result. 

1.2 Weak formulations of the Navier–Stokes equations Among the various equivalent formulations possible for the Navier–Stokes equations, we have chosen to present two which are very similar and which seem to us to be the most convenient to manipulate. The main idea (due to

348

Chapter V. Navier–Stokes equations for homogeneous fluids

Leray) consists in taking divergence-free test functions which are zero at the boundary. These have the advantage of making the pressure disappear in the formulations considered. As we show later (see Section 1.5), once we have resolved one or other of these weak formulations we can recover the pressure by using de Rham’s theorem established in Chapter IV.

1.2.1 Time-independent test functions In this first formulation, we only consider time-independent test functions. More precisely, for the system (V.1) we investigate the following problem: to find v ∈ L2 (]0, T [, V ) such that for all ψ ∈ V we have     d v(t) · ψ dx + (v(t) · ∇)v(t) · ψ dx dt Ω Ω  (V.6) 1 ∇v(t) : ∇ψ dx = f (t), ψH −1 ,H01 , + Re Ω in the sense of distributions in D (]0, T [) and such that v(0) = v0 in V  in the weak sense. Let us clarify the meaning of this last condition. It is easy to see that if v belongs to L2 (]0, T [, V ) and satisfies (V.6) then, for all ψ ∈ V , the realvalued function Fψ : t → Fψ (t) ≡ (v(t), ψ)H = v(t), ψV  ,V has a derivative in the sense of distributions which lies in L1 (]0, T [). Hence Fψ belongs to W 1,1 (]0, T [) which shows that this function is continuous (Corollary II.4.2). In other words, any solution of the above formulation is -weakly continuous with values in V  , which allows us to give a meaning to the initial value v(0). This first formulation is, in a certain sense, simpler than the one that follows. Unfortunately, in order to establish the energy equation, or even the uniqueness of the solutions, we need to take the solutions themselves as the test functions, or the differences between two solutions. This is only possible in the formulation with time-dependent test functions.

1.2.2 Time-dependent test functions Associated with system (V.1) we investigate the following variational problem: to find a function v ∈ L2 (]0, T [, V ) such that dv/dt ∈ L1 (]0, T [, V  ) which, for all test functions ϕ in Cc0 (]0, T [, V ), satisfies

1. Leray’s theorem

349

!

"  T T   dv dt + (v(t) · ∇) v(t) · ϕ(t) dx dt , ϕ(t) dt 0 0 Ω V  ,V  T  T 1 ∇v(t) : ∇ϕ(t) dx dt = f (t), ϕ(t)H −1 ,H01 dt, + Re 0 Ω 0 

(V.7)

and moreover such that v(0) = v0 in V  . We can immediately give a sense to this last condition because the functions v ∈ L2 (]0, T [, V ) such that dv/dt ∈ L1 (]0, T [, V  ) are continuous with values in V  for the strong topology (Proposition II.5.11). We now note that if we also know that the solution v satisfies dv dt ∈ p L (]0, T [, V  ) for a certain p ∈]1, 2], then this formulation can be extended,  by density, to the test functions ϕ ∈ Lp (]0, T [, V ). This remark is fundamental because, in the case of dimension 2, we show that the solution we obtain satisfies dv/dt ∈ L2 (]0, T [, V  ), and that we can therefore extend the formulation to test functions ϕ ∈ L2 (]0, T [, V ). In particular, in the two-dimensional case, we can take the solution v itself as a test function. This is not true in dimension 3 and this is one of the reasons for the particular difficulty of the three-dimensional case.

1.2.3 Equivalence of the formulations Let us start by proving a lemma on the density of functions of the “tensor products” type. Lemma V.1.2. The set E of functions ϕ of the form ϕ(t, x) =

N 

ηk (t)ψk (x),

k=1

where N is any integer, ηk ∈ D(]0, T [), and ψk ∈ V , is dense in Cc0 (]0, T [, V ). Proof. Let ϕ ∈ Cc0 (]0, T [, V ) and ε > 0. Since ϕ is continuous on the compact set [0, T ], it is uniformly continuous. Therefore, there exists δ > 0 such that for all s, t ∈ [0, T ] satisfying |s − t| ≤ δ we have ϕ(s) − ϕ(t)V ≤ ε. Now, let t0 = 0, . . . , tN +1 = T be a regular division of the interval [0, T ] into subintervals of length less than δ and sufficiently fine so that ϕ = 0 on [0, t1 ] ∪ [tN , 1]. The intervals (]tk−1 , tk+1 [)1≤k≤N form an open covering of ]0, T [. Therefore, let (ψk )k be a partition of unity of class C ∞ associated with this covering (Lemma II.2.38). Then, we set ϕN (t) =

N 

ψk (t)ϕ(tk ) ∈ V,

k=1

which is indeed a function of the set E.

Chapter V. Navier–Stokes equations for homogeneous fluids

350

 Now, let t ∈ [0, T ]; since k ψk (t) = 1 and ψk ≥ 0 we have N  N      ϕ(t) − ϕN (t)V =  ψk (t)(ϕ(t) − ϕ(tk )) ≤ ψk (t)ϕ(t) − ϕ(tk )V .   k=1

V

k=1

However, ψk (t) can only be nonzero if |t − tk | < δ and we have the inequality ϕ(t) − ϕ(tk )V ≤ ε, by definition of δ. Finally, we have indeed shown that ϕ(t) − ϕN (t)V ≤ ε, for all t ∈ [0, T ].  We can now show the following important result which proves that we can work independently with one or other of the preceding formulations. Proposition V.1.3. Let f ∈ L1 (]0, T [, V  ) and v ∈ L2 (]0, T [, V ). The following assertions are equivalent. • v has a weak derivative dv/dt in L1 (]0, T [, V  ) and v satisfies (V.7). • v satisfies (V.6). Moreover, if v satisfies these two equivalent assertions, then for almost all t we have the following equality in V  , 1 dv + Av(t) + B(v(t), v(t)) = f (t). dt Re Proof. Let us assume that dv/dt ∈ L1 (]0, T [, V  ) and that v satisfies (V.7). Let ψ ∈ V and be independent of time and let η ∈ D(]0, T [) be a smooth realvalued function with compact support. We can take the function ϕ(t, x) = η(t)ψ(x) as a test function in the formulation (V.7), which gives: !

"  T  dv dt + η(t) (v(t) · ∇v(t)) · ψ dxdt , η(t)ψ dt Ω 0 0 V  ,V  T   T 1 η(t) ∇v(t) : ∇ψ dxdt = η(t)f (t), ψH −1 ,H01 dt. + Re 0 0 Ω 

T

(V.8)

By definition of the weak derivative dv/dt (Definition II.5.7), and because η is regular, the first term can also be written as 6 7 "  T! T dv dv dt = η(t) dt, ψ , η(t)ψ dt dt 0 0 V  ,V V  ,V 6 7 T

=− 0

 =− 0

T

η  (t)v(t) dt, ψ

V  ,V

η  (t)v(t), ψV  ,V dt.

1. Leray’s theorem

351

However, as for almost all t, v(t) ∈ V , by identification of H and its dual via the natural scalar product of H, we know that v(t), ψV  ,V = (v(t), ψ)H for almost all t. We have thus obtained  T  T   − η (t)(v(t), ψ)H dt + η(t) (v(t) · ∇v(t)) · ψ dxdt 0 0 Ω (V.9)  T   T 1 + η(t) ∇v(t) : ∇ψ dxdt = η(t)f (t), ψH −1 ,H01 dt. Re 0 0 Ω This is valid for any function η ∈ D(]0, T [), thus we have indeed shown that (V.6) holds in the sense of distributions. Since the initial condition is satisfied in the strong sense in V  , it is clear that it is also satisfied in the weak sense. Conversely, let us suppose that v satisfies (V.6). We first show that v has a weak derivative with respect to time in the space L1 (]0, T [, V  ). To do this, we take the preceding calculation in reverse, so that (V.9) is again true. Using the definition of the Stokes operator (IV.35) and that for the bilinear function B (V.4), we can also write 6  7 6 7 T



T

η  (t)v(t) dt, ψ

+

0

6

T

+

η(t)B(v(t), v(t)) dt, ψ 0

V  ,V

η(t) 0

1 Av(t) dt, ψ Re

6

7

=

η(t)f (t) dt, ψ 0

V  ,V

V  ,V

7

T

. V  ,V

Since this is true for all ψ ∈ V , we can deduce the following equality in V  , 

T



η  (t)v(t) dt = −

0



T

η(t)B(v(t), v(t)) dt − 0

 +

1 Re



T

η(t)Av(t) dt 0

T

η(t)f (t) dt. 0

However, since the Stokes operator A is continuous from V to V  and the bilinear function B is continuous from V × V to V  , we have 



T

T

B(v(t), v(t))V  dt ≤ C 0



v(t)2V dt ≤ Cv2L2 (]0,T [,V ) , 0



T

Av(t)V  dt ≤ C 0

T

√ v(t)V dt ≤ C T vL2 (]0,T [,V ) .

0

Hence, since (V.9) is true for any function η ∈ D(]0, T [), we have indeed shown that v has a weak derivative with respect to time in L1 (]0, T [, V  ) and also that, for almost all t ∈]0, T [, we have dv 1 =− Av(t) − B(v(t), v(t)) + f (t). dt Re

352

Chapter V. Navier–Stokes equations for homogeneous fluids

Now that we know that dv/dt exists in L1 (]0, T [, V  ), we can deduce from (V.9) that Equation (V.8) is satisfied for all ψ ∈ V and all η ∈ D(]0, T [) and by density, it is clear that (V.8) remains valid for all η ∈ Cc0 (]0, T [). Moreover, by linearity of (V.8) with respect to the test function η(t)ψ, we notice that the formulation (V.7) is satisfied for any test function belonging to the set E defined in Lemma V.1.2. This lemma makes it possible to show that (V.7) is valid for any function ϕ ∈ Cc0 (]0, T [, V ). Indeed, it is easy to see that since v ∈ L2 (]0, T [, V ) and dv/dt ∈ L1 (]0, T [, V  ), the linear functional with respect to ϕ which defines (V.7) is continuous for the topology of Cc0 (]0, T [, V ). Furthermore, we know from Proposition II.5.11, that v is continuous with values in V  for the strong topology and, by hypothesis, v(0) = v0 in the weak continuity sense with values in V  . We can, indeed, recover the initial data v(0) = v0 in the strong sense in V  because the weak limit is unique. 

1.3 Existence and uniqueness of weak solutions 1.3.1 Statement of the main result We can now give the main existence and uniqueness result for (so-called “weak”) solutions of the Navier–Stokes equations. Theorem V.1.4 (Leray). Let Ω be a connected bounded Lipschitz domain of Rd . Let Re > 0, v0 be given in H and f in L2loc ([0, +∞[, (H −1 (Ω))d ); then there exists a pair (v, p) defined on all R+ which is a solution of (V.1) and such that for all T > 0,   (v, p) ∈ L∞ (]0, T [, H) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, V ) × W −1,∞ (]0, T [, L20 (Ω)), and

dv ∈ L4/d (]0, T [, V−1 ) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, V−d/2 ). dt • For d = 2, this solution is unique and v is continuous from [0, +∞[ into H. Moreover, it satisfies the following energy equality for all t ∈ R+ ,  t  t 1 1 1 ∇v(τ )2L2 dτ = v0 2L2 + f (τ ), v(τ )H −1 ,H01 dτ. v(t)2L2 + 2 Re 0 2 0 (V.10) • For d = 3, v is continuous from [0, +∞[ into V−1/4 and weakly continuous from [0, +∞[ into H. It satisfies the following energy inequality, for all t ∈ R+ ,

1. Leray’s theorem

1 1 v(t)2L2 + 2 Re

353



t

∇v(τ )2L2 dτ ≤ 0

1 v0 2L2 + 2

 0

t

f (τ ), v(τ )H −1 ,H01 dτ. (V.11)

The uniqueness of such solutions remains an open problem. The sketch of the proof is the following. We take any T > 0 and attempt to solve one of the equivalent formulations (V.6) or (V.7) on [0, T ]. To achieve this, we introduce a finite-dimensional approximate problem that can be easily resolved using the Cauchy–Lipschitz theorem. Then we prove estimates on the solutions of this approximate problem which are uniform with respect to the approximation parameter. Finally, we use compactness theorems to obtain the strong convergences which allow us to justify the limit in the approximate formulation, particularly in the nonlinear term. This strategy gives the existence of the velocity field v satisfying the proposed formulations. The uniqueness of such solutions in the two-dimensional case is established in an independent section. Then, we show that we can construct a solution on all R+ , in both dimensions d = 2 and d = 3. Then the proof of the energy equality (or inequality) is obtained together with certain regularity properties over time for the solution. We note that the energy inequality (V.11) in the three-dimensional case is only proven for the specific weak solution that we have defined in the proof of the Leray theorem. In particular, if by any chance there exist other weak solutions of the problem, then we have no reason to assume that they will also satisfy this energy inequality. To finish, since the weak formulation used does not directly provide the pressure p, we need to find it indirectly in order to prove and guarantee that we have indeed solved equation (V.1) in the distribution sense.

1.3.2 Approximate problem Let T > 0 be given. We choose to discretise the weak formulation (V.6) of the Navier–Stokes equations which only involves time-independent test functions. To do this we use the special basis (wk )k made of eigenfunctions of the Stokes operator introduced in Definition IV.5.6. Let HN be the finitedimensional vector space generated by the functions (wk )k≤N . We introduce a regularisation with respect to time of the source term f , denoted (fN )N , which is defined by  0 fN (t) = N f (t + h) dh, ∀t ≥ 0, (V.12) −1/N

where f is the extension by 0 of f to all R. Hence, for all N , fN is continuous with respect to time with values in (H −1 (Ω))d . Moreover, the sequence (fN )N converges towards f in L2 (]0, T [, (H −1 (Ω))d ). Indeed, for all t ≥ 0, from the Jensen inequality we have

Chapter V. Navier–Stokes equations for homogeneous fluids

354

 f (t) −

fN (t)2H −1

≤N

0

f (t) − f (t + h)2H −1 dh,

−1/N

and hence 

T



f − fN 2L2 (]0,T [,H −1 ) ≤ N

−1/N

0



0

0







T

f (t) − f (t +

=N −1/N

f (t) − f (t + h)2H −1 dh dt h)2H −1

dt

dh

0

sup f − τh f 2L2 (]0,T [,H −1 ) ,

|h|≤1/N

where τh f is the time-translation of f defined in (II.20). The result thus follows from Corollary II.5.4. Furthermore, we note that for all N and all T > 0 we have fN L2 (]0,T [,X) ≤ f L2 (]0,T [,X) , (V.13) for any Banach space X such that f ∈ L2 (]0, T [, X). Now we consider the following approximate problem: to find vN belonging to C 1 ([0, T ], HN ) which satisfies, for all ψN ∈ HN , the differential equation     d 1 + ((vN · ∇)vN ) · ψN dx + ∇vN : ∇ψN dx vN , ψN dt Re Ω (V.14) Ω H = fN , ψN H −1 ,H01 , as well as the initial condition vN (0) = PN (v0 ), where PN is the orthogonal projection in H onto the finite-dimensional space HN . One such approximate problem of the variational formulation considered above is known as a Galerkin approximation. The family (wk )k is orthogonal in H, therefore if we denote the component along wk of the function vN as αk (t) and the vector of components (αk (t))k≤N as α(t), this approximate problem can be written as a system of ordinary differential equations for α(t) of the form dα = F (t, α), dt where F is continuous and locally Lipschitz continuous with respect to α (because it is polynomial). The Cauchy–Lipschitz theorem gives us the existence of a unique C 1 solution, defined on a maximum interval [0, TN ) where 0 < TN ≤ T . We now need to establish energy estimates on vN , independent of N , which first ensure that TN = T , from the finite time blow-up theorem for ordinary differential equations. Moreover, these estimates also allow us to deduce the

1. Leray’s theorem

355

existence of weakly convergent subsequences in appropriate spaces and hence justify passing to the limit in the approximate problem.

1.3.3 Energy estimates By taking ψN = vN in equality (V.14) we obtain, by selecting the L2 norm of the gradient as the norm on H01 (Ω), and by using Young’s inequality 1 1 d vN 2L2 + ∇vN 2L2 ≤ fN H −1 vN H01 2 dt Re ≤ fN H −1 ∇vN L2 Re 1 ≤ fN 2H −1 + ∇vN 2L2 . 2 2Re

(V.15)

Note that we have used here the fact that the nonlinear term b(vN , vN , vN ) is zero (see (V.2)) and therefore does not appear in this inequality. By simple integration over time, we can deduce  t 1 vN (t)2L2 + ∇vN (τ )2L2 dτ Re 0  t (V.16) fN (τ )2H −1 dτ ≤PN v0 2L2 + Re  ≤v0 2L2

+ Re

0 t

fN (τ )2H −1 dτ, 0

because the projection PN is orthogonal (therefore having norm equal to 1) in (L2 (Ω))d . From (V.13), we have therefore proven the following. Lemma V.1.5. For all N ∈ N, we have the estimates ⎧ sup vN (t)2L2 ≤ v0 2L2 + Ref 2L2 (]0,T [,(H −1 (Ω))d ) , ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ t≤TN  TN ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ ∇vN (τ )2L2 dτ ≤ Rev0 2L2 + Re2 f 2L2 (]0,T [,(H −1 (Ω))d ) .

(V.17)

0

The first fundamental consequence of this lemma is that, for fixed N , the solution vN is bounded on [0, TN ] (for the L2 norm, for example) independently of TN , so that the finite time blow-up theorem for ordinary differential equations gives that TN = T . As a consequence, the estimates (V.17) are valid with TN = T . To pass to the limit in the nonlinear term, it is necessary to obtain a strong convergence result. The compactness theorem of Aubin–Lions–Simon (Theorem II.5.16) needs to be used. To this end we need to prove an estimate

356

Chapter V. Navier–Stokes equations for homogeneous fluids

on the derivatives with respect to time of the approximate solutions and hence estimate the various terms of Equation (V.14). Lemma V.1.6. There exists K(T, v0 , f ) > 0 such that for all N we have    dvN    ≤ K(T, v0 , f ).  dt  4/d L (]0,T [,V  ) Proof. The space HN is built on a basis of eigenfunctions of the Stokes operator. As we have seen, this basis is orthogonal in H and in V . Hence, the operator PN is also an orthogonal projection in V onto HN . The adjoint operator t PN is therefore a continuous linear operator on V  with norm less than or equal to 1. From the definition of the adjoint, we have the following equation in D (]0, T [),   1 dvN (V.18) =− AvN + t PN (B(vN , vN )) − t PN (fN ) . dt Re Indeed, for all ψ ∈ V , since dvN /dt and AvN belong to HN , we have !  "  dvN 1 + AvN +t PN (B(vN , vN )) −t PN (fN ) , ψ dt Re V  ,V ! " dvN 1 = = 0, + AvN + B(vN , vN ) − fN , PN ψ dt Re V  ,V because PN ψ ∈ HN and we can therefore apply (V.14) with ψN = PN ψ. Hence, since the Stokes operator A is continuous from V to V  , it follows from (V.18) and (V.5), that    dvN  1    dt   ≤ Re AvN V  + B(vN , vN )V  + fN (t)V  V 2−d/2

≤ CvN V + vN L2 = gN (t),

d/2

vN H 1 + fN (t)V  ,

where gN is a sequence of bounded functions in L4/d (]0, T [) according to (V.13) and the estimates provided by Lemma V.1.5. Hence 

d/4   T  dvN  4/d   ≤ gN dt ,  dt  4/d 0 L (]0,T [,V  ) which gives the desired estimate.  1/2

3

Remark V.1.2. In the three-dimensional case, by noting that (H (Ω)) (or also that V1/2 ) embeds continuously in (L3 (Ω))3 , we can show, by writing

1. Leray’s theorem

357

the estimate on the bilinear term slightly differently, that B(vN , vN ) is also bounded in L2 (]0, T [, V−3/2 ). Indeed, we write    b(v, v, w) = b(v, w, v) = (v · ∇)w · v dx, Ω

and hence by the H¨ older inequality |b(v, v, w)| ≤ vL3 ∇wL3 vL3 ≤ vL2 vH 1 wV3/2 . By duality this proves that B(v, v)V−3/2 ≤ vL2 vH 1 , and that since (vN )N is bounded in L∞ (]0, T [, H) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, V ), we have (B(vN , vN ))N is bounded in L2 (]0, T [, V−3/2 ), which enables us to show a bound on dvN /dt in L2 (]0, T [, V−3/2 ). 1.3.4 Passing to the limit In Lemmas V.1.5 and V.1.6 we established that the sequence (vN )N is bounded in L∞ (]0, T [, H) and in L2 (]0, T [, V ) and that (dvN /dt)N is bounded in L4/d (]0, T [, V  ). Moreover, from the Sobolev embeddings, we know that H 1 (Ω) is continuously embedded into L6 (Ω) because the space dimension d is less than or equal to 3. We can then deduce that the sequence (vN )N is also bounded in L2 (]0, T [, (L6 (Ω))d ). We now need to obtain a bound for the nonlinear inertia term (vN · ∇)vN . From the H¨ older inequality, we have (vN · ∇)vN L2 (]0,T [,(L1 (Ω))d ) ≤ vN L∞ (]0,T [,(L2 (Ω))d ) ∇vN L2 (]0,T [,(L2 (Ω))d ) ≤ vN L∞ (]0,T [,H) vN L2 (]0,T [,V ) ≤ C(T, v0 , f ). However, we also have (vN · ∇)vN L1 (]0,T [,(L3/2 (Ω))d ) ≤ vN L2 (]0,T [,(L6 (Ω))d ) ∇vN L2 (]0,T [,(L2 (Ω))d ) ≤ vN 2L2 (]0,T [,V ) ≤ C(T, v0 , f ). We have therefore shown that the sequence ((vN · ∇)vN )N is bounded in the spaces L2 (]0, T [, (L1 (Ω))d ) and L1 (]0, T [, (L3/2 (Ω))d ). These regularity spaces are optimal in the sense where the regularity L1 in time, or L1 in space, is the weakest regularity in the class of Lp spaces. In the usual way, we observe that a gain in regularity in time implies a loss of regularity in space and vice versa. The bound obtained in the two spaces above enables us to

358

Chapter V. Navier–Stokes equations for homogeneous fluids

deduce many other bounds in the intermediate spaces from Theorem II.5.5. More precisely, for all 0 ≤ θ ≤ 1, we can deduce from this theorem that the sequence ((vN · ∇)vN )N is bounded in Lp (]0, T [, (Lq (Ω))d ) with 1 θ 1−θ 1 2θ 1 − θ = + and = + . p 1 2 q 3 1

(V.19)

What estimate do we require? To determine this, we need to go back to the weak formulation of the approximate problem in which we wish to pass to the limit. The nonlinear term appears in the formulation in the following form  t ((vN · ∇)vN ) · ψ dx, 0

Ω

where ψ is a time-independent function of (H 1 (Ω))d and hence lies in L∞ (]0, T [, (L6 (Ω))d ). To be able to pass to the limit in this term, we require a weak convergence of the nonlinear term ((vN · ∇)vN )N in the dual space Lr (]0, T [, (L6/5 (Ω))d ) with r > 1 because 6/5 is the conjugate exponent of 6. By returning to (V.19), we see that we need to take θ = 1/2 to have q = 6/5 which gives p = 4/3. In summary, the estimate which will be useful to us is therefore ((vN · ∇)vN )N is bounded in L4/3 (]0, T [, (L6/5 (Ω))d ).

(V.20)

From Theorem II.2.7 there exists a function v and a subsequence of (vN )N , still referred to as (vN )N to simplify the notation, satisfying ⎧ vN −−−− v ⎪ ⎪ N →∞ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ v − −−− v ⎪ N ⎨ N →∞

weakly- in L∞ (]0, T [, H), weakly in L2 (]0, T [, V ),

vN −−−− v weakly in L2 (]0, T [, (L6 (Ω))d ), ⎪ ⎪ N →∞ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ 4 dv dv ⎪ N ⎩ −−−− weakly in L d (]0, T [, V  ). dt N →∞ dt We note that the weak limit in the three initial spaces are necessarily the same, because the three weak convergences imply convergence in the distributions sense (in D (]0, T [×Ω)), and we know that the limit of a sequence in the distributions sense is unique. Finally, the weak limit of dvdtN is equal to dv dt , because the operator for differentiation with respect to time is continuous in the sense of distributions. Then, even if it means again extracting a subsequence, we know from Theorem II.2.7 and using estimate (V.20), that there exists a function g such that (vN · ∇)vN −−−− g, weakly in L4/3 (]0, T [, (L6/5 (Ω))d ). N →∞

1. Leray’s theorem

359

Note that at this stage, we cannot yet affirm that g = (v·∇)v. The fundamental step which follows, consists precisely in using the compactness properties (which we have not used so far) to prove that we do indeed have this equality. Let us start by noting that thanks to the weak convergences above and through Theorem II.5.16 and Proposition II.3.4, we directly obtain that vN −−−−→ v, N →∞

in L2 (]0, T [, H).

We know that (vN )N strongly converges towards v in L2 (]0, T [, (L2 (Ω))d ) and that (∇vN )N weakly converges in L2 (]0, T [, (L2 (Ω))d×d ) towards ∇v. From Proposition II.2.12, we conclude that the sequence ((vN · ∇)vN )N weakly converges in L1 (]0, T [, (L1 (Ω))d ) towards (v · ∇)v. However, we also know that ((vN · ∇)vN )N weakly converges towards g in L4/3 (]0, T [, (L6/5 (Ω))d ). The convergence in these two spaces both imply the convergence in the distributions sense, therefore we can deduce that g = (v · ∇)v by uniqueness of the limit in D (]0, T [×Ω). We want to emphasise the very general method which, for treating nonlinear terms, consists in establishing estimates and weak convergences in the most precise regularity spaces, towards limits which are a priori unknown and identifying these limits by compactness through justifying the passing to the limit in larger spaces (i.e., spaces of less regular functions). This strategy is exactly the one that we presented in Proposition II.2.10 in a quite abstract setting. We can now pass to the limit in the weak formulation. Indeed, let ψK be a fixed function of HK and let θ(t) be a function of D(]0, T [). The spaces (HN )N are nested, thus for all sufficiently large N we have "  T dvN θ(τ )dτ + ((vN · ∇)vN ) · ψK θ(τ )dxdτ , ψK dt Ω 0 0 V  ,V  T  T 1 ∇vN : ∇ψK θ(τ )dxdτ = fN , ψK H 1 ,H01 θ(τ )dτ. + Re 0 Ω 0 

T

!

Since K is fixed, we make N tend towards infinity by using all the convergences established above to obtain "  T!  T dv dτ + ((v · ∇)v) · (θ(τ )ψK )dxdτ , θ(τ )ψK dt 0 0 Ω V  ,V (V.21)  T  T 1 ∇v : ∇(θ(τ )ψK )dxdτ = f, θ(τ )ψK H −1 ,H01 dτ. + Re 0 Ω 0 Note that we only use weak convergences here; the strong convergence of (vN )N towards v in L2 (]0, T [, H) has, indeed, only been used to identify the weak limit of the product (vN · ∇)vN .

Chapter V. Navier–Stokes equations for homogeneous fluids

360

Now let ψ ∈ V and let ψK = PK ψ. Since the (wk )k form a complete family in V , we know that ψK converges towards ψ in V . It is then clear that θ(·)ψK converges towards θ(·)ψ in C 0 ([0, T ], V ) and therefore also in C 0 ([0, T ], (L6 (Ω))d ) by Sobolev embedding. However, since dv/dt ∈ L4/d (]0, T [, V  ), (v · ∇)v ∈ L4/3 (]0, T [, (L6/5 (Ω))d ), and f ∈ L2 (]0, T [, (H −1 (Ω))d ), we can pass to the limit with respect to K in all the terms of Equation (V.21), which exactly demonstrates (V.6) for the test function ψ. Note that, from Proposition V.1.3, the function v thus obtained also satisfies equation (V.7). Since we have seen that dv/dt belongs to the space L4/d (]0, T [, V  ), we can extend the formulation (V.7) to test functions ϕ ∈ L4/(4−d) (]0, T [, V ) by density. We now need to verify that the initial condition is satisfied. From Proposition II.5.11, the limit function v is continuous with values in V  . Moreover, using Theorem II.5.16 we know that the sequence (vN )N strongly converges towards v in C 0 ([0, T ], V  ) which implies, in particular, that vN (0) converges towards v(0) in V  . However, by definition, we have vN (0) = PN (v0 ) and since the special basis chosen is an orthonormal basis of H, the sequence vN (0) converges towards v0 in H and therefore in V  . Through the uniqueness of the limit in V  , we have indeed obtained v(0) = v0 . 

1.3.5 The uniqueness problem Currently, establishing the uniqueness (or nonuniqueness) of weak solutions of the Navier–Stokes equations in 3D is still an open problem. Among other things, this is linked to the lack of regularity of the nonlinear term which only belongs to L4/3 (]0, T [, V  ), as we have seen. This does not allow us to take a test function of L2 (]0, T [, V ) in the weak formulation (V.7), which is the regularity of the solution we just have built. By contrast, this objection disappears in dimension 2. We therefore assume in this section that d = 2 (the 3D case is discussed further in Section 2.3.2). We consider v1 and v2 to be two weak solutions of (V.7) and introduce v = v2 − v1 . The function v therefore satisfies, for any function ψ ∈ L2 (]0, T [, V ), 

T

0

 +

0

T

"  T dv 1 dτ + ∇v(τ ) : ∇ψ(τ )dx dτ (τ ), ψ(τ ) dt Re 0 Ω V  ,V   T (v2 (τ ) · ∇v(τ )) · ψ(τ )dx dτ + (v(τ ) · ∇v1 (τ )) · ψ(τ )dx dτ = 0. !

Ω

0

Ω

For any t ∈ [0, T ], the function ψ(τ ) = 1[0,t] (τ )v(τ ) lies in L2 (]0, T [, V ) and it is therefore possible to take it as a test function in the above equation. Then,

1. Leray’s theorem

361

from Theorem II.5.12 we obtain  t 1 1 2 |∇v(τ )|2 dx dτ v(t)H + 2 Re 0 Ω  t  t 1 b(v2 (τ ), v(τ ), v(τ )) dτ + b(v(τ ), v1 (τ ), v(τ )) dτ = v(0)2H . + 2 0 0 Since b(v2 (τ ), v(τ ), v(τ )) = 0 for almost all τ (see (V.2)), using Estimate (V.3) and Young’s inequality, we get  t 1 1 ∇v(τ )2L2 dτ v(t)2L2 + 2 Re 0  t 1 |b(v(τ ), v1 (τ ), v(τ ))| dτ ≤ v(0)2L2 + 2 0  t 1 ∇v1 (τ )L2 v(τ )L2 ∇v(τ )L2 dτ ≤ v(0)2L2 + 2 0  t 1 1 ∇v(τ )2L2 dτ ≤ v(0)2L2 + 2 2Re 0  Re t ∇v1 (τ )2L2 v(τ )2L2 dτ, + 2 0 from which we deduce  v(t)2L2



v(0)2L2

+ Re

t

∇v1 (τ )2L2 v(τ )2L2 dτ. 0

Since the function v1 lies in L2 (]0, T [, V ), the real-valued function defined by τ → g(τ ) = ∇v1 (τ )2L2 ) belongs to L1 (]0, T [). Hence, we can apply the Gronwall lemma (Lemma II.4.10) and obtain   t  g(τ ) dτ . ∀t ∈ [0, T ], v(t)2L2 ≤ v(0)2L2 exp Re 0

However, v1 (0) = v2 (0) = v0 and therefore v(0) = 0, and hence for t ∈ [0, T ], we obtain v(t) = 0 which proves the uniqueness of the weak solutions. 

1.3.6 Globality of weak solutions In all that has gone before, we have constructed weak solutions of the problem on intervals [0, T ], where T > 0 was set arbitrarily large. We now wish to show, as we claimed in the statement, that we can in reality obtain global solutions, that is, solutions defined over all time.

362

Chapter V. Navier–Stokes equations for homogeneous fluids

• The two-dimensional case: In this case, we obtained the uniqueness of the solutions on the entire interval [0, T ]. This allows us to construct a global solution easily. Indeed, if we denote (vn , pn ) as the unique solution of the problem on the interval [0, n] then, thanks to the uniqueness property, we have vn = vk , pn = pk , on [0, n], provided n < k. We obtain the solution on all R+ by defining v(t) = vn (t), p(t) = pn (t), for t ≤ n. • The three-dimensional case: The preceding argument does not apply because there is no uniqueness of the solutions and we are therefore not certain that the various solutions on the intervals [0, n] cover themselves correctly. We need, therefore, to proceed in a different manner by returning to the way in which solutions are constructed. We introduced an approximate problem in which we denoted the solutions (vN )N (the pressure is obtained directly, at the end, from the solution v). We have established the energy estimates which show that these approximate solutions are unique and exist on all R+ (Cauchy– Lipschitz theorem). Let us set K = 1 and let us consider the interval [0, K] = [0, 1]. By extracting a subsequence (vϕ1 (N ) )N of (vN )N which converges on [0, 1] in the appropriate spaces, at the limit we obtain a solution v of the problem on [0, 1] (see Section 1.3.4). Now let us take K = 2 and let us consider the situation on the interval [0, K] = [0, 2]. We extract a subsequence (vϕ1 (ϕ2 (N )) )N of the sequence (vϕ1 (N ) )N which provides a solution on [0, 2], and so on. Hence, by successive extractions, we can obtain the strictly increasing functions ϕi of N in N such that, at the limit, (vϕ1 ◦...◦ϕK (N ) )N provides a solution of the initial problem on the interval [0, K]. In conclusion, it is now sufficient to use a diagonal extraction process, that is to consider the subsequence (vϕ1 ◦...◦ϕN (N ) )N . This sequence converges towards a solution of the initial problem on any interval [0, K], or even on any interval [0, T ]. Hence, the limit of this subsequence is indeed a solution defined on all R+ .

1. Leray’s theorem

363

1.4 Kinetic energy evolution We now detail the properties of continuity over time for the weak solutions obtained above. Proposition V.1.7. In the two-dimensional case, the previously constructed solution v satisfies v ∈ C 0 (R+ , H). In the three-dimensional case, it satisfies v ∈ C 0 (R+ , V−1/4 ), and v ∈ C 0 (R+ , Hweak ); that is, it is weakly continuous with values in H. Proof. In 2D, we know that v ∈ L2 (]0, T [, V ), dv ∈ L2 (]0, T [, V  ). dt Corollary II.5.13 then gives the claim. In 3D, from Remark V.1.2, we have v ∈ L2 (]0, T [, V ), dv ∈ L2 (]0, T [, V−3/2 ). dt In this case Theorem IV.5.11 expresses the first desired result. We note that since v is strongly continuous with values in V−1/4 , it is also weakly continuous in this same space and that, moreover, we have v ∈ L∞ (]0, T [, H). Hence, Lemma II.5.9 allows us to conclude the weak continuity of v with values in H.  What can we say about the behavior of the energy over time? The physical  energy of the system is kinetic energy 12 Ω |v|2 dx (remember that in this dimensionless model the fluid density is set to 1). We show that in 2D, we can write an energy equation (V.10) which we can physically interpret in the following way  t  t 1 1 1 ∇v(τ )2L2 dτ = f (τ ), v(τ )V  ,V dτ. v(t)2L2 − v0 2L2 + 2  2  Re 0   0   Kinetic energy variation

Dissipated energy

Work of the source term

364

Chapter V. Navier–Stokes equations for homogeneous fluids

In 3D, this energy balance equation simply becomes an inequality. This problem is intimately linked to the currently still unsolved problem of the uniqueness of weak solutions in dimension 3.

The two-dimensional case. We know that, in 2D, the previously constructed weak solution satisfies dv/dt ∈ L2 (]0, T [, V  ), and that the same holds for the term (v·∇)v, which implies that we can extend (V.7) by density to all the functions ϕ ∈ L2 (]0, T [, V ) as we have already commented above. In particular, we can apply (V.7), with ϕ = v and we exactly obtain the energy equation (V.10) through Theorem II.5.12.

The three-dimensional case. Here, as we have seen, we no longer have dv/dt ∈ L2 (]0, T [, V  ), but only dv ∈ L2 (]0, T [, V−3/2 ) ∩ L4/3 (]0, T [, V  ). dt This does not allow the extension of (V.7) to test functions in L2 (]0, T [, V ), and therefore we cannot perform the same calculations as in the twodimensional case. The proof of the energy inequality is therefore more intricate. • Step 1: We can take ψN = vN in the approximate problem (V.14), and obtain  1 1 d |∇vN |2 dx = fN , vN H −1 ,H01 , (V.22) vN 2L2 + 2 dt Re Ω which, by integrating over time, gives for all t ∈ [0, T ]  t 1 1 ∇vN 2L2 dτ vN (t)2L2 + 2 Re 0  t 1 fN , vN H −1 ,H01 ds = PN v0 2L2 + 2 0  t 1 fN , vN H −1 ,H01 dτ. ≤ v0 2L2 + 2 0

(V.23)

The remaining steps of the proof consist in justifying that we are allowed to pass to the limit in this inequality. • Step 2: We show that

1. Leray’s theorem

365

v0 2H = v(0)2H = lim

s→0+

1 s



s

v(t)2H dt.

(V.24)

0

We note that since v is weakly continuous on [0, T ] in H, this essentially amounts to proving that 0 is a Lebesgue point for the mapping t → v(t)2H . To do this, let us integrate (V.23) between 0 and s > 0 and divide by s. This gives:     t 11 s 1 1 s vN 2H dt + ∇vN 2L2 dτ dt 2s 0 Re s 0 0 (V.25)   s  t 1 1 ≤ v0 2H + fN , vN H −1 ,H01 dτ dt. 2 s 0 0 At fixed s > 0, passing to the limit when N tends towards infinity in the first term is an immediate consequence of the strong convergence of (vN )N towards v in L2 (]0, T [, H). Inasmuch as (vN )N is bounded in L2 (]0, T [, V ), and from (V.13), the term  t fN , vN H −1 ,H01 ds is uniformly bounded in t and N , and, furthermore, 0  t f, vH −1 ,H01 ds when for all t ∈ [0, T ], this term converges towards 0

N tends towards infinity by weak convergence of (vN )N towards v in L2 (]0, T [, V ) and by strong convergence of (fN )N towards f . Hence, with Lebesgue’s dominated convergence theorem we have:     t   t 1 s 1 s fN , vN H −1 ,H01 dτ dt −−−−→ f, vH −1 ,H01 dτ dt. N →∞ s 0 s 0 0 0 Furthermore, the sequence (∇vN )N weakly converges towards ∇v in the space L2 (]0, T [, (L2 (Ω))d×d ) and therefore, by denoting the characteristic function of the interval [0, t] as 1[0,t] , it is easy to see that (1[0,t] ∇vN )N weakly converges towards 1[0,t] ∇v in L2 (]0, T [, (L2 (Ω))d×d ). Therefore, by weak lower semicontinuity of the norm (Corollary II.2.8), we obtain 



t

∇v2L2 dτ ≤ lim inf 0

N →∞

t

∇vN 2L2 dτ, ∀t ∈ [0, T ]. 0

Hence, from Fatou’s lemma we have     t    t 1 s 1 s 2 2 lim inf ∇vL2 dτ dt ≤ ∇vN L2 dτ dt N →∞ 0 s 0 s 0 0    s t 1 2 ∇vN L2 dτ dt. ≤ lim inf s N →∞ 0 0

Chapter V. Navier–Stokes equations for homogeneous fluids

366

So we can finally pass to the lower limit (in N ) in the inequality (V.25). It follows     t 11 s 1 1 s 2 2 vH dt + ∇vL2 dτ dt 2s 0 Re s 0 0 (V.26)    t 1 1 s 2 f, vH −1 ,H01 dτ dt. ≤ v0 H + 2 s 0 0 Furthermore, the functions τ → ∇v(τ )2L2 and τ → f (τ ), v(τ )H −1 ,H01  t are in L1 (]0, T [) and hence their antiderivatives t → ∇v(τ )2L2 dτ 0  t and t → f (τ ), v(τ )H −1 ,H01 dτ are continuous functions (Lemma II.4.1) 0

which cancel at zero; their own antiderivatives are therefore differentiable at 0 with zero derivatives (Proposition II.4.6). In other words, we have    t 1 s ∇v2L2 dτ dt −−−−→ 0, s 0 s→0+ 0 and    t 1 s f, vH −1 ,H01 dτ dt −−−−→ 0. s 0 s→0+ 0 By taking the upper limit when s tends towards 0+ in inequality (V.26), we obtain  1 s lim sup v2H dt ≤ v0 2H . (V.27) s→0+ s 0 We now need to obtain an inequality in the other sense. To do this, we use the fact that v is weakly continuous with values in H (Proposition V.1.7) and the property of weak lower semicontinuity of the norm in a Banach space (Corollary II.2.8). This then gives:   2 2 2 2 v0 H = v(0)H ≤ lim inf v(s)H = lim inf v(t)H . + + s→0

σ→0

t∈[0,s]

However, for all s > 0, we have inf v(t)2H ≤

t∈[0,s]

1 s



s

v(t)2H dt, 0

and by taking the lower limit in this inequality, it follows that  1 s v0 2H ≤ lim inf v(t)2H dt. s→0+ s 0

(V.28)

Hence, by combining (V.27) and (V.28), we have indeed demonstrated (V.24).

1. Leray’s theorem

367

|

• Step 3: Let t ∈]0, T ]. For all δ < 2t we introduce the piecewise affine function θδ defined by ⎧1 1 τ in [0, δ], ⎪ ⎪ ⎨δ 1 in [δ, t − δ], θδ (τ ) = 1 | | | | (t − τ ) in [t − δ, t], ⎪ ⎪ ⎩δ t T δ t − δ 0 in [t, T ]. This function belongs to W01,1 ([0, T ]) and we can therefore multiply (V.22) by θδ , integrate over [0, T ], and carry out an integration by parts. This gives 11 2δ 11 = 2δ



t

vN 2H dτ + t−δ δ





1 Re

vN 2H dτ + 0

0



t

∇vN 2L2 θδ (τ ) dτ 0

t

fN , vN H −1 ,H01 θδ (τ ) dτ.

For the same reasons as in the previous step, we can pass to the lower limit when N tends towards infinity in this equality (all the terms converge except those which relate to the gradient of vN for which we use once again the weak lower semicontinuity of the norm in a Banach space). This gives  t 1 dτ + ∇v2L2 θδ (s) dτ Re 0 t−δ   t 11 δ v2H dτ + f, vH −1 ,H01 θδ (τ ) dτ. ≤ 2δ 0 0 11 2δ



t

v2H

We now wish to pass to the limit when δ tends towards 0. The two integrals which contain the function θδ can be treated directly by the dominated convergence theorem. Let us initially assume that t is a Lebesgue point of the function s → v(s)2H . By employing Proposition II.4.4 and the convergence (V.24), we obtain the desired energy inequality  t  t 1 1 1 ∇v2L2 dτ ≤ v0 2H + f, vH −1 ,H01 dτ. v(t)2H + 2 Re 0 2 0 We know that the Lebesgue points of a function in L1 (]0, T [) are dense in ]0, T [ (Theorem II.4.5); we have therefore demonstrated the energy inequality for a dense set of points of [0, T ]. Now, let t ∈ [0, T ] which is not a Lebesgue point of s → v(s)2H . There exists a sequence (tj )j of points of [0, T ] which tends towards t, formed from Lebesgue points of this function and for which the energy inequality is true. Therefore, we have  tj  tj 1 1 1 ∇v2L2 ≤ v0 2H + f, vH −1 ,H01 ds, v(tj )2H + 2 Re 0 2 0

Chapter V. Navier–Stokes equations for homogeneous fluids

368

and, furthermore, since the function v is weakly continuous in H, we have v(t)H ≤ lim inf v(tj )H , j→∞

and thus we can pass to the lower limit in the energy inequality above and obtain the desired result, for all t ∈ [0, T ], 1 1 v(t)2H + 2 Re



t

∇v2L2 ds ≤ 0

1 v0 2H + 2

 0

t

f, vH −1 ,H01 ds. 

1.5 Existence and regularity of the pressure Let ψ ∈ V be fixed and η ∈ D(]0, T [). We take ϕ = η(t)ψ(x) in the formulation (V.7), which gives 

!

T

"    T dv ,ψ dt + η(t) ((v · ∇)v) · ψ dx dt dt 0 Ω V  ,V    T η(t) ∇v : ∇ψ dx dt − η(t)f, ψH −1 ,H01 dt = 0.

η(t) 0

1 + Re

 0

T

Ω

0

This is true for any function η, thus we obtain that for almost any t in ]0, T [, we have ! "   dv 1 ,ψ + ((v · ∇)v) · ψ dx + ∇v : ∇ψ dx − f (t), ψH −1 ,H01 = 0. dt Re Ω Ω V  ,V This can also be written in the form ! " ! " dv 1 ,ψ + (v · ∇)v − Δv − f, ψ = 0. dt Re V  ,V H −1 ,H 1

(V.29)

0

Let us now integrate (V.29) over time using Theorem II.5.12 and the fact that ψ does not depend on time. We obtain (v(t), ψ)H − (v(0), ψ)H ! t "  t  t 1 + (v · ∇)v dτ − Δv dτ − f dτ, ψ = 0. Re 0 0 0 H −1 ,H 1 0

The scalar product on H is exactly the scalar product of (L2 (Ω))d , therefore this equation can also be written as

1. Leray’s theorem

369

! " G(t), ψ H −1 ,H01

= 0, for all t ∈ [0, T ],

(V.30)

with  G(t) = v(t) − v(0) +

t

(v · ∇)v dτ − 0

1 Re





t

t

Δv dτ − 0

f dτ. 0

We have already seen that the function v is weakly continuous with values in H, and hence with values in (L2 (Ω))d as well as with values in (H −1 (Ω))d . Furthermore, v lies in L2 (]0, T [, V ) and hence in L2 (]0, T [, (H01 (Ω))d ). Thus, since the Laplace operator continuously maps H01 to H −1 , the term Δv belongs to L2 (]0, T [, (H −1 (Ω))d . Similarly, from (V.3), the nonlinear term (v · ∇)v belongs to L1 (]0, T [, (H −1 (Ω))d ). Hence, all the integral terms in (IV.59) are antiderivatives of integrable functions with values in (H −1 (Ω))d and, as a consequence, they are continuous in time with values in (H −1 (Ω))d . All this shows that the function G is weakly continuous on [0, T ] with values in (H −1 (Ω))d . Hence, for all t ∈ [0, T ], G(t) is an element of (H −1 (Ω))d which moreover satisfies (V.30) for all ψ ∈ V . From de Rham’s theorem (Theorem IV.2.3), for all t ∈ [0, T ], there exists a unique π(t) ∈ L20 (Ω) such that G(t) = −∇π(t). (V.31) Let us show that t → π(t) is weakly continuous with values in L2 (Ω). Indeed, if g is a function of L2 (Ω), then from Theorem IV.3.1 there exists a function h ∈ (H01 (Ω))d such that div h = g − m(g). Since π(t) has a zero mean, we then have (π(t), g)L2 = (π(t), g − m(g))L2 = (π(t), div h)L2 = −∇π(t), hH −1 ,H01 = G(t), hH −1 ,H01 , and this last quantity is continuous in time because G is weakly continuous in time with values in (H −1 (Ω))d . We have therefore established, in particular, that the function t → π(t) lies in L∞ (]0, T [, L20 (Ω)). We can now introduce the distribution p = ∂π/∂t which belongs to W −1,∞ (]0, T [, L20 (Ω)). By taking test functions of the form ∂ϕ/∂t with ϕ ∈ D(]0, T [×Ω) in (V.31) we can easily show that the Navier–Stokes equation ∂v 1 + (v · ∇)v − Δv + ∇p = f, ∂t Re is satisfied in the distributions sense on ]0, T [×Ω. Note that if v, which is a solution of (V.7), is given, then the pressure p ∈ W −1,∞ (]0, T [, L20 (Ω)) is unique.  This concludes the proof of Leray’s theorem.

370

Chapter V. Navier–Stokes equations for homogeneous fluids

2 Strong solutions To avoid the problem of the nonuniqueness of weak solutions for d = 3, we can ask ourselves if more regular solutions exist for which we could obtain uniqueness. The answer to this question is affirmative but with one important restriction, which is the loss of globality in time for such solutions in 3D. To establish the existence of strong solutions we return to the Galerkin approximation which uses a special basis (V.14) and we look for new estimates. Of course, if we hope to obtain these more regular solutions, we also need to start with more regular data (v0 , f ). Let us first state the main results concerning those strong solutions. Their proofs are given in the next subsections. Theorem V.2.1. Let Ω be a connected, bounded domain of Rd of class C 1,1 . Let Re > 0, let v0 be given in V , and f be given in L2loc ([0, +∞[, (L2 (Ω))d ). • For d = 2, there exists a unique solution to Problem (V.1) satisfying v ∈ C 0 ([0, +∞[, V ) ∩ L2loc ([0 + ∞[, (H 2 (Ω))d ∩ V ), dv ∈ L2loc ([0, +∞[, H), dt p ∈ L2loc ([0, +∞[, H 1 (Ω)). This solution, of course, satisfies the energy equation for all t ∈ [0, +∞[, 1 1 v(t)2L2 + 2 Re



t

∇v(τ )2L2 dτ 0

1 = v0 2L2 + 2



t

(f (τ ), v(τ ))L2 dτ. (V.32) 0

• For d = 3, there exists a T > 0 dependent on the data and a unique solution to Problem (V.1) satisfying v ∈ C 0 ([0, T [, V ) ∩ L2loc ([0, T [, (H 2 (Ω))d ∩ V ), dv ∈ L2loc ([0, T [, H), dt p ∈ L2loc ([0, T [, H 1 (Ω)). Furthermore, it also satisfies the energy equality (V.32). Moreover, since Ω is bounded, if the data are sufficiently small we can show that T = +∞. From a physical point of view, this states that if the viscosity is sufficiently large, then the regular solutions are global. We can also see this result as a stability result of the rest state (v = 0, p = 0) (see Section 3.4 for a similar result concerning steady solutions of the Navier–Stokes equations). This is what specifies the following theorem. Theorem V.2.2 (Global strong solutions for small data). In the threedimensional case, if v0 is given in V and f in L∞ (R+ , (L2 (Ω))d ), then under

2. Strong solutions

371

the following hypotheses, ∇v0 2L2 ≤

C(Ω) C(Ω) 2 , 2 , f L∞ (R+ ,L2 ) ≤ Re Re4

where C(Ω) depends only on the domain Ω, we have T = +∞, which means that the associated strong solution is global. In the 2D case, and if the source term is independent of time, we can prove the following additional estimate. Theorem V.2.3 (Uniform bound over time). Let Ω be a connected bounded domain of R2 of class C 1,1 , v0 ∈ V , and f ∈ (L2 (Ω))2 independent of time; then there exists a C > 0 such that sup ∇v(t)L2 ≤ C.

t∈R+

2.1 New estimates We return to the Galerkin approximation which involves considering an approximate solution vN ∈ C 1 ([0, T ], HN ) for all ψN ∈ HN satisfying   dvN · ψN dx + ((vN · ∇)vN ) · ψN dx Ω dt Ω   (V.33) 1 ∇vN : ∇ψN dx = fN · ψN dx. + Re Ω Ω The basic idea is to take −ΔvN as a test function, but this is not allowed / HN . Instead, we can take ψN = PN (−ΔvN ) as a test function. since ΔvN ∈ Since the approximation space HN is based on the eigenfunctions of the Stokes operator we see that this amounts to taking ψN = AvN = −ΔvN + ∇pN ∈ HN . We note that since AvN ∈ HN ⊂ V , we have   ∇w : ∇vN dx = AvN , wV  ,V = w · AvN dx, ∀w ∈ HN , Ω

Ω

from the identification of H with its dual, via the scalar product of (L2 (Ω))d . In particular, by taking w = vN , w = dvN /dt and w = AvN , respectively, we obtain

Chapter V. Navier–Stokes equations for homogeneous fluids

372



 vN · AvN dx =

 

Ω

Ω

dvN · AvN dx = dt

∇vN

|∇vN |2 dx, 

Ω

dvN 1 d ∇ : ∇vN dx = dt 2 dt Ω : ∇(AvN ) dx = |AvN |2 dx.

Ω

 |∇vN |2 dx, Ω

Ω

These calculations are valid since the approximate solution vN is smooth in time and space. Hence, taking ψN = AvN in (V.33) gives   1 1 d 2 2 fN · AvN dx − ((vN · ∇)vN ) · AvN dx. ∇vN L2 + AvN L2 = 2 dt Re Ω Ω We now need to estimate the right-hand side term of this equality. To do this, we use the H¨older inequality, the precise Sobolev inequalities (Proposition III.2.35), and finally Young’s inequality in the following way 1 d 1 ∇vN 2L2 + AvN 2L2 2 dt Re ≤fN L2 AvN L2 + AvN L2 vN L6 ∇vN L3 ≤fN L2 AvN L2    1−d/3 d/3 1−d/6 d/6 ∇vN L2 AvN L2 + CAvN L2 vN L2 ∇vN L2 1+d/6

1+d/6

1−d/3

≤fN L2 AvN L2 + CAvN L2 ∇vN L2 vN L2 1 ≤ AvN 2L2 2Re 2(6+d)/(6−d) 4(3−d)/(6−d) + CRefN 2L2 + CRe(6+d)/(6−d) ∇vN L2 vN L2 from which we deduce d 1 ∇vN 2L2 + AvN 2L2 (V.34) dt Re 2(6+d)/(6−d) 4(3−d)/(6−d) (6+d)/(6−d) 2 ≤CRefN L2 + CRe ∇vN L2 vN L2 . From now on, we need to distinguish between the case d = 2 and the case d = 3.

2. Strong solutions

373

2.2 The two-dimensional case 2.2.1 Existence We have already established, during our study of weak solutions (estimate (V.16)), that vN (t)2L2 +

1 Re





t

∇vN (τ )2L2 dτ ≤ v0 2L2 +Re

t

fN (τ )2H −1 dτ. (V.35)

0

0

Moreover, (V.34) written for d = 2 gives 1 d ∇vN 2L2 + AvN 2L2 ≤ CRefN 2L2 + CRe2 ∇vN 4L2 vN L2 . (V.36) dt Re Hence, after integration over time, and from (V.35), we obtain ∇vN (t)2L2 2

+ CRe

1 + Re

v0 2L2





t

AvN (τ )2L2 dτ 0



+ Re



∇vN (0)2L2

1/2 

T

f (s)2H −1 ds

T

f (τ )2L2 dτ

+ CRe 0

t

∇vN (τ )2L2 ∇vN (τ )2L2 dτ. 0

0

(V.37) We recall that vN (0) = PN v0 , that is, the orthogonal protection in (L2 (Ω))d of v0 onto HN . We have already seen that, inasmuch as HN is constructed on eigenfunctions of the Stokes operator, the operator PN is also the orthogonal projection onto HN in the space V . Hence we have ∇vN (0)L2 = PN v0 V ≤ v0 V = ∇v0 L2 .

(V.38)

The Gronwall lemma (Lemma II.4.10) applied to y(t) = ∇vN (t)2L2 gives the following bound from (V.37)

 T ∇vN (t)2L2 ≤ ∇v0 2L2 + CRe f (τ )2L2 dτ ekN (t) , 0

where kN (t) = CRe2





v0 2L2 + Re

1/2 

T

f (s)2H −1 ds 0

t

∇vN (τ )2L2 dτ. 0

t We now use the estimate on 0 ∇vN (τ )2L2 dτ given by (V.35), which shows that for all N and all t ∈ [0, T ],

Chapter V. Navier–Stokes equations for homogeneous fluids

374

kN (t) ≤ CRe3



v0 2L2 + Re

3/2

T

f (s)2H −1 ds

.

0

We have therefore shown that there exists a C(v0 , f, T ) > 0 such that sup ∇vN (t)L2 ≤ C(v0 , f, T ). t∈[0,T ]

Through this estimate, we can return to (V.37) to obtain the existence of another C(v0 , f, T ), such that 

T

AvN (τ )2L2 dτ ≤ C(v0 , f, T ). 0

Since Ω is of class C 1,1 , the above estimates, and Proposition IV.5.9, show that the sequence of approximate solutions (vN )N is bounded in L∞ (]0, T [, V ) and in L2 (]0, T [, V ∩(H 2 (Ω))d ). We can easily deduce, in a similar way to the case of weak solutions, that the sequence (dvN /dt)N is bounded in L2 (]0, T [, H). Hence, with the help of additional extractions of subsequences, we can assume that the sequence of approximate solutions (vN )N , in addition to the convergences obtained in Section 1.3.4, satisfies ⎧ weakly- in L∞ (]0, T [, V ), vN −−−− v, ⎪ ⎪ N →∞ ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ weakly in L2 (]0, T [, V ∩ (H 2 (Ω))d ), vN −−−− v, N →∞ ⎪ ⎪ dv ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ N −−−− dv , weakly in L2 (]0, T [, H). dt N →∞ dt From these new properties, we arrive at the existence of a unique solution of Equation (V.1) such that v ∈ C 0 (R+ , V ) ∩ L2loc (R+ , V ∩ (H 2 (Ω))d ) with

dv ∈ L2loc (R+ , H). dt

Indeed, the continuity of the solution with values in V results from Theorem IV.5.11 because v ∈ L2 (]0, T [, D(A)) and dv/dt ∈ L2 (]0, T [, H). Moreover, inasmuch as we know now that the terms dv/dt and (v · ∇)v are in L2 (]0, T [, (L2 (Ω))d ), we can write ∇p = −

dv 1 + Δv − (v · ∇)v + f ∈ L2 (]0, T [, (L2 (Ω))d ). dt Re

Since p has a zero mean, the Poincar´e–Wirtinger inequality (Proposition III.2.39) shows that p ∈ L2 (]0, T [, H 1 (Ω)). 

2. Strong solutions

375

2.2.2 Uniform bound over time The essential ingredient here is the uniform Gronwall lemma (Lemma II.4.11). Proof (of Theorem V.2.3). Remember that we assumed that f does not depend on time so that the regularisation with respect to time defined by (V.12) simply reads fN = f . We denote the smallest eigenvalue of the Stokes operator as λ1 . We have seen in Proposition IV.5.12, that we then have the following Poincar´e inequality v2L2 ≤ (1/λ1 )∇v2L2 . Estimate (V.15) gives d λ1 vN 2L2 + vN 2L2 ≤ Ref 2H −1 . dt Re Lemma II.4.9 then allows us to deduce that vN (t)2L2 ≤ v0 2L2 e−λ1 /Ret +

Re2 Re2 f 2H −1 ≤ v0 2L2 + f 2H −1 . λ1 λ1

By integrating (V.15) between t and t + 1, and by using the above inequality, we get  t+1 1 ∇vN (τ )2L2 dτ ≤ vN (t)2L2 + Ref 2H −1 Re t   Re . ≤ v0 2L2 + Ref 2H −1 1 + λ1 Using (V.36), this allows the uniform Gronwall lemma (Lemma II.4.11) to be applied, with y(t) = ∇vN 2L2 , g1 (t) = CRef 2L2 , and g2 (t) = CRevN L2 ∇vN 2L2 . Hence, we obtain the desired bounds on the Galerkin approximations vN of the solution, uniformly in N . More precisely, we have shown ∇vN L∞ (R+ ,(L2 (Ω))d×d ) ≤ C. From Corollary II.2.8, we know that the norm is weakly lower semicontinuous. The preceding inequality therefore passes to the limit, which gives: sup ∇v(t)L2 ≤ C. t≥0



Chapter V. Navier–Stokes equations for homogeneous fluids

376

2.3 The three-dimensional case Estimate (V.34) written for d = 3 gives d 1 ∇vN 2L2 + AvN 2L2 ≤ CRefN 2L2 + C Re3 ∇vN 6L2 . dt Re

(V.39)

We first study the general case and then the case for small data.

2.3.1 General case We set yN (t) = ∇vN (t)2L2 for any t ∈ R. By using (V.12) and (V.38), and by integrating (V.39) over time, for all t ≥ 0, we get  yN (t) ≤ ∇v0 2L2 + CRe



t

f (s)2L2 ds + CRe3 0

t 3 yN (s) ds.

0

Hence, let T ∗ > 0 be the unique real number satisfying T∗ =

1





∇v0 2L2 + CRe

2CRe3

2 .

T∗

(V.40)

f (s)2L2 ds 0

From Lemma II.4.12, we can deduce that for any T < T , there exists a constant C(T, ∇v0 L2 , Re, f L2 ) independent of N such that ∇vN (t)2L2

1 + Re



t

AvN (τ )2L2 dτ ≤ C(T, ∇v0 L2 , Re, f L2 ), ∀t < T. 0

We note that T ∗ tends towards 0 when ∇v0 L2 tends towards infinity and also that this “lifetime” tends towards infinity when the data v0 and f tend towards 0. This latter behavior is described in detail in Section 2.3.3. By applying the regularity theorem for the Stokes problem (see Proposition IV.5.9) we deduce the following result from the above. Proposition V.2.4. Let Re > 0, v0 ∈ V , and let f be in L2loc ([0, +∞[, (L2 (Ω))d ), then there exists a T > 0 such that for any T < T , there exists a C(T, ∇v0 L2 , Re, f L2 ) > 0 such that 

∇vN (t)L2 ≤ C, ∀t ≤ T, T

vN (τ )2H 2 dτ ≤ C. 0

It is now useful to estimate the nonlinear term (vN · ∇)vN . Proposition V.2.5. For all T < T , there exists a C > 0 such that

(V.41)

2. Strong solutions

377



T

(vN (τ ) · ∇)vN (τ )4L2 dτ ≤ C, ∀N ≥ 1.

(V.42)

0

Proof. By using Proposition III.2.35, we have the following inequality 4

(vN · ∇)vN L2 ≤ vN 4L6 ∇vN 4L3  4 1/2 1/2 ≤ ∇vN 4L2 ∇vN L2 AvN L2 ≤ ∇vN 6L2 AvN 2L2 Estimate (V.41) then allows us to reach the claim.  This demonstrates, in particular, that the nonlinear term is bounded in L2 (]0, T [, (L2 (Ω))d ). Remark V.2.1. When we estimate the derivative with respect to time of vN , we see that in the equation dvN 1 = −t PN (B(vN , vN )) − AvN + t PN (fN ), dt Re

(V.43)

the term with lowest regularity is now the linear term contrary to the 2D case. Proposition V.2.6. For all T < T , there exists a C > 0 such that    dvN    ≤ C, ∀N ≥ 1.  dt  2 L (]0,T [, (L2 (Ω))d )

(V.44)

Proof. This follows easily from the hypothesis on f , from estimates (V.41) and (V.42), and from Equation (V.43).  As in the two-dimensional case, Estimates (V.41) and (V.44) allow us to conclude the existence of a subsequence always denoted as (vN )N such that for all T < T , ⎧ weakly- in L∞ (]0, T [, V ) , vN −−−− v, ⎪ ⎪ N →∞ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ −−− v, weakly in L2 (]0, T [, V ∩ (H 2 (Ω))d ), ⎨ vN − N →∞ dvN dv ⎪ ⎪ −−−− , weakly in L2 (]0, T [, H), ⎪ ⎪ N →∞ dt dt ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ vN −−−−→ v, in L2 (]0, T [, V ), N →∞

Chapter V. Navier–Stokes equations for homogeneous fluids

378

where v is a solution of (V.1). The solution v thus obtained is indeed a strong solution of the equations. As we have already seen in the two-dimensional case, the pressure p then belongs in L2 (]0, T [, H 1 (Ω)).

2.3.2 Uniqueness of the strong solution Let v1 and v2 be two strong solutions of (V.1) for the same initial data v0 ∈ V , and let us set v = v2 − v1 . Since for i ∈ {1, 2}, (vi · ∇)vi and dvi /dt lie in L2 (]0, T [, (L2 (Ω))d ), we can extend formulation (V.7) for v1 and v2 with test functions ϕ ∈ L2 (]0, T [, V ). By subtraction of these two equations, we obtain that v satisfies, for any ϕ ∈ L2 (]0, T [, V ), !

"  T 1 dv dt + ∇v : ∇ϕ dx dt ,ϕ dt Re 0 Ω 0 V  ,V  T  T ((v2 · ∇)v) · ϕ dx dt + ((v · ∇)v1 ) · ϕ dx dt = 0. +



T

0

Ω

0

Ω

It is now possible, for all t ∈]0, T [, to  take ϕ = 1[0,t] .v in the preceding equality and since from (V.2) we have ((v2 · ∇)v) · v dx = 0, from Theorem II.5.12 we obtain

Ω

 t 1 1 ∇v(τ )2L2 dτ v(t)2L2 + 2 Re 0  t 1 ∇v1 (τ )L2 v(τ )||2L4 dτ ≤ v(0)2L2 + 2 0  t 2  1 1/4 3/4 g(τ ) v(τ )L2 ∇v(τ )L2 dτ ≤ v(0)2L2 + 2 0  t  t 1 1 ∇v(τ )2L2 dτ + C g(τ )4 v(τ )2L2 dτ, ≤ v(0)2L2 + 2 2Re 0 0 where τ → g(τ ) = ∇v1 (τ )L2 ∈ L∞ (]0, T [) because v1 is a strong solution of the problem. We have hence obtained the inequality  t 1 1 2 2 g(τ )4 v(τ )2L2 dτ, v(t)L2 ≤ v(0)L2 + C 2 2 0 which allows us to apply the Gronwall lemma which then tells us that   t  v(t)2L2 ≤ v(0)2L2 exp 2C g(τ )4 dτ . 0

2. Strong solutions

379

However, v(0) = v1 (0) − v2 (0) = v0 − v0 = 0, and the preceding inequality implies that v(t) = 0 for all t, and therefore completes the proof of the theorem.  In fact, we have a stronger result than the previous one. Theorem V.2.7 (Weak–strong uniqueness). In dimension d = 3, let u be a weak solution of (V.1) satisfying the energy inequality (V.11) and let v be a weak solution of (V.1) such that there exists a time T > 0, for which v ∈ L4 (]0, T [, V ).

(V.45)

If u(0) = v(0) then the solutions u and v coincide on [0, T [. Proof. We first need to remark that the weak solution v satisfies the energy equality (V.32). Indeed, we have seen that in 3D, the weak solutions satisfy dv/dt ∈ L4/3 (]0, T [, V  ) and (v · ∇)v ∈ L4/3 (]0, T [, V  ), which allows the weak formulation (V.7) to be extended to test functions ϕ ∈ L4 (]0, T [, V ). Having assumed that v ∈ L4 (]0, T [, V ), we can take ϕ = v in the weak formulation and obtain the energy equation (V.32) in the usual way. Furthermore, v ∈ L4 (]0, T [, V ), thus we can easily show that (v · ∇)v lies in L2 (]0, T [, V  ) which proves that we indeed have dv/dt ∈ L2 (]0, T [, V  ). Since v ∈ L4 (]0, T [, V ), for the same reason as above we can take v as a test function in the weak formulation (V.7) for the solution u. Similarly, as we have seen above, we can take the function u ∈ L2 (]0, T [, V ) as a test function in the weak formulation (V.7) for the solution v. Hence, for all t ∈ [0, T ] we obtain the two formulas "  t!  t du 1 dτ + ∇u : ∇v dx dτ ,v dt Re 0 Ω 0 V  ,V  t  t ((u · ∇)u) · v dx dτ = f, vH −1 ,H01 dτ, + 0

and

Ω

0

 t!

"  t dv 1 dτ + ∇v : ∇u dx dτ ,u dt Re 0 Ω 0 V  ,V  t  t ((v · ∇)v) · u dx dτ = f, uH −1 ,H01 dτ. + 0

Ω

0

A purely algebraic computation on the nonlinear terms, together with application of Theorem II.5.12, then shows that if we denote w = u − v, by adding the two previous equations, we obtain

380

Chapter V. Navier–Stokes equations for homogeneous fluids

 t 2 (u(t), v(t))H + ∇u : ∇v dx dτ Re 0 Ω  t  t ((w · ∇)w) · v dx dτ. f, u + vH −1 ,H01 dτ − =(u(0), v(0))H + 0

0

Ω

(V.46) The energy inequality for u and the energy equality for v can be written as  t  t 2 2 ∇uL2 dτ ≤ (u(0), u(0))H + 2 (u(t), u(t))H + f, uH −1 ,H01 dτ, Re 0 0 (V.47)  t  t 2 (v(t), v(t))H + ∇v2L2 dτ = (v(0), v(0))H + 2 f, vH −1 ,H01 dτ, Re 0 0 (V.48) by forming the equation (V.47) + (V.48) − 2 × (V.46) we obtain the inequality  t  t 2 w(t)2L2 + ∇w(τ )2L2 dτ ≤ w(0)2L2 + 2 ((w · ∇)w) · v dx dτ. Re 0 Ω 0 By hypothesis we have w(0) = u(0) − v(0) = 0 and by using the Sobolev inequalities given in Proposition III.2.35 and Young’s inequality, we can deduce  t 2 2 w(t)L2 + ∇w(τ )2L2 dτ Re 0  t w(τ )L3 ∇w(τ )L2 v(τ )L6 dτ ≤2 0  t 1/2 3/2 w(τ )L2 ∇w(τ )L2 ∇v(τ )L2 dτ ≤C 0  t  t 1 ∇w(τ )2L2 dτ + C w(τ )2L2 ∇v(τ )4L2 dτ. ≤ Re 0 0 In particular for all t ∈ [0, T ], we have  w(t)2L2 ≤ C

t

w(τ )2L2 ∇v(τ )4L2 dτ, 0

which allows us to make the desired conclusion using Gronwall’s lemma, because by assumption we have ∇v ∈ L4 (]0, T [, (L2 (Ω))d×d ).  Remark V.2.2.

2. Strong solutions

381

• We note that if v is a strong solution constructed above, then v lies in L∞ (]0, T [, V ) ⊂ L4 (]0, T [, V ) for all T < T ∗ and hence satisfies the hypotheses of the theorem. • It is needed to assume that the weak solution u satisfies the energy inequality (V.11). Indeed, as we have already noted, the only weak solution which we can be sure satisfies this inequality is the one constructed by the Galerkin method proposed above. We do not possess a uniqueness result for weak solutions in 3D, thus we cannot guarantee that any other possible weak solution satisfies this energy inequality. There exist various results proving regularity and/or uniqueness of weak solutions in dimension d = 3 starting from a suitable a priori estimate. As an example, we give without proof the following result (see [106, 107, 116, 115]). Theorem V.2.8. Let Ω be a bounded domain in R3 and v be any weak solution of the Navier–Stokes defined on a time interval ]0, T [. If v satisfies v ∈ Lr (]0, T [, (Ls (Ω))3 ), (V.49) for some r, s satisfying 2 3 + = 1, 3 < s ≤ ∞, r s

(V.50)

then v satisfies the energy equality (V.32). Moreover, if 2/r + 3/s < 1 then v is smooth in ]0, T [×Ω. Finally, if u is a weak solution associated with the same initial data as v and which satisfies the energy inequality (V.11) then u = v. Remark V.2.3. It is possible to intuitively understand why the condition (V.50) plays a key role in this theory. Any weak solution v satisfies, by definition, v ∈ L2 (]0, T [, (H 1 (Ω))3 ) ⊂ L2 (]0, T [, (L6 (Ω))3 ), v ∈ L∞ (]0, T [, (L2 (Ω))3 ). This is not sufficient for the nonlinear term (v · ∇)v to belong to the dual of the space X = L2 (]0, T [, V ) ∩ L∞ (]0, T [, H), which is a fundamental property to get the energy equality. Let us show that the additional assumption (V.49), with (V.50) exactly implies this regularity of the nonlinear term. For a given w ∈ L2 (]0, T [, V ) ∩ L∞ (]0, T [, H) we first use the H¨older inequality with respect to the space variable as  θ (v · ∇)v · w dx ≤ vLs ∇vL2 w1−θ L2 wL6 , Ω

where θ ∈ [0, 1] is defined by

Chapter V. Navier–Stokes equations for homogeneous fluids

382

θ 1−θ 1 1 3 + = − , that is, θ = . 6 2 2 s s We now use the H¨older inequality with respect to the time variable   T (v · ∇)v · w dx dt 0 Ω θ ≤vLr (]0,T [,Ls ) ∇vL2 (]0,T [,L2 ) w1−θ L∞ (]0,T [,L2 ) wL2rθ/(r−2) (]0,T [,L6 ) .

Condition (V.50) exactly implies that θ=

2 r−2 3 =1− = , s r r

so that

2rθ = 2, r−2

and thus we get   T (v · ∇)v · w dx dt 0 Ω θ ≤vLr (]0,T [,Ls ) ∇vL2 (]0,T [,L2 ) w1−θ L∞ (]0,T [,L2 ) wL2 (]0,T [,L6 )

≤Cv wX , and the claim is proved; that is, (v · ∇)v ∈ X  .

2.3.3 The case of small data In (V.40) we obtained a lower bound for the lifetime of the solutions. This bound seems to show that the smaller the data are, the larger the lifetime is. The aim of this section is to show that, in 3D, if the external forces f , the Reynolds number Re, and the initial data v0 are sufficiently small, then T = +∞; that is, that the strong solution associated with the data (v0 , f ) is in fact global. Let us begin by giving an elementary result relating to a class of nonlinear differential inequalities. Lemma V.2.9. Let z be a nonnegative numerical function of class C 1 , satisfying the differential inequality:  z  (t) + αz(t) ≤ β + γz(t)3 , z(0) = z0 , on a time interval [0, T [, 0 < T < +∞, and where α, β, γ, z0 are nonnegative real numbers. If we assume that

2. Strong solutions

383

z0 ≤

1 2

?

α α ,β≤ 2γ 4

?

α , 2γ

then the function z satisfies ? z(t) ≤

α , ∀t ∈ [0, T [. 2γ

Proof. ( Let z0 ≤ 12 α/2γ; since t → z(t) is continuous, there exists a maximum ( time T1 ∈]0, T ] such that z(t) remains less than α/2γ on the interval [0, T1 [. If T1 = T , the lemma is proven. Hence, we suppose that T1 < T and we are going to prove that this leads to a contradiction. For t ≤ T1 , γz 2 (t) − α remains less than −α/2 and hence we have the inequality: α z  (t) ≤ β + z(t)(γz(t)2 − α) ≤ β − z(t). 2 Thus, from Lemma II.4.9, for all t ≤ T1 , we have z(t) ≤ z0 e−α/2t +

2β , α

so that from the hypotheses on z0 , α, and β, we get ? ? α 1 α −α/2T1 z(T1 ) ≤ z0 e + < . 2 2γ 2γ Since the ( function z is continuous, we see that there exists ε > 0 such that z(t) ≤ α/2γ for all t ∈ [T1 , T1 + ε], which contradicts the definition of T1 .  We can now prove the globality of strong solutions of the Navier–Stokes equations in dimension 3 for small data. Proof (of Theorem V.2.2). From Proposition IV.5.12, inequality (V.39) gives: d λ1 ∇vN (t)2L2 + ∇vN (t)2L2 ≤ CRefN 2L2 + CRe3 ∇vN (t)6L2 dt Re ≤ CRef 2L∞ (R+ ,L2 ) + CRe3 ∇vN (t)6L2 , and the preceding lemma allows us to conclude that under the hypothesis ∇v0 2L2 ≤

C(Ω) C(Ω) 2 , 2 and f L∞ (R+ ,L2 ) ≤ Re Re4

384

Chapter V. Navier–Stokes equations for homogeneous fluids

where C(Ω) depends on λ1 and the Sobolev constants on the open set Ω, then there is no finite time blow-up; that is, TN = +∞ and the sequence (∇vN )N is bounded in L∞ (R+ , (L2 (Ω))d×d ). The proof is complete 

2.4 Parabolic regularity properties Theorem V.2.10. Let Ω be a connected bounded domain of Rd of class C k,1 , with k ≥ 1. Let Re > 0, v0 be in V and f be in L2loc ([0, +∞[, (L2 (Ω))d ). From Theorem V.2.1, there exists 0 < T ∗ ≤ +∞ and a unique pair (v, p), with m(p) = 0, which is a strong solution of the Navier–Stokes equation (V.1) in the sense of Theorem V.2.1, for the initial data v0 . We now assume that we have v0 ∈ (H k (Ω))d , and for all s ≤ k/2, ∂sf ∈ L2 (]0, T [, (H k−2s−1 (Ω))d ). ∂ts Hence, assuming compatibility conditions (V.54) at the boundary on the data, that we detail in the proof, the solution (v, p) of the Navier–Stokes equations possesses the following regularity properties ∂sv ∈ L∞ (]0, T [, (H k−2s (Ω))d ∩ V ), ∂ts ∂sv ∈ L2 (]0, T [, (H k−2s+1 (Ω))d ∩ V ), ∂ts ∂sv ∈ L2 (]0, T [, Vk−2s+1 ), ∂ts ∂sp ∈ L∞ (]0, T [, H k−2s−1 (Ω)), ∂ts ∂sp ∈ L2 (]0, T [, H k−2s (Ω)), ∂ts

k , 2 k ∀s ∈ N, s ≤ , 2  k for s = E +1 , 2 k ∀s ∈ N, s ≤ − 1, 2 k ∀s ∈ N, s < . 2 ∀s ∈ N, s ≤

Before proving this theorem, we state and demonstrate a direct corollary of this result. Corollary V.2.11. Under the conditions of the preceding theorem, we have k ∂sv ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], (H k−2s (Ω))d ∩ V ), ∀s ∈ N, s < , ∂ts 2 k ∂sv ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], H), if s = ∈ N, ∂ts 2

2. Strong solutions

385

s

∂ p k ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], H k−2s−1 (Ω)), ∀s ∈ N, s < − 1. s ∂t 2 Proof (of the corollary). It is sufficient to use the results of the preceding theorem as well as Corollary II.5.13 (or Theorem IV.5.11).  Proof (of the theorem). In order to simplify the calculations, in the proof that follows we choose a Reynolds number equal to 1 such that (v, p) is a solution of ⎧ ∂v ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ ∂t + (v · ∇)v − Δv + ∇p = f, in Ω, div v = 0, ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ v = 0,

in Ω, on ∂Ω.

Below, in the usual way, we will make formal energy estimates on these equations. To perform the complete proof, it should be necessary to make these estimates over the Galerkin approximations of the solution (which are as regular as we wish provided that the domain is sufficiently regular) and then pass to the limit. This process is now standard and we leave the details as an exercise for the reader. Furthermore, to conserve the readability of the calculations, we define until the end of the proof v (s) =

∂ s v (s) ∂sp ∂sf , p = s , f (s) = s . s ∂t ∂t ∂t

Let us perform a proof by induction. The case k = 1 is simply an alternative expression of the regularity obtained in Theorem V.2.1. Hence, let k ≥ 2 and let us assume the required result up to row k − 1 and then let us demonstrate it to row k. The proof differs depending on the parity of k. • First case: odd k. We write k = 2S + 1. The idea is to differentiate the equation s times with respect to time, for all 0 ≤ s ≤ S s    ∂v (s) s (v (r) · ∇)v (s−r) + ∇p(s) = f (s) . − Δv (s) + r ∂t r=0

More particularly, at time t = 0, we find for all s ≤ S

(V.51)

Chapter V. Navier–Stokes equations for homogeneous fluids

386 (s)

∂v (s−1) ∂t t=0  s−1   s−1 (s−1) (r) (s−1−r) (s−1) (s−1) (v0 · ∇)v0 = Δv0 − − ∇p0 + f0 . r (s)

v0 = v|t=0 =

r=0

We can then project this equation onto the set of divergence-free vector fields to obtain    s−1   s−1 (s) (s−1) (r) (s−1−r) (s−1) v0 = −Av0 P (v0 · ∇)v0 + Pf0 − . (V.52) r r=0

We now note that these equations do, indeed, have a meaning. Indeed, the result is assumed to be true for the row k − 1, therefore we can apply Corollary V.2.11 to row k − 1, which proves that for all s ≤ S the trace of v (s) at t = 0 is indeed defined. Similarly, the hypothesis of regularity on f (s) and on all its derivatives with respect to time shows that f0 is, indeed, defined and we have (s) f0 ∈ (H k−2s−2 (Ω))d . From the hypothesis v0 ∈ (H k (Ω))d and from Equations (V.52), it is now easy to show (by an immediate induction) that for all s ≤ S, we have (s)

v0 ∈ (H k−2s (Ω))d .

(V.53)

For this, we use the fact that the Stokes operator maps (H t (Ω))d to (H t−2 (Ω))d and the fact that the product of two functions, respectively, in H s1 and H s2 (over all s1 , s2 > 0), belongs to H s with s = min(s1 , s2 ) except if s1 = s2 = 1 in which case s = 0. The simple proof of this result is left to the reader. We can now give the compatibility condition that is required to obtain the regularity to all orders of the solution. Intuitively, since v vanishes at the boundary, we see that if v is sufficiently regular, then we must also have v (s) = 0 on the boundary. Hence, if we hope to have continuity up to t = 0 (s) of v (s) with values in (H 1 (Ω))d , for example, then we must have v0 = 0 (s) on the boundary of Ω. We then assume, in all of the following, that v0 , defined by recurrence using Equation (V.52), satisfies the condition (s)

v0 = 0 on ∂Ω.

(V.54)

Under this hypothesis, we see in particular that by taking s = S in (V.53), we have shown that (S) v0 ∈ V. We then return to Equation (V.51) with s = S, where we now know that the initial data belong to V . The idea is therefore to multiply this equation

2. Strong solutions

387

by Av (S) and integrate by parts to obtain the following energy estimate 1 d ∇v (S) 2L2 + Av (S) 2L2 2 dt S  1 ≤ Av (S) 2L2 + C (v (r) · ∇)v (S−r) 2L2 + Cf (S) 2L2 . 2 r=0

(V.55)

From the induction hypothesis, for all r ≤ S, we know that v (r) ∈ L∞ (]0, T [, (H k−2r−1 (Ω))d ∩ V ) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, (H k−2r (Ω))d ∩ V ), and hence in particular for all r ≤ S − 1,  (r) v ∈ L∞ (]0, T [, (H 2 (Ω))d ∩ V ) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, (H 3 (Ω))d ∩ V ), v (S) ∈ L∞ (]0, T [, H) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, V ).

(V.56)

Hence, we can control the nonlinear term of the estimate (V.55) in the following way, by separating out the case where r = S, S 

(v (r) · ∇)v (S−r) 2L2

r=0



S−1 

v (r) 2L∞ ∇v (S−r) 2L2 + v (S) 2L4 ∇v (0) 2L4

r=0

≤C

S−1 

v (r) 2H 2 v (S−r) 2H 1

+

v (S) 2H 1 v (0) 2H 1

r=0

≤k1 (t) + k2 (t)∇v (S) 2L2 , where k1 and k2 are two functions of t belonging to L1 (]0, T [) from (V.56). Finally, (V.55) gives d ∇v (S) 2L2 + Av (S) 2L2 ≤ Cf (S) 2L2 + Ck1 (t) + Ck2 (t)∇v (S) 2L2 , dt and we can use the Gronwall lemma to conclude that v (S) ∈ L∞ (]0, T [, V ) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, (H 2 (Ω))d ∩ V ). This concludes the first part of the claim. We now write Equation (V.51) taking s = S which, after projection onto the set of divergence-free vector fields, reads v

(S+1)

 S     ∂v (S) S (S) (r) (S−r) P (v · ∇)v + Pf (S) . = −Av − = r ∂t r=0

Chapter V. Navier–Stokes equations for homogeneous fluids

388

Through the hypotheses on f (s) and the result obtained above, we immediately obtain that v (S+1) ∈ L∞ (]0, T [, V  ) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, H). Now, we can rewrite Equation (V.51) taking s = S but in a slightly different form Av (S) = −Δv (S) + ∇p(S) = f (S) −

S   ∂v (S)  S (v (r) · ∇)v (S−r) , + r ∂t r=0

which let us see the pair (v (S) , p(S) ) as the solution of a certain Stokes-like problem. However, the preceding results obtained on v (S+1) , as well as the hypothesis on f , show that the source term of this Stokes-like problem belongs to L∞ (]0, T [, V  ) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, (L2 (Ω))d ). Hence, by using the regularity theorem for the Stokes problem (see Proposition IV.5.9), and the fact that the operator A is an isomorphism from V to V  , we obtain v (S) ∈ L∞ (]0, T [, V ) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, (H 2 (Ω))d ∩ V ), p(S) ∈ L2 (]0, T [, H 1 (Ω)). The end of the proof is now clear. We proceed in the same way by reverse induction from s = S to s = 0, writing each time that (v (s) , p(s) ) is a solution to the Stokes problem −Δv

(s)

+ ∇p

(s)

=f

(s)

s   ∂v (s)  s (v (r) · ∇)v (s−r) , − + r ∂t r=0

for which the regularity of the source term is given by the results of row s + 1. This concludes the proof for the case where k is odd. • Second case: even k. We write k = 2S. The principle is entirely identical to the preceding case and we do not detail the proof, which is also rather simple. Firstly, the first part of the proof is strictly the same so that (V.53) is again true. However, now k = 2S and hence we simply have (S)

v0

∈ H.

Thus, we can easily carry out a L2 estimate on Equation (V.51) for s = S. This is obtained by multiplying the equation by v (S) and integrating by parts. We obtain

2. Strong solutions

389

1 d (S) 2 1 1 v L2 + ∇v (S) 2L2 ≤ ∇v (S) 2L2 + f (S) 2H −1 2 dt 2 2  S    (v (r) · ∇)v (S−r) · v (S) dx . +C r=0

Ω

We note that the nonlinear term, corresponding to the index r = 0, is zero due to property (V.2). The nonlinear terms are again (for 1 ≤ r ≤ S) estimated in a similar way to the case where k is odd by using the induction hypothesis on row k − 1. Furthermore, the hypothesis on f says that f (S) lies in L2 (]0, T [, (H −1 (Ω))d ). Finally, we obtain v (S) ∈ L∞ (]0, T [, H) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, V ). The end of this proof is then exactly the same; the various regularities of v (s) and p(s) are obtained by writing that the pair (v (s) , p(s) ) is a solution of the Stokes problem for which the regularity is known by descending recurrence in s. 

2.5 Regularisation over time As for parabolic nondegenerate problems (for which the simplest model is the heat equation), the weak solutions of the Navier–Stokes equations are regularised over time. More exactly, in the two-dimensional case, if the open set Ω is of class C ∞ and the data f are smooth enough, then from an initial condition v0 in H, the solution satisfies   v ∈ C ∞ ]0, T [, V ∩ (H k (Ω))d , for all k, one such regularity being certainly false on the whole interval [0, T [. This property illustrates the irreversibility of diffusion phenomena. We do not fall into the trap of believing that this occurs for weak solutions in 3D! Indeed, not having uniqueness for such solutions, we could not hope for a result of the type: “under certain assumptions, there exist weak solutions which regularise themselves along the time.” Such results have no physical relevance. On the contrary, if we consider local strong solutions in 3D, they also regularise themselves along the time, over the whole time interval on which the solution exists. We establish this phenomenon for k ≤ 2 and in the case where f does not depend on time. The more general case can be obtained by combining the proof which follows with the method used in the preceding subsection to prove Theorem V.2.10.

Chapter V. Navier–Stokes equations for homogeneous fluids

390

To obtain this result we proceed by the Galerkin approximation and perform the estimates which follow for the approximate solutions; this tedious step, with which the reader is already familiar, is omitted. We content ourselves with carrying out the formal calculations. Theorem V.2.12. Let Ω be a connected bounded domain of R2 of class C 1,1 , Re > 0, let v0 be given in H, and f be given in (L2 (Ω))d , independent of time. Then for all ε > 0, the unique weak solution (v, p) of the Navier–Stokes equations satisfies v ∈ C 1 ([ε, +∞[, H) ∩ C 0 ([ε, +∞[, V ) ∩ L2loc (]ε, +∞[, V ∩ (H 2 (Ω))d ), and p ∈ L2loc ([ε, +∞[, H 1 (Ω)). Proof. In order to simplify the notation, from here on we denote the derivative of v with respect to time as v˙ . Let ψ ∈ V be fixed independent of time. Almost everywhere, the solution v satisfies    1 v, ˙ ψV  ,V + ∇v : ∇ψ dx + ((v · ∇)v) · ψ dx = f · ψ dx. Re Ω Ω Ω After multiplication by t and differentiation with respect to time, by introducing w = tv, ˙ we obtain ! "    dw 1 1 + ∇w : ∇ψ dx + ∇v : ∇ψ dx + ((w · ∇)v) · ψ dx ,ψ dt Re Ω Re Ω Ω V  ,V    + ((v · ∇)w) · ψ dx + ((v · ∇)v) · ψ dx = f · ψ dx. Ω

Ω

Ω

 ((v · ∇)w) · w dx = 0 (due

By taking ψ = w(t) in this identity, and since Ω

to (V.2)), we find that the function w satisfies the energy estimate   1 1 1 d 2 2 ∇v : ∇w dx − ((w · ∇)v) · w dx wL2 + ∇wL2 = − 2 dt Re Re Ω Ω  f · w dx − ((v · ∇)v) · w dx + Ω

Ω

1 ≤ ∇vL2 ∇wL2 + C∇vL2 wL2 ∇wL2 Re 1/2 3/2 1/2 1/2 + CvL2 ∇vL2 wL2 ∇wL2 + f L2 wL2 1 ≤g(t)w2L2 + h(t) + ∇w2L2 , 2Re where g and h are two functions of L1 (]0, T [) for fixed T > 0, because v is a weak solution of the problem and hence satisfies the corresponding energy

3. The steady Navier–Stokes equations

391

estimates. Hence, we have 1 d w2L2 + ∇w2L2 ≤ 2g(t)w2L2 + 2h(t). dt Re Since w(0) = 0, we can deduce from this inequality, by the Gronwall lemma, that for all T > 0, w ∈ L∞ (]0, T [, H) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, V ), which implies in the classic way (see the proof of the Leray theorem), that dw ∈ L2 (]0, T [, V  ). dt All this demonstrates (by Theorem II.5.13), that w ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], H). However w = tdv/dt and so we see that for all ε > 0, and T > 0 we have v ∈ C 1 ([ε, T ], H) ∩ C 0 ([ε, T ]; V ). Since v(ε) ∈ V , the function t → v(t) is also a strong solution of the Navier–Stokes equations on the interval [ε, T ] (here we use the uniqueness of the weak solutions in dimension 2). Hence, we indeed obtain v ∈ L2 (]ε, T [, V ∩ (H 2 (Ω))d ), and p ∈ L2 (]ε, T [, H 1 (Ω)). 

3 The steady Navier–Stokes equations In this section, we deal with steady solutions for the Navier–Stokes equations. We first establish the existence of at least one solution for space dimension 2 and 3. We consider homogeneous and non-homogenous Dirichlet boundary conditions. Then we prove the uniqueness of such solution for small data and we finally establish asymptotic stability properties of such solutions.

Chapter V. Navier–Stokes equations for homogeneous fluids

392

3.1 The case of homogeneous boundary conditions 3.1.1 Existence Theorem V.3.1. Let Ω be a Lipschitz bounded domain in Rd , d ∈ {2, 3}.  d Let f ∈ H −1 (Ω) be given. There exists at least one solution (v, p) in  1 d H (Ω) × L20 (Ω) of: ⎧ 1 ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ − Re Δv + (v · ∇)v + ∇p = f,

in Ω,

⎪ ⎪ ⎩

in Ω, on ∂Ω.

div v = 0, v = 0,

(V.57)

Any such solution satisfies   ∇vL2 ≤ Ref H −1 and pL2 ≤ C f H −1 + Re2 f 2H −1 . Proof. Let us consider the special basis introduced in Definition IV.5.6. For N ≥ 1, let us denote by HN the finite-dimension vector space spanned by N (wj )1≤j≤N . We look for vN ∈ HN , vN = j=1 αj wj solution of     1 ∇vN : ∇ψN dx + (vN · ∇)vN · ψN dx Re Ω Ω = f, ψN H −1 ,H 1 , ∀ψN ∈ HN .

(V.58)

0

To this end, we introduce the map P defined on RN by P (α) = β, where the coordinates βj are equal to     1 βj = ∇vN : ∇wj dx + (vN · ∇)vN · wj dx − f, wj H −1 ,H 1 . 0 Re Ω Ω From Equation (V.58) one has    1 a · P (α) = ∇vN 2L2 + (vN · ∇)vN · vN dx − f, vN H −1 ,H 1 , 0 Re Ω   =0, by (V.2)



(V.59)

1 ∇vN 2L2 − f H −1 vN H01 . Re

Since vN H01 = ∇vN L2 , we observe that a · P (α) ≥ 0 as soon as vN H01 ≥ Ref H −1 . This condition is fulfilled if |α| = ρ, where ρ is large enough. Therefore we can apply the Brouwer theorem (Proposition II.3.11), which ensures the existence of at least one α ∈ RN such that P (α) = 0 and thus gives one solution of (V.58).

3. The steady Navier–Stokes equations

393

Moreover, P (α) = 0, therefore the inequality (V.59) gives the estimate ∇vN L2 ≤ Re f H −1 . Hence, there exists v ∈ (H01 (Ω))d and a subsequence (vNk )k such that: ⎧  d ⎪ ⎨ vNk −−−− v, weakly in H01 (Ω) , k→∞

⎪ ⎩ vNk −−−−→ v, in (Lp (Ω))d , ∀p < 6. k→∞

In particular, by Corollary II.2.8, we have ∇vL2 ≤ lim inf ∇vk L2 ≤ Re f H −1 . k→∞

The convergences above imply, by Proposition II.2.12, that 

(vNk · ∇)vNk



−−−− (v · ∇)v,

k k→∞

d

weakly in (Lp (Ω)) , ∀p
0 depending only on Ω, such d  d  that for any f ∈ H −1 (Ω) and g ∈ H 1/2 (∂Ω) satisfying ⎧ ⎪ ⎪ g · ν dσ = 0, ⎨ ∂Ω

⎪ C ⎪ ⎩Q∂Ω (g) ≤ 1,Ω , Re

(V.63)

396

Chapter V. Navier–Stokes equations for homogeneous fluids

 d then Problem (V.62) has at least one solution (v, p) ∈ H01 (Ω) × L20 (Ω) which satisfies ∇vL2 ≤ C2,Ω Ref H −1 + C2,Ω gH 1/2 exp(C2,Ω RegH 1/2 ) .

(V.64)

We will see that the smallness condition (V.63) is certainly useful in the following proof. Nevertheless, it is not known up to now if this condition is really necessary for the steady Navier–Stokes problem to have a solution. We refer to [63] for a more detailed discussion on this issue. The key point of the proof of this theorem is to build a suitable lifting of the boundary data in order to transform the problem into a case with homogeneous Dirichlet boundary conditions. The problem is nonlinear, thus this lifting has to be small enough to let us perform energy estimates. We consider boundary data g such as in the statement of the theorem and we define  1 μi = g · ν dσ, ∀i ∈ {1, . . . , m}. |Γi | Γi We observe that, by assumption, we have m  i=1

 μi |Γi | =

g · ν dσ = 0. ∂Ω

Therefore, according to Theorem IV.5.2, we can find a vector field F1 ∈  1 d H (Ω) satisfying, for some π1 ∈ L2 (Ω), the equations ⎧ − ΔF1 + ∇π1 = 0, in Ω, ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ div F1 = 0, in Ω, ⎪ ⎨ F1 = μi ν, on Γi , ∀i ∈ {1, . . . , m}, ⎪ ⎪ m ⎪  ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ |μi | ≤ CQ∂Ω (g). ⎩ F1 H 1 ≤ C

(V.65)

i=1

Note that we only use that F1 is a divergence-free lifting of the trace μi ν on Γi . In particular the scalar field π1 is useless in the sequel. By construction, the function g − F1 satisfies on the boundary ⎧ ⎪ ⎪ (g − F1 ) · ν dσ = 0, ⎨ ∂Ω (V.66) ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ (g − F1 ) · ν dσ = 0, ∀i ∈ {1, . . . , m}. Γi

Applying once more Theorem IV.5.2 we can find a divergence-free vector field  d F2 ∈ H 1 (Ω) satisfying F2 = (g − F1 ) on ∂Ω and F2 H 1 ≤ Cg − F1 H 1/2 . Under the assumption (V.63), the estimate (V.65) says that the term F1 can be made small but we do not know anything about the size of the term F2 .

3. The steady Navier–Stokes equations

397

The following result (see [71]) shows that one can modify F2 in the interior of Ω, in such a way that F2 is small enough in a weak sense which is sufficient for our purpose. Lemma V.3.4 (Hopf’s lemma). For all α > 0, there exists a vector field  d G ∈ H 1 (Ω) , such that div G = 0, G = F2 on ∂Ω and satisfying G ⊗ wL2 ≤ αwH01 , ∀w ∈ (H01 (Ω))d ,

(V.67)

  C ∇GL2 ≤ CgH 1/2 exp gH 1/2 . (V.68) α We refer, for instance, to [70] for a discussion about the more general conditions on the domain and on the boundary data which ensure the validity of this lemma. Proof. We recall that we only consider here the three-dimensional case. Let us first notice that we can simply take G = F2 if α is large enough. Indeed we have and

F2 ⊗ vL2 ≤ F2 L3 vL6 ≤ CF2 H 1 vH01 ≤ C  g − F1 H 1/2 vH01 , and then (V.67) is satisfied as soon as α ≥ C  g − F1 H 1/2 . Note that (V.68) is also satisfied in that case. From now on, we assume that α ≤ C  g − F1 H 1/2 .

(V.69)

From (V.66) we have  γν (F2 ), 1H −1/2 (Γi ),H 1/2 (Γi ) =

F2 · ν dσ = 0, Γi

for any 1 ≤ i ≤ m. Thus, we can apply Theorem IV.4.13 to obtain the  d existence of a vector field Φ in H 2 (Ω) such that ⎧ in Ω, ⎪ ⎨ curl Φ = F2 , div Φ = 0, in Ω ⎪ ⎩ ΦH 2 ≤ CF2 H 1 ≤ C  g − F1 H 1/2 . We emphasise that it is not needed to impose a boundary condition on this vector field Φ. For all ε > 0, we set δε = e−1/ε , and we introduce the function ψε : R → [0, +∞[ defined by ⎧ 2 ⎨1  δε  for s2≤ δε , ψε (s) = ε log s for δε ≤ s ≤ δε , ⎩ 0 for s ≥ δε .

Chapter V. Navier–Stokes equations for homogeneous fluids

398

Let η : R → R be a mollifying kernel with support in ] − 1, 1[. We introduce a C ∞ function βε as follows    s−t 4 η βε (s) = 2 ψε (t) dt. δε R δε2 /4 The function βε satisfies ⎧ 3δ 2 ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ βε (s) = 1, ∀s ≤ ε , ⎪ ⎪ 4 ⎪ ⎨ δ2 βε (s) = 0, ∀s ≥ δε + ε , ⎪ 4 ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ε 3 ⎪  ⎩ |βε (s)| ≤ , ∀s ≥ 0. 2s

(V.70)

We only give the details for the estimate on βε (s) for 3δε2 /4 ≤ s ≤ δε + δε2 /4      4 s−t s−t (t) dt = η ψ ψε (t) dt, ε δε2 /4 δε2 δε2 /4 R R    s+δε2 /4   4 s−t = η ψε (t) dt. δε2 δε2 /4 s−δε2 /4

βε (s) =



4 δε2

2 

η



The derivative of the function ψε is bounded by |βε (s)| ≤



4 δε2





s+δε2 /4

η s−δε2 /4

s−t δε2 /4



ε t

thus we have

ε ε dt ≤ . δ2 t s − 4ε

Finally for 34 δε2 ≤ s, one obtains |βε (s)| ≤ 3ε/(2s). In the same way, we can prove      4 2 s − t  η (t) dt |β  (s)| = 2 η 2 /4 δε δ R ε

 2     s−t ε 4 ≤ η δ 2 /4 dt δ2 δε2 R s − 4ε ε

 ε 4 |η  (t)|dt ≤ 2 δ2 δε R s − 4ε 1 ≤ εe1/ε . s Therefore, by definition of δε , we have βε ∞ ≤ 2εe2/ε and βε ∞ ≤ Cεe3/ε .

3. The steady Navier–Stokes equations

399



 We now define χε (x) = βε ρ(x)) , for all x ∈ Ω, where ρ is the regularized distance function built in Section 3.3 of Chapter III. Notice that for ε > 0 small enough χε is smooth because its support is a small neighborhood  of the boundary ∂Ω. We now take G = curl χε Φ so that div G = 0 is automatically satisfied. Since χε = 1 near the boundary of Ω, we also have G = F2 on ∂Ω. From Equation (V.70), it is straightforward that the function G satisfies ⎧   ε ⎪ ⎨ |G(x)| ≤ C |Φ(x)| + |∇Φ(x)| , ∀x ∈ Ω, ρ(x) ⎪ ⎩ G(x) = 0, as soon as ρ(x) ≥ δ + δ 2 /4. ε ε 

We are now able to estimate the L2 norm of G ⊗ v, where v belongs to d H01 (Ω) . One has 

 |G| |v| dx ≤C ε 2

2

2

v 2 dx |Φ| ρ(x) 2

ρ(x)≤δε +δε2 /4

Ω



|∇Φ|2 |v|2 dx

+C ρ(x)≤δε +δε2 /4

≤Cε

2

Φ2H 2

+C

 v(x) 2 dx Ω ρ(x) 

2/3 |∇Φ| dx

v2L6

3

.

ρ(x)≤δε +δε2 /4

According to the Hardy inequality (Proposition III.2.40 using also (III.69)), we have proved that G ⊗ vL2 ≤ CεΦH 2 ∇vL2 + Cθ(ε)vL6 ,   ≤ C εΦH 2 + θ(ε) ∇vL2 , where

1/3



|∇Φ| dx 3

θ(ε) = ρ(x)≤δε +δε2 /4

≤ Cδε1/6 ΦH 2 ≤ CεΦH 2 .

Finally, we have shown the inequality G ⊗ vL2 ≤ CεΦH 2 vL2 ≤ Cεg − F1 H 1/2 vL2 , so that (V.67) is proved if we choose ε=

α . Cg − F1 H 1/2

Chapter V. Navier–Stokes equations for homogeneous fluids

400

Thanks to assumption (V.69), we remark that this value of ε remains bounded by some number depending only on Ω. Finally we easily find that ∇GL2 ≤ C(1 + βε L∞ + βε 2L∞ + βε L∞ )ΦH 2   α2 C ≤ Cε2 e5/ε ΦH 2 ≤ exp g − F1 H 1/2 , Cg − F1 H 1/2 α which gives (V.68) by using (V.69) and the definition of F1 .

 Proof ( of Theorem V.3.3 ). Let α > 0 determined later and G the vector field given by the previous  = G + F1 , so that by construction, we have G  = g on lemma. We define G the boundary ∂Ω. We look for a solution of the system (V.62) in the form  The Navier–Stokes system is then equivalent to the following v = w + G. problem, with homogeneous Dirichlet boundary conditions ⎧ 1 ⎪    ⎪ ⎨ − Re Δw + (w · ∇)G + (G · ∇)w + (w · ∇)w + ∇p = f + f , in Ω ⎪ ⎪ ⎩

div w = 0, w = 0,

in Ω, on ∂Ω, (V.71)

with

1  − (G  · ∇)G.  ΔG (V.72) f = Re We shall find a solution to this system by using the same Galerkin approximation strategy as in the proof of Theorem V.3.1. We do not give the details of this procedure but only the energy estimate that we need to prove an uniform bound on the approximate solutions (passing to the limit is then justified in the same way as in the proof of the above-mentioned theorem). Thanks to the homogeneous boundary condition satisfied by w, the nonlinear term (w · ∇)w does not contribute to the energy estimate (see (V.2)). Therefore, the new difficulty is to estimate the following linear terms,       ˜   · w dx. I(G, w) = (G · ∇)w · w dx + (w · ∇)G Ω

Ω

An integration by parts of the second term allows us to write   ˜ w) = (w ⊗ G)  : ∇w dx − (G  ⊗ w) : ∇w dx. I(G, Ω

Ω

˜ w) = I(G, w) + I(F1 , w). ˜ = G + F1 , and thus I(G, We recall that G By Lemma V.3.4, we have |I(G, w)| ≤ 2α∇w2L2 .

3. The steady Navier–Stokes equations

401

Using Sobolev embeddings and the condition (V.63) (where the constant C1,Ω is chosen appropriately) we have |I(F1 , w)| ≤ 2wL6 F1 L3 ∇wL2 ≤ CF1 L3 ∇w2L2 ≤ CF1 H 1 ∇w2L2 1 ∇w2L2 . ≤ CQ∂Ω (g)∇w2L2 ≤ 4 Re Hence the energy estimate for Equation (V.71) reads     1 1 ∇w2L2 + f H −1 + f˜H −1 ∇wL2 , ∇w2L2 ≤ 2α + Re 4Re with α to be determined. For example, we can take α = 1/8Re to obtain   (V.73) ∇wL2 ≤ 2Re f H −1 + f˜H −1 , and we conclude the proof of the existence of at least a solution to Equation (V.62) as for the homogeneous case. From (V.72), (V.68), and the choice α = 1/8Re we find, using assumption (V.63), that f˜H −1 ≤

1  + G  ⊗ G  L2 ≤ C gH 1/2 exp(CRegH 1/2 ) . ∇G Re Re

 we deduce from (V.73) that the estimate (V.64) holds. Since v = w + G, 

3.3 Uniqueness for small data Theorem V.3.5. Let Ω be a bounded, simply connected, and Lipschitz domain of Rd with d = 3. There exists C3,Ω > 0 depending only on Ω, such that for any f ∈ (H −1 (Ω))d and g ∈ (H 1/2 (∂Ω))d satisfying the conditions ⎧ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ g · ν dσ = 0, ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ ∂Ω C1,Ω , Q∂Ω (g) ≤ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ Re ⎪ ⎪ ⎩Re2 f  −1 + Reg 1/2 exp(C Reg 1/2 ) ≤ C , 2,Ω 3,Ω H H H the problem (V.62) has a unique solution (v, p) ∈ (H 1 (Ω))d × L20 (Ω).

Chapter V. Navier–Stokes equations for homogeneous fluids

402

Remark V.3.2. For some particular domains Ω, it can be shown that for high values of the Reynolds number this uniqueness property may fail (even with homogeneous boundary conditions); see [63] for instance. Proof. Under the assumption on Q∂Ω (g), Theorem V.3.3 proves the existence of at least one solution (v, p) satisfying the estimate (V.64). Let (˜ v , p˜) ∈ (H 1 (Ω))d × L20 (Ω) be any other possible solution of (V.62) and let us denote by w = v˜ − v, q = p˜ − p the differences between these two solutions. By subtracting the two systems, we see that (w, q) solves the problem ⎧ 1 ⎪ v · ∇w) + ∇q = 0, in Ω, ⎪ ⎨ − Re Δw + (w · ∇)v + (˜ ⎪ ⎪ ⎩

div w = 0, w = 0,

in Ω, on ∂Ω.

We use w as a test function in this problem and integrate by parts. Since w vanishes on the boundary, with (V.2) we obtain    1 2 (w · ∇)v · w dx ≤ C∇vL2 ∇w2L2 . ∇wL2 = − Re Ω With the estimate (V.64), we see that we can find C2,Ω and C3,Ω such that CRe∇vL2 ≤ 12 which leads to ∇w = 0 and then w = 0.  Remark V.3.3. In the case of the homogeneous Dirichlet condition, we have g = 0, and the uniqueness of the solution is ensured as soon as the condition Re2 f H −1 ≤ C3,Ω is fulfilled.

3.4 Asymptotic stability of steady solutions We now deal with the stability properties of steady solutions. We only concentrate on the case of homogeneous Dirichlet boundary conditions but the nonhomogeneous case can be treated in the very same way. For a given source term f which does not depend on time, we consider a steady solution (v∞ , p∞ ) ∈ (H01 (Ω))d × L20 (Ω) to (V.62). The question we want to adress now is the following: given initial data v0 ∈ H close enough to v∞ (made precise below), is there a unique global solution (v, p) to the unsteady Navier–Stokes problem

3. The steady Navier–Stokes equations

⎧ 1 ∂v ⎪ ⎪ − Δv + (v · ∇)v + ∇p = f, in Ω, ⎪ ⎪ Re ⎪ ⎨ ∂t div v = 0, in Ω, ⎪ ⎪ v = 0, on ∂Ω, ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ v(0) = v0 ,

403

(V.74)

and does this solution converge towards (v∞ , p∞ ) when t → +∞? In such a case, we say that the steady solution under study is asymptotically stable. Of course, the situation will be different depending on the dimension because, for d = 2, the existence of an unique global weak solution is known for any initial data (Theorem V.2.1), whereas for d = 3, global weak solutions are not necessarily unique and strong solutions are not necessarily global. From now on we look for a solution to (V.74) in the form v = v∞ + w and p = p∞ + π where (w, π) solves the problem ⎧ 1 ∂w ⎪ ⎪ − Δw + (w · ∇)w + (v∞ · ∇)w + (w · ∇)v∞ + ∇π = 0, in Ω, ⎪ ⎪ ∂t Re ⎪ ⎨ div w = 0, in Ω, ⎪ ⎪ w = 0, on ∂Ω, ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ w(t = 0) = v0 − v∞ . (V.75) We first concentrate on the asymptotic behavior of the velocity field v (or w) and we postpone the discussion on the behavior of the pressure to the end of this section.

3.4.1 The two-dimensional case We show here that a steady solution is asymptotically stable, provided that it is small enough. Theorem V.3.6. Let Ω be a bounded, simply connected, and Lipschitz domain. Let f be given in (H −1 (Ω))2 and (v∞ , p∞ ) ∈ (H01 (Ω))d × L20 (Ω) be a steady solution to (V.62) associated with the source term f . There exists C > 0, α > 0 depending only on Ω such that, under the condition C ∇v∞ L2 ≤ , Re then for any initial data v0 ∈ H, the unique weak solution (v, p) of (V.74) satisfies v(t) − v∞ L2 ≤ v0 − v∞ L2 e−αt , ∀t ≥ 0, ∇v(t) − ∇v∞ L2 ≤ Cv0 − v∞ L2 e−αt , ∀t ≥ 1. Proof.

404

Chapter V. Navier–Stokes equations for homogeneous fluids

The existence and uniqueness of an unique global weak solution is already known in that case. Therefore, we only have to give a suitable estimate on w. We multiply (V.75) by w and we use (V.3) to obtain the following estimate 1 d 1 w2L2 + ∇w2L2 ≤ C∇v∞ L2 wL2 ∇wL2 . 2 dt Re Then by using the Young inequality, we get 1 d w2L2 + ∇w2L2 ≤ C Re ∇v∞ 2L2 w2L2 . dt Re Finally, using the Poincar´e inequality (Proposition IV.5.12), this estimate leads to   d C1 2 2 wL2 + − C Re ∇v∞ L2 w2L2 ≤ 0. dt Re Provided that CRe2 ∇v∞ 2∞ < C1 , we obtain d w2L2 + 2α w2L2 ≤ 0, dt which finally gives the expected exponential behavior w(t)2L2 ≤ w0 2L2 e−2αt . The estimate on ∇w can be proved by using the same arguments as the one used in the three-dimensional case below. 

3.4.2 The three-dimensional case In that case we need to consider smoother initial data because uniqueness of weak solutions is not known. Nevertheless, global existence of strong solutions is not known in general and we then have to show that the existence time if infinite as soon as the initial data are close enough to v∞ . Notice that, as it is shown below, we do not need to suppose that the  d source term belongs to L2 (Ω) , even though we are interested in strong solutions. This is due to the fact that we look for a solution in the form v = v∞ + w where w is a solution of Problem (V.75) for which there is no source term. Theorem V.3.7. Let Ω be a bounded, simply connected, and Lipschitz domain  3 of R3 . Let f be given in H −1 (Ω) and (v∞ , p∞ ) ∈ (H01 (Ω))3 × L20 (Ω) a steady solution of (V.62). There exist C > 0, α > 0 depending only on Ω such that, under the condition

3. The steady Navier–Stokes equations

∇v∞ L2 ≤

405

C , Re

for any initial data v0 ∈ V satisfying ∇v0 − ∇v∞ L2 ≤

C , Re

there exists a unique global strong solution (v, p) to (V.74) which satisfies ∇v(t) − ∇v∞ L2 ≤ ∇v0 − ∇v∞ L2 e−αt , ∀t ≥ 0. Proof. We show the existence of a unique global strong solution of (V.75) which implies the existence of a unique global strong solution for (V.74). Existence and uniqueness of a local strong solution of (V.75) can be done exactly as in the proof of Theorem V.2.1. We only give the new estimates which prove that this solution is global and converges towards v∞ . By multiplying (V.75) by Aw (where A is the Stokes operator), and using (V.3) we get 1 d 1 ∇w2L2 + Aw2L2 2 dt Re ≤wL∞ ∇wL2 AwL2 + v∞ L6 ∇wL3 AwL2 + wL∞ ∇v∞ L2 AwL2   3/2 3/2 1/2 3/2 ≤C ∇wL2 AwL2 + ∇v∞ L2 ∇wL2 AwL2 . By using the Young inequality, we deduce 1 d ∇w2L2 + Aw2L2 ≤ CRe3 ∇v∞ 4L2 ∇w2L2 + CRe3 ∇w6L2 , dt Re and then, with the Poincar´e inequalities given in Proposition IV.5.12, we get C1 d ∇w2L2 + ∇w2L2 ≤ CRe3 ∇v∞ 4L2 ∇w2L2 + CRe3 ∇w6L2 . dt Re We see that if v∞ satisfies the condition 2CRe4 ∇v∞ 4L2 ≤ C1 , then the previous equation leads to   d C1 (V.76) ∇w2L2 + − CRe3 ∇w4L2 ∇w2L2 ≤ 0. dt 2Re Now, we assume that the initial data v0 are such that w(0) = v0 − v∞ is small enough, in the following sense C1 C1 − CRe3 ∇w(0)4L2 ≥ . 2Re 4Re

(V.77)

406

Chapter V. Navier–Stokes equations for homogeneous fluids

We denote by T ∗ ∈]0, +∞] the maximal existence time for the strong solution w. We define now % & C1 C1 T = sup t ∈ [0, T [, s.t. − CRe3 ∇w(s)4L2 ≥ , ∀s ∈ [0, t] . 2Re 8Re (V.78) By continuity and assumption (V.77), we see that T > 0. We show that we necessarily have T = +∞, which implies in particular that T ∗ = +∞. Let us assume, by contradiction, that T < +∞. This implies that T < T because the solution remains bounded when t → T . By definition of T , and by (V.76), we see that d C1 ∇w2L2 + ∇w2L2 ≤ 0, ∀t ∈ [0, T ], dt 8Re

(V.79)

so that we deduce that ∇w(t)L2 ≤ ∇w(0)L2 , ∀t ∈ [0, T ]. In particular we have C1 C1 − CRe3 ∇w(T )4L2 ≥ , 2Re 4Re and then, by continuity, there is ε > 0 such that T + ε < T and C1 C1 − CRe3 ∇w(t)4L2 ≥ , ∀t ∈ [0, T + ε[. 2Re 8Re This is a contradiction with the maximality property of T (see (V.78)). Finally, we have shown that T = T = +∞, so that the strong solution under consideration is global. Moreover, since T = +∞ we deduce from (V.79) that ∇w(t)2L2 ≤ ∇w(0)2L2 e−C1 t/(8Re) , ∀t ≥ 0, and the claim is proved.

3.4.3 Asymptotic behavior of the pressure Let τ > 0 be given, we can prove the following convergence of the pressure field  1 t+τ p(s, .) ds −−−→ p∞ , in L2 (Ω). t→∞ τ t This amounts to showing that the pressure π in Problem (V.75) satisfies that  t+τ t → t π(s, .) dx converges to 0. To this end, we integrate the equation in time to obtain

3. The steady Navier–Stokes equations

 ∇

t+τ

π(s, .) ds t

407

 =w(t) − w(t + τ )  t+τ  1 + div ∇w − w ⊗ w − v∞ ⊗ w − w ⊗ v∞ ds . Re t

Thus, using the Neˇcas inequality (Theorem IV.1.1) and Proposition IV.1.7, we get   t+τ    t+τ        π(s, .) ds ≤C ∇ π(s, .) ds   t

t

L2

H −1

≤w(t)H −1 + w(t + τ )H −1  t+τ    1  + ∇w − w ⊗ w − v∞ ⊗ w − w ⊗ v∞ ds  Re t

L2

≤w(t)H −1 + w(t + τ )H −1  t+τ +C ∇wL2 + w2L4 + wL4 v∞ L4 ds, t

and the claim follows because we already know that w(t)L2 −−−−→ 0 and that ∇w(t)L2 −−−−→ 0. t→+∞

t→+∞

Chapter VI

Nonhomogeneous fluids

In this chapter we study the nonhomogeneous incompressible Navier–Stokes equations. The difference with the equations studied in the previous chapter is that the density is no longer a constant and has become a new unknown function. For simplicity, in this chapter, we set Γ = ∂Ω and for any vector field v, and any time t, we define the outflow and inflow parts of Γ as Γ+ v (t) = {x ∈ Γ, (v(t, x) · ν(x)) > 0}, Γ− v (t) = {x ∈ Γ, (v(t, x) · ν(x)) < 0}, the trace of v on Γ being understood in a weak sense if necessary. We recall that the equations involved are the mass balance equation, the momentum balance equation and the incompressibility constraint, as well as initial and boundary data ⎧ ∂ρ ⎪ ⎪ + div(ρv) = 0, in Ω, ⎪ ⎪ ∂t ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ∂(ρv) ⎪ ⎨ + div(ρv ⊗ v) − 2 div(μ(ρ)D(v)) + ∇p = ρf, in Ω, ∂t ⎪ div v = 0, in Ω, ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ on Γ, v = vb , ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ in on Γ− ρ=ρ , v (t), together with initial conditions of the type ρ(0) = ρ0 , v(0) = v0 . We will see that the meaning to give to these initial conditions is not as simple as in the case of homogeneous fluids. The interpretation of the boundary condition for the density ρ has also to be detailed since, for weak solutions, the density ρ does not possess integrable derivatives, so that the trace theory for functions in Sobolev spaces described in Chapter III is not sufficient. Moreover, this boundary condition is only imposed on the inflow part of Γ.

F. Boyer and P. Fabrie, Mathematical Tools for the Study of the Incompressible Navier-Stokes Equations and Related Models, Applied Mathematical Sciences 183, DOI 10.1007/978-1-4614-5975-0_6, © Springer Science+Business Media New York 2013

409

410

Chapter VI. Nonhomogeneous fluids

In this model, the viscosity is allowed to depend on the density ρ according to a given law ρ → μ(ρ). As we saw in Chapter I, using the mass balance equation, the momentum balance equation can also be written in the form   ∂v ρ + (v · ∇)v − 2 div(μ(ρ)D(v)) + ∇p = ρf. ∂t The first form of this equation is called the conservative form and the second one is called the nonconservative form. In the same way, by using the incompressibility constraint, we can write the mass balance equation in the nonconservative form Dρ ∂ρ = + (v · ∇)ρ = 0. Dt ∂t

(VI.1)

This last equation is called a transport equation. It describes the transport of the quantity ρ by the velocity field v, as we saw in the transport theorem (Theorem I.2.1). When compared to the homogeneous model studied in Chapter V, several new difficulties appear. First there are new nonlinearities which reflect the fact that the density ρ and the viscosity μ(ρ) are no longer constant. Second, if we allow situations where vacuum regions exist (i.e., regions where the density is zero, or so low as to be negligible), then the problem above degenerates (the momentum equation becoming elliptic in some sense). This is why the initial condition must be applied to the pair mass density/momentum density (ρ, ρv) and not to the pair mass density/velocity (ρ, v). We emphasise the fact that, despite the mathematical interest of this issue, the vanishing density limit is in some sense contradictory with the continuum medium assumption which is the basis of the derivation of the models. It is then quite clear that the subcase in which one assumes that inf Ω ρ0 > 0 and inf ρin > 0, should be in some way simpler and that there will be fewer difficulties to define and to build weak solutions. We return to this special case at the very end of this chapter. We begin this chapter by exploring how to solve the transport equation (VI.1) subject to initial and inflow boundary data, for a given velocity field v. This is, of course, an essential component in the resolution of the full coupled problem. First of all it is worth noticing that, when the velocity field v is tangent to the boundary of the domain, there are no more boundary data to impose on the density because v · ν = 0. In that particular case, if the data are regular the equation can be solved by using the method of characteristics which amounts to solving the characteristic equation associated with v (see (I.4)) and observing that the solution ρ of (I.2.1) has to be constant along this flow. However, when the data are less regular (in particular if the velocity field does not satisfy the hypothesis of the Cauchy–Lipschitz theorem), it is necessary to use a more sophisticated theory known as renormalised solu-

1. Weak solutions of the transport equation

411

tions initially introduced by Di Perna and Lions in [52]. This method let us build a complete theory of existence and uniqueness for weak solutions of the transport equation for less regular data. This approach can be generalised to the case of nontangent velocity fields. It allows us to define a trace for such weak solutions in a suitable sense. This is exactly the framework that we present in Section 1, in the slightly more general context of linear transport-reaction equations which can appear in many other models. Next, in Section 2, we introduce a complete approximate problem for the coupled system considered here. The resolution of this problem is itself not obvious and uses the Schauder fixed-point theorem as well as a stability result for solutions of the transport equation which is proved in Section 1. We then are able to obtain uniform estimates with respect to the approximation parameter. They give us enough weak and strong compactness to justify the passage to the limit in the approximate problem and to conclude that there exists at least one weak solution of the system. We emphasise that we do not prove any uniqueness result for these solutions here, even in 2D. To do this, it would be necessary to construct more regular solutions. For that approach, in the case vb = 0, a local existence result and uniqueness in the class  ρ ∈ C 1 ([0, T ] × Ω), ∂v v ∈ Lq (]0, T [, (W 2,q (Ω))d ∩ V ), ∈ (Lq (]0, T [×Ω))d , ∂t where q > 3, can be found in [77] under the assumption that the viscosity, μ, does not depend on ρ. Results concerning this problem can also be found in [12, 50, 51, 86, 83, 42, 45]. Finally, since the two-dimensional case is (as usual) simpler than the threedimensional case, below we concentrate exclusively on the dimension d = 3. The results presented in this chapter come principally from the references [52, 22] concerning the transport equation and [110, 86] concerning weak solutions of the Navier–Stokes problem with possibly vanishing density. We again use the various functional spaces H and V defined in Section 3.3 of Chapter IV.

1 Weak solutions of the transport equation Let us begin with a classical notation that we use in this section. Definition VI.1.1. The positive and negative parts of any real number x, are defined by x+ = max(x, 0), x− = − min(x, 0),

Chapter VI. Nonhomogeneous fluids

412

in such a way that we have x = x+ − x− and |x| = x+ + x− .

1.1 Setting of the problem Let d ≥ 1, Ω ⊂ Rd be a bounded Lipschitz domain and T > 0 given. We are interested in the following equation (written in conservative formulation) ∂ρ + div(ρv) + cρ = 0, in Ω, ∂t assorted with the following initial and boundary conditions  ρ(0, ·) = ρ0 , on Γ− v (t),

ρ = ρin ,

(VI.2)

(VI.3)

where ρ0 ∈ L∞ (Ω) and ρin ∈ L∞ (]0, T [×Γ) are given data. We need the following assumptions c ∈ L1 (]0, T [×Ω),

(VI.4)

v ∈ L1 (]0, T [, (W 1,1 (Ω))d ),

(VI.5)

 (c + div v)− ∈ L1 (]0, T [, L∞ (Ω)),

(VI.6a)



(div v) ∈ L (]0, T [, L (Ω)). +

1

(VI.6b)

Remark VI.1.1. We considered here, and in the whole section, a slightly more general equation than the one we strictly need for the study of the incompressible nonhomogeneous Navier–Stokes equations, that is to say, the advection equation (I.2.1). This allows us to account for a broader range of situations, in particular for non divergence-free vector fields, such as in compressible models or in Vlasov models in kinetic theory. • In the particular case where c = − div v, we recover the usual advection equation ∂ρ + v · ∇ρ = 0, ∂t and in this case Assumption (VI.6a) is automatically satisfied. • In the particular case where c = 0, the equation under study is nothing but the mass conservation equation ∂ρ + div(ρv) = 0, ∂t

1. Weak solutions of the transport equation

413

and Assumptions (VI.6) are then equivalent to requiring that div v ∈ L1 (]0, T [, L∞ (Ω)). Associated with the vector field v, we introduce the measure dμv = (v · ν) dt dσ, on ]0, T [×Γ, − and we denote by dμ+ v (resp., dμv ) its positive (resp., negative) part in such + − − a way that |dμv | = dμv +dμv . The support of dμ+ v (resp., dμv ) is the outflow (resp. inflow) part of ]0, T [×Γ.

Definition VI.1.2. Let v ∈ (L1 (]0, T [×Ω))d and c ∈ L1 (]0, T [×Ω). A function ρ ∈ L∞ (]0, T [×Ω) is said to be a weak solution of (VI.2) if it satisfies 

T



 ρ

0

Ω

 ∂ϕ + v · ∇ϕ − cϕ dx dt = 0, ∂t

for any test function ϕ ∈ C 0,1 ([0, T ] × Ω) such that ϕ(0, .) = ϕ(T, .) = 0 and ϕ = 0 on [0, T ] × Γ. In the next subsections, we prove the main properties of those weak solutions. First of all we show that any weak solution has a trace on the boundary in some weak sense, and that it satisfies the so-called renormalisation property. Then we show that the Cauchy–Dirichlet transport problem is wellposed and finally that its solution depends continuously on the data, in particular the velocity field. The introduction of the concept of renormalised solutions for the transport equation comes from [52] (see also [5] for the case of BV vector fields). The presentation proposed here and which includes the trace theory is mainly taken from [22] with some improvements, in particular concerning the regularity assumptions on the domain. An application of these results to the convergence analysis of finite volume schemes for the transport problem is presented in [23].

1.2 Trace theorem. Renormalisation property The study of weak solutions of the transport problem begins with proving that such solutions have traces on the boundary in a suitable sense. This is the objective of the following theorem. Theorem VI.1.3. Assume that v and c satisfy assumptions (VI.4) through (VI.6) and let ρ ∈ L∞ (]0, T [×Ω) be any weak solution of (VI.2). Then the following properties hold. 1. Time continuity: The function ρ lies in C 0 ([0, T ], Lp (Ω)) for any 1 ≤ p < +∞.

Chapter VI. Nonhomogeneous fluids

414

2. Existence and uniqueness of a trace: There exists a unique function γρ ∈ L∞ (]0, T [×Γ, |dμv |) such that, for any test function ϕ ∈ C 0,1 ([0, T ] × Ω) and for any [t0 , t1 ] ⊂ [0, T ], we have   t1    t1  ∂ϕ ρ (γρ)ϕ(v · ν) dσ dt + v · ∇ϕ − cϕ dx dt − ∂t t0 Ω t0 Γ (VI.7)   ρ(t0 )ϕ(t0 ) dx − ρ(t1 )ϕ(t1 ) dx = 0. + Ω

Ω

3. Renormalisation property: For any function β : R → R of class C 1 , for any ϕ ∈ C 0,1 ([0, T ] × Ω) and any [t0 , t1 ] ⊂ [0, T ], we have    t1   t1  ∂ϕ β(ρ) cρβ  (ρ)ϕ dx dt + v · ∇ϕ dx dt − ∂t t0 Ω t0 Ω  t1   t1  − (div v)(ρβ  (ρ) − β(ρ))ϕ dx dt − β(γρ)ϕ(v · ν) dσ dt t0 Ω t0 Γ   β(ρ(t0 ))ϕ(t0 ) dx − β(ρ(t1 ))ϕ(t1 ) dx = 0. + Ω

Ω

(VI.8) It is important to understand that the renormalisation property simply consists in justifying that the chain rule   ∂ρ ∂β(ρ)  + v · ∇β(ρ) = β (ρ) + v · ∇ρ , ∂t ∂t still holds for weak solutions and low regularity vector fields v. Remark VI.1.2. We show below, in Corollary VI.1.5, that the renormalisation property actually holds for any β which is simply continuous and piecewise C1. Remark VI.1.3. The same result holds if one adds a given source term f ∈ L1 (]0, T [×Ω) in the right-hand side of the transport equation (VI.2). More  t1  precisely the term f ϕ dx dt has to be added to the left-hand side of t0  t1 Ω (VI.7) and the term f β  (ρ)ϕ dx dt in the left-hand side of (VI.8). t0

Ω

However, we emphasise the fact that we need to know a priori that ρ is a bounded weak solution in order to prove the result. Extension of these results to the case of weak solutions in L∞ (]0, T [, Lp (Ω)) , p < +∞ can be found for instance in [52, 22]. Before proving Theorem VI.1.3, we give a preliminary technical result on the approximation of the absolute value by smooth functions. Its proof is straightforward.

1. Weak solutions of the transport equation

415

Lemma VI.1.4. For any δ > 0 the function βδ : R → R defined by ξ2 βδ (ξ) = ( , ξ2 + δ is of class C ∞ and satisfies |βδ (ξ)| ≤ |ξ|, |βδ (ξ)| ≤ 2, √ |ξβδ (ξ) − βδ (ξ)| ≤ δ, βδ (ξ) −−−→ |ξ|, δ→0

∀ξ ∈ R, ∀ξ ∈ R, ∀ξ ∈ R, ∀δ > 0, ∀ξ ∈ R.

Proof (of Theorem VI.1.3). The proof of this result strongly relies on the use of the mollifying operators introduced in Section 2.2 of Chapter III and of the corresponding Friedrichs commutation estimates. • We consider the family of operators (Sε )ε defined in (III.18) and we set, for any t ∈ [0, T ], ρε (t, .) = Sε ρ(t, .). We observe that, since Sε is only acting on the space variables, the time variable is just a parameter in this mollifying procedure. In particular the differential operators ∂/∂t and Sε commute. Thanks to the regularity assumptions (VI.4) and (VI.5), we can then apply Proposition III.2.8 and Theorem III.2.10 to conclude that ρε solves the following equation in the distribution sense ∂ρε + div(ρε v) + cρε = Rε , (VI.9) ∂t where Rε ∈ L1 (]0, T [×Ω) satisfies Rε L1 → 0 as ε → 0. From Proposition III.2.8, we know that ρε ∈ L∞ (]0, T [, C k (Ω)), ∀k ≥ 0, ρε L∞ (]0,T [×Ω) ≤ ρL∞ (]0,T [×Ω) ,

(VI.10)

and that ρε (t) −−−→ ρ(t), in Lp (Ω) for any p < +∞ and any t ∈ [0, T ], ε→0

ρε −−−→ ρ, ε→0

in Lp (]0, T [×Ω) for any p < +∞.

Note that these convergences and the L∞ bound on ρε imply that |ρε − ρ|2 −−− 0, in L∞ (]0, T [×Ω) weak-. ε→0

(VI.11)

Since ρε is smooth with respect to the space variable, we deduce from (VI.9) that for any ε > 0 we have

Chapter VI. Nonhomogeneous fluids

416

∂ρε = Rε −div(ρε v)−cρε = Rε −ρε (div v)−v·(∇ρε )−cρε ∈ L1 (]0, T [×Ω). ∂t In particular we have ρε ∈ W 1,1 (]0, T [×Ω). It follows from this property, and using for instance Proposition II.5.11, that ρε ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], L1 (Ω)). From (VI.10), we finally obtain that ρε ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], Lp (Ω)) for any p < +∞. • Let us show now that (ρε )ε is a Cauchy sequence in C 0 ([0, T ], L1 (Ω)). For any ε1 , ε2 > 0, we have   ∂ (ρε1 − ρε2 ) + div (ρε1 − ρε2 )v + c(ρε1 − ρε2 ) = (Rε1 − Rε2 ). (VI.12) ∂t Let β : R → R be a smooth function such that β  is bounded. We multiply (VI.12) by β  (ρε1 − ρε2 ) (this is allowed because ρε ∈ W 1,1 (]0, T [×Ω)). We get the following equation in the distribution sense     ∂ β(ρε1 − ρε2 ) + div β(ρε1 − ρε2 )v + c(ρε1 − ρε2 )β  (ρε1 − ρε2 ) ∂t   + (div v) (ρε1 − ρε2 )β  (ρε1 − ρε2 ) − β(ρε1 − ρε2 ) (VI.13) =β  (ρε1 − ρε2 )(Rε1 − Rε2 ). Let ϕ ∈ C 0,1 (Ω) be a time-independent Lipschitz continuous function which satisfies ϕ = 0 on Γ and 0 ≤ ϕ ≤ 1 in Ω. We use this test function in (VI.13) to obtain   d ϕβ(ρε1 − ρε2 ) dx − β(ρε1 − ρε2 )v · ∇ϕ dx dt Ω Ω  + c(ρε1 − ρε2 )β  (ρε1 − ρε2 )ϕ dx Ω    + (div v) (ρε1 − ρε2 )β  (ρε1 − ρε2 ) − β(ρε1 − ρε2 ) ϕ dx  Ω = β  (ρε1 − ρε2 )(Rε1 − Rε2 )ϕ dx, Ω

so that for any s ∈ [0, T ], we have   s ϕβ(ρε1 − ρε2 )(s) dx + c(ρε1 − ρε2 )β  (ρε1 − ρε2 )ϕ dx dt Ω 0 Ω  s   + (div v) (ρε1 − ρε2 )β  (ρε1 − ρε2 ) − β(ρε1 − ρε2 ) ϕ dx dt  0 Ω  s ≤ |ρε1 (0, ·) − ρε2 (0, ·)| dx + C |Rε1 − Rε2 | dx dt 0 Ω Ω  s |ρε1 − ρε2 ||v · ∇ϕ| dx dt. +C 0

Ω

1. Weak solutions of the transport equation

417

We use Lemma VI.1.4, take β = βδ (which is smooth enough) in this inequality, and then pass to the limit when δ → 0. By using the dominated convergence theorem and the convergence properties of βδ given in the lemma, we get   s ϕ|ρε1 − ρε2 |(s) dx + c|ρε1 − ρε2 |ϕ dx dt Ω

0

Ω

≤ρε1 (0) − ρε2 (0)L1 (Ω) + CRε1 − Rε2 L1 (]0,T [×Ω)  s +C |ρε1 − ρε2 ||v · ∇ϕ| dx dt. 0

Ω

We remark now that c = c + div v − div v ≥ −(c + div v)− − (div v)+ , so that 0 ≤ c− ≤ (c + div v)− + (div v)+ ∈ L1 (]0, T [, L∞ (Ω)), thanks to (VI.6). Therefore, we can write, for any s ∈ [0, T ],  ϕ|ρε1 − ρε2 |(s) dx ≤ρε1 (0) − ρε2 (0)L1 (Ω) + CRε1 − Rε2 L1 (]0,T [×Ω) Ω  s + c− (t)L∞ (Ω) ρε1 (t) − ρε2 (t)L1 (Ω) dt 0



T

 |ρε1 − ρε2 ||v · ∇ϕ| dt dx.

+C 0

(VI.14)

Ω

The idea is now to take a function ϕ = ϕh in such a way that ϕh → 1 in Ω when h → 0, so that the limit of the left-hand side in (VI.14) will exactly be the L1 norm of ρε1 − ρε2 . The only problem that we have to deal with is the last term in the right-hand side. Let us define ϕh , for h > 0 as follows ϕh (x) =

1 min (h, δ(x)) , ∀x ∈ Ω, h

where we recall that δ(x) is the distance from x to the boundary of Ω. By construction, ϕh is Lipschitz continuous on Rd , satisfies 0 ≤ ϕh ≤ 1 and since Lip(δ) ≤ 1, we have ⎧ ⎨0 in Ωh , |∇ϕh | = 1 ⎩ in Oh , h where we used here the notation introduced at the beginning of Section 1 of Chapter III. For any h, ε1 , ε2 , we have   (1 − ϕh )|ρε1 − ρε2 |(s, .) dx ≤ 2ρL∞ (1 − ϕh ) dx ≤ 2ρL∞ |Oh |, Ω

Ω

Chapter VI. Nonhomogeneous fluids

418

so that, for any s ∈ [0, T ], (VI.14) leads to ρε1 (s) − ρε2 (s)L1 (Ω) ≤2ρL∞ |Oh | + ρε1 (0) − ρε2 (0)L1 (Ω)  s + c− (t)L∞ (Ω) ρε1 (t) − ρε2 (t)L1 (Ω) dt 0

+ CRε1 − Rε2 L1 (]0,T [×Ω)   C T + |ρε − ρε2 ||v| dx dt . h 0 Oh 1   

(VI.15)

=Ih,ε1 ,ε2 (v)

Let us study the term Ih,ε1 ,ε2 (v). To this end we consider a smooth vector field w ∈ C ∞ ([0, T ] × Ω)d and we write Ih,ε1 ,ε2 (v) ≤Ih,ε1 ,ε2 (v − w) + Ih,ε1 ,ε2 (w) ≤

2CρL∞ v − wL1 (]0,T [×Ω) h C + wL∞ (]0,T [×Ω) ρε1 − ρε2 L1 (]0,T [×Ω) . h

Since (VI.15) holds for any s ∈ [0, T ], and c− ∈ L1 (]0, T [, L∞ (Ω)) we use the Gronwall lemma to get  sup ρε1 − ρε2 L1 (Ω) ≤C |Oh | + ρε1 (0) − ρε2 (0)L1 (Ω) [0,T ]

+ Rε1 − Rε2 L1 (]0,T [×Ω) + +

1 v − wL1 (]0,T [×Ω) h 

1 wL∞ (]0,T [×Ω) ρε1 − ρε2 L1 (]0,T [×Ω) . h

Notice that the left-hand side of the above estimate only depends on ε1 and ε2 whereas the right-hand side also depends on h and w. Let us now choose some ζ > 0. We first take h > 0 such that C|Oh | ≤ ζ. Using the density of C ∞ ([0, T ] × Ω)d in L1 (]0, T [×Ω)d , we then choose w ∈ C ∞ ([0, T ] × Ω)d such that C v − wL1 (]0,T [×Ω) ≤ ζ. h We use now the fact that ρε (0) → ρ0 in L1 (Ω), ρε → ρ in L1 (]0, T [×Ω) and Rε → 0 in L1 (]0, T [×Ω). Since w and h are fixed, we can find some ε0 > 0 such that, for any 0 < ε1 , ε2 < ε0 , we have

1. Weak solutions of the transport equation

419

Cρε1 (0) − ρε2 (0)L1 (Ω) ≤ ζ, CRε1 − Rε2 L1 (]0,T [×Ω) ≤ ζ, C wL∞ (]0,T [×Ω) ρε1 − ρε2 L1 (]0,T [×Ω) ≤ ζ. h Gathering all these estimates we finally get sup ρε1 − ρε2 L1 (Ω) ≤ 5ζ, ∀0 < ε1 , ε2 < ε0 .

[0,T ]

This proves that (ρε )ε is a Cauchy sequence in C 0 ([0, T ], L1 (Ω)). We already know that (ρε )ε converges to ρ in L1 (]0, T [×Ω), thus it follows that ρ ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], L1 (Ω)), ρε −−−→ ρ, in C 0 ([0, T ], L1 (Ω)). ε→0

By (VI.10), we immediately deduce that the convergence also holds in C 0 ([0, T ], Lp (Ω)) for any p < +∞. • Let us now prove the existence of the trace γρ. Writing equation (VI.13) with β(s) = s2 gives  2 ∂ (ρε1 − ρε2 )2 + v · ∇(ρε1 − ρε2 )2 + 2(c + div v) ρε1 − ρε2 ∂t    =2 Rε1 − Rε2 ρε1 − ρε2 .

(VI.16)

We choose a test function ψ ∈ C 0,1 ([0, T ] × Ω) such that ψ(0, .) = ψ(T, .) = 0 in (VI.16). We integrate by parts and look precisely at the following boundary term 

T



|ρε1 − ρε2 |2 ψ(v · ν) dσ dt Γ 0    T ∂ψ 2 = |ρε1 − ρε2 | + v · ∇ψ − (div v)ψ − 2cψ dx dt ∂t Ω 0  T (Rε1 − Rε2 )(ρε1 − ρε2 )ψ dx dt. +2 0

(VI.17)

Ω

Notice that ρε has a trace on Γ in the usual sense because it is smooth with respect to the space variable. We would like to choose ψ such that ψ = sgn(v ·ν) on the boundary but this is not possible because of the regularity requirements on ψ. Nevertheless, using for instance Theorem III.2.21 we can find a sequence ψn ∈ C 0,1 ([0, T ] × Ω) satisfying ψn L∞ (]0,T [×Ω) ≤ 1, ψn (0, .) = ψn (T, .) = 0 and such that ψn −−−−→ sgn(v · ν), a.e. in ]0, T [×Γ. n→∞

(VI.18)

Chapter VI. Nonhomogeneous fluids

420

Taking the test function ψ = ψn in (VI.17), it follows that 

T





T



|ρε1 − ρε2 |2 |v · ν| dσ dt ≤4ρ2L∞ 0

Γ



T

|v · ν| |ψn − sgn(v · ν)| dσ dt



0

Γ

|ρε1 − ρε2 |2 Fn dx dt

+ 0

Ω

+ CRε1 − Rε2 L1 (]0,T [×Ω) ,

(VI.19)

where Fn = (∂ψn /∂t + v · ∇ψn − (div v)ψn − 2cψn ) ∈ L1 (]0, T [×Ω). Let ζ > 0 be fixed. The first term in the right-hand side of (VI.19) tends to 0 as n → ∞ by using the Lebesgue dominated convergence theorem and (VI.18). Therefore, this term can be made smaller than ζ for some n. Such an integer n being fixed, by using (VI.11), we can choose ε0 > 0 such that the second and third terms are less than ζ for any ε1 , ε2 such that ε1 < ε0 , ε2 < ε0 . All these computations show that the restriction to ]0, T [×Γ of (ρε )ε is a Cauchy sequence in the space L2 (]0, T [×Γ, |dμv |). We define γρ ∈ L2 (]0, T [×Γ, |dμv |) to be the corresponding limit. Notice that γρ is welldefined |dμv |-almost everywhere. For any β ∈ C 1 (R), we can compute from (VI.9) that ∂β(ρε ) + v · ∇β(ρε ) + (c + div v)ρε β  (ρε ) = β  (ρε )Rε . ∂t Testing against a function ϕ ∈ C 1 ([t0 , t1 ] × Ω) we get    t1   t1  ∂ϕ β(ρε ) + v · ∇ϕ dx dt − cρβ  (ρε )ϕ dx dt ∂t t0 Ω t0 Ω  t1   t1  − (div v)(ρε β  (ρε ) − β(ρε ))ϕ dx dt − β(ρε )ϕ(v · ν) dσ dt t0 Ω t0 Γ   + β(ρε (t0 ))ϕ(t0 ) dx − β(ρε (t1 ))ϕ(t1 ) dx 

Ω T

Ω



=

Rε ϕ dx dt. 0

Ω

Thanks to all the convergences proved above, we can pass to the limit as ε → 0, in particular in the boundary term, and obtain (VI.8). Finally, (VI.7) follows by simply taking β(s) = s. • It remains to show the uniqueness property. Assume that γ1 ρ, γ2 ρ belong to L∞ (]0, T [×Γ, |dμv |) and both satisfy (VI.7); then we have 

T

 (γ1 ρ − γ2 ρ)ϕ(v · ν) dσ dt = 0,

0

Γ

1. Weak solutions of the transport equation

421

for any test function ϕ ∈ C 0,1 ([0, T ]×Ω). By density, there exists a sequence of Lipschitz continuous functions ϕn such that sup ϕn L∞ < +∞, n

ϕn −−−−→ (γ1 ρ − γ2 ρ) sgn(v · ν), almost everywhere in ]0, T [×Γ. n→∞

It follows, by the dominated convergence theorem, that 

T

 |γ1 ρ − γ2 ρ|2 |v · ν| dσ dt = 0,

0

Γ

so that γ1 ρ = γ2 ρ for |dμv |-almost every (t, σ) ∈]0, T [×Γ.  Corollary VI.1.5. Assume that (VI.4), (VI.5), and (VI.6) hold and let ρ be a bounded weak solution to (VI.2). 1. For any α = 0, we have the following property c + div v = 0, for almost every (t, x) in the level set {ρ = α}. 2. For any function β : R → R which is continuous and piecewise C 1 , we have the renormalisation property (VI.8), for any choice of the values of β  at singular points. Proof. Notice that the first property of the lemma cannot hold for α = 0 (for instance the solution ρ ≡ 0 is an obvious counterexample). 1. For any 0 < ε ≤ 1, we define √ ε(s − α) βε (s) = ( , (s − α)2 + ε which is a smooth function satisfying βε L∞ ≤ 1 and βε L∞ ≤ 1. We observe that βε (s) −−−→ 0, ∀s ∈ R, ε→0  α, for s = α,  sβε (s) −−−→ ε→0 0, for s = α. We then apply (VI.8) and find that, for any ϕ ∈ Cc∞ (]0, T [×Ω) we have 





T

βε (ρ) 0



Ω T 



∂ϕ + v · ∇ϕ ∂t

βε (ρ)(div v) −

+ 0

Ω

 dx dt

ρβε (ρ)(c

 + div v) ϕ dx dt = 0.

Chapter VI. Nonhomogeneous fluids

422

We now pass to the limit when ε → 0 by the Lebesgue convergence theorem to obtain   T

α

(c + div v)ϕ1{ρ=α} dx dt = 0. 0

Ω

Since α = 0, and c + div v ∈ L1 (]0, T [×Ω) and by weak- density of Cc∞ (]0, T [×Ω) into L∞ (]0, T [×Ω), we deduce that 

T

 (c + div v)ϕ1{ρ=α} dx dt = 0,

0

Ω

for any ϕ ∈ L∞ (]0, T [×Ω). The claim is proved. 2. Let β : R → R be a continuous piecewise C 1 function. Notice that (VI.8) has a sense even though β  is not well-defined at some points because for such points α ∈ R (even for α = 0) we have, by the first point proved in this corollary,  0

T



(c + div v)ρ1{ρ=α} ϕ dx dt = 0, ∀ϕ ∈ L∞ (]0, T [×Ω).

Ω

Such a piecewise smooth function β can be written as the sum of a globally C 1 function and a finite linear combination of functions of the form s → |s − αi |. By linearity of the problem and by translation, it is then enough to prove the claim for β(s) = |s|. To this end, we use the smooth approximation βδ introduced in Lemma VI.1.4 and we pass to the limit when δ → 0.  Remark VI.1.4. During the proof of Theorem VI.1.3, we built a sequence of approximations (ρε )ε of the weak solution ρ, which are smooth with respect to the space variable and which satisfy the same equation as ρ up to a remainder term which strongly converges to 0 in L1 (]0, T [×Ω). We want here to observe that it is possible to obtain a similar result with approximate functions which are smooth with respect to both time and space variables. This can be of importance in some applications; see for instance [23]. To do this we consider, for any ξ > 0, a mollifying operator S ξ associated with the 1D domain ]0, T [, as defined in Section 2.2 of Chapter III (we added a line over the symbol S ξ to emphasise the fact that, contrary to Sε , it opers on functions depending on t). We set ρε,ξ = S ξ ρε = S ξ (Sε ρ). By construction, ρε,ξ is smooth with respect to both the time and space variables. Moreover, it satisfies ∂ρε,ξ + div(ρε,ξ v) + cρε,ξ = Rε,ξ , ∂t with

1. Weak solutions of the transport equation



423



∂ρε ∂S ξ ρε Rε,ξ =S ξ Rε + − Sξ ∂t ∂t     + div (S ξ ρε )v − S ξ (ρε v) + (S ξ ρε )c − S ξ (ρε c) . Using in particular that, for any given ε > 0, ∂ρε /∂t belongs to L1 and that ρε is smooth with respect to x, we get that Rε,ξ ∈ L1 (]0, T [×Ω) and that Rε,ξ −−−→ Rε , in L1 (]0, T [×Ω), for any ε > 0. ξ→0

Note that we do not need any time regularity of v at that point inasmuch as the operator S ξ only acts on the time variable. We also immediately get that ρε,ξ converges to ρε when ξ → 0 in C 0 ([0, T ], Lp (Ω)) for any finite p. Since Rε tends to 0 as ε → 0, one can choose ξ as a function of ε so that limε→0 ξ(ε) = 0 and Rε,ξ(ε) −−−→ 0, ε→0

in L1 (]0, T [×Ω),

ρε,ξ(ε) −−−→ ρ, in C 0 ([0, T ], Lp (Ω)) for any p < +∞., ε→0

with ρε,ξ(ε) ∈ C ∞ ([0, T ] × Ω). Convergence of the traces are obtained in the same way. We emphasise the fact that the same result cannot be obtained by directly using a mollifying operator associated with the d + 1-dimensional Lipschitz domain ]0, T [×Ω, because it would require more time regularity for the velocity field v in order to apply the Friedrichs commutator estimate. Here, we used the particular structure of the d + 1-dimensional vector field (1, v(t, x)) which let us apply successively a mollifier with respect to x and then a mollifier with respect to t. This kind of argument was used for instance, in [78] to extend the renormalised solution theory to partially W 1,1 velocity fields.

1.3 The initial- and boundary-value problem Using the trace theorem that we proved above, we can now study the existence and uniqueness of the Cauchy–Dirichlet problem for transport problems. Theorem VI.1.6. Assume that v and c satisfy assumptions (VI.4) through (VI.6). For any initial data ρ0 ∈ L∞ (Ω), and any inflow boundary data ρin ∈ ∞ L∞ (]0, T [×Γ, dμ− v ), there exists a unique ρ ∈ L (]0, T [×Ω) such that • ρ is a weak solution to the transport equation (VI.2). • The initial condition ρ(0) = ρ0 is satisfied. • The trace γρ of the solution ρ satisfies the inflow boundary condition

Chapter VI. Nonhomogeneous fluids

424

γρ = ρin , dμ− v -almost everywhere in ]0, T [×Γ. Moreover this solution satisfies ρ(t, .)L∞ (Ω)

 t  ≤ M exp α(s) ds , ∀t ∈ [0, T ],

(VI.20a)

0

γρL∞ (]0,T [×Γ,|dμv |)

 ≤ M exp

T

α(s) ds ,

(VI.20b)

0

  M = max ρ0 L∞ , ρin L∞ (]0,T [×Γ,dμ− , ) v

where and

α(s) = (c + div v)− (s, .)L∞ (Ω) , for any s ∈ [0, T ].

(VI.21)

Proof. • Let us first show the uniqueness property. Assume that ρ1 , ρ2 are two weak solutions of the problem with the same initial and inflow boundary data. We set ρ = ρ1 − ρ2 , so that ρ is also a weak solution to the problem which satisfies ρ(0) = 0 and γρ = 0, dμ− v -almost everywhere in ]0, T [×Γ. We apply the renormalisation property (VI.8) to ρ and for β(ξ) = |ξ|, ϕ = 1, t0 = 0 and t1 = s (see Corollary VI.1.5). It follows that, for any s ∈ [0, T ],  s   s c|ρ| dx dt + |ρ(s, .)| dx + |γρ|(v · ν)+ dσ dt = 0. (VI.22) 0

Ω

Ω

0

Γ

Since c− ∈ L1 (]0, T [, L∞ (Ω)) we first deduce that  s ρ(s)L1 (Ω) ≤ c− (t)L∞ (Ω) ρ(t)L1 (Ω) dt, ∀s ∈ [0, T ], 0

and thus, by using the Gronwall lemma, we get ρ = 0 in ]0, T [×Ω. Coming back to (VI.22), we deduce that γρ = 0, dμ+ v -almost everywhere. This concludes the proof of the uniqueness property. • For any ε > 0 we consider the following parabolic problem ⎧ ∂ ρ˜ε ⎪ ⎪ ρε − εΔ˜ ρε = 0, in Ω + div(˜ ρε v) + c˜ ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ ∂t ∂ ρ˜ε on Γ, ε + (˜ ρε − ρin )(v · ν)− = 0, ⎪ ⎪ ∂ν ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ ρ˜ε (0) = ρ0 , whose weak formulation is

1. Weak solutions of the transport equation



T







ρ˜ε Ω

0



T



  T ∂ϕ ∇˜ ρε · ∇ϕ dx dt + v · ∇ϕ − cϕ dx dt + ε ∂t Ω 0

425

(˜ ρε (v · ν)+ ϕ − ρin (v · ν)− ϕ) dσ dt   ρ˜ε (T )ϕ(T ) dx − ρ0 ϕ(0) dx = 0, +

+

Γ

0

Ω

Ω

(VI.23) for any ϕ ∈ C 0,1 ([0, T ] × Ω). By using a standard Galerkin approximation for this problem, we can easily show that for any ρ0 ∈ L∞ (Ω) and ρin ∈ L∞ (]0, T [×Γ, dμ− v ) there exists a unique solution ρ˜ε ∈ L∞ (]0, T [, L2 (Ω))∩L2 (]0, T [, H 1 (Ω)) to (VI.23). There is no particular difficulty because the problem is linear and satisfies the following energy estimates (which hold uniformly with respect to the Galerkin approximations) √ ˜ ρε L∞ (]0,T [,L2 (Ω)) +  ε∇˜ ρε L2 (]0,T [,L2 (Ω)) ≤ C, (VI.24)  T |γ0 ρ˜ε |2 (v · ν)+ dσ dt ≤ C, (VI.25) 0

Γ

where C does not depend on ε. We have used here the fact that, since it is smooth enough in the space variable, the function ρ˜ε has a trace γ0 ρ˜ε ∈ L2 (]0, T [, H 1/2 (Γ)) ⊂ L2 (]0, T [×Γ), in the usual trace sense (see Section 2.5 in Chapter III). To obtain these energy estimates, we first choose ϕ = ρ˜ε in (VI.23). It follows   T  T |˜ ρε (T )|2 dx + (2c + div v)˜ ρ2ε dx dt + 2ε |∇˜ ρε |2 dx dt Ω



T

0

Γ



T



ρ20 dx +

= Ω

Ω



T



ρ˜2ε (v · ν)+ dσ dt +

+ 

0



0

0

0

Ω

(˜ ρε − ρin )2 (v · ν)− dσ dt

Γ

(ρin )2 (v · ν)− dσ dt.

(VI.26)

Γ

Then we observe that, by (VI.6), we have 0 ≤ (2c + div v)− ≤ (2c + 2 div v)− − (div v)+ ∈ L1 (]0, T [, L∞ (Ω)). Therefore, we can use the Gronwall lemma from (VI.26) and obtain the bounds (VI.24) and (VI.25). Let us now state the following L∞ bounds on the approximation solution ρ˜ε , whose proof is admitted for the moment. Lemma VI.1.7. For any ε > 0, we have the estimate

Chapter VI. Nonhomogeneous fluids

426

 ˜ ρε (t)L∞ (Ω) ≤ M exp

t

 α(s) ds , ∀t ∈ [0, T ],

0

where α is defined in (VI.21). In particular the sequence (˜ ρε )ε (resp., (γ0 ρ˜ε )ε ) is bounded in L∞ (]0, T [×Ω) (resp., in L∞ (]0, T [×Γ, dμ+ v )). Thanks to this lemma and to Proposition II.2.28, we can find a sequence (εk ) k, a function ρ ∈ L ∞ (]0, T [×Ω) and a function ρ out ∈ L∞ (]0, T [×Γ, dµ+ v) such that ρ˜εk −−−− ρ, k→∞

weakly- in L∞ (]0, T [×Ω),

ρ˜εk −−−− ρout , weakly- in L∞ (]0, T [×Γ, dμ+ v ). k→∞

Thanks to these convergences and to the estimate (VI.24), it is now straightforward to perform the limit in the linear equation (VI.23). This proves that ρ satisfies the weak formulation of Problem (VI.2) with (VI.3). Estimates (VI.20) are immediately deduced from Lemma VI.1.7.  It remains to prove the L∞ bounds we used. Proof (of Lemma VI.1.7).   t By changing ρ˜ε into ρ˜ε exp − 0 α(s)ds , we see that it is enough to consider the case where c + div v ≥ 0, and to show the monotonicity property # $ in ρ0 ≥ 0 and ρ ≥ 0 ⇒ ρ˜ε ≥ 0. To this end, we define a function β : R → R of class C 2 by  |ξ|3 for ξ ≤ 0 β(ξ) = 0 for ξ > 0. ρε ) in the weak formulation (VI.23). Then we take the test-function ϕ = β  (˜ It follows after some computations that for any s ∈ [0, T ] we have   s β(˜ ρε (s)) dx + (3c + 2 div v)β(˜ ρε ) dx dt Ω 0 Ω  s  s +ε β  (˜ ρε )|∇˜ ρε |2 dx dt + β(˜ ρε )(v · ν)+ dσ dt 0 Ω 0 Γ    s   in = β(ρ0 ) dx + β(˜ ρε ) + β (˜ ρε )(ρ − ρ˜ε ) (v · ν)− dσ dt. Ω

0

Γ

Since β is convex and ρin ≥ 0, we have ρε )(ρin − ρ˜ε ) ≤ β(ρin ) = 0, β(˜ ρε ) + β  (˜

1. Weak solutions of the transport equation

427

and moreover β(ρ0 ) = 0 because ρ0 ≥ 0. Using once more the convexity of β, it follows that   s β(˜ ρε (s)) dx + (3c + 2 div v)β(˜ ρε ) dx dt ≤ 0, ∀s ∈ [0, T ]. Ω

0

Ω

We assumed at the beginning that c + div v ≥ 0, and β is nonnegative, therefore we finally obtain   s β(˜ ρε (s)) dx ≤ (div v)+ β(˜ ρε ) dx dt 0 Ω Ω    s + ≤ (div v) (t)L∞ (Ω) β(˜ ρε (t)) dx dt. 0

Ω

By using (VI.6b) and the Gronwall lemma once more , we deduce that  β(˜ ρε (s)) dx ≤ 0, ∀s ∈ [0, T ], Ω

which gives, by definition of β, that ρ˜ε ≥ 0 on ]0, T [×Ω.

 Using the renormalisation property and the same function β as in the proof above, it is very easy to show with the same assumption as in Theorem VI.1.6, that the unique weak solution ρ to the transport problem associated with nonnegative initial and inflow boundary data is itself nonnegative. A stronger version of this result can be proved with an additional assumption on c and v. Proposition VI.1.8. We consider the same assumptions as in Theorem VI.1.6 and moreover we suppose that (c + div v)+ ∈ L1 (]0, T [, L∞ (Ω)). If there exists ρmin > 0 such that ρ0 ≥ ρmin and ρin ≥ ρmin dμ− v -almost everywhere, then the weak solution ρ of the transport problem satisfies the following bound from below

 T

−(c + div v)+ (t)L∞ dt .

ρ ≥ ρmin exp 0

The proof is very similar to the previous one; we leave the details to the reader.

1.4 Stability theorem In this section, we study the stability of weak solutions of the Cauchy– Dirichlet transport problem with respect to all the data.

Chapter VI. Nonhomogeneous fluids

428

∞ Theorem VI.1.9. For any k ≥ 1, let ρ0,k ∈ L∞ (Ω), ρin k ∈ L (]0, T [×Γ), ck satisfying (VI.4) and vk satisfying (VI.5) and (VI.6). We define ρk ∈ L∞ (]0, T [×Ω) to be the unique weak solution, given by Theorem VI.1.6, of the following initial- and boundary-value problem ⎧ ∂ρ k ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ ∂t + div(ρk vk ) + ck ρk = 0, in Ω, (VI.27) on Γ− γρk = ρin ⎪ k , vk (t), ⎪ ⎩ ρk (0) = ρ0,k .

We assume that there exists c ∈ L1 (]0, T [×Ω), v ∈ L1 (]0, T [, (W 1,1 (Ω))d ) with (div v)+ ∈ L1 (]0, T [, L∞ (Ω)), ρ0 ∈ L∞ (Ω), ρin ∈ L∞ (]0, T [×Γ) such that vk −−−−→ v, k→∞

in L1 (]0, T [×Ω)d ,

(VI.28a)

div vk −−−−→ div v, in L1 (]0, T [×Ω),

(VI.28b)

(vk · ν) −−−−→ (v · ν), in L1 (]0, T [×Γ),

(VI.28c)

k→∞ k→∞

ck −−−−→ c,

in L1 (]0, T [×Ω),

(VI.28d)

ρin −−− ρin , k −

weakly- in L∞ (]0, T [×Γ),

(VI.28e)

ρin −−−→ ρin , k −

in L1 (]0, T [×Γ, dμ− v ).

(VI.28f)

k→∞ k→∞ k→∞

((ck + div vk )− )k is bounded in L1 (]0, T [, L∞ (Ω)), (ρ0,k )k is bounded in L∞ (Ω) and ρ0,k −−−−→ ρ0 in L1 (Ω) k→∞

(VI.28g)

Then, if we denote by ρ the unique solution to the transport problem (VI.2)(VI.3) associated with the data c, v, ρ0 , ρin , we have ρk −−−−→ ρ in C 0 ([0, T ], Lp (Ω)), for any p < +∞, k→∞

γρk −−−−→ γρ in Lp (]0, T [×Γ, |dμv |), for any p < +∞. k→∞

Remark VI.1.5. Notice that we do not need the strong convergence of vk towards v in the space L1 (]0, T [, (W 1,1 (Ω))d ) but only in L1 (]0, T [×Ω)d supplemented by the strong convergence of (div vk )k and of the normal traces (vk · ν)k in L1 . In the case of tangential divergence-free velocity fields, these last two assumptions are obviously satisfied. We also notice that it is not necessary to assume that ((div vk )+ )k is bounded in L1 (]0, T [, L∞ (Ω)). Remark VI.1.6. • From assumption (VI.28e) and Corollary II.2.8, we deduce ∞ that (ρin k )k is bounded in L (]0, T [×Γ).

1. Weak solutions of the transport equation

429

• Using (VI.28e), it can be easily shown that the assumption (VI.28f) is equivalent to − ρin −−−→ ρin (v · ν)− , in L1 (]0, T [×Γ), k (vk · ν) − k→∞

which can be interpreted, in the framework of fluid mechanics, as a convergence property of the inflow mass flux. Proof. We first observe that γρk is only well-defined |dμvk |−almost everywhere. From now on, we set γρk = 0 on the set {(t, σ) ∈]0, T [×Γ, vk · ν = 0} so that γρk is a well-defined element in L∞ (]0, T [×Γ). • By using the estimates (VI.20) and the assumptions on ρ0,k , ρin k and (ck + div vk )− , we immediately obtain that  (ρk )k is bounded in L∞ (]0, T [×Ω), (VI.29) (γρk )k is bounded in L∞ (]0, T [×Γ). In particular, (γρk )k is bounded in L∞ (]0, T [×Γ, |dμv |). Therefore, we can find a subsequence (still referred to as (ρk )k ) and R ∈ L∞ (]0, T [×Ω), g ∈ L∞ (]0, T [×Γ, |dμv |) such that ρk −−−− R, weakly- in L∞ (]0, T [×Ω), k→∞

γρk −−−− g, k→∞

weakly- in L∞ (]0, T [×Γ, |dμv |).

(VI.30)

We now show that R = ρ and g = γρ, so that finally the convergences above are shown to hold for the whole initial sequence (ρk )k (see Proposition II.2.9). Let ϕ ∈ C 0,1 ([0, T ] × Ω) be a test function such that ϕ(T, .) = 0. The weak formulation satisfied by ρk reads    T ∂ϕ ρk + vk · ∇ϕ − ck ϕ dx dt ∂t 0 Ω  T  ρ0,k ϕ(0) dx − (γρk )ϕ(vk · ν) dσ dt = 0. + Ω

0

Γ

Thanks to the weak convergence of ρk and the strong convergence of vk and ck in L1 , we can easily pass to the limit in the first integral (we use Proposition II.2.30). The assumption (VI.28g) let us pass to the limit in the second term. It remains to study the boundary term by writing

Chapter VI. Nonhomogeneous fluids

430

   T T (γρk )ϕ(vk · ν) dσ dt − gϕ(v · ν) dσ dt 0 Γ 0 Γ     T T , = (γρk − g)ϕ(v · ν) dσ dt + (γρk )ϕ (vk · ν) − (v · ν) dσ dt 0 Γ 0 Γ   T ≤ (γρk − g)ϕ(v · ν) dσ dt + Cϕ vk · ν − v · νL1 (]0,T [×Γ) . 0 Γ The first term goes to 0 by the weak- convergence property of γρk , and the second one also tends to 0 by using (VI.28c). We have thus shown that R and g satisfy    T ∂ϕ R + v · ∇ϕ − cϕ dx dt ∂t 0 Ω (VI.31)  T  + ρ0 ϕ(0) dx − gϕ(v · ν) dσ dt = 0. Ω

0

Γ

In order to conclude, we just need to show that g = ρin dμ− v -almost everywhere. For any test function ψ ∈ L∞ (]0, T [×Γ) we have    T T in − − ρk (vk · ν) ψ dσ dt − g(v · ν) ψ dσ dt 0 Γ   0 Γ =(γρk )(vk ·ν)−   T ≤ ((γρk ) − g)(v · ν)− ψ dσ dt 0 Γ   T   − − + ρin ψ dσ dt . k (v · ν) − (vk · ν) 0 Γ The first term in the right-hand side tends to 0 by (VI.30) and the second one by using the L∞ bound on ρin k (obtained from (VI.28e)) and (VI.28c). Comparing this result to (VI.28f) leads to the equality 

T







T



g(v · ν) ψ dσ, dt = 0

Γ

0

ρin (v · ν)− ψ dσ dt,

Γ

for any test function ψ. It follows that g = ρin , dμ− v -almost everywhere. We finally deduce from (VI.31) that R solves the transport problem with initial data ρ0 and inflow boundary data ρin . By uniqueness of such a weak solution, we conclude that R = ρ and g = γρ. As a consequence, we have just shown the weak convergence of ρk (resp., of the trace γρk ) towards ρ (resp., towards the trace γρ).

1. Weak solutions of the transport equation

431

• In a second step, we prove that the convergence obtained above is in fact much stronger. By assumption, the problem (VI.27) satisfies the renormalisation property. In particular, if we define ζk = (ρk )2 , we know that ζk solves the following initial- and boundary-value problem ⎧ ∂ζk ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ ∂t + div(ζk vk ) + (2ck + div vk )ζk = 0, in Ω, (VI.32) 2 on Γ− γ(ζk ) = (ρin ⎪ k ) , vk (t), ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ ζ (0) = (ρ )2 . k

0,k

Similarly, ζ = ρ2 solves the problem ⎧ ∂ζ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ ∂t + div(ζv) + (2c + div v)ζ = 0, in Ω, on Γ− γ(ζ) = (ρin )2 , ⎪ v (t), ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ ζ(0) = (ρ )2 , 0

Problem (VI.32) has the same form as (VI.27) with ck replaced with 2ck + div vk and satisfies all the corresponding assumptions (VI.28). We can then use the weak convergence result that we proved in the previous step which shows that (ρk )2 = ζk −−−− ζ = (ρ)2 , weakly- in L∞ (]0, T [×Ω). k→∞

This implies in particular that  ρk 2L2

T





T



(ρk ) dx dt −−−−→

ρ2 dx dt = ρ2L2 ,

2

= 0

Ω

k→∞

0

Ω

which gives the strong convergence of (ρk )k towards ρ in L2 (]0, T [×Ω) (by Proposition II.2.32). The convergence in any Lp (]0, T [×Ω), p < +∞ follows thanks to the bounds (VI.29). Similarly, we obtain that (γρk )k strongly converges towards γρ in the space Lp (]0, T [×Γ, |dμv |), for any p < +∞. • It remains to show the strong convergence of (ρk )k in C 0 ([0, T ], Lp (Ω)), p < +∞, that is to say uniformly with respect to the time variable. Here also, thanks to the uniform bounds (VI.29), it is sufficient to consider the case p = 2, for instance. The basic idea is to look at the equation satisfied by the difference ρ − ρk . Unfortunately, since ρ is not smooth enough this does not let us perform all the required computations. Therefore, we replace ρ by its regularisation Sε ρ. We recall that we established in the proof of Theorem VI.1.3, that Sε ρ − ρC 0 ([0,T ],L2 (Ω)) −−−→ 0, ε→0

(VI.33)

Chapter VI. Nonhomogeneous fluids

432

γ0 (Sε ρ) −−−→ γρ, in L2 (]0, T [×Γ, |dμv |), ε→0

(VI.34)

and that Sε ρ solves ∂Sε ρ + div(Sε ρv) + cSε ρ = Rε , ∂t with Rε L1 (]0,T [×Ω) −−−→ 0. ε→0

(VI.35)

Notice that we avoided using the notation ρε here because it can lead to confusion. It follows that ⎧ ∂   ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ ∂t (Sε ρ − ρk ) + div (Sε ρ − ρk )vk + ck (Sε ρ − ρk ) = Rε,k , in Ω, on Γ− γ(Sε ρ − ρk ) = γ0 (Sε ρ) − ρin ⎪ k , vk (t), ⎪ ⎩ (Sε ρ − ρk )(0) = Sε ρ0 − ρ0,k , where Rε,k = Rε + (Sε ρ) div(vk − v) + (∇Sε ρ) · (vk − v) + (ck − c)(Sε ρ) satisfies Rε,k L1 (]0,T [×Ω) ≤ Rε L1 + div v−div vk L1 +Cε v−vk L1 +ck −cL1 . By using assumptions (VI.28a), (VI.28b), (VI.28d) and the property (VI.35), we deduce that   lim lim sup Rε,k L1 = 0. (VI.36) ε→0

k→∞

We can then apply the renormalisation property to this problem (see Remark VI.1.3) and deduce that ⎧   ∂ ⎪ ⎪ (Sε ρ − ρk )2 + div (Sε ρ − ρk )2 vk ⎪ ⎪ ∂t ⎪ ⎨ + (2ck + div vk )(Sε ρ − ρk )2 = 2Rε,k (Sε ρ − ρk ), in Ω,   ⎪ ⎪ γ (Sε ρ − ρk )2 = (γ0 (Sε ρ) − ρin )2 , on Γ− ⎪ k vk (t), ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ 2 2 (Sε ρ − ρk ) (0) = (Sε ρ0 − ρ0,k ) . Integrating this equation over Ω and between times 0 and s ∈ [0, T ], we get  s 2 (Sε ρ − ρk )(s)L2 + (2ck + div vk )(Sε ρ − ρk )2 dx dt 

s

 

0





Ω

2

γ Sε ρ − ρk (vk · ν) dσ dt  s =Sε ρ0 − ρ0,k 2L2 + 2 Rε,k (Sε ρ − ρk ) dx dt. +

0

Γ

0

Ω

1. Weak solutions of the transport equation

433

It follows, since supε Sε ρL∞ + supk ρk L∞ < +∞, that (Sε ρ − ρk )(s)2L2 ≤ 2Sε ρ0 − ρ0 2L2 + 2ρ0 − ρ0,k 2L2 2 + 4CRε,k L1 (]0,T [×Ω) + γ0 (Sε ρ) − ρin k L2 (]0,T [×Γ,dμ− v )  s + (2ck + div vk )− (t)L∞ (Sε ρ − ρk )(t)2L2 dt 0

+ C(vk · ν)− − (v · ν)− L1 (]0,T [×Γ) . By using the Gronwall lemma, it follows that  Sε ρ − ρk 2C 0 ([0,T ],L2 (Ω)) ≤ M Sε ρ0 − ρ0 2L2 + ρ0 − ρ0,k 2L2 + Rε,k L1 + (vk · ν)− − (v · ν)− L1 (]0,T [×Γ)

 2 + γ0 (Sε ρ) − γρ2L2 (]0,T [×Γ,dμ− ) + γρ − ρin  k L2 (]0,T [×Γ,dμ− ) . v

v

By the triangle inequality, we deduce  2 ρ − ρk C 0 ([0,T ],L2 (Ω)) ≤ M Sε ρ − ρ2C 0 ([0,T ],L2 (Ω)) + Sε ρ0 − ρ0 2L2 + ρ0 − ρ0,k 2L2 + Rε,k L1 + (vk · ν)− − (v · ν)− L1 (]0,T [×Γ)  2 in 2 + γ0 (Sε ρ) − γρL2 (]0,T [×Γ,dμ− ) + γρ − ρk L2 (]0,T [×Γ,dμ− ) . v

v

We take now the lim sup as k → ∞ in this inequality to obtain lim sup ρ − ρk 2C 0 ([0,T ],L2 (Ω)) k→∞  ≤M Sε ρ − ρ2C 0 ([0,T ],L2 (Ω)) + Sε ρ0 − ρ0 2L2

 + lim sup Rε,k L1 + γ0 (Sε ρ) − γρ2L2 (]0,T [×Γ,dμ− ) . v

k→∞

The left-hand side does not depend on ε, thus we can pass to the limit as ε → 0 in the right-hand side. Using (VI.33),(VI.34) and (VI.36), we finally get that lim sup ρ − ρk 2C 0 ([0,T ],L2 (Ω)) = 0, k→∞

and the proof of the theorem is complete.  Remark VI.1.7. Assume that the strong convergence of vk towards v in L1 is not known. We can observe that the proof of the theorem still holds if we know instead that, at least for a subsequence, we have

Chapter VI. Nonhomogeneous fluids

434

• The product (ρk vk )k weakly converges towards the product ρv. • The product (ρ2k vk )k weakly converges towards ζv, where ζ is the weak limit of (ρ2k )k . This remark is used in the study of the nonhomogeneous Navier–Stokes problem in the next section.

2 The nonhomogeneous incompressible Navier–Stokes equations The goal of this section is to give a proof of the (global) existence of a weak solution of the nonhomogeneous incompressible Navier–Stokes equations.

2.1 Main result In all that follows, we assume that the function μ, giving the viscosity as a function of the density, is of class C 1 and satisfies the following hypotheses ∃μ1 , μ2 > 0, μ1 ≤ μ(x) ≤ μ2 , ∀x ∈ R and μ is bounded.

(VI.37)

The ultimate goal of this chapter is to demonstrate the following existence result in space dimension 3. Theorem VI.2.1 (Existence of a weak solution). Let Ω be a bounded Lipschitz domain of Rd with d = 3, T > 0 and let μ satisfy (VI.37). Let vb ∈ (H 1 (Ω))d with div vb = 0, v0 ∈ vb +H, ρ0 ∈ L∞ (Ω), ρin ∈ L∞ (]0, T [×Γ) and f ∈ L1 (]0, T [, (L2 (Ω))d ) such that ρ0 ≥ 0 and ρin ≥ 0. Then, there exists at least one triplet (v, ρ, p) such that v ∈ vb + L2 (]0, T [, (H01 (Ω))d ), ρv ∈ L∞ (]0, T [, (L2 (Ω))d ) ∩ N2 (]0, T [, (W −1,3 (Ω))d ), 1/4

p ∈ W −1,∞ (]0, T [, L20 (Ω)), ρ ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], Lq (Ω)), ∀q < +∞,  t → (ρ(t)v(t)) · ϕ dx ∈ C 0 ([0, T ]), for any ϕ ∈ V , Ω

ρmin ≤ ρ(t, x) ≤ ρmax , for almost every (t, x) ∈]0, T [×Ω, with ρmin = min(inf ρ0 , inf ρin ), ρmax = max(sup ρ0 , sup ρin ), and which satisfies, in the distribution sense

2. The nonhomogeneous incompressible Navier–Stokes equations

⎧ ∂ρ ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ ∂t + div(ρv) = 0, ρ(0) = ρ0 , ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ γρ = ρin ,

435

in Ω, (VI.38) on Γ− v (t),

⎧ ⎨ ∂(ρv) + div(ρv ⊗ v) − 2 div(μ(ρ)D(v)) + ∇p = ρf, ∂t ⎩ (ρv)(0) = ρ0 v0 , div v = 0, in Ω,

in Ω,

(VI.39) (VI.40)

Moreover, if we assume that inf Ω ρ0 > 0, then v ∈ L∞ (]0, T [, H) ∩ N2 (]0, T [, H). 1/4

We recall that the Nikolskii spaces Nqσ (]0, T [, E) were defined by (II.26). A similar result holds in dimension d = 2 with slightly different functional spaces. We note that the initial condition on ρv in (VI.39) has to be understood in V  ; that is, more precisely, in the following sense    ρv · ϕ dx = ρ0 v0 · ϕ dx, ∀ϕ ∈ V. Ω

|t=0

Ω

This weak interpretation of the initial data cannot be strengthened without some further assumptions (particularly regarding the initial data ρ0 ). In particular, it is not possible in general to give a sense to (ρv)(0) nor, of course, to v(0). We briefly return to this problem in Section 2.5. Remark VI.2.1. It is possible to show the same result for a time-dependent boundary data for the velocity vb , provided some suitable time regularity properties hold for this data. Moreover, it is also possible to consider outflow boundary conditions of the same type as the one we will study in Section 1 of Chapter VII. We refer to [25] for the study of this particular problem, using similar tools as in the present chapter.

2.2 Approximate problem 2.2.1 Definition of the approximate problem We consider the same assumptions and notation as in Theorem VI.2.1. For any integer k ≥ 1, let Vk be a k-dimensional Galerkin approximation space in V ⊂ H satisfying Vk ⊂ Vk+1 for any k. We can, for example, build this space upon the eigenfunctions of the Stokes operator, as we did in Section

Chapter VI. Nonhomogeneous fluids

436

1.3.2 of Chapter V but this is not necessary here because it does not lead to any simplification of the proof. Therefore, we do not specify in the sequel a particular choice for Vk . We introduce approximations of the data defined by: in ρin k =ρ +

1 1 , ρ0,k = ρ0 + , k k

(VI.41)

so that we have

1 1 and inf ρ0,k ≥ , k k even if the initial and boundary density data are allowed to vanish. We finally choose a sequence (fk )k of smooth vector fields which converges towards f in L1 (]0, T [, (L2 (Ω))d ). Let us consider the following approximate problem. inf ρin k ≥

Definition VI.2.2. We set v˜0,k = PVk (v0 − vb ), the orthogonal projection (in H) of v0 − vb onto Vk . The approximate problem consists in looking for vk = vb + v˜k ∈ vb + C 1 ([0, T ], Vk ), ρk ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], L1 (Ω)) ∩ L∞ (]0, T [×Ω) such that 1. ρk is the unique solution to the transport problem associated with the velocity field vk , the initial data ρ0,k , and the inflow boundary data ρin k . 2. The couple (ρk , vk ) satisfies     ∂vk ρk + (vk · ∇)vk · ψ dx + 2μ(ρk )D(vk ) : D(ψ) dx ∂t Ω (VI.42) Ω = ρk fk · ψ dx, Ω

for any ψ ∈ Vk and any t ∈ [0, T ], as well as the initial data vk (0) = vb + v˜0,k . Notice that the approximate density ρk depends on vk in a complex nonlocal way. Therefore, the resolution of the approximate problem is not a straightforward consequence of the ordinary differential equations theory.

2.2.2 Resolution of the approximate problem The resolution of the approximate problem is performed using a fixedpoint method (see, for instance, [86]). To this end, we introduce the finitedimensional subspace of (H 1 (Ω))d defined by Vk = Rvb + Vk , and the infinite-dimensional Banach space Ek = C 0 ([0, T ], Vk ).

2. The nonhomogeneous incompressible Navier–Stokes equations

437

We now define a map Θk : Ek → Ek for which we want to find a fixed-point. This fixed-point will be a solution to the approximate problem under study. • Let wk ∈ Ek be given. We first consider the following transport problem ⎧ ∂ρ k ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ ∂t + div(ρk wk ) = 0, in Ω (VI.43) on Γ− γ(ρk ) = ρin ⎪ k , wk (t), ⎪ ⎩ ρk (0) = ρ0 . Since wk belongs in particular to L1 (]0, T [, (W 1,1 (Ω))d ), and is divergencefree, we know from Theorem VI.1.6 that there exists a unique solution ρk ≥ 0 to (VI.43) which satisfies sup ρk ≤ max(ρ0 L∞ , ρin L∞ ) + 1/k,

(VI.44)

]0,T [×Ω

and which is continuous in time with values in any Lq (Ω) for q < +∞. Moreover, by using Proposition VI.1.8, the fact that div wk = 0 and (VI.41), we deduce that 1 inf ρk ≥ . (VI.45) k ]0,T [×Ω • Once ρk is built, we look for vk ∈ vb + C 1 ([0, T ], Vk ) ⊂ Ek satisfying     ∂vk ρk 2μ(ρk )D(vk ) : D(ψ) dx + (wk · ∇)vk · ψ dx + ∂t Ω Ω (VI.46)  = ρk fk · ψ dx, Ω

for any ψ ∈ Vk and any t ∈ [0, T ], as well as the initial data vk (0) = vb + v˜0,k . This equation is obtained from the original equation (VI.42) by replacing in the inertia term the (unknown) advection vector field vk by the given vector field wk , in such a way that (VI.46) is now a finite-dimensional linear ordinary differential equation. k Indeed, if one seeks its solution under the form vk = vb + i=1 αi (t)ψi , we obtain that (VI.46) can be written M (t)

dα (t) = A(t)α(t) + B(t), dt

(VI.47)

where α(t) = (αi (t))i ∈ Rk is the unknown vector, A(t), M (t) are k × k matrices and B(t) ∈ Rk is a vector, all of them being continuous with respect to the time variable t (recall that fk is smooth). In order to show that (VI.47) has a unique global solution for any initial data, we only need to show that the matrix M (t) is invertible for any t ∈ [0, T ] so that the Cauchy–Lipschitz theory can be applied. By definition,

Chapter VI. Nonhomogeneous fluids

438

the entries of M (t) are given by  (M (t))ij = ρk (t, x)ψi (x)ψj (x) dx, ∀i, j ∈ {1, . . . , k}. Ω

Therefore, for any t ∈ [0, T ], M (t) is the Gram matrix of the basis (ψi )i with respect to the inner product defined by  (f, g) → f, gρk (t) = ρk (t, x)f (x)g(x) dx. Ω

Notice that ., .ρk (t) is indeed a scalar product thanks to (VI.45). It follows that M (t) is invertible for all t, thus (VI.47) has a unique global solution associated with any initial data. As a consequence, there exists a unique vk ∈ vb + C 1 ([0, T ], Vk ) ⊂ Ek which is a solution of (VI.46) and such that vk (0) = vb + v˜0,k . • Finally, with any wk ∈ Ek we have associated a unique couple (ρk , vk ) which solves the previous set of equations. We set Θk (wk ) = vk . We now show that the map Θk has a fixed-point in a suitable subset of Ek . It is straightforward to see that such a fixed-point vk (and its associated density ρk ) is a solution to the nonlinear approximate problem introduced in Section 2.2.1. • Preliminary computations: We first observe that, for any ψ ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], Vk ), we can take ψ(t) as a test function in (VI.46) and integrate the resulting equation with respect to time. We obtain    T ∂vk ρk + (wk · ∇)vk · ψ dx dt ∂t 0 Ω (VI.48)  T  T +

ρk fk · ψ dx dt.

2μ(ρk )D(vk ) : D(ψ) dx dt = 0

Ω

0

Ω

Notice that (VI.48) is equivalent to (VI.46) for any time t, as soon as vk , wk are continuous in time. For ψ ∈ C 1 ([0, T ], Vk ) and, since vk is smooth enough, we can consider 1 vk ·ψ) (which is vanishing at the boundary) as a test function in (VI.43). 2 (˜ It follows that     ∂ψ 1 T ∂˜ vk ρk vk ) · ψ + ((wk · ∇)ψ) · v˜k dx dt · ψ + v˜k · + ((wk · ∇)˜ 2 0 Ω ∂t ∂t   1 1 (VI.49) = ρk (T )(˜ vk (T ) · ψ(T )) dx − ρ0,k (˜ v0,k · ψ(0)) dx. 2 Ω 2 Ω We subtract (VI.49) from (VI.48). Using that vk = v˜k + vb , vb being timeindependent, it follows

2. The nonhomogeneous incompressible Navier–Stokes equations



T







439

∂˜ vk ∂ψ vk ) · ψ − ((wk · ∇)ψ) · v˜k dx dt ·ψ− · v˜k + ((wk · ∇)˜ ∂t ∂t 0  Ω  1 1 + ρk (T )(˜ vk (T ) · ψ(T )) dx − ρ0,k (˜ v0,k · ψ(0)) dx 2 Ω 2 Ω  T  T   + 2μ(ρk )D(vk ) : D(ψ) dx dt = ρk fk − (wk · ∇)vb · ψ dx dt.

1 2

ρk

0

Ω

Ω

0

(VI.50) Subtracting once more (VI.49) from this equation we find a conservative formulation of the approximate momentum equation    T ∂ψ ρk v˜k · + (wk · ∇)ψ dx dt − ∂t 0 Ω  T 2μ(ρk )D(vk ) : D(ψ) dx dt + Ω 0 (VI.51)   ρk (T )˜ vk (T ) · ψ(T ) dx − ρ0,k v˜0,k · ψ(0) dx + Ω



Ω



T





ρk fk − (wk · ∇)vb · ψ dx dt.

= Ω

0

This formula is useful to analyse the limit as k → ∞ in the sequel. • Energy estimate: Consider wk ∈ vb + C 0 ([0, T ], Vk ) and vk = Θk (wk ) as defined previously. Let us choose ψ = v˜k = vk − vb as a test function in (VI.50). We see that the first integral vanishes and it follows 1 2 =

1 2





T



ρk (T )|˜ vk (T )|2 dx + Ω





2μ(ρk )|D(˜ vk )|2 dx dt 0

T



ρ0,k |˜ v0,k |2 dx − Ω



T



Ω

2μ(ρk )D(˜ vk ) : D(vb ) dx dt 0

Ω

ρk v˜k · (fk − (wk · ∇)vb ) dx dt.

+ 0

Ω

Using the L∞ bound on ρk given in (VI.44), assumption (VI.37), and the Korn inequality (IV.87), we get  T 1 ( 2 vk (T )L2 + μ1 ∇˜ vk 2L2 dt  ρk (T )˜ 2 0  T  T ≤C˜ v0,k 2L2 + C ∇˜ vk L2 ∇vb L2 dt + C fk L2 ˜ vk L2 dt 0 0   T ρk v˜k · ((wk · ∇)vb ) dx dt . + (VI.52) 0 Ω

Chapter VI. Nonhomogeneous fluids

440

Let us consider the last term of this inequality. Using the H¨ older inequality, and the Sobolev embedding H 1 (Ω) ⊂ L6 (Ω), we get   T ρk v˜k · ((wk · ∇)vb ) dx dt 0 Ω  T √ √ ≤  ρk L∞  ρk wk L3 ∇vb L2 ˜ vk L6 dt 0



T

≤C 0

√ 1/2 √ 1/2  ρk wk L2  ρk wk L6 vb H 1 ∇˜ vk L2 dt 

T

≤Cvb H 1 0

≤C 0

T

Z

√ 1/2 1/2  ρk wk L2 ∇wk L2 ∇˜ vk L2 dt

!1/4 Z √ k ρk wk k2L2 dt

0

!1/4

T

k∇wk k2L2 dt

0

!1/2

T

Z

k∇˜ vk k2L2 dt

.

0

Using this estimate in (VI.52) and the Young inequality, we get  ( 2  ρk (T )˜ vk (T )L2 + μ1  ≤C + C

T

0 T

√  ρk wk 2L2 dt

∇˜ vk 2L2 dt

1/2 

1/2

T

∇wk 2L2

0

dt

,

0

where C only depends on the data f , vb , μ1 , μ2 , ρ0 . Finally, writing vk = vb + v˜k we deduce that  T ( 2  ρk (T )vk (T )L2 + μ1 ∇vk 2L2 dt 

≤C + C



0



T

√  ρk wk 2L2 dt

1/2 

1/2

T

∇wk 2L2

0

dt

(VI.53) .

0

We now use the fact that k being fixed, the H 1 -norm is equivalent to the L2 -norm on the finite-dimensional space Vk (with constants depending on k) and (VI.45). It follows from (VI.53),  vk (T )2L2 ≤ Ck + Dk

T

wk (t)2L2 dt, 0

where Ck and Dk depend on the data and on k but not on wk . The above estimate applies for any final time T > 0 so that we have in fact proved that  t 2 vk (t)L2 ≤ Ck + Dk wk (s)2L2 ds, ∀t ∈ [0, T ]. (VI.54) 0

2. The nonhomogeneous incompressible Navier–Stokes equations

441

Let us introduce Mk (t) = Ck eDk t , ∀t ≥ 0. Suppose that wk is such that wk (t)2L2 ≤ Mk (t), ∀t ∈ [0, T ], then, using (VI.54), we deduce vk (t)2L2 ≤ Mk (t), ∀t ∈ [0, T ]. In other words, we proved that Θk maps the following convex subset of Ek , % & K0,k = v ∈ vb + C 1 ([0, T ], Vk ), such that v(t)2L2 ≤ Mk (t), ∀t ∈ [0, T ] , into itself. Notice in particular that K 0,k is bounded in L∞ (]0, T [, (L2 (Ω))d ). Moreover, since Vk is a finite-dimensional subspace of (H 1 (Ω))d , the L2 norm and the H 1 -norm are equivalent in this subspace so that the set K0,k is also bounded in L∞ (]0, T [, (H 1 (Ω))d ). Of course, the corresponding bound depends on k. • Compactness: Let wk ∈ K0,k and vk = Θk (wk ) ∈ K0,k . We take ψ = ∂˜ vk /∂t = ∂vk /∂t in (VI.46) (recall that vb does not depend on time). All the norms in Vk are equivalent so that using once more (VI.45), we find a bound    ∂vk    ≤ Ck , sup  ∂t Vk 0≤t≤T where Ck depends only on T, k, and on convex set % K1,k = v ∈ K0,k , sup

the data. As a consequence, the   &  ∂v    ≤ Ck ,   0≤t≤T ∂t Vk

is invariant through the map Θk . By the Ascoli theorem (Theorem II.3.1), we know that the set K1,k is relatively compact in Ek . • Continuity of Θk : In order to apply the Schauder fixed-point theorem to the map Θk on the compact convex set K1,k , it remains to show that Θk is continuous for the topology of Ek . In fact it is enough to show that Θk is sequentially continuous. Recall that k is a fixed integer. Let (wkn )n be a sequence in Ek which converges towards some wk in this space. For any n, let ρnk be the unique solution to the transport problem (VI.43) with wk = wkn . Let ρ be the unique solution to (VI.43) for the limit velocity field wk . Since k is fixed,

Chapter VI. Nonhomogeneous fluids

442

all these transport problems are associated with the same initial data ρ0,k and boundary data ρin k . By assumption, the sequence (wkn )n strongly converges in the space C 0 ([0, T ], (H 1 (Ω))d ), so that the sequence of traces (wkn · ν)n converges towards (wk · ν) in L1 (]0, T [×Γ). Hence, by Theorem VI.1.9 we deduce that (ρnk )n strongly converges towards ρk in L∞ (]0, T [, Lq (Ω)) for any q < +∞ and that (γ(ρnk )(wkn · ν)+ )n strongly converges towards γ(ρk )(wk · ν)+ in L1 (]0, T [×Γ). Therefore, since μ is a Lipschitz continuous bounded function, we deduce that (μ(ρnk ))n converges towards μ(ρk ) in all the spaces L∞ (]0, T [, Lq (Ω)), for any q < +∞. Let us now consider the solution vkn ∈ vb + C 0 ([0, T ], Vk ) to (VI.46) for the advection vector field wkn and the density ρnk constructed above. Since (wkn )n is bounded in C 0 ([0, T ], (H 1 (Ω))d ), the energy estimate (VI.54) leads to sup vkn C 0 ([0,T ],L2 ) < +∞, n

and, taking ψ =

∂vkn /∂t

in (VI.46), we also easily get that  n  ∂vk   < +∞. sup   ∂t  0 n C ([0,T ],L2 )

(VI.55)

Using once again the Ascoli theorem, we find that there exists a subsequence always referred to as (vkn )n which strongly converges towards some limit vk in vb + C 0 ([0, T ], Vk ). Furthermore, from (VI.55) we deduce that the limit vk is Lipschitz continuous with respect to the time variable. Thanks to the convergences obtained above, we can perform the limit as n → ∞ in the equation satisfied by vkn . We finally obtain that ρk , vk , wk satisfy (VI.51) and by adding (VI.49) twice, we find that vk solves (VI.48) and thus the differential equation (VI.46) in the sense of D (]0, T [). The solution to (VI.46) is unique (and equal to Θk (wk )) as soon as ρk and wk are fixed thus we deduce, with the same argument as in the proof of Proposition II.2.9, that the whole sequence (vkn )n , and not only a subsequence, actually converges in C 0 ([0, T ], (H 1 (Ω))d ) towards vk = Θk (wk ). This concludes the proof of the continuity of the map Θk . • Conclusion: We just proved that Θk is a continuous map from Ek into itself and that the convex compact set K1,k is invariant by Θk . Thanks to the Schauder fixed-point theorem (Theorem II.3.9), we obtain that there exists at least one fixed-point vk of Θk into K1,k . This exactly provides the existence of at least one solution to the approximate problem under study introduced in Definition VI.2.2.

2. The nonhomogeneous incompressible Navier–Stokes equations

443

2.3 Estimates for the approximate solution Up to now we obtained k-dependent estimates. In the present section, we are going to provide uniform estimates with respect to k for this approximate solution. This is useful for performing the limit when k goes to infinity.

2.3.1 Uniform energy estimates Lemma VI.2.3. There exists C0 > 0 depending only on the data such that, for any k ≥ 1, we have ρk L∞ (]0,T [×Ω) ≤ C0 , √  ρk vk L∞ (]0,T [,L2 ) + vk L2 (]0,T [,H 1 ) ≤ C0 , √  ρk vk L8/3 (]0,T [,L4 ) ≤ C0 .

(VI.56) (VI.57) (VI.58)

Proof. The estimate (VI.56) directly follows from (VI.44) and the fact that ρk ≥ 0. Since for a fixed-point of Θk we have wk = vk = Θk (vk ), using Young’s inequality and the Gronwall lemma, with inequality (VI.53) gives the bound (VI.57). The 3D Sobolev embedding H 1 (Ω) ⊂ L6 (Ω) and the bound (VI.44) gives √  ρk vk L2 (]0,T [,L6 ) ≤ Cvk L2 (]0,T [,L6 ) ≤ C  vk L2 (]0,T [,H 1 ) . We now use the interpolation inequality (Theorem II.5.5) to get √  ρk vk 

8

L 3 (]0,T [,L4 )

√ √ 1/4 3/4 ≤  ρk vk L∞ (]0,T [,L2 )  ρk vk L2 (]0,T [,L6 ) √ 1/4 3/4 ≤ C   ρk vk L∞ (]0,T [,L2 ) vk L2 (]0,T [,H 1 ) .

Using (VI.57), the estimate (VI.58) follows.  Remark VI.2.2. Since ρk may vanish in the limit k → ∞, we cannot deduce from (VI.57) a classical L∞ (]0, T [, (L2 (Ω))d ) estimate on the velocity field vk .

2.3.2 Time derivative estimate for the density Lemma VI.2.4. For any β : R → R of class C 1 , there exists Cβ > 0 such that for any k ≥ 0 we have    ∂β(ρk )    ≤ Cβ .  ∂t  2 L (]0,T [,W −1,6 )

Chapter VI. Nonhomogeneous fluids

444

Proof. Since div vk = 0, the renormalisation property applied to the mass balance equation shows that β(ρk ) satisfies ∂β(ρk ) + div(β(ρk )vk ) = 0, ∂t in the distribution sense. It follows that    ∂β(ρk )    = div(β(ρk )vk )L2 (]0,T [,W −1,6 )  ∂t  2 L (]0,T [,W −1,6 ) ≤ β(ρk )vk L2 (]0,T [,L6 ) . Moreover, by (VI.56) and the Sobolev embedding theorem we have β(ρk )vk L2 (]0,T [,L6 ) ≤ Cvk L2 (]0,T [,L6 ) ≤ C  vk L2 (]0,T [,H 1 ) . The claim follows from (VI.57). 

2.3.3 Time translations estimates for the velocity In order to perform the limit in the approximate problem, it is necessary to prove some compactness property for the sequence (vk )k . As in [110], for instance, this compactness property follows from fractional time derivatives and more precisely from time translations estimates. To this end, we use the framework introduced in Section 5, in particular the time translation operators τh : f → f (. + h). Lemma VI.2.5. There exists C2 > 0 depending only on the data and the final time T , such that for any k ≥ 0 and any 0 < h < T , we have √  τh ρk (τh vk − vk )L2 (]0,T −h[,(L2 (Ω))d ) ≤ C2 h1/4 .

(VI.59)

Proof. Since vb is time-independent, we observe that τh vk − vk = τh v˜k − v˜k . Then we write the following algebraic identity τh ρk (τh v˜k − v˜k ) · (τh v˜k − v˜k ) = (τh (ρk v˜k ) − ρk v˜k ) · (τh v˜k − v˜k )    =A   (VI.60) − (τh ρk − ρk )˜ vk · (τh v˜k − v˜k ) .    =B

• Estimate of the term A:

2. The nonhomogeneous incompressible Navier–Stokes equations

445

Consider Ψ ∈ C 1 ([0, T ], Vk ) and let us introduce ψ(t, x) = 1[s,s+h] (t)Ψ(s, x), with s < T − h. We use ψ as a test function in the conservative formulation (VI.51) where we recall that wk = vk because vk is assumed to be a fixedpoint of Θk . This computation is allowed because ρk and v˜k are continuous with respect to the time variable. We get  (τh (ρk v˜k )(s) − ρk v˜k (s)) · Ψ(s) dx Ω s+h







s+h



ρk ((vk · ∇)Ψ(s)) · v˜k dx dt −

= s



Ω

  ρk fk − ((vk · ∇)vb ) · Ψ(s) dx dt.

+ s

2μ(ρk )D(vk ) : D(Ψ(s)) dx dt s

Ω s+h  Ω

Using (VI.56) and the H¨ older inequality, we get  (τh (ρk v˜k )(s) − ρk v˜k (s)) · Ψ(s) dx Ω

 s+h √ √  ρk vk L4 ( ρk v˜k L4 + ∇vb L2 ) dt ∇Ψ(s)L2 ≤C s





s+h

∇vk L2 + fk L2 dt ∇Ψ(s)L2 .

+C s

By using the H¨ older inequality with respect to the time variable, it follows  (τh (ρk v˜k )(s) − ρk v˜k (s)) · Ψ(s) dx Ω 1/4 √ 3/5 √ ≤C(h  ρk vk L8/3 (]0,T [,L4 ) + h  ρk vk 2L8/3 (]0,T [,L4 ) )∇Ψ(s)L2 + Ch1/2 (vk L2 (]0,T [,H 1 ) + fk L2 (]0,T [,L2 ) )∇Ψ(s)L2 . Using the bounds given in Lemma VI.2.3, we finally proved the following estimate  (τh (ρk v˜k )(s) − ρk v˜k (s)) · Ψ(s) dx ≤ Ch1/4 ∇Ψ(s)L2 . Ω

Let us take now Ψ(s) = τh v˜k (s) − v˜k (s). It follows  (τh (ρk v˜k )(s) − ρk v˜k (s)) · (τh v˜k (s) − v˜k (s)) dx Ω

≤Ch1/4 τh v˜k (s) − v˜k (s)H 1 . By integrating this inequality with respect to s and using (VI.57), we get

446

Chapter VI. Nonhomogeneous fluids

 T −h  (τh (ρk v˜k )(s) − ρk v˜k (s)) · (τh v˜k (s) − v˜k (s)) dx ds 0 Ω

(VI.61)

≤Ch1/4 ˜ vk L2 (0,T −h,H 1 ) ≤ K1 h1/4 . This is the estimate of the term A in (VI.60). • Estimate for the term B : Consider a given time s ∈]0, T −h[, and choose a time-independent function ϕ ∈ H01 (Ω). We take (t, x) → 1[s,s+h] (t)ϕ(x) as a test function in (VI.43) with wk = vk (this is allowed because ρk is continuous in time). It follows

   s+h

(τh ρk (s, x) − ρk (s, x))ϕ(x) dx = Ω

ρk vk dt Ω

· ∇ϕ(x) dx.

s

Let ψ ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], (H 1 (Ω))d ). We choose ϕ(x) = v˜k (s, x) · ψ(s, x) ∈ H01 (Ω) in the above identity. It follows, using Sobolev embeddings and (VI.56), that  (τh ρk (s) − ρk (s))˜ vk (s) · ψ(s) dx Ω

 s+h (VI.62) ≤C vk (t)H 1 dt ˜ vk (s)H 1 ψ(s)H01 s

≤Ch

1/2

vk L2 (]0,T [,H 1 ) ˜ vk (s)H 1 ψ(s)H 1 .

We now take ψ(s) = τh v˜k (s) − v˜k (s) in (VI.62), so that integrating with respect to s we get  T −h  (τh ρk − ρk )˜ vk · (τh v˜k − v˜k ) dx ds 0 (VI.63) Ω ≤Ch1/2 vk L2 (]0,T [,H 1 ) ˜ vk 2L2 (]0,T [,H 1 ) ≤ K1 h1/2 . Combining estimates (VI.61) and (VI.63) gives the claim thanks to (VI.60).  Lemma VI.2.6. There exists C > 0 depending only on the data, such that for any h > 0 we have (τh ρk − ρk )vk L2 (]0,T −h[,W −1,3 ) ≤ Ch1/2 . Proof. We first write  ρk (t + h) − ρk (t) = t

t+h

∂ρk (s)ds, ∂t

2. The nonhomogeneous incompressible Navier–Stokes equations

447

this equality being satisfied in W −1,6 (Ω). We have seen in Lemma VI.2.4 that (∂ρk /∂t)k is bounded in L2 (]0, T [, W −1,6 ), therefore we have    ∂ρk   τh ρk − ρk L∞ (]0,T −h[,W −1,6 ) ≤ h1/2  ≤ Ch1/2 .  ∂t  2 −1,6 L (]0,T [,W ) Using Theorem III.2.37, we know that the product operator continuously maps W −1,6 (Ω) × H 1 (Ω) into W −1,3 (Ω). From the inequality above and from (VI.57), we deduce the claimed estimate (τh ρk − ρk )vk L2 (]0,T −h[,W −1,3 ) ≤Cτh ρk − ρk L∞ (]0,T [,W −1,6 ) vk L2 (]0,T [,H 1 ) ≤ Ch1/2 .  Proposition VI.2.7. The sequence (ρk vk )k is bounded in the Nikolskii space 1/4 N2 (]0, T [, (W −1,3 (Ω))d ), that is, there exists C > 0 such that, for any 0 < h < T and any k, we have τh (ρk vk ) − ρk vk L2 (]0,T −h[,W −1,3 ) ≤ Ch1/4 . Proof. We just write τh (ρk vk ) − ρk vk = (τh ρk − ρk )vk +



√ τh ρk τh ρk (τh vk − vk ).

The first term is estimated by Lemma VI.2.6 and the second one by Lemma VI.2.5 (using the continuous embedding from L2 into W −1,3 ). 

2.4 End of the proof of the existence theorem We can now conclude the proof of Theorem VI.2.1 by establishing the existence of at least one weak solution to Problem (VI.38)–(VI.40). The end of the proof consists in showing that the approximate solution (ρk , vk ) constructed in the previous section has a limit, at least for a subsequence, in suitable spaces and that its limit is a solution to the required problem. • Weak convergence of the density: 1,6/5 From Theorem III.2.34, we know that the embedding of W0 (Ω) in 1 L (Ω) is compact, and thus by duality (Lemma II.3.6) the embedding of L∞ (Ω) in W −1,6 (Ω) is also compact. Using (VI.56), Lemma VI.2.4, and Theorem II.5.16, we conclude that, for any β : R → R of class C 1 , the sequence (β(ρk ))k is relatively compact in C 0 ([0, T ], W −1,6 (Ω)).

Chapter VI. Nonhomogeneous fluids

448

Applying this compactness property with β(s) = s and β(s) = s2 , we obtain that there exists a subsequence still referred to as (ρk )k , and two functions ρ, ζ ∈ L∞ (]0, T [×Ω) such that ⎧ ρk −−−− ρ, weakly- in L∞ (]0, T [×Ω), ⎪ ⎪ k→∞ ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ ∂ρk ∂ρ −−−− , weakly in L2 (]0, T [, W −1,6 (Ω)), ⎪ k→∞ ∂t ∂t ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ ρk −−−−→ ρ, in C 0 ([0, T ], W −1,6 (Ω)), k→∞

and

⎧ ρ2k −−−− ζ, weakly- in L∞ (]0, T [×Ω), ⎪ ⎪ k→∞ ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ 2 ∂ρk ∂ζ −−−− , weakly in L2 (]0, T [, W −1,6 (Ω)), ⎪ ∂t k→∞ ∂t ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ ρ2 −−−−→ ζ, in C 0 ([0, T ], W −1,6 (Ω)). k k→∞

We notice that vk ∈ vb +C 0 ([0, T ], Vk ) so that, in particular, the trace vk ·ν is equal to vb · ν and does not depend on k. Moreover, the renormalisation property gives us  2 γ(ρ2k ) = (γ(ρk ))2 = (ρin k ) =

ρin +

1 k

2 , where (vb · ν) < 0.

It follows that γ(ρk ) −−−−→ ρin , k→∞

in L1 (]0, T [×Γ, dμ− vb ),

γ(ρ2k ) −−−−→ (ρin )2 , in L1 (]0, T [×Γ, dμ− vb ). k→∞

• Weak convergence of the velocity and the momentum: Using (VI.57), we can find another subsequence still referred to as (vk )k and a v ∈ vb + L2 (]0, T [, V ) such that vk −−−− v, k→∞

weakly in L2 (]0, T [, (H 1 (Ω))d ).

(VI.64)

The product mapping (ρ, v) → ρv is continuous from W −1,6 (Ω)×(H 1 (Ω))d into (W −1,3 (Ω))d (Theorem III.2.37). Using Proposition II.2.12, and the strong convergences proved above for (ρk )k and (ρ2k )k we deduce that ρk vk −−−− ρv, weakly in L2 (]0, T [, (W −1,3 (Ω))d ), k→∞

ρ2k vk

−−−− ζv, k→∞

weakly in L2 (]0, T [, (W −1,3 (Ω))d ).

Moreover, by (VI.57) we know that (ρk vk )k and (ρ2k vk )k are bounded in L∞ (]0, T [, (L2 (Ω))d ). Therefore, by using Proposition II.2.10 (in the

2. The nonhomogeneous incompressible Navier–Stokes equations

449

slightly different case of a weak- convergent sequence; see Remark II.2.1), we obtain that ρk vk −−−− ρv, weakly- in L∞ (]0, T [, (L2 (Ω))d ),

(VI.65)

weakly- in L∞ (]0, T [, (L2 (Ω))d ).

(VI.66)

k→∞

ρ2k vk −−−− ζv, k→∞

• Strong convergence of the density and the viscosity: We can now use the stability result of the transport equation obtained in Section 1. Indeed, from Theorem VI.1.9 and Remark VI.1.7, the weak convergence of (ρk vk )k towards ρv and the one of (ρ2k vk )k towards ζv obtained in (VI.65) and (VI.66), as well as the strong convergence of the initial and inflow data, allow us to conclude first that ζ = ρ2 and that (ρk )k strongly converges towards ρ in C 0 ([0, T ], Lq (Ω)) for all q < +∞. In particular, we have ρ(0) = lim ρk (0) = lim ρ0k = ρ0 , k→∞

k→∞

by definition of the initial approximate data ρ0k . Finally, from (VI.37), we have μ(ρk ) − μ(ρ)L∞ (]0,T [,Lq ) ≤ μ ∞ ρk − ρL∞ (]0,T [,Lq ) , and therefore we have proved the strong convergence μ(ρk ) −−−−→ μ(ρ), k→∞

in L∞ (]0, T [, Lq (Ω)).

(VI.67)

• Weak convergence of the inertia term: The Sobolev theorem shows that the embedding W01,r (Ω) ⊂ L2 (Ω) is compact for any r > 5/6. By duality, we deduce that the embedding L2 (Ω) ⊂ W −1,q (Ω) is compact for any q < 6. From Proposition VI.2.7 and Theorem II.5.17, we deduce that (ρk vk )k is relatively compact in L2 (]0, T [, (W −1,q (Ω))d ) for any q < 6. We already obtained (VI.65), therefore an argument similar to the one used in the proof of Proposition II.2.9 shows that ρk vk −−−−→ ρv, k→∞

in L2 (]0, T [, (W −1,q (Ω))d ), ∀q < 6.

(VI.68)

The product operator (w, v) → w ⊗ v is continuous from the space 6q (W −1,q (Ω))d × (W 1,2 (Ω))d into (W −1,σ (Ω))d×d with σ = 6+q . Therefore, it follows from (VI.64), (VI.68) and Proposition II.2.12 that ρk vk ⊗ vk −−−− ρv ⊗ v, k→∞

weakly in L1 (]0, T [, (W −1,σ (Ω))d×d ), ∀σ < 3.

Chapter VI. Nonhomogeneous fluids

450

Finally, we know by using (VI.58) that the sequence (ρk vk ⊗ vk )k is bounded in the space L4/3 (]0, T [, (L2 (Ω))d×d ). Thus, we can use Proposition II.2.10 once more to deduce that ρk vk ⊗ vk −−−− ρv ⊗ v, k→∞

weakly in L4/3 (]0, T [, (L2 (Ω))d×d ).

• Passing to the limit in the momentum equation: Let k ≥ n, θ ∈ C 1 ([0, T ]), θ(T ) = 0, and ψn be fixed in Vn . Through integration by parts, the previously defined approximate solution satisfies T

 −

(ρk vk ) · ψn Ω 0  T

∂θ dx dt − ∂t





T

(ρk vk ⊗ vk ) : ∇ψn θ dx dt Ω

0



T



2μ(ρk )D(vk ) : D(ψn )θ dx dt −

+ 

Ω

0

ρk fk · ψn θ dx dt Ω

0

ρ0,k v0,k · ψn dx.

=θ(0) Ω

The test function ψn being fixed, convergences (VI.65) and (VI.67), obtained above, allow us to pass to the limit in k to obtain 

T





(ρv) · ψn Ω

0



T



∂θ dx dt − ∂t



T

 (ρv ⊗ v) : ∇ψn θ dx dt Ω

0



T



2μ(ρ)D(v) : D(ψn )θ dx dt −

+ 

Ω

0

ρf · ψn θ dx dt 0

Ω

ρ0 v0 · ψn dx.

=θ(0) Ω

By linear combination of test functions of the form θ(t)ψn (x), for all n ≥ 1 and for any test function ϕ ∈ C 1 ([0, T ], Hn ) such that ϕ(T ) = 0, we obtain 

T

 (ρv) ·

− Ω

0

 + 

T



∂ϕ dx dt − ∂t



T

 (ρv ⊗ v) : ∇ϕ dx dt

0

Ω



T



2μ(ρ)D(v) : D(ϕ) dx dt − 0

Ω

ρf · ϕ dx dt 0

(VI.69)

Ω

ρ0 v0 · ϕ(0)dx.

= Ω

The regularity obtained on ρ and v allows us to extend the identity above, by density, to the test functions ϕ of C 1 ([0, T ], V ) such that ϕ(T ) = 0, by using Lemma V.1.2. By restricting ourselves to test functions C ∞ with compact support over time in ]0, T [, we indeed obtain the equation in the sense of distributions, by using Theorem IV.2.3 to recover the pressure as we did in Chapter V. • Interpretation of the initial condition on ρv:

2. The nonhomogeneous incompressible Navier–Stokes equations

451

It is now necessary to interpret the initial velocity data. If we take a test function of the form ϕ(t, x) = θ(t)ψ(x) with θ ∈ D(]0, T [) and ψ ∈ V fixed, in (VI.69), by definition we obtain exactly that    d (ρv) · ψ dx − (ρv ⊗ v) : ∇ψ dx + 2μ(ρ)D(v) : D(ψ) dx dt Ω Ω Ω  (VI.70) ρf · ψ dx, = Ω

in the sense of distributions of D (]0, T [). Thanks to the regularity property of ρ and of v, we can deduce that   d (ρv) · ψ dx ∈ L1 (]0, T [), and (ρv) · ψ dx ∈ L1 (]0, T [). dt Ω Ω  Hence t → (ρv)·ψ dx is a function of W 1,1 (]0, T [) and, as a consequence, Ω

can be seen as a continuous function of t (Corollary II.4.2). If we now choose θ ∈ C ∞ ([0, T ]), we can write, by using (VI.70), an equation for integration by parts (Corollary II.4.2) in the form     (ρv) · ψ dx (T ) θ(T ) − (ρv) · ψ dx (0) θ(0) 

Ω T #

= 0



T

= 0

Ω

    $ dθ dt (ρ v) · ψ dx θ(t) + (ρ v) · ψ dx dt Ω Ω   T (ρv ⊗ v) : ∇ψ θ(t) dx dt − 2μ(ρ)D(v) : D(ψ) θ(t) dx dt



d dt



Ω T 



T



0

ρf · ψ θ(t) dx dt +

+ 0

(ρ v) · ψ 0

Ω

Ω

Ω

dθ dx dt. dt

If we assume that θ(0) = 1 and θ(T ) = 0, then by comparing the result obtained above to that given by (VI.69) (for ϕ = θ(t)ψ), we get    (ρv) · ψ dx (0) = ρ0 v0 · ψ dx, ∀ψ ∈ V. Ω

Ω

This gives a suitable weak sense to the initial condition at t = 0 for ρv. We draw the attention of the reader to the fact that v(0) does not have a precise meaning in this respect and that we can only define the initial condition for the momentum ρv.

452

Chapter VI. Nonhomogeneous fluids

2.5 The case without vacuum In the case where inf ρ0 > 0 and inf ρin > 0, that is, when the fluid being studied does not contain any vacuum regions, the results can be improved. In a more precise way, we have • For all k, we have inf ρk ≥ min(inf ρ0 , inf ρin ) > 0. • From (VI.57), we deduce that (vk )k is bounded in L∞ (]0, T [, (L2 (Ω))d ) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, (H 1 (Ω))d ). • From (VI.59), we deduce that we have τh vk − vk L2 (]0,T −h[,L2 ) ≤ Ch1/4 , 1/4

and therefore that the sequence (vk )k is bounded in N2 (]0, T [, (L2 (Ω))d ). This allows us to finally obtain the strong convergence of (vk )k towards v in L2 (]0, T [×Ω)d , as in the case of homogeneous fluids studied in Chapter V. This case is therefore simpler, and justifying the passage to the limit in the approximate problem is more straightforward than in the general case. Furthermore, still in the case where inf ρ0 > 0 and inf ρin > 0, we can show (see [86]) that ρv and v are continuous with respect to the time variable with values in (L2 (Ω))d for the weak topology and also that v(t) converges towards v0 in (L2 (Ω))d for the strong topology as t → 0 (because we have chosen v0 which is divergence-free).

Chapter VII

Boundary conditions modelling

In this chapter, we consider two different problems related to boundary conditions that one may encounter when trying to compute numerical approximations of real flows. These problems arise when the computational domain is not exactly the original physical domain which is of interest. • In Section 1, we consider the case where the computational domain is strictly smaller than the physical domain (for saving computational ressources, for instance, or because the physical domain is unbounded). Therefore, we need to propose artificial boundary conditions on the nonphysical part of the boundary and to analyse the resulting system. We discuss flows for which the velocity is prescribed at one part of the boundary whilst being able to flow freely at another. An example of this type of situation is a network of pipes for which the input velocity is imposed at a certain number of points in the network but remains unknown at the output. From a mathematical and numerical point of view it is necessary to choose boundary conditions on the outflow part of the boundary. In this section, we propose a nonlinear boundary condition aiming at providing a stable solution of the Navier–Stokes equations, that we hope to be close enough to the real flow. • Conversely, in Section 2, we consider the case where the computational domain is greater than the physical domain. This is called the fictitious domain approach. This often occurs when one wants to avoid the difficulties related to numerical methods on unstructured or moving meshes. We refer to the part of the computational domain which is not in the physical domain as the obstacle. In this section, we are interested in taking into account Dirichlet boundary conditions for the Navier–Stokes equations on the real physical boundary by using a penalty method which consists in adding some unphysical term in the equations inside the obstacle which aims at taking into account for real boundary conditions on the boundary of the obstacle. We show that F. Boyer and P. Fabrie, Mathematical Tools for the Study of the Incompressible Navier-Stokes Equations and Related Models, Applied Mathematical Sciences 183, DOI 10.1007/978-1-4614-5975-0_7, © Springer Science+Business Media New York 2013

453

454

Chapter VII. Boundary conditions modelling

the approximation is well-posed and we analyse its convergence towards the real solution as the penalty parameter goes to 0. In addition to the particular interest of each of these two problems in practical situations, this is the opportunity for us to present mathematical methods which can be useful in many other frameworks.

1 Outflow boundary conditions In general, whatever the physical situation encountered, when we want to compute the flow around an object (such as the classic case of an airflow around the wing of an aircraft, for example) we are required to, more or less arbitrarily, truncate the physical domain so as to obtain a suitable computational domain. When doing so, it is useful to write realistic boundary conditions for the “non-physical” boundaries of the domain so as to arrive at a mathematically well-posed problem which will be able to describe the physical situation under study. Typically, when a flow ceases to be laminar at high values of the Reynolds number, turbulent structures are induced at the exit of the flow (i.e., the place where, on average, the fluid leaves the computational domain), presenting a velocity field that is alternately exiting and re-entering the domain, although the net flow is outward. However, at a point where the velocity field is leaving the domain, we can intuitively understand that it is not necessary to impose a boundary condition whereas in the opposite case, where the velocity field is entering the domain, it is an absolute necessity to provide some boundary condition. In order to deal with this difficulty we describe weakly reflective boundary conditions downstream of the flow, that is, which will not contribute to increasing the energy of the system too much. These boundary conditions were first introduced and studied in the references [29, 30]. Extension of these results to the case of the nonhomogeneous Navier–Stokes equation is proposed in [25].

1.1 Setting up the model Let Ω be a bounded Lipschitz domain of Rd , where d = 2 or d = 3. We denote its boundary as Γ = ∂Ω and consider a partition of Γ, Γ = Γ1 ∪ Γ2 where Γ1 and Γ2 have nonzero surface measures. We assume that the Dirichlet boundary data g1 are known on Γ1 (which represents the upstream part of the flow) and we consider the following problem. We need to find a pair (v, p) which is a solution of

1. Outflow boundary conditions

455

⎧ ∂v ⎪ ⎪ + (v · ∇)v − div σ(v, p) = 0, ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ ∂t div v = 0, ⎪ ⎪ v = g1 , ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ v(0) = v0 ,

in Ω, in Ω, on Γ1 ,

(VII.1)

where σ(v, p) = (2/Re)D(v) − p Id is the stress tensor of the flow, the strain rate tensor being defined by D(v) = 12 (∇v + t ∇v). It is also necessary to give a boundary condition (which is not prescribed by the physical situation being modelled) on Γ2 , which accounts as precisely as possible for the downstream part of the flow which is not computed, see Figure VII.1. Clearly, this boundary condition must relate to the stress experienced by the flow across Γ2 . We can, for the moment, express this in the general form σ(v, p).ν = F (v), onΓ2 , (VII.2) where the function F is specified below.

outflow Γ2

inflow Γ1

computational domain

physical domain Fig. VII.1 Truncation of the physical domain for computational purposes

In order to build the boundary condition that we consider, we need to choose some reference flow uref , which is any uref ∈ (H 1 (Ω))d such that uref = g1 on Γ1 . It is important for the efficiency of the method that uref is chosen so as to be a reasonable approximation of the expected flow (which is unknown of course) near Γ2 . In order to simplify the computations, even though it is not necessary at all, we assume that uref is a solution to the following under-determined steady Stokes problem

Chapter VII. Boundary conditions modelling

456

⎧ 1 ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ − div σ(uref , pref ) = − Re Δuref + ∇pref = 0, in Ω, ⎪ ⎪ ⎩

div uref = 0, uref = g1 ,

in Ω, on Γ1 .

(VII.3)

We also need to choose a reference stress tensor σref defined on the outflow part of the boundary Γ2 . Here also to simplify a little, we simply choose σref .ν = σ(uref , pref ).ν ∈ (H −1/2 (∂Ω))d .

(VII.4)

From now on, we assume that uref and σref are fixed and time-independent. We then look for a solution of problem (VII.1) in the form (v = u + uref , p) where u satisfies homogeneous boundary conditions on Γ1 and for which the condition on Γ2 are satisfied in a weak sense. Let us introduce the functional spaces which are naturally associated with this problem 8 9 V = ϕ ∈ (H 1 (Ω))d , ϕ|Γ1 = 0, div ϕ = 0 , H = V , the closure of V in (L2 (Ω))d . Note that those spaces are different (because the Dirichlet boundary condition is only prescribed on Γ1 ) from the spaces V and H introduced in Section 3.3 of Chapter IV. We are, therefore, looking for a pair (u, p), with u(t) ∈ V for almost any t, such that the pair (u + uref , p) satisfies the following weak formulation of problem (VII.1), for all ψ ∈ V Z Z d (u + uref ) · ψ dx + σ(u + uref , p + pref ) : ∇ψ dx dt Ω Ω   Z   1 + ((u + uref ) · ∇)(u + uref ) · ψ − ((u + uref ) · ∇)ψ · (u + uref ) dx 2 Ω Z   1 =− (u + uref ) · ψ (u + uref ) · ν dσ 2 Γ2

+ σ(u + uref , p + pref ).ν, ψ H −1/2 ,H 1/2 . This equation is of course understood in the sense of distributions on ]0, T [. As in Chapter V, we can write a weak formulation with test functions which depend on time. Furthermore, we can add to this formulation the initial data which are satisfied in the weak sense of V  . This formulation takes account of the nonhomogeneous Dirichlet boundary conditions on Γ1 and of the fact that uref is a lifting of this boundary condition. We now need to detail the condition imposed on Γ2 . The idea is as follows. At a place where the flow is outward (i.e., if v · ν = (u + uref ) · ν > 0) then we impose on the fluid the constraint coming from the selected reference flow (in general a nonturbulent flow). In contrast, if v ·ν = (u+uref )·ν < 0 we

1. Outflow boundary conditions

457

need, for stability reasons, to control the increase of energy generated by inertia through the boundary. In other words, in the case where (u + uref ) · ν < 0, it is necessary to take account of the pressure exerted by the fluid situated outside the computational domain (on the other side of Γ2 ) where, of course, we know nothing. By recalling that the square of the norm of a velocity field is homogeneous with the quotient of the pressure over the density, we deduce that the constraint term which we need to add on Γ2 must depend quadratically on the velocity. To take account of both cases (i.e., the inward and outward parts of the boundary), we specify boundary conditions (VII.2) in the form σ(u + uref , p + pref ).ν = −

− 1 (u + uref ) · ν u + σref .ν, on Γ2 . 2

(VII.5)

We recall that the positive and negative parts of any real number are defined in Definition VI.1.1. We show that the choice of the quadratic term in (VII.5) is exactly that which allows us to compensate the energy contained in the contributions of inertia terms on the unphysical parts of the boundary, where the fluid is entering the domain. Remark VII.1.1. • Other boundary conditions of this type can be found in [30]. Furthermore, we note that these boundary conditions actually depend on the reference flow uref , σref . From a physical and numerical point of view, the choice of a “good” reference flow is clearly crucial. Indeed, we observe that (VII.5) is exactly satisfied if it happens that v = uref ; that is, u = 0. Therefore, if we are able to choose, a priori, (uref , σref ) not too far from the expected solution, then the computed solution will be close to the exact flow. This of course depends on the physical situation under study. • In [25], the same kind of boundary condition is studied in the case of incompressible nonhomogeneous flows (i.e., the same model that we studied in Chapter VI). In particular, it is shown that σref and uref do not need to be related by the relation (VII.4) and may also depend on time. If we take this boundary condition (VII.5) into the problem and if we consider the fact that uref is a solution of the steady Stokes problem (VII.3), then the weak formulation which we study now can be written as follows, for any test function ψ ∈ V , Z Z d u · ψ dx + σ(u, p) : ∇ψ dx dt Ω Ω Z   1 + ((u + uref ) · ∇)(u + uref ) · ψ − ((u + uref ) · ∇)ψ · (u + uref ) dx 2 Ω Z Z   1 1 (u + uref ) · ψ (u + uref ) · ν dσ = − (u · ψ)((u + uref ) · ν)− dσ. + 2 Γ2 2 Γ2

Chapter VII. Boundary conditions modelling

458

By using the fact that the doubly contracted product of a symmetric tensor with an asymmetric tensor is zero, we obtain for all ψ ∈ V that   2 1 t σ(u, p) : ∇ψ = D(u) : D(ψ) + (∇ψ − ∇ψ) − p (div ψ), Re 2 2 = D(u) : D(ψ). Re Finally, the weak formulation on u no longer explicitly contains the pressure term, reducing the problem to looking for t → u(t) ∈ V which satisfies, for all ψ ∈ V , the following equation in the sense of D (]0, T [),   d 2 u · ψ dx + D(u) : D(ψ) dx dt Ω Re Ω      1 + ((u + uref ) · ∇)(u + uref ) · ψ − ((u + uref ) · ∇)ψ · (u + uref ) dx 2 Ω     + 1 1 + u · ψ (u + uref ) · ν dσ = − (uref · ψ)((u + uref ) · ν) dσ. 2 Γ2 2 Γ2 (VII.6)

1.2 Existence and uniqueness In this section we prove the following result. Theorem VII.1.1. Let Ω be a connected, bounded, Lipschitz domain of Rd , with d ∈ {2, 3}. Let Re > 0, g1 ∈ (H 1/2 (Γ))d and (uref , pref ) be the unique solution of (VII.3). For all v0 ∈ uref + H and all T > 0, there exists u ∈ L∞ (]0, T [, H) ∩ 2 L (]0, T [, V ) a solution of (VII.6) such that for all ψ ∈ V we have    u · ψ dx (0) = u0 · ψ dx, (VII.7) Ω

Ω

with u0 = v0 − uref . 4 Moreover, we have du/dt ∈ L d (]0, T [, V  ) and the solution u is unique in dimension d = 2. Finally, there exists p ∈ W −1,∞ (]0, T [, L2 (Ω)) such that the pair (v = uref + u, p) is a solution of the Navier–Stokes equations in Ω. The initial condition (VII.7) has a meaning because for any solution of (VII.6), we see that t → Ω u · ψ dx is continuous with respect to time, using Corollary II.4.2.

1. Outflow boundary conditions

459

1.2.1 Definition of an approximate problem We now return to the functional space V introduced above. This space is a closed subspace of (H 1 (Ω))d and in particular a separable Hilbert space. Therefore, it possesses a countable Hilbert basis (wk )k . Let us construct an approximate problem which is suitable for the weak formulation (VII.6). Let HN be the vector space generated by the functions (wk )k≤n . We consider the following Galerkin approximation: to find t → uN (t) ∈ HN a solution for all ψ ∈ HN of   d 2 uN · ψ dx + D(uN ) : D(ψ) dx dt Ω Re Ω     1  + ((uN +uref ) · ∇)(uN +uref ) · ψ − ((uN +uref ) · ∇)ψ · (uN +uref ) dx 2 Ω     +    1 1 + uN · ψ (uN + uref ) · ν dσ = − uref · ψ (uN + uref ) · ν dσ. 2 Γ2 2 Γ2 (VII.8) In this case, we do not use a special basis constructed from the eigenfunctions of a well-chosen operator, contrary to our approach in Chapter V. The reason is that the study of the Stokes operator with mixed boundary conditions of the Dirichlet type on Γ1 and Neumann conditions on Γ2 introduces additional difficulties that we do not wish to address here. Because of this, we do not know a priori that the functions wk are regular and, moreover, we do not know how to estimate the norm of the orthogonal projection PN : H → HN ⊂ H considered as a (nonorthogonal) projection in V . Hence, we cannot obtain an estimate of the time derivative of the approximate solutions in the same way as in Lemma V.1.6 in Chapter V. For this reason, we replace here this estimate of duN /dt by an estimate over the fractional derivatives with respect to time. We get this estimate by using the Fourier transform with respect to time introduced in Section 5.4 of Chapter II. By using Proposition II.5.23, we obtain an estimate of the approximate solution in a well chosen Nikolskii space. This is sufficient to obtain the compactness properties that we need (see Theorem II.5.17). This general approach is well-described in the case of the Navier–Stokes equations with usual Dirichlet boundary conditions in [84].

1.2.2 The energy inequality Proposition VII.1.2. The approximate system (VII.8) has a unique global solution on R+ and for all T > 0 there exists a constant C, independent of N , such that

Chapter VII. Boundary conditions modelling

460

sup uN (t)2L2 t≤T 

T



+ 0

1 + Re



T

∇uN (t)2L2 dt 0

+  |uN |2 (uN + uref ) · ν dσ dt ≤ C.

(VII.9)

Γ2

Proof. In the usual way, Equation (VII.8) is equivalent to a system of finite dimensional ordinary differential equations. The existence and uniqueness of a solution of this system over a maximal time interval [0, TN [ comes from the Cauchy–Lipschitz theorem. It is now sufficient to establish an energy inequality with bounds independent of N , in order to prove that the solution is global and the associated estimate (VII.9). This energy inequality is obtained by selecting ψ = uN (t) = (uN (t) + uref ) − uref as a test function and by being aware of the time dependence of ψ. It follows  +  1 d 2 1 |uN |2 (uN + uref ) · ν dσ uN 2L2 + D(uN )2L2 + 2 dt Re 2 Γ2      ((uN + uref ) · ∇)uN · uref − ((uN + uref ) · ∇)uref · uN dx ≤ Ω     1 uN · uref (uN + uref ) · ν dσ + 2 Γ2   ≤uN + uref L3 ∇uN L2 uref L6 + uN L6 ∇uref L2 + uN + uref L8/3 (Γ2 ) uN L8/3 (Γ2 ) uref L4 (Γ2 ) . From the Sobolev inequalities (Proposition III.2.35), we can bound the 1/2 1/2 quantity uN L3 from above by CuN L2 ∇uN L2 . Moreover, we bound uN L8/3 (Γ2 ) from above by uN L8/3 (Γ) and hence from Theorem III.2.36 and the generalised Poincar´e inequality (Proposition III.2.38), we obtain 1/4

3/4

uN L8/3 (Γ2 ) ≤ CuN L2 ∇uN L2 . We note that these inequalities are equally valid in dimension 2 and in dimension 3. We also recall that uref is a fixed reference steady flow in (H 1 (Ω))d so that there exists a C > 0 which only depends on uref and on Ω, such that  +  2 1 1 d 2 2 |uN |2 (uN + uref ) · ν dσ uN L2 + D(uN )L2 + 2 dt Re 2 Γ2   1/2 3/2 ≤C 1 + ∇uN L2 + uN L2 ∇uN L2 . Now we need to use the Korn inequality (Lemma IV.7.6) in order to control the norm of ∇uN by the norm of D(uN ). Hence, by suitable use of Young’s inequality, this gives

1. Outflow boundary conditions

1 d 2 1 uN 2L2 + D(uN )2L2 + 2 dt Re 2 1 ≤ D(uN )2L2 + C(1 + uN 2L2 ), Re



461

+  |uN |2 (uN + uref ) · ν dσ

Γ2

where C depends on uref . From Gronwall’s lemma, we can deduce from this last inequality the existence of a C(T ) > 0, independent of N such that sup uN (t)2L2 t≤T 

T



+ 0

1 + Re



T

D(uN )2L2 dt 0

+  |uN |2 (uN + uref ) · ν dσ dt ≤ C(T ).

Γ2

The desired inequality (VII.9) is finally obtained by once again using the Korn inequality.  As in Chapter V, we deduce from the estimate above that the approximate solution obtained through the Galerkin method is global on R+ ; that is, that the existence time TN is +∞. Remark VII.1.2. For a smooth bounded domain Ω of R3 , the largest boundary Sobolev space in the family H s (Γ), with s > 0, which embeds into L3 (Γ) is H 1/3 (Γ) (because Γ is a 2-dimensional manifold). This is the trace space associated with the fractional Sobolev space H 5/6 (Ω), since 13 = 56 − 12 . Thanks to the Sobolev embeddings and by using interpolation (Theorem II.5.5) we obtain that the functions of L∞ (]0, T [, L2 (Ω))∩L2 (]0, T [, H 1 (Ω)) only belong to L12/5 (]0, T [, H 5/6 (Ω)). Hence, |u|3 is not integrable on ]0, T [×Γ because it is not regular enough with respect to time. From a mathematical point of view this is a justification of the fact that the outflow boundary condition need be quadratic in order to lead to a well-posed system.

1.2.3 Estimates of fractional derivatives with respect to time It is now useful to obtain an additional estimate of the velocity uN in view of passing to the limit in the nonlinear terms by the compactness theorems. We now use the fractional derivatives with respect to time and more precisely the Fourier transform in the time variable, the properties of which we detailed in Section 5.4 of Chapter II. We return to using the notation u' N to designate the extension by 0 of uN to all the time interval R. Proposition VII.1.3. For all T > 0, and for all σ < 1/6, there exists a C > 0, independent of N , such that:  2 |τ |2σ F(u' N )(τ )L2 dτ ≤ C. R

Chapter VII. Boundary conditions modelling

462

Proof. The test function ψ ∈ HN being fixed, we can extend the ordinary differential equation (VII.8) by 0 outside the interval [0, T ]. We then apply the Fourier transform with respect to time to the equation obtained. Making use of (II.27), for all τ ∈ R this gives:     1 iτ F(u' F ((u' @ ' @ N ) · ψ dx + N +u ref ) · ∇)(u N +u ref ) · ψ dx 2 Ω Ω    1 F (((u' @ ' @ − N +u ref ) · ∇)ψ) · (u N +u ref ) dx 2 Ω     +  2 1 + dσ D (F(u' F (u' ' @ N )) : D(ψ)dx + N · ψ) (u N +u ref ) · ν Re Ω 2 Γ2    1 (uref · ψ)F (u' @ =− N +u ref ) · ν dσ 2 Γ2   1 e−iτ T (VII.10) +√ uN (0) · ψ dx − √ uN (T ) · ψ dx. 2π Ω 2π Ω We note that since ψ does not depend on time, the third term can be expressed by a purely algebraic manipulation    F (((u' @ ' @ N +u ref ) · ∇)ψ) · (u N +u ref ) dx Ω      F (u' @ ' @ : ∇ψ dx. = N +u ref ) ⊗ (u N +u ref ) Ω

The number τ being fixed, we now take ψ = F(u' N )(τ ) in (VII.10) and we obtain     1 2 iτ |F(u' )| dx + F (( u ' + u @ ) · ∇)( u ' + u @ ) · F(u' N N ref N ref N ) dx 2 Ω Ω      1 F (u' + u @ ) ⊗ ( u ' + u @ ) : ∇F(u' − N ref N ref N ) dx 2 Ω  2     +  2 1 D F( u ' + ) dx + F ( u ' + u @ ) · ν u' ' N N ref N · F(u N ) dσ Re Ω 2 Γ2    1 (uref · F(u' ' @ =− N ))F (u N +u ref ) · ν dσ 2 Γ2   1 e−iτ T +√ uN (0) · F(u' uN (T ) · F(u' N ) dx − √ N ) dx. 2π Ω 2π Ω We then note that the first term in the left-hand side is pure imaginary whereas the term coming from the viscous stresses a nonnegative real number. The estimate of interest to us is that of the first term. We therefore estimate the absolute value of the imaginary part of the above equation. We obtain

1. Outflow boundary conditions 2 |τ |kF(uf N )kL2

463

Z   1 g f g f ≤ F ((uf N +u ref ) · ∇)(u N +u ref ) · F(u N ) dx 2 Ω Z    1 + F (uf g f g : ∇F(uf N +u ref ) ⊗ (u N +u ref ) N ) dx 2 Ω Z  +  1 + F (uf + u g ) · ν u f · F( u f ) dσ N ref N N 2 Γ2 Z  1 + (uref · F(uf f g N ))F (u N +u ref ) · ν dσ 2 Γ2 Z Z 1 1 . √ + √ uN (0) · F(uf ) dx + u (T ) · F( u f ) dx N N N 2π Ω 2π Ω (VII.11)

We refer to the six terms on the right-hand side of this inequality as 1 6 IN (τ ), . . . , IN (τ ) and let us try to estimate them. 1 • Term IN (τ ): From the estimates (VII.9), the sequence (uN )N is bounded in the space L2 (]0, T [, (H 1 (Ω))d ) and therefore also in the space L6/5 (]0, T [, (L6 (Ω))d ), thanks to Sobolev embeddings. Hence, the sequence (u' N )N is bounded in the space L6/5 (R, (L6 (Ω))d ). From the Hausdorff–Young theorem (Theorem II.5.20) we therefore have 6 6 d (F(u' N ))N is bounded in L (R, (L (Ω)) ).

(VII.12)

We also have the estimate     (uN + uref ) · ∇ (uN + uref ) 6/5 ≤ ∇(uN + uref )L2 uN + uref L3 L 3/2

1/2

≤ C∇(uN + uref )L2 uN + uref L2 ,     which demonstrates, from (VII.9), that (uN + uref ) · ∇ (uN + uref ) is N d 6/5 6/5 d bounded in L4/3 (]0, T [, (L6/5 (Ω))  ) and hence in L (]0, T[, (L (Ω)) ).   As a consequence, the sequence (u' @ ' @ is bounded N +u ref )·∇ (u N +u ref ) N

in L6/5 (R, (L6/5 (Ω))d ). By using the Hausdorff–Young theorem we can deduce that      F (u' @ ' @ is bounded in L6 (R, (L6/5 (Ω))d ). N +u ref ) · ∇ (u N +u ref ) N

(VII.13) From the H¨ older inequality (with respect to time and space), we deduce from (VII.12) and (VII.13) that 1 (IN )N is bounded in L3 (R).

(VII.14)

464

Chapter VII. Boundary conditions modelling

2 • Term IN : By using the H¨ older inequality and the precise Sobolev inequalities (Proposition III.2.35), we obtain the estimate 2

(uN + uref ) ⊗ (uN + uref )L2 ≤ uN + uref L4 1/2

3/2

≤ C uN + uref L2 ∇(uN + uref )L2 , and hence, using (VII.9), the sequence ((uN + uref ) ⊗ (uN + uref ))N is 4 bounded in L 3 (]0, T [, (L2 (Ω))d×d ). By considering its extension by 0 outside the time interval ]0, T [ and by once again using the Hausdorff–Young theorem, we obtain that (F((u' @ ' @ N + u ref ) ⊗ (u N + u ref )))N is bounded in L4 (R, (L2 (Ω))d×d ). We also deduce from (VII.9) that (∇F(u' N ))N is bounded in L2 (R, (L2 (Ω))d×d ). By combining these two bounds, we get 2 (IN )N is bounded in L4/3 (R).

(VII.15)

3 • Term IN : Theorem III.2.36 allows us to write   ((uN + uref ) · ν)+ uN  2 ≤ uN + uref L4 (Γ2 ) uN L4 (Γ2 ) L (Γ ) 2

≤ CuN + uref H 1 uN H 1 , and hence from (VII.9), we obtain that the sequence (((uN +uref )·ν)+ uN )N is bounded in L1 (]0, T [, (L2 (Γ2 ))d ). Then, we deduce that the sequence + ∞ 2 d (F(((u' @ ' N +u ref ) · ν) u N ))N is bounded in L (R, (L (Γ2 )) ). Furthermore, we have uN L2 (Γ2 ) ≤ uN L2 (Γ) ≤ CuN H 1 , 2 2 and therefore (F(u' N ))N is bounded in L (R, L (Γ2 )). All this shows that 3 (IN )N is bounded in L2 (R).

(VII.16)

4 • Term IN : We treat this term in a similar way to the preceding one and we deduce that 4 (IN )N is bounded in L1 (R). (VII.17) 5 6 and IN : • Terms IN These two similar terms are Dirac mass contributions at t = 0 and t = T which we obtain by differentiating a function extended by 0 outside the 5 time interval ]0, T [ with respect to time. Let us focus on the term IN , which is estimated by 5 IN (τ ) ≤ CuN (0)L2 F(u' N )(τ )L2 .

1. Outflow boundary conditions

465

However, uN (0) = PN (v0 − uref ) is bounded in (L2 (Ω))d independently of N . Furthermore, we have already seen that (VII.9) implies that the 2 2 d sequence (F(u' N ))N is bounded in L (R, (L (Ω)) ). We therefore have 5 6 (IN )N and (IN )N are bounded in L2 (R).

(VII.18)

Now, let δ ∈ [0, 1]. From Young’s inequality we deduce that there exist d1 , d2 > 0 such that |τ |1−δ ≤ d1

|τ | + d2 , ∀τ ∈ R. 1 + |τ |δ

Hence from (VII.11), we have for all τ ∈ R 1 2 3 5 6 IN (τ ) IN (τ ) IN (τ ) + IN (τ ) + IN (τ ) + d + d 1 1 δ δ δ 1 + |τ | 1 + |τ | 1 + |τ | 4 IN (τ ) 2 (VII.19) + d1 + d2 F(u' N )(τ )L2 . 1 + |τ |δ

2 |τ |1−δ F(u' N )(τ )L2 ≤ d1

In order to use the bounds (VII.14) through (VII.18), via the H¨ older inequality, we see that τ → 1/(1 + |τ |δ ) has to belong to L3/2 (R) ∩ L∞ (R). It is indeed clear that this is a bounded function and it is therefore sufficient to choose δ so that it belongs to L3/2 (R). Hence, for all δ ∈] 23 , 1[ from (VII.19) we deduce the estimate  2 |τ |1−δ F(u' N )(τ )L2 dτ ≤ Cδ , R

the number Cδ being independent of N . By setting σ = (1 − δ)/2 we have indeed proved the result. 

1.2.4 Existence of a weak solution It is now possible to pass to the limit in the approximate problem thanks to the following result. Proposition VII.1.4. Assume that d = 3. Even if it means considering a subsequence, there exists a function u and functions w1 , w2 and γ1 satisfying uN −−−− u,

weakly- in L∞ (]0, T [, (L2 (Ω))d ),

uN −−−− u,

weakly in L2 (]0, T [, (H 1 (Ω))d ),

uN −−−− u,

weakly in L2 (]0, T [, (L6 (Ω))d ),

uN −−−−→ u,

in L2 (]0, T [, (L2 (Ω))d ),

N →∞ N →∞ N →∞ N →∞

Chapter VII. Boundary conditions modelling

466

(uN · ∇)uN −−−− w1 ,

weakly in L4/3 (]0, T [, (L6/5 (Ω))d ),

uN ⊗ uN −−−− w2 ,

weakly in L4/3 (]0, T [, (L2 (Ω))d×d ),

N →∞ N →∞



+ (uN + uref ) · ν uN −−−− γ1 , N →∞     uN · ν uref −−−− u · ν uref , N →∞

weakly in L4/3 (]0, T [, (L4/3 (Γ))d ), weakly in L4 (]0, T [, (L4/3 (Γ))d ),

uN −−−− u,

weakly in L4 (]0, T [, (L2 (Γ))d ),

uN −−−−→ u,

in L2 (]0, T [, (L2 (Γ))d ).

N →∞ N →∞

A similar result is valid in dimension d = 2 and provides, in reality, convergence results in higher regularity spaces. We leave this more successful case to the conscientious reader. Proof. The first weak convergences claimed here are obtained directly by using the bounds (VII.9) as well as Theorem II.2.7 in the same way as during the study of the homogeneous Navier–Stokes equations with Dirichlet boundary conditions in Chapter V. The strong convergence of (uN )N in L2 (]0, T [, (L2 (Ω))d ) is a consequence of Theorem II.5.17. Indeed, from the Fourier estimate obtained in Proposition VII.1.3 and Proposition II.5.23, we get a bound of (uN )N in the Nikolskii space N2σ (]0, T [, (L2 (Ω))d ) which is uniform with respect to N . The only point necessary to detail here is the handling of the boundary terms. The first of these is treated using Theorem III.2.36 in the following way 

T

0



4/3

((uN + uref ) · ν)+ uN L4/3 (Γ) dt T



4/3

4/3

uN L8/3 (Γ) uN + uref L8/3 (Γ) dt

0



≤C 0

T



 8/3 4/3 4/3 uN L8/3 (Γ) + uN L8/3 (Γ) uref L8/3 (Γ) dt  8/3

≤Curef L8/3 (Γ) + C

0

T

2/3

uN L2 uN 2H 1 dt

2/3

≤C + CuN L∞ (]0,T [,L2 (Ω)) uN 2L2 (]0,T [,H 1 (Ω)) . Using (VII.9), this inequality shows a bound independent of N in the space L4/3 (]0, T [, (L4/3 (Γ))d ) which is reflexive. This allows us to prove the existence, up to a subsequence, of a weak limit γ1 of this term. The other boundary terms are linear and are treated in a straightforward way. To conclude, it is necessary to justify the strong convergence of the trace of uN in L2 (]0, T [, (L2 (Γ))d ). This is obtained using Theorem III.2.36. Indeed,

1. Outflow boundary conditions

467

we have 1/2

1/2

uN − uL2 (Γ) ≤ CuN − uL2 uN − uH 1 , from which we can deduce using the H¨ older inequality that 



T

uN −u2L2 (Γ)

dt ≤ C

1/2 

T

uN −

0

u2L2

uN −

dt

0

1/2

T

u2H 1

dt

.

0

We have already obtained the strong convergence of uN towards u in L2 (]0, T [, (L2 (Ω))d ) and hence the first term of the right-hand side of this inequality tends towards 0 when N tends towards infinity. Furthermore, the second factor remains bounded thanks to (VII.9). This indeed proves the strong convergence of the trace that we claimed above.  We now need to identify the weak limits w1 , w2 , and γ1 exhibited above. To do this, as we have already seen, it is necessary to prove convergence in the spaces that are weaker than those in which we obtained these limits. More precisely, we argue by using the continuity of the product operator in suitable Lebesgue spaces (using the H¨older inequality) and the weak-strong limit property given in Proposition II.2.12. Thanks to convergences obtained above (especially the strong convergence of (uN )n in L2 (]0, T [, (L2 (Ω))d )), we obtain (uN · ∇)uN −−−− (u · ∇)u, N →∞

weakly in L1 (]0, T [, (L1 (Ω))d ), 3

uN ⊗ uN −−−− u ⊗ u, weakly in L1 (]0, T [, (L 2 (Ω))d×d ), N →∞  +  + 4 (uN +uref ) · ν uN −−−− (u+uref )· ν u, weakly in L 3 (]0, T [, (L1 (Γ))d ). N →∞

To handle the boundary term, we use the fact that for any sequence (fN )N which converges in Lp (Γ) towards a function f we have + fN −−−−→ f + , in Lp (Γ). N →∞

This is obtained by noting that the map s → s+ is Lipschitz continuous on R. All these results allow us to identify w1 with (u · ∇)u, w2 with u ⊗ u and γ1  + with (u + uref ) · ν u, by uniqueness of the limit in the sense of distributions (see Proposition II.2.9). Passing to the limit in the weak formulation of the approximate problem is now standard and gives that u is indeed a solution of the initial problem. Finally, by returning to the approach used in the proof of Proposition V.1.3, we show that u has a weak derivative with respect to time in 4 L d (]0, T [, V  ) (because we know that u ∈ L∞ (]0, T [, H) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, V )) and

468

Chapter VII. Boundary conditions modelling

that it also satisfies a weak formulation with test functions which depend on time. This proves the first part of Theorem VII.1.1

1.2.5 Uniqueness in the case d = 2 In this section, we show that the weak solution obtained above is unique in the two-dimensional case. The proof is made as in Chapter V but considering the additional boundary terms. Therefore, let u1 and u2 be two solutions of (VII.6). Their difference, u = u1 − u2 , satisfies !  "       du 1 (u · ∇)(u1 + uref ) + ((u2 + uref ) · ∇)u · ψ dx + ,ψ dt 2 Ω V  ,V        1 − (u · ∇)ψ · (u1 + uref ) + ((u2 + uref ) · ∇)ψ · u dx 2 Ω    + 2 1 + D(u) : D(ψ)dx + (u · ψ) (u1 + uref ) · ν dσ Re Ω 2 Γ2   +  +  1 dσ (u2 · ψ) (u1 + uref ) · ν − (u2 + uref ) · ν + 2 Γ2  1 (uref · ψ)(u · ν) dσ = 0. + 2 Γ2 It is allowed to take ψ = u as a test function in the preceding system because in dimension 2 we have du/dt ∈ L2 (]0, T [, V  ). By using Theorem II.5.12 and the fact that u(0) = u1 (0) − u2 (0) = 0, we obtain for all t ∈ [0, T ], 1 1 d u(t)2H + D(u)2L2 2 dt  Re      1 1 =− (u · ∇)(u1 + uref ) · u dx + (u · ∇)u · (u1 + uref ) dx 2 Ω 2 Ω   +  1 1 |u|2 (u1 + uref ) · ν dσ − (uref · u)(u · ν) dσ − 2 Γ2 2 Γ2   +  +  1 dσ (u2 · ψ) (u1 + uref ) · ν − (u2 + uref ) · ν − 2 Γ2 older inequality, the By using that s → s+ is Lipschitz continuous, the H¨ Sobolev embeddings (Proposition III.2.35), and finally the sharp trace Theorem III.2.36 in dimension d = 2, we get

1. Outflow boundary conditions

469

d 4 u(t)2L2 + D(u)2L2 dt Re ≤u2L4 ∇u1 + ∇uref L2 + uL4 ∇uL2 u1 + uref L4 + u2L3 (Γ2 ) u1 + uref L3 (Γ2 ) + u2L3 (Γ2 ) (u2 L3 (Γ2 ) + ur L3 (Γ2 ) ) ≤CuL2 ∇uL2 u1 + uref H 1 1/2

3/2

1/2

1/2

+ CuL2 ∇uL2 u1 + uref L2 u1 + uref H 1   2/3 4/3 1/3 2/3 1/3 2/3 + CuL2 ∇uL2 u2 L2 u2 H 1 + uref L2 uref H 1 . We now need to use the Korn inequality (Lemma IV.7.6) to make the term D(u)L2 appear on the right-hand side. By again using Young’s inequality, we obtain d 4 2 u(t)2L2 + D(u)2L2 ≤ D(u)2L2 + Cg(t)u2L2 , dt Re Re which, of course, gives 2 d u(t)2L2 + D(u)2L2 ≤ Cg(t)u2L2 , dt Re

(VII.20)

the function g(t) being given by g(t) = 1 + u1 + uref 2H 1 + u1 + uref 2L2 u1 + uref 2H 1 + u2 2H 1 + uref 2H 1 + u2 L2 u2 2H 1 + uref L2 uref 2H 1 . The reference flow uref is independent of time. Moreover, u1 and u2 are two solutions of the problem and thus belong to the space L∞ (]0, T [, H) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, V ), which shows that the real-valued function g above is integrable on ]0, T [. Gronwall’s lemma allows us to deduce from inequality (VII.20) that the function u is identically zero on ]0, T [. Therefore, u1 = u2 and the claim is proved.

1.2.6 Existence of the pressure The existence and regularity of the pressure is demonstrated in a completely identical way as in the proof of the Leray theorem in Chapter V, that is, by using de Rham’s theorem. We thus obtain that v = uref + u and the pressure p satisfies the Navier–Stokes equations in the sense of distributions on ]0, T [×Ω.

470

Chapter VII. Boundary conditions modelling

2 Dirichlet boundary conditions through a penalty method Over the last 30 years, starting from the pioneer works by Peskin [97, 98] in the framework of blood flow simulation inside a beating heart, there have been many attempts to build penalty methods in order to impose homogeneous Dirichlet boundary conditions for the velocity field on the boundary of an obstacle inside a given computational domain. The aim of these methods is to avoid the use of complex (possibly moving) unstructured meshes due to the geometry of the physical domain, when performing numerical simulations. Such an approach allows, for example, the use of spectral methods [74], or finite-difference methods [75] on Cartesian meshes, which are easier to set up and more effective in some cases. Similarly, the use of Cartesian meshes can be more suitable for parallel computations, which are fundamental in particular in the 3D case. This is illustrated in Figure VII.2 which shows, at the top, a triangle mesh required when using a classic discretisation method and below, an uniform Cartesian mesh from a fictitious calculation domain in which the obstacle (grey in the figure) is considered via an additional penalty term in the equations. In this case, the computational domain is the large rectangle. Studies have shown that the penalty term has to be extended over the entire volume of the obstacle to give a correct solution at high Reynolds number [13, 103]. In [34], it was suggested that this technique is able to provide a good approximation of the lift and drag coefficients by integration of the penalty term over the obstacle. This is fundamental for physical applications (e.g., in aeronautics). Similar ideas have also been successfully used in [9, 11, 31, 35, 36] to deal with fluid–porous or fluid–porous–solid systems. Several researchers have used, for instance, this method to compute the flow of an incompressible fluid around an obstacle [9, 28, 29, 30, 75] or the motion of a rigid body in a viscous incompressible flow [20, 81]. To be more precise, in this section we consider the following penalty method ⎧ ε ∂u 1 1 ε ε ε ε ε ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ ∂t − Re Δu + (u · ∇)u + ε2 χω u + ∇p = f, in Ω, (VII.21) div uε = 0, in Ω, ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ ε u = 0, on ∂Ω, in which uε designates the penalised velocity field, Ω is the computational domain, ω the obstacle (supposed here to be at rest) which we wish to penalise, and χω is the corresponding characteristic function (see Figure VII.5). Under these conditions U = Ω \ ω represents the physical domain in which the fluid evolves. We assume that U is connected.

2. Dirichlet boundary conditions through a penalty method

471

Triangular mesh of the fluid domain

Cartesian mesh of an artificial calculation domain and penalised obstacle Fig. VII.2 Classic method and penalty method for calculating the flow around a cylinder

In U, the equation considered is the usual Navier–Stokes equation; whereas inside the obstacle, since the coefficient ε is small, we expect that the predominant term in the equation will be the term (1/ε2 )χω uε , and so that the equation considered will lead to χω uε ≈ ε2 , so that, asymptotically, we can think that uε will tend to 0 as ε → 0. Finally, we hope that, in the fluid domain U, uε is close to the physical solution which is of course not defined in the obstacle. From the theoretical point of view, an error estimate for this particular method was first established in [10]. These estimates did not agree with experimental results. Indeed, it was shown in this reference that the error was at least of order ε1/2 in the fluid, whereas the numerical results seemed to show that the error is of order ε. In this section, we prove (following [35, 37]) that the error generated by the method is indeed effectively of order ε. To achieve that objective, and this is the second goal of this section, we prove that the presence of the penalty term leads to the appearance of a boundary layer inside the obstacle, but not in the fluid region. The careful study of this boundary layer is the key point of the proof of the sharp error estimate. Boundary layer theory is fundamental in PDE analysis and, in particular, for problems in fluid mechanics. Our objective is not to propose

472

Chapter VII. Boundary conditions modelling

here a general theory, but only to illustrate the concept of boundary layer with a concrete example issued from a numerical problem. We propose to establish the existence of the boundary layer by carrying out an asymptotic expansion of the solution, in the spirit of the WKB method (Wentzel–Kramers–Brillouin). Note that such an analysis requires knowing in advance that the solution of the limit problem is regular enough. Furthermore, in the present case, we obtain a global error estimate rather than one which concerns only the fluid domain. This requires us to describe the error in Sobolev spaces with small indices because the penalised solution cannot be smooth in the whole computational domain Ω. In order to show that the results obtained are optimal in some sense, as well as to illustrate the concept of boundary layers and the technique employed in the sequel, we first describe a simple example of a 1D problem at the very beginning of this section. For such a toy system, we show through an explicit calculation that the error between the penalised solution and the exact solution is exactly of order ε in the L2 -norm.

2.1 A simple example of a boundary layer Before we start the study of the problem described above, we illustrate, using an example, the behavior of an equation describing a boundary layer when one of the equation’s parameters tends towards 0. We are attempting to solve the following one-dimensional problem  −u (x) = 1, in ]0, 1[, (VII.22) u(0) = u(1) = 0. A straightforward computation shows that the exact solution is given by u0 (x) =

1 x(1 − x). 2

Let us assume that we wish to solve this problem using a penalty method similar to that described above. For example, being given a small parameter ε, we replace Problem (VII.22) by the following penalised problem: ⎧ ⎨ −uε  (x) + 1 χ ε ]−1,0[ u = 1, in ] − 1, 1[, ε2 (VII.23) ⎩ uε (−1) = uε (1) = 0. If we make an analogy with the model described in the introduction, the computational domain is Ω =] − 1, 1[, the obstacle is ω =] − 1, 0[, and the “physical” domain is U = Ω \ ω.

2. Dirichlet boundary conditions through a penalty method

473

We now proceed to calculate the exact solution of the approximate problem and see in what way it converges towards the solution u0 in the initial problem when ε tends towards zero. To solve (VII.23), we start by solving the problem on ] − 1, 0[ and, independently, on ]0, 1[. For now we do not have a boundary condition at x = 0 and therefore we have an indeterminate term for each part of the solution. After straightforward computations, we obtain ⎧ ⎨ 1 (1 − x)(x + β), in ]0, 1[, uε (x) = 2 x ⎩ −x 2 A0 e ε + B0 e ε − ε , in ] − 1, 0[, where β, A0 , and B0 are constants to be determined. The boundary condition uε (−1) = 0 leads to A0 e1/ε + B0 e−1/ε = ε2 . (VII.24) It is now necessary to write the conditions connecting the two parts of the solution. We know that the solution of (VII.23) in the variational sense is defined a priori in H01 (] − 1, 1[) but, if we write the equation in the following way, 1 uε  = −1 + 2 χ]−1,0[ uε ∈ L2 (] − 1, 1[), ε we see that in reality the solution belongs to H 2 (] − 1, 1[). This implies that the function uε and its derivative uε  are continuous on [−1, 1]. This gives us the two compatibility conditions between the two parts of the solution obtained above. It hence follows that 1 β = A0 + B0 − ε2 , 2 1 1 1 (1 − β) = − A0 + B0 . 2 ε ε

(VII.25) (VII.26)

Equations (VII.24) through (VII.26) give us the expressions for the constants β, A0 , and B0 as a function of ε. After some tedious calculations, we find ⎧ 1 ⎪ ε2 (1 + ε) − (ε3 + 2ε )e− ε ⎪ ⎪ A0 = ⎪ 1 1 , ⎪ ⎪ (1 + ε)e ε + (1 − ε)e− ε ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ 1 ⎨ ε2 (1 − ε) + (ε3 + 2ε )e ε B0 = 1 1 , ⎪ (1 + ε)e ε + (1 − ε)e− ε ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ 1 1 ⎪ ⎪ 4ε2 − (2ε2 − ε)e ε − (2ε2 + ε)e− ε ⎪ ⎪ β = . ⎩ 1 1 (1 + ε)e ε + (1 − ε)e− ε These exact expressions are not of much interest in themselves. Let us look at the behavior of the coefficients as a function of ε by remembering that, unlike for β, the constants A0 and B0 appear in front of exponential terms in the expression for uε . Asymptotically, we have the following equivalents

474

Chapter VII. Boundary conditions modelling

A0 ≈ ε2 e−1/ε , ε B0 ≈ , 2 β ≈ ε, Hence, the penalised solution uε can be expressed, up to first-order, as ⎧ ε x 2 − 1+x 2 ⎪ in ] − 1, 0[, ⎨ε e ε + eε − ε , 2 ε u (x) ≈ 1 ⎪ ⎩ (1 − x)(x + ε) = u0 (x) + ε (1 − x), in ]0, 1[. 2 2 We see that this method approaches the solution u0 of the initial problem at the order ε in the original domain ]0, 1[ and this is true for all Sobolev norms. Let us now consider the behavior of the approximate solution in “the obstacle”, that is, in ] − 1, 0[ (see Figures VII.3 and VII.4). We observe that it tends towards zero, but only in the L∞ norm. Indeed, if we look at the convergence of the first derivative, we find 1 uε  (x) ≈ −εe−(1+x)/ε + ex/ε , 2 which tends towards 1/2, for example, at x = 0. This is satisfactory because the value of the derivative of the exact solution u0 at x = 0 is exactly 1/2. Nevertheless, this damages the convergence of uε towards 0 in Sobolev spaces of higher exponent in ]−1, 0[. We obtain, in a more precise way, the estimates uε L2 (]−1,0[) ∼ Cε3/2 , √ uε  L2 (]−1,0[) ∼ C ε, 1 uε  L2 (]−1,0[) ∼ C √ . ε This phenomenon is called a boundary layer because the derivatives of the approximate solution have relatively high values in a transition zone of width ε in the neighborhood of the boundary of the penalty zone. It is very important to note that the boundary layer only appears inside the penalised domain and does not perturb the approximation inside the original domain ]0, 1[. We observe and describe the same phenomenon below for the problem of the flow of an incompressible viscous fluid around an obstacle. We also show in this case that the boundary layer appears only inside the obstacle and not in the fluid domain. Furthermore, in the example above we observe that the boundary layer is of size ε and that the solution has a behavior in the form εe−|x|/ε in this boundary layer. This is the reason why, in the study below, we look for an asymptotic expansion of the solution with terms in the form

2. Dirichlet boundary conditions through a penalty method

|

0

|

0

475

ε = 0.1

ε = 0.05

| 0

| 0

|

0

|

0

ε = 0.01

ε = 0.005

| 0

| 0

Fig. VII.3 General appearance of the exact solution (thin line) and the penalised solution (thick line) for ε = 0.1, 0.05, 0.01, 0.005

 W

t, x,

d(x, ∂ω) ε

 ,

where the last variable (referred to as z in the sequel) aims to describe the solution inside the boundary layer.

|

0

| 0 Fig. VII.4 Zoom in at the point x = 0: the exact solution (thin line) and penalised solution (thick line) for ε = 0.1, 0.05, 0.01, 0.005

Chapter VII. Boundary conditions modelling

476

Remark VII.2.1. The artificial boundary conditions chosen at x = −1, are hardly important in this problem. Hence if we replace the Dirichlet boundary condition by a Neumann type of boundary condition uε  (−1) = 0, then the general formula for the solution is unchanged but the relations satisfied by A0 , B0 , and β are now (VII.25), (VII.26), and a new condition in x = −1 which replaces (VII.24) given by −

A0 1/ε B0 −1/ε e + e = 0. ε ε

We can then show that we have the following asymptotics A0 ≈ εe−2/ε , B0 ≈

ε , and β ≈ ε. 2

and therefore on [−1, 0], we have ε uε (x) ≈ ε2 e−(x+2)/ε + ex/ε − ε2 . 2 The general behavior of the solution is therefore the same as the one observed above.

2.2 Statement of the main result We can now state the main result concerning the penalty method for the Navier–Stokes equations around an obstacle. To simplify the calculations we assume that the Reynolds number is equal to 1. This is legitimate because we are not interested here in a viscous boundary layer (that one can observe in the inviscid limit Re → 0) but in the boundary layer induced by the penalty method. Furthermore, we show that this boundary layer only develops inside the penalised obstacle and does not therefore perturb the solution in the viscous boundary√layer which develops inside the fluid domain with a characteristic size of Re. Throughout this section Ω designates a smooth bounded domain (at least of class C 5,1 ) of Rd , d = 2, or 3 and ω is a bounded subdomain of Ω, with same regularity as Ω, such that ω ⊂ Ω. We denote the fluid domain as U = Ω\ω. In this context, we first recall the existence and regularity results for the solution of the Navier–Stokes equations (Theorems V.2.1 and V.2.10 and Corollary V.2.11). Proposition VII.2.1. Let v0 ∈ (H 5 (U))d ∩ V and f ∈ C 2 ([0, +∞[, (H 4 (U))d ) satisfying the compatibility conditions (V.54). Then, there exists a final time

2. Dirichlet boundary conditions through a penalty method

477

ω



x ϕ(x) = d(x, ∂ω)

U

Fig. VII.5 The calculation domain Ω containing the fluid domain U and the obstacle ω

T ∗ > 0 and there exists a unique pair (V 0 , p0 ) defined on [0, T ∗ [×U satisfying ⎧ ∂V 0 ⎪ ⎪ − ΔV 0 + (V 0 · ∇)V 0 + ∇p0 = f, ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ ∂t 0 div V = 0, ⎪ ⎪ V 0 = 0, ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ 0 V (0) = v0 ,

in U, in U, on ∂U,

and such that for all T < T ∗ , we have ⎧ V0 ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ∂V 0 ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ∂t ⎪ ⎨ 2 0 ∂ V ⎪ ∂t2 ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ p0 ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ 0 ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ ∂p ∂t

∈ C 0 ([0, T ], (H 5 (U))d ) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, (H 6 (U))d ), ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], (H 3 (U))d ) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, (H 4 (U))d ), ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], (H 1 (U))d ) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, (H 2 (Ω))d ),

(VII.27)

∈ C 0 ([0, T ], H 4 (U)) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, H 5 (U)), ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], H 2 (U)) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, H 3 (U)).

Moreover, in the case of the dimension d = 2, we have T ∗ = +∞. We therefore propose to replace the numerical computation of V 0 in the fluid domain U, by that of uε , a solution of (VII.21) in the domain Ω. We will then prove an error estimate which gives the precise order of magnitude of the error due to this approach. In a precise way, we have the following result. Theorem VII.2.2. Let v0 , f , V 0 and T ∗ be as in Proposition VII.2.1. We define a perturbation of the initial data of the form

Chapter VII. Boundary conditions modelling

478

 uε0 (x) =

v0 (x) + rε (x), rε (x),

for x ∈ U, for x ∈ ω,

with div rε = 0 and rε L2 (Ω) ≤ Kε. Then, there exists (uε , π ε ), a weak solution of the penalised problem ⎧ ε 1 ∂u ⎪ ⎪ − Δuε + (uε · ∇)uε + ∇π ε + 2 χω uε = f, in Ω, ⎪ ⎪ ∂t ε ⎪ ⎨ div uε = 0, in Ω, ⎪ ε ⎪ u = 0, on ∂Ω, ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ ε ε u (0) = u0 , such that for all T < T ∗ , there exists a constant C independent of ε such that uε L∞ (]0,T [,(L2 (Ω))d ) + uε L2 (]0,T [,(H01 (Ω))d ) ≤ C. Moreover, uε is an approximation of order 1 of V 0 in U in the energy norms. This means that for all T < T ∗ there exists C > 0 such that uε − V 0 L∞ (]0,T [,(L2 (U ))d ) + uε − V 0 L2 (]0,T [,(H 1 (U ))d ) ≤ Cε. Finally, (uε )ε tends to zero in ω in the following sense uε L∞ (]0,T [,(L2 (ω))d ) ≤ Cε, √ uε L2 (]0,T [,(H 1 (ω))d ) ≤ C ε. The existence of the solution uε , for a given ε > 0, involves the same techniques as introduced in Chapter V. In dimension 2, this solution is unique. The difficult point is to establish the error estimate. To prove this result, we carry out an asymptotic expansion of the solution uε , which allows us to describe the boundary layer present inside the obstacle ω. We assumed that ω is sufficiently regular, therefore we know (see Section 3.2 of Chapter III) that there exists a neighborhood of ∂ω in ω defined by ω1 = {x ∈ ω, d(x, ∂ω) < η}, in which the function x → δ(x) = d(x, ∂ω) is smooth. Therefore, in all that follows, we fix a function ϕ which is regular on ω and which coincides with δ on ω1 . We note that on ∂ω, we have ∇ϕ = ∇δ = ν, where ν is the inward unit normal of ω and is also the outward unit normal of U on ∂ω because ω and U share a part of their boundary. Furthermore, for any x ∈ ω1 , we have ∇ϕ(x) = ν(P0 (x)), where P0 (x) is the orthogonal projection of x on ∂ω; see (III.66). In particular, in ω1 , we have |∇ϕ| = 1. We can now describe the boundary layer as follows.

2. Dirichlet boundary conditions through a penalty method

479

Theorem VII.2.3. Let v0 , f , V 0 , and T ∗ be as in Proposition VII.2.1. There exist two functions V 1 and V 2 defined in [0, T ∗ [×U, and two functions W 1 and W 2 defined on [0, T ∗ [×ω × R+ , which are sufficiently smooth, such that ⎧ 0 for x ∈ U, V (t, x) + εV 1 (t, x) + ε2 V 2 (t, x) + εvεr (t, x), ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ uε (t, x) =     ⎪ ϕ(x) ϕ(x) ⎪ 1 2 2 ⎪ ⎩ εW t, x, + ε W t, x, + εwεr (t, x), for x ∈ ω, ε ε where vεr and wεr are bounded independently of ε, in L∞ (]0, T [, (L2 )d ) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, (H 1 )d ), for all T < T ∗ . The error estimate given by Theorem VII.2.2 is now a direct consequence of Theorem VII.2.3, which is in fact more precise because it provides a complete description of the first term of the boundary layer in ω. Looking for an asymptotic expansion in the multiscale form above (i.e., introducing the variable ϕ/ε) is known as the WKB method. We first find the equations that the profiles need to satisfy. After that, we prove the existence and regularity of the various terms of the asymptotic expansion obtained. Finally, in the last section, we estimate the size of the remainder and prove the convergence. Remark VII.2.2. In view of the definition of the functions V 1 , V 2 and W 1 , W 2 which follow, we could expect that the remainder terms εvεr and εwεr would have a size of at least ε2 . As usually observed, the WKB method of decomposition into profiles does not necessarily allow us to obtain this result. As in [32] or [38], for example, it is absolutely necessary to write the formal expansion up to second-order terms, in order to prove that the remainders are of order ε.

2.3 Formal asymptotic expansion To construct the asymptotic expansion we proceed using sufficient conditions. This expansion depends in particular on the choice of ϕ and we are not concerned about its uniqueness away from the boundary layer. The expansion has the simple goal of constructing an explicit approximate solution of the problem at a sufficiently high order. Therefore, let uε be a solution of ⎧ ε ∂u 1 ⎪ ⎪ − Δuε + (uε · ∇)uε + ∇π ε + 2 χω uε = f, in Ω, ⎪ ⎪ ε ⎪ ⎨ ∂t ε in Ω, div u = 0, (VII.28) ⎪ ε ⎪ on ∂Ω, ⎪ u = 0, ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ ε u (0, x) = uε0 (x).

Chapter VII. Boundary conditions modelling

480

The first thing to do is to distinguish the behavior of the solution inside the obstacle ω from the one in the fluid domain U. To do this, we denote the restrictions of uε and π ε on U = Ω \ ω ¯ as v ε and pε , respectively, and the ε ε ε restriction of u and π on ω as w and q ε , respectively. The global problem (VII.28) is then equivalent to the following system on the functions v ε , wε , pε , and q ε ⎧ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎨

1 ∂wε − Δwε + (wε · ∇)wε + ∇q ε + 2 wε = 0, in ω, ∂t ε div wε = 0, in ω, ∂v ε − Δv ε + (v ε · ∇)v ε + ∇pε = f, ∂t div v ε = 0,

⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ v ε = wε , ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ∂wε ∂v ε ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ − + pε ν = − + q ε ν, ⎪ ⎪ ∂ν ∂ν ⎪ ⎩ ε v = 0,

(1) (2)

in U,

(3)

in U,

(4) (VII.29)

on ∂ω,

(5)

on ∂ω,

(6)

on ∂Ω. (7)

Remark VII.2.3. Boundary conditions (5) and (6) in the preceding system are the natural transmission conditions which ensure continuity in the sense of the traces of uε and of the normal fluxes (π ε − ∇uε ).ν across ∂ω and hence the existence of a solution uε which belongs to (H 2 (Ω))d . For example, to justify the transmission condition on the fluxes, we can proceed as follows. We take a divergence-free test function ψ ∈ (D(Ω))d and write the weak formulation of (VII.28), using the fact that f is extended by 0 on ω,      ε  d 1 uε · ψ dx + ∇uε : ∇ψ dx + uε · ψ dx (u · ∇)uε · ψ dx + 2 dt Ω ε ω Ω Ω  f · ψ dx. = U

Then, we multiply the equation inside the obstacle (1) by ψ|ω which is certainly not zero on ∂ω and which, since ν is the inward normal to ω, gives through integration by parts      d ∂wε + wε · ψ dx + ∇wε : ∇ψ dx + − q ε ν · ψ dσ dt ω ∂ν ω ∂ω    ε  1 + wε · ψ dx = 0, (w · ∇)wε · ψ dx + 2 ε ω ω then we multiply the equation in the fluid (3) by ψ|U . This gives

2. Dirichlet boundary conditions through a penalty method









∂v ε − ∇v ε : ∇ψ dx + + pε ν ∂ν U ∂ω U   ε  ε + f · ψ dx. (v · ∇)v · ψ dx =

d dt

481



v ε · ψ dx +

U

· ψ dσ

U

We now add together the last two equations and compare the result to the first one, recalling that v ε and wε are restrictions of uε of U and ω, respectively. It then remains       ∂wε ∂v ε + − − q ε ν · ψ dσ + + pε ν · ψ dσ = 0. ∂ν ∂ν ∂ω ∂ω This relation must be satisfied by all the test functions ψ which proves Equation (6). Let us look for the asymptotic expansion of v ε , wε , pε , and q ε in the following form (this is called an ansatz) ⎧ ε v (t, x) = V 0 (t, x) + εV 1 (t, x) + . . . , ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ 1 1 ⎪ ⎪ pε (t, x) = 2 p−2 (t, x) + p−1 (t, x) + p0 (t, x) + . . . , ⎪ ⎪ ε  ε ⎨   ϕ(x) ϕ(x) ε 0 1 + εW + ..., t, x, t, x, (t, x) = W w ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ε ε ⎪ ⎪       ⎪ ⎪ 1 ϕ(x) ϕ(x) ϕ(x) 1 ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ q ε (t, x) = 2 q −2 t, x, + q −1 t, x, + q 0 t, x, .... ε ε ε ε ε (VII.30) Furthermore, as we saw in the 1D example considered at the beginning of this section, it is reasonable to look for the various profile terms inside the obstacle in the form: i ' i (t, x, z), W i (t, x, z) = W (t, x) + W

q i (t, x, z) = q i (t, x) + qi (t, x, z), i

where W and q i are the interior terms of the profile, that is, those which ' i and qi describe do not contribute to the boundary layer, and in contrast W the behavior inside the boundary layer. This precisely means that, at a fixed ' i (t, x, ϕ(x)/ε) = 0. By taking inspiration x in ω, we should have limε→0 W again from the 1D example of Section 2.1, where we obtained boundary layer profiles of the form g(x)e−|x|/ε , we expect that the decrease with respect to ' i and qi is very rapid. the scalar variable z of the profiles W ' i and qi as well as their Hence, below, we will impose the condition that W derivatives with respect to z, tend towards 0 when z tends towards infinity; that is, for any i and k ≥ 0, ' i −−−−−→ 0 and ∂zk qi −−−−−→ 0, ∀(t, x) ∈ [0, T ∗ [×ω. ∂zk W z→+∞

z→+∞

(VII.31)

Chapter VII. Boundary conditions modelling

482

At the end, we show that we are indeed able to construct profiles satisfying this hypothesis and that the decrease in z is exponential as we would expect.

2.3.1 Determining the profile equations Henceforth, for the functions W (t, x, z), the standard notation for differential operators ∇, div, Δ represents the operators acting only on the original space variables x. We denote the derivatives with respect to the boundary layer variable z as Wz , Wzz , and so on. Thus, for any vector field (t, x, z) → W (t, x, z), the function defined by (t, x) → w(t, x) = W (t, x, ϕ(x)/ε) satisfies the formulas ⎧ 1 ⎪ ⎪ ∇w = ∇W + Wz ⊗ ∇ϕ, ⎪ ⎪ ε ⎪ ⎨ 1 (VII.32) div w = div W + Wz · ∇ϕ, ⎪ ε ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ Δw = ΔW + 2 ∇Wz .∇ϕ + 1 (Δϕ)Wz + 1 |∇ϕ|2 Wzz , ε ε ε2 and for any scalar function (t, x, z) → Π(t, x, z), the function (t, x) → π(t, x) = Π (t, x, ϕ(x)/ε) satisfies 1 ∇π = ∇Π + Πz ∇ϕ. ε Finally, we remember that in ω1 the function ϕ satisfies |∇ϕ| = 1, and that at the boundary ∂ω we have ∇ϕ = ν, the outward normal to the fluid domain U, which is also the inward normal to the obstacle ω. The general principle is now as follows: we introduce the formal expressions (VII.30) in the equations (VII.29), which we have written as a function of the derivatives with respect to x and z; then we formally identify the terms corresponding to each power of ε, even in the boundary conditions.

2.3.1.1 Asymptotic expansion of Equation (1) of (VII.29) • Order ε−2 : 0 + W 0 + qz−1 ∇ϕ = 0, −Wzz

and hence, if we use hypothesis (VII.31) by taking the limit of this equation when z tends towards +∞, it follows 0

W = 0, and by difference, we obtain

in ω,

(VII.33)

2. Dirichlet boundary conditions through a penalty method

'0 + W ' 0 + q −1 ∇ϕ = 0, −W zz z

483

in ω × R+ .

(VII.34)

• Order ε−1 : 1 −Wzz + W 1 − 2∇Wz0 .∇ϕ − ΔϕWz0 + (W 0 · ∇ϕ)Wz0 + ∇q −1 + qz0 ∇ϕ = 0;

hence when z tends towards infinity, by again using hypothesis (VII.31), we obtain W 1 + ∇q −1 = 0, in ω, (VII.35) and through the difference with the equation above 1 ' 1 − 2(∇ϕ · ∇W 'z0 ) − ΔϕW 'z0 'zz +W −W −1 + q0 ∇ϕ = 0, 'z0 + ∇q@ + (W 0 · ∇ϕ)W z

in ω × R+ .

(VII.36)

• Order ε0 : ∂W 0 2 − 2∇Wz1 .∇ϕ − ΔϕWz1 − ΔW 0 − Wzz ∂t + (W 0 · ∇)W 0 + (W 1 · ∇ϕ)Wz0 + (W 0 · ∇ϕ)Wz1 + ∇q 0 + qz1 ∇ϕ + W 2 = 0,

in ω × R+ .

Hence, by again making z tend towards +∞, we obtain 0

∂W 0 0 0 2 − ΔW + (W · ∇)W + ∇q 0 + W = 0, ∂t

in ω,

(VII.37)

and once again from the difference this gives '0 ∂W 2 'z1 .∇ϕ − ΔϕW 'z1 − ΔW '0 'zz − 2∇W −W ∂t ' 0 · ∇)W 0 + (W 0 · ∇)W ' 0 + (W 1 · ∇ϕ)W ' 0 + (W 0 · ∇ϕ)W '1 + (W z

' 2 = 0, + ∇q0 + qz1 ∇ϕ + W

in ω × R . +

z

(VII.38)

• Order ε: In ω × R+ this gives ∂W 1 3 − 2∇Wz2 .∇ϕ − ΔϕWz2 − ΔW 1 + (W 0 · ∇)W 1 + (W 1 · ∇)W 0 − Wzz ∂t + (W 0 · ∇ϕ)Wz2 + (W 1 · ∇ϕ)Wz1 + (W 2 · ∇ϕ)Wz0 + ∇q 1 + qz2 ∇ϕ + W 3 = 0. When z tends towards infinity, in ω × R+ we obtain 1

∂W 1 0 1 1 0 3 − ΔW + (W · ∇)W + (W · ∇)W + ∇q 1 + W = 0. (VII.39) ∂t

Chapter VII. Boundary conditions modelling

484

2.3.1.2 Asymptotic expansion of Equation (2) in (VII.29) • Order ε−1 : • Order ε0 :

' 0 · ∇ϕ = 0, W

in ω × R+ .

(VII.40)

∇ϕ · Wz1 + div W 0 = 0,

and hence 0

div W = 0, in ω,

(VII.41)

'z1 + div W ' 0 = 0, in ω × R+ . ∇ϕ · W • Order ε:

(VII.42)

∇ϕ · Wz2 + div W 1 = 0;

hence 1

div W = 0, in ω,

(VII.43)

'z2 + div W ' 1 = 0, in ω × R+ . ∇ϕ · W • Order ε2 :

(VII.44)

∇ϕ · Wz3 + div W 2 = 0;

hence, when z tends towards infinity, we have 2

div W = 0, • Order ε3 :

in ω.

(VII.45)

∇ϕ · Wz4 + div W 3 = 0;

hence, as before, 3

div W = 0,

in ω.

(VII.46)

2.3.1.3 Asymptotic expansion of Equation (3) in (VII.29) • Order ε0 : ∂V 0 − ΔV 0 + (V 0 · ∇)V 0 + ∇p0 = f, ∂t

in U.

(VII.47)

• Order ε1 : ∂V 1 − ΔV 1 + (V 0 · ∇)V 1 + (V 1 · ∇)V 0 + ∇p1 = 0, ∂t • Order ε2 :

in U.

(VII.48)

2. Dirichlet boundary conditions through a penalty method

485

∂V 2 − ΔV 2 + (V 0 · ∇)V 2 + (V 1 · ∇)V 1 + (V 2 · ∇)V 0 + ∇p2 = 0, ∂t

in U. (VII.49)

2.3.1.4 Asymptotic expansion of Equation (4) in (VII.29) At all orders we obtain the relations div V 0 = div V 1 = div V 2 = 0,

in U.

(VII.50)

2.3.1.5 Asymptotic expansion of Equation (5) in (VII.29) We easily obtain the relations V 0 = W 0, V 1 = W 1, V 2 = W 2,

on ∂ω × {z = 0}.

(VII.51)

2.3.1.6 Asymptotic expansion of Equation (6) in (VII.29) • Order ε−1 :

− Wz0 + q −1 ν = 0,

on ∂ω × {z = 0}.

(VII.52)

• Order ε0 : −

∂V 0 ∂W 0 − Wz1 + q 0 ν = p0 ν − , ∂ν ∂ν

on ∂ω × {z = 0}.

(VII.53)

on ∂ω × {z = 0}.

(VII.54)

• Order ε: −

∂V 1 ∂W 1 − Wz2 + q 1 ν = p1 ν − , ∂ν ∂ν

2.3.2 Formal resolution of the profile equations We now determine, for the moment at a formal level, the various terms of the asymptotic expansion. We use the relations obtained above by identifying the various powers of ε in the original equations and we look for solutions of these equations. We note that certain of these equations do not have unique solutions and we therefore arbitrarily choose one possible solution. This is not so surprising if we remember that the essential aim is to obtain a suitable approximate solution which is certainly not unique.

Chapter VII. Boundary conditions modelling

486

2.3.2.1 Determination of q −1 and W

1

'z0 · ∇ϕ = 0 (see By taking the scalar product of (VII.52) with ∇ϕ, since W (VII.40)), and ∇ϕ = ν on ∂ω, we get q −1 = 0,

on ∂ω × {z = 0}.

(VII.55)

If we now take the divergence of (VII.35) and if we use (VII.43), then we obtain Δq −1 = 0, in ω. (VII.56) ' 0 · ∇ϕ = 0 Finally, we form the scalar product of (VII.34) with ∇ϕ. Since W −1 in all ω (see (VII.40)), we obtain q@ = 0 and therefore, from (VII.31), we z get −1 = 0, q@ in ω × R+ . −1 (t, x, z), we can now deduce from Since q −1 (t, x, z) = q −1 (t, x) + q@ −1 (VII.55) that q = 0 on ∂ω and hence using (VII.56) and the uniqueness of the solution to the Laplace equation with Dirichlet boundary conditions, we have shown that q −1 = 0, in ω,

and hence that

−1 = 0. q −1 = q −1 + q@

With (VII.35), this implies that 1

W = 0,

in ω.

2.3.2.2 Determination of W 0 0

From (VII.33), we already know that W = 0. Using (VII.34), and the fact −1 = 0, we have that q@ '0 + W ' 0 = 0, −W zz

in ω × R+ .

'z0 = 0 on the boundary Now from (VII.52), since q −1 is zero, we obtain that W ∂ω × {z = 0}. The idea is then to extend the boundary conditions to all ω and hence to ' 0 = 0 in ω × R+ . This particular choice implies that choose W z ' 0 = 0, W 0

and hence since W = 0, we finally have W 0 = 0,

in ω × R+ .

(VII.57)

2. Dirichlet boundary conditions through a penalty method

487

The choice above is of course arbitrary; however, we should not forget that we are proceeding by sufficient conditions. Hence, this choice is justified by the fact that we are able to complete the calculations below, that is, to define all the profiles of the expansion and to establish an estimate of the remainder terms.

2.3.2.3 Determination of V 0 and p0 By using (VII.57) and (VII.51) we deduce that V 0 = 0 on ∂ω. Hence, with Equations (VII.47) and (VII.50), we obtain that V 0 and p0 are completely determined (apart from a constant for the pressure) by the Navier–Stokes equations: ⎧ ∂V 0 0 0 0 0 ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ∂t − ΔV + (V · ∇)V + ∇p = f, in U, ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ div V 0 = 0, in U, ⎪ 0 ⎪ ⎪ V = 0, on ∂U, ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ 0 V (0) = v0 . ' 1 and q0 2.3.2.4 Determination of W ' 1 · ∇ϕ = 0 and thus From (VII.42) we have on all ω, that W z ' 1 · ∇ϕ = 0, W

in ω × R+ .

(VII.58)

Remark VII.2.4. Equation (VII.58) means in particular that the first term of the boundary layer in ω is tangential to ∂ω, because ∇ϕ = ν on ∂ω. Then, from (VII.36), and since W 0 = 0 and q −1 = 0, we have 1 'zz ' 1 + qz0 ∇ϕ = 0, −W +W

on ∂ω × {0}.

(VII.59)

Hence, by taking the scalar product of this equation with ∇ϕ we obtain, using (VII.58), that qz0 = 0, and hence (using (VII.31)) q0 = 0,

in ω × R+ .

(VII.60)

Equation (VII.59) now reduces to 1 'zz ' 1 = 0, −W +W

in ω × R+ .

Its only solution which tends to 0 as z → +∞ is given by ' 1 (t, x, z) = w1 (t, x)e−z , W

in ω × R+ ,

(VII.61)

488

Chapter VII. Boundary conditions modelling

' 1 at z = 0. where w1 is the (still unknown) value of W Using (VII.53) and inasmuch as W 0 = 0 and q0 = 0, we obtain on the boundary 0 ' 1 + q 0 ν = − ∂V + p0 ν. −W z ∂ν ' 1 is tangent By taking the scalar product of this equation with ν and since W to the boundary of ω from (VII.58), we have   ∂V 0 q0 = − (VII.62) · ν + p0 , on ∂ω. ∂ν Hence, at the boundary (when z = 0 and x ∈ ∂ω), this gives   0 0 'z1 = w1 = − ∂V + ∂V · ν ν. −W ∂ν ∂ν We therefore decide to extend this formula to the whole domain ω by setting   (VII.63) w1 (t, x) = −∇V 0 .∇ϕ + (∇V 0 .∇ϕ) · ∇ϕ ∇ϕ, in all ω, where V 0 is a simultaneous lifting in ω of the trace of V 0 and of that of ∂V 0 /∂ν on ∂ω and having the same regularity as V 0 (see Remark III.2.12). This extends the condition found at the boundary, because ∇ϕ = ν on ∂ω.

2.3.2.5 Determination of q 0 and W

2

We already know that q0 = 0. Using (VII.37), and since W 0 = 0, this gives 2

∇q 0 + W = 0,

in ω.

(VII.64)

If we now take the divergence of this equation and use (VII.45) and (VII.62), we can completely determine q 0 as a solution of the following Laplace problem ⎧ 0 ⎪ in ω, ⎨ Δq = 0,   0 (VII.65) ∂V ⎪ · ν + p0 , on ∂ω. ⎩ q0 = − ∂ν 2

2

Moreover, knowing q 0 , the term W is simply defined by W = −∇q 0 .

2. Dirichlet boundary conditions through a penalty method

489

2.3.2.6 Determination of V 1 1

Using (VII.48), (VII.51), (VII.61), and (VII.63), and since W = 0, we obtain that V 1 and p1 satisfies a Navier–Stokes equation which is linearised around V0 ⎧ ∂V 1 ⎪ ⎪ − ΔV 1 + (V 0 · ∇)V 1 + (V 1 · ∇)V 0 + ∇p1 = 0, in U, ⎪ ⎪ ∂t ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ div V 1 = 0, in U,   0 0 ∂V ∂V ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ V1 =− + · ν ν, on ∂ω, ⎪ ⎪ ∂ν ∂ν ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ 1 on ∂Ω. V = 0, We then note that V 1 · ν = 0 on ∂ω, which shows that the first correction term of the solution in U is tangential to ∂ω. Moreover, this induces the compatibility of the Dirichlet boundary data with the incompressibility constraint. ' 2 and q1 2.3.2.7 Determination of W We recall that, since W 0 = 0 and q0 = 0, from (VII.38) we have 2 'zz 'z1 .∇ϕ − ΔϕW 'z1 + qz1 ∇ϕ + W ' 2 = 0, −W − 2∇W

in ω × R+ .

(VII.66)

'z2 · ∇ϕ) = − div W ' 1 and by integrating with Using (VII.44), we know that (W respect to z we obtain using (VII.61): ' 2 (t, x, z) · ∇ϕ(x)) = (W



+∞

' 1 (t, x, ζ)dζ = div w1 (t, x)e−z . (VII.67) div W

z

Let us now show that

'z1 .∇ϕ) · ∇ϕ = 0. (∇W

(VII.68)

'z1 ·∇ϕ = 0 and therefore To achieve this, we note that from (VII.58) we have W   1 ' 0 = ∇ Wz · ∇ϕ · ∇ϕ   'z1 · ∇ |∇ϕ|2 . 'z1 .∇ϕ) · ∇ϕ + 1 W = (∇W 2 However, the second term above is zero, at least in ω1 because |∇ϕ| ≡ 1 in ω1 . If we now take the scalar product of (VII.66) with ∇ϕ, we obtain using ' 1 · ∇ϕ = 0, (VII.68) and since we know that W 2 'zz ' 2 · ∇ϕ). qz1 = (W · ∇ϕ) − (W

490

Chapter VII. Boundary conditions modelling

' 2 · ∇ϕ = W ' 2 · ∇ϕ and we then have However, (VII.67) shows that W zz q1 z = 0, which finally gives q1 = 0,

in ω1 × R+ .

(VII.69)

' 2 , that is (in diIt remains to determine the tangential component of W ' 2 ∧ ∇ϕ. To do this, we compute the vector mension d = 3, e.g.) the vector W ' 2 ∧∇ϕ satisfies products (VII.54)∧∇ϕ, and (VII.66)∧∇ϕ, which show that W the following ordinary differential equation with respect to the variable z ⎧ 2 ' ∧ ∇ϕ + 2(∇W 'z1 .∇ϕ) ∧ ∇ϕ W ⎪ zz ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ 'z1 ∧ ∇ϕ − W ' 2 ∧ ∇ϕ = 0, in ω × R+ , + (Δϕ)W (VII.70) ⎪ 1 1 ⎪ ∂W ∂V ⎪ ⎩W 'z2 ∧ ν = − ∧ν+ ∧ ν, on ∂ω × {z = 0}. ∂ν ∂ν The first equation is of the form 2 'zz ' 2 ∧ ∇ϕ = g(t, x)e−z , W ∧ ∇ϕ − W

where g(t, x) is a known vector field as a function of w1 and ϕ. The general solution of this differential equation, at fixed (t, x), is given by   1 2 z ' W ∧ ∇ϕ = a(t, x)e + b(t, x) − g(t, x)z e−z . 2 ' 2 tends to 0 when z tends towards +∞, this However, if we impose that W proves that a(t, x) = 0. We obtain the term b(t, x) by writing the boundary conditions at z = 0 given in (VII.70) 1 ∂W 1 ∂V 1 b(t, x) = − g(t, x) + ∧ν− ∧ ν, 2 ∂ν ∂ν

on ∂ω.

As with the term w1 introduced above, we again choose to extend this formula to the whole obstacle ω by setting 1 b(t, x) = − g(t, x) + (∇W 1 .∇ϕ) ∧ ∇ϕ − (∇V 1 .∇ϕ) ∧ ∇ϕ, 2

in ω,

where V 1 is a lifting in ω of the traces of V 1 and of ∂V 1 /∂ν having the same regularity properties as V 1 , obtained from Remark III.2.12. ' 2 , as follows This completely determines the tangential part of W  2 ' W ∧ ∇ϕ = (∇W 1 .∇ϕ) ∧ ∇ϕ − (∇V 1 .∇ϕ) ∧ ∇ϕ  (VII.71)   ' 1 .∇ϕ) ∧ ∇ϕ e−z . 'z1 ∧ ∇ϕ + 2(∇W + (1 + z) ΔϕW z

2. Dirichlet boundary conditions through a penalty method

491

2.3.2.8 Determination of V 2 and p2 Using (VII.49) through (VII.51), and since W 2 is known, we can determine V 2 and p2 as solutions of the linear system ⎧ ∂V 2 ⎪ ⎪ − ΔV 2 + (V 0 · ∇)V 2 + (V 1 · ∇)V 1 + (V 2 · ∇)V 0 + ∇p2 = 0, ⎪ ⎪ ∂t ⎪ ⎨ div V 2 = 0, ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ V 2 = W 2, ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ 2 V = 0,

in U, in U, on ∂ω, on ∂Ω.

Remark VII.2.5. The boundary condition V 2 = W 2 on ∂ω is compatible with the divergence-free condition div V 2 = 0 in U because  W 2 · ν dσ = 0. ∂ω

Indeed, from (VII.45), we have   2 0= div W dx = − ω

W 2 · ν dσ.

∂ω

2.3.2.9 Determination of q 1 1

We have already seen that q1 = 0 and that W = 0. Hence Equation (VII.39) gives 3 ∇q 1 + W = 0, and using the Laplace equation (VII.46) this leads to Δq 1 = 0,

in ω.

(VII.72)

Furthermore, by making z tend towards infinity and by taking the scalar product with ν, Equation (VII.54) becomes   ∂V 1 1 1 · ν, on ∂ω. (VII.73) q =p − ∂ν This completely determines the term q 1 .

492

Chapter VII. Boundary conditions modelling

2.4 Well-posedness of profile equations In this section we revisit the formal equations established in the preceding section and show that these equations are indeed well-posed in functional spaces with suitable regularity. The existence, uniqueness, and regularity result for the nonpenalized solution V 0 has already been given by Proposition VII.2.1. We therefore concentrate on the higher-order terms. '1 : • Regularity of W We recall that in (VII.63), we asserted that on all ω:   w1 = −∇V 0 .∇ϕ + (∇V 0 .∇ϕ) · ∇ϕ ∇ϕ, such that the regularity established for V 0 (which is hence also that of V 0 , by construction of the lifting V 0 ) and that of ϕ, show that for any T < T ∗ we have ⎧ w1 ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], (H 4 (ω))d ) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, (H 5 (ω))d ), ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ∂w1 ⎨ ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], (H 2 (ω))d ) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, (H 3 (ω))d ), (VII.74) ∂t ⎪ ⎪ 2 1 ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ ∂ w ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], (L2 (ω))d ) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, (H 1 (ω))d ). ∂t2 Conforming with (VII.61), we now assert ' 1 (t, x, z) = w1 (t, x)e−z , W

∀(t, x, z) ∈ [0, T ∗ [ω × R+ ,

such that ⎧   ' 1 ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], (H 4 (ω))d ) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, (H 5 (ω))d ) ⊗ C ∞ , W ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ '1  ⎨ ∂W  ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], (H 2 (ω))d ) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, (H 3 (ω))d ) ⊗ C ∞ , (VII.75) ∂t ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ 2 '1 ⎪ ∂ ⎪ ⎩ W ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], (L2 (ω))d ) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, (H 1 (ω))d ) ⊗ C ∞ , ∂t2 where the symbol Lp (]0, T [, (H s (ω))d ) ⊗ C ∞ is the vector space spanned by functions of the form fi (t, x)gi (z), with fi ∈ Lp (]0, T [, (H s (ω))d ) and gi ∈ C ∞ (R). • Regularity of V 1 : Proposition VII.2.4. Let Ω, ω, v0 , and f be as in Proposition VII.2.1. Let T ∗ and V 0 also be given by that proposition. There exist two functions V 1 and p1 such that

2. Dirichlet boundary conditions through a penalty method

⎧ ∂V 1 ⎪ ⎪ − ΔV 1 + (V 0 · ∇)V 1 + (V 1 · ∇)V 0 + ∇p1 = 0, ⎪ ⎪ ∂t ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ div V 1 = 0,   ∂V 0 ∂V 0 ⎪ 1 ⎪ ⎪V = − + · ν ν, ⎪ ⎪ ∂ν ∂ν ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ 1 V = 0, and which satisfy: for all T < T ∗ , ⎧ V1 ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ∂V 1 ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ∂t ⎪ ⎨ 2 1 ∂ V ⎪ ∂t ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ p1 ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ∂p1 ⎩ ∂t

493

in U, in U, on ∂ω, on ∂Ω, (VII.76)

∈ C 0 ([0, T ], (H 4 (U))d ) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, (H 5 (U))d ), ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], (H 2 (U))d ) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, (H 3 (U))d ), ∈ L2 (]0, T [, (H 1 (U))d ),

(VII.77)

∈ C 0 ([0, T ], H 3 (U)) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, H 4 (U)), ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], H 1 (U)) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, H 2 (U)).

We note that in this proposition we do not set the initial data for Problem (VII.76). Since V 1 is the first term of the asymptotic expansion sought, we could impose V 1 (t = 0) = 0 but this would not allow us to ensure that the compatibility conditions (of type (V.54)) are satisfied and hence would not allow us to establish the regularity properties stated above. Hence, in the following proof, we construct suitable initial data. Proof. First, we want to find a suitable lifting of the boundary conditions. We therefore seek V 1 in the form Z 1 + Υ 1 where Υ 1 is a lifting on U of the trace   ∂V 0 ∂V 0 − + · ν ν. ∂ν ∂ν We construct this lifting by solving the following steady linear Stokes problem for each time t ⎧ in U, −ΔΥ 1 + ∇Π1 = 0, ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ 1 ⎪ ⎪ in U, ⎨ div Υ = 0,   0 0 ∂V ∂V ⎪ Υ1 = − + · ν ν, on ∂ω, ⎪ ⎪ ∂ν ∂ν ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ on ∂Ω, Υ 1 = 0, where Π1 has a zero mean value in U. This equation can be solved because the boundary conditions are compatible with the divergence-free condition. Furthermore, from the regularity properties of the Stokes problem (Theorem IV.5.8), the lifting Υ 1 and the pressure Π1 enjoy regularity

494

Chapter VII. Boundary conditions modelling

properties induced by those of V 0 from the boundary conditions. More precisely (time is a parameter here), we have ⎧ ⎪ Υ 1 ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], (H 4 (U))d ) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, (H 5 (U))d ), ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ∂Υ 1 ⎪ ⎪ ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], (H 2 (U))d ) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, (H 3 (U))d ), ⎪ ⎪ ∂t ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ∂2Υ 1 ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ ∈ L2 (]0, T [, (H 1 (U))d ), ∂t2 (VII.78) ⎪ Π1 ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], H 3 (U)) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, H 4 (U)), ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ∂Π1 ⎪ ⎪ ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], H 1 (U)) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, H 2 (U)), ⎪ ⎪ ∂t ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ 2 1 ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ ∂ Π ∈ L2 (]0, T [, L2 (U)). ∂t2 This lifting being defined, we must now establish the existence and regularity of a solution Z 1 of ⎧ ∂Z 1 ⎪ 1 0 1 1 0 1 1 1 ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ ∂t − ΔZ + (V · ∇)Z + (Z · ∇)V + ∇(p − Π ) = Q ,in U, div Z 1 = 0, in U, ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ 1 Z = 0, on ∂U, (VII.79) where Q1 = −∂Υ 1 /∂t − (V 0 · ∇)Υ 1 − (Υ 1 · ∇)V 0 . We note that, from (VII.78), we have for all T < T ∗ , ⎧ 1 0 2 d 2 3 d ⎨ Q ∈ C ([0, T ], (H (U)) ) ∩ L (]0, T [, (H (U)) ), 1 (VII.80) ⎩ ∂Q ∈ L2 (]0, T [, (H 1 (U))d ). ∂t As we have already seen above, in order to ensure the regularity of the solution Z 1 it is necessary to choose an initial condition well suited to the problem so that compatibility conditions of type (V.54) hold. This may seem somewhat difficult; however, we overcome this difficulty by providing initial data coming from the solution of the problem starting at time t = −1. To achieve this, we start by extending Q1 , by setting Q1 (t) = Q1 (−t) for all t < 0. Next, we consider a real-valued function η of class C ∞ such that η(t) = 1 for t ≥ 0 and η(t) = 0 for t ≤ − 12 . Applying the same method as in Chapter V, we solve Equation (VII.79) starting from time t = −1 for the initial data Z 1 (t = −1) = 0, and for the second term η(t)Q1 (t) which enjoys the same regularity properties as Q1 given by (VII.80). Since η(t)Q1 (t) is zero for any t ≤ − 12 , and the data Z 1 (t = −1) is chosen to be zero, it is clear that the compatibility conditions of type (V.54), posed

2. Dirichlet boundary conditions through a penalty method

495

for this problem from the initial time t = −1, are satisfied. This then gives us a solution Z 1 to Problem (VII.79) satisfying the desired properties, the initial data at t = 0 now being a function of (H 4 (U))d issued from the solution of the Cauchy problem at time t = −1. Now, by combining Υ 1 and Z 1 , we see that we have indeed solved Problem (VII.76) by ensuring (VII.77). The initial data in V 1 are not zero, rather they are a well-determined function of (H 4 (Ω))d . 2 • Regularity of q 0 and W : We have seen that q0 = 0, and hence that q 0 = q 0 . Therefore, from (VII.65), we find that the pressure term q 0 satisfies ⎧ 0 ⎪ in ω, ⎨ Δq = 0,   0 ∂V 0 ⎪ · ν + p0 , on ∂ω. ⎩q = − ∂ν Because of the regularity properties of V 0 and p0 (estimates (VII.27)), by using the elliptic regularity properties of the Laplace operator (Theorem III.4.2), we obtain that for all T < T ∗ , ⎧ 0 0 4 2 5 ⎨ q ∈ C ([0, T ], H (ω)) ∩ L (]0, T [, H (ω)), 0

⎩ ∂q ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], H 2 (ω)) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, H 3 (ω)). ∂t 2

Finally, since W = −∇q 0 , we get ⎧ 2 0 3 d 2 4 d ⎪ ⎨ W ∈ C ([0, T ], (H (ω)) ) ∩ L (]0, T [, (H (ω)) ), 2

⎪ ⎩ ∂W ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], (H 1 (ω))d ) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, (H 2 (ω))d ). ∂t '2 : • Regularity of W ' 2 · ∇ϕ = div(w1 (t, x))e−z , and hence with From (VII.67), we have W (VII.74) we obtain ⎧   ' 2 · ∇ϕ ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], H 3 (ω)) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, H 4 (ω)) ⊗ C ∞ , ⎪ ⎨ W '2   ⎪ ⎩ ∂ W · ∇ϕ ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], H 1 (ω)) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, H 2 (ω)) ⊗ C ∞ . ∂t We recall that, by construction, V 1 possesses the same regularity in ω that V 0 possesses in U. Hence, from (VII.71) and from estimates (VII.75) and (VII.77), we obtain that for all T < T ∗ ⎧ ' 2 ∧ ∇ϕ ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], (H 3 (ω))d ) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, (H 4 (ω))d ) ⊗ C ∞ , ⎪ ⎨ W '2 ⎪ ⎩ ∂ W ∧ ∇ϕ ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], (H 1 (ω))d ) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, (H 2 (ω))d ) ⊗ C ∞ . ∂t

496

Chapter VII. Boundary conditions modelling

'2. This all gives us the regularity of the vector field W 2 2 • Regularity of V and p : Proposition VII.2.5. Under the hypotheses of Proposition VII.2.1, there exist two functions V 2 and p2 such that ⎧ ∂V 2 ⎪ ⎪ − ΔV 2 + (V 0 · ∇)V 2 +(V 1 · ∇)V 1 +(V 2 · ∇)V 0 + ∇p2 = 0, in U, ⎪ ⎪ ∂t ⎪ ⎨ div V 2 = 0, in U, ⎪ 2 2 ⎪ ⎪ V =W , on ∂ω, ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ 2 V = 0, on ∂Ω, and satisfying, for all T < T ∗ , ⎧ V 2 ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], (H 2 (U))d ) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, (H 3 (U))d ), ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ∂V 2 ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], (L2 (U))d ) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, (H 1 (U))d ), ∂t ⎪ p2 ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], H 1 (U)) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, H 2 (U)), ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ 2 ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ ∂p ∈ L2 (]0, T [, L2 (U)). ∂t Proof. The principle of the proof is the same as for V 1 and p1 . We first define 2 a lifting of W|∂ω by solving, for each time t, the following steady Stokes problem ⎧ −ΔΥ 2 + ∇Π2 = 0, in U, ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ div Υ 2 = 0, in U, ⎪ Υ 2 = W 2, ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ Υ 2 = 0,

on ∂ω, on ∂Ω.

It follows from Theorem IV.5.8 that for all T < T ∗ , we have ⎧ Υ 2 ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], (H 3 (U))d ) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, (H 4 (U))d ), ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ∂Υ 2 ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], (H 1 (U))d ) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, (H 2 (U))d ), ∂t ⎪ Π2 ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], H 2 (U)) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, H 3 (U)), ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ 2 ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ ∂Π ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], L2 (U)) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, H 1 (U)). ∂t We then look for V 2 in the form V 2 = Υ 2 + Z 2 where Z 2 satisfies

2. Dirichlet boundary conditions through a penalty method

497

⎧ ∂Z 2 ⎪ 2 0 2 2 0 2 2 2 ⎪ ⎪ ⎨ ∂t − ΔZ + (V · ∇)Z + (Z · ∇)V + ∇(p − Π ) = Q , in U, 2 in U, ⎪ div Z = 0, ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ 2 Z = 0, on ∂U, (VII.81) with ∂Υ 2 Q2 = − − (V 0 · ∇)Υ 2 − (V 1 · ∇)V 1 − (Υ 2 · ∇)V 0 . ∂t From the estimates on V 0 , V 1 , and Υ 2 , we deduce that Q2 ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], (H 1 (U))d ) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, (H 2 (U))d ). We can therefore solve Problem (VII.81) in the classic way for the initial data Z 2 (t = 0) = 0, with  Z 2 ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], (H 1 (U))d ) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, (H 2 (U))d ), p2 ∈ L2 (]0, T [, L2 (U)). We note that given the assumptions applied on v0 and f , we cannot hope for any better regularity for Z 2 because we do not have information on ∂Q2 /∂t. Hence, here, we do not have the issue of compatibility conditions for the initial data that we encountered during the resolution of problem (VII.79). This is why we impose arbitrarily that the initial data are zero for Z 2 .  • Regularity of q 1 : As we saw in (VII.72) and (VII.73), the term q 1 is a solution of a Laplace problem. The existence and uniqueness of this problem are now classic and the regularity of such a term is deduced from the regularity of the boundary data (Theorem III.4.2): ⎧ 1 0 3 2 4 ⎨ q ∈ C ([0, T ], H (ω)) ∩ L (]0, T [, H (ω)), 1 ⎩ ∂q ∈ C 0 ([0, T ], H 1 (ω)) ∩ L2 (]0, T [, H 2 (ω)). ∂t

2.5 Convergence of the asymptotic expansion We want to complete the proof of the main result, that is, to estimate the remainder terms in the formal asymptotic expansion we proposed. For tech' i ) need to be localized nical reasons, the boundary layer terms (i.e., the W near the boundary of the obstacle. To do this, we introduce a localisation function θ ∈ C ∞ (ω) such that θ ≡ 1 in a neighborhood of ∂ω and satisfies supp(θ) ⊂ ω1 .

498

Chapter VII. Boundary conditions modelling

We proved in the previous sections that there exist various profile terms which constitute the sought-after asymptotic expansion. When we gather these various terms together, we obtain an approximate solution of the initial equations in a particular form. We now show that the exact solution of the initial equations (uε , π ε ) is close to the approximate solution thus constructed. We therefore search now for an exact solution of our equations in the following form   ⎧ ϕ(x) ε 1 ⎪ ' ⎪ w (t, x) = εθ(x)W t, x, ⎪ ⎪ ε ⎪ ⎪   ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ϕ(x) 2 ⎪ 2 2 2 ' ⎨ + ε W (t, x) + ε θ(x)W t, x, + εwεr (t, x), in ω, ε ⎪ ⎪ in U, ⎪ v ε (t, x) = V 0 (t, x) + εV 1 (t, x) + ε2 V 2 (t, x) + εvεr (t, x), ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ε 0 1 r ⎪ q (t, x) = q (t, x) + εq (t, x) + εq (t, x), ⎪ in ω, ε ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ ε 0 1 2 2 r in U, p (t, x) = p (t, x) + εp (t, x) + ε p (t, x) + εpε (t, x), where the terms wεr , vεr , qεr and prε are the remainder terms that we have to estimate. Hereafter, we will denote the approximation of the velocity wε in ω as εWapp and its approximation in U as Vapp ; there are defined as follows 2

1 + εW + εθw 2 , Wapp = θw Vapp = V 0 + εV 1 + ε2 V 2 , ' i (t, x, ϕ(x)/ε). Note the presence of the localisation by setting w i (t, x) = W function θ in the definition of Wapp . Similarly, we set papp = p0 + εp1 + ε2 p2 , qapp = q 0 + εq 1 .

2.5.1 Equations satisfied by the remainders By definition, the remainders satisfy the following system

2. Dirichlet boundary conditions through a penalty method

⎧ r ⎪ ⎪ ∂wε − Δwεr + ε(wεr · ∇)Wapp + ε(wεr · ∇)wεr ⎪ ⎪ ∂t ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ 1 ⎪ ε ⎪ + ε(Wapp · ∇)wεr + ∇qεr + 2 wεr = Robst , ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ε ⎪ ⎪ r ε ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ div wε = Rdiv , ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ∂vεr ⎪ ⎪ − Δvεr + (Vapp · ∇)vεr + (vεr · ∇)Vapp ⎪ ⎪ ∂t ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ + ε(vεr · ∇)vεr + ∇prε = Rfε lu , ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ div v r = 0, ⎪ ⎪ ε ⎨ ⎪ vεr = wεr , ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ∂wεr ∂v r ⎪ ε ⎪ − qεr ν = Rboundary , − ε + prε ν + ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ∂ν ∂ν ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ vεr = 0, ⎪ ⎪ ⎪   ⎪ ⎪ ϕ(.) ⎪ r ε 1 ⎪ ' ⎪ ⎪ wε (0, .) = r − θ(.)W 0, ., ε ⎪ ⎪ ⎪   ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ϕ(.) 2 2 ⎪ ' ⎪ − εW (0, .) − εθ(.)W 0, ., , ⎪ ⎪ ε ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ r vε (0, .) = rε (.) − V 1 (0, .) − εV 2 (0, .),

499

in ω,

(1)

in ω,

(2)

in U,

(3)

in U,

(4)

on ∂ω,

(5)

on ∂ω,

(6)

(VII.82)

on ∂Ω, (7)

in ω,

(8)

in U,

(9)

where we define ∂Wapp 1 1 + ΔWapp − ε(Wapp · ∇)Wapp − 2 Wapp − ∇qapp , ∂t ε ε = − div(Wapp ),   1 ∂Vapp − (Vapp · ∇)Vapp + ΔVapp − ∇papp , = f− ε ∂t   1 ∂Vapp ∂Wapp − papp ν − ε + qapp ν . = ε ∂ν ∂ν

ε Robst =− ε Rdiv

Rfε lu ε Rboundary

We note, to start with, that the initial data wεr (0, x) and vεr (0, x) are bounded independently of ε in (L2 )d . Moreover, the support of θ is included in ω1 , therefore we know that |∇ϕ| ≡ 1 everywhere where θ is not zero. This simplifies the following calculations. If we now use the equations satisfied by all the terms of the asymptotic expansion, then we get

Chapter VII. Boundary conditions modelling

500

2 '2 '1 ∂W ∂W ∂W '1 −ε − εθ + θΔW ∂t ∂t ∂t 'z1 + (Δθ)W ' 1 .∇θ + 2 (∇θ · ∇ϕ)W '1 + 2∇W ε 2 ' 2 + 2θ∇W ' 2 .∇ϕ + θ(Δϕ)W '2 + εΔW + εθΔW z z

ε Robst =−θ

' 2 .∇θ + 2(∇θ · ∇ϕ)W 'z2 + ε(Δθ)W '2 + 2ε∇W − ε(Wapp · ∇)Wapp − ∇q 1 , ε ' 1 − ε∇θ · W ' 2 − εθ div W '2, = − ∇θ · W Rdiv   Rfε lu = − ε2 (V 1 · ∇)V 2 + (V 2 · ∇)V 1 − ε3 (V 2 · ∇)V 2 ,

2 '2 ∂W ∂V 2 ∂W ε 2 −p ν− − . Rboundary = ε ∂ν ∂ν ∂ν

Using the regularity properties of the various profile terms obtained above, we can easily show the following estimates for all T < T ∗ , ⎧ ε R L2 (]0,T [,(L2 (ω))d ) ≤ C, ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ obst ⎪ ε ⎪ ⎪ L∞ (]0,T [,L2 (ω)) ≤ Cε, Rdiv ⎪ ⎪   ⎪ ⎨∂  ε   Rdiv ≤ Cε, (VII.83)   2 ∂t ⎪ L (]0,T [,L2 (ω)) ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ε ⎪ ⎪ Rf lu L2 (]0,T [,(L2 (U ))d ) ≤ Cε, ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ ε Rboundary L2 (]0,T [,(L2 (∂ω))d ) ≤ Cε. ε , that the factor ε in Indeed, we note, for example, in the case of Robst front of the term (Wapp · ∇)Wapp compensates the factor 1/ε which comes from the differentiation of Wapp with respect to x. Furthermore, the term ' 1 is exponen'z1 is indeed bounded because we recall that W (2/ε)(∇θ · ∇ϕ)W tially decreasing in z so that 2 'z1 ≤ 2 |∇θ(x) · ∇ϕ(x)||w1 (t, x)|e−ϕ(x)/ε , (∇θ · ∇ϕ)W ε ε

and since ∇θ ≡ 0 in a neighborhood of ∂ω (because, close to ∂ω, θ has a value identically 1), we see that the term considered is zero if ϕ(x) = d(x, ∂ω) ≤ α, for a well-chosen α > 0. Hence, the term under study is bounded by C |w1 (t, x)|e−α/ε , ε which proves that it is indeed bounded with respect to ε in the suitable functional spaces. Lastly, to carry out the final estimate, we need to use the following lifting lemma.

2. Dirichlet boundary conditions through a penalty method

501

Lemma VII.2.6. There exists a function ψε such that ε div ψε = Rdiv ,

(VII.84)

and, for all T < T ∗ , satisfying the following estimates, ψε L∞ (]0,T [,(H01 (ω))d ) ≤ Cε.

   ∂ψε    ≤ Cε.  ∂t  2 L (]0,T [,(H 1 (ω))d )

(VII.85)

0

Proof.  ε We should first note that Rdiv dx = 0, because: ω



 ε Rdiv

ω

dx = −



 Wapp · ν dσ = ε

div Wapp dx = ω

W 2 · ν dσ = 0,

∂ω

∂ω

from Remark VII.2.5. We can then apply Theorem IV.3.1, which tells us that there exists a linear operator Π which is continuous from L20 (Ω) into (H01 (Ω))d and which is a right inverse of the divergence operator, that is, such that div(Π(q)) = q for all q ∈ L20 (Ω). ε For almost all t ∈]0, T [, we set ψε (t) = Π(Robst (t)). This choice satisfies the divergence condition by definition and the first estimate because of the ε properties of Robst and the operator Π. Moreover, since Π is linear, we have  0

T −h

 ψε (t + h) −

ψε (t)2H 1 0

T −h

dt ≤ C 0



T −h

≤C

ε ε Robst (t + h) − Robst (t)2L2 dt



0



≤ Ch

T −h

0



t+h

t

t

t+h

 ε   ∂Robst     ∂t (s)

2 ds

dt

L2

 ε   ∂Robst 2    ∂t (s) 2 ds dt L

 ε 2   2  ∂Robst  . ≤ Ch  ∂t L2 (]0,T [,L2 ) Hence, we obtain for all h > 0 small enough  ε     ∂Robst   ψε (· + h) − ψε (·)     ≤C  ∂t    h 1 2 L (]0,T −h[,H0 )

.

L2 (]0,T [,L2 )

This proves that ∂ψε /∂t exists in L2 (]0, T [, (H01 (ω))d ) and satisfies the claimed estimate. 

Chapter VII. Boundary conditions modelling

502

2.5.2 Estimate of the remainders To carry out this estimate, we multiply Equation (1) in (VII.82) by wεr − ψε (which is divergence-free thanks to Equation (2) of (VII.82) and (VII.84)) and we integrate over ω. Through integration by parts, we obtain an inequality of the following form, 1 d 1 wr 2 2 + ∇wεr 2L2 + 2 wεr 2L2 = I1 + · · · + I10 , 2 dt ε L ε

(VII.86)

where the various terms on the right-hand side are defined by  r   ∂wε r r wε · − qε ν dσ, I1 = − ∂ν ∂ω    r r r (wε · ∇)Wapp + (Wapp · ∇)wε + (ψε · ∇)wε · wεr dx, I2 = −ε ω    r I3 = −ε (wε − ψε ) · ∇ (wεr − ψε ) · (wεr − ψε ) dx, ω   r (wε − ψε ) · ∇ ψε · (wεr − ψε ) dx, I4 = −ε ω    r r r (wε · ∇)Wapp + (Wapp · ∇)wε + (ψε · ∇)wε · ψε dx, I5 = ε ω   1 r ε I6 = 2 w · ψε dx, I7 = Robst · wεr dx, ε ω ε ω   ∂wεr I8 = ∇wεr : ∇ψε dx, · ψε dx, I9 = ∂t ω ω  ε ε I10 = − Robst · ψ dx. ω

If we multiply Equation (3) of (VII.82) by vεr then, by another integration by parts, we obtain 1 d r 2 v  2 + ∇vεr 2L2 = J1 + · · · + J4 , 2 dt ε L with  ∂vεr − pε ν · vεr dσ, ∂ν ∂ω      J2 = − (Vapp · ∇)vεr · vεr + (vεr · ∇)Vapp · vεr dx, U  r  (vε · ∇)vεr · vεr dx, J3 = −ε  U Rfε lu · vεr dx. J4 = 

J1 =

U



(VII.87)

2. Dirichlet boundary conditions through a penalty method

503

Next, we add the two estimates (VII.86) and (VII.87) and it just remains to estimate the various terms as follows. First of all, we use boundary conditions (5) and (6) of (VII.82) and obtain  ε ε I1 + J1 = − Rboundary · wεr dσ ≤ Rboundary L2 (∂ω) wεr L2 (∂ω) ∂ω ε ≤Rboundary L2 (∂ω) wεr H 1 ε ≤Rboundary L2 (∂ω) (wεr L2 + ∇wεr L2 ) 1 ε 2L2 (∂ω) . ≤ ∇wεr 2L2 + wεr 2L2 + CRboundary 8

By using the H¨ older and Young inequalities and the Sobolev embeddings, it follows |I2 | ≤εwεr L6 ∇Wapp L2 wεr L3 + εWapp L6 ∇wεr L2 wεr L3 + ε∇wεr L2 wεr L3 ψε L6   1 ≤ ∇wεr 2L2 + wεr 2L2 + Cε4 Wapp 4H 1 + ψε 4H 1 wεr 2L2 . 8 Since wεr − ψε is divergence-free and ψε is zero on ∂ω, we obtain through integrating by parts (don’t forget that ν is the inward normal to ω)  ε I3 = − (wr − ψε ) · ∇(|wεr − ψε |2 ) dx 2 ω ε    ε div |wεr − ψε |2 (wεr − ψε ) dx =− 2  ω  ε ε r 2 r |w − ψε | (wε − ψε ) · ν dσ = |wr |2 wεr · ν dσ, = 2 ∂ω ε 2 ∂ω ε and also

    ε ε r r 2 J3 = − vε · ∇(|vε | ) dx = − div |vεr |2 vεr dx 2 ω 2 ω  ε |v r |2 v r · ν dσ. =− 2 ∂ω ε ε

Hence, from boundary condition (5) in (VII.82), we have I3 + J3 = 0. The term I4 can be written in the following manner   r r I4 = − ε (wε · ∇)ψε · wε dx + ε (ψε · ∇)ψε · wεr dx  ω  ω r + (wε · ∇)ψε · ψε dx − ε (ψε · ∇)ψε · ψε dx, ω

ω

Chapter VII. Boundary conditions modelling

504

from which we deduce, using the H¨ older inequality and Sobolev embeddings, the estimate |I4 | ≤ε∇ψε L2 wεr L3 wεr L6 + 2εwεr L6 ψε L3 ∇ψε L2 + ε∇ψε L2 ψε L3 ψε L6 1

3

2 r 3 2 ≤εψε H 1 wεr L2 2 wεr H 1 + εψε H 1 wε H 1 + εψε H 1 1 ≤ ∇wεr 2L2 + C(1 + ε4 ψε 4H 1 )wεr 2L2 + Cε2 ψε 4H 1 + Cεψε 3H 1 . 8

The term I5 is estimated in the following classic way |I5 | ≤ε∇Wapp L2 ψε L3 wεr L6 + εWapp L4 ∇wεr L2 ψε L4 + ε∇wεr L2 ψε 2L4 1 ≤ ∇wεr 2L2 + ε2 (Wapp 2H 1 + ψε 2H 1 )ψε 2H 1 . 8 Finally, terms I6 and I7 are bounded above, respectively, by 1 1 wr 2 2 + 2 ψε 2L2 , 2ε2 ε L 2ε ε |I7 | ≤ Robst 2L2 + wεr 2L2 .

|I6 | ≤

If we integrate the term I8 over time between 0 and t, we obtain, through integration by parts in time (Theorem II.5.12) 



t

0

ω

 t

 wεr (t) · ψε (t) dx −

I8 ds =

wεr (0) · ψε (0) dx + ω

wεr · 0

ω

∂ψε dx ds, ∂t

1 1 1 ≤ wεr (t)2L2 + ψε (t)2L2 + wεr (0)2L2 + ψε (0)2L2 4 2 2    t  ∂ψε 2 1 t r 2   + wε L2 ds +  ∂t  2 ds. 4 0 0 L By using the Sobolev embeddings, we can estimate the term J2 as follows |J2 | ≤Vapp L6 ∇vεr L2 vεr L3 + ∇Vapp L2 vεr 2L4 3/2

1/2

≤Vapp H 1 vεr H 1 vεr L2   3/2 1/2 ≤Vapp H 1 vεr 2L2 + ∇vεr L2 vεr L2 1 ≤ ∇vεr 2L2 + C(1 + Vapp 4H 1 )vεr 2L2 . 8 Finally, terms I9 , I10 , and J4 are estimated in the usual way by

2. Dirichlet boundary conditions through a penalty method

505

1 |I9 | ≤ ∇wεr 2L2 + 2ψε 2H 1 , 8 1 ε 1 ε |I10 | ≤ Robst L2 ψε L2 ≤ Robst 2L2 + ψε 2L2 , 2 2 |J4 | ≤ Rfε lu 2L2 + vεr 2L2 . We now set y(t) = wεr (t)2L2 + vεr (t)2L2 , z(t) = ∇wεr (t)2L2 + ∇vεr (t)2L2 . Adding Equations (VII.86) and (VII.87), then integrating with respect to time between 0 and t, we get for any 0 ≤ t ≤ T , of the estimate  t  t y(t) + z(s) ds ≤ C(1 + wεr (0)2L2 + vεr (0)2L2 ) + Cε4 Wapp 2L2 ds 0 0  

 t  ∂ψε 2 ε 2 ε 2 ε 2   Rboundary L2 (∂ω) + Robst L2 + Rf lu L2 +  ds +C ∂t L2 0  t  (VII.88) +C 1 + ε4 Wapp 4H 1 (ω) + Vapp 4H 1 (U ) y(s) ds, 0

where C does not depend on ε. However, by definition of the approximate solutions Vapp and Wapp and from the estimates obtained above, we have Vapp L∞ (]0,T [,H 1 (U )) ≤ C, and C Wapp L∞ (]0,T [,H 1 (ω)) ≤ √ . ε Indeed, we should not forget that by estimating the H 1 norm of Wapp , the dependency of the profiles on ϕ(x)/ε leads to a factor 1/ε during differentiation and, furthermore, √ the exponential decrease of these same terms allows us to gain a factor of ε. To observe this, it is sufficient to calculate the L2 norm of the derivative of the function e−x/ε on R+ as follows 1 ε



+∞

−2x/ε

e 0

1/2 dx

1 =√ 2ε



+∞

−x

e 0

1/2 1 dx =√ . 2ε

Moreover, we have estimates of the remainders (VII.83) and the estimate (VII.85). This brings the energy inequality (VII.88) back to the inequality 



t

z(s) ds ≤ C(1 + wεr (0)2L2 + vεr (0)2L2 ) + C

y(t) + 0

t

y(s) ds, (VII.89) 0

Chapter VII. Boundary conditions modelling

506

from which we deduce, by initially ignoring the (nonnegative) term and by using Gronwall’s lemma,   y(t) ≤ C 1 + wεr (0)2L2 + vεr (0)2L2 eT , ∀t ≤ T.

t 0

z(s) ds,

However, from Equations (8) and (9) of (VII.82), this indeed proves that vεr 2L∞ (]0,T [,L2 (U )) + wεr 2L∞ (]0,T [,L2 (ω)) ≤ C. If we now return to (VII.89), we obtain the second estimate 

T

z(s) ds ≤ C, 0

which we can state exactly as vεr 2L2 (]0,T [,H 1 (U )) + wεr 2L2 (]0,T [,H 1 (ω)) ≤ C. This completes the proof of Theorem VII.2.3 and hence that of Theorem VII.2.2. 

Appendix A

Classic differential operators

In this appendix, we very briefly revise several definitions and formulas relating to the basic differential operators, namely the gradient, divergence, curl, and Laplace operators. Throughout the text, we denote the scalar product of two vectors of Rd as A · B and the vector product of two vectors of R3 (an orientation being fixed) as A ∧ B.

1 The scalar and vector cases 1.1 Definitions Definition A.1.1. Let f be a scalar field and let g be a vector field, sufficiently regular and defined on a domain Ω of Rd . • The gradient of f refers to the vector field defined by its coordinates in any orthonormal basis of Rd by ⎛

∂f ∂x1



⎟ ⎜ ∇f = ⎝ ... ⎠ . ∂f ∂xd

• The divergence of g refers to the scalar field defined by div g =

d  ∂gi , ∂xi i=1

where the coordinates of g are refered to as g1 , . . . , gd in an othonormal basis of the space. • The Laplacian of f refers to the scalar field defined by F. Boyer and P. Fabrie, Mathematical Tools for the Study of the Incompressible Navier-Stokes Equations and Related Models, Applied Mathematical Sciences 183, DOI 10.1007/978-1-4614-5975-0, © Springer Science+Business Media New York 2013

507

Appendix A. Classic differential operators

508

Δf = div(∇f ) =

d  ∂2f i=1

∂x2i

.

• In the case d = 3, the curl of g refers to the vector field denoted as curl g, defined by its coordinates in the same orthonormal basis by ⎞ ⎛ ∂g3 ∂g2 − ⎜ ∂x2 ∂x3 ⎟ ⎜ ∂g ∂g3 ⎟ ⎟ ⎜ 1 curl g = ⎜ − ⎟. ⎜ ∂x3 ∂x1 ⎟ ⎝ ∂g2 ∂g1 ⎠ − ∂x1 ∂x2 Moreover, if v is a vector field of Rd , we denote the first order differential operator as v · ∇, defined by (v · ∇)f =

d  i=1

vi

∂f . ∂xi

The concepts defined above are actually intrinsic; that is, they do not depend on the choice of basis. Consequently, we can express these operators in non-Cartesian coordinates. We recall that the cylindrical coordinates in R3 are defined by x = r cos θ, y = r sin θ, z = z, and that a rotating othonormal reference frame is associated with the system of coordinates, denoted as (er , eθ , ez ) and defined by ⎛ ⎞ ⎛ ⎞ ⎛ ⎞ cos θ − sin θ 0 er = ⎝ sin θ ⎠ , eθ = ⎝ cos θ ⎠ , ez = ⎝ 0 ⎠ . 0 0 1 Proposition A.1.2. Let f be a scalar field and g be a vector field, sufficiently regular and defined in cylindrical coordinates on the cylindrical domain Ω of R3 . We then have the following formulas ∇f =

∂f 1 ∂f ∂f er + eθ + ez , ∂r r ∂θ ∂z

1 ∂ 1 ∂gθ ∂gz (rgr ) + + , r ∂r r ∂θ ∂z where g = gr er + gθ eθ + gz ez , and   1 ∂ ∂2f ∂f 1 ∂2f Δf = r + 2 2 + 2, r ∂r ∂r r ∂θ ∂z div g =

(A.1)

(A.2)

2. Extension to second-order tensors

 curl g =

∂gz ∂gθ − ∂θ ∂z

509



 er +

∂gr ∂gz − ∂z ∂r



 eθ +

1 ∂(rgθ ) 1 ∂gr − r ∂r r ∂θ

 ez .

1.2 Useful formulas Let A, B and C be three vector fields and f a scalar field. Let us start this small formulary with the following algebraic formula known as the vector triple product A ∧ (B ∧ C) = (A · C) B − (A · B) C. (A.3) We next have the following formulae which link the various differential operators introduced above div(f A) = f (div A) + (A · ∇)f, curl(f A) = f (curl A) + (∇f ) ∧ A, 1 (A · ∇)A = ∇|A|2 − A ∧ curl A, 2 div(A ∧ B) = B · curl A − A · curl B, curl(A ∧ B) = (div B)A − (div A)B + (B · ∇)A − (A · ∇)B, curl(curl A) = ∇ div A − ΔA.

(A.4) (A.5) (A.6) (A.7) (A.8) (A.9)

Of course, this list is a long way from being exhaustive and only contains the formulas which are most useful in fluid mechanics.

2 Extension to second-order tensors Our goal is not to provide a detailed general study of tensors. In this text, we only need to consider in detail tensor fields of order 2, that is, the endomorphism fields of Rd . We therefore simply identify second-order tensors with square matrices via the canonical basis of Rd . Definition A.2.1. Let Ω be a domain of Rd . • Lets v be a regular vector field on Ω; we call the gradient of v, the tensor field   ∂vi ∇v = . ∂xj 1≤i,j≤d • Let σ = (σij )1≤i,j≤d be a regular tensor field on Ω; we call the divergence of σ, the vector field

510

Appendix A. Classic differential operators

⎛ div σ = ⎝

3  ∂σij j=1

∂xj

⎞ ⎠

.

1≤i≤d

• Let v be a regular vector field on Ω; we call the Laplacian of v, the vector field Δv = div(∇v). We can easily verify that Δv is the vector field whose components in a fixed othonormal basis of Rd are the Δvi , where vi are the components of the field v in this same basis. Definition A.2.2 (Tensor product). Let u, v be two vector fields; we refer to the tensor product of u and v, and we write u ⊗ v, for the second-order tensor defined in an orthonormal basis by   u ⊗ v = ui vj 1≤i,j≤d . If we apply u ⊗ v to a third vector field w, then we have (u ⊗ v).w = (v · w)u. Furthermore, we have the following formula for the divergence of a tensor product div(u ⊗ v) = (div v)u + (v · ∇)u. (A.10) Finally, we can define a scalar product on the set of second-order tensor fields, which is simply the Euclidean scalar product in the space of the matrices identified with Rd×d . In tensor language, this is called the contracted tensor product. Definition A.2.3 (Contracted product). Let σ, τ be two tensors of order 2; we define their contracted product, to be the real number defined by  σ:τ = σij τij . 1≤i,j≤d

The norm associated with this scalar product is simply denoted as | · |, such that |σ|2 = σ : σ.

Appendix B

Thermodynamics supplement

The goal of this appendix is to recall, in an extremely succinct and therefore necessarily very incomplete way, the main concepts of the thermodynamics of fluids which are used in Chapter I. Our basic objective is to introduce the notion of entropy and the second law of thermodynamics (in particular the Clausius theorem). Among the various reference textbooks available on this topic, we refer, for example, to [94] for a much more detailed exposition. Thermodynamics is the study of the evolution of material systems and of their energy taking into account their internal molecular structure. Such material systems are well described by a certain number of quantities, referred to as state variables, among which • Volume, mass, and density which account for the size of the system and the quantity of matter in the system under study • Temperature and energy which account for the excitation state of the elementary particles of the matter • Pressure which is a mechanical measure of the random motion of the particles through the collisions of these particles on a (virtual) wall placed in the material. Other state variables are often necessary when dealing with complex systems (such as multiphase systems, for instance). Among all these quantities, there are some which do not vary when the size of the system is increased (temperature, pressure, etc.) and these are referred to as intensive variables. By contrast, some quantities increase with the size of the system (volume, energy, etc.) and are referred to as extensive variables. In fact, the values of the state variables are not independent. It is admitted that each homogeneous thermodynamical system satisfies an equation of state which is a algebraic relationship between all the state variables. Depending on the system under study, it can take the form of an expression of the pressure as a function of the temperature and the density of the system, or of an F. Boyer and P. Fabrie, Mathematical Tools for the Study of the Incompressible Navier-Stokes Equations and Related Models, Applied Mathematical Sciences 183, DOI 10.1007/978-1-4614-5975-0, © Springer Science+Business Media New York 2013

511

Appendix B. Thermodynamics supplement

512

expression of the temperature as a function of pressure and density, or any other combination of independent variables. In the case of fluid dynamics, we need to apply the concepts of this appendix to fluid elements (Ωt )t . They are assumed to be in instantaneous local thermodynamical equilibrium so that each elementary fluid particle can be considered as a closed homogeneous thermodynamical system. This means that the relaxation time towards the local molecular equilibrium at any point x and any time t in the fluid is much shorter than any characteristic time for the overall evolution of the fluid.

1 Heat capacity Definition B.1.1. We use the term heat capacity at constant volume (resp. heat capacity at constant pressure) denoted by CV (or CP , resp.) to refer to the quantity of heat required to increase the temperature of a system by 1K while maintaining the volume (resp. the pressure) constant. It follows that an increase of temperature ΔT requires us to furnish to the system an energy which is given by ΔQ = CV ΔT, at constant V , ΔQ = CP ΔT, at constant P . Of course CV and CP are extensive quantities and we often make use of the specific heat capacities (i.e., per unit mass) defined by cV =

CV CP , cP = , M M

where M is the mass of the system considered.

2 The first law of thermodynamics. Internal energy Let us now consider a closed homogeneous thermodynamic system (i.e., one which does not exchange matter with the exterior but which, nevertheless, can exchange energy in the form of heat or work). The first law of thermodynamics tells us that there exists a state variable known as the internal energy and referred to as E, which depends on temperature, pressure, and density such that the change in energy of the system during a transformation must be exactly equal to the external energy provided to the system. This internal energy accounts for the kinetic energy of each individual molecule in the system even though the system is at rest at the macroscopic level. For a given elementary transformation of our closed system, we have

3. The second law of thermodynamics

513

ΔE = ΔQ + ΔW, where ΔQ is the heat provided and ΔW is the work done by external forces acting on the system during the transformation. If we assume that the system is submitted to no external forces other than the pressure, then the term for the work reduces to the work of the pressure forces and can be written as ΔW = −P ΔV, where ΔV is the volume change undergone by the system in the course of the transformation. Remark B.2.1. In the energy equation above, ΔE represents the change in a state variable E when passing from an initial to a final state and, importantly, this value does not depend on the path by which the system passes from the initial state to the final state. However, the values ΔQ and ΔW do not represent changes of state variables and they do depend on the path followed by the system between the two states considered. It is a standard and useful notation to write ΔE in the form of the exact differential dE of the function E (considered as a function of some set of independent variables) but we cannot do the same for ΔQ and ΔW . The same “differential” notation is used for any state function that we encounter in this book but we do not need any precise element of the differential form theory. Remark B.2.2. In the context of fluid mechanics, each fluid element contains internal energy so that the total energy of this fluid element is given by Etot = Eint + Ekin + Epot , where Ekin is the macroscopic kinetic energy of the system (computed from the mean velocity field v in the flow) and Epot is its potential energy. In this formula Eint is the total internal energy contained in the fluid element considered. In practice, this internal energy term can be expressed as an integral term of the density of internal energy.

3 The second law of thermodynamics 3.1 Entropy The second law of thermodynamics asserts the existence of a new state variable S, called entropy such that for any quasi-static transformation of the closed system considered, we would have

Appendix B. Thermodynamics supplement

514

ΔQ ≤ ΔS, T

(B.1)

the equality being true if, and only if, the transformation is reversible. In the case of an elementary reversible transformation we therefore have ΔQ = T dS. Here, we used the fact that the entropy is a state function to replace the notation ΔS by the differential notation dS. This statement, known as the Clausius theorem, is equivalent to saying that the transfer of heat from a cold system to a warm system is forbidden. Now, by combining these two laws of thermodynamics, we can show that in an elementary reversible transformation the internal energy of a closed system changes according to the equation dE = T dS − P dV.

(B.2)

Remark B.3.1. The preceding result only applies to reversible transformations. How should we handle irreversible transformations? We can use the fact that the change in energy depends only on the initial and final states and attempt to construct a reversible transformation which will take the system from the first state to the second. Along such a path, the above relation is valid and we can therefore integrate it.

3.2 Internal energy calculation We can now give an expression for the internal energy as a function of the other variables T, P, V, and S. To do this, it is sufficient to use the intensive or extensive character of each variable. Let us consider a system of size 1 and then consider the same system (1 + ε) times as large as before, with all its proportions being conserved. The temperature and pressure do not change in this system, whereas the energy, entropy, and volume are each multiplied by (1 + ε). By applying (B.2), and using that T and P are the same in each state, it follows that εE = (1 + ε)E − E = ΔE = T (ΔS) − P (ΔV ) = T ((1 + ε)S − S) − P ((1 + ε)V − V ) = εT S − εP V ; we then find the expression E = T S − P V.

4. Specific variables

515

By taking the differential of this expression and by comparing it to (B.2), we obtain the Gibbs–Duhem relation which is written as SdT − V dP = 0.

(B.3)

4 Specific variables We now work with specific variables, that is, quantities per unit mass. We call e and s the specific energy and specific entropy of the system. Furthermore, we introduce the specific volume v = 1/ρ (where ρ is the density of the system being studied) as a volume variable. The relations obtained in the previous section become e = Ts − Pv, s dT − v dP = 0. As we have seen above, for an elementary reversible transformation at constant specific volume, the quantity of heat acquired by the system is written as ΔQ = T ds but we also have ΔQ = cv dT , from which we can deduce that   ∂s cv = , ∂T v T where we use here the notation (∂F/∂x)y for the partial derivative of the quantity F with respect to x, at a fixed value of the variable y. This notation is useful to make precise the choice of independent state variables which is done in each computation. Hence, we can write the differential of the specific entropy (considered as a function of T and v ) in the form   cv ∂s ds = dT + dv. T ∂v T From the Gibbs–Duhem relation (B.3), we have: d(P v) = P dv + v dP = P dv + sdT ; we can therefore use Schwarz’s theorem on crossed second-order derivatives for any (smooth) function, which gives us one of the so-called Maxwell relations     ∂s ∂P = . ∂v T ∂T v It follows that

cv ds = dT + T



∂P ∂T

 dv , v

516

Appendix B. Thermodynamics supplement

and then returning to the specific internal energy, we have     ∂P de = T ds − P dv = cv dT + T − P dv . ∂T v

(B.4)

Therefore, if we know the equation of state for the fluid under study (i.e., the expression of P as a function of T and v ), we can calculate all of the coefficients of these last two relations. Some classic equations of state for the dynamics of a gas are, for example: • The ideal gas law

T P =k , v where k is a constant depending only on the molar mass of the fluid study. • The Van der Waals equation of state    a T b P+ 2 =k , 1− v v v where a and b are two new constants which depend on the fluid studied. Unlike the very simple equation of state for an ideal gas, this law takes account of the diameter of the molecules (assumed to be hard spheres) and the attractive forces between molecules.

Liquids also satisfy equations of state but in that case, as explained in Section 6 of Chapter I, the flow can often be considered to be incompressible so that the particular expression of the equation of state is not useful for the description of the flow. We observe finally that to obtain Equation (B.4), we have not used the explicit expression for the entropy and, furthermore, the entropy did not appear in the formula obtained. The simple fact of postulating the existence of this state variable, S, allows us to apply the Schwarz theorem and to deduce the fundamental thermodynamic relations from it. In the incompressible framework which is the main topic of this book, the entropy does not explicitly appear in the final system of equations describing the flow. However, it is a fundamental quantity in compressible flow modelling.

References

1. R.A. Adams and J.J.F. Fournier. Sobolev spaces, volume 140 of Pure and Applied Mathematics (Amsterdam). Elsevier/Academic Press, Amsterdam, second edition, 2003. 2. S. Agmon, S. Douglis, and L. Nirenberg. Estimates near the boundary for solutions of elliptic partial differential equations satisfying general boundary conditions I. Comm. Pure Appl. Math., 12:623–727, 1959. 3. S. Agmon, S. Douglis, and L. Nirenberg. Estimates near the boundary for solutions of elliptic partial differential equations satisfying general boundary conditions II. Comm. Pure Appl. Math., 17:35–92, 1964. 4. T. Alazard. A minicourse on the low Mach number limit. Discrete Contin. Dyn. Syst. Ser. S, 1(3):365–404, 2008. 5. L. Ambrosio. Transport equation and Cauchy problem for BV vector fields. Invent. Math., 158(2):227–260, 2004. 6. C. Amrouche, C. Bernardi, M. Dauge, and V. Girault. Vector potentials in threedimensional non-smooth domains. Math. Methods Appl. Sci., 21(9):823–864, 1998. 7. C. Amrouche and V. Girault. On the existence and regularity of the solution of Stokes problem in arbitrary dimension. Proc. Japan Acad. Ser. A Math. Sci., 67(5):171–175, 1991. 8. M.E. Andersson. On the vector valued Hausdorff-Young inequality. Ark. Math., 36:1–30, 1998. 9. P. Angot. Analysis of singular perturbation on the Brinkman problem for fictitious domain models of viscous flow. Math. Methods Appl. Sci., 22(15):1395–1412, 1999. 10. P. Angot, C.H. Bruneau, and P. Fabrie. A penalization method to take into account obstacles in incompressible viscous flows. Numer. Math., 81:497–520, 1999. 11. P. Angot and J.-P. Caltagirone. Natural convection through periodic porous media. In Proceeding 9th Int. Heat Transfer Conf., Jerusalem, Hemisphere,, volume 5, pages 219–224, 1990. 12. S.N. Antontsev, A.V. Kazhikhov, and V.N. Monakhov. Boundary value problems in mechanics of nonhomogeneous fluids, volume 22 of Studies in Mathematics and Its Applications. North-Holland, Amsterdam, 1990. 13. E. Arquis and J.-P. Caltagirone. Sur les conditions hydrodynamiques au voisinage d’une interface milieu fluide-milieu poreux: application ` a la convection naturelle. C. R. Acad. Sci Paris S´ erie II, 299(1):1–4, 1984. 14. T. Aubin. Un th´eor` eme de compacit´e. C. R. Acad. Sci. Paris, 256:5042–5044, 1963. 15. R. Bellman. The stability of solutions of linear differential equations. Duke Math. J., 10:643–647, 1943. 16. I. Bihari. A generalization of a lemma of Bellman and its application to uniqueness problems of differential equations. Acta Math. Acad. Sci. Hungar., 7:81–94, 1956.

F. Boyer and P. Fabrie, Mathematical Tools for the Study of the Incompressible Navier-Stokes Equations and Related Models, Applied Mathematical Sciences 183, DOI 10.1007/978-1-4614-5975-0, © Springer Science+Business Media New York 2013

517

518

References

17. A. Blouza and H. Le Dret. An up-to-the-boundary version of Friedrichs’s lemma and applications to the linear Koiter shell model. SIAM J. Math. Anal., 33(4):877–895 (electronic), 2001. 18. M.E. Bogovski˘ı. Solution of the first boundary value problem for the equation of continuity of an incompressible medium. Soviet. Math. Doklady, 20:1094–1098, 1979. 19. M.E. Bogovski˘ı. Solutions of some problems of vector analysis, associated with the operators div and grad. In Theory of cubature formulas and the application of functional analysis to problems of mathematical physics, volume 1980 of Trudy Sem. S. L. Soboleva, No. 1, pages 5–40, 149. Akad. Nauk SSSR Sibirsk. Otdel. Inst. Mat., Novosibirsk, 1980. 20. C. Bost, G.-H. Cottet, and E. Maitre. Convergence analysis of a penalization method for the three-dimensional motion of a rigid body in an incompressible viscous fluid. SIAM J. Numer. Anal., 48(4):1313–1337, 2010. 21. J. Bourgain and H. Brezis. On the equation div Y = f and application to control of phases. J. Amer. Math. Soc., 16(2):393–426 (electronic), 2003. 22. F. Boyer. Trace theorems and spatial continuity properties for the solutions of the transport equation. Diff. Integ. Eq., 18(8):891–934, 2005. 23. F. Boyer. Analysis of the upwind finite volume method for general initial- and boundary-value transport problems. IMA J. Numer. Anal., 2011. ´ ements d’analyse pour l’´ 24. F. Boyer and P. Fabrie. El´ etude de quelques mod` eles d’´ ecoulements de fluides visqueux incompressibles, volume 52 of Math´ ematiques & Applications (Berlin) [Mathematics & Applications]. Springer-Verlag, Berlin, 2006. 25. F. Boyer and P. Fabrie. Outflow boundary conditions for the incompressible nonhomogeneous Navier-Stokes equations. Discrete Contin. Dyn. Syst. Ser. B, 7(2):219– 250 (electronic), 2007. 26. S.C. Brenner and L.R. Scott. The mathematical theory of finite element methods, volume 15 of Texts in Applied Mathematics. Springer, New York, third edition, 2008. 27. H. Brezis. Functional analysis, Sobolev spaces and partial differential equations. Universitext. Springer, New York, 2011. 28. C.-H. Bruneau. Numerical simulation and analysis of the transition to turbulence. In Paul Kutler, Jolen Flores, and Jean-Jacques Chattot, editors, Fifteenth International Conference on Numerical Methods in Fluid Dynamics, volume 490 of Lecture Notes in Physics, pages 1–13. Springer Berlin / Heidelberg, 1997. 29. C.-H. Bruneau and P. Fabrie. Effective downstream boundary conditions for incompressible Navier-Stokes equation. Int. J. Num. Meth. Fluids, 19:693–705, 1994. 30. C.-H. Bruneau and P. Fabrie. New efficient boundary conditions for incompressible Navier-Stokes equation: A well-posedness result. M2 AN, 30(7):815–840, 1996. 31. C.-H. Bruneau and I. Mortazavi. Contrˆ ole passif d’´ ecoulements incompressibles autour d’obstacles ` a l’aide de milieux poreux. C. R. Acad. Sci. Paris S´ erie II, 329:517– 521, 2001. 32. V. Bruneau and V. Carbou. Asymptotic expansion for large limit coupling. Asymp. Anal., 29(2):91–113, 2002. 33. V.I. Burenkov. Sobolev spaces on domains, volume 137 of Teubner-Texte zur Mathematik [Teubner Texts in Mathematics]. Teubner Verlagsgesellschaft mbH, Stuttgart, 1998. 34. J.-P. Caltagirone. Sur l’interaction fluide-milieux poreux : application au calcul des efforts exerc´ es sur un obstacle par un fluide visqueux. C. R. Acad. Sci. Paris S´ erie II, 318:571–577, 1994. 35. G. Carbou. Penalization method for viscous incompressible flow around a porous thin layer. Nonlinear Anal. Real World Appl., 5(5):815–855, 2004. 36. G. Carbou. Brinkmann model and double penalization method for the flow around a porous thin layer. J. Math. Fluid Mech., 10(1):126–158, 2008. 37. G. Carbou and P. Fabrie. Boundary layers for a penalisation method for incompressible flows. Adv. Diff. Eq., 8(12):1453–1480, 2003.

References

519

38. G. Carbou, P. Fabrie, and O. Gu`es. Couches limites dans un mod`ele de ferromagn´etisme. Comm. Partial Diff. Eq., 27(7–8):1467–1495, 2002. 39. L. Cattabriga. Su un problema al contorno relativo al sistema di equazioni di Stokes. Rend. Sem. Padova, 31:308–340, 1961. 40. S. Chandrasekhar. Hydrodynamic and hydromagnetic stability. Dover, New York, 1961. 41. J.-Y. Chemin. Perfect incompressible fluids, volume 14 of Oxford Lecture Series in Mathematics and Its Applications. Clarendon Press, Oxford University Press, New York, 1998. 42. H. Choe and H. Kim. Strong solutions of the Navier-Stokes equations for nonhomogeneous incompressible fluids. Comm. Partial Differential Equations, 28(5-6):1183– 1201, 2003. 43. P. Chossat and G. Iooss. The Couette-Taylor problem. Number 102 in Applied Mathematical Sciences. Springer Verlag, New York, 1994. 44. P. Constantin and C. Foias. Navier-Stokes equations. Chicago Lectures in Mathematics. University of Chicago Press, 1988. 45. R. Danchin. Density-dependent incompressible viscous fluids in critical spaces. Proc. Roy. Soc. Edinburgh Sect. A, 133(6):1311–1334, 2003. 46. R. Danchin. Low Mach number limit for viscous compressible flows. M2AN Math. Model. Numer. Anal., 39(3):459–475, 2005. 47. R. Dautray and J.-L. Lions. Mathematical analysis and numerical methods for science and technology. Vol. 3. Springer-Verlag, Berlin, 1990. Spectral theory and applications. 48. R. Dautray and J.-L. Lions. Mathematical analysis and numerical methods for science and technology. Vol. 5. Springer-Verlag, Berlin, 1992. Evolution problems. I. 49. G. de Rham. Differentiable manifolds, volume 266 of Grundlehren der Mathematischen Wissenschaften [Fundamental Principles of Mathematical Sciences]. SpringerVerlag, Berlin, 1984. Forms, currents, harmonic forms,. 50. B. Desjardins. Global existence results for the incompressible density-dependent Navier-Stokes equations in the whole space. Diff. Integral Eq., 10:587–598, 1997. 51. B. Desjardins. Linear transport equations with initial values in Sobolev spaces and application to the Navier-Stokes equations. Diff. Integral Eq., 10:577–586, 1997. 52. R.J. Di Perna and P.-L. Lions. Ordinary differential equations, transport theory and Sobolev spaces. Invent. Math., 98:511–547, 1989. 53. P.G. Drazin and W.H. Reid. Hydrodynamic stability. Cambridge Monographs on Mechanics and Applied Mathematics. Cambridge University Press, Cambridge, New York, 1982. 54. G. Duvaut and J.-L. Lions. Inequalities in mechanics and physics. Springer-Verlag, Berlin, 1976. 55. A. Ern and J.-L. Guermond. Theory and practice of finite elements, volume 159 of Applied Mathematical Sciences. Springer-Verlag, New York, 2004. 56. L.C. Evans. Partial differential equations, volume 19 of Graduate Studies in Mathematics. American Mathematical Society, Providence, RI, second edition, 2010. 57. E. Feireisl. Dynamics of viscous compressible fluids, volume 26 of Oxford Lecture Series in Mathematics and its Applications. Oxford University Press, Oxford, 2004. 58. E. Feireisl. Mathematical models of incompressible fluids as singular limits of complete fluid systems. Milan J. Math., 78(2):523–560, 2010. 59. C. Foias, O. Manley, R. Rosa, and R. Temam. Navier-Stokes equations and turbulence. Encyclopedia of Mathematics and Its Applications. Cambridge University Press, Cambridge, 2001. 60. C. Foias and R. Temam. Remarques sur les ´equations de Navier-Stokes et les ph´ enom` enes successifs de bifurcation. Annal. Sc. Norm. Sup. Pisa, Serie IV, 5:29–63, 1978. 61. K.O. Friedrichs. The identity of weak and strong extensions of differential operators. Trans. Amer. Math. Soc., 55:132–151, 1944.

520

References

62. G.P. Galdi. An introduction to the Navier-Stokes initial-boundary value problem. In Fundamental directions in mathematical fluid mechanics, Adv. Math. Fluid Mech., pages 1–70. Birkh¨ auser, Basel, 2000. 63. G.P. Galdi. An introduction to the mathematical theory of the Navier-Stokes equations. Springer Monographs in Mathematics. Springer, New York, second edition, 2011. Steady-state problems. 64. J. Garcia-Cuerva, K.S. Kazarian, V.I. Kolyada, and J.L. Torrea. Vector-valued Hausdorff-Young inequality and applications. Russ. Math. Surv., 53(3):435–513, 1998. 65. V. Girault and P.-A. Raviart. Finite element methods for Navier-Stokes equations. Springer-Verlag, 1986. 66. O. Gonzalez and A. M. Stuart. A first course in continuum mechanics. Cambridge Texts in Applied Mathematics. Cambridge University Press, Cambridge, 2008. 67. P. Grisvard. Elliptic problems in nonsmooth domains. Monographs and Studies in Mathematics, 24. Pitman Advanced Publishing Program. Pitman, Boston-LondonMelbourne XIV, 410 p., 1985. 68. J. Heinonen. Lectures on Lipschitz analysis, volume 100 of Report. University of Jyv¨ askyl¨ a Department of Mathematics and Statistics. University of Jyv¨ askyl¨ a, Jyv¨ askyl¨ a, 2005. 69. E. Hewitt and K. Stromberg. Real and Abstact Analysis. Springer Verlag, New York,, 1965. 70. J.G. Heywood. On the impossibility, in some cases, of the Leray-Hopf condition for energy estimates. J. Math. Fluid Mech., 13(3):449–457, 2011. 71. E. Hopf. Ein allgemeiner Endlichkeitssatz der Hydrodynamik. Math. Ann., 117:764– 775, 1941. ¨ 72. E. Hopf. Uber die Anfangswertaufgabe f¨ ur die hydrodynamischen Grundgleichungen. Math. Nachr., 4:213–231, 1951. 73. R.B. Kellogg and J.E. Osborn. A regularity result for the Stokes problem in a convex polygon. J. Funct. Anal., 21:397–431, 1976. 74. N. Kevlahan and J.-M. Ghidaglia. Computation of turbulent flow past an array of cylinders using a spectral method with Brinkman penalization. Eur. J. Mech., B, Fluids, 20(3):333–350, 2001. 75. K. Khadra, S. Parneix, P. Angot, and J.-P. Caltagirone. Fictitious domain approach for numerical modeling of Navier-Stokes equation. Int. J. Numer. Meth. in Fluids, 34(8):651–684, 2000. 76. O. Ladyzhenskaya. The Mathematical Theory of Viscous Incompressible Flow. Gordon and Breach, New York, 1963. 77. O. Ladyzhenskaya and V.A. Solonnikov. Unique solvability of an initial and boundary value problem for viscous incompressible non-homogeneous fluids. J. ZSoviet. Math., 9:697–749, 1978. 78. C. Le Bris and P.-L. Lions. Renormalized solutions of some transport equations with partially W 1,1 velocities and applications. Ann. Mat. Pura Appl. (4), 183(1):97–130, 2004. 79. J. Leray. Essai sur les mouvements plans d’un liquide visqueux emplissant l’espace. Acta Math., 63:193–248, 1934. 80. J. Leray. Essai sur les mouvements plans d’un liquide visqueux que limitent des parois. J. Math. Pures Appl., 13:331–418, 1934. 81. R. Lewandowski and G. Pichot. Numerical simulation of water flow around a rigid fishing net. Comput. Methods Appl. Mech. Engrg., 196(45-48):4737–4754, 2007. 82. G.M. Lieberman. Regularized distance and its applications. Pacific J. Math., 117(2):329–352, 1985. 83. T. Lining and Y. Hongjun. Classical solutions to Navier-Stokes equations for nonhomogeneous incompressible fluids with non-negative densities. J. Math. Anal. Appl., 362(2):476–504, 2010.

References

521

84. J.-L. Lions. Quelques m´ ethodes de r´ esolution des probl` emes aux limites non lin´ eaires. Dunod, Paris, 1969. 85. J.-L. Lions and E. Magenes. Probl` emes aux limites non homog` enes et applications. Vol. 1. Travaux et Recherches Math´ematiques, No. 17. Dunod, Paris, 1968. 86. P.-L. Lions. Mathematical topics in fluid mechanics, Tome 1 : Incompressible models, volume 3 of Oxford Lecture Series in Mathematics and Applications. Oxford University Press, New York, 1996. 87. P.-L. Lions. Mathematical topics in fluid mechanics, Tome 2 : Compressible models, volume 10 of Oxford Lecture Series in Mathematics and Applications. Oxford University Press, New York, 1998. 88. A.J. Majda and A.L. Bertozzi. Vorticity and incompressible flow, volume 27 of Cambridge Texts in Applied Mathematics. Cambridge University Press, Cambridge, UK, 2002. 89. V.G. Maz ya and S.V. Poborchi. Differentiable functions on bad domains. World Scientific, River Edge, NJ, 1997. 90. R.E. Meyer. Introduction to mathematical fluid dynamics. Dover, New York, 1982. Corrected reprint of the 1971 original. 91. J. Neˇ cas. Sur les normes equivalentes dans Wpk et sur la coercivite des formes formellement positives. Sem. math. sup. Universite Montreal, pages 102–128, 1966. 92. J. Neˇcas. Direct Methods in the Theory of Elliptic Equations. Springer, New York, 2012. 93. A. Novotn´ y and I. Straˇskraba. Introduction to the mathematical theory of compressible flow, volume 27 of Oxford Lecture Series in Mathematics and its Applications. Oxford University Press, Oxford, 2004. 94. J.P. O’Connell and J.M. Haile. Thermodynamics: Fundamentals for Applications (Cambridge Series in Chemical Engineering). Cambridge University Press, Cambridge, UK,, 2005. 95. A. Pazy. Semigroups of linear operators and applications to partial differential equations, volume 44 of Applied Mathematical Sciences. Springer-Verlag, New York, 1983. 96. J. Peetre. Sur la transformation de Fourier des fonctions ` a valeurs vectorielles. Rend. Sem. Math. Univ. Padova, 42:15–26, 1969. 97. C. Peskin. Numerical analysis of blood flow in the heart. J. Comput. Phys., 25:220– 252, 1977. 98. C. Peskin. The fluid dynamics of heart valves: Experimental, theoretical and comptutational method. Annu. Rev. Fluid Mech, 14:235–259, 1982. 99. W. Rudin. Principles of mathematical analysis. International Series in Pure and Applied Mathematics. McGraw-Hill, New York, third edition, 1976. 100. W. Rudin. Real and complex analysis. McGraw-Hill, New York, third edition, 1987. 101. W. Rudin. Functional analysis. International Series in Pure and Applied Mathematics. McGraw-Hill, New York, second edition, 1991. 102. I.L. Ryhming. Dynamique des fluides. Presses Polytechniques et Universitaires Romandes, Lausanne, second edition, 2004. Un cours de base du deuxi`eme cycle universitaire. 103. E.M. Saiki and S. Biringen. Numerical simulation of a cylinder in uniform flow: application of a virtual boundary method. J. Comput. Phys., 123:450–465, 1996. 104. L. Schwartz. Analyse. Deuxi` eme partie: Topologie g´ en´ erale et analyse fonctionnelle. Collection Enseignement des Sciences, No. 11. Hermann, Paris, 1970. 105. L. Schwartz. Analyse. I Th´ eorie des ensembles et topologie. [Set theory and topology], With the collaboration of K. Zizi, volume 42 of Collection Enseignement des Sciences [Collection: The Teaching of Science]. Hermann, Paris, 1991. 106. J. Serrin. On the interior regularity of weak solutions of the Navier-Stokes equations. Arch. Rational Mech. Anal., 9:187–195, 1962. 107. J. Serrin. The initial value problem for the Navier-Stokes equations. In Nonlinear Problems (Proc. Sympos., Madison, Wis., 1962), pages 69–98. Univ. of Wisconsin Press, Madison, 1963.

522

References

108. J. Simon. Caract´erisation d’espaces fonctionnels. Bolletino Un. Math. Ital. B, 5(2):687–714, 1978. 109. J. Simon. Compact sets in the space Lp (0, T ; B). Ann. Mat. Pura appl., 146(4):65–96, 1987. 110. J. Simon. Nonhomogeneous viscous incompressible fluids: Existence of velocity, density and pressure. SIAM J. Math. Anal., 21(5):1093–1117, 1990. 111. J. Simon. D´emonstration constructive d’un th´eor` eme de G. de Rham. C. R. Acad. Sci. Paris, S´ er. I, 316:1167–1172, 1993. 112. J. Simon. Representation of distributions with explicit antiderivatives up to the boundary. In Progress in partial differential equations: The Metz surveys, 2 (1992), volume 296 of Pitman Res. Notes Math. Ser., pages 201–215. Longman Sci. Tech., Harlow, 1993. 113. J. Simon. Distributions et espaces de Lebesgue ` a valeurs dans un espace vectoriel topologique localement convexe, 2009. http://math.unice.fr/~jsimon/pubs/ Simon-E12.pdf. 114. D.R. Smart. Fixed point theorems, volume 66 of Cambridge tracts in mathematics. Cambridge University Press, 1974. 115. H. Sohr. Zur Regularit¨ atstheorie der instation¨ aren Gleichungen von Navier-Stokes. Math. Z., 184(3):359–375, 1983. 116. H. Sohr and W. von Wahl. On the singular set and the uniqueness of weak solutions of the Navier-Stokes equations. Manuscripta Math., 49(1):27–59, 1984. 117. E. M. Stein. Singular integrals and differentiability properties of functions. Princeton Mathematical Series, No. 30. Princeton University Press, Princeton, NJ, 1970. 118. L. Tartar. Topics in nonlinear analysis, volume 13 of Publications Math´ ematiques d’Orsay 78. Universit´ e de Paris-Sud D´epartement de Math´ematique, Orsay, 1978. 119. L. Tartar. An introduction to Navier-Stokes equation and oceanography, volume 1 of Lecture Notes of the Unione Matematica Italiana. Springer-Verlag, Berlin, 2006. 120. R. Temam. Navier-Stokes equations and nonlinear functional analysis, volume 66 of CBMS-NSF Regional Conference Series in Applied Mathematics. Society for Industrial and Applied Mathematics (SIAM), Philadelphia, second edition, 1995. 121. R. Temam. Infinite Dimensional Dynamical Systems in Mechanics and Physics. Second edition, volume 68 of Applied Mathematical Sciences. Springer Verlag, New York, 1997. 122. R. Temam. Navier-Stokes equations. AMS Chelsea, Providence, RI, 2001. Theory and numerical analysis, Reprint of the 1984 edition. 123. R. Temam and A. Miranville. Mathematical modeling in continuum mechanics. Cambridge University Press, Cambridge, UK, second edition, 2005. 124. X. M. Wang. A remark on the characterization of the gradient of a distribution. Appl. Anal., 51(1-4):35–40, 1993. 125. C. Wassgren, C. M. Krousgrill, and P. Carmody. The continuum assumption. https: //engineering.purdue.edu/~wassgren/applet/java/continuum/index.html. 126. R. Kh. Zeytounian. Theory and applications of nonviscous fluid flows. SpringerVerlag, Berlin, 2002. 127. R. Kh. Zeytounian. Theory and applications of viscous fluid flows. Springer-Verlag, Berlin, 2004.

Index

Adjoint operator, 111 Balance equation for angular momentum, 9, 18 for energy, 10, 19, 363 for entropy, 30 for linear momentum, 8, 17 for mass, 8 Bochner integral, 92 Boundary conditions Dirichlet, 222 Neumann, 226, 307 on the stress, 315 on the vorticity, 329 outflow, 454 Boundary layer, 472 Characteristic equation, 4 Compactness in function spaces, 77 of mappings, 79 of Sobolev embeddings, 167 weak and weak- , 53 Conservative/Nonconservative form, 19, 410 Continuous medium, 2 Coordinates cylindrical, 508 Eulerian, 3 Lagrangian, 3 Critical exponent, 167 Differential operator curl, 252, 507 divergence, 245, 507 gradient, 241, 507 Dimensionless number

Froude, 39 Mach, 35 Reynolds, 39 Distribution theory, 71 div/curl problem, 269 regularity, 304 Domains, 122 cone property, 126 definitions, 122, 189 distance to the boundary, 50, 191 first fundamental form, 190 integral on the boundary, 131 Lipschitz, 123 outward unit normal, 132 parametrisation near the boundary, 200, 203, 217 projection on the boundary, 191 regularised distance, 194 star-shaped, 130 Extension operator, 233 Flow Couette, 46 incompressible, 32 laminar, 39 planar shear, 44 Poiseuille, 43 steady, 32 turbulent, 39 Fourier transform, 106 Galerkin approximation, 354, 435, 459 Inequality Bihari, 90 Clarkson, 65

F. Boyer and P. Fabrie, Mathematical Tools for the Study of the Incompressible Navier-Stokes Equations and Related Models, Applied Mathematical Sciences 183, DOI 10.1007/978-1-4614-5975-0, © Springer Science+Business Media New York 2013

523

524 Gronwall, 88 H¨ older, 58 Hardy, 87, 181, 205 Inf-Sup, 246 Jensen, 59 Korn, 319 LBB, 246 Minkowski, 60 Neˇ cas, 230 Poincar´ e, 179, 238, 285, 320 Poincar´ e–Wirtinger, 180 uniform Gronwall, 89 Young, 58 Interface Stokes problem, 323 Laplace problem, 222, 332 Lebesgue points, 86 Leray projection, 251, 280 Lipschitz continuous functions, 75 Material derivative, 4 Mollifying kernel, 61 Mollifying operator, 138, 162 Navier–Stokes equations homogeneous, 38, 346 nonhomogeneous, 37, 409 steady solutions, 391 strong solutions, 370 weak formulations, 347 weak solutions, 346 Newtonian fluids, 23 Partition of unity, 68 Penalty method, 287, 470 Self-adjoint operator, 111 Sobolev spaces, 121 change of variables, 149 definitions, 136 duality theory, 159 embeddings, 167 extension operator, 150 local Sobolev spaces, 136 precised embeddings, 173 product theorem, 176 tangential Sobolev spaces, 206 trace and trace lifting operators, 153 weak traces, 185, 248, 257, 332 Space H, 249 L20 (Ω), 239 Lp (Ω), 56 Lp (]0, T [, X), 92

Index Lploc (Ω), 67 V , 249 W 1,1 (]0, T [), 84 m,p (Ω), 136 Wloc C0α (Ω), 50 C k (Ω), 50 Cbk (Ω), 50 D (Ω), 71 Hdiv (Ω), 248 Hdiv,curl,ν (Ω), 260 Hdiv,curl,ν,0 (Ω), 260 Hcurl (Ω), 257 V , 249 C 0 ([0, T ], Xweak ), 95 H¨ older continuous functions, 50 Lipschitz continuous functions, 50 Nikolskii, 105, 109 Stokes operator, 278 Stokes problem, 273 Lq theory, 302 homogeneous, 274 nonhomogeneous, 276 regularity, 281, 290 unsteady solutions, 286 Tensor contracted product, 510 strain rate, 21 stress, 15, 316 Tensor product, 510 Theorem Agmon–Douglis–Nirenberg, 302 Ascoli, 77 Aubin–Lions–Simon, 102 Banach–Steinhaus, 52 Cattabriga, 303 Cauchy’s stress, 11 Clausius, 26, 514 de Rham, 243 Density of smooth functions, 144 density of smooth functions, 63, 262 divergence theorem, 133 Friedrichs commutation lemma, 143, 148, 162 Hausdorff–Young, 106 interpolation, 66, 93, 94 Kolmogorov, 78 Lax–Milgram, 52 Leray, 352 Lions–Magenes, 99, 101 open mapping, 51 Rademacher, 76 regularity for the Laplace problem, 223, 226

Index right inverse for the divergence, 245 Schauder, 83 Simon, 106 spectral decomposition, 112 Stokes formula, 133, 185, 248, 249, 257 traces, 156, 174, 249 traces lifting, 157 transport, 5 Thermodynamics First law, 512 Second law, 513 Translation operator, 78, 92, 164, 208, 294 Transport equation, 411 initial- and boundary-value problem, 423 renormalisation property, 413

525 stability theorem, 427 trace theorem, 413 weak solutions, 413 Unbounded operator, 110 Viscosity bulk, 27 dynamic, 27 Vorticity, 329 Weak convergence, weak- convergence, 52, 63 WKB expansion, 479